137 88 6MB
English Pages 248 [262] Year 2006
Modern North American Criticism and Theory
Also available:
Modern British and Irish Criticism and Theory Modern European Criticism and Theory
Modern North American Criticism and Theory A Critical Guide ÐÐÐÐÐ
Edited by Julian Wolfreys
Edinburgh University Press
#
The Contributors, 2006
The Edinburgh Encyclopaedia of Modern Criticism and Theory in 2002 First published as part of
Edinburgh University Press Ltd 22 George Square, Edinburgh
Typeset in Ehrhardt by Hewer Text UK Ltd, Edinburgh, and printed and bound in Great Britain by Antony Rowe Ltd, Chippenham, Wilts
A CIP record for this book is available from the British Library
ISBN-10 0 7486 2451 1 (paperback) ISBN-13 978 0 7486 2451 5
The right of the contributors to be identified as authors of this work has been asserted in accordance with the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988.
Contents Preface
1.
Charles Sanders Peirce and Semiotics
vii
1
Kenneth Womack 2.
The New Criticism
4
Charles Altieri 3.
The Chicago School
12
William Baker 4.
Northrop Frye
19
Imre Salusinszky 5.
The Encounter with Structuralism and the Invention of Poststructuralism
26
Mark Currie 6.
Reception Theory and Reader-Response: Norman Holland, Stanley Fish and David Bleich
33
Jeremy Lane 7.
The Yale Critics? J. Hillis Miller, Geoffrey Hartman, Harold Bloom, Paul de Man
40
Ortwin de Graef 8.
Deconstruction in America
49
William Flesch 9.
Fredric Jameson and Marxist Literary and Cultural Criticism
55
Carolyn Lesjak 10.
Edward W. Said
63
John Kucich 11.
American Feminisms: Images of Women and Gynocriticism
70
Ruth Robbins 12.
Feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s: The Encounter with Poststructuralism and Gender Studies
79
Megan Becker-Leckrone 13.
Psychoanalysis and Literary Criticism
87
Megan Becker-Leckrone 14.
Feminists of Colour
Anne Donadey
96
contents
vi 15. Stephen Greenblatt and the New Historicism
103
Virginia Mason Vaughan 16. Lesbian and Gay Studies/Queer Theory
110
David Van Leer 17. Postcolonial Studies
118
Malini Johar Schueller 18. Cultural Studies and Multiculturalism
126
Marcel Cornis-Pope 19. African-American Studies
135
Yun Hsing Wu 20. Chicano/a Literature
143
 de la Luz Montes Amelia Maria 21. Film Studies
150
Toby Miller 22. Feminist Film Studies and Film Theory
159
Julian Wolfreys 23. Ethical Criticism
167
Kenneth Womack 24. Postmodernism
176
Marcel Cornis-Pope 25. The Role of Journals in Theoretical Debate
186
Kate Flint 26. Whiteness Studies
193
Betsy Nies 27. Masculinity and Cultural Studies
199
David Alderson 28. Comics Studies
207
Christopher Eklund 29. Anglophone Canadian Literary Studies
214
Fiona Tolan 30. Francophone Canadian Literature
224
Elodie Rousselot Contributors
229
Index
230
Preface Modern North American Criticism and Theory
presents the reader with a comprehensive and
critical introduction to the development and institutionalization of literary and cultural studies throughout the twentieth century and at the beginning of the twenty-first in North American
universities.
Focusing
on
the
growth
and
expansion
of
critical
trends
and
methodologies, with particular essays addressing key figures in their historical and cultural contexts,
the
present
continuous quest
volume
offers
for and affirmation
a
narrative
of
change,
transformation
of multiple cultural voices
and
the
and identities. It is a
narrative on the one hand that traces the movements, schools of thought and institutional allegiances that have emerged, while, on the other hand, it considers the ways in which the close reading and formal analysis of works of literature have given way to more politicized and theorized accounts. From semiotics and the New Criticism to the identity politics of Whiteness
Studies,
the
cultural
study
of
masculinity
assumptions of cultural value by Comics Studies,
Theory
and
the
challenge
presented
to
Modern North American Criticism and
provides an overview of literary and cultural study in North America as a history of
questioning, debate and exploration. While emphasizing the practice and theory of literary and cultural criticism in many of its historically specific guises, the present volume also provides extensive critical coverage of related cultural issues in the articles, and the contextual discourses that inform those issues. Clearly the focus is on the institutional practice of criticism and, with that, an implicit narrative develops concerning acts of institutionalization. Another way to understand this is that there takes place repeatedly instances of accommodation, domestication and, in some cases, normalization of currents of thought imported or translated from other disciplines, other fields of thought, and, in the case of so-called high theory from the late 1960s to the 1980s, other cultures of critical thinking. This is inevitable in any process of institutionalization. It is a matter of what Jacques Derrida has referred to as auto-immunization. Any institution ± but it has to be said the university is particularly good at this, and thus exemplifies the means by which institutionalization maintains itself ± takes in and makes over just enough of some
other
in order to
keep it going. In that act of self-interested maintenance there is also an act of hospitality. Such reciprocity is an inescapable feature of any accommodation. One welcomes the other into one's home, across the threshold, boundary or border as a gesture of hospitality and welcome. But intrinsic to this welcome, inextricably tied up with any such act, is a desire to render the foreign, the other, that which is different, less other, less strange or threatening perhaps. Hospitality assumes both tolerance and neutralization, and it seeks to maintain a
preface
viii
degree of mastery through taking in just enough of the other into its system, immunizing itself if you will, in order to allow it to carry on with business as usual. Again, the university is wonderfully effective in such processes, and nowhere has this appeared to be more the case than in institutions of higher education in North America. Such incorporations are not without consequences, without the rise of contest
and
conflict; and also, not inconsequent to the encounters between a more or less idealized notion of community such as the `university' are the misreadings and misperceptions, the avoidances, the non-reception and even occasionally the hostilities that provide some of the more visible punctuations within the history of criticism and theory. (Hostility, after all, shares its roots, at least etymologically, with volume
chart
and
reflect
on
the
hospitality
accommodations
and
.) The articles in the present
resistances,
the
tolerances
and
intolerances. In this, each article concerns itself not only with the formalist contours and epistemological parameters of a particular discourse or movement, it also acknowledges the cultural, historical and ideological specificities of the emergence and transformation of criticism. Together and individually, the essays offer to the reader a view of the extent to which philosophy, poetics, politics, aesthetics, linguistics and psychoanalysis are part of the densely imbricated textures of critical practice. Furthermore, while remaining aware of the importance of the various contexts within and out of which criticism has grown, the essays herein
also
concern
themselves
with
the
equally
important
issue
of
cross-fertilization
between the various academic and intellectual cultures under consideration.
American Criticism and Theory
Modern North
thus provides the reader with a comprehension of the key
issues with the intention of demonstrating that those issues and the fields into which they are woven are marked by, even as they themselves re-mark, an unending and vital process of hybridization ± of methodologies, disciplines, discourses and interests. In this, taken together the essays comprising the present volume interrogate implicitly the very condition of the practice and theory of criticism itself. In presenting the various facets of critical activity across one century approximately, there have been omissions, doubtless. This is true of the shaping of any narrative. Even so, it
is
hoped
that
the
overall
contours
of
critical
practice
in
North
America
are
not
misrepresented, and that, concomitantly, the dominant hegemonies of thought in their particular historical and cultural moments are neither distorted nor in some other manner misrepresented. It has to be said that if there is no such thing as a pure discourse, selfsufficient and closed off from influences, confluences and even contaminations, there is also no such thing as a finite context or group of contexts. One obviously cannot speak of either purely national or universal determinations; equally one cannot ascribe to critical thinking a finite or unchanging condition. The very definition of literary criticism and its institutional manifestations is as an identity always in crisis, and always accommodated as such in its mutability. Intellectual cultures, like literary genres, have moments of historical ascendance, ideological transformation and hegemonic dominance. Appearing to lose that dominance, going `out of fashion' as is sometimes perceived in the more journalistic of interpretations, traces, influences, remain, continuing to be transformed, and so to effect the cultures of criticism in which the reader is presently situated. It is with such issues, such processes
and
cultures
Criticism and Theory
of
transformation
and
is purposely involved.
translation
that
Modern North American Julian Wolfreys
1. Charles Sanders Peirce (1839±1914) and Semiotics
Coined
by
American
philosopher
Charles
Sanders
Peirce,
the
concept
of
semiotics
involved, at least initially, the examination of various signs and signifiers in relation to one another. Peirce's linguistic theories underscored the significance of social and cultural interaction as fundamental aspects of language. Peirce's discoveries regarding the three classes of signs and the notion of pluralism, moreover, continue to impact the direction of contemporary linguistics and literary criticism. As a foundational philosopher and exponent of pragmatism, Peirce would seem, at least on the scholarly surface, to be an unlikely proponent of semiotics and its remarkable impact upon twentieth-century linguistics. Nevertheless, he shared in the establishment of several basic principles of modern linguistics. In 1906, Peirce identified the nature and study of signs as a kind of semiosis. Peirce recognized that the emergence of semiotics as a science in its own right required a more dynamic understanding of signification as a linguistic process. As John Deely observes, Peirce realized that `semiotics could not be merely a response to the question of the being proper to signs ontologically considered'. Rather, `response must also be made to the further question of the becoming this peculiar type of being enables and sustains itself by. Symbols do not just exist', Deely adds, `[t]hey also grow' (1990, 23). Understanding the social organicism inherent in signs and symbols, Peirce approached semiotics as a distinctive activity in itself and referred to the relationship between such linguistic components as the product of `brute force' and `dynamical interaction'. Peirce defined the actions and relationships of signs in terms of their objectivity, while intuitively comprehending
the
subjectivity
that
they
take
on
when
considered
in
regard
to
the
present, to the social and cultural forces that exist in the here and now. Simply put, given historical and cultural moments imbue signs and symbols with variant degrees of meaning dependent purely upon the function of time and place. Having established the interactional and temporal properties of signs, Peirce demonstrated the nature of their action via the concepts of mediation and triadicity. First, signs are invariably mediated by external forces ± history, culture, time ± and these mediating entities concept,
characterize the
process
the of
ways
in
triadicity,
which finds
we its
interpret
origins
in
signs the
and
dyadic
symbols.
The
relationship
second
between
the sign itself and the signified, which refers to the idea that constitutes the sign's meaning. Peirce furthered this notion in terms of a more complex, triadic relationship between the sign and the signified, as well as between the sign and the interpretant, which Peirce
modern north american criticism and theory
2
described as `all that is explicit in the sign itself apart from its context and circumstances of utterance' (cit. Deely 1990, 26). For Peirce, signs become actualized when they represent something other than themselves. Signs exist as mere objects when standing on their own. In other words, signs always depend upon something other than themselves to establish their uniqueness. In Peirce's philosophy, then, signs are inevitably subordinate to their qualities of representation. As Deely notes, `the key to understanding what is proper to the sign is the notion of relativity, relation, or relative being. Without this content, the sign ceases to be a sign, whatever else it may happen to be' (35). Essentially, signs can only be recognized in a relational context with something other than themselves; hence, signs take on their unique characteristics of being when interpreted in terms of their historical or cultural antecedents. The Peircean philosophy of triadicity provided the basis for his postulation of the three classes of signs, which Peirce identified in terms of the relationship between the sign and the signified. The first class of signs, the icon, operates by virtue of its shared features and similarities with that which it signifies. In his work, Peirce referred to the icon rather opaquely
as
a
`possibility
involving
a
possibility,
and
represented as a possibility' (cit. Merrell 1997, 53). In Floyd
Merrell
describes
icons
in
regard
to
their
thus
the
possibility
of
its
Peirce, Signs, and Meaning
inherent
self-referentiality
as
being
(1997),
`signs
of
themselves and themselves only' (54). The notion of the index, Peirce's second class of signs, denotes a kind of sign that enjoys a natural relationship with the cause and effect of what it signifies. As Merrell explains, `Indices, by nature binary in character, ordinarily relate to some
other'
(54). The third class of signs, the symbol or `sign proper', refers to the
unnatural relationship between the sign and its signifier. These symbols ultimately function as the words that constitute the nature of a given language. Peirce described the concept of the symbol as `a sign which would lose the character which renders it a sign if there were no interpretant'
(cit.
Lidov
1999,
93).
David
Lidov
usefully
recognizes
the
dependent
relationship that exists between Peirce's three classes of signs. While the notion of the symbol has since come to refer to a broader range of textual and linguistic referents in literary studies, Peirce's classification schema continues to impact on the ways in which we understand the interrelationships ± indeed, the dependency that exists ± between language and the objective reality of a given historical or cultural moment (1999, 93±4). Peirce's contributions to semiotics also include his expansive philosophies of pragmatism and pluralism, schools of intellectual thought that continue to impact on the course and direction of scholarship in the humanities. Peirce introduced his ground-breaking philosophy
of
pragmatism
during
a
1903
lecture
at
Harvard
University.
His
concept
of
pragmatism finds its roots, moreover, in our collective understanding of the larger ethical and communal matrix of human behaviour. More than a simple practical approach to life and human discourse, Peirce's pragmatism involves a recognition of the highest form of good, which he describes as the ways in which communities search for forms of higher truth. Peirce ascribes a given person's capacity for accomplishing a higher sense of goodness to their ability to achieve what he refers to as self-control. `In its higher stages', Peirce writes, `evolution takes place more and more largely through self-control, and this gives the pragmatist
a
sort
of
justification
for
making
the
rational
purport
to
be
general'
(cit.
Corrington 1993, 53). By entering into the development and community of the world, then, the pragmatist in Peirce's formulation evolves toward ideal states of being that imbue life
with
more
rational
and
objective
senses
of
reality.
In
a
1905
essay
on
`Issues
of
Pragmaticism', Peirce attributes his philosophy of pragmatism to a kind of critical common-
charles sanders peirce and semiotics
3
sensism, which, in the words of Robert S. Corrington, `applies evolutionary thinking to the unconscious and foundational propositions of our moral and scientific life' (1993, 54). Honouring the strictures of critical common-sensism affords pragmatists with the capacity for enjoying greater possibilities for self-control and rationalism. The seemingly logical intellectual result of his notion of a pragmatic philosophy, Peirce's concept of pluralism finds its origins in the multifarious ways in which we perceive the worlds in which we live. In Peirce's philosophical purview, our sensory perceptions of the world
are
contingent
upon
the
interdependence
between
our
experiences
±
however
divergent they may be ± of reality and the facticity inherent in the perceived worlds of our human others. `The real world is the world of sensible experiences', Peirce writes, and `the sensory world is but a fragment of the ideal world' (cit. Rosenthal 1994, 3). The notion of possibility ± in fact, the very same concept of possibility inherent in the vague spaces of reality
that
exist
between
our
real
worlds
and
our
sensory
worlds
±
operates
as
the
foundation for Peirce's philosophy of pluralism. Sandra B. Rosenthal ascribes the philosopher's ultimate vision of plurality to a comprehension of the power inherent in our creative selves:
Human creativity can be understood as a uniquely specialized, highly intensified instance of the free creative activity characteristic of the universe within which it functions, and the conditions of possibility of human freedom in general, as self-directedness rooted in rationality, are to be found in the conditions that constitute the universe at large and within which rationality emerges. (Rosenthal 1994, 126)
Clearly, Peirce's ideas of possibility and pluralism ± rooted, as they are, in notions of freedom and rationality ± offer a fertile intellectual background for the analysis of signs, symbols
and
signifiers,
open-ended
concepts
that
are
invariably
contingent
upon
the
infinitely more powerful social forces of a given historical and cultural moment.
Kenneth Womack
Further reading and works cited Chomsky, N.
Aspects of the Theory of Syntax. Cambridge, MA, 1965.
Colapietro, V.
Peirce's Approach to the Self. Albany, NY, 1989.
Corrington, R. S.
Deely, J. Eco, U.
An Introduction to C. S. Peirce. Lanham, MA, 1993.
The Pursuit of Signs. Ithaca, NY, 1981.
Culler, J.
Basics of Semiotics. Bloomington, IN, 1990.
A Theory of Semiotics. Bloomington, IN, 1976.
Hawkes, T. Holland, N. Jameson, F. Lidov, D.
Structuralism and Semiotics. London, 1977. The Critical I. New York, 1992. The Prison-House of Language. Princeton, NJ, 1972.
Elements of Semiotics. New York, 1999.
Malmberg, B. Merrell, F.
Structural Linguistics and Human Communication . Berlin, 1967.
Peirce, Signs, and Meaning. Toronto, 1997.
Rosenthal, S. B.
Charles Peirce's Pragmatic Pluralism. Albany, NY, 1994.
2. The New Criticism
Recent literary theory has had very little good to say about the New Criticism. As Gerald Graff puts it, `With remarkable speed, the fortunes of the New Criticism in the university had gone from rags to riches to routine' in two decades (Graff 1987, 227). Here I will argue that there is much to learn from both transitions. The New Criticism struck it rich in America because the founding efforts of a few critics ± especially John Crowe Ransom, Allen Tate, R. P. Blackmur, Robert Penn Warren and Cleanth Brooks ± came to represent two important possibilities for literary education and hence drew many people into loose associations with most of their principles. These critics spoke for many who came to believe it was time to focus on what held individual texts together as distinctive experiences rather than on what bound them to contexts they shared with other aspects of their culture. And they
promised
that
such
experiences
would
foster
powers
encouraging
revolutionary
changes in educational practices. The prevailing emphasis on historical and philological scholarship
could
be
replaced
by
more
direct
efforts
to
address
the
`dissociation
of
sensibility' that T. S. Eliot had diagnosed as the fundamental torment for contemporary culture. But the emerging consensus was made routine because the stress on cultivating powers soon
gave
way
to
a
transmittable
method
in
which
close
readings
instruments for producing original interpretations explicating the `
were
organic unity
treated
as
' that gave
the texts their unique identities. Cognitive claims then typically got reduced to thematic analyses, with the statement of ideas replacing the initial ideal of treating the texts as unique experiences that modified sensibilities rather than addressed ideological frameworks. And, as critics like Frank Lentricchia, Terry Eagleton and John Fekete would later point out, it had also come to seem the case that the basic ideas generating this revolution were in fact very difficult to reconcile. The best way to preserve ideals stressing the organic unity of individual texts is to deal with them as discrete specific contexts whose internal densities continually ironize all efforts at generalization. But this route to individuation seemed to depend on bracketing concerns for intentionality and historical contexts that would in fact prove necessary for any adequate account of how texts confer or contribute to the development of cognitive powers. Many of the major New Critical essays were written in the 1930s as part of a ferment in critical culture that linked these critics loosely with others like Kenneth Burke and Yvor Winters and William Empson who were trying to develop general interpretive stances attuned
to
modernist
practices.
But
the
movement
movement with the publication in 1941 of Ransom's
only
took
on
public
The New Criticism
identity
as
a
, with chapters on
Eliot, Winters, Richards and `ontological criticism'. Concentrating on poetry, these early writings defined powers attributable to close reading individual texts by developing sharp
the new criticism
5
contrasts with what were then the two perspectives dominating literary study in America. Because American PhD programmes had been founded in the 1880s on German ideals, the prevailing model for literary study was a positivist historicism concerned with elaborating biographical contexts, tracing the `evolution' of forms, and establishing the sources and influences for major texts. For the New Critics such work seemed to treat those texts as excuses
for
studying
contexts
established
by
the
historian,
not
by
the
project
of
the
individual work. The New Critics found some sustenance in neohumanist critiques of that historicism along fundamentally Arnoldian lines. Thinkers like Norman Foerster and Paul Elmer More tried to replace historical frameworks by discourses insisting on the intellectual and moral significance of individual texts. But because these critics treated these texts as offering beliefs that could enter into dialogue with the great philosophers, they seemed no less eager than the historians to sacrifice text to context. The New Critics' primary task then was to develop a vocabulary and methodology that could foreground what seemed the distinctive concrete experience produced by the words of the text so as to reduce the need for either historical or philosophical contexts. In hindsight it is easy to say that they went too far ± clearly, reading is a dialogical relation among what Rene Wellek called `intrinsic and extrinsic' aspects of a text's presence in the world. But such rapprochement is difficult in practice when one's opponents are no more balanced than oneself and seem a lot more dangerous. More important, rapprochement requires a shared sense of practice. But the New Critics came to power largely because they would not accept the fundamentally academic nature of the discourses carried out by their opponents. Early New Criticism was suffused with the passions of modernist writing. It saw criticism not primarily as scholarship but as an instrument for taking on the cultural project of resisting the `
dissociation of sensibility
' diagnosed by T. S. Eliot as the basic disease facing
modernity. And it therefore concentrated on ways of reading that might actually make a difference in how audiences engaged the blend of market thinking, positivist empiricism and
enervated
romanticism
that
seemed
to
carry
public
authority
in
their
respective
domains. American New Critical responses to these cultural forces were mostly reactionary. Their roots were Southern agrarian and their sense of manners Mandarin. But resisting modernity was
a
task
that
bred
strange
alliances.
We
have
to
imagine
those
Southern
values
interacting with a new academic clientele undreamt of in historicist and neohumanist philosophies. Only a few years after Ransom's book, the GI Bill sent millions of Americans to universities and colleges, usually as the first members of their families to enter higher education. And that rush to education soon filtered down into the children of parents who had suffered in the name of freedom and wanted to begin reaping some of its benefits. These new populations had quite practical goals for their educations. But they were curious about the culture that had seemed worth fighting for, and a new age of opportunity made it appealing to imagine remaking psyches through the arts. These new students would not sit long for dry scholarship or pious moralizing, and they could not be expected to bring to their classes the historical education or the trainings in discrimination given to those from families with generations of university attendance. But they were a perfect audience for writers committed to plain prose and practical attention to texts. Guided by New Critical principles popularized in the anthology
Understanding Poetry
(1938), students did not have
to bring much learning to literature (and did not have to feel guilty or disqualified by their ignorance of historical contexts). They could work out concrete terms for what brought texts
alive
for
them,
and
they
could
imagine
themselves
participating
in
the
work
of
modern north american criticism and theory
6
cultural reformation largely by recognizing how their reading promised to make their lives quite different from those led by their parents. They could idealize culture as a release from the levelling forces fundamental to modernity without having to idealize the South and its institutions. After all, these American Southerners themselves learned a good deal from the English psychologist
I.
A.
Richards,
whose
presence
seems
to
me
fundamental
to
the
field
of
possibilities and struggles that was to constitute New Critical theorizing during the years when it was consolidating power. Richards's experiments
over
several
years
with
Practical Criticism
undergraduates
(1929) recorded a series of
reading
for
an
honours
degree
in
English at Cambridge. Given poems for which the author was not identified, these gifted and privileged students nonetheless proved themselves simply awful readers. They were trained to provide historical backgrounds for identified texts, but they had very weak abilities to interpret and to evaluate work not situated historically for them. Analysing this data led Richards to postulate ten aspects of reading for which teachers and critics had to provide
`educational
models
more
efficient
than
those
we
use
now
in
developing
discrimination and the power to understand what we hear and read' (1929, 3). Criticism then was not recondite scholarship but the struggle to provide society improved means of making and communicating intricate judgements. Richards's
Principles of Literary Criticism
(1924) presented his most influential effort to
restructure the education enabling such judgements. All the ladders start with a fundamental
distinction
eliminating
between
psychology
and
science
and
developing
poetry.
methods
Science for
seeks
generating
true
propositions
unequivocal,
by
testable
statements. Poetry, on the other hand, is not concerned with picturing the world. Its utterances are `pseudo-statements' making possible specific
attitudes
affecting how we take up
stances towards the world. Where science seeks unequivocal clarity enabling firm decisions between
what
is
to
be
believed
and
what
rejected,
poetry
provides
textual
relations
modelling how psyches can compose their energies and form attitudes articulating complex balances for the psyche: `In describing the poet we laid stress upon. . . the width of the field of stimulation which he can accept, and the completeness of the response that he can make.
Compared
with
him
the
ordinary
man
suppresses
nine-tenths
of
his
impulses,
because he is incapable of managing them without confusion' (1924, 243). Art puts inner impulses into `equilibrium' and hence `brings into play far more of our personality than is possible in experiences of more defined emotion' (1924, 251). Close reading is our means of attuning ourselves to such equilibrium, and hence it is fundamental to psychic health. And tragedy's blend of pity, fear and awe offers poetry's richest contribution
to composing
permanent modifications in readerly sensibilities preparing them to adapt more fully to the world. The
New
Critics
deeply
admired
three
basic
features
of Richards's
arguments
±
his
emphasis on criticism as oriented towards cultural literacy rather than towards scholarship, his finding cultural roles for modernist emphases on complexity, and his locating that complexity primarily in how texts are read as semantic structures rather than in how they are contextualised. But they were made uneasy by his secular liberal rationalism and his faith in psychological paradigms. So they developed theoretical alternatives for each of his key
principles,
and
in
the
process
they
set
intellectual
currents
running
that
would
transform a potentially radical psychology into routine academic exercises. First and most important, the New Critics could not accept Richards's treating science and poetry as just two distinctive practices, each with its own roles to play in society. The
the new criticism
7
New Critics had to demonize science because it was the source of dissociated sensibility and the basic instrument for industrial capitalism. Science gave public authority to an inflexible empiricism that could deal with bodies but not with souls, with pleasures but not with the intricate
purposiveness of meanings constructed by the imagination. More
drastic yet,
science gave currency to myths of progress in every domain, so that people were tempted to overlook all that is tragic and unexplainable and probably unchangeable in their lives. Where the populace had once managed to accept their fates, now they would feel entitled to resentment and society would be rife with conflict. Second, treating the textual density of poetry as if it were mere pseudo-statement simply did not provide a sufficient counterweight to science or to the romantic psychologizing that gave personal resonance to myths of progress and individuality. Poetry had to do more than establish possible attitudes toward the world that were valuable because of the complex states of mind produced. States of mind are useless or dangerous unless they are anchored in actual truths. Only the disciplines associated with pursuing truths beyond the self could free the western psyche from the self-absorption imposed upon it by the nineteenth century. So theory had to show how literature provided cognitive access to some kind of distinctive truth to which science did not have access (a task which required privileging poetry over the novel's embeddedness in social issues). The third dissatisfaction followed naturally. Richards' concern was primarily with how psyches processed different kinds of meanings. But an effective poetics would stress texts, not psyches, since only attention to the text itself
could
discursive
establish
knowledge
objective rivalling
evidence what
for
science
the
claims
could
that
provide.
poetry
provided
Stressing
texts
a
non-
required
minimizing context, and that could best be done by showing how most contextual work depended on what W. K. Wimsatt called the `intentional fallacy'. There seemed only two choices ± either one proposed contexts that limited what the words could be seen as performing or one trusted the complex patterning implicit in the verbal texture as the ultimate arbiter of what texts meant. Each major New Critic offered a distinctive slant on these topics. Here, I will try to indicate their major differences by concentrating on three different ways they went about approaching Richards
the
question
stressed
the
of
overall
poetry's
access
balancing
of
to
truths
affective
unavailable
investments,
to
science.
Ransom
Where
locates
the
balancing in real miraculous integrations of the physical and the metaphorical, Tate turns to what can be known by our experience of the text as itself a real event, and Brooks takes organicism to its logical extreme in a vision of poetry as complex dramatic irony. From there, only routinization can follow because all texts end up sustaining pretty much the same kind of experience. Ransom's model of poetry is based largely on what he came to call a miraculous fusion of local
texture
and
logical
structure.
At
one
pole
we
find
movements
like
imagism
demonstrating the power of a fundamentally physical poetry to make us recognize the sharp edges, the givenness and the density of the material world (1955, 873). But even physical poetry (especially physical poetry) requires rhythm, which is profoundly bodily yet also depends on systemic structures that cannot be made physically visible but appeal to the self-reflexive mind. So poetry is constantly tempted also by a second possibility responding to these transformative mental energies. Ransom calls this orientation that of `Platonic poetry'. We must feel the energy of an allegorical pull organizing the elements into some kind of overall meaningfulness. But at the same time Ransom constantly reminds us of the danger within this Platonic impulse because it is happiest when it can march images like
modern north american criticism and theory
8
`little lambs to the slaughter' (1955, 874). Because this Platonic impulse is so strong within us, we need poetry to provide concrete trials for its ideas (1955, 875), and even to establish a density of experience that does not so much disprove the idea as make it `look ineffective and therefore foolish' (1955, 876). Ultimately Ransom denigrates ideas in order to celebrate experiences that can build on reason's
energies
encounters
the
but
thwart
fundamental
its
self-confidence.
religious
awareness
Then of
even
how
spirit
in
secular
can
live
contexts
one
incarnationally
in cooperation with the sensuous world rather than as its master. Poetry is cognition in resistance to reason. So where `science gratifies a rational or practical impulse and exhibits the minimum of perception, Art gratifies a perceptual impulse and exhibits the minimum of reason' (1955, 877). `Miraculism' is our recognition of how this minimum of reason turns out
to
be
a
maximum
of
spirit,
as
we
see
most
fully
in
poetry
that
is
fundamentally
metaphysical (that is physical and Platonic). This poetry manifests metaphoric powers capable of making what had seemed mere analogy proceed `to an identification which is complete' (1955, 880). As a mundane example consider how fully true lovers can make real the figure of exchanging hearts. And as a sublime example think of how Milton's
Lost
comes
to
represent
for
us
the
entire
process
of
the
Fall
and
the
Paradise
possibilities
of
redemption that it created. For Ransom poetry takes on the burden of two centuries of seeking substitutes for religion through art, and it almost succeeds in at least keeping alive the possibility that notions like grace and miracle need not be dismissed because of the demise of organized religion. Allen
Tate
shared
Ransom's
sense
that
the
spirit
of
religion
had
somehow
to
be
preserved in the face of science. But he wanted to base the claims for poetry on something much more defensible in secular terms than talk of miraculism. So he took on the leading semioticians of his day in order to develop a notion of meaning which did not reduce poetry either to non-sense or to the rhetorical manipulation of feelings (1968, 91). Ransom made a
mistake
construct,
locating not
a
the
`reality'
perception
or
of
poetry
in
proposition.
the If
image
poetry
is
because
the
to
a
offer
image
remains
distinctive
kind
a of
knowledge, one must be able to characterize it as a distinctive kind of experience in the real world, and one must do that in terms that reach beyond Richards' purely psychological register. Poetry must be the experience of something for which truth claims can be made. Tate faces these challenges by shifting from what poetry says to what poetry does. Its claim for
truth
depends
on
the
fact
that
the
poem
is
not
merely
about
the
world
but
in
a
significant sense `an object that exists' in its own right (1968, 194). By attending to the work as real object we can show how it provides `complex wholes which are never in a rigid state of adjustment' so that the experience rendered invites `infinitely prolonged attention'. And it is this fascinated prolonging of attention which constitutes the major difference between science and poetry. Where `the half-statement of science arrests our attention at those features of the whole that may be put at the service of the will', poetry presents an object that may be `known' as a `qualitative whole' and hence grasped in terms of the intricacy of the internal relations emerging as aspects of the experience that we cannot control but nonetheless find compelling (1968, 194). Now Tate can provide a theoretical foundation for modernist critiques of views that art is fundamentally a mode of communication, and hence he can show clearly why notions of intention and context based on communication models are inappropriate. Were poetry to seek communication it would have to stress either the extensional or the intentional aspect of
its
assertions.
Either
it
relies
on
specific
claims
to
depict
actual
particulars
or
it
the new criticism
9
concentrates on mobilizing the range of connotations by which expressions indicate how someone feels. In the one case we have images without cogent purposiveness; in the other we have all too evident purposes without what Ransom called trial by experience (1941, 56±63). But if the poem exists in its own right, then rather than communicating it focuses our infinitely prolonged attention on the conditions by which communications are shaped and
modified.
Rather
than
The
audience
stressing
is
witness
intension
or
to
the
extension,
problematic `the
aspects
meaning
of
of
communication.
poetry'
consists
in
`its
``tension'', the full organized body of all the intension and extension that we can find in it' (1941, 64). Poetry offers cognition because it organizes experiences of the complex energies running through human actions and interactions. This mode of cognition in turn cannot be judged and tested in scientific terms but depends on the collective body of reflections on experience previous
that
constitutes
exposure
to
cultural
poetry's
traditions
truths
±
the
(1941,
63).
fundamental
Poetry's circular
truths
depend
argument
that
on the
humanities cannot escape. I think it was grappling with this circularity that led to the making routine of New Criticism, along with all those sociological factors set in motion by success within an institution. For critics had to address two contradictory demands: they had to show how works of literature stressed an internal density or organic unity that made them different from typical communicative acts, and they had to show that they could explain the value of this difference by providing some model of cognition that would display the use value of these texts in terms that science could not replicate but had to envy. The distinction of art as experience from art as statement provided a promising beginning. But how could one make distinctive truth claims about experience without reintroducing the very models from science that had to be resisted? One option was to say that the truths involved were manifest only in the audience's enhanced powers for experience. This path, however, led to undemocratic, Nietzschean visions of agency (or radical theological visions of authenticity) incompatible with New Critical Christian humanism, and it undermined struggles against the authority of science in the universities and in politics. If the arts produce little Nietzsches we need science to tell us how to regulate them. So criticism turned instead to simply finding wisdom within the experiences it was characterizing. `Infinitely prolonged attention' gave way to thematic `readings' explicating ideas and values which held the unity together (when in fact organic unity must be pervasive, with each element playing its irreducible part). Yet these readings still had to stress the specialness of art, even on the thematic level, so they tended to treat texts as `about' the power of art or the mystery of metaphor and of love. Thematics suspicious of science and of philosophy has very few ways to avoid becoming routine. Cleanth Brooks's criticism directly confronted the dilemma of reconciling organic unity claims with cognition claims, but in highly persuasive ways that intensified the pressures on routinization. Where Tate stressed the role of tension at the core of poetic experience Brooks idealized the presentation of paradox resulting from foregrounding that tension. Poetry's terms are `continually modifying each other and thus violating their dictionary meanings' (Brooks 1947, 9). Consequently, assertions in poetry are always confronted with their opposites, and metaphors continually tilt planes and overlap edges so as to bring contradictory possibilities into play. One could praise the paradox as an end in itself, and hence an analogue to Ransom's miraculism. But Brooks took an overtly more secular tack. Rather than stop with the paradoxical meanings, Brooks insisted that we situate these contradictions in dramatic terms. Then poetry has the immense power of making us aware
modern north american criticism and theory
10
at every step of the contradictions fundamental to our desires and our practices. Richards' inclusiveness has cognitive force as dramatic irony. Then, probably to dignify that irony and restore a kind of fideism, Brooks adds the unwarranted but powerful insistence that this sense
of
irony
summarizing affirmation.
is
his
inseparable
from
reading
Randall
of
`the
unity
of
Jarrell's
the
experience
`Eighth
Air
itself'.
Force':
`In
Here this
is
Brooks
poem
the
. . seems to me to supply every qualification that is required. The sense of
self-guilt, the yearning to believe in man's justness.
. . all render accurately and drama-
tically the total situation' (Brooks 1950, 1048). Irony is poetry's truth, and its organic unity is the privileged means by which this completeness of experience gets embodied. Brooks was the most influential of the New Critics on academic practice, probably because he offered very full readings of texts and managed to make theory seem practical rather than philosophical. But his success came with a substantial price. There were many possibilities of `intrinsic criticism' not pursued, especially those offered by Kenneth Burke that stressed authorial action and so were open to a variety of possible projects and ways of organizing materials. More important, the possibilities that were pursued ran the risk of making all readings demonstrate that they have captured the wholeness of the text by revealing how intricately self-cancelling it is. Wholeness could only have cognitive force if it was based on drama ± otherwise it was only an aesthetic abstraction. But all one can know
through
drama
is
the
imposing
of
positionality
on
referentiality.
Poetry
staged
personae whose situation dictated what they could assert or even experience. Burdened
by
such
constraints,
the
New
Criticism
had
lost
most
of
its
intellectual
authority by 1960, although vague idealizations of close reading as a cognitive instrument governed most literary practice for at least the next decade. However, this lost intellectual authority served almost as a contrastive springboard against which two new movements could promote themselves. The perspective that would become deconstruction saw itself the eager heir of `the process of negative totalisation that American criticism discovered when it penetrated more or less unwittingly into the temporal labyrinth of interpretation' (de Man 1971, 35). Where the New Critics tried to domesticate irony by treating it as a form of knowledge subordinate to supple aesthetic and ethical judgements, the spirit of deconstruction required making whatever was positive a direct complement of this absolute negativity.
One
could
not
talk
of
`cognition'
without
convicting
oneself
of
terminal
naivety. There were no miracles connecting the allegorical to the existential; there was only the tracing or remaking of unjustifiable desires exposed in all their hopeless neediness. Yet as de Man's arrogant prose makes visible, one could find deep pleasure and even full psychological release in the process of continually undermining truth claims in the name of fascination or `tragic gaiety'. The ethical correlate of art's dense internal patterning was an absolute writerliness committed to treating the real world by analogies with the process of fingering the folds of the text. There is in all this positioning one irony that de Man apparently did not grasp. At his most arrogant he seems only to repeat one of the most problematic aspects of New Critical theory: `Considerations of the actual and historical existence of writers are a waste of time from a critical viewpoint' (1971, 35). Perhaps only this insouciant dismissal of history could sustain a belief that there is only
a critical viewpoint. In any case de Man entirely failed to
see that what irony erases as a metaphysical negation, history promises to restore as a field of possible
cognitive
attachments.
For
history
needs
no
absolutes
and
promises
not
to
overcome irony but only to contextualize it in its limitations. So it should be no surprise that the most powerful heir to the New Criticism turned out to be a variety of historicisms,
the new criticism
11
each promising its own versions of Brooks's dramatic view of situations but without the uncomfortable baggage of having to find a place for `organic unity' or, indeed, for any terms stressing the existential significance of the internal relations writers establish. It is crucial that we understand how the New Criticism unwittingly set the stage for the success of these historicisms and prepared conditions where a new routinization would soon take hold. It was the New Critics who popularized the demand that literary study pursue cognitive ambitions enabling it to rival the sciences for social and institutional authority. Their particular versions of the cognitive proved impossible to sustain ± in part for their quasi-mystical talk about miraculism or just about `experience', and in part because they could not find a way of making generalizations that was sufficiently responsive to the strong individuality basic to claims about organic unity. But they made literary study very difficult to justify for audiences who had learned to idealize that practice unless the discipline promised some kind of cognitive reward. As the authority of New Criticism waned it became increasingly easy to weaken or bracket the concern for aesthetic unity. That in turn cleared the way to exploring cognitive claims much more closely linked to the kinds of claims made by other disciplines. One could take the particularity of texts as especially dense moments where conjunctions of historical forces become visible. One might even keep principles of close reading but turn them against the aesthetic in order to show how texts worked to conceal ideological interests or to invent ways of grappling with actual historical contradictions. Soon historicist arguments like Terry Eagleton's would analyse the New Critics' evasions of history as itself a historical symptom: these critics were trapped in an aesthetic ideology committed to bourgeois ideals of autonomy, self-sufficiency and independence from demands that might arise from collective interests. Now the first of these successors to the New Criticism is already in ruins, the second has become routine. Perhaps we have arrived at a time when critics will once again take on the social burden of resisting academicism and exploring the powers that can be developed by focusing on how works of art organize experience and create values. They may well find much in New Criticism that can help them, provided that they learn from its history the costs of ignoring history and of seeking too avidly to attach what geniuses make to what critics can know.
Charles Altieri
Further reading and works cited  , P. Bove
Intellectuals in Power.
Brooks, C. Ð.
New York, 1986.
Modern Poetry and the Tradition.
The Well Wrought Urn.
Chapel Hill, NC, 1939.
New York, 1947.
Ð. `Irony as a Principle of Structure', in
Literary Opinion in America,
ed. M. D. Zabel. New York,
1951. Ð with Warren, R. Penn.
Understanding Poetry.
New York, 1938.
Crane, R. S. `History vs Criticism in the University Study of Literature'. October 1935. de Man, P.
Blindness and Insight.
Eagleton, T.
Literary Theory.
Fekete, J.
The Critical Twilight.
Graff, G.
Professing Literature.
Jancovich, M.
New York, 1971.
Oxford, 1983. London, 1978.
Chicago, 1987.
The Cultural Politics of the New Criticism.
Cambridge, 1993.
The English Journal,
24,
modern north american criticism and theory
12
Janssen, M.
The Kenyon Review 1939±1970. Baton Rouge, LA, 1990.
Krieger, M.
The New Apologists for Poetry. Minneapolis, MN, 1956.
Lentricchia, F.
After the New Criticism. London, 1983.
Ransom, J. Crowe.
God Without Thunder.
Ð.
The World's Body. New York, 1938.
Ð.
The New Criticism. Norfolk, 1941.
Ð.
Poems and Essays. New York, 1955.
Richards, I. A. Ð.
Principles of Literary Criticism. London, 1924.
Practical Criticism. London, 1929.
Spurlin, W. J. and Fischer, M. (eds)
The New Criticism and Contemporary Literary Theory . New York,
1995. Tate, A.
Essays of Four Decades. New York, 1968.
Twelve Southerners. Warren, R. Penn.
I'll Take my Stand: The South and the Agrarian Tradition. Baton Rouge, LA, 1980.
Selected Essays. New York, 1958.
Wellek, R. and Warren, A. Winchell, M. R.
Theory of Literature. New York, 1949.
Cleanth Brooks and the Rise of Modern Criticism. Charlottesville, NC, 1996.
Wimsatt, W. K. and Brooks, C. Wimsatt, W. K.
Literary Criticism. New York, 1957.
The Verbal Icon. New York, 1958.
3. The Chicago School
The Chicago School flourished from the later 1930s into the 1950s. It centred on Ronald Salmon Crane (1886±1967), who taught at Chicago from 1924 to 1951. In 1925, he was made professor, and, ten years later, chair of the English department, holding this position until 1947. Although Crane's early output was largely devoted to the post-Restoration period, this work was not ostensibly concerned with the application of Aristotelian ideas to English literary thought, so important to the shaping of the Chicago School. He was also responsible for a bibliography of journalism from 1620 to 1800, published under the title
A
Census of British Newspapers and Periodicals 1620±1800 (1927), and the annual survey of current scholarship in eighteenth-century studies for the edited
from
1930
to
1952.
Crane's
work
was
infused
Philological Quarterly, which he with
neoclassical
ideas
and,
subsequently, with the awareness of the role that Aristotle had played in the formation of such ideas. Using Aristotle's
Rhetoric and Poetics as their theoretical base texts, the Chicago School
believed, along with T. S. Eliot, that criticism should study `poetry as poetry and not another thing'. They viewed with suspicion what they regarded as New Criticism's practice of
rejecting
historical
analysis,
its
penchant
for
presenting
subjective
judgements
as
objective analysis and its emphasis on poetry rather than other genres such as fiction. Crane and others examined other genres, drawing for their `techniques on a ``pluralistic and instrumentalist'' (Crane,
in
basis,
Preminger
from 1974,
whatever 22).
In
method
seemed
appropriate
to a
particular
case'
Critics and Criticism edited by Crane (1952), for
example, there are many illustrations of this critical phenomenon including Crane's own essay, `The Concept of Plot and the Plot of
Tom Jones', a reading of Fielding's novel.
modern north american criticism and theory
12
Janssen, M.
The Kenyon Review 1939±1970. Baton Rouge, LA, 1990.
Krieger, M.
The New Apologists for Poetry. Minneapolis, MN, 1956.
Lentricchia, F.
After the New Criticism. London, 1983.
Ransom, J. Crowe.
God Without Thunder.
Ð.
The World's Body. New York, 1938.
Ð.
The New Criticism. Norfolk, 1941.
Ð.
Poems and Essays. New York, 1955.
Richards, I. A. Ð.
Principles of Literary Criticism. London, 1924.
Practical Criticism. London, 1929.
Spurlin, W. J. and Fischer, M. (eds)
The New Criticism and Contemporary Literary Theory . New York,
1995. Tate, A.
Essays of Four Decades. New York, 1968.
Twelve Southerners. Warren, R. Penn.
I'll Take my Stand: The South and the Agrarian Tradition. Baton Rouge, LA, 1980.
Selected Essays. New York, 1958.
Wellek, R. and Warren, A. Winchell, M. R.
Theory of Literature. New York, 1949.
Cleanth Brooks and the Rise of Modern Criticism. Charlottesville, NC, 1996.
Wimsatt, W. K. and Brooks, C. Wimsatt, W. K.
Literary Criticism. New York, 1957.
The Verbal Icon. New York, 1958.
3. The Chicago School
The Chicago School flourished from the later 1930s into the 1950s. It centred on Ronald Salmon Crane (1886±1967), who taught at Chicago from 1924 to 1951. In 1925, he was made professor, and, ten years later, chair of the English department, holding this position until 1947. Although Crane's early output was largely devoted to the post-Restoration period, this work was not ostensibly concerned with the application of Aristotelian ideas to English literary thought, so important to the shaping of the Chicago School. He was also responsible for a bibliography of journalism from 1620 to 1800, published under the title
A
Census of British Newspapers and Periodicals 1620±1800 (1927), and the annual survey of current scholarship in eighteenth-century studies for the edited
from
1930
to
1952.
Crane's
work
was
infused
Philological Quarterly, which he with
neoclassical
ideas
and,
subsequently, with the awareness of the role that Aristotle had played in the formation of such ideas. Using Aristotle's
Rhetoric and Poetics as their theoretical base texts, the Chicago School
believed, along with T. S. Eliot, that criticism should study `poetry as poetry and not another thing'. They viewed with suspicion what they regarded as New Criticism's practice of
rejecting
historical
analysis,
its
penchant
for
presenting
subjective
judgements
as
objective analysis and its emphasis on poetry rather than other genres such as fiction. Crane and others examined other genres, drawing for their `techniques on a ``pluralistic and instrumentalist'' (Crane,
in
basis,
Preminger
from 1974,
whatever 22).
In
method
seemed
appropriate
to a
particular
case'
Critics and Criticism edited by Crane (1952), for
example, there are many illustrations of this critical phenomenon including Crane's own essay, `The Concept of Plot and the Plot of
Tom Jones', a reading of Fielding's novel.
the chicago school
13
Becoming chair of Chicago's English department, Crane was instrumental in hiring, over the next decade or so, critics such as Elder Olson, Norman MacLean and W. R. Keast, who were also sympathetic to the application of Aristotelian ideas to the study of literature, and whose work, in retrospect, has become recognized as the Chicago School. A student of Crane's, Wayne C. Booth (1921±), inherited his mantle at Chicago, teaching there from 1962 until well into the 1990s. Booth's
The Rhetoric of Fiction
(1961) was influential in the
formation of the study of narratology and its emphasis upon the analysis of how language is used. A major legacy of Booth's work has been narratological analysis of prose carried out by, among others, James Phelan, editor of the journal
Narrative
, whose work is in the same
general, neo-Aristotelian tradition as that of Wayne Booth and Sheldon Sacks. Many of the publications identified with what is regarded as the Chicago School were produced during the 1930s as part of a ferment created by the radical reorganization of undergraduate
education
at
the
University
of
Chicago.
Robert
Maynard
Hutchins
re-
structured the undergraduate programme. He emphasized the value of interdisciplinary studies and stressed the importance of reading and understanding primary texts. These activities were epitomized by Mortimer Adler's `Great Books of the Western Tradition' and by philosopher Richard P. McKeon in a course, `Organizations, Methods and Principles'. The influence of Hutchins, Adler and McKeon directed Crane's focus away from stressing the primary importance of historical criticism to concentrating on a humane liberal arts education for English Department graduates. In `History versus Criticism in the Study of Literature', Crane advocated an approach for the
teaching
origins,
but
of
undergraduate
with
a
literature,
preference
for
an
not
primarily
approach
aesthetics. Crane's style has been described by Gerald Graff in and
scholastic that it became a
target
of parody'
through
combining
literature's
textual
Professing Literature
(1927,
236±7).
historical
explication
and
as `so elephantine
However, central
Crane's ideas and crucial for the Chicago School was the notion of `
pluralism
to
', which
derives from the work of McKeon, particularly his adherence to the idea of philosophical pluralism. Writing the 1965 entry on the Chicago Critics for Alex Preminger's
Encyclopedia of Poetry and Poetics pluralism ``
Princeton
, Crane notes that `the most explicit statements of . . .
'' are contained in McKeon's ``The Philosophic Bases of Art and Criticism'',
Olson's ``An Outline of Poetic Theory'' ' and his own
Structure of Poetry
The Languages of Criticism and the
. Underlying `pluralism' is a relativist approach that advocates many
different forms of literary criticism, each of which has its own interpretive powers and limitations.
The
Chicago
School,
in
other
words,
did
not
advocate
one
method,
but
several, to be adopted pragmatically as dictated by the needs of the given text and situation. For Crane, `the only rational ground for adhering to one of them rather than to any of the others is its superior capacity to give us the special kind of understanding and evaluation of literature we want to get, at least for the time being' (Crane, in Preminger 1974, 117). Elder Olson observes in his memoir, `R. S. Crane' (1984), that `all of us were influenced by McKeon', who `provided the philosophical foundations for much of our work', although McKeon `never published anything that could be taken as a formulation of the poetics of the Chicago School' (Olson 1976, 236). McKeon also argues that philosophical systems in history `were generated by their prior choice of organizations, methods, principles and modes of thought'. In
The Languages of Criticism and the Structure of Poetry
, Crane argues
that criticism is unlike other areas of inquiry, such as biochemistry for instance, which has an agreed set of methodological and factual assumptions. Criticism is rather `a collection of
modern north american criticism and theory
14
distinct and more or less incommensurable ``frameworks'' or ``languages'' '. These critical vocabularies differ radically in `matters of assumed principle, definition and method'. For Crane, `we ought to have at our command, collectively at least, as many different critical methods as there are distinguishable major aspects in the construction, appreciation, and use of literary
works' (1953,
acceptance
different
of
192). Inasmuch as
critical
methods,
their
the Chicago Critics shared
approach
may
be
seen
to
the
be
broad
primarily
methodological in nature, rather than ideological, as Paul de Man has correctly asserted (1986, 54). In other words, they concentrated their efforts on the methods of reading literary texts, not on pre-existing political or aesthetic criteria for evaluating such texts. If McKeon provided a methodological basis for the work of the Chicago School, Crane's personality and vision of literary criticism can be seen to be of equal importance. Crane greatly influenced his students and gathered around him colleagues who developed similar ideas to his own. Olson (1909±1998), for example, gives an account of his initial encounter with Crane, `one afternoon in 1933', for the start of a new course, `a survey of English literature from 1660 to 1800'. Crane was, Olson writes, `a man of immense erudition'. He was `someone who strained [Olson's] capacities. More than that, he made me realize that I had capacities I had not guessed'. They shared the same concerns: `criticism should be made into and recognized as an academic discipline'; `literary history was not really history'; `the theory of both literary history and history in general must be more closely looked into'; `that the present condition of critical theory was deplorable'. They also shared a `distrust of . . .
Geistesgeschichte,
the ``spirit of the
age'' ' and `nonsensical classifications as ``Classical'' or ``Romantic'' ' (Olson 1976, 232, 234±5). As Gerald Graff has succinctly expressed it, underlying the scepticism towards the history of ideas and historicism was `the feeling that the power of literature was somehow compromised if it were felt to be rooted in history' (1987, 192). Writing in what may be taken as the manifesto of the Chicago school of criticism ±
Critics and Criticism: Ancient and Modern
(1952) ± Olson makes the now well-known
remark that `criticism in our time is a sort of Tower of Babel'. He adds:
Moreover, it is not merely a linguistic but also a methodological Babel; yet in the very pursuit of this analogy, it is well to remember that at Babel men did not begin to talk nonsense; they merely began to talk what
seemed
like nonsense to their fellows. A statement is not false merely
because it is unintelligible; though it will have to be made intelligible before we can say whether it is true. (Olson, in Crane 1952, 546)
To make something intelligible needs, according to Crane, `a general critique of literary criticism . . . such as might yield objective criteria for interpreting the diversities and opposition among critics and for judging the comparative methods of rival critical schools' (546)
David
pluralistic
Richter
position.
indicates
For
that
Richter,
there
`there
are
are
inconsistencies
always
going
to
in be
Crane's
and
reductive
Olson's
theoretical
positions we are going to wish to exclude (e.g. `poetry judged by its suitability for landfill'); secondly, `there was an ineluctable rhetorical conflict between Crane's position as the chief advocate for the Neo-Aristotelian mode of interpretation, and his meta-critical position as a pluralist' (Olson, in Crane 1952, 92). Crucial to the Chicago School, already stated, is the idea of `neo-Aristotelianism' and the Chicago group's `special interest in the
Poetics',
as Richter suggests. The reasons for this,
as Crane explains in his account of the Chicago School, are `pragmatic'. The critics were literature
teachers
concerned
with
the
practical
criticism
of
literary
texts
and
the
specifically artistic principles that characterize their construction. These aspects of literary
the chicago school
15
works are `distinct from their verbal meanings, their historical and biographical backgrounds, or their general qualities'. But why Aristotle? Crane writes that the
appeal of Aristotle to the Chicago group lay in the fact that he, more than any other critic they knew, had conceived of literary theory in this
a posteriori and differential way and had not only
formulated some of its necessary distinctions and principles in his brief discussions of ancient tragedy and epic but pointed the way to further inquiries of the same general sort concerning possibilities in these and other literary arts still unrealized at the time he wrote.
Crane adds that the Chicago group has `attempted to pursue some of these, and with increasing independence of the letter of the
Poetics,
in their writings on the lyric, the
drama, and the novel' (1971, 117). Particularly important to the Chicago critics are the Aristotelian concepts of ` form and
genre'.
Literary forms include `species of works, inductively known, and differentiated, more
or less sharply, in terms of their artistic elements and principles of construction' (Crane 1967, 2: 59). Important to the idea of `form' is the concept of `synolon', or the `concrete whole', that is `matter shaped by form, and shaped so as to be coherent, comprehensible, and meaningful in itself. Meaning comes from the inferred sense of the whole, not from the parts' (Richter 1982, 92). Genre is a heuristic concept, conceptual rather than prescriptive; that is, genre is not supposed to be understood as a series of categorical rules, but as a basis which is open to adaptation. Olson writes in
On Value Judgments:
`The words must be
explained in terms of something else, not the poem in terms of the words; and further, a principle must be a principle of something other than itself; hence the words cannot be a principle of their own arrangements' (1976, 13). This `focus on genre and method does not preclude an interest in historical analysis'. Genre studies by Olson on comedy and tragedy, Crane on the eighteenth century and MacLean writing on the lyric `are developed around hypotheses of historical change' (Gorman 1994, 145). The prominent members of the Chicago School include, apart from Crane and Olson, Dryden
scholar
William
R.
Keast,
Norman
MacLean,
Richard
McKeon
and
Bernard
Weinberg. On the whole, their focus was on poetics. The texts on which they concentrated often came from the eighteenth century, so it is hardly surprising that the University of Chicago produced during the period of Crane's ascendancy many distinguished eighteenthcentury scholars. Among these are the editors Donald F. Bond, Arthur Friedman and Shirley Strum Kenny. It also produced scholars such as Gwin J. Kolb, Louis A. Landa, Edward W. Rosenheim and Paul Alkon, as well as historians of ideas such as Philip Harth, James Malek and Howard Weinbrot. The general trend of the second generation, however, has tended to be on rhetoric rather than poetics (Gorman 1994, 145). The
formative
voice
of
the
second
generation
has
been
Wayne
C.
Booth.
Booth
obtained both his graduate degrees at the University of Chicago where he taught from 1947 to 1950. In 1962 he rejoined the English Faculty at Chicago. In a telephone interview with Mary
Frances
Hopkins
(3
December
1981),
Booth
defined
his
relationship
with
the
Chicago critics. Hopkins asked him: `Could you comment on what the Chicago critics are doing now?' Booth replied `that the school is not at this point a school, even if it ever was one, partly because of a series of tragic deaths'. Booth explains, `The second generation after Crane and Olson and McKeon, and others who originally met together, there was a kind of second generation school here consisting of Robert Marsh, Sheldon Sacks, [Arthur] Heiserman and me; all three died in their forties' (Hopkins 1982, 58).
modern north american criticism and theory
16
Booth also told Hopkins, `I'm the only one left' in Chicago `who is even thought of as closely connected with the Chicago critics, and of course I'm always whoring after false gods, like rhetoric, from the point of view of the originators. That's the first point, that there
is
no
Aristotelian
Chicago critics'.
School
Booth
at
also
Chicago suggests
in
that
that
there
narrow was
sense
neither
a
of
a
group
`common
of
Neo-
mold'
nor
a unification of focus on subject matters: `We're different people going different ways', he remarks
(Hopkins
1982,
59).
What
such
a
statement
omits
of
course
is
the
shared
methodological interests, the focus on form, on the eighteenth-century, on ` pluralism', on Aristotle's
Poetics,
which runs as a thread throughout the eclectic writings of the differing
generations of the Chicago School. Also, as the direct heir of Crane and the Chicago thinkers, Booth's own preoccupation in the
role
of
readers
has
in
its
turn
The Rhetoric of Fiction
been
subsumed
into
with communication and
other
reader-oriented
theories,
conducted for instance by Norman Holland and Bernard J. Paris among others. But, and this is perhaps more to the point, Booth adds that `there is a Chicago ethos that I think may be as powerful as ever; the place is permeated with a commitment to reflection about methods ± to going twice as deep as anybody else into the assumptions of a text' (Hopkins 1982, 58). This
methodological
rigour
is
exemplified
by
Booth's
complex and prolific. His most influential work remains
own
output,
which
The Rhetoric of Fiction
is
both
(1961),
revised in an augmented edition of 1983. His concern with the ways in which directly and indirectly authors address readers has its roots in Aristotle's
Poetics.
Booth's study is
divided into three parts: `Artistic Purity and the Rhetoric of Fiction', `The Author's Voice in Fiction' and an investigation of `Impersonal Narration'. In the Afterword to the second edition, Booth meditates on the changes that two decades have brought on his own thinking and on writing about narrative theory since the first publication of
The Rhetoric of Fiction .
The
second
edition
also
contains
an
additional
bibliography
compiled by James Phelan of 4,000 writings on narrative theory since the first edition of 1961. Booth is forced to clarify and modify the central arguments of his rhetorical analysis in  rard Genette, Mikhail Bakhtin and others, acknowledging their the light of the work of Ge influence. For Booth, the relationship between morality and rhetoric, and our implied moral
judgements
during
the
act
of
reading,
are
much
more
complex
than
he
first
envisioned. He also refines his ideas of the complex relationships between different kinds of authors, different kinds of readers and different kinds of narrators. Booth's subsequent major work,
A Rhetoric of Irony,
owes more to Longinus than it does to Aristotle. Already in
the 1983 revision of the classic
The Rhetoric of Fiction
may be seen the subsuming of the
ideas of the Chicago critics. Other than Booth, of the second generation of critics, Sheldon Sacks' 1964 study
and the Shape of Belief
Fiction
is a good illustration of the application of the ideas of the Chicago
School applied to fiction and specifically Henry Fielding. Sacks differentiates between the `comic', the tragic' and the `serious' in Fielding's writing (1964, 20±4). He argues that Fielding's intention was `to recommend goodness and innocence'. Fielding the novelist incorporated this into the structure of, for instance,
Tom Jones,
not as a distinct `theme' or
`vision' but `through its embodiment in the structure of beliefs by which we are led to evaluate
characters
and
actions'
(Richter
1982,
37).
Elsewhere,
the
influence
of
the
Chicago critics is still indirectly refracted through the discourse on narratology conducted by critics such as James Phelan. The Chicago-based journal
Critical Inquiry
also retains the
the chicago school Chicago
concern
with
17
the
examination
of
the
formal
organization
of
structure
and
language. Looked at from a historical perspective, the Chicago critics may be viewed on one level as reflecting a local situation at the University of Chicago. In formulating their theoretical ideas based upon classical principles, Crane and others were reacting to the internal demands of a university dean intent on creating a great school of liberal and humane
education.
Crane
and
his
colleagues
were
also
trying
to
place
the
study
of
English as a discipline on a sound footing. Indeed, John Crowe Ransom, an influential new critic, writing in 1938 in an essay appropriately entitled `Criticism, Inc.', refers to Crane as `the first of the great professors to have advocated [criticism] as a major policy for
Departments
of
English'
(1938,
330).
These
reactions
to
perceived
internal
university pressures and threats to English as a legitimate area of study[/help] tended to ignore external events such as the Great Depression and Nazism. Waves of left-wing thought tended to pass Crane and his fellow critics by, although thinkers such as Isaac Rosenfeld and Saul Bellow were Chicago-based. Others, such as George Steiner, who did
his
insular
undergraduate ideas
Department.
than In
work
those
the
late
at
Chicago,
prevalent 1930s
at
and
left the
during
for
Europe
University the
1940s
and of
were
influenced
Chicago
Chicago
and
was
its
the
by
less
English
centre
for
the `Chicago School of Social Thought'. This suggested `that we go through recurring, even ceaseless cycles of social organization, disorganization, and then social reorganization, cycles when existing patterns of social interaction and relations, social institutions and
forms
(Carey
of
1997,
colleagues
in
life,
even
28). the
forms
This
English
of
individual
emphasis
on
department
identity
society who
was
focused
are not
broken
down
stressed
instead
on
by
form,
and
dispersed'
Crane on
and
the
his
means
by which form was expressed, and on reactions to `New Criticism'. With the advent of various formalisms in the 1970s, the Chicago School's influence waned further, its approach to analysis even more marginalized. New Criticism, with its emphasis on the word and thematic analysis, could more easily adapt in response to new forms of critical discourse, especially those interested in matters of ideology. Criticism has tended to move away from the focus on the expression of language towards an emphasis on social considerations represented, for instance, by the New Historicists who have been influenced by neo-Marxist thinkers such as Raymond Williams and others. Crane and others were concerned with theory but in a rather insular fashion. Graff indicates in
Professing Literature
that Crane's postwar
writings contain `a critique of the routinization of criticism' reflected in the dominance of the New Criticism (1987, 234). Further, as Graff suggests, Crane's concern in his introduction to the revised edition of
Critics and Criticism
with the `authority of criticism' and `the problem of
the interpretability of literature' was ahead of its time. The reasons were twofold: first, `most literary theorists were still preoccupied with the problem of its truth'; second, `Crane was raising problems few people wanted to hear about at a time when academic literary studies had finally won their institutional autonomy'. For Graff, `Crane's work looked forward to the later growth of ``theory'' ' (Graff 1987, 236±7, 240). It is perhaps ironic, then, given their concern for methodological rigour, that the shift of focus in critical study in English departments should be away from the work of the Chicago critics to that of continental thinkers, particularly those from Paris in the late 1950s and 1960s, and represented, for instance, by the import of the thought of Jacques Derrida. In the last decades of the twentieth century, literary criticism in English departments has been profoundly influenced by criticism and philosophy which has emerged from Europe, and
modern north american criticism and theory
18
the irony exists in the return to concerns with rhetoric, tone and poetics in the work of those who are grouped together under the name `poststructuralism', while it is forgotten that such were the interests of the Chicago School.
William Baker
Further reading and works cited Battersby, J. L. `Elder Olson', in
Modern American Critics since 1965 , ed. I. J. Gregory. Detroit, MI,
1988. Booth, W. C. Ð.
A Rhetoric of Irony. Chicago, 1974.
The Rhetoric of Fiction. Chicago, 1983.
Carey, J.
James Carey A Critical Reader, eds E. Stryker Munson and C. A. Warren. Minneapolis, MN,
1997. Crane, R. S. `Imitation of Spenser and Milton in the early Eighteenth Century',
Studies in Philology,
15, April 1918. Ð.
`An
Early
Eighteenth-Century
Enthusiast
for
Primitive
Poetry',
Modern Language Notes, 37,
January 1922. Ð. `Gray's
Ð.
Elegy and Lycidas'. Modern Language Notes, 38, March 1923.
English Literature 1660±1800. Princeton, NJ, 1952.
Ð et al.
The Languages of Criticism and the Structure of Poetry. Toronto, 1953.
Ð (ed.)
Critics and Criticism. Chicago, 1952.
Ð.
The Idea of the Humanities and Other Essays Critical and Historical . Chicago, 1967.
Ð.
Critical and Historical Principles of Literary History . Chicago, 1971.
Ð. `The Chicago Critics', in
Princeton Encyclopedia of Poetry and Poetics, ed. A. Preminger. Princeton,
NJ, 1974. Crane, R. S. and Kaye, F. B.
A Census of British Newspapers and periodicals, 1620±1800 , ed. M. E.
Prior. London, 1966. de Man, P.
The Resistance to Theory. Minneapolis, MN, 1986.
Gorman, B. `Chicago Critics'.
The Johns Hopkins Guide to Literary Theory and Criticism, eds M. Groden
and M. Kreiswirth. Baltimore, MD, 1994. Graff, G.
Professing Literature. Chicago, 1987.
Gregory, I. J. (ed.)
Modern American Critics since 1965. Detroit, 1988.
Hopkins, M. F. `Interview with Wayne C. Booth'.
Literature in Performance, II, 2, April 1982.
Narrative, 1, January, 1993. Olson, E. (ed.) Olson, E.
Aristotle's Poetics and English Literature. Chicago, 1965.
On Value Judgments in the Arts and Other Essays. Chicago, 1976.
Ð. `R. S. Crane',
American Scholar, 53, Spring, 1984.
Phelan, J. `Wayne C. Booth', in
Modern American Critics since 1965 , ed. I. J. Gregory. Detroit, MI,
1988. Preminger, A. (ed.)
Princeton Encyclopedia of Poetry and Poetics. Princeton, NJ, 1974.
Ransom, J. C. `Criticism, Inc.'. in
The World's Body. New York, 1938.
Richter, D. H. `The Second Flight of the Phoenix'. Ð. `R. S. Crane', in
The Eighteenth Century, 23, 1, Winter 1982.
Modern American Critics since 1965 , ed. I. J. Gregory. Detroit, MI, 1988. April,
1918. Sachs, S.
Fiction and the Shape of Belief. Berkeley, CA, 1964.
Selden, R. et al. (eds)
A Reader's Guide to Contemporary Literary Theory . Hemel Hempstead, 1997.
4. Northrop Frye (1912±1991)
No single literary critic influenced a period of twentieth-century academic criticism more than Northrop Frye who dominated the 1960s and early 1970s. In his first book,
Symmetry
Fearful
(1947), Frye had glimpsed, and demonstrated, an order and a symmetry in the
thought of William Blake that nobody had suspected before. Everything in Blake studies since has been affected by it. In his seminal
Anatomy of Criticism
(1957), Frye more or less
established the modern field of critical theory as an independent discipline (though it would eventually move in directions that disquieted him). In the 1960s and 1970s, Frye devoted himself to the practical application of his ideas and methods to the central writers of the western tradition: in particular, he made influential contributions to Shakespeare studies, and transformed our understanding of romanticism, providing a catalyst for the `Romantic revivalism' that marked the earlier careers of Yale critics like Geoffrey Hartman and Harold Bloom. Finally, in the last decade of his life, Frye produced two monumental studies of the Bible and literature ±
The Great Code
(1982) and
Words with Power
(1990) ±
in which his special qualities of unfettered intellectual play, of bringing new shape and structure to previously chaotic subjects, and of being able to appeal to specialist and nonspecialist audiences at once, are all still evident. While Frye brought a great deal to the understanding of criticism and literature, there is almost nothing that he brought that cannot be found, implicit at least, in
Fearful Symmetry
,
and hence that cannot be traced back to Blake: indeed, the relationship between Blake and Frye provides as intense an example of identification between a poet and his foremost critic as the English-speaking tradition affords. In particular,
Fearful Symmetry
contains the seeds
of Frye's approach to four subjects ± the role of the archetype in literature, the function of imagination in art and society, the relation between the religious and artistic visions, and the existence of what he would eventually call the `literary universe' ± that would occupy him for the next four decades, in a `spiral curriculum' pattern that he described as `circling around the same issues, though trying to keep them open-ended' (1976b, 100). Several times he described the epiphany that got this movement started. Staying up all night to write an undergraduate paper on Blake's
Milton
, in the early 1930s, he began to ponder the
principle that Blake and Milton were connected by their use of the Bible. This seemed both an obvious and an unhelpful fact, since surely it was a likeness that only served to obscure what was `individual', or really interesting, about each of them:
Around about three in the morning a different kind of intuition hit me, though it took me twenty
years
to
articulate
it.
The
two
poets
were
connected
by
the
same
thing,
and
sameness leads to individual variety, just as likeness leads to monotony. I began dimly to see
that
the
principle
pulling
me
away
from
the
historical
period
was
the
principle
of
modern north american criticism and theory
20
mythological framework. The Bible had provided a frame of mythology for European poets: an immense number of critical problems began to solve themselves as soon as one realized this. (1976b, 17)
Through
the
attempt
to
explain
the
`private
mythology'
and
`private
symbolism'
that
critics had always claimed were in Blake, Frye discovered, as he later put it, `not merely that Blake's mythology was not private, but that the phrase itself made no sense' (1976b, 108). Far from being the eccentric that he was frequently portrayed as, in method at least Blake
was
an
connections
absolutely
between
traditional
his
figure
`prophecies',
who
the
epic
sought
to
tradition,
make
explicit
myth
and
the
folktale
structural ±
and
of
course the Bible, which, in a phrase that haunted Frye throughout his life, he called `the Great
Code
of
Art'.
And
Blake's
characters,
Frye
argued,
weren't
failed
attempts
at
realistic representations, but successful attempts to isolate the models, or archetypes, that provide the structure for
a
ll
representations of character (including realistic ones, which
are simply, to use Frye's term, `displaced' from the archetypal models). A fully imaginative vision, for Blake, is one that sees all the works of human genius as contributing to a vast story of loss and redemption; in social terms, this is also a revolutionary vision, one that children possess a natural correspondence with, and that is hence driven out of them so that they may become more docile social subjects. At the close of
Fearful Symmetry
, Frye
concludes that Blake's belief in an overarching human vision in which local differences of religion, myth, and doctrine are reconciled `implies that a study of comparative religion, a morphology of myths, rituals and theologies, will lead us to a single visionary conception which the mind of man is trying to express' (1947, 424). It was to this study that Frye devoted the rest of his life. Although the feeling in
Fearful Symmetry
is of a productive confrontation between two
visionary intellects ± Blake's and Frye's ± played out before the backdrop of the entire western
imaginative
tradition,
there
were
more
local
issues
bubbling
just
beneath
the
book's surface. It is, after all, a book written during war, and Frye clearly wants to rescue the idea of myth from its perverted use in the rhetoric of fascism. (He was terrified that Blake's mythic heroes could be misread as supermen.) More locally, a suspicion of Blake, and of romanticism generally, had been a spark-plug in T. S. Eliot's canonical arguments, which had in turn strongly influenced the New Critics, whose `close reading' method had, noncoincidentally perhaps, made little headway with Blake, Milton and other unpopular poets who
stressed
poetic
argument
over
texture.
All
of
this
worked
as
a
challenge
and
a
provocation for Frye, not least because, especially in the Eliot version, it was connected with a broader attack on middle-class Protestants and their values (Frye was a left-liberal, and an ordained minister in the United Church of Canada). Meanwhile the New Critical method, with its obsessive attention to language and its lack of interest in the conventions that create linkages between poems, was already coming under pressure from the Chicago School. While sharing with Crane, Olson and the other neo-Aristotelians an interest in myth, Frye felt that the rigorously inductive procedure with which they sought to oppose the
New
Critical
dissolving
of
poetry
into
a
kind
of
language
suffered
from
a
similar
weakness to the New Criticism itself: it stood so close to the individual poem, in an effort to see how the parts contributed to a successful whole, that there was little possibility of seeing larger connective patterns, of moving towards a genuinely generic criticism. All of these themes, concerns and undercurrents culminate in
Anatomy of Criticism
,
Frye's unquestionable masterpiece, in 1957. Although Frye had not heard of structuralism
northrop frye when he wrote the
21
Anatomy
, he did at one time consider `Structural Poetics' as a title for it,
and we can see now some remarkable anticipations of the structuralist project: the mythic turn; the architectonic and spatial metaphors; the love of categories and system-building; the dazzling contraries; and, of course, the brimming confidence about the `human sciences' which smacks of the late 1950s and early 1960s and which has since passed so notably from the whole field of the humanities.
Anatomy
The footing
within
may be seen as an attempt to place criticism on a sound intellectual the
university,
not
reliant
in
any
special
way
upon
the
disciplines
surrounding it, and capable of proceeding in an orderly, non-contentious and progressive manner on the model of the natural sciences. While it is obvious that in this larger aim the
book
did
not
succeed,
in
numerous
more
specific
ways
it
assuredly
did.
In
the
Polemical Introduction, for example, Frye declares famously that the demonstrable valuejudgement,
anchored
in
something
outside
the
critic's
own
preferences,
prejudices
or
social conditioning, is `the donkey's carrot of literary criticism' (1957, 20). Specific valuejudgements
he
relegates
to
the
`history
of
taste',
along
with
`all
the
literary
chit-chat
which makes the reputations of poets boom and crash in an imaginary stock-exchange' (1957, 18). If Eliot's attack on Blake, Milton and the romantics was conventional literary warfare, then Frye's attempt to wipe out evaluation altogether is the nuclear response ± and
the
literary
almost
criticism
instantaneous marks
it
as
disappearance
one
of
the
rare
from
the
examples
academic of
a
scene
definitive
of
evaluative
clincher
in
the
humanities. And
if
value-judgements
have
no
place
within
a
systematic
criticism,
Frye
argues,
neither can such a criticism be founded on some externally derived religious or ideological position ± here, once again, in his critique of the fallacy of determinism, we feel the barely sublimated animus towards Eliot's Anglo-Catholic polemics. Adapting some of the key terms in the battle between the New Criticism and the Chicago School, which he clearly wishes to transcend, Frye proposes an alternation between an inductive survey of literary experience and the deductive assumption that there is such a subject as criticism, and that it makes or could make complete sense. It is its weakness or hesitancy in the second, conceptual
domain
that
has
left
criticism
so
vulnerable
to
ideology
and
determinism:
`Criticism seems to be badly in need of a coordinating principle, a central hypothesis which, like the theory of evolution in biology, will see the phenomena it deals with as parts of a whole' (1957, 16). Of all the passages in the
Anatomy
, perhaps the most startling are those in which Frye
outlines this `central hypothesis' as the `assumption of total coherence', the belief that the actual works of literature are not haphazard but form a `literary universe' analogous to the natural universe studied by the sciences, and that, analogous to the order of nature that the natural sciences posit, there is an `order of words' waiting for critics to uncover its structures and codes: `We begin to wonder if we cannot see literature, not only as complicating itself in time, but as spread out in conceptual space from some kind of centre that criticism could locate' (1957, 16±17). The four long essays that make up the body of the
Anatomy
explore the contours of this
cardinal assumption about an order of words. The First Essay deals with the historical sequence of `modes', defined as the literary hero's changing power of action, from ancient myth to contemporary irony; the Second Essay proposes a theory of meaning based on five levels
of
symbolism;
the
Third
Essay,
the
central
one
in
the
book,
is
an
account
of
archetype and myth; and the Fourth Essay is an attempt to define the basic genres of
modern north american criticism and theory
22
literature ± drama, epic, fiction and poetry ± according to their `radical of presentation', or the way that they are intended to be consumed by the audience. The discussion that the book aroused was immediate and enormous, and it centered on the Third Essay, or Theory of Myths. Here Frye proposes four basic narrative myths ± comedy,
romance, tragedy
and irony
±
all seen
as parts
of one large
story
of fall
and
redemption. Although he draws analogies between these four basic storylines and the seasons of the year, it is not his intention to derive the stories from primitive rites such as fertility rituals. Like these, however, the basic stories told in literature are attempts by the imagination
to
discover
parallels
between
the
human
drama
and
the
natural
world,
attempts to turn a hostile environment into a home and thus part of the larger project of civilization. As he rings the changes upon the typical storylines and characters of each
mythos
, ranging across three thousand years of western literature with extraordinary brio
and confidence, Frye comes upon pieces of symmetry that even he concedes are `forbidding', such as the existence of six `phases' within each phases of each neighbouring
mythos
. The
Anatomy
mythos
, three being parallel to the
is richly loaded with examples, and one
of the things that prevents most readers from feeling that it is as an exercise in empty pigeonholing is the way that Frye's categories and connections can throw a new light on the thousands of texts that he mentions along the way. We are hardly likely to read
Wonderland
tradition of Burton's
Anatomy of Melancholy Anatomy .
What was always going to make the explicit
Alice in
in quite the same way after Frye has described it as a Menippean satire in the
and
implied,
to
the
New
Critical
controversial were its correctives, both
methodology
that
had
dominated
literary
criticism almost since its emergence as a university discipline between the wars. When the Third Essay tells us that we need to `stand back' from a poem in order to see its archetypal organization (1957, 140), every reader at the time would have sensed a critique of the relentlessly `close reading' method that defined the New Criticism. Naturally, some of the older New Critics attacked Frye's myths as having no constructive role whatever in practical criticism, since they could not be derived, whole, from any individual work of literature. To this he replied, in 1966:
The principle that a work of literature should not be related to anything outside itself is sound enough, but I cannot see how the rest of literature can be regarded as outside the work of literature, any more than the human race can be regarded as outside a human being. When I use the metaphor of standing back from a work of literature . . . I am trying to give some reality to the word `literature'. (see Krieger 1966, 3)
For
younger
critics,
the
way
that
Frye's
perspective
broke
out
of
the
New
Criticism's
claustrophobic attentiveness to the individual poem and suddenly provided lines of sight in new, unexpected directions was a liberation. No less so was the toppling of the antiromantic literary hierarchy, in particular the denigration of the romantic long poem, that younger critics, many of them inspired by After all, the
Anatomy
Fearful Symmetry
, were already bridling against.
not only had a place for all literary modes and movements: its view
of all of these as contributing to one, larger picture seemed to resonate with romanticism itself, specifically with Shelley's vision of `that great poem, which all poets, like the cooperating thoughts of one great mind, have built up since the beginning of the world' (Shelley 1930, VII: 124). While the New Criticism had run out of steam long before 1957, the
Anatomy
was the final blow. At Yale, which had been a centre of New Critical activity,
it was like a burst of oxygen for younger critics like Harold Bloom, who had begun to find
northrop frye
23
the Eliotic atmosphere thin and suffocating. During a personal interview in 1982, Angus Fletcher, a friend of Bloom's and a distinguished follower of Frye himself, told me about a visit to Yale in 1957: Harold Bloom came into the room waving this book, shouting at the top of his voice, `The King is dead!' And the book was the
The
Anatomy of Criticism.
Anatomy, then, made Frye famous, and brought him many followers; but he never
formed a school, and never sought disciples, which he once told me would only be to invite `the Judas reaction'. Notoriously introverted by temperament, he resisted numerous invitations to move to the United States after 1957 (though he did teach terms there) and remained for over half a century on the faculty of the University of Toronto, where he had gained his undergraduate degrees. The 1960s and 1970s were a fertile period for Frye, in which his work moved in two related directions: essays in practical criticism that applied the theories outlined in
Anatomy, and an increasing emphasis on social criticism, directed at the general public, in which he developed the connections between literature, myth and religion. What links these endeavours is that at their root they are meditations on the same theme, one of Frye's favourites: the survival of romance, particularly in the area of the popular arts, despite all of the apparent gains made against it by realism in the arts specifically and by the scientific worldview in western society generally. In
A Natural Perspective
(1965), his study of
Shakespearean romance, Frye takes up Coleridge's distinction between Iliad critics interested in tragedy, realism and irony, and Odyssey critics interested in comedy and romance: `I have always been temperamentally an Odyssean critic myself, attracted to comedy and romance. But I find myself, apparently, in a minority, in a somewhat furtive and anonymous group who have not much of a theory, implicit or explicit, to hold them together' (1965, 2). In books like
A Natural Perspective and The Secular Scripture (1976),
and in essays of practical interpretation like `Dickens and the Comedy of Humours' (see Frye 1970, 218±40), Frye does much to rectify this situation, suggesting that romance is in fact the core of all storytelling, since it is precisely what reality lacks and only imagination can provide. Even the realist tradition, which Frye sees as a conservative response to romance's anarchic, erotic spirit, can only displace, never avoid, romance patterns and motifs, such as the monster, the questing knight, the descent into an underworld and so on. A writer like Dickens, whose characters are clearly drawn as much from the theory of humours as from `life', is much better understood as a traditional romancer than as a failed realist. Comedy and romance move from frustration and the blockage of desire towards erotic fulfilment and identity, thus implying `that what is must never take final precedence over what ought to be' (Frye 1970, 240). It is the fact that, in the last several centuries, this feeling that the realistic world-picture cannot be the whole story has been expressed principally through the arts that causes Frye to call them a `secular scripture', doing much of the same work in modern societies that religion performed in traditional ones. This connection is more fully sketched in Frye's final two books on the imaginative legacy of the Bible. Because the vision of identity in comedy, particularly, is a vision of a renewed social identity, Frye's interest in `Odyssean' forms also allows him to connect his central interests with a social criticism. In books like
The Modern Century (1967) and The Critical Path
(1971), we see Frye developing a view of literature as related to a society's `myth of concern'. While the `myth of freedom' ± essentially, scientific reasoning ± has brought
modern north american criticism and theory
24
modern society many benefits, it is always in a tensely dialectical relationship with the fundamental concerns that unite all human beings in all societies: concerns for things like food, shelter, warmth and love. Literature, says Frye in with concern, but `represents the
language
The Critical Path
, is not identical
of human concern' and `displays the imaginative
possibilities of concern'. While concern can readily turn into mere tribal will, or ideology, literature contains a more liberal and liberating element, because unlike concern `it is not to be believed in: there is no ``religion of poetry'': the whole point about literature is that it has no direct connection with belief' (Frye 1971, 98, 128). In a sense all of Frye's books are following
up
Blake's
point
about
the
imagination's
freedom
from
the
constraints
of
whatever, simply, is, and the way that this freedom enables all visions of a more fully humane world (including, of course, by providing the mythic substratum for revolutionary political stories). Only criticism, however, can trace these connections, and Frye never departs from the view in
Anatomy
that `a public that tries to do without criticism, and asserts that it knows
what it wants or likes, brutalizes the arts and loses its cultural memory' (Frye 1957, 4). After
Anatomy
, Frye frequently uses the language of the sublime in connection with the destiny
of criticism, language that would embarrass most contemporary critics. Literature, he says in his popular 1963 Massey Lectures broadcast on Canadian radio, is `a human apocalypse, man's revelation to man', and criticism is `not a body of adjudications, but the awareness of that revelation, the last judgement of mankind' (Frye 1963a, 105). Of course, as critics in the 1980s and 1990s continued to express their preference for combat over cooperation, ideology over myth, Frye's hope that criticism would ever realize the destiny he had posited for it became weaker. Although the claim that Frye was an arid formalist, a dehistoricizing critic and thus a bourgeois idealist, followed him through most of his career, it is clearer now that only from one, no longer ascendant, perspective, that of historical materialism, is this even remotely plausible. Terry Eagleton, for example, claims that Frye's work `emphasizes . . . the utopian root of literature because it is marked by a deep fear of the actual social world, a distaste for history itself' (Eagleton 1983, 93); but we may wonder, in response, whether literature is more sequestered from `the actual social world' by a view that sees it as an ideology masking a deeper reality, or by a view that embraces literature's utopian dreamings and connects them with the mainsprings of social concern, action and vision. Frye subtitled his 1970 collection,
The Stubborn Structure
, `Essays on Criticism and Society', and he explained the
subtitle as follows: `as some of those who write about me are still asserting that I ignore the social reference of literary criticism, the sub-title calls the attention of those who read me to the fact that I have written about practically nothing else' (Frye 1970, x). Indeed,
Symmetry
is
as
good
an
introduction
to
the
principal
currents
of
Fearful
eighteenth-century
politics, religion, philosophy and aesthetics as one is likely to get, and the cultural context never fades out of Frye's thought; it is simply construed in the very broad terms that characterize other historicist thinkers valued by Frye, like Vico or Spengler. Frye is always aware of the way that specific social formations impose their particular, and necessarily partial, perspectives, their own story-outlines, on the world: that is precisely his subject. But he
is
also
aware
that
beneath
the
ideological
level
of
this
activity
there
is
a
deeper,
mythological level that unites rather than divides different societies and periods. Is there a better explanation of why the great artistic works of the past continue to speak to us? For criticism to limit itself to the ideological level is to hand the entire show over to the faculty that Blake called `corporeal understanding', and which he contrasted with imaginative
northrop frye
25
vision. Critical vision, in Frye, is the fully imaginative response to the creative act that, while it recognizes part of that act as mere historical datum, lifts another part of it clear into the permanent mythological dimension. As he puts it in his last book,
Words with Power:
I think of a poet, in relation to his society, as being at the centre of a cross like a plus sign. The horizontal bar forms the social and ideological conditioning that made him intelligible to his contemporaries, and in fact to himself. The vertical bar is the mythological line of descent from previous poets back to Homer. (1990, 47)
On
this
ideology,
question
Frye's
of whether
humanist
there is
optimism,
a
level
which
of shared
conceives
of
concern more the
possibility
primary of
than
productive
cultural exchange, and which makes imaginative structures like literature central to that exchange, is suddenly starting to look less time-bound than the insistence on irreducible difference that characterized much of the criticism that displaced him in the 1980s and 1990s. With a `Collected Edition' of Frye's works (which will include his fascinating diaries and notebooks) currently underway with University of Toronto Press, and international meetings on his ideas being held in places as far apart as China, Australia and Canada, there is good reason to subscribe to A. C. Hamilton's view that `Frye's hope that he may play a role in holding traditional culture together and passing it on to the next generation may well be fulfilled because the multiculturalism characteristic of his criticism will have its place in an increasingly globalized world' (see Boyd and Salvszinsky 1999, 119). Frye once said that Blake possessed an imagination so large that it was impossible to feel claustrophobic within it: countless readers and students have had a similar experience of Frye's own critical imagination. A scholar and humanist of immense erudition, a brilliantly witty writer and polemicist, and a teacher in the best sense of the word, Northrop Frye was one of the most gifted individuals to devote himself to the theory and practice of literary criticism in the twentieth century.
Imre Salusinszky
Further reading and works cited Boyd, D. and Salusinszky, I. (eds) Denham, R. D. Ð.
Northrop Frye.
Rereading Frye.
Northrop Frye and Critical Method.
Eagleton, T. Frye, N.
Literary Theory.
Toronto, 1999.
Toronto, 1987. University Park, PA, 1978.
Oxford, 1983.
Fearful Symmetry: A Study of William Blake.
Ð.
Anatomy of Criticism.
Ð.
The Educated Imagination.
Ð.
Fables of Identity.
Ð.
T. S. Eliot.
Ð.
A Natural Perspective.
Ð.
The Modern Century.
Ð.
The Stubborn Structure.
Ð.
The Critical Path.
Bloomington, IN, 1963a.
New York, 1963b.
Edinburgh, 1963c.
Ð.
The Secular Scripture. Spiritus Mundi.
Ð.
The Great Code.
Ð.
Words with Power.
Hamilton, A. C.
New York, 1965. Toronto, 1967. Ithaca, NY, 1970.
Bloomington, IN, 1971.
Ð.
Princeton, NJ, 1947.
Princeton, NJ, 1957.
Cambridge, 1976a.
Bloomington, IN, 1976b New York, 1982. New York, 1990.
Northrop Frye.
Toronto, 1990.
modern north american criticism and theory
26
Krieger, M.
Northrop Frye in Modern Criticism The Legacy of Northrop Frye The Complete Works of Percy Bysshe Shelley
. New York, 1996.
Lee, A. and Denham, R. D. (eds) Shelley, P. B.
. Toronto, 1994.
, eds R. Ingpen and W. E. Peck. London,
1930.
5. The Encounter with Structuralism and the Invention of Poststructuralism
There is a common perception that poststructuralism arrived in the United States as an import in October 1966, when Derrida read his paper, `Structure, Sign, and Play in the Discourse of the Human Sciences', at Johns Hopkins University. Bearing in mind that the term
poststructuralism
was not used in Europe until much later, it is important to stress that
poststructuralism was not a ready-made object which could be imported, but something that had to be fashioned in the United States, something which emerged, in the 1970s, from a complex set of circumstances in North American criticism, and which was, in particular, deeply bound up with the context of reception of Derrida's work. Poststructuralism
was
not
so
much
imported
as
invented
in
the
United
States,
by
a
process
of
decontextualizing and then recontextualizing Derrida. To understand this process it will be necessary to sketch the debates into which Derrida's work intervened, the kind of impact that
this
intervention
entailed,
and
the
reception
history
of
Derrida
and
other
post-
structuralist thinkers in the 1970s and 1980s. Commentators North
American
often
claim
criticism
that
there
before
was
1960.
a
Paul
kind de
of
methodological
Man
is
one
who,
consensus
describing
in
the
relationship between American and European criticism, represents the New Criticism as
a
formalism
completely
isolated
from
`a
European
sense
of
history'.
It
is
to
be
regretted, according to de Man, that the New Criticism `was never able to overcome the anti-historical within
its
bias
original
that
presided
boundaries
over
and
its
was
beginnings'
and
allowed
do
to
`that so
it
remained
without
confined
being
seriously
challenged' (de Man 1983, 20±1). This idea of the New Criticism as an unchallenged, anti-historical formalism is highly influential in accounts of the history of criticism and theory
in
the
United
States,
but
it
is
not
easy
to
support.
There
are
some
hopeful
manifestos, such as R. S. Crane's `History versus Criticism in the Study of Literature' (1935) and John Crowe Ransom's `Criticism Inc.' (1937), which seek to establish a new criticism explicitly in opposition to a traditional historical scholarship. Commentators have
also
pointed
to
the
focus
on
poetry
in
early
New
Criticism
as
a
form
of
anti-
historical bias. Eagleton argues that `poetry is of all the literary genres the one most apparently sealed off from history, the one where ``sensibility'' may play its purest, least socially
tainted
role'
(Eagleton
1983,
48).
Similarly,
Norris
remarks
that
`the
New
Critics were bent upon preserving [poetry's] uniqueness as an object' (Norris 1982, 8), Culler observes that `the projects of the New Criticism were linked to the preservation of aesthetic autonomy' (Culler 1983, 20) and Lentricchia describes the New Critical
modern north american criticism and theory
26
Krieger, M.
Northrop Frye in Modern Criticism The Legacy of Northrop Frye The Complete Works of Percy Bysshe Shelley
. New York, 1996.
Lee, A. and Denham, R. D. (eds) Shelley, P. B.
. Toronto, 1994.
, eds R. Ingpen and W. E. Peck. London,
1930.
5. The Encounter with Structuralism and the Invention of Poststructuralism
There is a common perception that poststructuralism arrived in the United States as an import in October 1966, when Derrida read his paper, `Structure, Sign, and Play in the Discourse of the Human Sciences', at Johns Hopkins University. Bearing in mind that the term
poststructuralism
was not used in Europe until much later, it is important to stress that
poststructuralism was not a ready-made object which could be imported, but something that had to be fashioned in the United States, something which emerged, in the 1970s, from a complex set of circumstances in North American criticism, and which was, in particular, deeply bound up with the context of reception of Derrida's work. Poststructuralism
was
not
so
much
imported
as
invented
in
the
United
States,
by
a
process
of
decontextualizing and then recontextualizing Derrida. To understand this process it will be necessary to sketch the debates into which Derrida's work intervened, the kind of impact that
this
intervention
entailed,
and
the
reception
history
of
Derrida
and
other
post-
structuralist thinkers in the 1970s and 1980s. Commentators North
American
often
claim
criticism
that
there
before
was
1960.
a
Paul
kind de
of
methodological
Man
is
one
who,
consensus
describing
in
the
relationship between American and European criticism, represents the New Criticism as
a
formalism
completely
isolated
from
`a
European
sense
of
history'.
It
is
to
be
regretted, according to de Man, that the New Criticism `was never able to overcome the anti-historical within
its
bias
original
that
presided
boundaries
over
and
its
was
beginnings'
and
allowed
do
to
`that so
it
remained
without
confined
being
seriously
challenged' (de Man 1983, 20±1). This idea of the New Criticism as an unchallenged, anti-historical formalism is highly influential in accounts of the history of criticism and theory
in
the
United
States,
but
it
is
not
easy
to
support.
There
are
some
hopeful
manifestos, such as R. S. Crane's `History versus Criticism in the Study of Literature' (1935) and John Crowe Ransom's `Criticism Inc.' (1937), which seek to establish a new criticism explicitly in opposition to a traditional historical scholarship. Commentators have
also
pointed
to
the
focus
on
poetry
in
early
New
Criticism
as
a
form
of
anti-
historical bias. Eagleton argues that `poetry is of all the literary genres the one most apparently sealed off from history, the one where ``sensibility'' may play its purest, least socially
tainted
role'
(Eagleton
1983,
48).
Similarly,
Norris
remarks
that
`the
New
Critics were bent upon preserving [poetry's] uniqueness as an object' (Norris 1982, 8), Culler observes that `the projects of the New Criticism were linked to the preservation of aesthetic autonomy' (Culler 1983, 20) and Lentricchia describes the New Critical
encounter with structuralism and invention of poststructuralism
27
mentality as `a continuing urge to essentialise literary discourse by making it . . . a vast, enclosed textual and semantic preserve' (1980, xiii). These accounts may be expressing a tendency in some New Criticism, but they do not represent the extent to which historical consciousness continued to thrive within and around the New Critical project. A traditional, positivist model of historicism may have been displaced by the New Criticism, but there is no evidence to suggest that historicism at large ever accepted its demotion, and an impetus for historicist self-renewal became a recurring
feature
of
critical
debate
throughout
the
period
of
supposed
New
Critical
consensus. In the 1920s, Harry Elmer Barnes and James Harvey Robinson were at the forefront of a movement at Columbia University to develop a new historical method that freed itself from the positivist model. In 1940, Matthew Josephson can be found declaring in the
Virginia Quarterly
that `there seems to be a thirst for history in various forms. Is it
because the readers of our time have lived through so much history in the making since 1914 that they are more history-minded than ever before?' (Josephson 1940). Jumping forward to 1952, Cushing Strout argued that Barnes and Robinson's new historicism of the 1920s, marred by its adherence to a linear temporality, nevertheless points the way to new relativist historiography. Six years later the case was still being argued by Roy Harvey Pearce
in
the
Kenyon Review
(Pearce
1957),
this
time
claiming
strong
compatibility
between New Critical methods and the new historicisms. In 1960, Rene Wellek argued that there has always been a tension within the New Critical movement between criticism and history, and again evidence for this is easy to find. Soon after Ransom's anti-historical manifesto of 1937, Cleanth Brooks published an article in the
Kenyon Review
in which he
rejects the conflict between criticism and history as it is represented by his fellow `Southern Critic' Allen Tate, and Edwin Greenlaw, whose
The Province of Literary History
had sided
with historical scholarship in its rivalry with criticism. For Brooks, the question was not `whether we shall study the history of literature, but rather about what centre this history will be organised?' (Brooks 1940, 412). The importance of this background is that it is only a very selective, canonical history of theory and criticism that can represent New Criticism in the United States as a serene consensus or a hegemony. From Wimsatt's attempts to define and vindicate the role of history in criticism in
The Verbal Icon
(1954) to Wellek's persistent defence of historicism
in literary studies, it is clear that the American universities had no agreed position on history that could be incorporated into their programmes for the study of literature. It is also clear, from Wellek's spat with Gerald Graff in
Critical Inquiry
in 1979, how little agreement
there was in retrospective constructions of critical history on the role of history in the period of New Critical influence. Not only is there an apparent war between formalism and historicism
running
through
the
journals
before
1960,
there
is
also
an
apparent
war
between differing interpretations of that period in more recent critical histories. It is in the context of this irreconcilable battle between formalism and historicism that the impact of structuralism and poststructuralism in the United States is best understood. In fact it is hard to say which attitude to this polemic is more influential, those who, like Wellek, seek to stress the ferocity of the debate between criticism and history, or those who, like de Man, aim to reduce the critical past to a stable consensus. In either case, there is a strong sense of continuity between the era of New Critical dominance and the arrival of structuralism in the 1960s. De Man, for example claims that French criticism `especially in the case of Roland Barthes, appears to be moving in the direction of a formalism that, appearances notwithstanding, is not that different from New Criticism' (de Man 1983, 230±1). This
modern north american criticism and theory
28
continuity between New Criticism and structuralism is a theme in the work of many critics
The Romantic Image suggests, for example, that Frye's
and commentators. Frank Kermode's
Anatomy of Criticism extends the New Critical tradition of neo-Coleridgean symbolism into the 1960s despite Frye's explicit repudiation of New Critical aestheticism; Philip Thody's
Roland Barthes: a Conservative Estimate argues that Barthes's work operates with the same set of assumptions that mobilized New Criticism; Lentricchia finds `many traces (perhaps ``scars'' is the word) of New Criticism in the fixed and identifiable positions we have come to know as contemporary theory' (1980, ix); and Wellek's history of criticism describes Richards' view of Jakobson's work as the fulfilment of his own ambitions, and claims an obvious continuity from New Criticism in the structuralist poetics of Tzvetan Todorov. Nor does this sense of continuity stop at structuralism. This is Culler in
On Deconstruction:
One can certainly argue that American criticism has found in deconstruction reasons to deem interpretation
the
supreme
task
of
critical
inquiry,
and
thus
to
preserve
some
measure
of
continuity between the goals of New Criticism and those of the newer criticism. (1983, 220)
Because of the perceived continuity from New Criticism to structuralism and deconstruction, there was always a sense that the encounter with structuralism in the United States was being assimilated into an ongoing conflict between formal and historical approaches to literature. The exact moment of impact of literary structuralism in the United States is impossible to locate. While the New Criticism grew up in a distinctly Anglo-American context, criticism in the 1960s was moving into a phase of importation and translation of ideas from Continental European thought. The work of Roman Jakobson, for example, had been available from about 1960, but many were not aware of the highly scientific, linguisticsbased structuralist project in literary studies until the 1970s, with the publication of
The
Structuralist Controversy and Culler's Structuralist Poetics. The `structuralist controversy' was presented in the United States as a strange concoction of these highly systematic and scientific
approaches
to
literature
and
approaches that would later be named as to until well into the 1970s as a
the
critiques
of
these
systematized
linguistic
poststructuralist. Derrida was, for example, referred
structuralist. Whereas in France there was a slow unfolding
of structuralism as a literary critical science followed by a period of mounting critique of the scientism of these approaches (perhaps best represented in the work of Roland Barthes), in the United States, the encounter with scientific structuralism coincided largely with the reception of its critique. It may be that this contemporaneity of classical structuralism and the
beginnings
of
deconstruction
was
a
chronological
confusion
that
necessitated
the
invention of poststructuralism as a distinct critical tendency. The reception of Derrida's work in America was also conditioned by the delay between original publication dates in French and the publication of translations. The American academic expert in the reading of French and attentive to French academic journals could have had foreknowledge of the entirety of
  rence by the time of its L'Ecriture et la Diffe
publication in 1967, eleven years before its translation into English. The publication of
La
Á ne and De la grammatologie in the same year gave a start of six and nine Voix et le phenome years over translation-reliant colleagues. The reading of `Structure, Sign, and Play in the Discourse of the Human Sciences', at Johns Hopkins in October 1966 may be seen as marking the first impact of Derrida in America, but even here there was a complicated time lag. The translation did not appear until its inclusion in
The Languages of Criticism and the
Sciences of Man: the Structuralist Controversy in 1970, and did not reach a wide readership
encounter with structuralism and invention of poststructuralism until
1972,
when
the
Structuralist Controversy
paperback
edition
was
released
under
the
snappier
29
title
The
. Perhaps the most significant fact about Derrida's reception in
the United States was just how little material was available in translation before the process of mediating his work to an English-speaking readership had begun. In 1971, for example,
De la grammatologie
Paul de Man's landmark discussion of Derrida's
in
Blindness and Insight
was for many a crucial point of entry, and preceded the translation by five years. The importance of the translation history and the prominence of mediation is exactly that
it provides the
opportunity
for Derrida's work
to
be
reinvented, refashioned
and
recontextualized according to the preoccupations, interests and values of the American critical tradition. In the late 1970s and 1980s many commentators held the mediation process responsible for a `domestication' of Derrida, on the grounds that the original force of his writing had been sacrificed to these distinctly American preoccupations. It could be said that the invention of poststructuralism was structured according to two phases in the reception of Derrida, the first being the initial mediation of his ideas, and the second a revision of his reputation in the early 1980s. I have argued that the principal legacy of the American
critical
tradition
was
an
ongoing
polemic
between
historicist
and
formalist
approaches, and if we turn for a moment to the critical journals in which the invention of poststructuralism was unfolding, this legacy is overwhelmingly present. Most significant, perhaps, were
New Literary History
and
diacritics
, founded in 1969 and 1970 respectively, in
which there was a kind of table tennis being played with the character of poststructuralism between 1970 and 1975. On one hand Derrida formalist to be aligned with de Man (see
diacritics
can be represented as a kind of arch
, Winter 1972), who in this period, was
perceived above all as the critic who extended the influence of the New Criticism into French studies. He is, for Funt in 1971, `the avant-garde of the structuralist movement itself', and yet, in early 1972, was contrasted with the structuralists on the grounds of a more historicist orientation:
One of the characteristics that makes Derrida's work particularly valuable for scholars is that, in contrast to many contemporary Structuralists, he views this formal organisation which in itself has no sense as susceptible to historical delineation. (Gelley 1972, 10)
It would be fair to say, cutting a longer story short, that this kind of uncertainty dominated the early reception of Derrida. It might also be reasonable to see this initial discussion as somewhat
more
faithful
to
the
character
of
Derrida's
work
than
the
phase
which
immediately followed, in which he was much more decisively aligned with formalism, and in which deconstruction was consolidated as a critical school in such a way that it was difficult to sustain any notion that Derrida might represent some long awaited return to historicist values. A milestone in this regard was the publication of Jonathan Culler's
Structuralist Poetics
, which stresses Derrida's relation to the language-based paradigms of
structuralism. Up to this point, Derrida had been referred to primarily as a structuralist except when being claimed by the historicist camp. The significance of Culler's book is that it emphasizes Derrida's difference form the linguistic analyses of the structuralists, but represents this difference as a deviance in attitude to the linguistic model of analysis in criticism, rather than as a deviation into historicism of any kind. Not for the last time, Culler settled a debate that had been troubling the critical academy, and in so doing, distanced the idea of poststructuralism from the kind of historicism to which it might easily have been linked from the start. If poststructuralism was invented in the United States, it was invented by these debates
modern north american criticism and theory
30
which, for contextual reasons, had to decide upon whether it belonged to the formalist or historicist orientation. In the second half of the 1970s, the invented object takes on a distinctly formalist character largely through its heavy association with another invention ± deconstructive criticism. One way of telling the story of how deconstruction acquired a formalist character is to look at a debate which arose in
Critical Inquiry
in 1976. Here
Wayne Booth argued that Hillis Miller's critique of M. H. Abrams's historicism represented an exhilarating possibility, namely a `deconstructed history', which would exist in a kind of parasitical relationship to the traditional historicism represented by Abrams. In the same edition of
Critical Inquiry
, Abrams himself develops the question through rumination on
the relation between a deconstructed and a traditional criticism. Abrams is clearly talking about
the
impossibility
indeterminate
(a
of
history
writing
of
a
literary
deconstructed
history
texts),
when
without
texts
in
that
considering
history
the
are
question
as
Booth had, that the historical analysis is itself a text which tells a story as indeterminate as the texts it analyses. For Booth, an awareness of the textuality of history would constitute a new historical method (a deconstructed history). These two approaches to the question of deconstruction in relation to history might seem identical, since a history of indeterminacy and
an
indeterminate
contemplating, Miller,
history
however.
Derrida,
de
Man
In or
might
Booth's
be
hard
sense
Nietzsche,
to
there
which
tell
is
can
a
apart.
theory
be
The of
applied
difference
history to
in
the
literary
is
worth
work
history
of
and
historicism. In Abrams's sense, there is a prior theory of the indeterminacy of language in general which then leads into historiographical difficulties. These are markedly different ways
of
assessing
the
impact
of
deconstruction
and
poststructuralism
on
traditional
historicism, since one comes from within historiography and the other from without. The aftermath of this encounter was of great significance for the invention and impact of poststructuralism in America. At the first meeting of the Modern Language Association's `Division
on
Philosophical
Approaches
to
Literature'
in
1976,
Abrams
emphatically
endorsed this second conception of the relevance of deconstruction to literary history. He did this by analysing the challenge to his own historicism, and indeed to the `entire body of traditional inquiries in the human sciences', as one that derives from a theory of language. He then goes on to present what he calls the linguistic premises, in the work of Miller and Derrida, on which the critique of historicism depends. `It is often said', wrote Abrams, `that Derrida and those who follow his lead subordinate all inquiries into a prior inquiry into language'. This is one of the clearest incidences of the misrepresentation or reinvention of Derrida in the American context. And Miller's response to Abrams at the symposium is equally revealing (Miller 1977). Miller's `little example of a deconstructive strategy' focuses on Booth's suggestion that a deconstructive history would be `plainly and simply parasitical' on traditional history from the point of view of etymology. The use of etymology conception
for
Miller
of
history,
is in
twofold.
On
which
earlier
the
one
hand,
meanings
are
it
resonates
considered
with
more
a
traditional
authentic
than
derived ones, against which he can assert an alternative in which the history of words can be presented as a complex of conflicting senses. Where traditional etymology refers current usage of a word back to the solidity of a prior usage, Miller's discussion of `parasite' does the opposite, disrupting the secure interpretation of current usage with a complex of prior synonymic and antonymic relations. On the other hand, Miller uses etymology to illustrate just how much indeterminacy a deconstructive reading can produce from a small fragment of text, and therefore affirms Abrams's view that deconstructive strategy entails a view of the
language
as essentially
polysemic
and
indeterminate.
But
whereas
for
Abrams
the
encounter with structuralism and invention of poststructuralism
31
deconstructive challenge to history was based on prior linguistic premises, Miller's example seems to assert the priority of a historical method upon which the polysemy of language is consequent. In either case, what began as a debate about historical method quickly shifted to a debate about language and interpretation. There is a discernible process here of polarizing deconstruction as an anti-historicist formalism with linguistic premises which certainly cannot be substantiated with reference to Derrida's writings. But there was a tendency in 1976 and 1977 to represent Derrida, deconstruction and sometimes poststructuralism as a whole in this way. Whereas in 1972, Gelley had argued in
diacritics
that Derrida and Foucault could be distinguished only by the
most subtle nuances, it was more common in 1977 to see this nuance presented
as
the
opposition between linguistic formalism and political historicism. Edward Said was one who, in
Beginnings
in 1975, had identified the relationship between Derrida and Foucault
as a choice, and by 1978 was formulating it as an insistent opposition:
Whereas Derrida's theory of textuality brings criticism to bear upon a signifier freed from any obligation to a transcendental signified, Foucault's theories move criticism from a consideration of the signifier to a description of the signifier's place, a place rarely innocent, dimensionless, or without the affirmative authority of discursive discipline.
The point here is not that Said is wrong to characterize Derrida in this way, but that this is increasingly common as a representation of Derrida at the end of the 1970s. In both Said's call for a political history and Abrams's defence of a literary history, Derrida's work is represented primarily as an investigation into the signifier, and secondarily as a challenge to historical discourse. Despite the fact that Derrida's engagement with linguistics relentlessly
opposes
criticism,
he
the is
possibility
repeatedly
of
linguistic
characterized
premises, in
this
or
indeed
phase
as
a
of
linguistic
linguistically
models
in
orientated
theoretician of indeterminacy. But if Miller's debate with Abrams was the place where the idea of deconstruction as a critical approach with linguistic premises was established, it may be that the debate between Derrida and John Searle in
Glyph
in 1977 and 1978 put it
to rest. Given the opportunity to represent himself, rather than to be mediated by an American disciple, Derrida used this exchange as a demonstration of the distance between his work and any systematic theory of language. Remembered mainly for what Culler described as Searle's `egregious misunderstanding of Derrida', the debate between Derrida and Searle illustrated the problems for the academy in the United States of relying too heavily
on
the
mediation
of
Derrida's
work
for
its
understanding
of
the
nature
of
poststructuralism. There are three important points to be made here about this history. First, there is a profound theoretical difficulty in any account such as this which seems to imply that Derrida has been misrepresented, misread, domesticated or disrespected by his mediators. Deconstructive contexts
over
reading
characteristically
translations,
rejects
misrepresentations,
the
authority
misreadings
and
of
origins
errors.
and
Miller,
original de
Man
and Bloom have claimed that all readings (including translations) are misreadings. Derrida argues in
Speech and Phenomena
that the relationship between an origin and its supplements
is one in which `a possibility produces that to which it is said to be added on', which is to say that the possibility that a message will go wrong somehow inheres in the original as a possibility. Second, I have been describing a phase of critical history in which the terms poststructuralism and deconstruction (or the name of Derrida) were virtually synonymous, so that the invention of poststructuralism and the reception of Derrida were inseparable
modern north american criticism and theory
32
processes. Third, the context of polemic opposition between formalism and historicism made it necessary to be able to place a critical approach at one pole or the other. Taken together, these factors began to exert a pressure on the polemical context of American criticism which can be seen to have impelled a revision of the notion of poststructuralism along different lines. The idea, for example, that American poststructuralism represented a domestication
of
more
politicized
counterparts
in
Europe
became
a
commonplace
of
critical commentary. The extent of this realization at the beginning of the 1980s is striking. At the `Colloque de Cerisy' in 1980, for example, interventions from American speakers attest to a widespread feeling that the domestication of deconstruction was a function of the institutionalization of Derrida's work in American literary departments. After Ro 's `Deconstruction as Criticism' in 1979, which sought to retrieve Derrida for dolphe Gasche a radical philosophy, commentators were lining up to point out the domesticating effects of the American literary critical encounter with poststructuralism. In 1980, Frank Lentricchia's
After the New Criticism
attacked American deconstruction for its fall into ahistori-
 recognized `traces of New Criticism' in the `repeated and often cality, and like Gasche extremely subtle denial of history by a variety of contemporary theorists'. In 1983 Wlad Godzich's article `The Domestication of Derrida' points to some of the marxist semes, and in particular the term
production
, which had held significance for Derrida's original context
in the marxist Tel Quel Group, and which had been simply dropped in the American appropriation
of
Derrida.
And
in
an
interview
before
his
death,
even
Paul
de
Man
recognizes the distortion:
It is often said ± and this is true to some extent ± that whatever is audacious, whatever is really
subversive
and
incisive
in
Derrida's
text
and
in
his
work
is
being
taken
out
by
academicizing him, by making him just one other method by means of which literature can be taught. (1986, 116)
Perhaps what is most interesting about this realization, recontextualization and revision of the relation of deconstruction and its relation to history and politics is that it allowed the notion
of
Criticism
poststructuralism
to
acquire
a
wider
reference.
Lentricchia's
After the New
, for example, is one of the places where the idea of poststructuralism is cleaved
away from American deconstruction to the point where it becomes possible to speak of poststructuralism
and
history
in
the
same
breath.
Like
Said,
Lentricchia
depends
on
Foucault as an uneasy bridge between Derrida and marxism, and blames de Man for all that is wrong with the American invention. But when Lentricchia describes his own project as a `poststructuralist history', he significantly distances himself from those, like Maria Ruegg and Terry Eagleton, who have condemned poststructuralism as a whole for its ahistoricality. The early 1980s in American criticism can be seen as a period in which it was ensured that, the next time there was a call for a return to history, it could be made in the name of, and not in opposition to, poststructuralism. It is now recognized that the new historicisms that dominated criticism in the 1980s and 1990s represented a more appropriate critical response to Derrida
and other poststructuralists than the deconstructive
readings in relation to which poststructuralism was initially defined.
Mark Currie
reception theory and reader-response
33
Further reading and works cited Natural Supernaturalism. London, 1971.
Abrams, M. H.
Ð. `The Deconstructive Angel', Arac, J. et al. (eds)
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
The Yale Critics. Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
Booth, W. `M. H. Abrams: Historian, Critic, Pluralist', Brooks, C. `Literature and the Professors',
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
Kenyon Review, 1940.
Crane, R. S. `History versus Criticism in the Study of Literature', Culler, J. Ð.
On Deconstruction. London, 1983.
de Man, P. Ð.
English Journal, 24, 1935.
Structuralist Poetics. London, 1975.
Blindness and Insight. London, 1983.
The Resistance to Theory. Manchester, 1986.
Derrida, J.
Speech and Phenomena and Other Essays on Husserl's Theory of Signs . Evanston, 1973.
Ð.
Of Grammatology. Baltimore, 1976.
Ð.
Writing and Difference. London, 1978.
Eagleton, T.
Literary Theory. Oxford, 1983.
Funt, D. `Piaget and Structuralism',
diacritics, Winter 1971.
 , R. `Deconstruction as Criticism', Gasche Gelley, A. `Form as Force',
Glyph, 6, 1979.
diacritics, Spring 1972.
Godzich, W. `The Domestication of Derrida', in Arac, et al., ed. Greenlaw, E.
The Province of Literary History. Baltimore, MD, 1931.
Josephson, M. `Historians and Mythmakers', Kermode, F.
Lentricchia, F.
After the New Criticism. London, 1980.
Miller, J. H. `Tradition and Difference', Ð. `The Critic as Host', Norris, C.
diacritics, Winter 1972.
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
Deconstruction. London, 1982.
Pearce, R. H. `Historicism Once More', Ransom, J. C. `Criticism Inc.', Said, E.
Virginia Quarterly Review, Summer, 1940.
Romantic Image. London, 1957.
Kenyon Review, 1958.
Virginia Quarterly Review, Fall, 1937.
Beginnings. Baltimore, MD, 1975.
Ð. `The Problem of Textuality', Thody, P.
Critical Inquiry, Summer 1978.
Roland Barthes. London, 1977.
Wellek, R. `Literary Theory, Criticism and History', Wimsatt, W. K.
Yale Review, Spring, 1960.
The Verbal Icon. London, 1970.
6. Reception Theory and Reader-Response: Norman Holland (1927±), Stanley Fish (1938±) and David Bleich (1940±)
While some commentators (for example, Holub 1984) wish to restrict reception theory to the European tradition embracing both phenomenology and hermeneutics ± in shorthand terms, the Geneva and Constance Schools ± it is possible and I think valid to extend it ± and to use the alternative term `reader-response', indifferently ± to cover a wider and more
reception theory and reader-response
33
Further reading and works cited Natural Supernaturalism. London, 1971.
Abrams, M. H.
Ð. `The Deconstructive Angel', Arac, J. et al. (eds)
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
The Yale Critics. Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
Booth, W. `M. H. Abrams: Historian, Critic, Pluralist', Brooks, C. `Literature and the Professors',
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
Kenyon Review, 1940.
Crane, R. S. `History versus Criticism in the Study of Literature', Culler, J. Ð.
On Deconstruction. London, 1983.
de Man, P. Ð.
English Journal, 24, 1935.
Structuralist Poetics. London, 1975.
Blindness and Insight. London, 1983.
The Resistance to Theory. Manchester, 1986.
Derrida, J.
Speech and Phenomena and Other Essays on Husserl's Theory of Signs . Evanston, 1973.
Ð.
Of Grammatology. Baltimore, 1976.
Ð.
Writing and Difference. London, 1978.
Eagleton, T.
Literary Theory. Oxford, 1983.
Funt, D. `Piaget and Structuralism',
diacritics, Winter 1971.
 , R. `Deconstruction as Criticism', Gasche Gelley, A. `Form as Force',
Glyph, 6, 1979.
diacritics, Spring 1972.
Godzich, W. `The Domestication of Derrida', in Arac, et al., ed. Greenlaw, E.
The Province of Literary History. Baltimore, MD, 1931.
Josephson, M. `Historians and Mythmakers', Kermode, F.
Lentricchia, F.
After the New Criticism. London, 1980.
Miller, J. H. `Tradition and Difference', Ð. `The Critic as Host', Norris, C.
diacritics, Winter 1972.
Critical Inquiry, Spring 1977.
Deconstruction. London, 1982.
Pearce, R. H. `Historicism Once More', Ransom, J. C. `Criticism Inc.', Said, E.
Virginia Quarterly Review, Summer, 1940.
Romantic Image. London, 1957.
Kenyon Review, 1958.
Virginia Quarterly Review, Fall, 1937.
Beginnings. Baltimore, MD, 1975.
Ð. `The Problem of Textuality', Thody, P.
Critical Inquiry, Summer 1978.
Roland Barthes. London, 1977.
Wellek, R. `Literary Theory, Criticism and History', Wimsatt, W. K.
Yale Review, Spring, 1960.
The Verbal Icon. London, 1970.
6. Reception Theory and Reader-Response: Norman Holland (1927±), Stanley Fish (1938±) and David Bleich (1940±)
While some commentators (for example, Holub 1984) wish to restrict reception theory to the European tradition embracing both phenomenology and hermeneutics ± in shorthand terms, the Geneva and Constance Schools ± it is possible and I think valid to extend it ± and to use the alternative term `reader-response', indifferently ± to cover a wider and more
modern north american criticism and theory
34
diverse
range
American
of
theories
versions
of
of
how
literary literary
effect texts
and
response,
achieve
their
including
effects
on
the
various
readers,
how
Angloreaders
respond to them, and what the implications of the interaction between reader and text may be. The American scene lacks the apparent homogeneity and orderliness of the European, where the authority of `schools' of theory has been paramount, at least within the Germanspeaking arena, and where a culture of collaborative accumulation of theoretical models has been encouraged, in the perhaps
delusive hope of establishing an ultimate `grand
theory' of reception. Elements of reader-response criticism are diffused more widely and variously within the American academic and intellectual arena, which has in the postwar period been both more eclectic and more assimilative of a range of theoretical positions, from a still tenacious New Critical stance, various psychoanalytically oriented approaches, through structuralism to poststructuralism (a movement in the history of semiotics given exemplary clarification in the work of Jonathan Culler), and into various broadly sociological approaches which stress race or gender or pay particular attention to pedagogy. This multifarious mix no doubt answers to the cultural profusion and the social and ethnic variety of the USA and it has occasioned vigorous critical debate, not to say fractiousness, in
some
quarters
within
the
academy
there
in
the
late
twentieth
century.
However,
important though this context is, it is impossible to survey the whole variegated scene in the confines of a brief article (though some indications are given at the end and the bibliography refers to some selected contributions to the wider debate) and I therefore restrict myself largely to discussion of the three critics indicated above. These
major
American
proponents
of
reader-response
criticism
occupy
significantly
different and individualistic positions within the broad parameters of reception theory, in its general sense ± that understanding of literature (and other arts) which stresses the active and formative role of the reader (or audience or spectator) in the constitution of the artwork (primarily the literary text) and which reflects a dissatisisfaction with formalist principles which privilege and prioritize the text over the reader. While Norman Holland and David Bleich share an emphasis on the psychological approach to the activity of reading, their descriptions of that approach are significantly different. Stanley Fish, on the other hand, starting from a more strictly literary-critical position, develops a theoretical model which might be termed, in a specialized and abstract sense, sociological, with a strong
rhetorical
implications
of
inflection.
All
reader-response
three
theory
critics and
lay
varying
practice.
All
stress
three
on
are
the
also
pedagogical
engaged
with
the overall dialectical pressure that informs reception theory with regard to literature ± that is, the tension between reader and text, or subjective and objective principles, the initial affirmation of the former against the latter, and the subsequent `return of the text', as it might
be
termed,
in
the
effort
to
avoid
or
qualify
the
subjectivism
or
impressionism
threatened by the stress on the reader's role. Bleich and Holland, true to their emphasis on psychology, each affirm a qualified subjectivism, while Fish, through an ingenious and powerful theoretical strategy, is most successful in overcoming the dualizing pressure of the dialectical model, though this appears to lead him ultimately to a theoretical position which is, to use one of his own celebrated terms, `self-consuming'. Norman Holland, engaged in `constructing a post-Freudian psychoaesthetics' (Freund 1987,
30),
gives
substantial
and
predominant
force
to
the
conscious
personality
and
unconscious psyche of the reader in the activity of reading, employing concepts taken from American
ego
psychology
to
construct
a model
of the
reader
as enjoying
the
psychic
pleasures and benefits of engagement with the imaginative work. His starting point is the
reception theory and reader-response
35
Freudian sanctioning of artistic creativity as the therapeutic licence to fantasy which, although grounded in the infantile ego and its unconscious drives, succeeds in transforming these
(expressed
imaginative
as
forms
either
and
desire
thereby
or
fear)
achieves
into
an
socially
adult
respectable
mediation
and
between
representable
fantasizing
ego
and obdurate reality. Acknowledgement of this creatively mediating activity is developed by Holland into a theory that articulates the secondary operation implicit in it, in his view ± that is, the specific mediation between reader as ego and text as object ± and involves seeing the process of reading as a dynamic and mutual transaction between the text as artistic form and meaning and the reader as adaptive and defensive ego ± what he terms `the dynamics of literary response' (Holland 1968). He claims that we as readers `work out through the text our own characteristic patterns of desire and adaptation. We interact with the work, making it part of our own psychic economy and making ourselves part of the literary work ± as we interpret it' (Holland 1980, 124). This approach, usually termed transactive (sometimes transactional) criticism, has the merit of recognizing that reading is itself a psychological process and that the reader ± any reader ± has a subjective reality, but it is perhaps simplifyingly optimistic in its conviction that the dynamic transaction with the
text
necessarily
processes.
And
produces
although
it
pleasure
presents
from
the
the
sublimation
interaction
of
of
reader
traumatic
and
text
unconscious
as
one
that
is
mutually transformative and explicitly rejects a dualistic Cartesian epistemology, his model retains an implicit dualism with its positing of the imaginative text on the one hand in transaction with the autonomous ego on the other. For Holland, then, meaning
is fundamentally
psychological,
realized
according
to a
psychoanalytic and indeed Freudian and anti-Jungian prescription, and so he claims a correlation between textual and psychic processes ± as the text strives for unity, an eventual thematic
harmony,
so
the
individual
reader
strives
for
identity,
an
eventual
psychic
equilibrium. Text and self are accordingly parallel terms, as are unity and identity, the latter pair seen as abstractions or idealizations of the former, and a sort of isomorphism operates so that textual work (interpretation and understanding leading to thematic unity) and psychic work (expression and control of egoistic drives leading to personal identity) are seen as interinvolved, a mutual process as text and self interactively develop toward the achievement of unity and identity ± `when I arrive at the unity in a literary text or the identity theme of a personality I am studying, I do so in a way that is characteristic for me ± for my identity theme' (Holland 1980, 122). Accordingly, `interpretation is a function of identity' (Holland 1980, 124), an assertion which defines reading as to some degree a common
subjective
constituted
by
response,
fundamental
in
so
psychic
far
as,
drives,
in
Holland's
passing
Freudian
through
the
model,
infantile
we
are
all
pre-oedipal
stages, oral, anal and phallic, into the oedipal crisis ± but also as an individual subjective response, in so far as we are all particular persons with our own specific life experiences. The literary text is thus the means for its reader to recreate him or herself through a unifying interpretation, a centripetal movement that brings text and self together in a movement of self-identification on the reader's part. Holland's theory has been criticized for its tendency to subordinate the text to the personality of the reader, making reading a quasi-confessional or autobiographical procedure ± the reader ultimately finds only his or her own subjectivity at the core of the text. It has also, predictably, come under attack from a deconstructionist perspective which questions the unitary nature of the identity presupposed in Holland's model. Holland has sought to answer some of this criticism, and to take
account
of
his
own
experimental
work
with
readers
(Holland
1973,
1975),
by
modern north american criticism and theory
36
proposing
a
`transferential'
model,
which
moderates
the
emphasis
on
the
reader
as
personality in favour of a stress on the activity of reading as dialectical, a negotiation between text and reader, although this returns him to the problem of dualism. But overall his
theory
remains
strongly
oriented
toward
a
subjectivizing
view
of
the
text±reader
relationship. David
Bleich,
who
was
associated
with
Holland
and
others
in
the
Centre
for
the
Psychological Study of the Arts in New York, also produced a psychological model of reader response, but one that developed away from the ego-based theory of his colleague toward
a
theory
of
intersubjectivity
based
on
an
epistemology
of
the
reader's
initial
perception and subsequent interpretation of the text. There is also a recognition of the importance of language as the articulation, both mediating and objectifying, of the self, since language ensures a distancing which enables reflection but also requires the reader as subject for
its
animation
and
in
consequence
cannot
claim
abstract
objectivity.
In
a
quasi-
phenomenological spirit, Bleich claims that human attention distinguishes three kinds of entity ± people, objects and symbols ± and literary works fall into the third category. While the text in its mere physicality is an object, its realization as meaningful work depends on the capacity and desire for symbolization on the reader's part ± that is, the reader's initial response ± which is followed by a secondary symbolization, or `a motivated resymbolization' (Bleich 1980, 134), in which an understanding and coherent articulation of the initial response are developed as a process of interpretation. It is the reader as epistemological subject or agent who retains primacy in this process, however, which Bleich terms unapologetically `subjective criticism' (Bleich 1975, 1978) and it appears that it is the mode of attention, or response, directed by the reader at the object which constitutes the `perceptual symbolization' (Bleich 1980, 135) of it. This is not, however, a purely individual and arbitrary process because the decision to perceive the object as symbol ± as an aesthetic object ± both derives from a common immediate experience of seeing the words on the page and leads at once to a confirmation which is collective, that is the agreement of a community which determines the articulation of the resymbolization or interpretation which extends the initial reaction or perception into aesthetic understanding and enjoyment. However, the basis for discussion of any literary work, for an intersubjective activity related
to
the
resymbolization
text, of
remains
it'
which
not
the
produce
text the
per se
but
reader's
the
reader's
`subjective
`symbolization
syntheses'
(Bleich
and
1980,
145). For Bleich, then, the text has no efficacy or particular status so far as response is concerned: it is the reader who produces and invests the text-as-work through symbolizations that are grounded in the reader's psychology and therefore inalienably subjective (Bleich 1977). They are not therefore solipsistic and incommunicable, however, because of the intersubjective force of language and the capacity of an interpretive community to mediate
responses
communicative
through
agencies
in
an
implicit
`the
consensus.
common
social
Bleich
purpose
locates of
the
pedagogy'
origin
of
(Bleich
these 1980,
158) by which he appears to mean a communal inculcation of responsive knowledge, whether
formally
instituted
in
the
classroom
or
not.
In
the
context
of
the
modern
developed world, however, `schools become the regular agency of subjective initiative' (Bleich 1980, 159) and much of Bleich's attention has consequently been devoted to analysing the conditions of subjective response in the framework of pedagogy. As such, his work can be seen as an important contribution to a substantial current of reader-response theory which has been engaged in examining the acquisition and development of reading skills and powers of interpretation.
reception theory and reader-response
37
Bleich's formulations of the roles of both language and community in enabling and controlling
subjective
response
owe
a
good
deal
to
the
thinking
of
the
third
of
my
American representatives of reader-response theory, Stanley Fish. However, Fish's ideas regarding response develop over a period, and he starts out from a position which is in some respects that of the traditional literary critic, examining closely a canonical text. The text in question is Milton's
Paradise Lost,
which Fish subjects to a minutely scrupulous reading
that derives from the New Critical tradition, although his arguments from that reading take an importantly different direction. Briefly, he claims that the reader, through the process of reading, realizes an awareness of the parallels between his or her own epistemological situation and the imagined primal human situation articulated through the poem, a tension between reasoned inquiry and analysis on the one hand and faith on the other, and this realization renders the reader not merely an observer of but a participant in the poem (Fish 1967).
Although the approach is basically traditional in its
recognition
and
elaboration
of
the
reader's
difficulty
and
centring on the text,
uncertainty
of
the
response
is
a
significant first move, for Fish, toward a reader-oriented approach. The insight is developed and
extended
to
treat
a
wider
range
of
seventeenth-century
texts
(Fish
1972),
again
subjected to minute and often brilliant analysis, and a dualizing conception of reading, somewhat similar to the Barthesian division between `readerly' and `writerly' text (Barthes 1974),
is
proposed.
persuasive
in
expectations
The
text,
or
its
satisfaction
of
and
demanding
a
literary the
representation,
reader's
movement
of
is
seen
expectations,
or
self-reflection
on
as
either
`rhetorical',
`dialectical', the
disturbing
reader's
part
in
a
recognition of the difficulties of comprehension. The argument opens up but does not resolve, except in a negative way, the problematic of interaction between author, text and reader ± the question, that is, of where authority and responsibility for meaning are to lie. The
intriguing
concept
of
the
`self-consuming
artefact',
emphasized
in
the
subtitle,
epitomizes the problematic and its negativity, where `self-consumption' seems indifferently but somewhat obscurely the process to be undergone by author, text and reader in an unresolved play of interpretive and signifying forces. Fish is still holding here to some of the traditional principles of textual objectification and an ambiguity of focus results as he seeks to combine this with an increasingly radical recognition of the dynamic and constructive capacity of the reading process. However, a little earlier this recognition was generalized and given polemical force in Fish's essay of 1970, `Literature in the Reader', republished a decade later as the first chapter of
Is There a Text in This Class?
(1980). Here the emphasis shifts decisively toward the
reader as the text is reconceived not as object, however problematic in interpretation or dialectical in effect, but as
experience, and literature understood as event rather than content
or substance. It opens with a joust against the influential New Critical notion of the `Affective Fallacy' and claims the text, on the microlevel of the sentence, to be `no longer an
object,
a
thing-in-itself,
but
an
event,
something
that
participation of, the reader' (Fish 1980, 25). Accordingly,
happens process
to,
and
with
the
is given primacy: as
the sentence, and eventually the text, unfolds successively, word following word, it is this temporal flow, the experience of reading, which demands recognition and is not to be subsumed in a result or goal, the determination of a teleology. The text,
a fortiori
the
individual sentence (and Fish analyses a selection of sentences from various authors), is not to be viewed as `a repository of meaning' (Fish 1980, 29) but as a process of making meaning, every part of which remains significant and no part of which is to be relegated by an
end-oriented
or
totalizing
interpretative
claim.
Reading,
and
the
text
as
reading
modern north american criticism and theory
38
experience, are kinetic activities not static entities and their qualities of and as movement must be fully realized in any responsible interpretation. The tendency to `spatialize' and thereby `freeze' the text formalistically, in Fish's view the besetting sin of New Criticism, must be countered by an emphasis on temporality and flow. Further questions arise from this fundamental resituating of the relation between text and reader and simultaneous reconstitution of the nature of the text itself. One question concerns language ± is the faculty of `making meaning' in this experiential way peculiar to literary or poetic language a particular kind of semantic and formal strength? Fish answers this in the negative, with a progressively more radical inclusiveness ± this faculty belongs as much to the language of literary prose as of poetry, he claims initially, and then, making considerable use of the speech-act theory developed by Austin and Searle (Austin 1962; Searle 1969), widens this to reject any fundamental distinction between literary and nonliterary language. All language, he claims (adducing Austin), is performative, and carries illocutionary force (adducing Searle) ± that is, it bears with it the intentions and purposes of
its
speaker,
always
related
to
a
context,
and
accordingly
demands
a
corresponding
response. Language, in use, is never abstract or neutral, and the meaning of an utterance is never `pure', fully susceptible to abstract and categorical definition, but always in some sense
experientially
understood.
Another
question
concerns
the
nature
of
the
agency
responsible for rendering the text-as-experience: who or what is this? Fish introduces the concept of the `informed reader', which he acknowledges to be `a construct, an ideal or idealized reader' (1980, 48) but one that he claims is adequately although approximately identifiable with an empirically verifiable reader. The term raises difficulties, however, in its
uncertain
position
between
the
empirical
and
the
abstract,
in
its
individualizing
presumption, and in the degree to which it is understood to be a product or epiphenomenon of the text. Again, Fish revises the concept radically, later situating the reader in the context of what he terms `interpretive communities', the institutional frameworks which
govern
individual
readings,
which
he
emphasizes
in
the
subtitle
of
the
1980
collection of essays whose introduction provides an explanation of the term. Indeed,
Fish's
contribution
to
reader-response
theory
is
characterized
by
a
vigorous
capacity for self-revision, a willingness to reconsider and reshape his thinking, energized by a considerable capacity for forceful, perhaps occasionally truculent, polemic. First taking issue with New Critical precepts, he moves into an exploration of the complexities and perplexities of reading as process, which leads him to a radical reconsideration of meaning as experience, accompanied by attacks on what are viewed as attempts to re-objectify the text, notably the sophisticated strategies of stylistics (Fish's countering term is `affective stylistics'), but also by a critique of one-sidedly subjectivizing approaches, and finally to an effort to transcend the dualism of text and reader, object and subject, by means of the concept of `interpretive communities', understood as ineluctable, given institutions and systemic articulations of meaningfulness, enabling both texts and readers through their power of authorizing and controlling interpretation. Ultimately, as he acknowledges, his theory takes on a kind of implosive force ± fulfilled and voided at the same time in its `truth'. There is no `grand theory' to be applied to literature
in toto: there is only the
clarification of the conditions of our practice, what we do as readers constrained and enabled by our contexts and capabilities. Clarification of these conditions requires, in a Wittgensteinian
way,
the
removal
of
false
imperatives
and
directives
±
the
assumed
univocal authority of either text or reader, for example. But it also ensures escape from the falsely absolutized assumed consequences, a fall into subjectivism or solipsism on the
reception theory and reader-response
one
hand
(the
view
that
only
the
reader
39
produces
meaning)
or
into
objectivism
or
scientism on the other (the view that only the text does), as well as the, in Fish's view, unproductive
dualistic
oscillation
of
the
model
of
text±reader
interaction.
Nothing
is
changed by the recognition that Fish argues for: we are still (already) readers, as we were ± we have perhaps only the clarification and assurance of the recognition we no longer need. Holland, reception American
Bleich
theory
and
±
context
or ±
notably
reader
but
Fish
all
response,
they
are
by
offer
as
no
substantial
it is
more
means
its
and
interesting
commonly
only
termed
in
versions the
of
Anglo-
proponents. Recognition
and
investigation of the role of the reader extends back some way in twentieth-century AngloAmerican
critical
history,
as
the
important
examples
of
I.
A.
Richards
and
Louise
Rosenblatt illustrate, although its appearance is sporadic and it is overwhelmed by the success of the text-based New Criticism until the early 1960s. Thereafter it infiltrates into some of the structuralist models of literary theory, synthesized in Culler, and more broadly, though also contentiously, into linguistics and stylistics, in Chatman and Dillon. It is an aspect of the historical sociology of literature in the work of Ong, as well as more generally of the sociology of reading, notably that current which is concerned with pedagogy ± the ways
in
which
reading
ability
is
acquired
and
the
developmental
and
psychological
implications of reading in childhood and adolescence, at home and in school (Purves and Beach 1972; Many and Cox 1992). It also broadens to encompass other media, so that the reading of film in particular (a feature of Holland's work) and of other cultural products may be included ± in this it may be seen as true to its roots in reception theory and aesthetics. European reception theory has some influence but this is variable and models are
fairly
eclectically
adopted
or
engaged
with,
perhaps
because
of
the
vagaries
of
translation ± the major current of German reception theory is only very partially recognized (Holub
1987).
The
selection
of
essays
edited
by
Tompkins
(1980),
by
Suleiman
and
Crosman (1980) and by Bennett (1995) respectively are indicative of the range. Like the European, the American postwar development and efflorescence of reader-response theory and
criticism,
though
beginning
a
little
later,
is
similarly
swift,
impressive,
but
also
relatively short-lived ± with, again, a lifespan of little more than twenty years. Energized by its often polemical reaction against formalism, reader-response criticism is remarkably extensive in its theoretical exfoliation but also, it appears, determinate in its theoretical implications,
although
its
importance
in
encouraging
a
shift
of
concern
toward
the
pragmatic in literary criticism should not be underestimated.
Jeremy Lane
Further reading and works cited Austin, J. L. Barthes, R.
How to Do Things with Words.
S/Z.
New York, 1962.
New York, 1974.
Bennett, A. (ed.)
Readers and Reading.
Ð.
Readings and Feelings.
Ð.
Literature and Self-Awareness.
Ð.
Subjective Criticism.
London, 1995.
Urbana, IL, 1975. New York, 1977.
Baltimore, MD, 1978.
Ð. `Epistemological Assumptions in the Study of Response', in
Reader-Response Criticism,
Tompkins. Baltimore, MD, 1980. Chatman, S. Culler, J.
Narrative Structure in Fiction and Film.
Structuralist Poetics.
Ithaca, NY, 1975.
Ithaca, NY, 1978.
ed. J. P.
modern north american criticism and theory
40
Ð.
On Deconstruction.
Fish, S.
London, 1983.
Language Processing and the Reading of Literature.
Dillon, G.
Surprised by Sin.
Ð.
Self-Consuming Artefacts.
Ð.
Is There A Text in This Class?
Berkeley, CA, 1972.
Garvin, H. R. (ed.) Holland, N.
London, 1987.
Theories of Reading, Looking, Listening.
The Dynamics of Literary Response.
Ð.
Poems in Persons.
Ð.
5 Readers Reading.
Holub, R. C.
New Haven, CT, 1975.
Reception Theory.
Crossing Borders.
Reader-Response Criticism,
Madison, WI, 1992.
Many, J. and Cox, C. (eds)
Purves, A. C. and Beach, R.
Rosenblatt, L. Ð.
Royle, N.
Literature and the Reader.
Practical Criticism.
Slatoff, W.
Literature as Exploration.
Protocols of Reading. Speech Acts.
New York, 1968.
Oxford, 1991.
New Haven, CT, 1989.
Cambridge, 1969. Ithaca, NY, 1970.
Suleiman, S. R. and Crosman, I. (eds)
Weber, S.
Urbana, IL, 1972.
Carbondale, IL, 1978.
With Respect to Readers.
Tompkins, J. P. (ed.)
Norwood, MA, 1992.
New York, 1935.
Telepathy and Literature.
Searle, J. R.
10, 1977.
[1982]. London, 1988.
The Reader, the Text, the Poem.
Scholes, R.
Genre,
Reader Stance and Literary Understanding .
Orality and Literacy
Richards, I. A.
ed. J. P. Tompkins. Baltimore, MD, 1980.
London, 1984.
Mailloux, S. `Reader-Response Criticism?',
Ong, W. J.
Lewisburg, PA, 1981.
New York, 1968.
New York, 1973.
Ð. `Unity Identity Text Self', in
Ð.
Cambridge, MA, 1980.
The Return of the Reader.
Freund, E.
Bloomington, IN, 1978.
London, 1967.
The Reader in the Text.
Reader-Response Criticism.
Institution and Interpretation.
Princeton, NJ, 1980.
Baltimore, MD, 1980.
Minneapolis, MN, 1987.
7. The Yale Critics? J. Hillis Miller (1928±), Geoffrey Hartman (1929±), Harold Bloom (1930±), Paul de Man (1919±1983)
In 1975, the Algerian-French philosopher Jacques Derrida performed the first of his soon to become famous annual seminars at Yale University. Although Derrida's specialist background was in the critical tradition of Husserl's phenomenology and Heidegger's dismantling of metaphysics, the primary institutional niche he found himself in at Yale was the space of literary studies. Among his prominent colleagues in that location were Harold Bloom and Geoffrey H. Hartman, who both began their academic careers at Yale in 1955, and
Paul
de
respectively)
Man
and
moved
to
landmark conference on
J.
Hillis
Yale
Miller,
from
Johns
who
had
Hopkins
both
recently
University,
the
(in
1970
venue
The Languages of Criticism and the Sciences of Man
of
and
1972
the
1966
where Derrida
delivered his first lecture in the United States. Derrida's arrival at Yale, then, accompany-
modern north american criticism and theory
40
Ð.
On Deconstruction.
Fish, S.
London, 1983.
Language Processing and the Reading of Literature.
Dillon, G.
Surprised by Sin.
Ð.
Self-Consuming Artefacts.
Ð.
Is There A Text in This Class?
Berkeley, CA, 1972.
Garvin, H. R. (ed.) Holland, N.
London, 1987.
Theories of Reading, Looking, Listening.
The Dynamics of Literary Response.
Ð.
Poems in Persons.
Ð.
5 Readers Reading.
Holub, R. C.
New Haven, CT, 1975.
Reception Theory.
Crossing Borders.
Reader-Response Criticism,
Madison, WI, 1992.
Many, J. and Cox, C. (eds)
Purves, A. C. and Beach, R.
Rosenblatt, L. Ð.
Royle, N.
Literature and the Reader.
Practical Criticism.
Slatoff, W.
Literature as Exploration.
Protocols of Reading. Speech Acts.
New York, 1968.
Oxford, 1991.
New Haven, CT, 1989.
Cambridge, 1969. Ithaca, NY, 1970.
Suleiman, S. R. and Crosman, I. (eds)
Weber, S.
Urbana, IL, 1972.
Carbondale, IL, 1978.
With Respect to Readers.
Tompkins, J. P. (ed.)
Norwood, MA, 1992.
New York, 1935.
Telepathy and Literature.
Searle, J. R.
10, 1977.
[1982]. London, 1988.
The Reader, the Text, the Poem.
Scholes, R.
Genre,
Reader Stance and Literary Understanding .
Orality and Literacy
Richards, I. A.
ed. J. P. Tompkins. Baltimore, MD, 1980.
London, 1984.
Mailloux, S. `Reader-Response Criticism?',
Ong, W. J.
Lewisburg, PA, 1981.
New York, 1968.
New York, 1973.
Ð. `Unity Identity Text Self', in
Ð.
Cambridge, MA, 1980.
The Return of the Reader.
Freund, E.
Bloomington, IN, 1978.
London, 1967.
The Reader in the Text.
Reader-Response Criticism.
Institution and Interpretation.
Princeton, NJ, 1980.
Baltimore, MD, 1980.
Minneapolis, MN, 1987.
7. The Yale Critics? J. Hillis Miller (1928±), Geoffrey Hartman (1929±), Harold Bloom (1930±), Paul de Man (1919±1983)
In 1975, the Algerian-French philosopher Jacques Derrida performed the first of his soon to become famous annual seminars at Yale University. Although Derrida's specialist background was in the critical tradition of Husserl's phenomenology and Heidegger's dismantling of metaphysics, the primary institutional niche he found himself in at Yale was the space of literary studies. Among his prominent colleagues in that location were Harold Bloom and Geoffrey H. Hartman, who both began their academic careers at Yale in 1955, and
Paul
de
respectively)
Man
and
moved
to
landmark conference on
J.
Hillis
Yale
Miller,
from
Johns
who
had
Hopkins
both
recently
University,
the
(in
1970
venue
The Languages of Criticism and the Sciences of Man
of
and
1972
the
1966
where Derrida
delivered his first lecture in the United States. Derrida's arrival at Yale, then, accompany-
the yale critics?
ing
the
gradual
41
emergence,
or
at
least
the
naming,
of
the
`Yale
Critics',
marked
an
important institutional moment in the establishment of what has come to be known as `deconstruction in America'. A few years later, in 1979, this moment was half-heartedly monumentalized in the joint publication
Deconstruction and Criticism
, a volume of four
essays by Bloom, de Man, Hartman and Miller arranged (even if only by the random order of the alphabet) around an expanded version of one of Derrida's Yale seminars. It was to be the only collective publication of the `Yale School' ± and even that may already be saying too much. Two obvious but crucial points to be registered in this loose critical constellation are the apparent intent to welcome the `continental' challenge posed to the Anglo-American humanities,
and
the
determined
emphasis
on
the
specific
claims
of
literature
in
this
encounter. Throughout the 1970s, the most visible face of the `continental' challenge ± though by no means the only one ± was arguably that of Derridean deconstruction, and for better or worse the American reception and modulation of deconstruction initially took shape primarily in the context of literary scholarship. That this shape should have emerged at all is itself far from self-evident, and it could be argued that its very unlikelihood was an important factor in the impact of its appearance. The constitutive instability of the `Yale School' simultaneously allowed its members to become members at all (however briefly) and
contributed
to
the
Yale
Critics'
almost
implausibly
powerful
influence
on
the
development of literary studies well into the 1980s. Paul de Man's immediate response to the 1966 Johns Hopkins symposium mentioned above
offers
a
suggestive
illustration
of
the
relative
unlikelihood
of
the
Yale
Critics'
subsequent alliance with Derrida. Addressing what he calls `the structuralist aberration' as a `methodologically motivated attack on the notion that a literary or poetic consciousness is in any way a privileged consciousness' (1967, 56), de Man argues that this attack misfires because it mistakenly conceives of the disputed privilege of literary consciousness as a naive belief in the unity of sign and meaning erroneously associated with romanticism. To the contrary, de Man asserts, articulating a position arrived at in the course of reading primarily canonical European romantic and post-romantic authors and their critics since the early 1950s, literary consciousness
is
privileged precisely to the extent that it is `demystified from
the start' (1967, 55): it has always already abandoned this naive myth by presenting itself in the form of radical fiction, as `pure nothingness,
our
nothingness stated and restated by a
subject that is the agent of its own instability' (1967, 56). For this reason, the literary `self as a constitutive subject' (1967, 47), which structuralism seeks to dismiss, successfully survives  vi-Strauss and, surprisingly, `Deridda' ( the attack of the likes of Le
sic
).
The surprise here is not just that de Man misspells Derrida's name, but that he should conceive of him as a structuralist. For Derrida's lecture at the Johns Hopkins symposium de Man
alludes
to
here
is
pre-eminently
a
powerful,
be
it
sympathetic,
critique
of
the
structuralist project itself. Still, to the extent that Derrida's text does question the `myth' of `a subject which would be the absolute origin of its own discourse' (1967, 418), de Man's early misplacement of deconstruction as just another structuralism is perhaps less important than
his
fundamental
reservations
concerning
what
he
took
Derrida's
thought
to
be,
though it is important to underscore de Man's insistence on the critical merits of `the structuralist aberration' for a `philosophical criticism . . . that takes the critical process itself as its field of inquiry' (1967, 56). For in structuralism at least, and for de Man at the time this includes Derrida's work, `the problem of the subject', which involves `the central intent of literature', is mishandled `on such a vast scale that genuine criticism ensues', while in
modern north american criticism and theory
42
`the formalist and narrowly historical methods of literary study' still prevalent at the time, this problem is merely `bypassed . . . in a petty way' (1967, 56). When de Man revised his
Blindness and Insight (1971), which also features a
text for inclusion in his first book,
sustained response to Derrida's work as `one of the places where the future possibility of literary criticism is being decided' (1983, 111), the somewhat anomalous reference to Derrida was erased, but the defence of the literary self as a constitutive subject against all manner
of
mistaken
demystification
survived,
as
did
the
insistence
on
the
status
of
literature as `a primary source of knowledge' (1983, 19). Given the subsequent alliance between de Man and Derrida, it is not entirely surprising that readers of this revised text looking
for
deconstructive
demystification
of
literary
dogma
often
consciousness
blatantly
as
an
misread
outline
of
his
de
Man's
own
sketch
critical
of
the
project
(see
Berman 1988, 241 and further instances listed in de Graef 1995, 235). The mistake signals precisely the potential incommensurability between a privileging of literature and what `true' deconstruction is supposed to be all about, and it is this incongruity which can be read as the signature fissure in the Yale Critical edifice. A cursory investigation of the other Yale Critics' publications prior to their establishment as a `school' reveals a bedrock agreement on the status of literature ± and specifically what is received as `canonical', predominantly romantic and post-romantic literature ± as somehow
a
privileged
mode
of
discourse.
More
particularly,
this
privilege
involves
a
recognition of literature as the maximally lucid articulation of what is variously called consciousness,
the
self,
or
the
subject.
In
this
respect,
the
Yale
Critics'
early
work
participates in a broad resistance to the relative dismissal of consciousness, self or subject that had become codified in the critique of the so-called `intentional fallacy' at the heart of New
Critical
orthodoxy,
while
the
historical
focus
in
their
readings
amounts
to
a
reconsideration of the contemporary as more significantly marked by romanticism than the ideologues of modernism had been willing to admit. In its actual detail, this double emphasis takes on markedly different forms in their writing, yet the general pattern amply succeeds in creating at least the impression of a family resemblance. Thus, Harold Bloom's first major works are powerfully idiosyncratic readings of great or, to
use
Bloom's
romantic
own
tradition.
favourite
With
their
formidable figures, works like
term,
`strong'
unashamed
poets
in
emphasis
the on
English
the
romantic
creative
and
struggle
of
postthese
Shelley's Mythmaking (1959), The Visionary Company (1961),
Blake's Apocalypse (1963), Yeats (1970) and The Ringers in the Tower (1971) are so many stages in the antagonistic recovery of a company of extreme and powerful dissident selves from the neglect or even contempt they had suffered at the hands of, especially, the New Critics. Bloom's strong romantic poets are committed to the Stevensian notion that `the theory of poetry is the theory of life', and just as `they would not yield the first to historical convention, so they could not surrender the second to religion or philosophy or the tired resignations of society' (1971a, 3). Their `immense hope' was that `poetry, by expressing the whole man, could either liberate him from his fallen condition or, more compellingly, make him see that condition as unnecessary, as an unimaginative fiction that an awakened spirit could slough off' (1971a, xxiv). And while Bloom acutely registers the failure of this romantic ambition, he continues to call on the strong selves of true poetry `to help us in an increasingly bad time' by making `the dark grow luminous, the void fruitful' (1971b, 11). It is not surprising, therefore, that in the second half of the 1960s, when the New Critical orthodoxy was increasingly becoming a thing of the past, Bloom should have felt the need to measure his distance from the new anti-romantic challenges of the self associated with
the yale critics?
43
structuralism much in the same way as did de Man (as witness Bloom's epilogue to the 1971 revised edition of his plain
dreariness
demonstrate (1973,
of
that
12±13).
The Visionary Company all
those
they
can
While
it
is
, 1971a, 463±4) and from `the anti-humanistic
developments
aid
in
reading
not
quite
in
European
any
clear
one
who
criticism
poem
exactly
by
any
stands
that
have
poet
accused
yet
to
whatsoever'
in
this
latter
blanket judgement (one of Bloom's idiosyncrasies being his cavalier contempt for footnotes and bibliographical references), its implicit indictment of anti-humanism does not seem to augur well for a future alliance with a thinker like Derrida who, in the same seminal essay referred to above, outlined the prospect of a step `beyond man and humanism' (1967, 427). It is characteristic of Geoffrey Hartman, whose reluctant articulacy is at least as arresting as Bloom's rhetoric of strength, that he should frame his recognition of the privileged status of literature as an insight brought home to the `unwilling' company of literary scholars, himself included, who are now, at the time of writing just
`advanced
beyond
Â' Èvete naõ
intellectual
and
The Unmediated Vision
find
themselves
(1954), only
`forced
to
consider
literature as more than an organic creation, a social pastime, a religious trope, an emotional outlet, a flower of civilization, more even than an exemplary stage for ideal probabilities' (1954, x). More than all of this, literature stands revealed as `a moral force in its own right, an institution with its own laws, and, incipiently, a distinctive form of knowledge' (1954, x). In the `hard labor' of pursuing this recognition of `literature as a distinctive mode of knowledge in which the processes, or, better, the desires of the human mind find their clearest expression' (1954, xi), Hartman envisages the possibility of a universal `method of interpretation which could reaffirm the radical unity of human knowledge' (1954, x) ± a method, in short, which would transcend the parochial status of the mere `approach' ± , though
his
engagement
actual with
readings the
here
workings
and
of
elsewhere,
the
especially
`consciousness
of
his
long
and
consciousness'
complicated
in
the
poetry
of Wordsworth (1971, xii), remain marked by the hesitations and qualifications of the arch( - )interpreter ultimately unwilling to abandon literature to the unity he nonetheless invokes,
and
of
the
literary
scholar
who
constantly
seeks
to
retune
his
reading
by
confronting it with alternative `approaches' current at the time. Like Bloom, Hartman registers his reservations concerning the limitations of structuralism, both in its European and in its Anglo-American forms (notably Northrop Frye's archetypal criticism), but, like de Man, he is more usefully ready to recognize the critical potential of these limitations (see,
for
example,
Hartman
1970,
3±23).
Similarly,
in
his
strategic
play-off
between
`formalism' and `critical intuition', he proposes to rescue formalism from its commodification as `puerile' `explication-centred criticism' under the `dominion of Exegesis' rather than dismiss it altogether (1970, 56±7). Like
his
later
Yale
colleagues,
J.
Hillis
Miller
also
begins
his
critical
career
with
predominantly monographical arguments intent on disclosing the characteristic workings of individual literary minds. He differs from them, however, in devoting more attention to narrative fiction and to Victorian authors, pursuing the `spiritual history' (1965, vii) of a development beyond romanticism through nihilism. His theoretical alliances at that time are
primarily
Starobinski intimate the
with
being
the the
identification
Preface
to
his
Geneva
pivotal with
1963
School,
figures)
their
study
whose
practice
literary
a
object.
members
(Georges
criticism
of
Poulet
and
consciousness
As Miller programmatically
The Disappearance of God
,
`If
literature
is
Jean
based
a
on
states
in
form
of
consciousness the task of the critic is to identify himself with the subjectivity expressed in the words, to relive that life from the inside, and to constitute it anew in his criticism'
modern north american criticism and theory
44
(1965, ix). At a 1965 Yale symposium on literary criticism where de Man and Hartman also delivered papers, Miller found himself called upon to confront this critical principle, which presupposes a maximum access to the presence of consciousness at the heart of literature, with recent alternatives in European criticism challenging this metaphysics of presence (Miller 1966), and by 1970 a clear choice between Poulet and Derrida's interrogation of `consciousness as the will to language within its presence to itself' seemed inevitable: `A critic must choose either the tradition of ``presence'' or the tradition of ``difference'', for their assumptions about language, about literature, about history, and about the mind cannot be made compatible' (Miller 1970, 223). Except, it seems, in a recognition of the `failure' of Poulet's criticism (and, by implication, Miller's own earlier work) as itself a partly unwitting exercise in what Derrida calls the `rigorous reading of metaphysics' (223). The failure of criticism would then be its rigorous recovery of the `experience of failure' as `the central movement of literature' itself (224): its naming and renaming of `the failure of the mind ever to coincide with its point of origin' (225). The often desperate privilege accorded to literature in the first stages of these four critical careers
never
considerable
disappears
from
modifications
in
the the
work late
of
the
1960s
Yale
and
Critics,
early
though
1970s,
a
it
period
does in
undergo
which
the
future Yale Critics also begin to emerge as an alliance. This emergence can partly be derived from the fact that they publish alongside each other in new journals like Johns Hopkins's review of contemporary criticism
diacritics
, which features de Man and Miller in
its advisory board, but the more decisive formative factors are arguably Miller's repeated attempts throughout the 1970s to articulate the incipient connections between his own work and that of Derrida and de Man in the context of contemporary American criticism. The connections to Bloom and Hartman are less forcefully established, but their work too develops new emphases approaching those highlighted by Miller and de Man. De Man's retrospective recognition of a movement away from `the thematic vocabulary of consciousness and of temporality' towards a `rhetorical terminology' in his seminal 1969 essay
`The
Rhetoric
of
Temporality'
(1983,
xii)
offers
a
convenient
(and
therefore
admittedly also somewhat insensitive) frame for these emphases. Notwithstanding their lasting differences, Bloom, de Man, Hartman and Miller all articulate more explicitly the problematic linguistic constitution of the literature they continue to uphold as a distinctive discursive
mode.
One
way
to
investigate
that
linguistic
constitution
is
by
recognizing
literature as text, forbiddingly codified by de Man, in a 1975 essay on Nietzsche later republished in his most sustained collection
Allegories of Reading
, as an undecidable construct
that `allows for two incompatible, mutually self-destructive points of view, and therefore puts an insurmountable obstacle in the way of any reading or understanding' (1979, 131). From this perspective, the privilege of literature is bracketed by dint of its unreadability, yet, importantly, the privilege survives, with literature now `condemned (or privileged) to be forever the most rigorous and, consequently, the most unreliable language in terms of which man
names
and
transforms
himself'
(1979,
19).
This
notion
of
a
critically
unreliable
linguistic naming and transforming effectively brings about a crisis in the earlier emphasis on literary consciousness and (its) history, while at the same time preserving that emphasis in an alternative hermeneutics open to the challenge of Derridean deconstruction, itself fuelled by the recovery of differential unreliability within logocentrism. The practice of reading then becomes the critical tracing of the experience of the undecidable which both informs and unforms
interpretation,
and
the
pursuit
of
language's
`rhetorical,
figural
(`literature itself') (de Man 1979, 10) is one strategy to perform this tracing.
potentiality'
the yale critics?
45
If that, as they say, is the theory,
Deconstruction and Criticism
is a record of the resistance
of the practice of reading to the theoretical programme with which it is associated. In his preface to the volume, Hartman seeks to identify the alliance between `the critics amicably if not quite convincingly held together by the covers of this book' (Bloom et al. 1979, ix) in terms of `a shared set of problems': the question as to `what kind of maturer function' criticism `may claim . . . beyond the obviously academic or pedagogical', and the question as to `the importance ± or
force
± of literature' (Bloom et al. 1979, vii). Both questions are
clearly related: if the force of literature involves `the priority of language to meaning', the `excess' of `figurative language' over `any assigned meaning' (Bloom et al. 1979, vii), then the function of the criticism reading this literature will depend on its response to this excess. For Hartman, this appears to generate a distinction between Derrida, de Man and Miller on the one hand, and Bloom and Hartman himself on the other: the former are gently caricatured as `boa-deconstructors' mercilessly revelling in the repeated disclosure of the `pathos' of literary language as only ever a thin membrane covering `the ``abysm'' of words'; while the latter ± `barely deconstructionists' ± retain a special commitment to the `persistence' and the `psychological provenance' of this pathos (Bloom et al. 1979, ix). In Bloom's contribution, this pathos is celebrated as `the will to utter permanent truths of desire, and to utter these
within
a tradition of utterance' as manifested by `strong poems'
which refuse to be treated `merely as a formal and linguistic structure', as is the case, according to Bloom, in all rhetorical criticism `even of the advanced deconstructive kind' (Bloom et al. 1979, 20). The function of criticism is to oppose `the abysses of Deconstruction's ironies' by championing the strong poetry `that will not abandon the self to language' (Bloom et al. 1979, 37). Bloom acknowledges an affinity between his conception of texts as the `interplay of differences' and that of his `legitimate rival[s]' Derrida and de Man (Bloom et al. 1979, 13±14), but insists on the foundation of that interplay in the `narcissistic self-regard' (16) of the aggressive and historically situated self articulated in the achieved anxiety of literature which the alert reader must engage in combat. Where Bloom measures
his
appreciative
distance of
the
from
deconstruction
`significant
difference
as
a
veritable
between
lord
of
language
Anglo-American
poetic
properly tradition,
and the much weaker French and German poetic tradition' (Bloom et al. 1979, 13) ± a difference he reads as somehow explaining deconstruction's damaging blindness to the strong
historical
self
of
literature
±
Hartman
maintains
his
reserved
pose
and
`simply'
proposes an extremely complex reading of a Wordsworth poem as if nothing much had happened.
Yet
his
subtle
unfoldings
of
the
latent
undecidability
in
that
genuinely
Wordsworthian word `fit' (Bloom et al. 1979, 209) suggest the workings of his acknowledged awareness of deconstruction's untimely utterances. In Miller's contribution, `The Critic as Host', that awareness is voiced with an almost apostolic assertiveness matching Bloom's agonistic pathos. An earlier version of the piece had appeared in 1977
as
one
of
Miller's
fairly
regular
attempts
deconstructive company in America, and in
to
explicitly
claim
Deconstruction and Criticism
Critical Inquiry ground
for
in
the
Miller's expanded
essay is easily the most programmatic contribution, identifying the `extreme interpretation' of `deconstruction' as interpretation itself finally come into its own ± `interpretation as such' ± and culminating in the triumphant `ultimate justification for this mode of criticism' which is `that it works' (Bloom et al. 1979, 231±2, 252). As Miller also concedes, this is the ultimate
justification
for
any
conceivable
instructive to juxtapose his readings in
of Reality
mode
of
criticism,
and
in
this
respect
The Disappearance of God The Linguistic Moment
with the readings collected in his 1985 volume
and its 1965 sequel
it
is
Poets
: early and
modern north american criticism and theory
46
late,
Miller's
reading
genuinely
works,
even
to
the
point
that
it
survives
the
nagging
suspicion that this lasting success must involve a measure of theoretical failure. Miller's slightly shrill and self-consciously serpentine but strategically enabling corporate rhetoric in
Deconstruction and Criticism
stands in sharp contrast to de Man's saturnine reading of
The Triumph of Life
Shelley's unfinished long poem
: de Man's is the only piece in the
collection that does not explicitly address the shape of deconstruction at all, focusing instead on the `Shape all light' in Shelley's text whose radical unreadability simultaneously feeds and starves the hermeneutico-archaeological desire to establish meaningful relationships allowing us `to inhabit the world' (Bloom et al. 1979, 40). As Hartman points out in the preface, an `earlier scheme' for the collection had been `to acknowledge the importance of Romantic poetry directly, by focusing all contributions on [Shelley]', but as it happens only de Man has rigorously observed that scheme. Bloom ± the only one of the Yale Critics who frequently engages with contemporary literature ± devotes a large part of his piece to John Ashberry; Hartman pursues his admirably interminable interpretation of Wordsworth; Derrida memorably avoids Shelley, primarily by reading him into Blanchot; Miller, as he had promised in the original version of his piece, programmatically uses the `example' of Shelley's
Triumph of Life
to demonstrate the merits of
deconstruction in revealing `hitherto unidentified meanings and ways of having meaning in major literary texts' (Bloom et al. 1979, 252); de Man stubbornly and single-mindedly
reads
Shelley's
`historically frustratingly, the
rigor
`disfiguration'
more is
reliable
not
exhibited
to by
be
as
a
than
resistance
the
products
reproduced
Shelley
into
which
is
`a
to
`historicism'
of
historical
method
exemplary
of
which,
paradoxically,
archaeology',
reading',
precisely
lest
because
we it
but
`regress refuses
is
which, from to
be
generalized into a system' (Bloom et al. 1979, 69). In a somewhat trivial sense, the `Yale Critics' as a collective may be said to have observed this refusal of systematic methodization inscribed in their non-manifesto, for the Yale School
largely
remained
a
phantom
formation,
randomly
held
together
only
by
its
members' sheer commitment to the task of reading literature as a singularly other mode of discourse. Nonetheless, this commitment proved to be remarkably productive as a point of reference in the institutional developments of literary scholarship, primarily perhaps in the sense that Yale's phantom formation became a privileged target for widely divergent critical objections. Three large groups may be distinguished in this resistance. Proponents of a more traditional conception of the literary humanities grudgingly acknowledged the Yale Critics' commitment to canonical literature but deplored the putative nihilism of this commitment, as well as what
was perceived as a perverse blurring of the hierarchical
distinction between literature and `mere' criticism attendant on the self-reflexive scrutiny of the act of reading itself. Politically contestatory representatives of what can loosely be called the left opposed precisely the commitment to the (dead, white, male) canon itself and castigated the Yale School as an essentially conservative or even reactionary body diverting critical challenges to the status quo. In the course of the late 1970s and 1980s, this critique of the Yale School was a rallying issue in the development of feminist and more and
generally
new
gender-centred
historicist
research,
reading,
all
of
postcolonial
which
studies,
established
(post-)marxist
various
footholds
in
scholarship the
newly
emerging disciplinary formation of cultural studies. At the same time, however, numerous participants in these alternative critical formations have found considerable support in the Yale Critics' writings and in work produced by scholars associated with or influenced by them such as Gayatri Spivak, Shoshana Felman, Fredric Jameson and Barbara Johnson ±
the yale critics?
47
traces of this Yale dissemination are acknowledged in the work of, for instance, Stephen Greenblatt, Judith Butler and Homi Bhabha. A third and sometimes related strand of opposition to the Yale School specifically targeted its alleged abuse of Derridean deconstruction: here, the very preoccupation with literature as such was diagnosed as generating a disabling deflection of the radically political institutional charge of Derrida's thought (Ryan 1982) or as screening an intellectual incompetence or unwillingness to properly  1979; but see also Attridge appreciate deconstruction's philosophical credentials (Gasche 1992 for an excellent reflection on the `haunting' of literature in Derrida's own work). The death of de Man in 1983, followed by Miller's move to the University of California at Irvine in 1986, brought the decade or so of Yale Criticism to an appropriately arbitrary end. The heated debate occasioned by the 1987 publicization of de Man's contributions to the German-controlled press during the early years of the occupation of his native Belgium consolidated rather than decisively altered existing critical attitudes, both dismissive and appreciative, towards his later work, though it did lead to a more focused concern for the ethical charges of that work (which had already been foregrounded in Miller's 1986 book
The Ethics of Reading
) and for the historico-ideological thrust of de Manian deconstruction,
which he had been articulating more closely in his final years. The essays now published as
Aesthetic Ideology The Resistance to Theory (1996)
by
his
disciple
collected in
Andrzej
(1992) and
Warminski,
together
with
The Rhetoric of Romanticism
the
essays
(1994) remain
impressive testimony to his stubborn but erratic recognition of the literary imperative: literature's demand to be read as a language irreducible to yet of crucial import for the discourses of politics, ethics and philosophy. The critical careers of Bloom, Miller and Hartman have also observed this imperative in their widely different ways. Bloom's 1994 best-selling the
The Western Canon
Greatness
of
Strength
in
monumentalizes its author as a strong prophet proclaiming the
wilderness
wrought
by
`the
Balkanization
of
literary
studies' (483) at the hands of the members of the `School of Resentment', including the `Deconstructionists' (492). Bloom remains a formidable figure in contemporary literary scholarship,
partly
as
a
result
of
his
massive
self-performances
in
the
rhetoric
of
the
formidable, but also on account of the sheer volume of his output, including his valuable work as editor for Chelsea House's under-achieved
anxiety
Modern Critical Interpretations
of his writing threatens
to forfeit
series. Yet the increasingly
the patient reading
he does
deserve. Doubtlessly, such a reading would have to involve the influence of the figure of patient reading himself, Geoffrey Hartman, whose own reading has gradually become more explicitly preoccupied with the question of culture in the aftermath of the Holocaust (he is a founder and, since 1981, the project director of Yale's Video Archive for Holocaust Testimonies) and in the contemporary context of increasingly aggressive politics of cultural identity, leading him to call for a restoration of `literature's specificity as a focus for thinking about culture and as a force that challenges a monolithic or complacent culturalism' (1997, 2). An important aspect of that restoration is his at times exorbitant defence of literature as a medium for the representation of trauma, as witness for instance his suggestion that Wordsworth's specific poetic modulation of the traumatic transition from a rural to an industrial society around the turn of the eighteenth century `saved English politics from the virulence of a nostalgic political ideal centring on rural virtues, which led to serious ravages on the continent' (1997, 7) ± a proposal that seems ultimately more productively erratic than Bloom's eccentric tome-thumping thunders. Like Bloom, Hartman has continued to measure his distance from deconstruction, though he remains characteristically unsure about the extent and nature of that distance. Miller, on the other hand, and unsurprisingly,
modern north american criticism and theory
48
has lived up to his profile as deconstruction's closest advocate, defending its legacy both in his
literary-critical
writing
institutional
policy.
In
book-length
combination
and
`The of
in
his
Excess
of
numerous
contributions
Reading',
institutional
the
reflection
coda
and
to
of
debates
concerning
Black Holes, his 1999
literary
criticism
which
joins
covers with Manuel Asensi's monographic study of Miller's entire work, that defence is still the defence of literature as a discourse rather than anything else, except the reading of literature is `exemplary' of the encounter with otherness as such: reading `is exemplary of the aporias of the ethico-political situation in which we all live' (Asensi and Miller 1999, 491).
The
mechanical
memorializing their
extension
exemplary
of
this
trope
commitment
into
to the
an
epitaph
for
the
privileged exemplarity
Yale
Critics
of literature
remains to be read.
Ortwin de Graef
Further reading and works cited Arac, J. et al. (eds) Ð.
The Yale Critics. Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
Critical Genealogies. New York, 1987.
Asensi, M. and Miller, J. Hillis.
J. Hillis Miller or, Boustrophedonic Reading/Black Holes . Stanford, CA,
1999. Attridge, D. `Introduction: Derrida and the Question of Literature', in J. Derrida,
Acts of Literature, ed.
D. Attridge. New York, 1992. Berman, A. Ð et al.
From the New Criticism to Deconstruction . Urbana, IL, 1988.
Deconstruction and Criticism. New York, 1979.
Ð Bloom, H.
The Visionary Company. Ithaca, NY, 1971a.
Ð.
The Ringers in the Tower. Chicago, 1971b.
Ð.
The Anxiety of Influence. New York, 1973.
Caruth, C. and Esch, D. (eds)
Critical Encounters. New Brunswick, NJ, 1995.
Davis, R. C. and Schleifer, R.
Rhetoric and Form. Norman, OK, 1985.
de Bolla, P.
Harold Bloom. London, 1988.
de Graef, O.
Titanic Light. Lincoln, NE, 1995.
de Man, P. `The Crisis of Contemporary Criticism',
Arion, 6, 11, 1967.
Ð.
Allegories of Reading. New Haven, CT, 1979.
Ð.
Blindness and Insight. Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
Ð.
The Resistance to Theory. Minneapolis, MN, 1992.
Ð.
The Rhetoric of Romanticism. New York, 1994.
Ð.
Aesthetic Ideology, ed. and intro. A. Warminski. Minneapolis, MN, 1996.
Derrida, J.
 criture et la difference. Paris, 1967. L'e
Elam, H. R. (ed.) Felperin, H.
Essays in Honour of Geoffrey H. Hartman. Studies in Romanticism , 35, 4, 1996.
Beyond Deconstruction. Oxford, 1985.
 , R. `Deconstruction as Criticism', Gasche Hartman, G. H. Ð.
Glyph, 6, 1979.
The Unmediated Vision. New Haven, CT, 1954.
Beyond Formalism. New Haven, CT, 1970.
Ð.
Wordsworth's Poetry 1787±1814. New Haven, CT, 1971.
Ð.
The Fateful Question of Culture. New York, 1997.
Miller, J. Hillis.
The Disappearance of God. New York, 1965.
Ð. `The Antitheses of Criticism',
MLN, 81, 5, 1966.
Ð. `Geneva or Paris? The Recent Work of Georges Poulet', 1970.
University of Toronto Quarterly, 39, 3,
deconstruction in america Ð.
49
The Ethics of Reading Marxism and Deconstruction Reading de Man Reading . New York, 1986.
Ryan, M.
. Baltimore, MD, 1982.
Waters, L. and Godzich, W. (eds)
. Minneapolis, MN, 1989.
8. Deconstruction in America
In 1987 Ortwin de Graef announced the discovery of scores of articles written by the young Paul de Man for collaborationist journals in occupied Belgium between 1940 and 1942. This discovery considerably complicated the fortunes of deconstruction in the United States, but also had the virtue of clarifying an intellectual atmosphere that had become somewhat hazy in the previous years, certainly since the death of de Man in 1983. De Man was the principle expositor of deconstruction in the United States, and if Derrida was better known throughout the country, de Man's local presence (at Yale and therefore at schools whose faculty included a substantial number of Yale-trained teachers) guaranteed that his thought and methods would be highly influential to the thinking of a small but elite class of theoretical expositors. De Man was responsible for bringing Derrida to Yale as a
yearly visitor, and
in large
part
contributed
to
the
American
reception
of
Derrida's
thinking, and in particular to the widespread interest in deconstruction in a literary rather than a philosophical context. Not
that
this
interest
was
anti-philosophical.
Rather
deconstruction
in
the
United
States is a strange and interesting hybrid, a kind of imaginary enterprise that made possible an
intellectual
adventure
which
could
never
take
place
elsewhere.
Deconstruction
as
practised at Yale by de Man and Derrida introduced a philosophical vocabulary to students of literature ± especially a vocabulary derived from continental philosophy ± that tended to be foreign to the study of literature in the United States. W. K. Wimsatt, it is true, wrote powerfully and penetratingly about Hegel, and Wimsatt's and Monroe Beardsley's seminal article on `The Intentional Fallacy' set the philosophical tone for one version of the New Criticism, but the European philosophy important to most American students of literature tended in the 1960s to be restricted to somewhat potted versions of Sartre, himself taken to task by Heidegger (one of the centrally proclaimed forerunners of deconstruction) in his polemical `Letter on Humanism' against Sartre's `Existentialism is a Humanism'. Deconstruction has tended to be much more interested in Heidegger than in Sartre, but this interest has been largely critical. Heidegger (following Nietzsche, and in a way analogous to Freud who also followed Nietzsche) is regarded as having set the right agenda, as having asked the right questions and probed them deeply but as having become waylaid by an ontology that intensifies and symptomatizes the `metaphysics of presence' it attempts to dismantle.
Heidegger's
highly
idealizing
or
metaphysical
view
of
language
becomes
changed in deconstruction by an emphasis on Saussurean linguistics, and that emphasis, combined with the French critiques of Heidegger by Emmanuel Levinas and by Maurice Blanchot are the major ancestors of deconstruction proper. Deconstruction increased
came
attention
to
there
the
to
United
States
continental,
in
mainly
the
mid-1960s
French,
at
interest
the
in
beginning
the
relation
of of
deconstruction in america Ð.
49
The Ethics of Reading Marxism and Deconstruction Reading de Man Reading . New York, 1986.
Ryan, M.
. Baltimore, MD, 1982.
Waters, L. and Godzich, W. (eds)
. Minneapolis, MN, 1989.
8. Deconstruction in America
In 1987 Ortwin de Graef announced the discovery of scores of articles written by the young Paul de Man for collaborationist journals in occupied Belgium between 1940 and 1942. This discovery considerably complicated the fortunes of deconstruction in the United States, but also had the virtue of clarifying an intellectual atmosphere that had become somewhat hazy in the previous years, certainly since the death of de Man in 1983. De Man was the principle expositor of deconstruction in the United States, and if Derrida was better known throughout the country, de Man's local presence (at Yale and therefore at schools whose faculty included a substantial number of Yale-trained teachers) guaranteed that his thought and methods would be highly influential to the thinking of a small but elite class of theoretical expositors. De Man was responsible for bringing Derrida to Yale as a
yearly visitor, and
in large
part
contributed
to
the
American
reception
of
Derrida's
thinking, and in particular to the widespread interest in deconstruction in a literary rather than a philosophical context. Not
that
this
interest
was
anti-philosophical.
Rather
deconstruction
in
the
United
States is a strange and interesting hybrid, a kind of imaginary enterprise that made possible an
intellectual
adventure
which
could
never
take
place
elsewhere.
Deconstruction
as
practised at Yale by de Man and Derrida introduced a philosophical vocabulary to students of literature ± especially a vocabulary derived from continental philosophy ± that tended to be foreign to the study of literature in the United States. W. K. Wimsatt, it is true, wrote powerfully and penetratingly about Hegel, and Wimsatt's and Monroe Beardsley's seminal article on `The Intentional Fallacy' set the philosophical tone for one version of the New Criticism, but the European philosophy important to most American students of literature tended in the 1960s to be restricted to somewhat potted versions of Sartre, himself taken to task by Heidegger (one of the centrally proclaimed forerunners of deconstruction) in his polemical `Letter on Humanism' against Sartre's `Existentialism is a Humanism'. Deconstruction has tended to be much more interested in Heidegger than in Sartre, but this interest has been largely critical. Heidegger (following Nietzsche, and in a way analogous to Freud who also followed Nietzsche) is regarded as having set the right agenda, as having asked the right questions and probed them deeply but as having become waylaid by an ontology that intensifies and symptomatizes the `metaphysics of presence' it attempts to dismantle.
Heidegger's
highly
idealizing
or
metaphysical
view
of
language
becomes
changed in deconstruction by an emphasis on Saussurean linguistics, and that emphasis, combined with the French critiques of Heidegger by Emmanuel Levinas and by Maurice Blanchot are the major ancestors of deconstruction proper. Deconstruction increased
came
attention
to
there
the
to
United
States
continental,
in
mainly
the
mid-1960s
French,
at
interest
the
in
beginning
the
relation
of of
modern north american criticism and theory
50
language to psychological and cultural life. That attention has its sources in American interest in Sartre and also Merleau-Ponty (Lacan's teacher), and in New Wave French film-making
as
well,
in
particular
in
Jean-Luc
Godard,
himself
much
influenced
by
contemporary French philosophy: Brice Parain, important to Gilles Deleuze, appears in one of Godard's movies, as himself; it also has sources in New Critical interest in linguistic theory, in particular in Roman Jakobson and the figures who line up with him: in France Ferdinand de Saussure and Emile Benveniste. Saussure's linguistic theory and its expansion and
inversion
by
 vi-Strauss's Le
structuralist
project,
and
Jacques
Lacan's
Saussurean
reconceptualization of Freudian psychoanalysis, made for an incipient intellectual climate in
the
United
States
that
was
friendly
to
structuralism
and
poststructuralism,
and
deconstruction was received as a similarly vigorous and daring exposition of non-humanistic structures of human thought, agency and subjectivity. Derrida's version of deconstruction was itself profoundly influenced by psychoanalytic ways of thinking, in particular by the idea that repression is constitutive of mental phenomena and mental life, which is to say is constitutive of signifying phenomena and signifying life. The things that the mind thought about, and in particular the things that it regarded as central ± subjectivity, being, presence, spirit ± were all differentially erected through the repression of the fact and structure of their internal tensions; and this differential constitution was analogous to Saussure's account of the elements of language ± difference without positive terms. De Man was far less interested in psychoanalytic modes of thinking. For him literature provided the unnerving alterity that Derrida and Lacan ascribed to language and to the instabilities of language. De Man here was following in the footsteps of Blanchot, the great French philosopher, critic and novelist (a strong influence on Derrida as well, somewhat less strong on Lacan), who wrote of literary space as the space other to all worlds, strange and proximate but in a proximity without presence: for Blanchot this characterizes love as well, and his fictional work treats love much as his critical work treats literature: as the place of an otherness that haunts all settled nativity in the world. (Geoffrey Hartman had helped introduce Blanchot to an American readership in 1961.) De Man does not write about love, but he does write about the severe power of literature to unsettle system and certitude, and to expose its readers to an experience of power and alienation different from the ordinary business of the world, and not a commentary upon it. De Man won a fit and fairly large audience through a combination of sheer intellectual power and great personal charisma. In many ways he might be compared to Leo Strauss (although their political views were largely anathema to each other): an extraordinarily charismatic
teacher
whose
pedagogy
took
the
form
of
discerning
hidden
meanings
in
literary and philosophical texts, meanings that were hidden because of the radical danger they presented to dominant ideology. De Man's first book was
Blindness and Insight
(1971),
and in that book he offers lucid and powerful critiques not of literary but of critical texts, texts that in various ways are blind to the fact that their own best insights were anticipated and forestalled by the works in relation to which they offer them. De Man is often accused, with his Yale colleagues, of asserting the equality of criticism and the literature that it takes as its object, but where Hartman actually does come close to saying these sorts of things, and Harold Bloom does assert a continuity and partial identity between strong reading or misreading and strong writing, de Man in fact asserts very nearly the opposite doctrine. His canon,
though
Wordsworth,
small,
Keats,
is
very
close
 Mallarme
overwhelming as to force
all
to
sacred:
challenge
Shelley,
their
Pascal,
readers
them into evasive strategies
Rousseau,
with
a
Kleist,
cognitive
of aestheticization
Kant,
power
(as de
so
Man,
deconstruction in america
51
following Walter Benjamin, calls it). De Man might seem close to Hartman and Bloom in his sense of the difficulty and rarity of adequate `reading': the term already sacralized by Bloom becomes in de Man almost apotheosized as the province of an extremely select elite who could confront what was actually going on in a work. And de Man's extreme elitism applies as well to literary works, so that it's not hard to find him condescending to a wide range of literature, from Pope to Schiller, that doesn't meet his cognitive demands. This is the reason he has been mistaken as a relativist as to literary `standards', whereas in fact he is an
absolutist
so
uncompromising
that
most
canonical
literature
fails
to
meet
those
standards. But those that do are for him beyond praise as they are also beyond argument or subversion. Derridean deconstruction seeks the hidden fault lines and repressions by which a writer or text founds its illusory presence or meaning; de Man is interested not in textual or writerly evasions, but in those practised by readers confronted with literary works. He is concerned not with deconstructing works of literature but with showing how such works deconstruct themselves, or the assumptions readers bring to them, or the wishfulfilment that characterizes all our relationships with others. The similarity between Derrida and de Man is in the very high premium that they put on what they variously call `writing'. But for Derrida writing means a practice of
diffeÂrance,
something that any particular text struggles to repress in order to come into being and to establish itself as meaning and presence. Texts for Derrida tend to be examples of writing despite themselves, despite their wish and will to function as presence. In de Man the archiwriting that Derrida reads his authors as all evading is what
readers evade in confrontation with
the rare but rigorous works which instantiate it. For this reason de Man is profoundly suspicious of and studiously uninterested in psychoanalytic language or methods of reading which seek to discover anxiety within a work. Derrida is an analyst of constitutive repressions, whereas de Man focuses on the things that works say, not the things they evade or flee. Both Derrida and de Man derive many of their ideas from Blanchot, so that it is not surprising to see strong affiliations as well as strong differences. The strongest difference would be in the privilege that de Man accords to literature and literary texts (which also embrace
a
certain
symptomatic,
order
of
philosophical
de Man his own as
apodictic.
work).
Derrida
reads
his
central
texts
as
The results of this difference in the adventures
of literary theory in the United States are complex, often unexpected and not particularly deterministic, but certain general remarks can be made. Many of de Man's students and some of his colleagues sought to combine his emphasis on rhetorical criticism with the psychoanalytic proclivities of Derridean deconstruction. The tension between Derrida and de Man is a fruitful one (and their friendship was a deep one), and attempts to resolve that tension remain fruitful. Cynthia Chase, steeped in de Manian ideas, nevertheless is a profound reader of Freud, and exemplifies one virtue of the respect that de Man taught with regard to major textual events (as he called them): unlike Derrida she is less interested in demystifying Freud than in getting the most hidden and unnerving aspects of his writing right, instead of assimilating them to received wisdom. Many of de Man's students and followers remain deeply committed to a psychoanalytic methodology, variously Freudian, Lacanian or Kleinian (as in recent work by Barbara Johnson). Others have stressed his interest in a conceptualization of disruption embodied and represented with and in the other, and have extended these ideas (under the strong influence
of
Blanchot
and
his
friend
Levinas,
the
French
philosopher
and
Derrida's
teacher) to work on trauma and on the witnessing of trauma, for example Cathy Caruth, Shoshana Felman and Thomas Keenan.
modern north american criticism and theory
52
The general result of the kinds of psychoanalytic thinking that seems most consistent with de Man was an orientation of this thinking away from the text under analysis to its audience, and the more recent ascendancy of the new historicism, with its talk of cultural anxieties
and
aesthetic
hegemony
also
finds
in
de
Manian
deconstruction
an
often
unacknowledged ancestor, unacknowledged because de Man's philosophical and frankly anti-historical bent is something that the new historicism seeks to counter. But its methods are often de Manian as well as Foucauldian, at least in their origin, particularly to the extent that they overemphasize the political influence and efficacy of literary texts and of ways of reading literary texts. Here the influence might be traced through the arrival of some Yale-educated critics at Berkeley, where they encountered Foucault (also an acolyte of Blanchot's) and combined de Manian sensitivities to literature with a Foucauldian idea of culture. In particular Stephen Greenblatt, D. A. Miller and Walter Benn Michaels, were at the centre of this development, and Greenblatt and Michaels had also been involved with and published in the Johns Hopkins journal
diacritics
Glyph
which had been (with Cornell's
) the central American organs of deconstruction. De Man himself had been a
highly influential presence first at Cornell and then at Hopkins before arriving at Yale in 1971, and his influence continued to tell at those institutions. Other figures in whom to trace the movement and cohabitation of a broadly deconstructive orientation to a cultural studies, new historicist, cultural materialist, feminist, queer theoretical or more broadly hegemonic and counter-hegemonic analysis include Alan Liu, in particular his work on Wordsworth, Gayatri Spivak, de Man's student and Derrida's translator, Judith Butler, Eve Kosofsky Sedgwick, Jonathan Goldberg and J. Hillis Miller (de Man's Yale colleague). At Cornell, Neil Hertz ought to be singled out as the most important colleague of de Man's
in
this
context.
Hertz
(who
has
since
gone
to
Hopkins)
has
done
the
most
important readings of Freud and of the literature of the sublime central to de Man's later work, as well as of de Man himself. Hertz reads Freud as de Man might have, as operating with an idea about the uncanniness of literary power that he both approaches and avoids but that when applied to Freud himself becomes particularly vivid and powerful and that brings Freud into promising and powerful juxtaposition to Kant's analysis of the sublime. That
reading
of
Freud
and
of
Kant
is
one
in
which
what
has
seemed
too
central
a
Freudian insight ± the fundamental developmental status of the Oedipus complex ± turns out in Hertz's reading to be an evasion of a more uncanny, less appropriable agency, which might be inadequately designated as `the agency of the letter' (Lacan), `repetition' (Deleuze), `the sheer arbitrary power of language' (de Man), `alterity' (Levinas), `literary space' (Blanchot) or the `impossible' or `transgressive' (Georges Bataille). All of these are partial, all of them evasive ± just because in one way or another melodramatic, for Hertz, but what he is persistently and indefatigable alert to are echoes of this spookiness in literary works, a spookiness partly spooky because it has no designs on us and yet is not to be put by. Even the most telling critiques of de Man, by Hertz (who admires him) and by John Guillory, concede the force and power of his writing. Guillory is more interested in the ways that de Man's students and followers have tended to find a doctrine within a set of brilliant
readings
doctrinalism.
and
Guillory
aperc Ë us, is
and
strongly
he
has
influenced
analysed
the
by
Weber
Max
academic and
by
sociology Pierre
of
this
Bourdieu,
but that influence itself comes out of interests that de Man was the most imposing teacher of. Guillory's central opposition of Bourdieu to de Man plays out as a critique of the kind of canonicity that de Man (like Strauss) turns out to defend, as we shall remark below.
deconstruction in america
53
By an irony that de Man would have relished both his centrality and the evasion of that centrality to American literary theory in the last fifteen years or so has been catalysed by the scandal of his wartime writing. Hertz, Keenan and Werner Hamacher collected that writing in a volume whose companion was a volume of responses to the discovery of that journalism. Those responses range from invective to strong defences of de Man, and as with the notorious Sokal hoax the strongest defences, including Derrida's, had the unfortunate effect of helping to discredit deconstruction in the United States, despite the fact that its ways of thinking continue to be highly influential. (Indeed it also had something of an antithetical effect as well: fair-minded critics like Denis Donoghue who read through de Man's later work in the wake of the scandal were much more impressed by it than they expected to be, and increased attention to that work could only be salutary.) Perhaps the most pronounced effect overall was the not entirely strange reversal which reduced the small but absolute canon that American deconstruction established to no canon at all in the practice of much of the new historicism. There are two reasons for this: deconstructive scepticism about the value and politics of humanistic culture (a scepticism derivable from Nietzsche through Heidegger) finds an echo in new historicist accounts of how
cultural
artefacts
function
in
the
discursive
matrix established
by
power
and
the
organization of knowledge, but without the deconstructive sense that literature escapes reduction to this matrix; and the discovery that de Man himself had feet of clay (and less invidiously that some of his analyses don't withstand the test of time) means that the canonical figure of de Man himself became an example of the reasons that one ought to be sceptical of canon-formation. Nevertheless
deconstruction,
like
Foucauldian
(and
even
Bloomian)
criticism,
con-
tinues to have an enormous influence on critical thinking. These modes of criticism have such an effect because
the unlikely and somewhat unrigorous ideas they deploy mesh
extremely well with the literary vocation that attracts people to the study of literature to begin with. (This may change through its own dialectic: at least in a sardonic introduction to an issue of
Studies in Romanticism
that he edited and which contained essays mainly by
his own students, de Man himself suggested, in a tone of elaborate and deadpan praise, that their attraction to literary theory was far less literary than his own had been. On the other hand, critics like Sedgwick, Guillory and Lee Edelman have sought to return the centrality of
pleasure
to the analysis of literature.) As with Strauss, literature turns out in decon-
structive (and Foucauldian) analyses to be about things as fantastic and wonderful and strange as we originally believed in our archaic, childhood response to it. Kant, Shelley, Keats
were
involved
with
utterly
foundational
struggles
within
a
Manichean
world.
Literary and philosophical figures really were heroes of a fundamental and cosmic or at least
ontological
struggle
for
the
very
Shelley's actual body is inscribed in
existence
of
meaning.
The Triumph of Life
When
de
Man
says
that
, or that texts masquerade as wars,
 vi-Strauss's anthropology as being itself an actual creation story and when Derrida reads Le not just an account of one, it feels as if we have entered a mythic realm, the place where philosophy mythic
and
stature.
literature, Our
souls
or
philosophical
take
a
proud
literature
flight
in
and
literary
participating
in
philosophy, this
story.
take
The
on
new
historicism similarly and taking its cue from deconstruction provides a kind of magic realist Âa Ma  rquez and not of, say, account of history, so that we're in the realm of Gabriel Garcõ Christopher Hill. As in Strauss, intellectual figures turn out to be engaged in giant struggles that engage us still, that we participate in by reading their work properly. The most explicit and most canny version of this paradigm is in Bloom, who in his accounts of the life and
modern north american criticism and theory
54
death struggles of strong poets with their precursors makes all poetry into an exciting and mythical agon. But here Bloom is representative of the spirit of his times, and the very resentment he provokes (and encourages) in his fellow-theorists derives from the openness with which he mythologizes a struggle that they wish to believe is real. I
say
this
not
out
of
the
desire
to
demystify
or
deflate
the
pretensions
of
(broadly
speaking) deconstructive literary theory. Its salubrious effects have been far greater than its drawbacks:
literary
critics
are
on
the
whole
far
more
alert,
serious,
philosophical
and
intellectually engaged than they have been. That this should come with drawbacks ± newer pieties, sloppy thinking, risks of intolerance and resentment, and complacency ± is not surprising, and these deficits are no worse than they ever were among critics. And it should be said of deconstruction what is also true of Freud, that it invented a new adventure story, a new and exciting literary experience, which may be judged somewhat harshly as sober analysis, but must be praised highly as a literary enterprise that continues to grip people's imaginations.
William Flesch
Further reading and works cited Bloom, H. et al.
Deconstruction and Criticism.
Ð and Esch, D.
Critical Encounters.
Decomposing Figures.
Chase, C.
On Deconstruction.
Culler, J.
Ð (ed. and pref.)
Blindness and Insight.
Ð.
Rhetoric of Romanticism.
Ð.
Resistance to Theory.
Ð.
Wartime Journalism.
Ð.
Aesthetic Ideology.
Ð and Laub, D.
Guillory, J.
Lincoln, NE, 1989.
Minneapolis, MN, 1996.
Testimony.
Cultural Capital.
New York, 1985.
Lincoln, NE, 1989
The Critical Difference.
Quinney, L. Shaviro, S.
New York, 1990.
New York, 1993.
Fables of Responsibility.
Keenan, T.
trans. Cecile Lindsay et al. New York, 1986.
Ithaca, NY, 1983.
New York, 1992.
The End of the Line.
Johnson, B.
Wall, T.
New York, 1984.
Minneapolis, MN, 1986.
Learning to Curse.
Responses.
18, Winter 1979b.
Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
The Literary Speech Act.
Greenblatt, S.
Ð et al.
New Haven, CT, 1979a.
Memoires: For Paul de Man,
Felman, S.
Hertz, N.
Baltimore, MD, 1986.
Studies in Romanticism,
Ð.
Baltimore, MD, 1991.
New Brunswick, NJ, 1995.
New York, 1983.
Allegories of Reading.
de Man, P.
Derrida, J.
New York, 1979.
Empirical Truths and Critical Fictions.
Caruth, C.
Baltimore, MD, 1980. Stanford, CA, 1997.
Literary Power and the Criteria of Truth.
Passion and Excess.
Radical Passivity.
Gainesville, FL, 1995.
Gainesville, FL, 1990.
Albany, NY, 1999.
Waters, L. and Godzich, W. (ed.)
Reading de Man Reading.
Minneapolis, MN, 1989.
9. Fredric Jameson (1934±) and Marxist Literary and Cultural Criticism
More than anything, misreadings of Fredric Jameson's work testify to the remarkable range and
variety
of
elements
forming
his
intellectual
background
and
theoretical
method.
 csian, an Althusserian, a structuralist and a Variously characterized as a Hegelian, a Luka postmodernist, Jameson in fact draws on all of these thinkers and intellectual traditions without being reducible to any single one of them. Indeed, his work is best represented as an amalgam of marxist and non-marxist thought that exceeds any individual label at the Á -vis its object of study. same time that it resists recourse to a moralizing position vis-a Perhaps this latter fact more than any other accounts for the numerous misreadings of his work (the debate, for instance, over whether Jameson celebrates or criticizes postmodernism) and simultaneously highlights its singularity. As Jameson himself notes, the tendency to identify him with and/or to position him as either spokesperson or critic of his object of study excludes the possibility of being neither of those things, but obviously `neither' in a way hard for people to understand (Kellner 1989, 369±70). The possibility of this unusual and complicated `neither' forms the heart of Jameson's oeuvre; rather than appearing as a fault
or defect, Jameson's
important
and
necessary
eclectic and totalizing system intervention
into
both
of thought can
marxian
theory
be seen
generally
and
as an
literary
theory specifically. Two of Jameson's earliest books,
Language
Marxism and Form
(1971) and
(1972) established him as a leading marxist literary critic.
The Prison-House of
Marxism and Form,
in
particular, is often cited as the Ur-text of marxist literary criticism in the US academy (Homer 1998, 38). These two works, along with
The Political Unconscious
(1981), not only
firmly solidified Jameson's reputation and status but also contain the core components and vocabulary
of
his
intellectual
project:
the
dialectic,
utopia,
a
non-essentialist
subject,
totality, mediation, the analysis of movements of literary and cultural history (periodization) and the primacy of narrative. As his work has developed and expanded, Jameson has applied and amended these terms in an increasingly diverse set of analyses of texts and cultural objects, from single-author studies of Sartre, Wyndham Lewis, Adorno and Brecht to works on cinema (Signatures
Space in the World System Late Capitalism Time
(1994),
of the Visible
(1990),
The Geopolitical Aesthetic: Cinema and
(1992)), postmodernism (Postmodernism,
(1991)), and theory (The
The Cultural Turn
Ideologies of Theory,
or, The Cultural Logic of
2 vols (1988),
The Seeds of
(1998)). Tracing the lineaments of Jameson's thought
throughout this body of work reveals in fitting dialectical form how the sum of Jameson's contributions to contemporary marxism is greater than its parts. The central concept underlying all of Jameson's intellectual forays ± be they into marxist
modern north american criticism and theory
56
theory, mass culture, third world movements and literature, architecture, film theory or postmodernism ± is found in the injunction that opens
The Political Unconscious: `Always
historicize!' (1981, 9). While on the face of it a fairly straightforward gesture, Jameson's imperative yields surprisingly complex results. First and foremost, it shifts the focus of critical attention away from evaluative judgements (for example, is postmodernism good or bad) towards historical and dialectical analysis (why postmodernism now). The product of such a shift is perhaps most dramatically seen in Jameson's essay `Reification and Utopia in Mass Culture' (1979). Like
The Political Unconscious, the essay begins with the need for a
`genuinely historical and dialectical approach', in this case to the opposition between high
Jaws and The Godfather I and II specifically, Jameson shows how the high culture/mass culture divide
culture and mass culture. In a reading of theories of mass culture generally and
simply represents two sides of the same phenomenon, namely the `fission of aesthetic production under capitalism' (1979, 14). If high modernist art attempts to resist the commodification of culture in its development of a new language and a new aesthetic, it does so in reaction to the very same processes ± capitalist commodification and reification ± that produce mass culture. As such, high culture and mass culture are seen to exist in a relationship of structural dependency rather than oppositional independence. This dialectical overturning significantly challenges the classic Frankfurt School reading of the `culture industry' in which traditional high art is valorized over and against the manipulative designs of a denigrated mass culture. Instead, both modernism and mass culture are shown to be equally dissociated from group praxis: the former through its very resistance to commodification and its subsequent creation of aesthetic enclaves, and the latter through its absorption into the commodity form. The exposure of this surprising parallel between modernism and mass culture is but one
Jaws and The Godfather I and II, Jameson argues (and this is signature Jameson) that the new model move, however, in the final dialectical turn of the argument. In his readings of
of manipulation he is putting forward contains nothing less than the utopian: `the hypothesis is that the words of mass culture cannot be ideological without at one and the same time being implicitly or explicitly utopian as well: they cannot manipulate unless they offer some genuine shred of content as a fantasy bribe to the public about to be so manipulated' (Jameson 1979, 29). In other words, these films `work' only in so far as they tap into deep fantasies about how we wish to live and what sort of social life we want. The Á la the Frankfurt School misses this important move in its simple rejection of mass culture a emphasis on an evaluative critical stance and therefore too easily dismisses mass culture as mere manipulation. Significantly, the `content' that is lost is a vision of collectivity, of a desire for a collective form of social life not possible structurally under capitalism (imaged in
The Godfather,
for instance, in the form of the family). This dual move captures
Jameson's hermeneutic, or rather `double hermeneutic' (Kellner 1989, 13): ideological critique coupled with utopian hope, itself a coupling of traditional marxian ideological analysis (Marx et al.) with the utopian marxism of theorists such as Herbert Marcuse and Ernst Bloch. The need to historicize and the dialectical form through which Jameson's historicism operates marks the nature of his contributions to classical as well as more contemporary
The Political Unconscious (as well as in `Marxism and Historicism' and the introduction to The Ideologies of Theory, vol. 2) marxism is the theory of history and thus subsumes all other forms of
marxist and non-marxist thought. On the one hand, as he claims in
interpretation (1981, 10, 47; 1979, 149±50, 172±7; Kellner 1989, 14). It is the `un-
fredric jameson and marxist literary and cultural criticism
57
transcendable horizon', the master narrative that doesn't simply add to other interpretive frameworks
but
rather
(much
like
the
Aufhebung
of
Hegelian
dialectics)
cancels
and
preserves them, contains and transcends them. The act of subsumption defines Jameson's method of theoretical incorporation.
The Political Unconscious
, in particular, represents a
meeting of marxism and the new continental theoretical work of the 1970s, especially poststructuralism, psychoanalytic criticism and semiotics as well as Althusserian marxism. Much of the work of continental theorists ± Derrida, Foucault, Baudrillard, Deleuze and Guattari,
Lyotard,
Nietzschean totalizing,
and
Kristeva
and
Althusser
anti-interpretive
reductionist
Political Unconscious
and
current:
authoritarian.
± a
share
in
critique
Against
what
of
these
the
Jameson
refers
hermeneutic
readings,
the
to
act
premise
as
itself of
a as
The
± and one that incorporates these criticisms ± is that such a critique is
misplaced. The problem isn't interpretation in and of itself but the adequacy of previous
The Political Unconscious
hermeneutical models. What is needed and what
as a project
offers, then, is a new `immanent or anti-transcendent hermeneutical model' (1981, 23). Althusser's model of structural causality provides the framework for a new method of interpretation in which the relationship among different levels within the social system is conceived not in terms of expressive causality (as in Althusser's reading of Hegel) but of semi-autonomy. That is, rather than resting on a notion of expressive identity, in which each
part
of
the
system
expresses
the
essence
of
the
whole
and
thereby
exists
in
a
transparent relation to the whole, the notion of various social levels as semi-autonomous allows for the possibility of differentiation among individual parts of the whole ± and thus for a more complex and heterogeneous understanding of how the social system functions. Unlike Althusser, however, Jameson conceives of this model of structural causality not as a break with hermeneutics or the dialectical tradition of marxism but as a modification of them. Jameson thus finally situates Althusser (along with the other poststructuralists and theorists he considers) through a `radical historicizing of their mental operations, such that not only the content of the analysis, but the very method itself, along with the analyst, then comes to be reckoned into the ``text'' or phenomenon to be explained' (1981, 47). In short, Jameson places them within a dialectical framework, thereby aiming to retain their insights and simultaneously overcome their limits. In the case of Althusser, the result is the development of a hermeneutic derived from the very concept of structural causality, a hermeneutic
that
accounts
both
for
the
totality
and
for
its
`absence'.
In
the
process,
Althusser's conception of history as an absent cause is transcoded into a notion of totality: `Totality is not available for representation, any more than it is accessible in the form of some ultimate truth (or moment of Absolute Spirit)' (1981, 55). But what is available is narrative itself, which becomes the mode through which a political unconscious works and, in turn, defines the task of the critic: to unmask narratives as socially symbolic acts. Hence the primacy of narrative for Jameson: not only is it the means through which we live history but the means through which history lives. In other words, for Jameson, there is no narrative that is not political. The proper and only critical stance, then, is to apprehend history through its effects, namely in the form of texts or cultural artefacts. The body of various
generic
forms
The Political Unconscious
(magical
narratives,
realism
and
takes up this task by looking at romance)
and
authors
(Balzac,
Gissing, Conrad) that progressively mark the increasing commodification of everyday life and of the subject under capitalism. A
certain
Jameson
urgency
comes
to
drives
terms
this
with
project
given
contemporary
our
current
theory,
older
historical classical
moment.
models
of
Just
as
marxist
modern north american criticism and theory
58
criticism
(primarily
from
the
1930s)
demand
revitalizing
because
they
are
unable
to
account for the complex mediations between cultural artefacts and the socio-economic system. In place of the older base/superstructure formulation (a `vulgar Marxism'), Jameson turns to a Hegelian marxism for a theory of mediation adequate to the new conditions of monopoly capitalism and its subsequent mutation into late capitalism. As he states in
Marxism and Form,
it is in the context of this historical moment `that the great themes of
Hegel's philosophy ± the relationship of part to whole, the opposition between concrete and
abstract,
the
concept
of
totality,
the
dialectic
of
appearance
and
essence,
the
interaction between subject and object ± are once again the order of the day' (1971, xviii±xix). In
Marxism and Form,
 cs and the Frankfurt School as well as elsewhere, Georg Luka
Marxism and Form
provide the prime material for this rethinking. hensive
treatment
of
some
of
the
major
figures
of
western
comprises a compre-
marxism
with
chapters
on
 cs and Sartre, respectively, and a final chapter entitled Adorno, Benjamin, Bloch, Luka `Towards
Dialectical
Criticism'.
Above
all,
 cs's Luka
theory
of
reification
underwrites
Jameson's approach both to the problems of contemporary capitalist society and to the means
toward
brought
new
problem
of
a
solution.
attention
to
Published an
 cs Luka
reification.
in
aspect
1923,
of
develops
History and Class Consciousness
 cs's Luka
Marx's
analysis
Marx's
in
ideas
Capital
about
long
neglected,
commodity
fetishism
the or
reification, arguing that commodity fetishism is a problem specific to the age of modern capitalism (Bottomore 1983, 412). Moreover, he is concerned to show how the `essence of commodity structure' ± so pointedly summed up by Marx as the transformation of the relations between people into the mere relations between things ± transforms the `subject' of the commodity world as much as its objects. So that not only does a qualitative change occur in the world of commodities as a market economy comes to dominate our `outer life', but this same process penetrates our `inner life': `Just as the capitalist system continuously produces and reproduces itself economically on higher levels, the structure of reification progressively sinks more deeply, more fatefully and more definitively into the consciousness  cs 1971, 93). For Jameson this translates into an analysis of contemporary of man' (Luka capitalism where the reifying logic of capital is precisely that which blocks our ability to see it as a total, now fully global, system. The task of criticism is thus to draw out the very kinds of connections that capital logic denies; to overcome what Max Weber characterized as the process of rationalization (the division of both mental and manual labour, the specialization of skills and the reduction of all social processes to a rational system of calculation) and  cs argues `leads to the destruction of every image of the whole' (1971, 103). Luka For Jameson the concept of `cognitive mapping' defines this necessary critical function. It is an attempt to map the new space of the postmodern, to conceive the coordinates of the social
structure
and
the
totality
of
class
relations
on
a
global
scale
(1988a,
353).
Its
spatializing metaphor of the map is meant to capture the new organization of space under late capitalism: the disorientation of saturated space in which any sort of distance itself is suppressed. Central to this characterization of our present social structure is its differentiation from previous modes of production. Each of the three historical stages of capitalism, that is, has generated a space unique to it. Under classical or market capitalism, that space was a grid (and coincided aesthetically with realism); under monopoly capitalism it is best defined as a growing gap between lived experience and structure, a distance defined in terms
of
problems
irony, of
and
a
figuration
contradiction or
which
representation
produces,
which
the
according
various
to
Jameson,
modernisms
have
specific at
their
fredric jameson and marxist literary and cultural criticism
59
centre. Within the new complexities of postmodern space and its disorienting effects this problem of figuration becomes especially acute. How to even grasp the system as a whole when the organization of its parts functions to deny anything larger than the fragment and its
cognitive
effects
±
of
disorientation
and
fragmentation
±
prevent
any
sense
of
perspectival distance or `point of view'? And yet, to cede to this dilemma, to celebrate the fragmentary and the multiplicitous at the expense of the whole, is essentially to abandon a socialist politics altogether. The aesthetic
becomes
postmodern) gains
the a
political
certain
and
vice
primacy
versa
over
as
culture
economics or
(the
saturated
politics.
The
space
mapping
of
the
of the
cultural logic of late capitalism therefore takes on a political immediacy: `the incapacity to map socially is as crippling to political experience as the analogous incapacity to map spatially is for urban experience. It follows that an aesthetic of cognitive mapping in this sense is an integral part of any socialist political project' (1988a, 353) ± and a project, moreover, that is still yet to be conceived. Cognitive mapping thus attempts, finally, to `produce the concept of something we cannot imagine' (1988a, 347). In
essence,
realism
then,
adequate
to
cognitive the
mapping
demands
and
functions logic
of
as
Jameson's
consumer
version
culture
of
would
what
look
a
like,
new but
importantly one that is not `exactly mimetic in that older sense' given its simultaneously  cs' theory local, national and international coordinates (1991, 51). As such, it is from Luka of reification rather than his theories of realism that Jameson draws his own analysis of  cs' negative realism. (It is important to note that Jameson distances himself from Luka  cs pronouncements on modernism, identifying himself much more with Brecht than Luka when it comes to the question of innovative modernist forms or the creation of new forms of (critical) realism other than classical nineteenth-century realism.) Indeed, as Jameson himself clarifies, ` ``cognitive mapping'' was in reality nothing but a code word for ``class consciousness'' . . .: only it proposed the need for class consciousness of a new and hitherto undreamed
of
kind,
while
it
also
inflected
the
account
in
the
direction
of
that
new
spatiality implicit in the postmodern' (Kellner 1989, 387). The exploration of the new spatiality of postmodernism and its reorganization of politics finds its fullest articulation in Jameson's full-length study
Logic of Late Capitalism
Postmodernism, or, The Cultural
(1991), a collection of essays taking its title from the seminal 1984
essay on postmodernism. The same dictum that drives Jameson's earlier work forms the basis of this much later work where the postmodern as a concept is meant to capture the very
historicity
of
historical
thinking
itself:
`It
is
safest
to
grasp
the
concept
of
the
postmodern as an attempt to think the present historically in an age that has forgotten how to think historically in the first place' (xi). Here Jameson extends his earlier analyses across a wide spectrum of the arts: the visual arts, architecture, video and film. Certainly, the most cited and exemplary of his readings is his analysis of the Bonaventure Hotel in Los Angeles. In his description of its spatial disorientation, of the ways in which it seems designed to cause confusion and an utter inability on the individual's part to map its space, Jameson highlights how both the objects and the subjects of multinational capital are radically altered and transformed from their high modernist counterparts. In contrast to the space
of
degraded
high city
modernism, fabric
the
around
it
Bonaventure but
rather
to
seeks
not
replace
it
to
differentiate
altogether.
The
itself lack
from of
the
visible
entranceways, the mirroring effects of its glass exterior, and the interior elevators and escalators all conspire to produce a complete hyperspace as a substitute for the city and a totally new built environment that requires the production of new subjects to inhabit it:
modern north american criticism and theory
60
`The new architecture . . . stands as something like an imperative to grow new organs, to expand our sensorium and our body to some new, yet unimaginable, perhaps ultimately impossible,
dimensions'
(39).
As
Cultural Logic of Late Capitalism,
Jameson
argues
throughout
Postmodernism, or, The
these radical changes are not merely stylistic or formal
(as many earlier accounts of postmodernism would have it) but structural, linked directly to the social and to the changes in economic production identified by Ernest Mandel in his analysis of contemporary capitalism,
Late Capitalism.
The difficulty and the consequent
need to map on a spatial scale figures the need to map on a social scale. The most controversial of Jameson's work involves his extension of these concerns to socalled third-world literature and culture. Situated as a `pendant' to the postmodernism essay in its attention to the cognitive aesthetics of third-world literature, his essay `Thirdworld Literature in the Era of Multinational Capitalism' provocatively claims that all thirdworld texts are to be read as national allegories. In the most well-known critique, Aijaz Ahmad (1987) attacks the all-encompassing `all' in this claim and Jameson's attempt to establish a situation of radical difference between the first and third world. However, the definitiveness of this statement at once draws attention to the standpoint of the dominated in its radically different relationship to multinational capital as well as emphasizes the relative impoverishment of first-world culture. The perspective of the dominated (culled  cs' epistemology in from a combination of Hegel's master±slave dialectic and Luka
and Class Consciousness)
History
reveals certain forms of experience and collectivity no longer
available to the first world. Specifically, Jameson finds in representative readings of the Chinese writer Lu Xun and the Senegalese novelist and film-maker Ousmane Sembene wholly different relations between the subjective and the public or political: `Third-world texts,
even
those
which
are
seemingly
private
and
invested
with
a
properly
libidinal
dynamic ± necessarily project a political dimension in the form of national allegory:
the
story of the private individual destiny is always an allegory of the embattled situation of the public third-world culture and society'
(1991, 69). In a reversal of first-world/third-world relations,
Jameson concludes that the first world has much to learn from the third world and its texts ± about the reified nature of first-world public and private life, about the libidinal and the political, and about the role of the intellectual and the role of the humanities more broadly in American education. In short, they offer access to a notion of `cultural revolution' and a vision of community interdependence that has all but disappeared in the first world. In contrast to critiques such as that of Ahmad, then, Jameson's position on third-world culture serves not to subsume everything within a first world perspective (Ahmad accuses Jameson of
a
form
of
Orientalism)
but
to
highlight
the
very
processes
of
first-world
cultural
imperialism and its `crippling' effects for the `masters' or `we Americans' (1991, 85). Ahmad's response has its parallel in criticisms of Jameson that equate his emphasis on totality with totalitarianism. In this line of reasoning, the desire to create a totalizing system is described as violent or oppressive in its attempt to incorporate everything. Such a view, when not simply a false equation of two obviously different terms (totality and totalitarianism), mistakes a symptom for a cause: the dissatisfaction with the concept of totality is itself a marker for the increasing difficulties of cognitively mapping contemporary society, a project
that,
as
Jameson
underscores,
`stands
or
falls
with
the
conception
of
some
(unrepresentable, imaginary) social global totality' (Jameson 1988b, 356). More substantive responses to Fredric Jameson's work often tend paradoxically to centre on his style. Admittedly, Jameson's prose is difficult. It assumes a wide and diverse body of knowledge,
from
philosophy,
to
critical
theory,
semiotics,
psychoanalysis,
European
fredric jameson and marxist literary and cultural criticism
61
modernism and popular culture. For anyone who has thought about teaching Jameson to undergraduates, the problem is clear enough. Each text presupposes knowledge of so many other texts that it seems virtually impossible to find a point from which to begin. The breadth of Jameson's references is matched by the sheer bravado (at times) of his dialectical style of writing. In the tradition of the Frankfurt School, his prose is meant to be as difficult as the thought it represents, and because the very processes of dialectical thought are inimical to our reified way of thinking under capitalism, Jameson's style is too. In his own defence, Jameson asks: `Why should there be any reason to feel that these problems [of culture and aesthetics] are less complex than those of bio-chemistry?' (Jameson 1982, 88). Responses to Jameson's style range from unqualified admiration of its `splendour' to serious scepticism about its utility for a properly political or revolutionary criticism. On the positive extreme, Perry Anderson sees in it the perfect embodiment of the multiple texts and multiplicitous signs which it engages, of the melding of form and content (Anderson 1998, 71±2). Style meets content as Anderson glowingly assesses Jameson's contribution to the
postmodernism
debate
and
claims
that
he
does
what
no
other
theorist
of
the
postmodern does ± anchors the aesthetic forms or style of postmodernism in the economic and
political
alterations
of
late
capitalism.
In
stark
contrast,
Terry
Eagleton
identifies
Jameson's style as finally detrimental to an engaged socialist or marxist politics. As he sees it, the very generosity and appropriative nature of Jameson's thought marks the limits of its
bricoleur
political bite. Jameson becomes for Eagleton an `unrepentant
' who too easily
absorbs others' ideas and `leaves everything as it was' (Eagleton 1986, 71). Instead of formulating a sharp relationship between the mystifications of late capitalism or ideology more generally and a practical politics, Jameson, in Eagleton's view, prioritises theory (or  cs' ideological critique) over practice. In this sense, his distance from Luka
Consciousness
indispensable
is
marked:
`the
concomitant
dispelling
and
effect
of
of
reification
class
which
struggle
has
for
History and Class
that
become,
work
in
was
an
Jameson,
its
theoretical prolegomenon' (Eagleton 1986, 75). At issue finally is the larger question of institutional marxism and its relationship to the driving force of marxism: class struggle and the overthrow of capitalism. Does Jameson's work suffer from the same limits, for instance, as those of western marxism? If western marxism
represents
a
move
away
from
class
struggle
and
praxis
towards
theory
and
philosophy, reflective of the political realities post-1968, can the same be said for Jameson's project? According to Perry Anderson, whose
Considerations of Western Marxism
makes this
very case about western marxism, the answer is, interestingly, no. He argues that Jameson exceeds the limits of this tradition and provides its `most complete consummation' by grounding his account of postmodernism in the economic development of late capitalism. Whereas
the
aesthetic
in
the
western
marxist
tradition
functioned
as
`involuntary
consolation for impasses of the political and economic' in Jameson no such consolatory function is at work (Anderson 1998, 72). Rather the penetration of culture by capital and capital by culture bespeaks a different political reality and hence the necessity of a different political strategy. The very pervasiveness of `the cultural' that Jameson analyses in terms of the logic of late capitalism directly confronts the conditions of contemporary life rather than evading them. As a result, Anderson locates Jameson's contribution as central to a properly political intervention into the space of postmodernism: `So Jameson's resumption of
[the]
heritage
description
of
[of
the
western
marxism]
conditions
(Anderson 1992, 73).
of
could
yield
contemporary
a
life
much than
more
the
central
precedents
and it
political drew
on'
modern north american criticism and theory
62
Perhaps, given the conditional nature of Anderson's response, it is simply too soon for any final reckoning of Jameson's theoretical and political contributions. Or, rather, the very
provisional
nature
of
such
an
assessment
underscores
the
necessarily
mediated
relationship between the theoretical and the political that defines the marxist tradition and Jameson's work within it. In the best tradition harbours
no
illusions
that
academic
literary
of institutional marxism, Jameson
marxist
criticism
is
going
to
topple
the
capitalist system on its own. At the same time, his work derives its political immediacy from the recognition that in order to even begin to challenge the system we have to first understand how it functions. As with the classical marxist formulation, such theory will only be fully realized when it is put into practice. In the meantime, as Jameson's collection of texts cautions and simultaneously inspires, there is much groundwork yet to be done.
Carolyn Lesjak
Further reading and works cited Ahmad, A. `Jameson's Rhetoric of Otherness and the ``National Allegory'' ',
Lenin and Philosophy, and Other Essays.
Althusser, L. Anderson, P.
The Origins of Postmodernity.
Bottomore, T. (ed.) Burnham, C. Eagleton, T.
Against the Grain.
Hardt, M. and Weeks, K. (eds) Homer, S.
Fredric Jameson.
Ð.
Cambridge, MA, 1983.
Durham, NC, 1995.
London, 1986.
The Jameson Reader.
Oxford, 2000.
New York, 1998.
Marxism and Form.
Jameson, F.
17, 1987.
London, 1998.
A Dictionary of Marxist Thought.
The Jamesonian Unconscious.
Social Text,
London, 1971.
The Political Unconscious.
Princeton, NJ, 1971.
Ithaca, NY, 1981.
Ð. `Interview' with L. Green, J. Culler and R. Klein.
diacritics,
12, 3, 1982.
Ð. `Third-World Literature in the Era of Multinational Capitalism', Ð. `Cognitive Mapping', in
Social Text,
Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture,
15, Fall 1986.
ed. D. Kellner. Urbana, IL,
1988a. Ð.
The Ideologies of Theory.
Minneapolis, MN, 1988b.
Ð. `Afterword: Marxism and Postmodernism', in
Postmodernism/Jameson/Critique,
ed. D. Kellner.
Washington, 1989. Ð.
Signatures of the Visible.
Ð.
Postmodernism, or, The Cultural Logic of Late Capitalism.
Ð.
The Geopolitical Aesthetic.
New York, 1990. Durham, NC, 1991.
Bloomington, IN, 1992.
Ð. `Actually Existing Marxism', in
Marxism Beyond Marxism,
eds S. Makdisi, C. Casarino and R. E.
Karl. New York, 1996. Ð.
Brecht and Method.
Jay, M.
London, 1998.
Marxism and Totality.
Kellner, D. (ed.) LaCapra, D. Â cs, G. Luka
Berkeley, CA, 1984.
Postmodernism/Jameson/Critique.
Washington, DC, 1989.
Rethinking Intellectual History: Texts, Contexts, Language .
History and Class Consciousness.
Cambridge, 1971.
Ithaca, NY, 1983.
10. Edward W. Said (1935±2003)
Edward W. Said has not formulated a single, coherent theoretical model of his own ± nor has he founded a theoretical school or movement. But he has sketched out a number of important directions for cross-cultural analysis, as well as a unique set of positions within postcolonialist criticism. Said is best known for his work of the 1980s and 1990s, which has established him as a major cultural/political analyst of imperialism ± and, more particularly, as a spokesperson for Palestinian rights. Theorizing the cultural implications of power differentials between East and West and commenting on the Middle East situation have brought Said a public stature that is virtually unique among humanistic intellectuals in the US. While his work on imperialism has not had a measurable impact on public policy or discourse, it has had an enormous influence on a number of academic disciplines, including literary theory, Middle East studies, political science, history and anthropology. Though
he
has
achieved
his
high
public
and
academic
profile
primarily
colonialist critic, Said's career, launched in 1966 with the publication of
the Fiction of Autobiography preoccupations.
He
has
as
a
post-
Joseph Conrad and
, has evolved over four decades through a number of theoretical
moved
away
from
an
early
grounding
in
phenomenology
and
existentialism, through an extremely productive exploration of poststructuralism, and into the profound theoretical scepticism ± accompanied by proposals for alternative models of cultural
interpretation
±
that
has
characterized
his
more
recent
postcolonialist
work.
Appreciating Said's postcolonialist positions, as well as the range of theoretical contributions he has made over the course of his long career, requires an understanding of the persistent problems that have shaped the various stages of his critical development. Throughout his career, Said has been concerned with the agency of the intellectual, and with his ability to direct and control intellectual progress. At the same time, though, Said has been scrupulously attentive to the power of culture as a limit on intellectual invention. These dual concerns ± which, to be sure, characterize much twentieth-century thought ± have compelled Said to search for interpretive paradigms adequate to what he sees as the dialectical
relationship
between
such
opposing
pressures.
Said's
attempt
to
develop
a
dialectical theory of cultural production draws together a number of subsidiary themes in his work: the role of development or transformation within individual texts, over the course of careers or within large cultural movements; the viability of rational forms of knowledge that respect epistemological discontinuities and ruptures; and the complicity of culture with political power. The opposing pressures that have long preoccupied Said ± at the most general level: intellectual agency and cultural constraint ± also inhabit the very form of his writing. That is to say, Said's writing is often idiosyncratic in its choice of subject and method; but it remains systematically, respectfully focused on canonical writers and dominant intellectual movements. It is both encyclopaedic and oppositional, both
modern north american criticism and theory
64
learned and iconoclastic. Energized by this unstable dynamism, his writing can appear to be more
unclassifiable
than
that
of
many
other
contemporary
theorists.
It
can
also
seem
inherently resistant to discipleship or filiation. Said's first book extracts a dialectical model for intellectuals and culture from the work of Joseph
Conrad,
which
Said
explores
as
a
pre-figuration
of
phenomenological
and
ex-
istential philosophies. Said claims that Conrad was unable to resolve the tension between intellectual self-consciousness and the agonistic conditions of social existence by positing some authentic identity for the writer; instead, Conrad expresses this tension through dramatic conflicts that perform, without resolving, his own dilemma as an intellectual. Anticipating the emphasis on cross-cultural understanding that marks his later work, Said argues
that
±
unlike
many
other
writers
of
his
time
±
Conrad
welcomed
political
developments after the First World War, seeing them as a sign that nations had risen to a self-conscious individuality that could, at the same time, still accommodate panEuropean cooperation. Conrad's imagined resolution of tensions on an international scale parallel, according to Said, the tensions he perceived between the individual thinker and culture
as
a
whole.
At
this
stage
of
his
career,
Said
celebrates
Conrad's
dualistic
formulations and, significantly, does not emphasize the link between Conrad's political optimism and his enthusiasm for colonialism ± a conjunction that lies at the heart of Said's later work on Conrad, and on other western novelists as well. In
Beginnings
(1975), Said ambitiously expands his critical horizons to include Western
literature over the last two centuries, while he continues to meditate on the possibility of a theoretical `middle path' between subject-oriented humanism and modernist nightmares of cultural hegemony. 1970s,
in
which
Beginnings
he
marks a key phase of Said's development in the mid to late±
employs
while
contesting
poststructuralist
Michel Foucault's theories of power ± in order
theory
to think through
±
in
problems
particular, of cultural
production. Said elides the concept of beginning with intentionality, and although he understands intentionality in impersonal terms ± as the rules of inclusiveness or pertinence which
make
the
act
of
beginning
a
somewhat
arbitrary
and
retrospective
one
±
he
understands beginning intentions as a means of reconciling individual agency with the pressures of cultural systems.
Beginnings
risks positing an ahistorical and anti-materialist
model of interpretation, by containing the history of beginnings within an opposition of classic to modernist conceptions of intentionality in western writing. Yet by recognizing the persistent emphasis that conflicting philosophies of cultural production have placed on the
act
of
beginning,
Said
contests
the
poststructuralist
notion
that
such
acts
merely
disguise `the perpetual trap of forced continuity' (1975, 43), arguing that they are, in fact, newly generative. Despite late-twentieth-century preoccupations with the hegemony of paradigms and epistemes, then, Said argues that the notion of beginning intention cannot be eradicated from theoretical models, and needs to be theorized comprehensively. Said finds
fictions
of
beginning
in
poststructuralism,
for
example,
particularly
in
Foucault's
postnarrative methods of knowledge. Bravely celebrating the humanism he finds latent in Foucault's references to effective, if undeniable, pressures for epistemic disruption, Said attempts to undermine from within poststructuralism's goal of separating the construction of knowledge from the individual subject. Nevertheless, Said is very critical ± in
Beginnings
and in his other writings from this period ± of poststructuralism's collapsing of agency into signification. He is particularly harsh on the `linguacentricity' (1975, 336) of Derrida, both for failing to account for change and for denying that the discontinuous evolution of knowledge can ever be understood as progressive. Ultimately, Said takes his own preferred
edward
w. said
65
model of beginning from Giambattista Vico, the eighteenth-century Italian philosopher who remains a seminal force in much of Said's later work. In Said's view, Vico conceives knowledge as deeply embedded in textual systems, at the same time that he affirms the potency and the unpredictability of intellectual disruption. Significantly, though, Said's dialectical model of beginning largely ignores the role of state power, and its presence within both culture and self-consciousness ± an issue that becomes the central concern of his work from the late 1970s on.
Orientalism
culture,
and
(1978) is Said's first direct analysis of the relationship between politics and this
book
marks
a
stage
in
Said's
career
in
which
his
earlier
belief
in
intellectual agency is sometimes swamped by a monolithic, quasi-Foucauldian conception of power. For the first time in his career, Said formulates a deterministic theory of cultural hegemony,
one
that
continues
to
appear
±
though
often
throughout his later work on imperialism. Starting with
in
more
Orientalism
nuanced
forms
±
, the tensions between
Said's theories of cultural hegemony and his commitments to intellectual oppositionality break free of his earlier, synthetic models and generate dramatic oscillations ± contradictions, some critics would say ± within or across Said's own texts. In
Orientalism
, Said
argues that the western discourse of Orientalism ± as well as discourses of colonialism more generally
±
determine
the
thinking
of
scholars
who
set
out,
whatever
their
conscious
intentions, to acquire `objective' knowledge about Eastern cultures. Implicitly sceptical of intentionality,
Orientalism
describes an academic system of knowledge that is static, and
that ensnares its adherents
in grand misapprehensions. Said's central thesis about Or-
ientalist discourse is that its incapacity for development stems from its founding myth: that Eastern culture is itself a culture of arrested development. He claims that the concept of `the
Orient'
is
purely
a
western
invention,
and
that
Orientalist
discourse
conflates
knowledge with power in the absence of any real object of such knowledge. Said does historicize strategies
developing did
not
strategies
shift
within
relationships
of
Orientalist power
or
discourse,
challenge
but
he
them;
argues
rather,
that
they
these
merely
enabled the conversion of Orientalism from a contemplative discourse into an administrative and political one. Nevertheless, as James Clifford has pointed out, Said also departs from Foucauldian models of power and contradicts himself by suggesting rather persistently that there
is
a real Orient which has been distorted and denied the ability to speak (Clifford
1988, 260). Most importantly, though, in
Orientalism
Said argues for the first time that the
fact of political domination is dependent on a legitimating cultural discourse ± a cultural reductionism that he will develop much more extensively fifteen years later in
Imperialism Orientalism
Culture and
(1993).
Predictably,
virtually created the academic subdiscipline of colonial discourse analysis.
it
has
been
vigorously
and
sometimes
abusively
attacked
by
Islamic
and
Arabist specialists, but it has been well-received by specialists in related fields. It has been ambivalently critiqued by postcolonialist theorists, particularly by those who, like Benita Parry, admire Said's anti-Orientalist stance generally, but find that its totalizing approach suppresses native political voices and makes Said `indifferent to textual gaps, indeterminacies and contradictions' (Parry 1992, 26) in the dominant discourse as well. Some have argued that Said overestimates the degree to which western scholars have eroticized the Orient
(see
Spanos
1996).
Feminists
have
attacked
him
for
overlooking
questions
of
gender. He has also been faulted for ignoring the interrelated histories of victimization, particularly in regard to anti-Semitism. In a number of later essays, but particularly in
Orientalism
`
, an Afterword' (1995), Said strenuously debates these charges ± in particular,
modern north american criticism and theory
66
denying his alleged anti-westernism, his alleged totalizing of the West, and his alleged belief in the Orient as a stable referent ± though these criticisms continue to dog his work. Even those who praise Said for his political position and for his scholarship continue to complain that he has presented a history of Orientalism solely from the perspective of the West (though this critique must be seriously qualified in light of Said's work in the 1990s on Arab intellectuals).
Orientalism
may be bitingly clear about the insidious aspects of Orientalism, but it largely
ignores the very questions about intellectual subversion and oppositionality that dominated Said's first two books and that return to become central aspects of his later work. The dramatic imbalance of Said's thought during this phase of his career is reflected in two
Orientalism
books written at roughly the same time which form a kind of trilogy with
Question of Palestine
Covering Islam
(1979) and
Orientalism,
books seems a refutation of Said's fatalism, in ship of knowledge and power. In
The Question of Palestine,
oppositional
anti-Orientalist.
intellectual,
as
an
±
The
(1981). The very existence of these two
Said's
about the monolithic relation-
Said himself takes up the role of
twin
goals
are,
first,
to
provide
media-misinformed Americans with a general history of the Palestinians, and, second, to defend Palestinian political aspirations in the teeth of Orientalist distortions. In
Islam,
Covering
Said shows how Orientalist discourse has contaminated American media depictions
 s that of the Arab world. Besides documenting the gross generalizations and cultural cliche characterize
western
representations
of
the
Arab
world,
Said
demonstrates
how
these
distortions are embedded in assumptions about American political entitlement ± the selfserving belief that world events can and should be reduced to a calculus of American interests. Both these books indict cultural hegemony, while also enacting its subversion by means
of
historical
and
political
realities
±
as
Said
views
them
±
that
contradict
the
dominant discourse. In the last two books of the Orientalist trilogy, then ± both of which eschew the rhetoric of
theory
and
target
a
mainstream,
theoretical foundations of
Islam,
non-academic
Orientalism
readership
±
Said
contradicts
by vigorously calling for what, at the end of
the
Covering
he terms `antithetical knowledge' (1921, 167). Translating his complex thought on
the relationship of power and knowledge into ordinary language, he claims that `any good reader' can go `a reasonable distance toward overcoming the limitations of orthodox views' (167), and that `most knowledge about human society is, I think, finally accessible to common sense' (170). This position represents a bold, if unintegrated, return to traditional humanistic values that Said's later work continues to affirm ± but in highly qualified ways.
The World, the Text, and the Critic
(1983) is an important collection of Said's essays,
written between 1968 and 1983, all of which in some way attempt to refine his ideas about the
possibilities
interconnected
for ideas
antithetical that
could
knowledge. be
said
to
These
essays
characterize
revolve
all
of
around
Said's
a
major
series
work
of
after
his Orientalist trilogy: a strong condemnation of contemporary criticism's obsession with textuality; an even stronger condemnation of what he sees as the over-specialized and professionalized
discipline
of
literary
studies;
a
call
for
the
integration
of
cultural
and
political analysis; a systematic analysis of the cultural foundations of imperialism; and an affirmation
of
alienation,
as
the
necessary
starting
point
for
intellectual
labour.
The
importance of the last point cannot be overstated. In his later work, whenever Said affirms the power of the individual intellectual, he discards the humanistic rhetoric that marks early stages of his career by insisting that the awareness of culture as a system of exclusions must ground a
genuinely
critical consciousness. Yet
in Said's later
work, that kind of
edward
w. said
67
consciousness is never viewed as self-authorizing. Rather, it always negotiates a complex set of relationships between inherited and invented cultural traditions. Said thus reformulates
Beginnings,
the dialectical models of his early work on Conrad, and in
by conceiving the
intellectual as a kind of cultural bricoleur. Recombining the ideas of selected writers and cultural traditions into an idiosyncratic bulwark against determinative order, the intellectual appropriates and transforms rather than initiating ideas outside of the cultural context ± a methodological description that applies to many of Said's own essays on writers he admires, from Vico to Ghassan Kanafani. In `Secular Criticism', Said distinguishes between inherited order, or what he calls `filiation', and invented order, or `affiliation'. In Said's complicated
view
though
latter
the
Imagining
the
of
these
process
field
of
concepts, can
culture
filiation
either as
a
is
said
reproduce
plural
and
inevitably
filiation
or
to
produce
depart
discontinuous
affiliations,
radically
repertoire
of
from
it.
models
for
writing and thinking allows Said, in this phase of his career, to rework his earlier, quasiexistential
attitudes
toward
intellectual
work
within
a
more
complex
panorama
of
strategies for cultural production.
The World, the Text, and the Critic
is also a celebration of the essay form. Said is, perhaps
quintessentially, a writer of essays. In `Secular Criticism', he claims that the essay is the privileged form for antithetical thought. Reflecting on his own fundamental dilemma as a critic, Said claims that the book's demands for coherence and totality restrict the writer, while the essay has more affinities with the speculative and the sceptical. The bulk of Said's recent work has come in the form of essays, which have been collected in numerous anthologies, and which have ranged across a great many cultural and political topics ± from opera to Arabic fiction to the Balkans. The style of multi-layered thought that his essays, taken
as
a
whole,
seem
to
develop
has
recently
enabled
Said
to
take
a
more
fluid
methodological approach in his major projects as well. The single most important example of this fluid style is
Culture and Imperialism
(1993).
On one level, Said's critique of imperialism, and the cultural work that sustains it, seems to
Orientalism.
return to the totalizing approach of
Moving beyond his earlier analyses of
Orientalist discourse, Said seeks in this book to explore the general relationship between culture and empire. He rectifies one flaw cited by critics of
Orientalism
by tracing the
movements of resistance among colonized peoples, rather than describing them simply as the passive recipients of the imperial gaze. Nevertheless, in
Culture and Imperialism,
Said
tends to see the formation of both dominant and resistant cultures in a single source: metropolitan
self-legitimation.
More
disturbing,
for
some
of
Said's
critics,
he
seems
completely to conflate western culture and imperialism, as he argues that culture sustained, legitimated and normalized the imperial project. The British novel comes in for particularly harsh
criticism,
since
Said
regards
it
as
the
cultural
form
most
responsible
for
the
justification of imperial conquest ± one of the realistic novel's `principle purposes' was to `almost unnoticeably [sustain] the society's consent in overseas expansion' (12). While he is `not trying to say that the novel ``caused'' imperialism', Said does assert that the novel and
imperialism
`are
unthinkable
without
each
other'
(70±1).
Said
is
`struck
by
how
inexorably integrative' (6) imperial culture was ± and, to some extent, still is, since he argues that the western vision of the world is still haunted by imperialism. This
unforgiving,
all-encompassing
critique
has
many
productive
consequences.
It
allows Said to expose the complicity of contemporary culture with empire in representations of the New World Order and the End of History. It allows him to show how latenineteenth-century novels of empire were structurally congruent with novels written a
modern north american criticism and theory
68
century earlier, and to demonstrate how the linkage of domestic and imperial space in the novel grounds British morality in concepts of expansionism. Not just a simple indictment of
imperialism,
ideology,
Culture and Imperialism
including
codification
of
its
belief
ethnological
in
provides
ontological
differences,
its
a
thorough
differences
great
diagnosis
between
creative
power
East and
of
imperialist
and
its
West,
its
tendency
to
construct European subjective autonomy through the subjugation of native peoples. Oddly incongruent with this central project of
Culture and Imperialism
, however, is Said's
celebration of what he terms `contrapuntal reading' (1993, 66) ± a form of analysis he has championed increasingly in the 1990s. Derived in part from his recent studies of music, `contrapuntal reading', in the context of an analysis of imperialism, means fully taking into account
the
discovering canonical
relationships how
between
complex,
British
novels.
hybrid
dominant and
Significantly,
and
impure
any
resistant single
discourses.
text
Culture and Imperialism
might
It be
includes
a
also ±
means
including
long,
useful
account of previously neglected colonial responses to the West, and an analysis of the structures of such resistance ± an attentiveness to the non-European intellectual that has become central to Said's work since the late-1980s. Said does not reconcile his practice of `contrapuntal reading' with his uncompromising condemnation of western culture; rather, he weaves these two themes of his work ± the totalizing critique of western culture, and his own discovery and appropriation of cultural hybridity ± in an elaborate textual score that is finally, in some respects, resistant to theoretical resolution. `Contrapuntal reading' allows Said to entertain seemingly conflictual approaches to particular issues ± for example, he alternates between recognizing the necessity of a homogeneous native identity, including a nationalist one, and the inevitable hybridity of postcolonial identity ± a double-voiced reading
of
postcolonial
subjectivity
that
has
brought
him
into
conflict
with
many
postcolonialist critics, notably Homi Bhabha (Bhabha 1983, 200±2). Much of Said's most recent writing has explored, in effect, the dialogics of cross-cultural reading. His lifelong preoccupation with the dialectic of agency and culture has thus taken a productive new form in the shape of a mobile practice of writing and interpretation. Through `contrapuntal reading', he has been able to discuss disparate texts within multiple social and circumstantial contexts, and, therefore, to navigate between deterministic and agential perspectives. This method drives Said's recent essays on Arabic intellectuals, but it also fuels his essays
on
Middle
Discontents
East
(1996) and
politics,
many
of
which
have
The Politics of Dispossession
been
collected
in
Peace and Its
(1994b).
In the later stages of his career, then, Said recognizes that the tensions between agency and
culture
that
underlie
his
thought
are
best
handled
methodologically,
not
as
a
 developmental logic but as an `exfoliating structure of variations' (Buttigieg and Bove 1993, 3). Embracing this style has given Said a unique method, which proceeds by layering analytical
projects
and
positions,
building
cumulative
informational
resources
and
pa-
tiently exploring a variety of contextual fields. Said has not attempted to reconcile his method of `contrapuntal reading' with normative theorizing; instead, he has recently come to identify theoretical enterprises entirely with the privileged conjunction of knowledge and power. Predictably, perhaps, `contrapuntal reading' has been influential on a wide range of oppositional critics, not all of whom would recognize each other as allies: those who support particular nationalisms as well as those who oppose nationalism in general; those
engaged
defending
in
nativist
a
critique
traditions;
of
various
those
`universalizing'
interested
in
the
political
discourses,
overdetermination
and of
those
imperial
hegemony as well as those interested in the variable complexity of imperialism. What
edward
w. said
69
appeals to all these critics about Said's refusal of orthodox theorizing, more than anything else, is that it prevents him from succumbing to theoretical discourses popular in the wake of
poststructuralism
celebration
that
leave
no
room
for
the
assertion
of intellectual affiliation, or worldliness,
of
as a way
intellectual
will.
Said's
for the critic to express
oppositional power through alliances with particular cultural systems has generated a great deal of new work by cultural critics from many disciplines who are interested in the political efficacy of cross-cultural and interdisciplinary studies.
John Kucich
Further reading and works cited In Theory: Classes, Nations, Literatures.
Aijaz, A.
Bhabha, H.
Theory,
K. `Difference, Discrimination and
London, 1992. the
Discourse of Colonialism',
 , P. A. `An Interview with Edward W. Said', Buttigieg, J. A. and Bove Clifford, J.
The Predicament of Culture.
Gandhi, L.
Postcolonial Theory.
Loomba, A. Lowe, L.
in
The Politics of
eds F. Barker et al. Colchester, 1983. 2, 20, 1993.
New York, 1998.
Colonialism/Postcolonialism.
Critical Terrains.
Boundary,
Cambridge, 1988.
London, 1998.
Ithaca, NY, 1991.
Parry, B. `Overlapping Territories and Intertwined Histories',
Edward Said,
ed. M. Sprinker. Oxford,
1992. Said, E. W. Ð.
Joseph Conrad and the Fiction of Autobiography.
Beginnings.
Ð.
Orientalism.
Ð.
The Question of Palestine.
Ð ed. Ð.
Cambridge, MA, 1966.
New York, 1975. New York, 1978.
Literature and Society.
Covering Islam.
New York, 1979. Baltimore, MD, 1980.
New York, 1981.
Ð. `In the Shadow of the West',
The Arabs,
Channel 4 (London), 1982a.
Ð. `Opponents, Audiences, Constituencies, and Community'. Ð.
The World, the Text, and the Critic.
Ð. `An Ideology of Difference'. Ð. `Orientalism Reconsidered',
Critical Inquiry,
Cultural Critique,
Ð.
After the Last Sky.
Ð.
Musical Elaborations.
Ð.
Culture and Imperialism.
Ð.
Representations of the Intellectual.
Ð.
The Politics of Dispossession.
New York, 1994a.
New York, 1994b.
Raritan,
14, 1995.
New York, 1996.
Ð.
Out of Place: A Memoir.
New York, 1999.
Boundary,
1, 1985b.
New York, 1993.
Peace and Its Discontents.
V.
12, 1 (Autumn 1985a).
New York, 1991.
Ð.
W.
9, 1982b.
New York, 1986.
Ð. `Orientalism, an Afterword',
Spanos,
Critical Inquiry,
Cambridge, MA, 1983.
`Culture
2, 23, 1996.
and
Colonization:
The
Imperial
Imperatives
of
the
Centred
Circle',
11. American Feminisms: Images of Women and Gynocriticism
In her 1981 essay `Feminist Criticism in the Wilderness', Elaine Showalter identified three common modes of feminist literary theory which she saw as exemplifying different national tendencies:
English feminist criticism, essentially Marxist, stresses oppression; French feminist criticism, essentially psychoanalytic, stresses repression; American feminist criticism, essentially textual, stresses
expression.
All,
however,
have
become
gynocentric.
All
are
struggling
to
find
a
terminology that can rescue the feminine from its stereotypical associations with inferiority. (1986, 249)
Showalter's accurate,
separation
though
her
of
the
categories
insistence
on
the
of
feminism
gynocentrism
was
strategic
rather
than
(woman-centredness)
of
strictly literary
feminism is the right and necessary first step towards any feminism worth its name. In the years since the essay was published, however, it has become increasingly clear that feminist literary theories evade national and conceptual boundaries, and that it is perfectly possible to be a marxist-feminist who also takes account of the insights of psychoanalysis in order to make some sense of literary expression. With the benefit of hindsight, however, it might have been truer to say in 1981 that American
feminist
literary
theory
tended
to
be
concerned
primarily
with
issues
of
representation rather than those of textuality. Representation is used here in its widest sense: the representation of women as characters and images by literary texts whether female- or male-authored; the representation of women writers by literary critics; their representation in the institutional canons of literature departments in universities; their existence on or absence from the lists of publishers, both academic and popular. Some of the effort that went into recuperating and rediscovering women writers from past ages was indeed `textual' in the sense that it required textual scholarship and original research. But the research itself was motivated by the will of liberal feminism to equalize the representation of the sexes ± both in texts and in the world ± in the institutions that tend to guard cultural value. The most significant 1960s text for American feminism was by Betty Friedan, entitled
The Feminine Mystique
(1963). It was not a book about literature, drawing rather on the
methodologies of sociology and the language of popular journalism (Friedan herself was a magazine writer while she gathered the material for the book). On the other hand, it did both suggest and exemplify one of the routes that literary feminism would take through its investigation into
the
discrepancies
that existed
between
the
idealized
representations
american feminisms
71
women found of themselves in popular magazines aimed directly at them and their own lived experience as American housewives. Friedan examined the lives of women whose material lives could scarcely have been more comfortable ± they had enough money, nice houses, husbands and children, and all the labour-saving devices their husband's money could
buy.
She
uncovered,
however,
an
undercurrent
of
dissatisfaction,
neurosis
and
depression within those lives, in which the women themselves felt empty and insignificant. The women of the 1950s and 1960s appeared to her to be less liberated, less ambitious and far less satisfied than their mothers and grandmothers, the generations of women who had achieved suffrage, higher education and a degree of financial independence for themselves. They were less secure and less contented than the women who had lived through those struggles, and appeared to be objects of a backlash against the liberated women of the immediately
preceding
generations.
Often
college-educated
and
with
the
vote
long
achieved, these women had somehow been coerced back into the home, into the joint roles of homemaker and mother. The coercion was linked (though exactly how and why is not clear) to the conservative images fed to women by their own consumer culture. In the final chapter of
The Feminine Mystique
, Friedan suggested that the solution to the
problems encountered by such women was to be found in a serious response to educational opportunity. Women must make themselves a life-plan, and educate themselves to be more than `just' housewives. This would require a change of heart among women themselves, since too frequently they used their years of education and their early experiences of paid employment merely as time waiting for the right man to come along and `rescue' them from the ignominy of being a spinster-career-woman. It would also require a change in the educational system, away from training women to be mere homemakers, and towards a more intellectually stimulating curriculum. Finally, for the women already caught up in the feminine
mystique, it must be made
combine
their
undergraduate
learning and
with
graduate
possible
their
other
courses
be
for them
duties
±
so
to return Friedan
administratively
to education, and to
suggests
tailored
to
that
the
part-time
needs
of
the
housewife student. Friedan has been criticized for the narrow social focus of her book (with its insistent interest only in middle-class white American women), and it is certainly true to say that
Feminine Mystique
The
did not address the needs of those women who suffered acute material
deprivation, nor those who were further disadvantaged by a racist society because they were not white. Nonetheless, her example did offer important lessons for feminist literary theory and criticism in the years that followed. The housewives who took Friedan's advice and went back to college to gain an arts education in subjects such as literature or history might well have been disappointed by the curriculum they found there and the methodologies that they were to be taught. History had tended to be the study of the lives of `great men', and English literature had a rigidly exclusive canon, a great tradition containing, as Terry Eagleton has È as a marginal case' (1996a, 28). put it, `two and a half women, counting Emily Bronte Nonetheless, armed in part with Friedan's insight that the representations of women in literary
and
cultural forms can
have
real
effects on
the
lives
of
women
beyond
those
representations, female critics (they did not usually call themselves feminists because of the hostility such a label often produced) began a process of interrogating the canon, seeking not eternal truths and beauties, but rather investigating the truth status (or otherwise) of the images of women that they found therein. The force of what was essentially a content-based criticism was the presupposition of a woman reader in the pursuit of the woman's image, rather than the previous assumption of a male reader as the norm.
modern north american criticism and theory
72
Two of the earliest and most important discussions of the image of woman in literature (mostly
in
male-authored
(1968) and Kate Millett's
prose
fiction)
Sexual Politics
were
Mary
Ellmann's
Thinking About Women
(1969), each of which offers a very different
response to the material examined. Ellmann's book takes issue with what she calls the sexual analogy, in which the facts of the superior strength of the male and the prolonged nurturance of offspring by the female are turned into metaphors that govern the representation of every human action, even when these `facts' have no bearing on the matter in hand. Unlike Friedan, her focus is on the literary text, and on the representation of women within it. She argues that sexual analogy fatally infects literary representation with distortions of the truth. The images that (usually male) writers derive from their belief in the soft feminine woman and the hard warlike man must therefore be stereotypes. Stereotypes undermine both the literary value and
the
transcendent
truth-status
of
the
literary
text
because
of
their
fundamental
untruthfulness and self-evident absurdity. In readings of a wide range of contemporary fiction
(largely
from
the
1940s
through
to
the
1960s)
Ellmann
gently
and
wittily
demonstrates that the stereotypes are everywhere, and that they are always absurd. In particular, she suggests that female characters are almost always associated with formlessness, instability, confinement, piety, materiality, spirituality, irrationality and compliancy ± a list that in itself contains structural oppositions that necessarily render femininity as irrational: how can a woman be at once material and spiritual? And she concludes her discussion with a series of readings of two particularly long-standing types of fictional woman ± the witch and the shrew. Ellmann provides image criticism of a very sophisticated kind. Her arguments proceed through ironic understatements and juxtapositions rather than through strong statement.
Thinking About Women
is a creative performance as well as a critical one, and its poise and
irony unsettle the reader's certainties rather than setting out a polemical argument against what
she
perceives
as
the
wild
irrelevance
women in fiction. In contrast, Kate Millett's
and
inaccuracy
Sexual Politics
of
most
representations
of
, a much longer book, is also
much more forthright in foregrounding its own attitudes and assumptions. It was also a much more immediately successful book, becoming a bestseller in the English-speaking world soon after its publication (
Thinking About Women
has never enjoyed such success).
The reasons for the contrasts in fortune are not hard to fathom. Millett wrote a more or less sensationalist book of criticism, focusing as she did on the quasi-pornographic sex scenes in the works of a handful of male authors. And her response to these scenes is unmitigated fury ± the message against misogyny is far easier to follow in Millett's text than in Ellmann's. Millett's first chapter exemplifies her method. She extracts three sexually explicit sex passages from novels by the notoriously misogynistic Norman Mailer and Henry Miller, and from the work of French novelist and playwright Jean Genet. Her comments on each of these scenes demonstrate that there is a relationship in each of the writers between sexual potency and social and/or political power. She argues that the apparently private sexual relationships between men and women reflect the power structures in the world at large, hence her title,
Sexual Politics
, in which the private sphere of the bedroom becomes inescapably entwined
with the public sphere of politics. In addition, the representation of sexual relationships at once reflects, and is itself reflected by, the real. The falsity of such images of women matters, argues Millett, because it is to the cultural image that cultured beings turn in order to make their own self-images. What was once the reflection of the real becomes the real, and is then re-reflected in a never-ending interplay between image and reality.
american feminisms
73
As Toril Moi has noted, images of women criticism became for a while the dominant mode of feminist thought in American institutions. The publication of Susan Coppelman Kornillon's
edited
collection
of
essays
aimed
specifically
at
college
Images of
students,
Women in Fiction: Feminist Perspectives (1972) was influential on a whole generation of American college graduates, for whom it defined what feminist theory might mean. The essays
collected
in
Images of Women focused largely on male-authored texts, and dis-
covered, as Ellmann and Millett had done before them, that when men write about women they
often
write
inaccurately.
The
collection
had
certain
key
assumptions
that
have
subsequently been partially dismantled by feminist theory. It took for granted the idea that literature is supposed to be a more or less unmediated reflection of life; that life-experience and fictional representation of experience ought, therefore, to map onto each other; and that for the woman reader, the purpose of fiction is to find her own experience so that she can `identify' with her fictional counterparts. But, as Moi comments, a naive image critique is a theoretical dead-end. The `reality test' approach to literature leads to merely repeated critical gestures in which critics seek and find the same inaccuracies over and over again; the reader is led to assume that her own reality is a touchstone for the reality of all readers; and, in certain cases, image criticism fails to account for the persistence of the stereotype, fails to analyse the social context in which the type arises, fails to offer an alternative future ± a solution to the problem of representation (see Moi 1985, 42±9). In a 1979 essay entitled `Towards a Feminist Poetics', Elaine Showalter, again surveying the field of feminist criticism, identified what she saw as the two most usual modes of feminist practice. The first, which I have called `images of women' criticism, is named `feminist critique' by Showalter. She argued that this was a necessary first step in liberating the woman reader from masculine standards of judgement, but she went on to say that there were two fundamental problems with it as it had been practised to date. Firstly, it was `male-oriented', paying far too much attention to the texts of the male-authored canon; secondly, it had a tendency to `naturalize women's victimization by making it the inevitable and obsessive topic of discussion' ± a tendency, Showalter suggests, that could lead dangerously close to celebrating women's victim-status instead of challenging it (1986, 130±1). To prevent this danger, she suggested that academic feminism might choose as an alternative focus the figure of
`the
woman as writer', and she coined the term gynocritics to describe this focus.
Gynocritics was to be the study of literary writing by women, its key advantage that it would liberate feminist thought from a dependency on masculine models; in doing so, it would explode the canon by uncovering ± or inventing ± a separate, but equal, literary tradition in which women had participated. Gynocritics would interest itself in
woman as the producer of textual meaning, with the history, genres and structures of literature by women. Its subjects include the psychodynamics of female creativity; linguistics and the problem of female language; the trajectory of the individual or collective female literary career; literary history; and, of course, studies of particular writers and works. (1986, 128)
Gynocritics had, in fact, begun to take place, even before there was a word for it. For example,
Patricia
Meyer
Spacks's
The Female Imagination: A Literary and Psychological
Investigation of Women's Writing had been published in 1972. Spacks's argument was that a female tradition did, indeed, exist in literature. There were elements in women's writing that were transhistorical ± that remained constant despite the vagaries of time, history, geography and social class ± and that could be understood as `a woman's point of view' (Spacks 1976, 4). Moreover, she discovers not only a female tradition, but also the effects
modern north american criticism and theory
74
of women's specific problems in literature on female readers of those texts. Using the personal
(rather
than
academically
rigorous)
responses
of
her
own
classes
of
college
students, juxtaposed with her own more measured academic responses, Spacks dramatized the relationships between women as readers and women as writers. Covering quite a range of
texts,
genres
and
historical
periods,
the
book
argues
that
femininity
(the
cultural
construction of femaleness) is a double bind, both for writers and for their readers. Passivity, for example, is both attractive and dangerous ± attractive because it traditionally affords a technique for getting a man in marriage, dangerous because marriage itself can often be a deceptive state that is not nearly so ideal as romantic fictions portray it. Or, again, she argues that adolescence is felt very differently by women than by men. There is no book she says, that `celebrates female adolescence' (158), because adolescence is a time for secrecy and anxiety in women, not for a triumphant entry into the public world, as fiction often portrays it for men. Across history, therefore, women have chosen different solutions from men for the problems they face because the problems themselves are different, given the social set-up that proscribes such different lives for adult females than those it offers to adult males. In 1976, Ellen Moers also produced a text that performed a gynocritical method.
Women: The Great Writers
Literary
consists of chapters made up of essays that Moers had been
writing for at least ten years. Moers's focus is also very wide-ranging. She establishes the idea of a female tradition by appealing to writers' biographies, historical contexts and networks of literary influence (which often appear in surprising places); she also considers the significance of finance on women's writing; and she elaborates a theory of the Gothic as a female mode in fiction, a theory that develops very directly out of women's bodies and their material lives. Moers's introduction opens with the bold statement: `The subject of this book is the major women writers, writers we shall always read, whether interested or not in the fact that they happened to be women' (Moers 1985, ix). The bold assumption is that `great' women writers do, in fact, exist, and although Moers is careful not to call herself a feminist (the writers she is interested in just `happened to be women'), she is nonetheless anxious
to
emphasize
that
female
experience
±
especially
the
physical
and
psychical
consequences of femaleness ± are a legitimate subject for academic study. And, like Spacks, she is also sure that there are links between women
writers
because they are
women
writers.
For Moers, the female tradition, however, is often indirectly inherited, and is often elusive. Only in her description of the genesis and development of the female Gothic is she convinced of distinct networks of influence and of easily understood patterns of meaning that arise from the woman writer's female body. The Gothic, she says, is a literature of the body: it gets `to the body itself, its glands, muscles, epidermis, and circulatory system, quickly arousing and quickly allaying the physiological reactions to fear' (1985, 70). It arises because of the suppression in culture of the secrets of the female body (especially the taboos of menstruation, pregnancy and childbirth). And it finds a covert way to speak of the forbidden female. The definition of the female Gothic is important within
Women
as
a
whole
because
it
points
out
the
ways
in
which
a
female
Literary
tradition
will
necessarily be the result of both biology and culture ± of physiology and the repression of that physiology by different societies at different times. The book argues by implication that there is a commonality in all women's experiences, despite historical, geographical and social variations: and like Spacks, Moers assumes some congruence between the woman writer, the female character and the woman reader. There are problems with this view, to which I will return.
american feminisms
75
In 1977, Showalter produced her own explicitly gynocritical study,
È to Lessing, Own: British Women Novelists from Bronte
in
she
A Literature of their
which
set
out
to
place
individual women writers and their social, psychological and economic situations into a
larger
historical
picture
of
literary
influence
and
literary
value.
Thus,
rather
than
a
transhistorical appeal to a female imagination or tradition, Showalter provides a more nearly historicized approach to feminist theory and scholarship. She argues that there are distinctive phases of development in women's writing, phases that are reactions to specific historical and cultural conditions. She declares herself `uncomfortable with the notion of a ``female imagination'' ' because such a concept risks `reiterating the familiar stereotypes', and
renders
the
differences
between
men
and
women
in
writing
permanent
and
sex-
determined. Instead, her emphasis is on `not an innate sexual attitude, but [on] the ways in which the self-awareness of the woman writer has translated itself into a literary form in a specific place and time-span'; this enables her to argue that change and development in women's writing are possible (1978, 12). In her description of nineteenth- and twentiethcentury women's writing, she proposes that there have been three distinct phases: the feminine
phase,
roughly
from
1840
to
1880,
characterized
by
the
choice
of
male
pseudonyms as a strategy for evading a critical double standard, and by the disguise of subversive (feminist) content through displacement and irony; the feminist phase, 1880± 1920, the period of women's struggles for suffrage and education, in which women's writing became more overtly politicized and their texts spoke openly of female oppression; and finally, the female phase, from 1920 to the present, in which women's writing eschews the `dependency' on male models implied by imitation and protest, and turns unapologetically instead to female experience for its raw material (Showalter 1978, 13). The idea of the differences between women across time is important. For Showalter, women represent a sub-culture within the mainstream, coexisting in an uneasy symbiosis with the dominant, male-authored canon of the time. For women writing in the specific circumstances of Victorian England and its long aftermath, female sub-culture, she argues (as Moers had done before her), was characterized by secrecy, in particular the secrets of women's
bodies.
Because
women
could
not
write
directly
about
their
experiences
of
childbirth or menstruation, they tended to encode them into their texts as displaced images that only other women would notice and understand as shared markers of secret femininity. But perhaps more important than her commitment to some attempt at historicism is Showalter's commitment to the women writers who have never been classed among the `great'.
Spacks
and
Moers
focused
accepted as writers of literary quality.
almost
entirely
on
writers
A Literature of their Own,
who
have
usually
been
on the other hand, though it
È , George Eliot, Mrs Gaskell, Dorothy Richardson and does concentrate on Charlotte Bronte Virginia Woolf, also opens its pages to far less well known women writers, women whose names had more or less vanished from the literary canon (at least in 1977). Showalter notes that there has been a tendency for women writers to disappear, and for her, making a female tradition involves historical excavation of the texts that have not survived. It is only by considering even those whose works are `irreparably minor . . . Millicent Grogan as well as Virginia Woolf ± that we can begin to record new choices in a new literary history, and to understand why, despite prejudice, despite guilt, despite inhibition, women began to write' (Showalter 1978, 36). And, indeed, attention is accorded to the minor women, as well as the `great' ± though the attention is definitely skewed towards the `great', and Showalter clearly has some blindspots in relation to issues of literary value when she considers the minor writers.
modern north american criticism and theory
76
Two years later, in 1979, Sandra M. Gilbert and Susan Gubar published
The Madwoman
in the Attic: The Place of the Woman Writer in the Nineteenth-Century Literary Imagination .
It
is clear from their preface that in a relatively short period of time, the idea of a female tradition
in literature was pretty well secure.
They
cite
the works of both Moers
and
Showalter as having established without doubt that `nineteenth-century literary women
did
have both a literature and a culture of their own ± that . . . by the nineteenth century there was a rich and clearly defined female literary sub-culture, a community in which women consciously
read
methodological
and related to each impetus
derives
other's
not
only
works' (1979,
from
the
xii). Their theoretical
then
newly
developing
and
feminist
tradition of Moers and Showalter, but also from the aggressively masculinist writings of
The Anxiety of Influence.
Harold Bloom, in particular his 1973 book
Bloom's argument had
been that writers situate themselves in a tradition through violent reaction against their literary
forebears.
A
poet
is
validated
by
his
(all
Bloom's
examples
are
male)
hostile
rewritings of the texts of the past. The male writer is always engaged in a quasi-Oedipal struggle with his literary father for supremacy. The terms of this argument quite clearly, Gilbert
and
Gubar
suggest,
leave
no
space
for
the
woman
writer:
poets
have
no
metaphorical mothers, no significant relationships with women as women, or with women as readers and writers to whom their works might be addressed. Instead of the anxiety of influence, they propose as their model for the woman writer the
anxiety
of
authorship.
Women
fear
to
write
since
in
nineteenth-century
culture,
writing is a masculine activity, and value is only accorded to masculine production. The woman who chooses to write arrogates male power, and will necessarily fail to accrue literary
value
insignificant
since or
she
silly,
lacks
and
the
her
male
person
gift. will
Her be
literary
attacked
products as
will
be
monstrous
attacked
and
as
aberrantly
unfeminine. Gilbert and Gubar then set out to chart how nineteenth-century women writers
attempted
sustained
and
to
evade
impressive
or
confront
readings
of
the
the
hostile
works
of
literary
Jane
world.
Austen,
They
Mary
undertake
Shelley,
Emily
È , Charlotte Bronte È , George Eliot, Christina Rossetti and Emily Dickinson ± an Bronte alternative `great tradition' of women writers. They refer to a massive range of material ± from
Native
American
Wuthering Heights,
mythology
to
the
poetry
of
Sylvia
Plath
in
their
reading
of
for example ± and make connections between female experience and
female authorship across vast swathes of time and space. Their approach mixes traditional close readings of the texts with wide citation from critical material and with other more
tour de force;
eclectic detail. The book is a
it appears very persuasive and the readings of
individual texts remain important and fascinating. But the conclusions Gilbert and Gubar draw
about
Armstrong
the has
nature
argued,
of
a
they
female
are
often
tradition
are
dangerously
open
to
ahistorical
question, because
and of
as
their
Nancy will
to
connect the woman writer to her forebears (see Armstrong 1987, 7±8).
A Literature of their Own
and
The Madwoman in the Attic
are very important signpost
books that offered both a theory and a method for reading women's writing in its own terms. But like Friedan, Ellmann, Spacks and Moers before them, and for all the apparent inclusivity of their frames of reference, in the end Showalter and Gilbert and Gubar still offered
quite
a
partial
view
of
the
woman
writer.
One
criticism
has
been
that
their
concentration on nineteenth- and twentieth-century literature left earlier periods underrepresented, as if there was no such thing as a woman writer in earlier periods. But by far the most serious criticism of all these earlier manifestations of feminist criticism has come from black feminists. Where, in the elaboration of a female tradition, of female representation so
american feminisms
77
far, have been those `other women'? That is, where are the women who are not white, middle or upper class, straight and relatively privileged? Where are the non-housewives, those for whom work is not a choice or a privilege, but a necessity? In 1979, novelist, poet and critic Alice Walker spoke at Sarah Lawrence College in honour of Muriel Rukeyser. Her talk, subsequently published in
In Search of Our Mothers'
Gardens: Womanist Prose (1984), was entitled `One Child of One's Own: A Meaningful Digression Within the Work(s)'. It is a partially autobiographical piece, partly about the experience of maternity, partly about Walker's professional career as a writer and university teacher, and its theme is race and the race-blindness of white people that Walker has encountered. In one passage, she describes how she was, in the early 1970s, working at an upper-class college, teaching a course on black women writers: `There she shared an office with
a
white
woman
feminist
scholar
who
taught
poetry
and
literature.
This
woman
thought literature consisted predominantly of Nikki Giovanni, whom she had, apparently, once seen inadvertently on TV' (1984, 371). Walker, appalled by this ignorance tried to repair it by leaving books on her desks by black women writers such as Gwendolyn Brooks, Margaret Walker, Toni Morrison, Nella Larsen, Paula Marshall and Zora Neale Hurston, believing that this subtle approach would help. Some time passed, and then the white feminist scholar published her most famous book:
Dozens of imaginative women paraded across its pages. They were all white. Papers of the status quo, like the
Times, and liberal inquirers like The New York Review of Books and the
Village Voice, and even feminist magazines such as Ms . . . actually reviewed this work with varying degrees of seriousness. Yet to our young mother, the index alone was sufficient proof that the work could not be really serious scholarship, only serious white female chauvinism. (1984, 371±2)
The scholar was Patricia Meyer Spacks, and the book was
The Female Imagination. Walker
was not unnaturally infuriated to discover that for Spacks, and for many white feminists, the black woman scarcely counted as a woman at all. In
1977,
Barbara
Smith
had
also
noticed
the
yawning
gap
in
feminist
scholarship
represented by black female experience. In her essay `Towards a Black Feminist Criticism', she wrote that she did not know where to begin because writing about black women's experiences,
and
writing
specifically
about
black
lesbian
experiences,
had
never
been
tackled, even by `white women critics who think of themselves as feminists' (Smith, in Showalter 1986, 168). In many ways, Smith's essay restages some of the battles that white feminist scholars had already fought on their own behalf. First of all she has to establish that a
black
feminist
discourse
is
necessary.
After
all,
where
conditions
of
severe
material
deprivation exist, talking about books may not seem very important. But Smith suggests that political and aesthetic theories are one possible vehicle for raising the consciousness of oppressed groups, and knowing the terms of one's oppression is the prerequisite for tackling it. Moreover, because literature itself is a privileged category, claiming some of the value that goes with that privilege for black women writers is a highly charged political act that implies a claim of value for the lives of black women more generally. Black feminist theory necessarily entails a re-evaluation of the status of literary value and works back towards the lives of the women it represents. Smith suggested that black women's writing had to be read in the context of other black women's writing, rather than measured against some preexisting (white) standard. She advocated a criticism that focused in part on content, on its mediated reflections of lived experience, but she also argued that attention had to be paid
modern north american criticism and theory
78
to the forms, images, metaphors and plots that this writing expressed. In the examination of the
black
women's
forgotten),
black
tradition
feminist
(a
critics
tradition would
that
be
exists,
able
to
see
even that
if
it
had
been
`thematically,
buried
or
stylistically,
aesthetically and conceptually, black women writers manifest common approaches to the act of creating literature as a direct result of the political, social, and economic experience they have been obliged to share' (Smith, in Showalter 1986, 174). One would also discover a
`specifically
emphasis
on
black the
female
oral
language'
tradition.
expressing
These
forms
black
could
be
women's celebrated
experiences, when
seen
and in
an
their
proper context, not criticized for being improper, and such language might even then find their way into the discourses of criticism. Literary feminism, feminism in the academy in the United States, then, has largely been a matter of representation. In whatever guise it appears, it begins by looking at images of women, focusing on content. It then moves to consider the issue of the woman writer, and her representation in the canon, the academic institution and the publishers' lists. But where white feminist criticism was often content to describe what it perceived as the (white) woman problem, black feminist criticism, and the writings of other women of colour, is often much more radical in diagnosing its own problems and seeking change. As well as looking at issues of representation within the text, it also seeks a wider representation in the world beyond the text.
Ruth Robbins
Further reading and works cited Armstrong, N.
Desire and Domestic Fiction. Oxford, 1987.
Cornillon, S. Koppelman. Eagleton, T. Ð (ed.)
Images of Women in Fiction. Bowling Green, KY, 1972.
Literary Theory. Oxford, 1996a.
Feminist Literary Theory. Oxford, 1996b.
Ellmann, M.
Thinking About Women. New York, 1968.
The Feminine Mystique. Harmondsworth, 1992.
Friedan, B.
Gilbert, S. M. and Gubar, S. hooks, b.
Millett, K. Moers, E. Moi, T.
Sexual Politics. London, 1977.
Literary Women. Oxford, 1985.
Sexual/Textual Politics. London, 1985.
Poovey, M.
The Proper Lady and the Woman Writer. Chicago, 1984.
Showalter, E. Ð (ed.)
The Madwoman in the Attic. New Haven, CT, 1979.
Ain't I a Woman? London, 1982.
A Literature of their Own. London, 1978.
The New Feminist Criticism. London, 1986.
Ð. `Feminist Criticism in the Wilderness' and `Towards a Feminist Poetics', in
The New Feminist
Critic, ed. E. Showalter. London, 1986. Smith, B. `Towards a Black Feminist Criticism', In
The New Feminist Critic, ed. E. Showalter. London,
1986. Spacks, P. Meyer.
The Female Imagination. London, 1976.
Walker, A. `One Child of One's Own', in
In Search of our Mothers' Gardens. London, 1984.
12. Feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s: The Encounter with Poststructuralism and Gender Studies
It is commonplace in historical surveys of American feminism to identify a seismic shift ± in both subject matter and modes of inquiry ± near the end of the 1970s or beginning of the 1980s. Perhaps the most profound marker of this shift may be situated around the question of `difference'. As the previous article outlines, the academic feminisms of the 1960s and 1970s urged women to be resistant readers of the male literary canon and to reconsider women writers as part of a distinctly rich, differently established female canon. `Images of women' criticism (such as Kate Millett's or Judith Fetterley's) and `gynocriticism' (such as Elaine Showalter's, Sandra Gilbert's and Susan Gubar's) innovatively direct attention to issues
of
sexual
difference
within
the
western
literary
tradition,
laying
the
important
groundwork that has made feminism an undeniable force in academic discourse. Pointing to the ways women are excluded from or subsumed by prevailing concepts of reading, writing,
thinking
demonstrate
and
that
living,
humanism's
such
feminisms
supposedly
follow
universal
Simone
subject
de
was
Beauvoir's
actually
lead
only
and
male
all
along. For this mode of feminism, the difference between a male subject (or a purportedly ungendered one, which amounts to the same thing) and a female one makes a critical difference. And generally speaking, articulating this
difference it makes
difference between
and analysing what
was the central preoccupation of American feminist criticism prior to
1980. In the next two decades, by contrast, the contribution of feminists of colour, lesbian critiques, deconstruction, psychoanalysis and gender studies all serve to move the question of difference from a Much
of
the
difference between
energy
directing
this
to a
difference within.
shift
involves
feminism's
new
engagement
with
poststructuralism's powerful critiques of binary logic, particularly the logic that sanctions the
opposition
suspicious
of
within
the
sexual
extent
difference.
to which
its
As
own
such,
feminism
discourse
was
comes
to
dependent
be
upon
increasingly a
difference
between `men' and `women'. Because of this very suspicion towards oppositions, however, easy
divisions
determined especially
by
hard
between dates to
feminism
and
provide
`then'
descriptors in
and
calling
discussing
`now' for
also
prove
aetiologies
feminism's
unstable.
and
`encounter
And
definitions
with
surveys become
poststructuralism
and gender studies' since 1980. In the first place, a number of critics would dispute the notion that earlier feminist work was not concerned with or only naively aware of the theoretical challenges poststructuralism posed for those seeking to define a female literary tradition, or describing the experience of `reading like a woman', or expressing a unified
modern north american criticism and theory
80
feminist project. In her own survey, in fact, Naomi Schor emphasizes that feminism of the 1970s itself `was in fact part of a larger and very powerful critical trend of the early 1970s, the structuralist-poststructuralist critiques of mimetic representation' (1992, 265). In this regard, it might be useful to notice the continuities as well as the break between the two understandings of `difference' proposed above. For, as Schor implies, both feminist epochs intersect historically and intellectually with poststructuralist theories of representation, and both are concerned with `laying bare the sexual politics at work in seemingly innocent and authoritative imitations of social reality' (1992, 265). A further difficulty is that the very gesture of defining poststructuralism as a position, movement or method would be antithetical to those who stress that such an effort is misguided
from
the
start,
missing
precisely
what
poststructuralism
most
has
to
offer
±
namely, the critique of foundational `essence' as such. `Poststructuralism', asserts Judith Butler,
`is
not
exclusionary
strictly
speaking,
operations
by
position
a
which
,
but
``positions''
rather
a
[including
critical feminist
interrogation positions]
of
are
the
estab-
lished.' Linda Kauffman calls for a similarly rigorous self-consciousness and resistance to objective definition, stressing as well that poststructuralist critique involves a commitment to
a
continual
knowledge
work
in
progress:
`I
want
continually
to
cast
doubt
even as we are in the process of constructing it ±
±
a
on
the
status
perpetual
of
project.'
Poststructuralism is not grounded in a specific set of methods, except for a commitment to the `erosion of the very ground on which to take a stand', asserts Peggy Kamuf (all in Friedman 1995, 22). Diane Elam, writing about feminism and deconstruction, highlights the
problem
of
supposing
that
feminist
projects
that
`use'
deconstruction
or
other
poststructuralist theories simply bring together two discrete methods or movements (`they cannot
best
be
understood
as
movements')
to
make
a
new
one.
For,
more
than
just
historically, `there is a sense in which feminism already ``is'' deconstruction, and deconstruction ``is'' already feminism. And yet, with this said, they also do not collapse into one another and eliminate their differences' (Elam 1994, 9, 21). Such refusals have a strategic efficacy, indeed necessity, as well, for as Barbara Johnson warns, `[a]s soon as any radically innovative thought becomes an its
disciples
tend
conservative, (Johnson
at
1987,
to
become
which 11).
time
ism
, its specific ground-breaking force diminishes, . . . and
more its
Johnson
is
simplistic,
power
more
becomes
speaking
of
dogmatic,
institutional
and
ultimately
rather
`deconstructionism'
in
than
this
more
analytical'
instance,
but
her admonition is also in keeping with all of the above statements about feminism and poststructuralism (11). A similarly self-conscious impulse has brought a key feminist insight to new avenues of inquiry
we
regarding
could
the
place
`and'
in
under
the
`feminism
larger
and
heading
of
deconstruction'
`gender applies
studies'. equally
Elam's to
the
caution relation
between poststructuralism and gender studies as well, for in many ways gender studies `is' poststructuralist. (The other `and', however, requires circumspection. Schor cautions that `feminist and gender studies are not coextensive' and `cannot simply be collapsed onto each other' (1992, 275, 262).) If there is no category of identity that exists outside of culture, then understanding the construction of femininity must entail studying constructions of masculinity too, as well as the interaction and complicity of those constructs. For instance, Eve Kosofsky Sedgwick's important work on male `homosociality',
Men
in Between
(1985), examines the influence of patriarchal culture upon men's social interactions
with other men by means of methods feminists had previously used to study women. While Sedgwick's work is arguably `feminist' at its core, its focus on male rather than female
feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s
81
Episte-
gender construction also claims new intellectual territory. Her subsequent books,
mology of the Closet
Tendencies
(1990) and
(1993), have been particularly instrumental in
fostering the vitality of gay studies and `queer theory' of the late twentieth century. Other work one might place under the rubric of `gender studies' explores the implications of mainstream feminism's `compulsory heterosexuality', and works with a suspicion towards binary oppositions to promote a specifically lesbian critique of feminism's discourse on `women'. Naomi Schor points out, however, that it is misleading to assume that gay male gender studies and lesbian studies `fits neatly into the template of gay-gender studies' (1992, 280). As Sedgwick points out in the specific context of her literary study, it is important not
to
conflate
the
two
for
doing
so
overlooks
`an
asymmetry
in
our
present
society
between, on the one hand, the relatively continuous relation of female homosocial and homosexual bonds, and, on the other hand, the radically discontinuous relation of male homosocial and homosexual bonds' (1985, 4±5). Schor extends Sedgwick's point to a more general proviso for understanding the projects of contemporary gender studies. `[B]ecause male homosexuality threatens patriarchal society in a way that female homosexuality does not',
we
must
be
vigilant
about
recognizing
difference
here
as
well;
`there
is
no
gay
continuum' (1992, 281). Such a conflation would obscure as well the challenging role lesbian critique serves within a discourse she would still call `feminist'. Robyn Wiegman asserts such a role suggestively in a response to Susan Gubar in the pages of
Critical Inquiry.
For Wiegman, an avowedly poststructuralist lesbian critique came about and helped to bring about the epochal shift from a `difference between' to a `difference within' feminism, playing the important role of `the lesbian, [who] threatens to undermine from within the Edenic . . . unity' of a heterosexually grounded feminism (1999, 363). If they disavow definable method or unity of purpose, these assertions do nevertheless suggest a certain critical spirit or disposition we could characterize as specifically `poststructuralist'.
Structural
linguistics
stressed
the
arbitrary
and
differential
nature
of
sig-
nification, and poststructural theories brought that insight to bear on issues of psychic formation,
gender
identity
and
cultural
instantiations
of
sexual
difference
in
ground-
breaking ways. Correspondingly, all of these critics express an intellectual commitment to analytical rigour, scepticism and self-consciousness with regard to their object of study ± and in all of these cases, that object is
discourse
and that `object' includes their own. We
could also generalize that most academic feminism of the last two decades regards gender as a construction rather than a natural fact or an essence, produced by a complex set of social, political, psychic, racial, economic, historical, but most emphatically discursive or linguistic forces. The particular methodological orientation of a critic tends to be dictated by the privilege she gives to one or a combination of those forces. And in the high-stakes, often divisive
intellectual
climate
that
emerges
from
such
a
matrix
of
possibilities,
these
theoretical choices make all the difference. Though they do so in a vast heterogeneity of
ways,
arguably
all
academic
feminisms
of
the
last
two
decades
engage
in
this
self-
conscious approach and work from these basic premises ± or fail to do so at their peril. In a story many commentators tell, a number of concrete institutional changes also mark the transition between these two periods. Jane Gallop locates this foundational shift rather precisely `around 1981', a moment in which key incidents of continental drift take place: two major academic journals (Critical to
feminism;
poststructuralist
Inquiry
theory,
and
much
of
Yale French Studies) it
imported
from
devoted entire issues France,
gained
new
currency among many American feminists; and feminist inquiries that had largely been the domain of literary critics and members of English departments moved beyond their
modern north american criticism and theory
82
traditional disciplinary boundaries (Gallop 1992, 1±10). Many note that, more broadly, an institutional rite of passage seems to occur for feminism around this time. Citing Gallop, Naomi Schor adds that `such leading indicators as the exponentially growing list of feminist publications . . ., the proliferation of feminist sessions at the annual MLA convention, and . . . the tenuring of scholars primarily identified as feminist critics' ± including Gallop herself ± all point to the fact that `by the early 1980s feminist criticism and theory were without question no longer marginal activities, practiced by an embattled corps of largely untenured and powerless women' (275). Gubar notes that the last two decades have seen `some six hundred programs in Women's Studies . . . [develop] since the seventies' and `prominent feminist scholars serve as the presidents of major professional organizations', along with numerous other gains (2000, 157, 113). It would be misleading, however, to imply that this is simply a narrative of collective progress and exuberant solidarity. In fact, one of feminism's most suggestive theses is that such
narratives
are
necessarily
reductive,
that
they
necessarily
efface
the
incalculable
differences within the various categories feminism establishes for study. Though critics like Gubar and Wiegman warn against the seductiveness of casting early feminism as a lost Eden of either singular purpose or harmonious pluralism (whether to celebrate or castigate it), it is fairly safe to say that, in comparison with the body of feminist scholarship produced in the 1960s and 1970s, the subsequent proliferation of theoretical arguments and positions around the question of `women' and `gender' have rendered it effectively impossible to speak a `feminist project' in the singular. This theoretical heterogeneity has also led to new doubts
regarding
its
`collective'
goals
and
gains.
Somewhere
`around
1981',
it
seems,
feminism's very success story becomes the subject of scrutiny for critics who wonder whom this narrative leaves out and at what cost such `success' might come. Newly challenging assumptions about the insiders and outsiders of feminism, voices emerge with provocative questions. Who has been telling feminism's story? And who gets left out of that telling? Articulated
through
such
questions,
crucial
concerns
are
expressed
by
those
who
see
exclusionary powers at work within the feminist project as well as without. The discursive self-consciousness of the poststructuralist climate has encouraged scholars to consider the blind spots within the rhetoric and ideology of mainstream feminism itself. Under this lens, the largely white, middle-class, heterosexual bias at work in earlier feminist discourse comes into focus, ushering a new `generation' of critical work that regards gender as but one variable in the infinitely complex matrix of categories (such as race, class, nationality, religion, sexuality) that establish identity and structure power. bell hooks's pivotal 1981 publication, example,
posits
Ain't I a Woman: Black Women and Feminism , to give just one
`difference
feminism's method
within'
through
of locating exclusion or
the
question
occlusion to
of
race,
critique
applying
feminism
an
earlier
itself.
In
a
similar critical spirit, Gayatri Spivak also examines the difference at work in feminism and critical theory more generally. Her especially heterogeneous theoretical approach works from `within', both drawing from and critiquing poststructuralist theory to produce her influential
1988
psychoanalytic
book,
theory,
In
Other
Gayatri
Worlds.
Spivak
Working
expands
the
with black
marxist, feminist
deconstructive critique
of
and
`white'
feminism and grafts it to a critique of `French' feminism by placing both `in an international frame' (1988, 134). While offering translations of Indian short stories and literary analyses of texts as varied as Dante, Wordsworth and Woolf, this text also provides extremely influential essays on `subaltern studies'. Such studies consider the subject formation of the `subaltern', shaped in complex ways by the intersection of India's `culture of imperialism',
feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s
83
class hierarchies, gender, and recent historical shifts in global politics' (1988, 245). Related to the feminist effort to account for women in a history that has largely left them out, Spivak's project `attempt[s] to undo a massive historiographic metalepsis and ``situate'' the effect of the subaltern' by providing a detailed analysis of the existing `work of Subaltern Studies from within but against the grain' (205). Adumbrating questions of `difference within' and across race, class, nationality, history and political structures, Spivak's has proved foundational to the burgeoning field of `postcolonial studies', which has charted significant theoretical territory beyond the bounds of both feminism and gender studies. Her work provides just one illustration of how interdisciplinary and wide-ranging feminisms of the last decades have become, and the extent to which they engage with issues across a broad field of cultural and ethnic studies. As Gallop and so many others demonstrate, feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s show a similar preoccupation with the political effects of its own historiography. In her essay, `Making History: Reflections on Feminism, Narrative, and Desire', Susan Stanford Friedman
focuses
on
just
such
projects,
arguing
that
the
strategies
at
work
in
feminist
historiography have everything to do with the hotly contested question of not only what feminism has been and is, but also what it should be and will become. History, as she defines it, is more something we engage
in
a
`heuristic
activity'
do
than something that
and
to
stage
an
is.
To `make history' is both to
`intervention'.
As
Spivak
stresses
the
`interventionist value' and `strategy' of retelling a history with `the subaltern as the subject', Friedman considers interventionist strategies in various feminist historiographies (Spivak 1987, 207). She stresses that `writing the history of feminism functions as an act in the present that can (depending on its influence) contribute to the shape of feminism's future' (13). The purpose of citing Friedman here is, instead, largely heuristic. On the one hand, her project provides a fairly useful ± if somewhat arbitrary ± example of what premises broadly characterize feminism's `encounter' with
both
`poststructuralism and gender studies'.
On the other, it also occasions a duly self-conscious acknowledgement of the impossibility of justly synthesizing the voluminously heterogeneous body of work under its heading. In Elam's succinct words, `her-story
is not one story'
(1994, 37).
Primarily, and in the most general sense, Friedman approaches her subject from the premise that history `is' what we `make' it. It is a
construction.
Her argument is also informed
by the notion that `the politics of representation' is not simply a look at from an intellectual remove, but a profoundly
static structure
dynamic process
feminists
in which feminists
too ± including Friedman herself ± necessarily participate (1995, 18±19). That underlying distinction ± between a criticism that purports to study a static, external representational structure and a criticism that grapples with representation as a dynamic, co-implicating process of construction or `production' ± marks a key shift not only between `Feminism I' and `Feminism II', but from structuralism to poststructuralism writ large. In its attention to the
way
representational
dynamics
specifically
shape
feminist
narratives,
Friedman's
approach also indirectly echoes a guiding principle of scholars informed by intersections between deconstruction and post-Freudian psychoanalysis. She directly references Peter Brooks' theory of `narrative desire', a richly suggestive concept that insists upon a dynamic rather than static understanding of narrative, which Brooks formulates by juxtaposing Freud's drive theory with formalist and structuralist narratology. One could also read in her essay an indirect echo of projects like Johnson's, which bring deconstructive theoretical premises to bear on issues of `gender, race, literary genre, [and] institutional context' in consistently challenging ways. Johnson's pointed assertion that `the question of gender is a
modern north american criticism and theory
84
question of language' issues from the broader aims of a project she describes as `a critique of the fallacious naturalness and blinkered focus' of institutions and `articulations of power' that authoritatively claim reference to the `real world' (Johnson 1987, 37). For Johnson, the `real world' cannot be referenced except in quotation marks, a theoretical observation many poststructuralist feminists apply to the terms `woman' or `women' as well. Related to such projects are those that examine just how gender comes to be constituted by language, and Friedman's concerns point to another important avenue in feminist and gender studies: the issue of
performativity
. As Friedman's study asserts, accounts that say
where we are going and where we have been, to paraphrase the subtitle of the star-studded retrospective on feminist criticism at the December 1994 MLA convention, are, as that panel theatrically demonstrated to a capacity crowd,
performances
. They do not refer to pre-
existing categories of knowledge; they are produced and reproduced by being acted out. More simply put, as performances (or `speech acts'), they do something or make something happen. This emphasis on the performative construction of categories of knowledge we might assume are fixed or `natural' has especially informed Judith Butler's influential work in gender studies. Butler has taken into provocative new arenas Foucault's insistence on the historically-specific and ideologically-determined discursive construction `sex' in his landmark
History of Sexuality
(1976).
Butler
specifically
examines
both
gender
and
the
presumably `natural' and more primary category of `sex', arguing that the two function in a complex interrelationship, and that `gender is a performance that
produces
both
are indeed constructed rather than essential:
the illusion of an inner sex or essence or psychic
gender core' (1991, 28). Gender, for Butler, is a radically unstable category that exists only through repeated performances (iterations) by all of us who live within a sex-gender system (and that is everyone). Like much of the most innovative and challenging feminist theory to emerge in the last two decades, Butler's project both engages with and helps transform poststructuralism's radical critiques of representation, subjectivity and ideology. As Schor and Wiegman both suggest, the poststructuralist critique of essence and the expanding interdisciplinarity of gender studies has led a number of influential scholars to question the tenability and efficacy of that very adjective (`feminist') for critical theories aimed
at
examining,
even
dismantling,
the
humanist
subject
they
deem
irretrievably
phallogocentric. The most radical implication of such a critique is one that vexes some feminist orientations and invigorates others, namely that feminism's heuristic privileging of gender, on the word `women', as a guiding principle might be, in Biddy Martin's bold words, `plagued from the outset' and even `may have outlived its usefulness' (Martin 1997, 104, 106). A number of debates over the state of feminist theory at the turn of the century laments such propositions as grievously self-defeating. With a problematic deployment of terms
too
complex
to
delineate
here,
a
number
of
critics
lay
blame
at
the
feet
of
`poststructuralism' itself (arguably by means of poststructuralist premises), charging it with an extreme constructivism that denies any validity to the collective identity categories feminism claims in the service of its `cause' (see Gubar 2000, 113±34). Gubar complains that feminist discursive self-consciousness too often devolves into
ad feminam
accusations
of political bad faith. Similarly, Friedman worries that an unselfconscious commitment to self-consciousness could foster inertia: `first danger is the problem of paralysis, the kind of infinite regress and fetishization of indeterminacy that can develop out of constant navelgazing.
Perpetual
self-reflexivity
±
particularly
with
its
continual
focus
on
linguistic
construction ± contains within it the potential of dangerous inaction' (Friedman 1995, 25). The radical and relentless `differencing' feminist theory demands, however, need not
feminisms in the 1980s and 1990s
85
signal defeat, nor imply the job is not still worth doing. And, as Daphne Patai suggests, discursive self-consciousness is not theory's only concern: `It is a mistake to let ourselves be overwhelmed by these problems. The fact that doing research across race, class, and culture is a messy business is no reason to contemplate only our difficulties and ourselves struggling with them' (in Friedman 1995, 25). Patai's comment also implicitly points to the possibility that such criticisms misidentify their culprit. Wiegman vehemently responds to Gubar's diagnosis of `What Ails Feminism?' (a version of an essay originally called `Who Killed Feminism?') with a Socratic apology,
reminding
her
of
a
distinction
between
poststructuralism
done
badly
and
poststructuralism as such: `While it is always the case that critical modes of analysis spawn reductive and predictable scholarship . . ., it does not follow that the existence of such scholarship renders illegitimate the intellectual value of the trajectories of analysis being pursued' (1999, 369). Gubar refines her criticism in a response to Wiegman, protesting that what she laments, more precisely, are `boring, . . . routinized default positions [that] inhibit what one would ordinarily call thinking, making it hard for people to risk ideas that do not toe what is assumed to be a morally superior or epistemologically more sophisticated line' (1999,
381).
Wiegman's
and
Gubar's
debate
broader contentions within feminist theory,
is
illuminating
not
just
because
but also for the unified demand
it
(though each might object to the notion of such a unity). Sparring on the pages of
Inquiry,
stages
it makes
Critical
both invoke the importance of critical inquiry that proceeds in the face of risk ± the
risk of bad manners or bad grammar, perhaps, but more profoundly, the risk of genuine
thinking.
Implicitly defending herself against Gubar's charge that her bad grammar is one of
the symptoms of what ails feminism, Butler rebuts that it is a `mistake to think that received grammar is the best vehicle for expressing radical views, given the constraints that grammar imposes upon thought, indeed, upon the thinkable itself' (Butler 1999, xviii±xix). Barbara Johnson,
who
might
remind
both
Gubar
and
Wiegman
of
the
theoretical
value
of
`depersonalization' or `self-resistance' in their disagreements with one another, acknowledges the pitfalls of a poststructuralism on autodrive: `It can lead to a kind of infinite regress of demystification, in which ever more sophisticated subtleties are elaborated within an unchanging field of questions' (Johnson 1987, 42±6, 15). More to the point, she demands a rigorous
self-consciousness
that
does
not
equate
with
mere
`navel-gazing',
but
rather
remains vigilant against it. Like Butler's commitment to think the unthinkable, Johnson insists that the feminist interrogation of difference demands a commitment to `what can never be taken for granted' (16). `The impossible but necessary task of the reader is to set herself up to be surprised' (15). As such debates and avowals variously demonstrate, no matter how scholarship narrates the development of feminist study throughout the final decades of the twentieth century, a general
(if
not
generalizable)
discursive
tenor
does
emerge.
Although
with
widely
divergent, variously ominous tones, feminism in the 1980s and 1990s is anything but complacent with ± or convinced of ± its purported success. Attributed to a great diversity of causes
±
generational,
institutional,
political,
social,
practical
and
philosophical
±
the
critical mass of critical discourse on feminism of late explicitly locates itself at a particularly pivotal historical moment, at an uneasy crossroads where the work of the past calls for crucial new work to be done in the future. A cursory survey of titles from the period with which this article is concerned provides a telling snapshot of this richly overdetermined moment:
Conflicts in Feminism, Gender Trouble, Feminism Beside Itself, Feminist Contentions,
Generations, Critical Condition.
Joan Wallach Scott explains that she named the special
modern north american criticism and theory
86
issue of
differences she edited `Women's Studies on the Edge' ± an issue that included essays
with such provocative titles as `The Impossibility of Women's Studies' and `Success and Its Failures' ± to highlight the `sense of precariousness and uncertain anticipation' that marks this `time of transition' (Scott 1997, iii, iv). Scott sees troubling irony in the fact that this academic journal comes out just as
Time magazine asks on its cover, `Is Feminism Dead?'
(accompanied by Ally McBeal's pouty visage silently saying `yes'), but also recognizes a continued need and promise for feminist discourse in the future. Writes Scott:
An
edge
is
not
only
a
point
of
transition,
but
also
a
site
of
contestation,
a
place
where
differences become apparent and are erased, where lines divide and converge, and where new configurations emerge ± a place of anxiety and irritability, to be sure, but also one of great energy and vitality ± a cutting edge, in other words, in the worst and best senses of the term. (Scott 1997, iv)
In this special issue and beyond, the many rich proposals and daring rehearsals of what this
project
should
entail
similarly
suggest
that
the
`feminism'
of
the
future
will
be
contentious, multivocal, difficult, even impossible ± yet still vital and necessary, a perpetual project.
Megan Becker-Leckrone
Further reading and works cited Benhabib, S. et al.
Feminist Contentions. New York, 1995.
Brown, W. `The Impossibility of Women's Studies',
differences: A Journal of Feminist and Cultural
Studies, 9, 3, 1997. Butler, J. `Imitation and Gender Insubordination', in Ð.
Inside/Out, ed. D. Fuss. New York, 1991.
Gender Trouble. New York, 1999. Feminism and Deconstruction. New York, 1994.
Elam, D.
Ð and Wiegman, R. (eds) Foucault, M.
Feminism Beside Itself. New York, 1995.
The History of Sexuality. New York, 1976.
Friedman, S. Stanford. `Making History' in
Feminism Beside Itself, eds D. Elam and R. Wiegman. New
York, 1995. Fuss, D.
Essentially Speaking. New York, 1989.
Gallop, J.
Around 1981. New York, 1992.
Gubar, S. `Notations Ð.
in Medias Res', Critical Inquiry, 25, 1999.
Critical Condition. New York, 2000.
Hirsch, M. and Keller, E. Fox (eds) hooks, b.
Johnson, B. Ð.
Conflicts in Feminism. New York, 1990.
Ain't I a Woman. Boston, 1981. A World of Difference. Baltimore, MD, 1987.
The Feminist Difference. Cambridge, 1998.
Looser, D. and Kaplan, E. Ann
Generations. Minneapolis, MN, 1997.
Martin, B. `Success and Its Failures', Moi, T. Scott, J.
differences: A Journal of Feminist and Cultural Studies , 9, 3, 1997.
Sexual/Textual Politics. New York, 1985. Gender and the Politics of History. New York, 1988.
Scott, J. Wallach. `Women's Studies on the Edge. Introduction',
differences: A Journal of Feminist and
Cultural Studies, 9, 3, 1997. Schor, N. `Feminist and Gender Studies', in
Introduction to Scholarship in Modern Languages and
Literatures, ed. J. Gibaldi. New York, 1992. Seagwick, E. Kosofsky.
Between Men. New York, 1985.
psychoanalysis and literary criticism Ð. Ð.
87
Epistemology of the Closet Tendencies The New Feminist Criticism In Other Worlds Feminist Practice and Poststructuralist Theory . Berkeley, CA, 1990.
. Durham, NC, 1993.
Showalter, E. (ed.)
. New York, 1985.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty.
. New York, 1988.
Weedon, C.
. Oxford, 1997.
Wiegman, R. `What Ails Feminist Criticism? A Second Opinion',
Critical Inquiry
, 25, 1999.
13. Psychoanalysis and Literary Criticism
Surveying
the
work
of
Peter
Brooks,
Barbara
Johnson,
Shoshana
Felman,
Neil
Hertz,
Cynthia Chase or any of the innumerable others who could be added to this list provides ample evidence that some of the most significant contributions to recent psychoanalytic criticism and theory have come from scholars working in the United States. Today, critics at the forefront of this theoretical discourse almost invariably draw from poststructuralist understandings
of
reading,
language,
representation
and
subject
formation
that
were
initially `imported' from Europe in the 1970s. More often with the aid of than to the exclusion
of
prominent
similar
discourses
American
efforts
in
to
England,
juxtapose
France,
Germany
psychoanalysis
and
and
elsewhere,
literature
the
most
emphasize
the
complexity involved in the pairing. Some important common aims emerge among these projects:
an
interest
in
psychoanalysis
as
a
rich
site
for
exploring
the
vicissitudes
of
interpretation and theory as such, including one's own; an emphasis on the fruitful analogy between the workings of language or signification and the workings of the unconscious (often prompted by Jacques Lacan's linguistic `return to Freud'); an effort to explore not just what psychoanalytic theory can tell us about literature, but also, importantly, what literature or literary study can tell us about psychoanalysis or interpretation as such. Despite the possibility of such a generalization, however, it is also important to point out that recent critics approach these concerns by way of a fairly heterogeneous set of theoretical models, from Freudian to Lacanian vocabularies, from structuralist narratology to deconstructive rhetorical analysis, from feminism to marxism, from psychoanalytic readings of literature to literary readings of psychoanalysis. For these reasons, in fact, it seems specious to speak of
an
American psychoanalytic criticism as such, or an
criticism, or ± for that matter ± an American projects we
could practically place
psychoanalytic
American
psychoanalytic
criticism. The most suggestive
under such a heading have diverse aims and cross
national as well as discursive boundaries. It seems worth pointing out, in this regard, that all of the critics cited above are ± in both training and teaching ± comparatists. We might say that this state of the field is as it should be, since the first psychoanalytic literary critic was Sigmund Freud himself, an Austrian whose most famous theoretical formula borrowed from the plot of a Greek drama, and whose `scientific' study of the unconscious so often took him to the speculative reaches of religion, philosophy and art. Yet despite ± or perhaps because of ± Freud's formidable precedent, in
Dreams
The Interpretation of
and elsewhere, the critical juxtaposition of psychoanalysis and literature has always
been a rather anxious exercise. As Brooks himself admits at the outset of a recent essay:
psychoanalysis and literary criticism Ð. Ð.
87
Epistemology of the Closet Tendencies The New Feminist Criticism In Other Worlds Feminist Practice and Poststructuralist Theory . Berkeley, CA, 1990.
. Durham, NC, 1993.
Showalter, E. (ed.)
. New York, 1985.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty.
. New York, 1988.
Weedon, C.
. Oxford, 1997.
Wiegman, R. `What Ails Feminist Criticism? A Second Opinion',
Critical Inquiry
, 25, 1999.
13. Psychoanalysis and Literary Criticism
Surveying
the
work
of
Peter
Brooks,
Barbara
Johnson,
Shoshana
Felman,
Neil
Hertz,
Cynthia Chase or any of the innumerable others who could be added to this list provides ample evidence that some of the most significant contributions to recent psychoanalytic criticism and theory have come from scholars working in the United States. Today, critics at the forefront of this theoretical discourse almost invariably draw from poststructuralist understandings
of
reading,
language,
representation
and
subject
formation
that
were
initially `imported' from Europe in the 1970s. More often with the aid of than to the exclusion
of
prominent
similar
discourses
American
efforts
in
to
England,
juxtapose
France,
Germany
psychoanalysis
and
and
elsewhere,
literature
the
most
emphasize
the
complexity involved in the pairing. Some important common aims emerge among these projects:
an
interest
in
psychoanalysis
as
a
rich
site
for
exploring
the
vicissitudes
of
interpretation and theory as such, including one's own; an emphasis on the fruitful analogy between the workings of language or signification and the workings of the unconscious (often prompted by Jacques Lacan's linguistic `return to Freud'); an effort to explore not just what psychoanalytic theory can tell us about literature, but also, importantly, what literature or literary study can tell us about psychoanalysis or interpretation as such. Despite the possibility of such a generalization, however, it is also important to point out that recent critics approach these concerns by way of a fairly heterogeneous set of theoretical models, from Freudian to Lacanian vocabularies, from structuralist narratology to deconstructive rhetorical analysis, from feminism to marxism, from psychoanalytic readings of literature to literary readings of psychoanalysis. For these reasons, in fact, it seems specious to speak of
an
American psychoanalytic criticism as such, or an
criticism, or ± for that matter ± an American projects we
could practically place
psychoanalytic
American
psychoanalytic
criticism. The most suggestive
under such a heading have diverse aims and cross
national as well as discursive boundaries. It seems worth pointing out, in this regard, that all of the critics cited above are ± in both training and teaching ± comparatists. We might say that this state of the field is as it should be, since the first psychoanalytic literary critic was Sigmund Freud himself, an Austrian whose most famous theoretical formula borrowed from the plot of a Greek drama, and whose `scientific' study of the unconscious so often took him to the speculative reaches of religion, philosophy and art. Yet despite ± or perhaps because of ± Freud's formidable precedent, in
Dreams
The Interpretation of
and elsewhere, the critical juxtaposition of psychoanalysis and literature has always
been a rather anxious exercise. As Brooks himself admits at the outset of a recent essay:
modern north american criticism and theory
88
The enterprise hasn't on the whole made a good name for itself. It's in fact most often been something of an embarrassment . . . I find myself resisting the label `psychoanalytic critic' ± though no doubt I am one, in some sense still to be defined ± and worrying about the legitimacy and force that psychoanalysis may claim when imported into the study of literary texts. (Brooks 1994, 20)
He speaks here, presumably, of an embarrassment that comes from within, generated by his ambivalent membership in a group whose `legitimacy and force' he finds questionable. That
critical
positioning
performs
a
self-consciousness
that,
because
it
is
a
prominent
feature of much recent psychoanalytic literary criticism, warrants further consideration. But first, it is instructive to consider the more obvious state of affairs Brooks implicitly glosses. For when he worries that the `notion of a psychoanalysis applied to literature continues to evoke
reductive
categories',
he
maneuvers
seems
to
that
assign
flatten
blame
the
to
richness
both
of
creative
`reductive'
critics
texts
and
into
an
well-worn
audience
that
maintains stereotypical expectations about what psychoanalysis does in the first place. The ambiguous origin Brooks assigns to this mistaken `notion' in one sense acknowledges the deep, long-standing and overdetermined popular resistance to psychoanalysis generally and psychoanalytic applications to literature in particular. As Maud Ellmann puts it, `Freudian literary criticism causes a peculiar form of irritation' uniquely able, it seems, `to elicit sniggers of embarrassment or snorts of disbelief' (Ellmann 1994, 1). In her lucid introduction to a collection of such essays by prominent continental and Anglo-American critics, Ellmann attributes that reaction in part to the audacious strangeness of Freud's intellectual
project
and,
ultimately,
to
the
profoundly
troubling
implications
of
his
proposals. Thus, like Brooks' `embarrassment', this `visceral' reaction, she suggests, should not
necessarily
be
discounted
or
lamented.
For
in
a
certain
sense
`a
gut
resistance
to
psychoanalysis often signifie[s] a deeper recognition of its danger than [does] a prompt assimilation of its principles' (1). We could say that much recent criticism privileges the forces of `resistance' over impulses towards `assimilation' that occur when psychoanalysis and literature encounter one another, often by finding an inherent, analogous, kind of resistance in Freud's efforts to interpret the unconscious and critics' efforts to interpret literature. Ellmann argues that the latter reaction ± assimilation rather than resistance ± more aptly characterizes Freud's initial reception within American intellectual culture, from a medical community that developed from Freud the positivistic `ego-psychology' Lacan would so virulently attack, to a critical community prone to unsubtle applications of psychoanalysis to study the authors, characters and thematics of literary texts. What proves problematic, however, is that it may still be harder to confront an eager appropriation of psychoanalytic principles for the vocabulary of literary criticism than it is to confront a popular dismissal or resistance to such an approach. The history of Freud's reception in this country bears out this paradoxical truth: the alacrity with which some critics sought to `apply' psychoanalysis to literature
has
proven
a
more
onerous
legacy
than
the
suspicion
with
which
others
greeted it. In this sense, there is no real irony in the fact that the pioneering American psychoanalytic
critic
Frederick
Crews,
for
instance,
would
famously
come
to
reject
psychoanalysis as a hermeneutic tool, for, as Ellmann wryly observes, he `seems to have talked himself out of psychoanalysis precisely by applying it too heavyhandedly' (Ellmann 1994, 2). Crews'
Out of My System
, a collection written between 1967 and 1975, gives one
notable record of this ambivalence. In it, he offers a reading of Conrad's
Heart of Darkness
±
the images of castration and primal horror bespeak Marlow's and perhaps even Conrad's
psychoanalysis and literary criticism
89
own Oedipal anxieties, he suggests ± in the midst of a pervasively anxious meditation on the efficacies and pitfalls of his own critical method. Before and after cataloguing a series of thematic `[d]erivatives of the primal scene' that `await the hero everywhere' and `belabor[ing] the obvious point' that
Heart of Darkness
is deeply autobiographical, Crews concedes
that
Freudian criticism too easily degenerates into a grotesque Easter-egg hunt: find the devouring mother, detect the inevitable castration anxiety, listen . . . for the bedsprings of the primal scene.
A
critic
who
may
have
been
drawn
toward
Freud
by
the
promise
of
a
heightened
sensitivity to conflict in literature may, without ever knowing what has happened to him, become the purveyor of a peculiarly silly kind of allegory. (Crews 1975, 57±8)
But while Crews self-effacingly includes himself among such potentially wayward critics, he also expresses a certain pride in managing to knock literature off the liberal humanist pedestal that he claims, in a questionable hybridization, was kept erect in the twentieth century
by
`New-Critical
formalism
and
...
Northrop
Frye'
(167).
Arguing
that
his
methods expose the intentional fallacy of a purportedly less self-conscious criticism that supposes its object fully realized by the express motivations of its creator, Crews takes a `satisfaction in brushing past formal or generic or ironic or (above all) morally uplifting aspects of literature and showing instead that even the sublimist masterpiece traffics in unconscious wishes' (1975, 167). Throughout his meditation, which includes the imagined protests of `detractors' and `nonpsychoanalytic colleagues' (resistance of the common variety), Crews nevertheless sidesteps the more unsparing discursive self-consciousness (`self-resistance', to use Barbara Johnson's term) that a subsequent generation of psychoanalytic literary criticism would insist upon (Johnson 1987, 42±6). The latter generation, indeed, would make it a central aim
to
account
for
the
motivations
of
criticism
itself,
to
avoid
the
condition
of
an
unreflective critic (`without ever knowing what has happened to him . . .'). For despite the appearance of conscientious reflection, Crews never wavers from nor seeks to ground the operating literature
premise might
that
be
in
literary any
way
content
deserves
resistant
to
his
privilege
brand
of
over
literary
hermeneutic
form
or
detective
that
work.
`Using psychoanalytic assumptions', he writes, `a critic can show how a writer's public intention
was
evidently
deflected
by
a
private
obsession
...
Or
again,
he
can
draw
biographical inferences on the basis of certain recurrent themes that the author hadn't consciously meant to display' (168). Peter Brooks, working in large part from the formalism Crews considers retrograde, locates much of the embarrassment associated with `the label ``psychoanalytic critic'' ' in this very assumption; namely, in the notion of psychoanalysis as a stable master discourse that may treat a text as an unmediated record of a particular psyche. Brooks situates that idea in a larger tradition of criticism that has `over and over again mistaken the object of analysis, with the result that whatever insights it has produced tell us precious little about the structure and rhetoric of literary texts' (1994, 21). A telling demonstration of the shift in analytical object Brooks effects occurs in his own penetrating reading of describe
a
series
of
Heart of Darkness
psychic
, which stresses that the novel does not simply
experiences,
but
presents
them
within
complex
frames
of
narration, so that it proves important to consider how and why Marlow tells the story he tells,
and
why
Conrad
might
have
had
him
do
so
(1984,
238±63).
Calling
for
and
producing a criticism that avoids the traditional analysis of author, reader or character, Brooks instead emphasizes, so to speak, a psychoanalysis of textuality, acknowledging at the
modern north american criticism and theory
90
same time the overdetermined textuality of psychoanalysis itself. Whereas Crews considers
hermeneutics
psychoanalytic criticism a
(which aims at unveiling the latent meaning of
poetics
manifest textual content), Brooks considers it a
(which aims at describing how
particular textual elements work to achieve meaning). One central preoccupation for him, in
this
regard,
has
been
to
develop
an
emphatically
dynamic
poetics
of
plot
he
calls
`narrative desire', formulated by putting the relatively static models of formalist narratology together with Freudian drive theory, in order to describe not only how plots tend to be structured but what moves them forward. Rather than unveil `the meaning' of Marlow's journey into the heart of darkness, Brooks looks at the way Conrad's text, with its ironically framed narration, is itself
about
revelation. The force that moves the narration forward is
driven by Marlow's need to retell the story of his search for Kurtz, so that he may construct a meaning ± a `readable report' ± out of an initial experience (an `unreadable report') that disturbingly thwarts his epistemological desire, his desire to know, his need for the end of that journey to be indeed a `summing-up' (Brooks 1984, 247±8). Throughout, Brooks is careful to align such a `motor force' with the conventional tendencies of narrative and interpretations as such. His
often-anthologized
essay,
`Freud's
Masterplot',
provides
useful
illustration
of
the
current interest in reading psychoanalytic texts through the lens of literary study, as well as the reverse. Aristotle's study of reversal and recognition, Tzvetan Todorov's description of `narrative transformation' and Frank Kermode's `sense of an ending' are just some of the careful analyses of literary form Brooks incorporates into his reading of Freud's plotting and
Beyond the Pleasure Principle.
narrative strategies in
Brooks argues, in turn, that Freud's own
discursive style offers a suggestively dynamic `model' for thinking about `movement of plot and
its
motor
force
in
human
desire,
its
peculiar
relation
to
beginnings
and
ends,
its
apparent claim to rescue meaning from temporal flux' (Brooks 1984, 90). Exploring the dynamics of beginning and ending at stake not just in Freud's theory of the death drive but also in the very `plot' Freud's discourse produces, Brooks identifies a complex set of parallels between literary and psychoanalytic textuality ± and offers at the same time a provocative statement
of
purpose
that
claims
to
break
from
the
tradition
of
which
Crews
was
an
instrumental part. He writes:
[W]e can read
Beyond the Pleasure Principle
as a text concerning textuality and conceive that
there can be a psychoanalytic criticism of the text that does not become . . . a study of the psychogenesis of the text (the author's unconscious), the dynamics of literary response (the reader's unconscious), or the occult motivations of characters (postulating an unconscious for them). It is rather the superimposition of the model of the functioning of the psychic apparatus on the functioning of the text that offers the possibility of a psychoanalytic criticism. (Brooks 1984, 112)
Brooks stresses that his theory does not claim to account for the workings of a particular mind ± that of the author, reader or character ± but rather, as he states it here, of the `psychic
apparatus'
`[p]sychoanalysis recent
as
and
psychoanalytic
such.
This
focus
literature
are
critics.
Two
belongs
mutually
to
an
explicitly
illuminating',
influential
collections
a of
stated
premise essays
premise
shared devoted
by to
that
many that
mutuality emphasize both the potential force of such a pairing and the radical uncertainty it can elicit. Shoshana Felman, in the preface to
of Reading: Otherwise, and
Literature and Psychoanalysis: The Question
enumerates a new set of questions critics need to ask: `What does the
really mean? What is its conventional sense, its traditional function, in the usual
psychoanalysis and literary criticism
91
approach to the subject? In what way would we like to displace this function (to reinvent the ``and'') ± what would we like it to mean, how would we like it to work, in this issue?' (Felman 1977, 5). Her response is that the `traditional function' of this `and' has been far from
neutral,
subordination
typically
`implying
not
so
much
a
relation
of
coordination
as
one
of
. . . in which literature is submitted to the authority, the prestige of psycho-
analysis' (5). Felman argues that too often literature is presumed to be a static, passive `body of
language'
or signs to be interpreted by psychoanalysis' masterful `body of
knowledge'
± a
presupposition, as we have seen, on which Crews' hermeneutical approach depends (5, emphasis Felman's). Underlining the suggestive etymology of her proposed term, she calls instead
for
a
shift
from
application
to
implication
(`being
folded
within'),
where
the
`interpreter's role would be . . . to act as a go-between, to generate implications between literature and psychoanalysis', for instance the fact that literature is `not simply psychoanalysis, since it motivates and
inhabits
outside
the very names of its concepts' (9). While
`they are really traversed by each other', literature and psychoanalysis as Felman sees them also
contain
differences;
they
are
`other'
to
one
another,
each
other's
`blind
spot'
or
`unthought' (10). Thus, Felman's volume raises the stakes. The psychoanalytic project is complicated and fixed on new aims, with the question of reading at the centre.
[The
essays]
all
reflect
upon
the
textual
and
theoretical
encounter
between
literature
and
psychoanalysis not as an answer but as a question, questioning at once its possibilities and limits. They thus suggest . . . how the question of the relationship . . . might be articulated ±
otherwise:
how psychoanalysis and literature might indeed begin to be rethought, both in their otherness and in their common wisdom. (10)
Felman's own critical work ± such as the essay on Henry James and Freud, `Turning the Screw of Interpretation', included in this volume, and
Insight
Jacques Lacan and the Adventure of
(1980), which includes important essays on the place of literary examples in the
work of Freud and Lacan ± demonstrates a commitment to a rigorously self-conscious psychoanalytic criticism and a complicated understanding of literature's `implication' in it. The preface and selection of essays in another important collection ,
the Question of the Text, those
expressed
by
Psychoanalysis and
edited by Geoffrey Hartman, states a theoretical purpose similar to
Brooks
and
Felman.
Hartman
begins
by
somewhat
distinguishing the psychoanalytic criticism of an earlier period from
disdainfully
the efforts
of the
critics for whom he speaks, echoing the discursive mutuality Felman espouses:
This volume does not contain something for everyone. It reflects the considerable and, one hopes, fruitful complication of psychoanalytic studies as they accept their mutual rather than masterful relation to language and literature. Those who expect literary case studies will be disappointed
...
Every
essay
included
here
is,
if
anything,
too
conscious
of
the
changing
vocabularies and modified models of applied analysis, and particularly of the inadequacy of the applied science model of analysis itself. The emphasis has shifted from producing yet another interpretation, yet another exercise in casuistry, to understanding from within the institutional developments of psychoanalysis, and from the inner development of Freud's writings, what kind of event in the history of interpretation is proving to be. (Hartman 1978, vii)
From that initial provocation, however, Hartman takes a longer view to the past than Felman does, reflecting on Freud's place in a literary critical history that includes romantic and New Critical meditations on character and identity. While he too sees a determined shift in focus and method in the psychoanalytic criticism his collection showcases, he is also careful to acknowledge that the earliest literary critical efforts to engage with Freud did
modern north american criticism and theory
92
not
produce
a
mere
wasteland
of
naive
application,
as
Brooks,
Felman
and
others
sometimes imply. Along with a nod to Kenneth Burke, he favourably cites Lionel Trilling for probing the limits of the ego's unity in literary works, and for `raising this issue within a perspective that remains literary but assimilates in a highly critical way both Freudian and sociological currents of thought' (Hartman 1978, x). And indeed, Trilling's
Imagination the
The Liberal
contains a thoughtful meditation on `Freud and Literature' first published in
Kenyon Review
in 1940, where he presciently observes that `it was left to Freud to
discover how, in a scientific age, we still feel and think in figurative formations, and to create, what psychoanalysis is, a science of tropes, of metaphor and its variants, synecdoche and metonymy' (Trilling 1947, 51). Trilling's observation is closer to Brooks' own methodologies than the latter's diagnosis of the criticism's mistaken objects seems to allow, and it suggests, as Ellmann also does, that we would do well to look beyond `such howlers' as Crews' reading of Conrad in evaluating a diverse, complex critical history (Ellmann 1994, 2). Trilling's description of psychoanalysis as a `science of tropes' suggests particular continuity with Brooks' explanation for why interest in psychoanalysis and literature persists:
We continue to dream of a convergence of psychoanalysis and literary criticism because we sense that there ought to be, that there must be, some correspondence between literary and psychic process, that aesthetic structure and form, including literary tropes, must somehow coincide with the psychic structures and operations they both evoke and appeal to. (Brooks 1994, 25)
Even Trilling's otherwise traditional reading of Wordsworth's `Immortality Ode', in the same
book,
includes
a
deeply
suggestive
moment
where
he
speculates
on
the
striking
parallels between Wordsworth's and Freud's intellectual preoccupations ± namely, between the poet's idea that the infant's originary state of non-differentiation may be a possible source of our `intimations of immortality' and Freud's speculation that the `oceanic feeling', the feeling of `limitless extension and oneness with the universe', is a vestige of the `primary ego-feeling'
that
exists
prior
to
the
separation
by
which
the
child
comes
to
establish
identity (Trilling 1947, 137±8). Trilling leaves this speculation on Wordsworth and Freud largely undeveloped. But a remarkable number of recent critics who are psychoanalytically predisposed have also given attention to the poetry of Wordsworth in particular and romanticism in general. That common interest seems to reflect a broader theoretical investment: the crucial forbear of these scholars is Paul de Man, a sphere of influence that is somewhat ironic, given de Man's emphatic insistence that language, rhetoric, is radically empty of psychological content and his rare, but rather dismissive, references to psychoanalytic interpretation. (Brooks, it is worth mentioning, dedicates assessment
of
such
Reading for the Plot
relevance,
critics
such
as
to de Man.) Regardless of de Man's own
Neil
Hertz,
Cynthia
Chase
and
Barbara
Johnson have offered powerful testimony to the fruitfulness of generating psychoanalytic readings of literature that proceed from the methods de Man's rigorous rhetorical theory ± rooted in a radical reading of romanticism ± produced. They have, more importantly, demonstrated
the
compelling
resonances
between
psychoanalytic
speculation
on
the
earliest dynamics of significatory identification and de Man's rhetorical or deconstructive account of the materiality of language. Certainly Lacan also provides rich precedent for reading psychic structuration in linguistic terms, and some critics invested in a rhetorically oriented
psychoanalytic
criticism
attest
to
that
influence
explicitly.
But
it
is
striking,
psychoanalysis and literary criticism among
American
critics
in
particular,
that
93
a
de
Manian
model
of
language
so
often
supersedes a Lacanian one, in spite of these figures' relative theoretical interests. What de Man offers Cynthia Chase, in her dense but illuminating essay `The Witty Butcher's
Wife:
opportunity the
to
Freud,
read
disturbingly
in
Lacan,
and
Freud's
and
non-referential
the
Conversion
Lacan's
aspects
of
of
theoretical language
Resistance discourse
and
to
Theory',
instances
examples
of
of
the
is
an
resisting necessary
disavowal involved in every act of interpretation. Laying out the complex structure of meaning at work in the dream of the `witty butcher's wife' both Freud and Lacan interpret, Chase argues that the dynamics of mirroring or `specular rivalry' at work in the woman's story are themselves mirrored in the various analytic treatments of that story ± the woman's own, Freud's, Lacan's and Chase's own. She explains the helpfulness of de Man as follows:
What de Man's essay [`The Resistance to Theory'] describes is a resistance to language, or to the rhetorical nature of language or to the necessity of reading, precisely in theories of language, in `theory' understood as a reflection on how language is in the first instance about language rather than about the world. (Chase 1987, 991)
Chase demonstrates that each successive, contentious, theory of the dream depends on such a resistance. In a virtuoso demonstration of the self-consciousness and recursiveness recent psychoanalytic theory demands, Chase explores the shadowy ways in which the possibility of meaning (`interpretable and significative') ± in a dream, an interpretation, in referential language as such ± is predicated on a `resistance' to the possibility that they are `essentially non-significative' (999). As one step in this argument, she teases out Freud's contradictory claims about wish-fulfilment, which Lacan also notices: on the one hand, that we sleep in order to dream (and fulfil unconscious wishes), and on the other, that we dream in order to sleep (that is, fulfil a brute need not reducible to `wish'). Here, Chase is interested in highlighting the `indeterminably significative status' Freud assigns to the dream, but also of Lacan's own account and of language as such: `This is the moment in which the mirror
wavers,
in
which
the
specular
symmetry
of
the
structuralist
conception
about
language-about-language breaks down, as language . . . seems to mean also that which
not certainly
does
signify' (999).
Chase pursues a similar thesis in `Primary Narcissism and the Giving of Figure: Kristeva with Hertz and de Man' (Fletcher and Benjamin 1990, 124±36). She argues that Julia Kristeva's
rhetorically
inflected
theory
of
`primary
narcissism',
a
theory
that
posits
a
primordial structure of signification prior to Lacan's mirror stage, has offered Hertz and herself a provocative model for `mediating between psychoanalysis and non-psychoanalytic discourse, between the discourse to which the concept of primary narcissism would seem to belong, and a practice of rhetorical theory that denies that discourse explanatory authority' (124). Chase sees potent analogies between de Man's rhetorical theory and Kristeva's description
of
the
simultaneously
primordial
and
`recurrent
condition
of
the
speaking
subject' Kristeva calls `abjection' (129). She points out that such a theory `draws near de Man's considerations' in that Kristeva's specific brand of psychoanalytic theory, like de Man's, `becomes the analysis of an act of
reading'
(126, emphasis Chase's). The one literary
example in this discussion, one which strikingly echoes Kristeva's account and which de Man himself memorably uses, is the `blessed babe' passage from Book Two of Wordsworth's
Prelude,
which
between
a
props
describes
mother
and
the
infant
initially
intimate,
abruptly thrown
`indeterminably
into crisis by
of my affection were removed') (129, 134).
the
significative' mother's
relation
death
(`the
modern north american criticism and theory
94
As her title suggests, Chase recognizes that Hertz too is interested in such moments, both in an essay
on de
Man that explores the `drama of uncertain agency'
at work
in the
The
figurative logic of his rhetorical theory and, more elaborately, in his excellent book,
End of the Line: Essays on Psychoanalysis and the Sublime.
In the latter, the subtle rhetorical
moves of the first extant theory of sublimity (Longinus' `On Sublimity'), the notion of blockage in Kant's
Critique of Judgment,
the dynamics of influence in Wordsworth and
Milton, as well as readings of George Eliot, Flaubert and Freud, are united by an ambitious, provocative effort to align aesthetic with psychoanalytic discourse. It is in his `Afterword' that he explains and explores his title. Like Chase, he notably enlists Kristeva's pre-Oedipal theory of abjection to describe a crisis ± of signification, but also of subjectivity itself ± that is precipitated by differential undecidability, such as the sublimely, unsettlingly `minimal difference between black and black' in Courbet's painting,
La source de la Loue
or `the
minimal difference between the ``Label'' on [the] chest and the ``fixed face and sightless eyes'' ' of Wordsworth's famous description of the blind beggar in
The Prelude
(Hertz 1985a,
217). Borrowing from Kenneth Burke, Hertz calls such representations instances of an `end of
the
line'
moments
structure
in
reflection,
(218±19).
Wordsworth's
In
all
poetry),
a mise en abyme
of the
such
`what
examples
one
is
(he
drawn
explores
to
is
not
a
number
a
clearly
artist's representational project, but
an
of
such
oriented
engagement
with the act and with the medium of painting or writing condensed almost to the point of nonreflective opacity' (219). Hertz's innovation is to integrate such literary examples and the seemingly felicitous psychoanalytic theory that would account for them with a broader history of discourses on the sublime. He is conscientious, however, to acknowledge Thomas Weiskel's
earlier,
ground-breaking
engagement
with
just
such
a
juxtaposition
Romantic Sublime: Studies in the Structure and Psychology of Transcendence .
The
in
Hertz writes: `It
was Weiskel's distinction to have seen that the poetic and philosophical language of the primary sublime texts [Longinus, Kant and especially Edmund Burke] could be made to resonate with two quite different twentieth-century idioms, that of psychoanalysis and that of the semiological writings of Saussure, Jakobson, and Barthes' (Hertz 1985a, 49). Hertz respectfully
distinguishes
his
own
efforts
to
theorize
sublimity
psychoanalytically
from
Weiskel's by emphasizing his own debt to recent theories that challenge Freudian, Oedipal model on which Weiskel relies:
I . . . give Weiskel credit for dwelling as long as he did on the puzzles and the anxieties of the preOedipal,
while
also
calling
attention
to
the
relief
he
seemed
to
interpreter in bringing it all home to the Father. Since 1976 ± when
have
experienced
as
The Romantic Sublime
an was
published ± developments within psychoanalytic practice have converged with the work of feminist and post-structuralist theorists in providing counterirritants to [pre-Oedipal] anxieties and
encouraging
particular,
the
more,
concept
and of
more
varied,
narcissism
has
exploration been
of
expanded
the and
earliest
stages
generally
of
infancy.
reworked,
both
In by
American psychologists of the `self' and ± more interestingly to my mind ± by French writers drawing on Lacan's and Derrida's rereadings of Freud. (Hertz 1985a, 231)
The pressure Hertz puts on Weiskel's recourse to a relatively `reassuring' Oedipal model and, more remarkably, on the interpretive `relief' he finds in it recalls the potent critical ma of Barbara Johnson's well-known and widely published essay, `The Frame of Reference: Poe,
Lacan,
Derrida'
(Hartman
1978,
149±72).
Specifically
critiquing
an
exchange
between Lacan and Derrida on Poe's `Purloined Letter' ± a detective story about finding a stolen letter hiding in plain sight ± Johnson demonstrates that interpretation is inherently
psychoanalysis and literary criticism
95
prone to `framing' its object of analysis within an invested theoretical model. Effectively beginning where Crews' reflections on method seemed to stop, Johnson interrogates the very grounds on which meaning is, or may be, asserted in an interpretive act. Looking at Lacan's reading (which claims the story is `a kind of
allegory
of the signifier')
and Derrida's
rebuttal to it (which questions Lacan's gesture of fixing meaning on the very thing, the letter, he also claims has no inherent meaning), Johnson argues that Derrida repeats the very
`crime'
Derrida
of
which
`frames'
he
Lacan,
accuses
accusing
Lacan him
(Hartman
of
an
1978,
overbearing
152±3, faith
emphasis
in
the
Johnson's).
possibility
of
a
psychoanalytic metalanguage, in the same way that Lacan `frames' Poe's story, to make it readable as an allegory of the signifier. Yet, Johnson argues, `although the critique of what Derrida calls psychoanalysis is entirely justified, it does not quite apply to what Lacan's text is actually saying' (158). She finds this misreading `too interesting not to be deliberate' (158).
She
reads
the
exchange
between
these
two
radically
self-conscious
writers
as
performative display of interpretation's tendency ± indeed necessity ± to read past the
literary
aspect of the text in question, past the
letter
of the text. Johnson subtly demonstrates
that, rather than simply blind to this blindness, both Lacan and Derrida self-consciously act it out. The double sense in which she means `frame' mobilizes the key claim she makes about
interpretation
and
its
object,
especially
with
regard
to
that
elusive
object
of
psychoanalysis, the unconscious. Ultimately, what Johnson reads as the simultaneously inevitable and impossible conditions of psychoanalysis are the conditions of all acts of interpretation, including literary criticism, where `the theoretical frame of reference that governs recognition is a constitutive element in the blindness of any interpretive insight' (164). In closing, Johnson articulates the multiple connotations of the refrain with which both Lacan and Derrida play: `a letter always reaches its destination'. Among the things that phrase may indicate is the observation that the resistance of the letter ± of literature ± to an absolute, decisive reading:
It is not any one of these readings, but all of them and others in their very incompatibility, that repeat the letter in its way of reading the act of reading. Far from giving us [Lacan's] seminar's final truth, these last words, and Derrida's reading of them, can only enact the impossibility of any ultimate analytical metalanguage, the eternal oscillation between unequivocal undecidability and ambiguous certainty. (170)
What Johnson here describes much of her excellent work performs, exploring encounters between psychoanalytic and literary texts within the force field of this very oscillation. Her most
recent
Gender,
publication,
includes
psychoanalytic
several
criticism.
The Feminist Difference: Literature, Psychoanalysis, Race, and essays Here
similarly
and
interested
elsewhere,
in
Johnson
the
pitfalls
approaches
and the
promise act
of
of
a
reading
by means of a `self-resistant', rhetorically sensitive rigour that characterizes much of the current
American
psychoanalytic
work
literary
in
psychoanalysis.
criticism
±
like
the
As
all
of
these
`interminable'
dynamic
enterprise
studies
Freud
indicate,
understood
his analysis to be ± is vitally `still to be determined' (Brooks 1994, 20).
Megan Becker-Leckrone
modern north american criticism and theory
96
Further reading and works cited The Anxiety of Influence. New York, 1973.
Bloom, H. Ð.
Agon: Towards a Theory of Revisionism. New York, 1982. Reading for the Plot. New York, 1984.
Brooks, P. Ð.
Psychoanalysis and Storytelling. London, 1994. Decomposing Figures. Baltimore, MD, 1986.
Chase, C.
Ð. `The Witty Butcher's Wife', Crews, F.
Davis, R. Con (ed.) Ð.
MLN, 102 (1987).
Out of My System. New York, 1975. The Fictional Father. Amherst, MA, 1981.
Lacan and Narration. Baltimore, MD, 1983.
Ellmann, M. (ed.)
Psychoanalytic Literary Criticism. London, 1994.
Feldstine, R. and Roof, J. (eds) Felman, S. (ed.)
Feminism and Psychoanalysis. Ithaca, NY, 1989.
Literature and Psychoanalysis. Baltimore, MD, 1982.
Fletcher, J. and Benjamin, A. (eds)
Hartman, G. (ed.) Hertz, N. Ð.
Abjection, Melancholia, and Love. London, 1990.
The Daughter's Seduction. Ithaca, NY, 1982.
Gallop, J.
Psychoanalysis and the Question of the Text. Baltimore, MD, 1978.
The End of the Line. New York, 1985a.
The End of the Line. New York, 1985b.
Johnson, B.
The Feminist Difference. Cambridge, MA, 1998.
Lupton, J. Reinhard and Reinhard, K. MacCannell, J. Flower.
After Oedipus. Ithaca, NY, 1993.
Figuring Lacan. London, 1986.
Muller, J. P. and W. J. Richardson.
The Purloined Poe. Baltimore, MD, 1988.
Ragland-Sullivan, E. and Bracher, M. (eds) Schwartz, M. M. and Kahn, C. Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Skura, M. A.
Between Men. New York, 1985.
The Literary Use of the Psychoanalytic Process. New Haven, CT, 1981.
The Liberal Imagination. New York, 1978.
Trilling, L. Weber, S.
Lacan and the Subject of Language. London, 1991.
Representing Shakespeare. Baltimore, MD, 1980.
The Legend of Freud. Minneapolis, MN, 1982.
Weiskel, T.
The Romantic Sublime. Baltimore, MD, 1976.
14. Feminists of Colour
Feminists
of
colour
in
the
US
have
made
ground-breaking
contributions
to
feminist
thought (scholarship and activism) in general and feminist theory in particular. They have engaged, challenged and reformulated feminist insights from the inception of feminism in the nineteenth century to the present. They have been active participants in the social justice movements (Civil Rights, Latino, Native American, gay and lesbian, and women's liberation) of the past forty years. In the US, African-American women were the first to engage with feminist literary criticism in the early 1970s. Other women of colour followed suit in the late 1970s and early 1980s, calling for coalitions among women of colour as well as for the development of criticism accounting for specific group experiences (Chicana, Asian-American, etc.). These different groups of critics have influenced each other as well as white feminists, male writers of colour and entire academic disciplines. Always at the
modern north american criticism and theory
96
Further reading and works cited The Anxiety of Influence. New York, 1973.
Bloom, H. Ð.
Agon: Towards a Theory of Revisionism. New York, 1982. Reading for the Plot. New York, 1984.
Brooks, P. Ð.
Psychoanalysis and Storytelling. London, 1994. Decomposing Figures. Baltimore, MD, 1986.
Chase, C.
Ð. `The Witty Butcher's Wife', Crews, F.
Davis, R. Con (ed.) Ð.
MLN, 102 (1987).
Out of My System. New York, 1975. The Fictional Father. Amherst, MA, 1981.
Lacan and Narration. Baltimore, MD, 1983.
Ellmann, M. (ed.)
Psychoanalytic Literary Criticism. London, 1994.
Feldstine, R. and Roof, J. (eds) Felman, S. (ed.)
Feminism and Psychoanalysis. Ithaca, NY, 1989.
Literature and Psychoanalysis. Baltimore, MD, 1982.
Fletcher, J. and Benjamin, A. (eds)
Hartman, G. (ed.) Hertz, N. Ð.
Abjection, Melancholia, and Love. London, 1990.
The Daughter's Seduction. Ithaca, NY, 1982.
Gallop, J.
Psychoanalysis and the Question of the Text. Baltimore, MD, 1978.
The End of the Line. New York, 1985a.
The End of the Line. New York, 1985b.
Johnson, B.
The Feminist Difference. Cambridge, MA, 1998.
Lupton, J. Reinhard and Reinhard, K. MacCannell, J. Flower.
After Oedipus. Ithaca, NY, 1993.
Figuring Lacan. London, 1986.
Muller, J. P. and W. J. Richardson.
The Purloined Poe. Baltimore, MD, 1988.
Ragland-Sullivan, E. and Bracher, M. (eds) Schwartz, M. M. and Kahn, C. Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Skura, M. A.
Between Men. New York, 1985.
The Literary Use of the Psychoanalytic Process. New Haven, CT, 1981.
The Liberal Imagination. New York, 1978.
Trilling, L. Weber, S.
Lacan and the Subject of Language. London, 1991.
Representing Shakespeare. Baltimore, MD, 1980.
The Legend of Freud. Minneapolis, MN, 1982.
Weiskel, T.
The Romantic Sublime. Baltimore, MD, 1976.
14. Feminists of Colour
Feminists
of
colour
in
the
US
have
made
ground-breaking
contributions
to
feminist
thought (scholarship and activism) in general and feminist theory in particular. They have engaged, challenged and reformulated feminist insights from the inception of feminism in the nineteenth century to the present. They have been active participants in the social justice movements (Civil Rights, Latino, Native American, gay and lesbian, and women's liberation) of the past forty years. In the US, African-American women were the first to engage with feminist literary criticism in the early 1970s. Other women of colour followed suit in the late 1970s and early 1980s, calling for coalitions among women of colour as well as for the development of criticism accounting for specific group experiences (Chicana, Asian-American, etc.). These different groups of critics have influenced each other as well as white feminists, male writers of colour and entire academic disciplines. Always at the
feminists of colour cutting
edge,
they
97
have
redefined
feminism
at
the
levels
of
nomenclature,
theory,
methodology and genres or styles of writing.
Nomenclature Feminists
of
colour
have
renamed
feminism
in
order
to
make
it
better
reflect
their
concerns. Some have chosen to literally invent a new word, whereas others have opted for retaining the old word (sometimes modifying it) and redefining it to suit their own worldviews. The most famous renaming is African-American writer Alice Walker's definition of a `womanist' (1983, xi±xii). Anglicizing the word (from the French etymology of feminist, based on in
femme
[woman], to womanist), Walker's definition is grounded first and foremost
African-American
cultural
and
linguistic
specificity.
Her
first
definition
is
`a
black
feminist or a feminist of colour', thus placing women of colour at the centre of a concentric definition that expands to include `a woman who loves other women, sexually or nonsexually' (a direct reference to Jewish-American feminist Adrienne Rich's concept of the `lesbian continuum', in which all positive woman-to-woman relationships, sexual and nonsexual, are included as a way to bridge the tensions between lesbian and heterosexual feminists). Walker's definition then broadens to a holistic, radical feminist embrace of love of the world and of the self. The fourth and last part of the definition rests on the analogy, `womanist is to feminist as purple is to lavender'. Reminiscent of Walker's classic novel,
The Colour Purple
, this final definition deconstructs the perception that feminism is a broad
category of which feminists of colour are a part, to represent womanist as the standard, deeper colour (purple) and feminist as a variation on purple, a combination of purple and white. Walker's colour symbolism includes the struggle of the gay and lesbian movement, which has chosen the colour lavender (a mixture of pink and blue, the pastel colours typically
associated
with
little
girls
and
little
boys
in
western
cultures)
as
one
of
its
part
of
attributes. Womanist
is
presented
as
the
more
inclusive
standard,
and
feminist
as
a
womanist, for two reasons: first, because womanists come out of a historical and social context in which all people of colour, male and female, were and still are subjected to racist domination by a white supremacist order, their worldview includes men as part of the struggle for liberation. Therefore, womanists cannot agree with the gender separatism of some
feminist theories. The
second reason
for womanist being presented
as the
more
inclusive standard is a response to the exclusionary nature of a feminism that focuses solely or mostly on gender issues and refuses to give equal attention to the effects of race, class and other forms of domination. White feminists who are `committed to the survival of the entire people' can be womanists, white racist feminists cannot. Frances M. Beal was even more direct, as early as 1970: `Any white woman's group that does not have an antiimperialist
and
antiracist
ideology
has
absolutely
nothing
in
common
with
the
black
woman's struggle' (1970, 393). Finally, Walker never uses the form `womanism', only `womanist', to indicate that while there are womanists, people of all colours committed to a broad vision of social justice, there is no one way of being a womanist, no one doctrine to follow that would be called womanism. Walker's position is in keeping with that of many other black feminists who insist that there is no such thing as a monolithic black feminist standpoint (Collins), black feminist
theory
(Christian)
or
feminist
movement
(bell
hooks).
Inspired
by
Walker's
modern north american criticism and theory
98
Âa Isasi-Dõ Âaz coined the term `mujerista' (from the renaming, Latina theologian Ada Marõ Spanish word for woman,
mujer
) to refer to Latina feminists who struggle against the
oppressive strictures of racism, sexism and economic domination. Similarly, Chicana Ana Castillo has created the word `Xicanisma' to designate Chicana feminists. The second way of handling the problem of nomenclature is to continue using the term feminism, qualifying it to redefine its meaning. This is the way that Barbara Smith, among others, has chosen. Smith's redefinition is probably the most famous: `Feminism is the political theory and practice that struggles to free class
women,
economically
poor
women,
privileged,
disabled
women,
heterosexual
all
women: women of colour, working-
lesbians,
women.
old
Anything
women
less
than
±
as
this
well
as
vision
white,
of
total
freedom is not feminism, but merely female self-aggrandizement' (Smith 1990, 25). Several feminists of colour have modified the term, retaining a connection to it but specifically naming themselves to overcome a history of silencing. For example, Chela Sandoval
makes
a
distinction
between
`hegemonic
feminism'
(a
term
also
used
by
postcolonial feminist critic Gayatri Chakravorty Spivak to refer to mainstream, white middle-class feminism) and `US Third World Feminism' (1991, 1). Sandoval's definition makes the link between women of colour in the US and third world women, reminding us
that
worldwide,
women
of
colour
are
a
majority
and
that
international
alliances
between women of colour will serve them best. This new formulation bases itself on an analysis of racial domination in the US as a feature of internal colonialism, thus drawing parallels between colonial and neocolonial practices in the Third and the First Worlds. It also points to the class discrimination suffered by many US women of colour, who are disproportionately part of the poorest segments of US society (its `Third World'). Finally, it is a way to bring together US and foreign-born women of colour in North America in general, and Latinas of diverse nationalities in particular, a group whose interests are of special concern to Sandoval, a Chicana critic. The theorists calling for such alliances are generally part of a migrant or colonial experience (such as Chicanas or Puerto-Rican women) who may have relatives dispersed throughout different countries across North/ South borders. More recently, legal scholars using the methods of close textual analysis and concerned with the intersections of race, class and gender in the law have named themselves critical race feminists. In doing so, they claim their connection to a triple legal tradition: critical legal studies (whose primary focus tends to be class), critical race theory and feminist  thought. African-American scholars such as Lani Guinier, Adrien Wing and Kimberle Crenshaw and Asian-American scholars such as Mari Matsuda have participated in this new and exciting scholarly development.
Theory From Sojourner Truth in the nineteenth century onwards, women of colour involved in diverse
social
justice
movements
have
argued
that
other
people's
theories
about
their
situation were inadequate: these theories asked them to `choose' between a focus on race, on class or on gender. Women of colour have been told by white feminists that their insistence on fighting racism was `divisive' to a movement committed mostly to working against gender oppression. Marxist and labour movements have claimed that a focus on race and gender detracted from the `real' struggle. Finally, the civil rights leadership tended to replicate patterns of male dominance. Deborah K. King notes that this fundamental
feminists of colour difference
in
99
conceptualizing
oppression
(from
a
monist
to
a
multiplicative
analysis)
resulted in `the theoretical invisibility of black women' (1990, 76). She documents how African-American women have historically contributed to developing a multiaxial theory of race, class and gender (and other forms of oppression). For example, the work of Angela Davis
has
contributed
to
shaping
such
a
perspective.
Similarly,
the
Combahee
River
Collective espoused an anti-racist, anti-imperialist, socialist, black lesbian feminist position that theorized all forms of oppression as `interlocking' in its manifesto (1983, 210). Lesbian feminists of colour have argued that sexuality, like race, class and gender, is an Âe Moraga important part of the system of domination. Audre Lorde, Barbara Smith, Cherrõ Â a were some of the first theorists to analyse the connections between and Gloria Anzaldu heterosexism and homophobia and other forms of oppression. Perhaps because they often felt rejected by their own communities, lesbian feminists of colour have tirelessly agitated for inclusive spaces and against homophobia within the diverse movements in which they have participated. Mohawk poet and essayist Beth Brant and Laguna Pueblo writer Paula Gunn Allen have called for principled coalitions among people in different liberation struggles. Furthermore, Lorde and Brant have broadened and deepened the definition of sexuality by highlighting the healing and creative power of the erotic and the connections between sexuality and spirituality (Lorde 1984, 53±9; Brant 1994, 55±66). A fifth element of the system of domination, colonialism, was highlighted in the analyses of two groups of theorists: Native American and postcolonial scholars. Native American women have traditionally had a very vexed relationship with feminism for the following reasons:
feminism's
peoples,
and
the
general
discursive
failure
to
understand
colonialism
the
(Mohanty
et
colonial al.
domination
1991,
51)
of
of
much
Native feminist
thought. This discursive colonialism is expressed in an unwillingness on the part of most white
feminists
to
acknowledge
the
impact
of
US
colonialism
on
the
lives
of
Native
Americans, a refusal to support Native claims for sovereignty and self-determination, and a desire to place the blame for Native American women's oppression on the shoulders of Native American men. In terms reminiscent of Frances M. Beal, M. Annette Jaimes and Theresa Halsey state that until feminists start to join the Native American anti-colonial struggle, feminism will bring nothing to Native American women (Jaimes with Halsey 1992,
332).
Indeed,
few
Native
women
have
self-identified
as
feminists
(Paula
Gunn
Allen, Beth Brant, Janice Gould (Maidu), Wilma Mankiller (Cherokee) and Kate Shanley (Assiniboine) are important exceptions). Critics such as Brant and Gould have highlighted some
common
themes
of
Native
women's
literature:
the
question
of
multiple
and
fragmented identities in a colonial context; the deep sense of connection to the land, the people and other living beings; the question of how to express the centrality of the oral tradition
and
storytelling
through
writing;
and
finally,
conveying
the
pivotal
role
of
humour in the process of healing and survival (Gould 1995; Brant 1994, 5±24). Native writers and theorists have criticized the interlocking forces of colonialism and capitalist destruction of the land (Winona LaDuke), racism, sexism and homophobia (Allen, Brant), as well as the cultural appropriation of their spirituality by New Age religions (Brant, Wendy Rose, Laura Donaldson). Feminist theorists who migrated to the US from third world countries such as India and Vietnam have also argued for the necessity of including colonialism in a multiaxial analysis of domination and having a more global vision of the struggle to end domination. In particular, Talpade
US-based
Mohanty
South
have
Asians
argued
such
that
as
Gayatri
western
Chakravorty
feminists
replicated
Spivak
and
colonialist
Chandra
paradigms
modern north american criticism and theory
100
when they sought to `sav[e] brown women from brown men' (Spivak 1994, 93). A monist focus on gender (or gender and sexuality) as the primary source of women's oppression conveniently serves to blind hegemonic feminists to their own participation in third world women's oppression through the neocolonialist and imperialist practices of the US and Europe. The publication of Mohanty's essay `Under Western Eyes' in 1984 and of Trinh
Woman, Native, Other
Minh-ha's book,
in 1989 were landmark events of what came to be
known as `US Third World Feminism'. They sought to promote `a common context of struggle' between women of colour in the US and women in the third world in order to create broad-based alliances (Mohanty et al. 1991, 7). However, their occasional equation of racism and colonialism is sometimes problematic in so far as it can tend to subsume the concerns of women in the third world to those of US-based women of colour (problems due to colonial or neocolonial practices in the third world are sometimes viewed as being caused by racism by US third world feminists living in the US). In spite of this problem, the call
to
enlarge
feminist
issues
to
transnational
ones,
which
has
also
been
made
by
ecofeminists, has become a very important aspect of feminist theory. For example, Patricia Hill Collins's revised edition of her classic
Black Feminist Thought
now includes a chapter
on `US black feminism in transnational context' that draws from the work of African women writers and theorists. Most feminists of colour have built their theoretical frameworks around a recognition of the
centrality
of
self-definition
and
self-determination.
It
was
crucial
to
argue
for
the
centrality of women of colour in the theorizing process, especially at a time when their voices were few and silenced. Therefore a majority of criticism written by feminists of colour has focused on the importance of theorizing from experience and placing one's analysis in the appropriate cultural context, in order to avoid common misreadings and oppressive interpretations of the lives and writings of women of colour. Writers such as Patricia Hill Collins and Paula Gunn Allen, Asian-American authors Mitsuye Yamada and Deborah
Woo,
and
Chicana
critic
Norma
Ân Alarco
have
forcefully
countered
and
deconstructed stereotypical `controlling images' (Collins 2000, 69) of women of colour that stand in the way of self-definition. Since the 1970s, literary critics seeking to retrieve the voices of artists have established the existence of literary traditions by women of colour. They
have
attention include
brought
to
the
Barbara
Washington,
back
work
of
Smith,
Toni
to
light
Alice
Cade
forgotten
contemporary Walker,
Bambara
and
writers
women Amy
Ling,
Yvonne
of
writers
the
past,
of
colour
Âa Marõ
and
provided
(such
literary
Herrera-Sobek,
Yarbro-Bejarano).
Mary
Barbara
critical critics Helen
Christian
(1990) has pointed out that she reads and writes about the work of black women writers not as a luxury, but as a life-line, as a way to confirm her own worldview and experiences, in order to survive the theoretical invisibility of black women. Collins has clearly articulated the concept of a black feminist standpoint. She highlights the fact that black feminist thought not only provides new paradigms, but new epistemological frameworks as well (Collins 2000, 252±74). She sees black female intellectuals as affirming and rearticulating the experiential knowledge of everyday black women into a more specialized form of knowledge (Collins 2000, 32±4). In her view, black feminist thought is produced primarily, but not solely, by black women, who engage in principled coalitions with other groups fighting for and theorizing about social change (Collins 2000, 38). In contrast, theorists of colour who began writing at a time when ethnic literary criticism was blooming are sometimes more critical of the essentialist and overgeneralizing  n, Hazel Carby, pitfalls that can accompany such positions. Thinkers such as Norma Alarco
feminists of colour
101
Wahneema Lubiano, Valerie Smith, Hortense J. Spillers, Gayatri Spivak and Trinh T. Minh-ha
have
countered
identity-based
or
standpoint
theories
developed
by
other
theorists of colour and argued for a recognition of more postmodern or discursively-based positions. Finally, in the 1990s, feminist theorists of colour such as Rey Chow, bell hooks, Lisa Lowe, Valerie Smith and Michele Wallace have also been important contributors to the growing fields of cultural and film studies.
Methodology and genres of writing Since what usually counts as theory (including literary theory) originates mostly out of European
and
Euro-american
contexts,
feminists
of
colour
have
had
an
ambivalent
relationship to the concept of theory itself. Some have argued that theory is inherently oppressive because of its elitist language and disconnection from the actual lives of women. One of the best articulations of this position remains Barbara Christian's essay, `The Race for Theory', in which she makes a distinction between theory (an obfuscating pursuit that contributes to the theoretical invisibility of black women) and theorizing (a practice that seeks to illuminate the works of black women writers) (Christian 1990, 335±7). Many other
thinkers such
as
Gayatri
Spivak,
Hortense
J.
Spillers
Ân Alarco
and Norma
have
refused to disengage from mainstream theory and have thus countered the stereotype of women of colour as untheoretical. Generally speaking, the uncomfortable relationship that feminists of colour have had to theory has contributed to two original developments in the field: methodological innovations and a new use of genres in writing theory. Since feminists of colour
insist on the
primary
importance
of self-definition
in any
liberatory struggle, many have turned away from western-based theories and sought to establish a theory based on an analysis of the experiences of women of colour. This has contributed to redefining what counts as appropriate disciplinary methods. For example, Patricia Hill Collins explains that the sociological imperative to separate the researcher from her subjects of research is an impediment to black feminist sociological research, which seeks to understand black women's subjugated knowledge, their own interpretations of their experiences (Collins 2000, 254±6). Similarly, because black feminist thought aims to legitimize the voices of black women, Collins, rather than seeking academic credentials through
citing
authoritative
white
male
sociologists,
quotes
from
the
works
of
black
scholars and fiction writers, as well as the testimonies of everyday black women (domestic workers, working women). Theorizing from experience has also challenged boundaries of genre, as feminists of colour have made ample use of personal narrative as a form suitable to the theoretical Âe Moraga and Gloria Anzaldu  a, in particular, has been enterprise. The work of Cherrõ central to such reformulations of the genre of theory writing. The form of their books and
mestizaje
edited collections, which include theoretical and personal essays, poetry and fiction, as well as texts written in both English and Spanish, reflects the hybridity ( they
argue
is
at
the
heart
of
their
process
of
identity
formation
as
Chicana
) that
lesbians.
Similarly, Audre Lorde has argued that `poetry is not a luxury' but a first step toward articulating one's inchoate thoughts and feelings, a distillation of experience necessary for the process of theorizing (1984, 36±7). Japanese-American poets Mitsuye Yamada and Janice Mirikitani have also theorized and rewritten the silences of history through their magnificent people
of
poems.
colour
`is
Finally, often
Barbara
in
Christian
narrative
forms,
points in
the
out
that
stories
the
we
theorizing
create,
in
done
riddles
by
and
modern north american criticism and theory
102
proverbs,
in
the
play
with
language'
rather
than
in
the
obfuscating
language
of
high
theory (1990, 336). The use of literary sources in sociological scholarship and the use of personal narrative in much theory by feminists of colour are a testimony to the centrality of literature by women of
colour
to
the
process
of
theorizing.
In
many
ways,
theorists
of
colour
are
deeply
influenced by the work of creative writers such as Toni Morrison, Alice Walker, Maxine Hong Kingston and Leslie Marmon Silko (on whose work Trinh draws heavily to develop her theory of third world women's writing in
Woman, Native, Other).
Conversely, many of
these writers (such as Morrison, Silko, Walker, Lorde, Michelle Cliff, Mitsuye Yamada, Paula Gunn Allen, Beth Brant, Wendy Rose and Janice Gould) have also been important theorists and critics.
Conclusion Because feminists of colour in the US have called for a `paradigm shift' (Sandoval 1991, 9), not only from feminists, but from other liberation struggles based on monist models of race or class as well as from a variety of academic disciplines, their impact has paradoxically been both immense and modest. Tensions remain between those still subscribing to monist parameters
of
analysis
and
those
embracing
multiaxial
paradigms.
In
other
words,
the
paradigm shift required by US feminists of colour has not yet been achieved in feminist theory and practice today. The work of US feminists of colour has unfortunately often been co-opted through tokenism rather than full integration. The body of literary criticism on women writers of colour has become a field ripe with appropriations and misreadings. Furthermore, the US tendency to think through race issues in Black and White terms still remains strong in women's studies as in other fields. This means that issues of importance to Latinos, Native Americans and Asian-Americans, in particular, are even more vulnerable  a, Lorde, to tokenism. Finally, while the work of lesbians of colour such as Allen, Anzaldu Moraga and Barbara Smith has been central to the development of multiaxial theory, homophobia further contributes to their theoretical invisibility as lesbians. In spite of these continuing problems, however, it is very hard to imagine today the situation in which Barbara Smith found herself in 1977, trying to write one of the first articles ever about a black female literary tradition and black lesbian existence. Similarly, the concerns Barbara Christian expressed over the lack of critical academic attention to the works of Toni Morrison and Alice Walker are no longer an issue (Christian 1990, 344). Today, the study of ethnic and postcolonial literature has become an important part of the women's studies curriculum. Similarly, the study of women writers of colour has become very significant in ethnic studies, and is being incorporated more and more into the study of American literature in English departments. A market for the fiction of women of colour has developed, and academic recruitment in
literary
and
women's studies increasingly
demands specialization in, or familiarity with, ethnic literature and theory. Last but not least, the early efforts of scholars such as Smith and Christian have generated a vital, sophisticated tradition of theory and literary criticism analysing the works of women writers of colour through the lens of the interlocking effects of race, class, gender and other forms of domination.
Anne Donadey
stephen greenblatt and the new historicism
103
Further reading and works cited  n, Alarco
N.
`The
Feminism', in
Subject(s)
of
This Bridge Called My Back and Anglo-American
The Sacred Hoop. Boston, 1986.
Allen, P. Gunn.
 a, G. (ed.) Anzaldu Ð.
Theoretical
 a. San Francisco, 1990. Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G. Anzaldu
Making Face, Making Soul. Haciendo Caras. San Francisco, 1990.
Borderlands/La Frontera. San Francisco, 1999.
Bambara, T. Cade (ed.)
The Black Woman. New York, 1970.
Beal, F. M. `Double Jeopardy', in Brant, B.
Sisterhood is Powerful, ed. R. Morgan. New York, 1970.
Writing as Witness. Toronto, 1994. Reconstructing Womanhood. New York, 1987.
Carby, H. V.
Massacre of the Dreamers. Albuquerque, NM, 1994.
Castillo, A.
Collins, P. Hill.
Black Feminist Thought. New York, 2000.
Combahee River Collective. `A Black Feminist Statement', in
This Bridge Called My Back, eds C.
 a. New York, 1983. Moraga and G. Anzaldu Christian, B. `The Race for Theory', in
 a. Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G. Anzaldu
San Francisco, 1990. Davis, A. Y.
Women, Race and Class. New York, 1981.
Gould, J. `American Indian Women's Poetry', hooks, b.
Signs, 20, 4, Summer 1995.
Ain't I a Woman. Boston, 1981.
Âaz, A. M. Isasi-Dõ
En la Lucha/In the Struggle. Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
Jaimes, M. A. with Halsey, T. `American Indian Women', in
The State of Native America, ed. M. A.
Jaimes. Boston, 1992.
Feminist Theory in Practice and Process,
King, D. W. `Multiple Jeopardy, Multiple Consciousness', in eds M. R. Malson et al. Chicago, 1990. Lorde, A.
Sister Outsider. Freedom, 1984.
Minh-ha, T. T.
Woman, Native, Other. Bloomington, IN, 1989.
Mohanty, C. Talpade et al. (eds) Moraga, C.
Third World Women and the Politics of Feminism. Bloomington, IN, 1991.
Loving in the War Years. Boston, 1983.
 a, G. (eds) Рand Anzaldu
This Bridge Called My Back. New York, 1983.
Sandoval, C. `U.S. Third World Feminism',
Genders, 10, 1991.
Smith, B. `Racism and Women's Studies', in
Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G.
 a. San Francisco, 1990. Anzaldu Ð.
The Truth That Never Hurts. New Brunswick, NJ, 1998.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty. `Can the Subaltern Speak?', in
Colonial Discourse and Post-Colonial Theory,
eds P. Williams and L. Chrisman. New York, 1994. Walker, A.
In Search of our Mothers' Gardens. San Diego, CA, 1983.
15. Stephen Greenblatt (1943±) and the New Historicism
`I
began
with
the
desire
introductory essay to the
political
and
to
speak
with
the
dead',
wrote
Stephen
Greenblatt
in
the
Shakespearean Negotiations (1988, 1), speaking of a desire rooted in
social
upheavals
of
the
1960s
and
1970s.
New
Criticism
dominated
stephen greenblatt and the new historicism
103
Further reading and works cited  n, Alarco
N.
`The
Feminism', in
Subject(s)
of
This Bridge Called My Back and Anglo-American
The Sacred Hoop. Boston, 1986.
Allen, P. Gunn.
 a, G. (ed.) Anzaldu Ð.
Theoretical
 a. San Francisco, 1990. Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G. Anzaldu
Making Face, Making Soul. Haciendo Caras. San Francisco, 1990.
Borderlands/La Frontera. San Francisco, 1999.
Bambara, T. Cade (ed.)
The Black Woman. New York, 1970.
Beal, F. M. `Double Jeopardy', in Brant, B.
Sisterhood is Powerful, ed. R. Morgan. New York, 1970.
Writing as Witness. Toronto, 1994. Reconstructing Womanhood. New York, 1987.
Carby, H. V.
Massacre of the Dreamers. Albuquerque, NM, 1994.
Castillo, A.
Collins, P. Hill.
Black Feminist Thought. New York, 2000.
Combahee River Collective. `A Black Feminist Statement', in
This Bridge Called My Back, eds C.
 a. New York, 1983. Moraga and G. Anzaldu Christian, B. `The Race for Theory', in
 a. Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G. Anzaldu
San Francisco, 1990. Davis, A. Y.
Women, Race and Class. New York, 1981.
Gould, J. `American Indian Women's Poetry', hooks, b.
Signs, 20, 4, Summer 1995.
Ain't I a Woman. Boston, 1981.
Âaz, A. M. Isasi-Dõ
En la Lucha/In the Struggle. Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
Jaimes, M. A. with Halsey, T. `American Indian Women', in
The State of Native America, ed. M. A.
Jaimes. Boston, 1992.
Feminist Theory in Practice and Process,
King, D. W. `Multiple Jeopardy, Multiple Consciousness', in eds M. R. Malson et al. Chicago, 1990. Lorde, A.
Sister Outsider. Freedom, 1984.
Minh-ha, T. T.
Woman, Native, Other. Bloomington, IN, 1989.
Mohanty, C. Talpade et al. (eds) Moraga, C.
Third World Women and the Politics of Feminism. Bloomington, IN, 1991.
Loving in the War Years. Boston, 1983.
 a, G. (eds) Рand Anzaldu
This Bridge Called My Back. New York, 1983.
Sandoval, C. `U.S. Third World Feminism',
Genders, 10, 1991.
Smith, B. `Racism and Women's Studies', in
Making Face, Making Soul. Hacienda Caras, ed. G.
 a. San Francisco, 1990. Anzaldu Ð.
The Truth That Never Hurts. New Brunswick, NJ, 1998.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty. `Can the Subaltern Speak?', in
Colonial Discourse and Post-Colonial Theory,
eds P. Williams and L. Chrisman. New York, 1994. Walker, A.
In Search of our Mothers' Gardens. San Diego, CA, 1983.
15. Stephen Greenblatt (1943±) and the New Historicism
`I
began
with
the
desire
introductory essay to the
political
and
to
speak
with
the
dead',
wrote
Stephen
Greenblatt
in
the
Shakespearean Negotiations (1988, 1), speaking of a desire rooted in
social
upheavals
of
the
1960s
and
1970s.
New
Criticism
dominated
modern north american criticism and theory
104
Greenblatt's undergraduate education at Yale University, but during a Fullbright scholarship to Cambridge University he encountered the teachings of Raymond Williams: `In Williams's lectures all that had been carefully excluded from the literary criticism in which I had been trained ± who controlled access to the printing press, who owned the land and the factories, whose
voices
were
being
repressed
as
well
as
represented
in
literary
texts,
what
social
strategies were being served by the aesthetic values we constructed ± came pressing back in upon the act of interpretation' (1990, 2). Greenblatt returned to Yale to finish his PhD with a dissertation
on
Sir
Walter
Raleigh's
self-presentation
(see
Greenblatt
1973);
then,
in his early years at the University of California at Berkeley, he confronted the theories of visiting lecturer Michel Foucault. Such experiences taught Greenblatt that speaking with the
dead
required
better
knowledge
of
the
social
and
political
conditions
of
their
lives. Greenblatt implemented that desire in
speare
Renaissance Self-Fashioning from More to Shake-
(1980), a prize-winning analysis of identity formation in early modern England. To
describe the situation of individuals caught in a transitional period between the collective economy
of
medieval
feudalism
under
which
a
fixed
identity
was
inherited,
and
the
modern world of capitalist individualism, Greenblatt coined the term `self-fashioning', a logical extension of his earlier examination of Ralegh. Individuals caught between these two models necessarily had to improvise, `to capitalize on the unforeseen and to transform given materials into one's own scenario' (1980, 227). Sir Thomas More's writings reveal, for example, `the invention of a disturbingly unfamiliar form of consciousness, tense, ironic, witty, poised between engagement and detachment, and above all, fully aware of its own status as an invention' (1980, 31). Spenser's Red Cross Knight begins
The Faerie Queene
as
a `clown', a rustic who must learn how to play the role of gentleman and knight. Identity is not inherited or stable; it is constructed in the context of political ideologies circulated by and through the state, the church and the family. Thus for Greenblatt, the literary text is not an aesthetic object whose formal qualities set it apart from other texts. Literary works must be situated within the framework of practices, institutions and beliefs that constituted Renaissance culture at large. Greenblatt rejects the strict marxist notion that material conditions control the individual and accepts instead the possibility of agency, however limited; nevertheless, he shows the writer imbricated in social and political currents of which he may not be aware that necessarily shape his or her textual productions. Greenblatt's critical practice was clearly established before he coined the term `new historicism' in the introduction to a special issue of
Genre
on `The Forms of Power and the
Power of Forms'; the essays gathered in this volume, he claimed, demonstrate a kind of criticism `set apart from both the dominant historical scholarship of the past and the formalist criticism that partially displaced this scholarship in the decades after World War Two' (1982, 5). Old historicism, Greenblatt opined, had been monological, finding only one meaning in a text ± usually the official ideology of the dominant power structure. In the work of critics such as J. Dover Wilson and E. M. W. Tillyard old historicism described Shakespeare's history plays as literary refractions of the Tudor political ideology articulated in the
Homily Against Disobedience and Willful Rebellion
Ecclesiastical Polity
(1571) or Richard Hooker's
Laws of
(1594). In contrast, new historicism situates literary texts, no less than
other documents that circulated in the same period, as loci of competing interests and dissenting
voices.
Shakespeare's
histories
ideology (Richmond, John of Gaunt,
do,
indeed,
Henry V's
present
spokespersons
for
Tudor
Archbishop of Canterbury, for example),
but usually the plays' most attractive and appealing characters counter that ideology with
stephen greenblatt and the new historicism subversive
energies,
deeds
and
actions
(Richard
III
105
and
Falstaff
are
cases
in
point).
Subversive figures are normally contained by the dominant power structure, but the bulk of the plays' energies are devoted to divisiveness, contestation and debate. Greenblatt explained his methodology more fully in a 1986 lecture at the University of Western Australia that was later reprinted as `Towards a Poetics of Culture' (Veeser 1989, 1±14, and Greenblatt 1990, 146±60). Rejecting any totalizing theory, Greenblatt called the `new historicism' a practice as opposed to a theory or a doctrine. He went on to differentiate new historicism (or cultural poetics, as he prefers to call it) from Fredric Jameson's aesthetic
marxist from
the
approach public
which
and
blames
political;
capitalism
he
also
for
differed
separating
with
the
private
Jean-Franc Ë ois
and
Lyotard's
poststructuralist model of capitalism as a monological system. Instead Greenblatt views capitalism as a complex historical movement that has generated `regimes in which the drive
towards
differentiation
and
the
drive
towards
monological
organization
operate
simultaneously, or at least oscillate so rapidly as to create the impression of simultaneity' (1990, 151). American capitalism in the late twentieth century is characterized, Greenblatt argues, by its effortless `invocation of two apparently contradictory accounts of art' ± `in the same moment a working distinction between the aesthetic and the real is established and abrogated' (1990, 153). The resulting circulation is generated not just by politics but by `the whole structure of production and consumption ± the systematic organization of ordinary life and consciousness (1990, 154). Greenblatt's characteristic method is to apply the skilful close reading he learned at Yale to a non-literary text, event or experience and then, in a brilliant intertextual dance, juxtapose that text with a reading of a recognized literary work. The resulting analysis shows how the social energies which circulate between the two texts are, presumably, characteristic of the culture at large. `Invisible Bullets' works from Thomas Harriot's
Briefe and True Report of the new found Land of Virginia
A
(1588) and its account of the
Indians' explanation of their susceptibility to European diseases to Shakespeare's second Henriad;
both
texts
demonstrate
the
powerful, if illusory, voice (1988,
ways
21±65).
in
which
power
allows
subversive
`Learning to Curse' moves
forces
explorers' accounts of Indian languages as defective or uncultured to Caliban's curses in
Tempest Declaration of Egregious Popish Imposters (1990,
16±39);
`Shakespeare
and
the
Exorcists'
uses
(1603) to interrogate
a
from new world
Samuel
King Lear
The A
Harsnett's
's representation
of Edgar as a demonically possessed `Poor Tom' (1988, 94±128). The
relationship
between
texts
in
these
analyses
is
always
dynamic;
the
model
is
negotiation or exchange. Every text is necessarily embedded in a complex network of social, economic and political practices (similar to Foucault's episteme); literary and nonliterary texts circulate inseparably within this network. And because the theatre's intended audience was a community of spectators rather than the individual consciousness, the stage became a fruitful site for such inquiries:
For the circulation of social energy by and through the stage was not part of a single, coherent, totalizing system. Rather it was partial, fragmentary, conflictual; elements were crossed, torn apart, recombined, set against each other; particular social practices were magnified by the stage, others diminished, exalted, evacuated. (Greenblatt 1988, 19)
Although Greenblatt has often been criticized for opening his essays with an anecdote or petite histoire (sometimes related to Clifford Geertz's concept of thick description), he defends the practice:
modern north american criticism and theory
106
The historical anecdote functions
less as explanatory illustration than as disturbance, that
which requires explanation, contextualization, interpretation. Anecdotes are the equivalents in the register of the real of what drew me to the study of literature: the encounter with something that I could not stand not understanding, that I could not quite finish with or finish off, that I had to get out of my inner life where it had taken hold, that I could retell and contemplate and struggle with. (1990, 5)
Greenblatt's
early
work,
along
with
Stephen
Orgel's
treatments
of
the
Stuart
court
masque as an instrument of state power (Orgel 1975) and Jonathan Goldberg's analysis of Stuart literature's relationship to James I's court (Goldberg 1983), focuses on the state's power both to license and prohibit acting companies and the subversive energies they represented. In his subsequent work, however, Greenblatt moves away from an emphasis on Foucauldian analyses of power relations to the more aesthetic concepts of wonder and resonance. Wonder occurs during the observer's first encounter with an artefact, natural event
or
alien
other;
the
viewer
stops
in
his
tracks
and
feels
the
uniqueness
of
the
experience. Resonance comes as the encounter is repeated; the object, natural event or alien other evokes `in the viewer the complex, dynamic cultural forces from which it has emerged and for which as metaphor or more simply as metonymy it may be taken by a viewer to stand' (1990, 170). Greenblatt finds the concept of wonder particularly useful in his account of European travel narratives,
World,
Marvelous Possessions: the Wonder of the New
because wonder was invariably a `component of the discourse of discovery, for by
definition wonder is an instinctive recognition of difference, the sign of a heightened attention' (1991, 20). At the moment of first contact:
The seamless and naturalised world of Renaissance Europe is torn apart and dislocated . . . The alterity of the indigenous American form of life presents both a fascination and a challenge to the representational economy of the European invaders. The attempts to contain, delimit, order and incorporate the other are figured in the colonialist representation of the native Americans within European imagery. (Colebrook 1997, 216)
As he considers a variety of colonialist representations of the new world and its peoples, Greenblatt
shows
how
Renaissance
culture
incorporated
images
of
the
other
into
its
discourse and how those images evolved in ensuing negotiations. In the acknowledgements to
Marvelous Possessions
Greenblatt briefly relates his discus-
sion of European dispossession of new world natives to his own Zionist roots, but as he admits in his essay on `Wonder and Resonance' (1990, 167), because his own interests and values are pervasive, he seldom feels the need to articulate them. Other prominent new historicists are more insistent that the critic reflect on his or her own historical situation. Louis Adrian Montrose, for example, stresses the importance of recognizing `the agency of
criticism
in
constructing
and
delimiting
the
subject
of
study'
(1986,
7).
Thus
to
Montrose, new historicism's
collective project is to resituate canonical literary texts among the multiple forms of writing, and in relation to the non-discursive practices and institutions of the social formation in which those texts have been produced ± while, at the same time, recognizing that this project of historical
resituation
is
necessarily
the
textual
construction
of
critics
who
are
themselves
historical subjects. (1986, 6)
Like Greenblatt, Montrose locates the objects of his studies within a dynamic and unstable relationship to material conditions of production and circulation.
stephen greenblatt and the new historicism
107
Montrose's most quoted phrase acknowledges `the historicity of texts and the textuality of history' (1986, 8 and 1996, 5). The former refers to the `social and material embedding of
writing [and] . . . reading' (1996, 6); the latter suggests that
all modes of
we
can
have
no
access to a full
and
authentic past, to
a lived material
existence, that
is
unmediated by the surviving textual traces of the society in question, and furthermore, that the survival of those traces, rather than others, cannot be assumed to be merely fortuitous but must rather be presumed to be at least partially consequent upon complex and subtle social processes of selective preservation and effacement. (1996, 6)
In a move akin to cultural materialism's emphasis on the ways texts become imbricated in the dominant power structure,
Montrose cautions the reader to see the text within
a
continuous process of mediation. Montrose eschews strict marxist interpretations, seeing the subject as both determined and capable of agency. The process of subjectification, he contends, `on the one hand, shapes individuals as loci of consciousness and initiators of action'; on the other hand, it also `positions, motivates, and constrains them within ± subjects them to ± social networks and cultural codes that exceed their comprehension or control' (1986, 9). Thus Montrose finds a limited space for the individual to shape his world and allows texts a limited ability to shape social and cultural codes. Montrose's 1996 monograph,
The Purpose of Playing: Shakespeare and the Cultural Politics
of the Elizabethan Theatre, brings together several of his earlier essays in carefully revised form. The first half examines the place of the professional theatre within Elizabethan culture, showing how the emergence of acting companies and the commodification of dramatic impersonation in an entertainment industry `were consonant with other material and
ideological
developments
±
capital
accumulation,
market
calculation,
contractual
relations, and ``possessive individualism'' ± that manifested the emergence of what we now characterize as merchant capitalism and bourgeois subjectivity' (1996, 92). The stage thus played a major role in the shift from the communal ceremonies of the medieval Catholic church to the nationalization of English culture under the Tudor Protestant state at the same time as it called into question the state's absolutist assumptions. The book's second half examines the relationship between the theatre and the state in
A Midsummer Night's
Dream through its refiguration of popular mythology surrounding Elizabeth, the virgin Queen. Montrose's concern with `figurations of gender' is shared by another prominent new historicist, Jean E. Howard. In an early essay outlining new historicism's major tenets, Howard broadened the scope of its inquiries from the power structure of the Elizabethan and
Stuart
courts
to
include
people
of
the
`middling
sort',
among
them
merchants,
apprentices and women. Even
more
than
Montrose,
Howard
contends
that
`the
historical
investigator'
is
a
product of her own time and therefore she can never `recognize otherness in its pure form' but must always see it `in part through the framework of the present' (1986, 23). The uncertainties
of
the
present
moment
(late
twentieth-century
America)
explain
the
selection of the past moment (early modern England): the Renaissance was `a boundary or liminal space between two or more monolithic periods where one can see acted out a clash of paradigms and ideologies, a playfulness with signifying systems, a self-reflexivity, and a self-consciousness about the tenuous solidity of human identity which resonate with some of the dominant elements of postmodern culture' (1986, 16±17). In the English
modern north american criticism and theory
108
Renaissance
contemporary
critics
find
fragmentation
and
dissonance
similar
to
the
cacophony of their own world. Howard stresses that any critical interpretation of the past is an intervention, an attempt
The Stage and Social Struggle
to recuperate meaning from the past for the present. Thus her
in Early Modern England
(1994) looks at the ways in which a broad range of Renaissance
texts ± canonical works by Shakespeare and Jonson, anti-theatrical pamphlets and obscure dramas
such
as
The Whore of Babylon
The Wise Woman of Hogsden
and
±
represent
theatrical practices through language. She finds that theatrical discourse in the period was contradictory but reflective of social change. True to her self-description as a `Marxist feminist',
Howard
focuses
on
the
ways
in
which
servants,
rogues,
vagabonds,
London
citizens and women were represented in ways that sometimes supported, but also sometimes challenged, the dominant male, aristocratic power structure. Howard rejects the by-now outmoded model of subversion vs. containment for a more fluid paradigm of social struggle and contestation. New historicism has had its share of detractors. In the critical ferment of the 1980s, feminists found the movement's founding `fathers' ± Greenblatt, Orgel and Goldberg ± negligent for their indifference to the `woman's part'. Carol Thomas Neely charged that new
historicists
resorted
to
the
same
old
`male,
upper
class'
texts,
and
continued
to
marginalize women (1988, 8±10). In a review of studies of the family in Shakespeare, Lynda E. Boose ruefully wondered, `Since feminism is, by definition, a subversive site of resistance
to
the
(Foucauldian) co-opted
by
dominant
premise
the
that
dominant
discourse, any
site
what
of
is
to
subversive
institution?'
(1987,
be
made
resistance
741).
Peter
out is
of
new
inevitably
Erickson
historicism's defeated
surmised
that
or
the
schism between feminists and new historicists was a result of `their conflicting attitudes toward the present . . . [W]here new historicism regards the present as an influence to be neutralized or escaped, feminist criticism views the present ± including the lives we are living or able to imagine now ± as a vital resource and a source of strength' (1987, 335). During the late
1980s
and throughout the 1990s, however, the
work of
materialist
feminists such as Jean E. Howard, Karen Newman, Phyllis Rackin, Dympna Callaghan, Valerie Wayne and Catherine Belsey have undermined this binary opposition. Gender in their work, as Steven Mullaney notes, is
historically situated, not subordinated to an amorphous concept of power (as early versions of new historicism tended to do), but no longer the exclusive or central category of analysis (as early feminist critiques of new historicism insisted it should be); rather, in such work, gender
is
increasingly
inscribed
within
a
complex
nexus
of
class,
gender,
and
race
hierarchies. (1996, 34)
The opposition between new historicism and feminism, which was probably exaggerated to begin with, has faded as a new synthesis of approaches develops. As Lynda E. Boose's critique suggests, new historicism has been particularly vulnerable to criticism for upholding the Foucauldian notion that power ineluctably works to contain and
delimit
subversion.
Greenblatt's
conclusion
to
his
most
frequently
cited
essay,
`Invisible Bullets' ± `There is subversion, no end of subversion, only not for us' (1988, 65) ± has become a mantra for criticism from both left and right. Academic conservatives see in this doctrine a dangerous shift towards determinism that erases human agency and makes the author a mere conduit of social and political forces. Edward Pechter thus lumped new
historicism
with
marxist
criticism
because
it
views
`all
history
and
contemporary
stephen greenblatt and the new historicism
109
political life as determined, wholly or in essence, by struggle, contestation, power relations,
libido dominandi Critics
' (1987, 292).
from
containment
is
the
left
also
inevitable,
attack
that
`Invisible
efforts
to
Bullets'
effect
social
because change
of
are
its
insistence
inevitably
that
doomed.
Walter Cohen, for example, charged that `new historicism describes historical difference, but it does not explain historical change'; he suggested that new historicism was, in effect, a form of `leftist disillusionment' (1986, 33, 36). Defending new historicism from Pechter's charges of `Marxism', Carolyn Porter called on its practitioners to examine more carefully their theoretical assumptions: `new historicists must begin to ask themselves whether and when
this
ostensibly
kind
of
wants
to
analysis
becomes
analyse
and
complicit
resist'
(1988,
in
the
781;
cultural
see
also
operations
Porter
of
power
1989±90).
it
Frank
Lentricchia blamed new historicism in general, and Greenblatt in particular, for espousing orthodoxy disguised as radicalism and for suggesting that `all struggle against a dominant ideology is in vain' (Lentricchia 1989, 239). Despite this array of critiques ± or perhaps because of it ± new historicism seems to have blended into the mainstream as the twenty-first century begins. The work of Stephen Greenblatt and other new historicists has opened up new topics for research and new ways of thinking.
More
important,
the
multidisciplinary
thrust
of
their
work
has
been
widely
adopted in literary and cultural studies in the United States. Literary scholars now avidly embrace texts and methodologies that would not have been considered appropriate to the study of literature twenty-five years ago, and they have broadened the canon to include works from a wide array of nationalities and ethnic groups that were previously marginalized. The new historicist drive to broaden the canon, too, has been subject to criticism. Pechter, for example, decried new historicism's tendency to flatten out all texts, removing great works of literature from a primary place (1987). Paul Cantor echoed this theme: `New Historicism works to assimilate [masterpieces of literature] to the average and everyday of their era, to diminish their aura, ultimately to strip them of their claims to genius' (1993, 25). But such fears about a total revamp of the canon are clearly unfounded. New historicists continue to proffer Shakespeare pride of place in the literary pantheon: along with Jean E. Howard, Walter Cohen and Katherine Eisaman Maus, Greenblatt edited
The Norton Shakespeare
(1997) for the
textbook market, while Bedford editions of Shakespeare's plays provide an abundance of `Texts and Contexts' that ± in accord with new historicist teachings ± situate the dramas within the larger framework of early modern political, social and cultural economies. As early as 1986 Montrose predicted that new historicism was on its way to becoming the newest orthodoxy (1986, 5), a prescient statement that in many ways now seems a reality. No longer a young Turk resisting Yale's formalist father figures, Stephen Greenblatt now holds an endowed chair at Harvard University and, more significantly, he is the new Associate General Editor of the current
Norton Anthology of English Literature
(2000), the
two-volume textbook that for decades has set the canon studied by millions of students in the United States. At the beginning of the twenty-first century, the critical practices grouped together under the rubric `new historicism' are exercised throughout the United States, not only in university and college English departments, but in the study
of foreign literatures, art
history, geography, film and culture. One might even say that what in the 1980s seemed to be a strikingly `new' practice is now simply common practice.
Virginia Mason Vaughan
modern north american criticism and theory
110
Further reading and works cited Boose, L. E. `The Family in Shakespeare Studies; or ± Studies in the Family of Shakespeareans; or ± The Politics of Politics',
Renaissance Quarterly,
40, 1987.
Cantor, P. A. `Stephen Greenblatt's New Historicist Vision', Cohen, W. `Political Criticism of Shakespeare', in
Academic Questions,
Shakespeare Reproduced,
6, 1993.
eds J. E. Howard and M. F.
O'Connor. New York, 1986. Colebrook, C.
New Literary Histories.
Manchester, 1997.
Erickson, P. `Rewriting the Renaissance, Rewriting Ourselves', Foucault, M. Goldberg, J.
The Order of Things.
James I and the Politics of Literature.
Greenblatt, S. J.
Sir Walter Ralegh.
Shakespeare Quarterly,
38, 1987.
New York, 1970. Baltimore, MD, 1983.
New Haven, CT, 1973.
Ð.
Renaissance Self-Fashioning from More to Shakespeare.
Ð.
Shakespearean Negotiations: The Circulation of Social Energy in Renaissance England ,
Chicago, 1980. Berkeley, CA,
1988. Ð. `Introduction to the Forms of Power and the Power of Forms', Ð.
Learning to Curse.
Ð.
Marvellous Possessions.
15, 1982.
Chicago, 1991.
Howard, J. E. `The New Historicism in Renaissance Studies', Ð.
Genre,
New York, 1990.
The Stage and Social Struggle in Early Modern England.
Lentricchia, F. `Foucault's Legacy', in
English Literary Renaissance,
16, 1986.
London, 1994.
The New Historicism,
ed. H. Aram Veeser. New York, 1989.
Montrose, L. `Renaissance Literary Studies and the Subject of History',
English Literary Renaissance,
16, 1986. Ð.
The Purpose of Playing.
Chicago, 1996.
Mullaney, S. `After the New Historicism', in Neely, C. T. `Constructing the Subject', Orgel, S.
The Illusion of Power.
Alternative Shakespeares,
ed. T. Hawkes. London, 1996.
English Literary Renaissance,
18, 1988.
Berkeley, CA, 1975.
Pechter, E. `The New Historicism and its Discontents: Politicizing Renaissance Drama',
PMLA,
102,
1987. Porter, C. `Are We Being Historical Yet?', Ð. `History and Literature', Veeser, H. Aram (ed.)
South Atlantic Quarterly,
New Literary History,
The New Historicism.
87, 1988.
21, 1989±90.
New York, 1989.
16. Lesbian and Gay Studies/Queer Theory
Queer theory in the United States is opposed to the kind of encyclopaedic categorization of knowledge represented by this volume. At the same time, it is committed to the global dissemination of information also represented by this volume. It is only by acknowledging the difficulty (and perhaps the disingenuousness) of offering a summary overview that any scholar can hope to describe the disruptive critical endeavour undertaken by queer scholars in the United States. US queer studies is an amalgam of various theoretical methodologies ± feminist, marxist, Foucauldian,
deconstructive and new
historicist (among others). Coming
to academic
prominence during the last two decades, queer studies offers insight into issues of gender in
modern north american criticism and theory
110
Further reading and works cited Boose, L. E. `The Family in Shakespeare Studies; or ± Studies in the Family of Shakespeareans; or ± The Politics of Politics',
Renaissance Quarterly,
40, 1987.
Cantor, P. A. `Stephen Greenblatt's New Historicist Vision', Cohen, W. `Political Criticism of Shakespeare', in
Academic Questions,
Shakespeare Reproduced,
6, 1993.
eds J. E. Howard and M. F.
O'Connor. New York, 1986. Colebrook, C.
New Literary Histories.
Manchester, 1997.
Erickson, P. `Rewriting the Renaissance, Rewriting Ourselves', Foucault, M. Goldberg, J.
The Order of Things.
James I and the Politics of Literature.
Greenblatt, S. J.
Sir Walter Ralegh.
Shakespeare Quarterly,
38, 1987.
New York, 1970. Baltimore, MD, 1983.
New Haven, CT, 1973.
Ð.
Renaissance Self-Fashioning from More to Shakespeare.
Ð.
Shakespearean Negotiations: The Circulation of Social Energy in Renaissance England ,
Chicago, 1980. Berkeley, CA,
1988. Ð. `Introduction to the Forms of Power and the Power of Forms', Ð.
Learning to Curse.
Ð.
Marvellous Possessions.
15, 1982.
Chicago, 1991.
Howard, J. E. `The New Historicism in Renaissance Studies', Ð.
Genre,
New York, 1990.
The Stage and Social Struggle in Early Modern England.
Lentricchia, F. `Foucault's Legacy', in
English Literary Renaissance,
16, 1986.
London, 1994.
The New Historicism,
ed. H. Aram Veeser. New York, 1989.
Montrose, L. `Renaissance Literary Studies and the Subject of History',
English Literary Renaissance,
16, 1986. Ð.
The Purpose of Playing.
Chicago, 1996.
Mullaney, S. `After the New Historicism', in Neely, C. T. `Constructing the Subject', Orgel, S.
The Illusion of Power.
Alternative Shakespeares,
ed. T. Hawkes. London, 1996.
English Literary Renaissance,
18, 1988.
Berkeley, CA, 1975.
Pechter, E. `The New Historicism and its Discontents: Politicizing Renaissance Drama',
PMLA,
102,
1987. Porter, C. `Are We Being Historical Yet?', Ð. `History and Literature', Veeser, H. Aram (ed.)
South Atlantic Quarterly,
New Literary History,
The New Historicism.
87, 1988.
21, 1989±90.
New York, 1989.
16. Lesbian and Gay Studies/Queer Theory
Queer theory in the United States is opposed to the kind of encyclopaedic categorization of knowledge represented by this volume. At the same time, it is committed to the global dissemination of information also represented by this volume. It is only by acknowledging the difficulty (and perhaps the disingenuousness) of offering a summary overview that any scholar can hope to describe the disruptive critical endeavour undertaken by queer scholars in the United States. US queer studies is an amalgam of various theoretical methodologies ± feminist, marxist, Foucauldian,
deconstructive and new
historicist (among others). Coming
to academic
prominence during the last two decades, queer studies offers insight into issues of gender in
lesbian and gay studies/queer theory
general
and
the
heterosexual/homosexual
111
nexus
in
particular.
Moreover,
like
cultural
studies, postcolonialism and other nascent disciplines during this period of the so-called `cultural wars', queer studies stands as a testing ground for a whole range of postmodern attempts
to
understand
`difference'
±
both
in
terms
of
culturally
specific
conditions
concerning race/ethnicity, class and gender, and as a general category of knowledge. It is important not to overstate the role of academic critics in the study of gay culture. Homosexuality has, of course, been an object of interest since at least the medico-scientific research of the late nineteenth-century sexologists, most famously Richard von KrafftEbing, Karl Heinrich Ulrichs, Magnus Hirschfeld, John Addington Symonds, Havelock Ellis and of course Sigmund Freud. The origins of recent gay scholarship reach beyond academic theory back to the grassroots politics of sexual liberation. As long as there have been homosexuals, there has been interest in defining what constitutes the sub-culture, if only as a means of identifying possible sexual partners without fear of legal prosecution. Quite simply, one has always had to know a fair amount about patterns of homosexual behaviour to know whom to cruise. The early history of gay academic scholarship is generally comparable to that of other minority
disciplines. The
haphazard
study
of
homosexuality
in America
became
more
systematic after the Second World War, especially as part of Gay Liberation's pursuit of visibility following New York's Stonewall Rebellion in the summer of 1969. In the earliest stage of recent gay studies (the period roughly from the late 1960s to the late 1970s), journalists and scholars offered popular accounts of previously invisible homosexuals. The forerunner of such work was Jeannette H. Foster's pioneering study in 1956 of `sex variant [lesbian]' women in literature. More than a decade later book-length histories started to appear, often in conjunction with community organizations like San Francisco's Lesbian and Gay History Project or New York's Lesbian Herstory Archives. Jonathan Ned Katz and Martin Greif undertook broad surveys of gay men and women in history. For the popular press, Vito Russo explored the `closeted' presence of homosexuals in film, while Kenneth Anger tattled on the sexual misdeeds of a Hollywood `Babylon'. And in the late 1970s, to counteract the soft-core porn of Alex Comfort's heterosexual best-seller
The Joy of Sex,
Edmund White, Charles Silverstein, Emily Sisley and Bertha Harris all proclaimed the more complex sociological `joy' of gay and lesbian sex. These early commercial efforts were primarily
intended
homophobic isolated
to
educate
misconceptions,
lesbians
and
gay
straight
they
men
society
offered
unaware
and
historical
that
their
embolden profiles sexual
gay
in
readers.
gay
Correcting
courage
preference
was
to
those
shared
by
approximately one-tenth of America. Such efforts at consciousness-raising were followed in the late 1970s and early 1980s by more academic social and literary histories. The relocation of the centre of gay studies from the
grassroots
movements
(primarily
in
urban
communities)
to
the
academy
entailed
certain predictable shifts in form and emphasis. Many of the historical studies addressed specific issues, not all explicitly gay. Making space for sexuality in history was work by (among others): Estelle Freedman on American prison reform; John D'Emilio on pre rube  on Stonewall community groups; Guido Ruggiero on Renaissance Venice; Allan Be the Second World War; Judith C. Brown on a seventeenth-century Italian nun; B. R. Burg on
seventeenth-century
between
1890
encyclopaedic reference
for
and
account early
Caribbean
1940. of
Some
pirates;
histories
Christian
Church
opinion.
and took
tolerance In
a
George a
Chauncey
broader
toward
on
homosexuality
wide-ranging
New
perspective.
series
of
York
John
became
articles,
City
Boswell's the
key
subsequently
modern north american criticism and theory
112
collected, Martin Bauml Duberman and Carroll Smith-Rosenberg studied same-sex male and
female
relations
respectively
in
nineteenth-century
America.
And
more
recently
Freedman and D'Emilio turned from their specialized studies to co-author an overview of the history of American sexuality both gay and straight. The difference between these histories and their popular predecessors was as much one of
method
as
of
meaning,
and
scholarly
work
was
fully
compatible
with
the
popular
campaigns for `gay pride'. In chronicling the social oppression of homosexuals, historians implicitly defended gay civil rights. And in analysing earlier periods to demonstrate the existence of a positive attitude toward homosexuality, they used the precedent of the past to
counter
historians
contemporary
was
attacks
supplemented
on
sexual
somewhat
`unnaturalness'.
later
by
The
comparable
work
studies
of
of
professional
gay
aspects
of
literature. Some of these studies ± like those of Lillian Faderman on the development of lesbian
culture,
Enlightenment
Martha
Vicinus
Englishmen
or
on
Shari
Victorian Benstock
working on
the
women,
Left
Bank
G.
S.
female
Rousseau
on
modernists
±
approached literature with a eye to social history. Others ± like Robert K. Martin's survey of a gay
male
continuum in American
poetry
± were
more
traditionally
literary
in their
analysis. Biographers, too, began to pay more attention to the role of sexuality in identity formation, discussing the homosexuality of such writers as Lord Byron, Walt Whitman, Emily Dickinson, Henry James, Willa Cather and even such fellow academics as Ludwig Wittgenstein and Alan Turing. Although already a substantial body of work, gay and lesbian scholarship did not have much influence on mainstream theory until the 1980s, when an alliance between feminism and gay male studies placed it at the centre of gender debates. The established feminist scholar Elaine Showalter called for a broadening (and renaming) of `women's studies' as `gender studies' to signal the greater variety of ways in which one could `speak of' gender. Readings by D. A. Miller, Craig Owens, Joseph Allen Boone and Lee Edelman responded to (or anticipated) this call, adapting the paradigms of feminist theory to the study of male homosexuality. The central figure in the rapprochement between feminism and gay studies was the trail-blazing theorist Eve Kosofsky Sedgwick. Her 1985 book
Literature and Male Homosocial Discourse
used
Gayle
Rubin's
Between Men: English
notion
of
the
`traffic
in
women' to explore the misogyny and homophobia behind the representation of male±male `homosocial'
relations
in
canonical
English
literature.
And
Epistemology of the Closet,
Sedgwick's magisterial 1990 work, placed gay males at the centre of gender theory with its ringing opening statement that `an understanding of virtually any aspect of modern western culture must be, not merely incomplete, but damaged in its central substance to the degree that it does not incorporate a critical analysis of modern homo/heterosexual definition' (Sedgwick 1990, 1). In this first stage of academic commodification, gay studies read feminist theory through the
postmodern
lens
of
Derridean
Central was Foucault's claim in
deconstruction
and
Foucauldian
History of Sexuality: Volume I
discourse
analysis.
that the history of sexuality is
a history not of bodily activities but of `discursive practices', a history less of `sex' than of things said about sex. According to Foucault, `homosexuality' as a concept did not appear until the invention of the medico-scientific discourse of sexuality in 1869. Before that shift in discursive paradigms, homosexuality was understood as a series of related physical acts, but not associated with any sense of a unified sensibility or even of a distinct character type, `the homosexual'. In Foucault's powerful formulation, `homosexuality appeared as one of the forms of sexuality when it was transposed from the practice of sodomy onto a kind of
lesbian and gay studies/queer theory
113
interior androgyny, a hermaphrodism of the soul. The sodomite had been a temporary aberration; the homosexual was now a species' (Foucault 1978, 43). Academic gay intellectuals had always recognized the dangers of identity politics and of the
very
concept
of
`identity'
itself.
To
avoid
what
Foucault
considered
the
sin
of
`transhistoricism', American gay scholarship for the most part insisted that `homosexuality', along with other categories of minority difference like gender, race and ethnicity, was `socially constructed'. A debate between this constructionist position and the complementary
`essentialist'
reading
occupied
centre
stage
throughout
the
scholarship
of
the
1980s. Predictably, both positions made valid points, and both were capable of being overstated. Essentialist interpretations began in the attempt to identify the historical and cultural conditions characteristic of a specific sexual subgroup. At their most extreme, however, essentialists treated same-sex love as a timeless entity, leaving themselves open to charges
of
ahistoricism
and
even
biological
determinism.
Aiming
for
greater
historio-
graphic and linguistic precision, constructionists demonstrated that the definition of sexual preference as a timeless entity called `homosexuality' was itself the product of a particular historical moment in nineteenth-century Victorian culture. Coupling Foucault's sense of historical discontinuity with Derrida's theories of linguistic undecidability, constructionists insisted that identity categories should be treated as cultural fictions, implicitly within quotation marks. At best the constructionists ably battled presentism and parochialism. The apparent similarity of same-sex object-choice throughout the ages should not obscure how
different
cultures
experience
that
choice
differently:
clone
lovers
in
Greenwich
Village share little social reality with Sambian adolescents in New Guinea, or with Socrates and Sappho in ancient Greece. When pressed too far, however, this corrective flirted with cultural determinism. It at times represented sexual preference as so wholly imposed from without that same-sex love appeared as merely a social epiphenomenon, with no grounding in desire. The limitations of the debate were clearest in its treatment of one of the central political issues of the decade ± the spread of HIV virus throughout the gay male population of Europe and North America. More than any other single factor, the health crisis made visible
the
diversity
(and
disagreements)
within
western
homosexuality.
The
uneven
spread of the virus through gay communities tragically illustrated that differences in gender, race/ethnicity
and
class
(to
say
nothing
of
specific
sexual
practices)
could
be
more
important than similarities in sexual object-choice. Just as AIDS problematized definitions of
what
constitutes
`being
gay',
it
also
challenged
understanding
of
the
relationship
between academic analysis and political activism. The problem was not, as traditionalists occasionally argued,
that AIDS was not a proper object for scholarly study. The gaps
between biological evidence and scientific interpretation demonstrated that representations of the disease were as fully fictionalized as any literary narrative. Yet there remained questions about what kind of fiction AIDS was and what knowledge could come from analysing it. In the public arena, fiery protests from activist groups like ACTUP combined with acts of civil disobedience profoundly to change governmental policies concerning education and drug distribution. In more purely academic settings, however, comparable deconstructions of `the AIDS text' seemed less consequential, even smug. It was hard for `readings' of AIDS not to recycle platitudes about sexism, racism and homophobia, while flirting with the very objectification they deplored. By representing the health crisis in terms of fashionable theoretical paradigms, scholars did not so much use social construction to deconstruct the misconceptions of scientific discourse as use the (easily agreed upon)
modern north american criticism and theory
114
limitations of AIDS representations to validate Foucauldian and Derridean paradigms as methods of cultural critique. The problematic relation between deconstructive linguistic theories and practical politics was one played out in many disciplines ± race theory, postcolonialism and minority discourse, as well as gay studies. Although continuing to use constructionist language to caution against ahistoricism in sexuality studies, by the 1990s most scholars found the essentialist/social constructionist controversy less interesting than they had five years earlier. The impersonality of some postmodern paradigms simply did not seem to afford a means to discuss subcultural specificity. In the words of the black gay cultural historian Kobena Mercer, `although romanticist notions of authorial creativity cannot be returned to the central role they once played in criticism and interpretation, the question of agency in
cultural practices that
does
contest the canon and its cultural dominance suggests that it really
matter who is
speaking' (Mercer 1994, 194). And after the banishment of `the author' and `the subject' in the
1980s, many
minority
scholars in
the
1990s
began
to
call
for
a
reconsideration
of
essentialism, whether as `strategic essentialism' or the `risk of essentialism'. Some of the new tone in gay studies undoubtedly resulted from the rise of a parallel but distinct
strain
of
lesbian
theory.
Both
lesbian
and
gay
studies
derived
considerable
intellectual force and professional visibility from their readings in feminist theory. Yet the route by which gay male theory developed out of (and after) feminism was not identical to that by which lesbian theory developed alongside (and contemporaneous with) it. No single model can describe the relation between feminism and lesbian theory. Lesbians played important roles in the rebirth of feminism in the 1960s, and in fact two of modern feminism's anthology
founding
texts
±
Kate
Sisterhood is Powerful
Millett's
(1970)
±
Sexual Politics are
also
early
(1970)
and
statements
Robin
in
Morgan's
lesbian
theory.
Straight feminist accounts of homosexuality run the full range of responses, from homophobic to homophilic. The early work of feminist Betty Friedan was explicitly anti-gay and implicitly anti-lesbian. Ellen Moers' early literary history was anti-lesbian, though not antigay. Luce Irigaray's theory could be interpreted as anti-gay, though not as anti-lesbian. And most post-Foucauldian theorists ± male and female, gay and straight ± reproduced their mentor's silence about the role of lesbian desire in the construction of the homosexual.
The
very
ease
with
which
straight
feminists
assimilated
gay
Á cle fin-de-sie
male
theory
seemed to mask a lingering discomfort with lesbianism. It was at least worrisome, as more than one theorist remarked, that despite numerous accounts of `gay men in feminism' a parallel history of `gay women in feminism' remained unwritten, as though the topic were simultaneously redundant and de trop. Less wedded than gay male theory to Foucauldian or deconstructive paradigms, lesbian theory was more interested in defining what constituted non-traditional sexualities than in
attacking
attempts offering
by an
regularly historical
those
definitions
Bonnie
alternative
rejected periods
complementary
as
socially
Zimmerman,
as
of
`essentialist'.
and
ways
`history'
among of
Julie
constructed.
Abrahams
lesbian
The
texts,
wish
homosexual
conceptualizing
to
and
This
and an
trace
difference
others
enterprise lesbian
heterosexual
homosocial
to
was
modify that
gay
relations
canon
male
continuities, subjects,
apparent
the
among
theory
both
resulted
in by
across in
women.
two The
historian Carroll Smith-Rosenberg, in her ground-breaking article `The Female World of
Love
and
Ritual'
(first
published
in
1975),
argued
that
the
nineteenth
century
permitted a ritualized style of romantic, even sentimentalized affection which to modern ears
sounds
sexualized.
She
concluded
that
`the
twentieth-century
tendency
to
view
lesbian and gay studies/queer theory
115
human love and sexuality within a dichotomized universe of deviance and normality, genitality and platonic love, is alien
to the emotions and attitudes
of the nineteenth
century and fundamentally distorts the nature of these women's emotional interaction' (Smith-Rosenberg
1985,
58±9).
The
poet/critic
Adrienne
Rich
argued
for
a
more
`transhistorical' position five years later in her `Compulsory Heterosexuality and Lesbian Existence'. Through `compulsory heterosexuality', the false claim that people are `naturally' attracted to people of the opposite sex, society institutionalizes behavioural norms like heterosexuality (and by extension domesticity or capitalism) that threaten all forms of feminism gay or straight. To resist covert social attempts to homogenize desire, Rich not
only
along
a
asserted `lesbian
`lesbian
existence';
continuum',
a
she
single
imagined
line
that
female
included
sexual the
identities
full
`range
positioned of
woman-
identified experience, not simply the fact that a woman has had or consciously desired genital sexual experience with another woman' (Abelove et al. 1993, 239). Much lesbian theory
focused on rethinking, even recuperating,
cultural
stereotypes.
Anthropologist Esther Newton praised the usually pejorative notions of camp male `drag' and of lesbian `mannishness'. Drama theorist Sue-Ellen Case celebrated the transgressive character
of
what
others
had
considered
the
restrictive
Âs cliche
of
the
butch±femme
relationship and of lesbian vampirism. Especially influential in these recuperations were Á re's notion of insights drawn from performance and film theory. Building on Joan Rivie femaleness
as
a
`masquerade'
and
Laura
Mulvey's
claim
that
the
cinematic
gaze
was
inherently male, theorists like Case, Teresa de Lauretis and Kaja Silverman explored the implications of masquerade and the male gaze for sexuality. One particularly celebrated use of performance theory was that of philosopher Judith Butler. In
Gender Trouble: Feminism
and the Subversion of Identity, Butler argued that `the identity categories often presumed to be foundational
to feminist politics
. . . simultaneously
work to limit
and constrain in
advance the very cultural possibilities that feminism is supposed to open up'; that `gender' as
a
category
(Butler
1990,
unwittingly
supported
147,
Bodies That Matter: On the Discursive Limits of `Sex' , Butler
x).
In
gender
hierarchy
and
compulsory
heterosexuality
explored the interconnections between the `performativity' of gender and the materiality of the body. Butler conceived performativity both as an authoritarian form of speech, in which power acted
as discourse, and as a linguistic relation that automatically implicated
speakers in the very thing they opposed (Butler 1993, 225, 241). She understood bodily materiality as the effect of a dynamic of power, and construed `sex' not as a biological fact but as a cultural norm (ibid., 2±3). Her sense that performativity constituted the sex/gender matrix was subsequently taken up by such theorists of male sexuality as Sedgwick, Miller and Edelman, and remains one of the reigning paradigms of contemporary sexuality theory. The models of performance popularized by Butler and Sedgwick employed an aggressively postmodern notion of `self', coupling a Derridean focus on iterability with a psychoanalytic (often Lacanian) interest in repetition compulsion, abjection and interpellation to critique as static the more traditional Austinian sense of the linguistic performative. In the early 1990s these high theory paradigms found their notions of transgressive theatricality embodied in a grassroots movement seeking to expose some political limitations of Gay Liberation. At the start of the new decade, a group called `Queer Nation' extended the political project of ACTUP beyond the specific focus on AIDS reform to decry more generally the conservative, middle-class ethos of 1970s gay activism. Distancing itself from the misogyny and racism of earlier sexual movements, Queer Nation discarded as tainted the adjective `gay' and adopted instead the self-appellation `queer'.
116 modern north american criticism and theory Such confrontiveness was not universally admired by older generations, and as a coherent political movement Queer Nation lasted only a few years. Yet scholars saw in its disruptive tactics a model for the transformative potential of language. Judith Butler argued that such a use of `queer' did not simply redefine a term of derision into one of celebration. Calling into question the very nature of power, queering was `a linguistic practice whose purpose has been the shaming of the subject it names' (Butler 1993, 226). Others read the movement even more broadly, and influential `special issues' of differences and Social Text, edited respectively by Teresa de Lauretis and Michael Warner, used the term `queer' to call for a coalition among various minority positions ± gay and lesbian of course, but also other less clearly defined outcasts. As Warner explained in the introduction to Fear of a Queer Planet, `queer politics brings [together] very differently sexualized and differently politicized people' into a movement that `rejects a minoritizing logic of toleration or simple political interest-representation in favour of a more thorough resistance to the regime of the normal' (Warner 1993, xvi, xxvi). Or, as he stated in a piece co-authored with Lauren Berlant, `without assimilating queerness to a familiar minority identity like gay', queer theory `wants to address the full range of power-ridden normativities of sex': `the name queer [is not] an umbrella for gays, lesbians, bisexuals, and the transgendered. Queer politics makes available different understandings of membership at different times, and membership in them is more a matter of aspiration than it is the expression of an identity or a history' (Berlant and Warner 1991, 346, 345, 344). Everyone understood that there were limitations to conceiving of sexuality as oppositional. Leo Bersani long ago remarked that anyone who has ever been to a gay bathhouse understands that homosexuality does not necessary entail open-mindedness. While supporting the principles of `queeritude', Lauren Berlant cautioned that in its allegiance to the rhetorics of camp and citizenship, Queer Nation might unintentionally have reinforced an American national fantasy of consensus. Moreover, in declaring that `queer' sexuality does not depend purely on sexual identity, theorists extended minority status to those not systematically discriminated against: people apparently empowered by the mainstream could declare themselves individually `queered' by their personal deviations from heteronormativity. Doubting the value of any form of institutionalization, queer theory opposed all attempts to map out a `gay and lesbian' literary canon. The unfortunate result of such an admirable scepticism was that queer theory all too often focused on the already canonical work of Oscar Wilde or Henry James, while ignoring the importance of contemporary work by James Baldwin, John Rechy, Jane Rule, Audre Lorde, Samuel R. Delaney, Thomas Disch, Michael Nava, Dorothy Allison and Jewelle Gomez. Most distressing, however, was the way in which the oppositional strategy was so quickly domesticated by the mainstream. Not offering itself as a new category of knowledge, queer theory meant to challenge the very notion of labelling. When `queer' became simply the new name for Barnes & Noble shelves formerly labelled `Gay and Lesbian', the term, evacuated of its political content, lost much of its transformation status. Queer performativity is still an active, and arguably the dominant, paradigm of contemporary US theory of sexuality, especially as applied to cultural studies and theatre and film theory. Alive to the problems of commodification and co-optation, however, queer theorists have in recent years taken performance paradigms in a range of new directions. While it is too early to generalize comfortably about the shape of these new explorations, two tendencies have emerged. One develops out of ideological criticism in general (and Althusserian accounts of the invisibility of state apparatus in particular) to
lesbian and gay studies/queer theory
117
explore not the minority position but the character of dominant culture. Long ago Richard Dyer deplored the way in which `whiteness' was `unmarked', pretending to characterlessness at the same time that it constructed the putative differentiating traits with which to identify racial and ethnic minorities. Dyer and Ruth Frankenberg (among others) have continued to critique this misrepresentation both through delineating the processes by which whiteness manufactures its own invisibility, and by `marking' whiteness with the traits it represses. Similar critiques of the process by which hegemony renders itself invisible have considered the issues of masculinity and citizenship. Men's studies have for a long time applied feminist paradigms of the sex/gender system to understand maleness. More recently,
Judith
Halberstam
has
worked
to
separate
the
concept
of
`masculinity'
from
biology to claim that the processes by which masculinity has been constructed are most easily recognized in female masculinity. Similarly Warner, Berlant and a number of other scholars
have
problematized
the
notion
of
American
citizenship
with
quasi-Lacanian
critiques of the `National Symbolic' and `Queer Symbolic', the linguistic process by which those not actually enfranchised are made to feel as if they have been afforded a voice within national discourse. Another new direction studies the `intersectionality' among sexuality and other minority identities, customarily those of gender, race/ethnicity and class. Cultural studies scholars like Stuart Hall had always considered issues of `double' minoritization, and film-makers ± most notably the Sankofa Collective and Isaac Julien in Great Britain and Marlon Riggs and Cheryl Dunye in the US ± frequently explored the complexities of black gay identity. Since
its
institutionalization,
lesbian
and
gay
theory
has
tried
to
modify
its
own
pre-
dominantly white middle-class sensibility, especially along the lines suggested in famous  s Almaguer, Barbara Smith, bell hooks, Gloria Anzaldu Âa critiques by Kobena Mercer, Toma and
Cherrie
Norma
Moraga.
 rcon Ala
identities,
which
Theorists
have are
of
colour
increasingly
treated
as
like
focused
relatively
 Kimberle
not
on
stable,
but
Crenshaw,
the on
Valerie Smith
indeterminacy the
of
interpretative
and
individual ambiguities
that arise from the intersections (and at times indistinguishability) among those categories. Theorists
of
sexuality
like
David
Van
Leer
and
Robyn
Wiegman
applied
notions
of
`intersectionality' to include the sex/gender nexus. They argue that minority identities are traditionally treated as indistinguishable by the dominant culture and cannot really be studied as discrete entities. Such interest in a multi-valent `minority discourse' rejects the binaries of traditional minority scholarship, emphasizing the conversations among minority identities over the ways in which each is victimized and disciplined by dominant culture. It is pointless to predict paths for queer theory. Many recent developments in the field cannot be separated from similar impulses to globalization and multiculturalism in related disciplines like women's studies, race/ethnic studies, film studies, postcolonial studies and cultural studies. As a result of these shared impulses, sexuality theory may see less the further
development
of
its
own
methodologies
than
an
amalgamation
with
other
dis-
ciplines. But whether the future of sexuality lies in performativity, multi-ethnicity, or some as-yet undefined interdisciplinary coalition, at the beginning of the new millennium queer theory remains one of the most lively and active of academic enterprises.
David Van Leer
modern north american criticism and theory
118
Further reading and works cited Abelove, H. et al. (eds) Berlant, L.
The Lesbian and Gay Studies Reader. New York, 1993.
The Queen of America Goes to Washington City: Essays on Sex and Citizenship . Durham, NC,
1997. Ð and Warner, M. `What Does Queer Theory Teach Us about X?',
Periodical of Modern Languages
Association, 110, 1991. Bersani, L. `Is the Rectum a Grave?', in
AIDS: Cultural Analysis/Cultural Activism , ed. D. Crimp.
Cambridge, MA, 1988. Boone, J. A. and Cadden, M. (eds) Boswell, J.
Engendering Men. New York, 1990.
Christianity, Social Tolerance, and Homosexuality: Gay People in Western Europe from the
Beginning of the Christian Era to the Fourteenth Century. Chicago, 1980. Butler, J. Ð.
Gender Trouble: Feminism and the Subversion of Identity. New York, 1990.
Bodies that Matter: On the Discursive Limits of `Sex' . New York, 1993.
Case, S.-E. (ed.)
Performing Feminisms. Baltimore, MD, 1990. Out in Culture. Durham, NC, 1995.
Creekmur, C. K. and Doty, A. (eds) de Lauretis, T.
The Practice of Love. Bloomington, IN, 1994.
Duberman, M. Bauml et al. (eds)
Hidden From History: Reclaiming the Gay and Lesbian Past . New York,
1989.
Surpassing the Love of Men. New York, 1981.
Faderman, L. Foucault, M.
History of Sexuality: Volume I, An Introduction. New York, 1978.
Frankenberg, R.
White Women, Race Matters. Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
Fuss, D.
Essentially Speaking. New York, 1989.
Ð (ed.)
Inside/Out. New York, 1991.
Halberstram, J. Katz, J. N.
Martin, R. K. Mercer, K.
Female Masculinity. Durham, NC, 1998.
Gay American History. New York, 1976. The Homosexual Tradition in American Poetry . Austin, TX, 1979.
Welcome to the Jungle: New Positions in Black Cultural Studies . New York, 1994.
Miller, D. A.
The Novel and the Police. Berkeley, CA, 1988.
Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Ð.
Between Men. New York, 1985.
Epistemology of the Closet. Berkeley, CA, 1990.
Smith-Rosenberg, C. Van Leer, D.
Disorderly Conduct: Visions of Gender in Victorian America . New York, 1985.
The Queening of America: Gay Culture in Straight Society . New York, 1995.
Warner, M. (ed.) `Fear of a Queer Planet', Wiegman, R.
Cultural Politics, 6, 1993.
American Anatomies: Theorizing Race and Gender . Durham, NC, 1995.
Zimmerman, B. `What Has Never Been: An Overview of Lesbian Feminist Criticism', in
The New
Feminist Criticism, ed. E. Showalter. New York, 1985.
17. Postcolonial Studies
The publication of Edward Said's
Orientalism in 1978 inaugurated the field of postcolonial
studies in the US. Said's demonstration that an enormous number of literary, political, religious and philosophical texts about the Islamic Orient from the eighteenth century to the
present
functioned
as
a
Foucauldian
disciplinary
practice
linked
with
British
and
French colonization, influenced a generation of scholars. Although many, such as Homi
modern north american criticism and theory
118
Further reading and works cited Abelove, H. et al. (eds) Berlant, L.
The Lesbian and Gay Studies Reader. New York, 1993.
The Queen of America Goes to Washington City: Essays on Sex and Citizenship . Durham, NC,
1997. Ð and Warner, M. `What Does Queer Theory Teach Us about X?',
Periodical of Modern Languages
Association, 110, 1991. Bersani, L. `Is the Rectum a Grave?', in
AIDS: Cultural Analysis/Cultural Activism , ed. D. Crimp.
Cambridge, MA, 1988. Boone, J. A. and Cadden, M. (eds) Boswell, J.
Engendering Men. New York, 1990.
Christianity, Social Tolerance, and Homosexuality: Gay People in Western Europe from the
Beginning of the Christian Era to the Fourteenth Century. Chicago, 1980. Butler, J. Ð.
Gender Trouble: Feminism and the Subversion of Identity. New York, 1990.
Bodies that Matter: On the Discursive Limits of `Sex' . New York, 1993.
Case, S.-E. (ed.)
Performing Feminisms. Baltimore, MD, 1990. Out in Culture. Durham, NC, 1995.
Creekmur, C. K. and Doty, A. (eds) de Lauretis, T.
The Practice of Love. Bloomington, IN, 1994.
Duberman, M. Bauml et al. (eds)
Hidden From History: Reclaiming the Gay and Lesbian Past . New York,
1989.
Surpassing the Love of Men. New York, 1981.
Faderman, L. Foucault, M.
History of Sexuality: Volume I, An Introduction. New York, 1978.
Frankenberg, R.
White Women, Race Matters. Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
Fuss, D.
Essentially Speaking. New York, 1989.
Ð (ed.)
Inside/Out. New York, 1991.
Halberstram, J. Katz, J. N.
Martin, R. K. Mercer, K.
Female Masculinity. Durham, NC, 1998.
Gay American History. New York, 1976. The Homosexual Tradition in American Poetry . Austin, TX, 1979.
Welcome to the Jungle: New Positions in Black Cultural Studies . New York, 1994.
Miller, D. A.
The Novel and the Police. Berkeley, CA, 1988.
Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Ð.
Between Men. New York, 1985.
Epistemology of the Closet. Berkeley, CA, 1990.
Smith-Rosenberg, C. Van Leer, D.
Disorderly Conduct: Visions of Gender in Victorian America . New York, 1985.
The Queening of America: Gay Culture in Straight Society . New York, 1995.
Warner, M. (ed.) `Fear of a Queer Planet', Wiegman, R.
Cultural Politics, 6, 1993.
American Anatomies: Theorizing Race and Gender . Durham, NC, 1995.
Zimmerman, B. `What Has Never Been: An Overview of Lesbian Feminist Criticism', in
The New
Feminist Criticism, ed. E. Showalter. New York, 1985.
17. Postcolonial Studies
The publication of Edward Said's
Orientalism in 1978 inaugurated the field of postcolonial
studies in the US. Said's demonstration that an enormous number of literary, political, religious and philosophical texts about the Islamic Orient from the eighteenth century to the
present
functioned
as
a
Foucauldian
disciplinary
practice
linked
with
British
and
French colonization, influenced a generation of scholars. Although many, such as Homi
postcolonial studies Bhabha,
parted
119
company
with
Said
and
emphasized
the
ambivalence
rather
than
the
hegemony of colonial discourse, and feminists such as Gayatri Spivak forced a dialogue between western feminism and colonialism, the major areas of inquiry opened up by Said's work ± the analysis of western texts as colonial discourse, the investigation of representations of the colonized, the study of forms of resistance
to colonization in third world
literature ± all became important areas of inquiry in literary and cultural studies, and to a lesser
extent
in
decolonization,
history
and
anthropology.
neocolonialism
and
So,
imperialism
too, began
concerns to
be
such
seen
as
as
nationalism,
the
problems
of
language itself. More recently, postcolonial studies has concerned itself with the `internal colonization' of racial minorities in the US and with globalization. What explains the spectacular growth of postcolonial studies in the US academy in the 1980s? For marxist critics such as Aijaz Ahmad and Arif Dirlik, US postcolonial theory has flourished because of its complicity with global capitalism (Dirlik 1997, 503): its emergence at the beginning of global capitalism; its privileging of the position of the elite migrant intellectual; its attractiveness as a narrative eliding specific
inequities
of class; and its
inbuilt incapacity for praxis because of its critique of grand narratives (Ahmad 1992, 68, 69). To an extent, these critiques are true. There is reason to be vigilant about the politics of postcoloniality because of its production at the metropolitan centre. On the other hand, not all migrant intellectuals are similarly located at the centre. Edward Said's position as a Palestinian
activist,
which
has
subjected
him
to
numerous
death
threats
and
daily
harassment, is not the same as Homi Bhabha's purely western academic positioning, or Spivak's intimacy with historians in India and her precarious status as a feminist in the West, or Partha Chatterjee's split US ± India appointments which challenge `location' itself. Metropolitan location, thus, cannot be homogenized. US postcolonial studies, in fact, includes a diverse variety of interests, having in common an analysis of colonization and its aftermath. That postcolonial studies are not marxist enough does not go far enough to explain the popularity
of
this
complex
field.
The
reasons
for
its
ascendancy
are
institutional
and
cultural and occasion both hope and vigilance. On the positive side, clearly, postcolonial studies has opened up college curricula to third world texts in unprecedented ways. Chinua
Things Fall Apart of Darkness
Achebe's
is probably as well known by undergraduates as Conrad's
Heart
. Concerns of colonization and empire have become important in all humanities
fields. Postcolonial studies have realized these gains because of the momentum built up by the
Civil
Rights
era,
and
the
formation
of
African-American
and
ethnic
studies
pro-
grammes in which prominent intellectuals such as Henry Louis Gates and Ronald Takaki have argued for canon and paradigm expansion. On the more sobering side, one can see two
related
and
troubling
issues:
(a)
the
turn
toward
`ambivalence'
and
`hybridity'
as
analytic models for colonization and the attractiveness of this turn to both practitioners and observers of postcolonial studies; and (b), the scarcely acknowledged role of postcolonial studies to defuse concerns of race. When
postcolonial
studies
began,
the
radical
race-based
demands
for
Civil
Rights
articulated in the 1960s were experiencing a strong backlash, fuelled by the anti-affirmative action policies of the Reagan era. In the social sciences, the paradigm of race (associated with rights and inequalities) was replaced with the safer paradigm of ethnicity (Omi and Winant 1986, 12). African-American studies continued to grow, most significantly in the discovery of nineteenth-century texts and the stature of theorists such as Henry Louis Gates,
Houston
Baker,
bell
hooks
and
Hortense
Spillers,
but
nobody
seemed
very
modern north american criticism and theory
120
interested in the Black Panthers. Internationally, most anti-colonial movements had been won
and
most
revolutionary
writing
had
been
published
at
least
a
decade
previously.
Postcolonial studies thus entered the academy after the period of active radical politics and has, in some ways, chosen not to be activist. Unlike scholars in fields such as AfricanAmerican
studies,
feminist
studies
and
ethnic
studies,
fields
inaugurated
to
address
concerns of domination and exploitation, no postcolonialist has demanded the creation of postcolonial studies programmes. Thus, despite the prestige of a handful of scholars, most postcolonialists
could
diversity.
importantly,
More
be
easily
tucked
the
away
general
in
departments
movement
in
which
postcolonial
could
then
studies
away
claim from
Said's model of discourse analysis which, for all its flaws, foregrounded domination and exploitation (seen as too binaristic by some critics) to negotiatory analyses of colonization popularized by Homi Bhabha, has ensured the non-threatening nature of much of the field. Postcolonial studies could thus be seen as a field that, while satisfying marginality, could be used to offset the challenges posed by African-American studies and to neutralize concerns of race. As postcolonial studies grows to cover `internal colonization', it cannot afford its separatist stance from African-American studies or real concerns of race and domination, concerns currently being addressed by theorists like Lisa Lowe. Yet, despite its tendency to get co-opted into a liberal pluralism, postcolonial studies have posed significant challenges to our understanding of western modernity, to relations between First and Third Worlds or what is now the North and South, to western feminist theory, to issues of immigration and globalization, and even to the field of American studies. The immediate historical antecedent to the development of postcolonial studies was the decolonization of most of Asia and Africa in the 1950s and 1960s. At the Bandung Conference of 1955, representatives from twenty-nine Asian and African states collectively condemned colonialism and Indian Prime Minister Jawaharlal Nehru used the term third world as a form of identity. The 1950s saw the beginning of the Mau-Mau rebellion in Kenya, the FLN's struggle for liberation in Algeria and the independence of Ghana. By the 1960s and 1970s most of Africa, Asia and the Caribbean was decolonized. The 1950s and 1960s
also
produced
the
revolutionary,
anti-colonial
Discourse on Colonialism The Tempest The Pleasures of Exile Black Skin White Masks
Cesaire's
(1955),
Shakespeare's
George
in
of racial marginalization in
treatises
Lamming's
born
of
struggle:
Calibanistic
 Aime
reading
of
(1960), Frantz Fanon's experiences (1952), his treatise on the Algerian
The Wretched The Colonizer and the
revolution in `Algeria Unveiled' (1959) and on the importance of nation in
of the Earth Colonized ,
(1961),
the
Tunisian
numerous
works
revolutionary of
C.
L.
R.
Albert James,
Memmi's
and
Roberto
Fernandez
Retamar's
`Caliban' (1971). The idea of a pan-African identity was begun by revolutionaries in exile  Cesaire (Martinique) and Leopold Senghor (Senegal) who turned in France such as Aime Á gre' into a term of pride signified by the term `negritude', a movement the despised term `ne that in turn inspired a generation of African-American activists. In its most basic sense, the term `postcolonial' is a temporal marker for the condition after colonialism. Postcolonial theory attempts to understand and interrogate the colonial past, see its effects on the present and, at its best, articulates strategies for cultural survival. The term (first used by Hamza Alavi) has been debated by critics on several grounds. Some claim that the hyphenated term marks a decisive break with the colonial past, while others claim that the non-hyphenated, `postcolonial' captures more accurately the continuing effects of colonialism. Anthony Appiah describes the `post' as a `space-clearing gesture' for producing work which, though marked by colonialism, transcends its modes of knowledge
postcolonial studies
121
(Appiah 1997, 432, 440). The term postcolonial is now freely applied to literature being written by the formerly colonized countries and has replaced older terms such as third world literature and imperial terms such as Commonwealth literature. It is also being used as an analytical category in relation to internally colonized cultures such as Native American, Chicana/o, African-American and Asian-American. The prefix `post' has also generated discussions about postcolonial's connections with other postist terms such as `poststructuralism' and `postmodernism'. While hardly identical with these latter terms which do not carry its economic or military weight, postcolonial theory does share with poststructuralism its critique of western master narratives which masked the process of Othering, and with postmodernism its suspicion of historiography as truth. Postcolonial theory also broadly relies on poststructuralism's critique of any sign system as simple representation. In the US, the major paradigms for postcolonial studies have been offered by Edward Said (colonial discourse analysis), Homi K. Bhabha (psychoanalysis and hybridity) and Gayatri C. Spivak (critiques of western feminism, the sovereign Subject, and attention to the foreclosed subaltern). In
Orientalism
(1978), Said applied Foucault's notion of discourse
as that which produces its objects of knowledge and procedures of truth to address an area that Foucault had left out: colonialism. Beginning with the late eighteenth century and up to contemporary anti-Arab sentiment in the US media, Said powerfully demonstrated how Orientalism (including research on the Orient, theories about the Orient, novels, epics, etc. about the Orient, as well as Oriental institutes in the West) was a colonial discourse through which European culture managed and produced the Orient `politically, sociologically, militarily, ideologically, scientifically, and imaginatively during the post-Enlightenment period' (Said 1978, 3). Despite various writers and genres, Orientalism produced a picture of the Oriental as passive, deviant, feminized and unable to represent itself. In
Culture and Imperialism
, (1993), Said extended his readings to include texts by Conrad,
Austen and Camus, as well as resistance literature, and shifted the terms of his analysis to emphasize what he called a contrapuntal reading of the cultural archive with both the metropole
and
the
colony
writing
with
awareness
of
each
other.
Nevertheless,
Said
continued to insist that the division between the `West and the rest' (Said 1993, 51) ran like a fissure through imperial history. Although Said pays scant attention to issues of gender and class, his work has provided a powerful model for analysing colonial discourse. If
Said
stressed
the
inexorable
constructions
of
the
West
and
the
rest
in
colonial
discourse, Homi K. Bhabha has introduced what are probably the most popular terms in postcolonial
theory
today:
hybridity,
ambivalence
and
contradiction.
Influenced
by
Lacanian psychoanalysis, Bhabha emphasized the contradictory motivations of anxiety and
defence,
mastery
and
pleasure
behind
the
construction
of
the
stereotype.
The
stereotype, according to Bhabha, functions as a fetish, at once affirming and disavowing difference (Bhabha 1994, 74±5). Because colonial texts acquire meaning only after being circulated in the colony, difference becomes part of such texts. Consequently, Bhabha writes, `the colonial presence is always ambivalent, split between its appearance as original and authoritative and its articulation as repetition and difference', producing a mode of authority agonistic rather than antagonistic (1994 107±8). Such split forms of authority, Bhabha argues, are implicit in Said and central to Fanon who evokes the colonial situation through image and fantasy and privileges the psychic dimension of the colonial experience (1994, 42±3). Does feminism participate as colonial discourse? Gayatri Spivak took up this question in two path-breaking essays: `French Feminism in an International Frame' (1981) and `Three
modern north american criticism and theory
122
Women's Texts and a Critique of Imperialism' (1985). Spivak employed the techniques of deconstructive reading, marxism and feminism to question the ethnocentrism of French and British feminisms. Spivak demonstrated how French feminists routinely ignored their own emphasis on recognizing the heterogeneity of the concept `woman' in dealing with third world women; Kristeva spoke for the Chinese women she saw, and analysed them definitively
as
participants
of
an
unchanging
patriarchal
culture
(Spivak
1988,
137).
Spivak also suggested ways in which marxist analysis could help uncover the complicity between
domestic
repression
of
the
womanhood clitoral
and
and
the
patriarchal
specific
capitalism
oppression
of
on
third
the
one
world
hand
women
and as
the
cheap
labour on the other. Throughout her critiques, Spivak has remained strongly Derridean, always suspicious of narratives of origin or totalization. Thus, while Said focused attention on the power of Orientalist representation, and Bhabha on the inevitable ambivalence of this power, Spivak has insistently focused on the situatedness of the speaking position, the problem of representation itself and the inevitable voicelessness of the subaltern. In her most
misunderstood
and
most
well
known
work,
`Can
the
Subaltern
Speak',
Spivak
critiques Foucault and Deleuze for not recognizing their positions as western intellectuals at the moment at which they suggest the possibility of the oppressed being speaking subjects. For Spivak, the idea of the oppressed being able to speak can too often become a simplified denial of the complex conditions of language and power under which particularly the female subaltern operates. While colonial history homogenizes the subaltern, the attempts of
the
subaltern
studies
historians
(from
India)
to
retrieve
subaltern
consciousness
is
problematic and impossible. `For the ``true'' subaltern group, whose identity is its difference, there is no unrepresentable subaltern subject that can know and speak itself' (Spivak 1994, 80). The subaltern, Spivak suggests, can never be adequately represented by intellectuals nor
can
the
dominant
subaltern
culture.
And
ever she
have will
access
be
to
what
constitutes
misrepresented.
Thus,
speech
according
Spivak moves
to
to
her
the
much
criticized statements: `The subaltern as female cannot be heard or read' and `The subaltern cannot speak' (Spivak 1994, 104). In
Outside in the Teaching Machine
(1993), Spivak interrogates what is taken to be third
world or marginal writing in the context of the explosion of marginality studies in the US Arguing that the marginal is shaped by the kind of institution (teaching machine) it enters, Spivak critiques the homogenizing imperatives of the US academy as it constructs third world writing as always revolutionary, conscious of marginality and poised against western feminism. Spivak shifts the focus to differences among third world women, and through Bengali writer, Mahasweta Devi, points to a writing outside that of metropolitan postcoloniality. Seemingly reversing her earlier position about the unrepresentability of the subaltern, Spivak suggests that Devi can indeed speak about and write to the subaltern (Spivak
1993,
78).
Analyses
of
the
power
of
western
institutions
in
shaping
what
is
circulated as third world or marginal promise to be an important area in postcolonial studies. Attention to positionality and to the Derridean deferment of the trace in the figure of the subaltern woman continue to be Spivak's major concerns. In
Reason
A Critique of Postcolonial
(1999), Spivak combines these concerns with an increasing attention to native
complicity in imperialism and an insistence of the urgency of postcolonial theory to learn from the insights of third world activism.
A Critique
is monumental in its sheer range: four
major sections cover Philosophy, Literature, History and Culture; her analysis moves from Kant, Hegel, Marx and the Gita in philosophy to Kipling, Rhys, Mahasweta and Coetzee in
postcolonial studies literature,
to
the
British
123
management
of
widow
burning
in
history,
to
the
politics
of
postmodern fashion in culture. Although derided precisely because of its range by marxist
A Critique
critic Terry Eagleton,
emphasizes the responsibility of the postcolonial critic to
address precisely those areas deemed separate and unrelated through the epistemic violence of colonialism. Spivak constantly tracks the figure of the native informant, thus emphasizing, for instance, the continuity between the needed and foreclosed figure of the `raw man' in
Kant's
construction
of
the
sublime
and
the
contemporary
female
subaltern
who
is
silenced within a universalist feminist solidarity in which ` ``woman'' is important, not race, class, and empire' (Spivak 1999, 409). Spivak demonstrates how the native informant is not simply a slight figure within western philosophical and literary narratives, but rather the key on which major concepts rest. Spivak also focuses on uncovering native complicity with
imperialism.
In
a
bold
move
from
the
politics
of
resistance
broadly
accepted
by
postcolonialists, Spivak writes, `We cannot merely continue to act out the part of Caliban. One task of deconstruction might be a persistent attempt to displace the reversal, to show the complicity between native hegemony and the axiomatics of imperialism' (Spivak 1999, 37). Thus Spivak demonstrates, for instance, the complicity between Hegel's reading of the Gita as belonging to the unconscious symbolic and the structure of the Gita itself which functions to confirm the social order of the castes, marking the movement away from a
Critique
tribal social order. In more
activist
phase
deconstructible (instead
of
of
terms.
, Spivak also suggests a new project intimated by Derrida's
affirmative Spivak
representation
deconstruction
argues
of)
for
a
in
which
postcolonial
`counterglobalist
or
justice
learning
and
of
ethics
are
vocabularies
alternative-development
un-
from
activism'
(1999, 429). Many
postcolonial
feminists
have
focused
on
questions
of
alterity
and
identity,
on
`authenticity', the status of the diasporic native, and the importance of concrete specificity in feminist analyses of third world women. The issue of authenticity, i.e. what the native woman is `actually' like or should be represented as, has brought feminists of different races and from different fields together. Thus the highly experimental, postmodern VietnameseAmerican
film-maker
and
anthropologist
Trinh
T.
Minh-ha
writes,
`Today,
planned
authenticity is rife . . . it constitutes an efficacious means of silencing the cry of racial oppression. We no longer wish to erase your difference. We demand on the contrary, that you remember and assert it. At least to a certain extent' (Minh-ha 1989, 89). Similarly, Chandra
Mohanty,
the
Indian-American
feminist,
critiques
the
homogenization
of
diversely classed, sexed and raced women under the singular category, `third world women' (Mohanty).
Rey
Chow
interrogates
the
Orientalist
lens
within
China
studies
that
associates the `authentic' China only with the past, as well as the politics of US academia in which the criticism of Chinese communism by a diasporic Hong Konger can only be seen as retrograde (Chow 1991, 1993). While Minh-ha, Mohanty and Chow focus on sites that can easily be identified as postcolonial (Vietnam, India, Hong Kong), the status of black feminists within postcoloniality has been more vexed. Postcolonial anthologies now include
works
(McClintock
by
et
black
al.
feminists
1997).
This
such
as
Hazel
convergence
of
Carby,
Audre
different
Lorde
feminists
and
under
bell
hooks
postcolonial
studies is, of course, not surprising if we recollect that the third-world movement of the late 1960s
was
Chicano/a
a
coalition
students
of
who
African-American, modelled
Native
themselves
after
American, third
Asian-American
world
liberation
and
struggles,
declaring ghettos to be `internal colonies'. Conversely, anti-colonial writers such as George Lamming recalled for inspiration the writers of the Harlem Renaissance. Yet the `inclusion'
modern north american criticism and theory
124
of black women has not been unproblematic. The postmodern epistemological basis of a lot of postcolonial theory and the historical neglect of black women within the former has been a cause for concern among black feminists. As bell hooks puts it, radical postmodern practice will be politically inept if it fails to incorporate the voices of oppressed blacks. hooks writes, `third world nationals, elites, and white critics' who `never notice or look at black people on the streets . . . are not likely to produce liberatory theory that will challenge racist domination . . .' (hooks 1990, 25). In order for black feminism and postcolonial theory to engage in productive dialogue, postcolonial theorists will have to privilege race more as a category, and to acknowledge the radical insights of early black feminists such as Sojourner Truth. Spivak's dismissal of race as simple chromatism in her most recent work will continue to be problematic (Spivak 1999, 166). It is precisely Lisa Lowe's focus on race as a regulatory mechanism that energizes her study of Asian-Americans as citizens, cultural producers and sweatshop labour (Lowe 1996). Postcolonial studies has also provided an arena of fierce debate about ideas of nation. While Benedict Anderson claimed `nation-ness [as] the most universally legitimate value in the political life of our time' (Anderson 1991, 3), demonstrating the inherent democracy of
the
concept,
Partha
Chatterjee
critiqued
Anderson's
claims
by
demonstrating
the
inherent elitism of third world nationalisms that rested upon western modernity (1993, 11). Globalization and the fast flow of information in the electronic age have added new questions A key argument has been that of Arjun Appadurai who suggests that that the new
cultural
scene
is
one
of
`global
flows'
and
disjunctures,
a
`global
culture
of
the
hyperreal' in which many people live in `imagined worlds' (rather than imagined communities/nations) (1996, 31, 33). Such a world cannot be explained through older centre± periphery models. However, one should note that Appadurai's analysis of globalization through metaphors of movement and disorganization overlooks both the gross economic inequities unleashed by multinational corporations, as well as the one-way movement of American culture to third world countries. While paradigms such as rooted cosmopolitanism have also been posited to address the `postnational' world, critics of globalization have offered more sobering analyses (Appiah 1998, 91). Aihwa Ong, for instance, suggests that the
`flexible
citizenship'
of
diasporic
Chinese
from
Hong
Kong
amounts
to
flexible
accumulation of capital (Ong 1998, 138±41). Many contemporary critics are seeing globalization as an Americanized continuation of colonialism. Within the United States, the idea of examining racially different groups through postcoloniality is increasingly becoming important. The diasporic `reterritorialization of postcoloniality into ethnicity' has the potential to represent the third world within the First by fundamentally questioning the way dominant regimes dictate questions of identity (Radhakrishnan 1996, xxiv). For Chicano/a and Native American populations within
the
United
States,
however,
postcoloniality
needs
ethnicity. The colonized, in these cases, is the ethnic. In influential
Chicana
treatise
about
the
colonization
of
no
reterritorialization
Borderlands
into
, arguably the most
Mexican-Americans,
Âa Anzaldu
celebrates the hybrid border cultures formed in the Southwest as a result of US coloniza Saldivar have used the border as a  a, Chicano critics such as Jose tion. Following Anzaldu powerful metaphorical challenge to the idea of a dominant, hegemonic nationalism. A similar impetus to Native American studies is being given through the idea of Native Americans as a colonized people (Krupat 1994). Studies of early treaty negotiations, oral narratives and legal battles over forced movement have all energized the study of both contemporary and early US literature.
postcolonial studies
125
The examination of early US literary and cultural texts through postcoloniality has the potential to significantly alter the field. Ever since the authors of
The Empire Writes Back
stated that the United States was the first country to produce a postcolonial literature, questions about who can constitute legitimate postcolonial subjects have surfaced. The essays in
The Cultures of United States Imperialism focus on imperialism as a significant
ideology
in
the
culture
after
US
expansion
in
the
1890s;
Malini
Schueller's
U.S.
Orientalisms (1998) traces a genealogy of different Orientalist discourses in the US from Writing and Postcoloniality in the Early Republic (1998) argues
1790 to 1890. Edward Watts'
for a `Second World' model (appropriate for cultures both colonizing and colonized). As postcolonial studies continue to enjoy academic prestige, its challenge will be to forge a constituency from which minority voices can be articulated without being homogenized and
to
continue
to
critique
its
own
emergence
from
the
metropolitan
centre
of
the
contemporary world.
Malini Johar Schueller
Further reading and works cited Ahmad, A.
In Theory. London, 1992.
Anderson, B.
Imagined Communities. London, 1991.
 a, G. Anzaldu
Borderlands/La Frontera. San Francisco, 1987. Modernity at Large. Minneapolis, MN, 1996.
Appadurai, A.
Appiah, A. `Is the ``Post'' in ``Postcolonial'' the ``Post-'' in ``Postmodern''?, in
Dangerous Liaisons, eds
A. McClintock et al. Minneapolis, MN, 1997. Ð. `Cosmopolitan Patriots', in Ashcroft, B. et al.
Bhabha, H. K. (ed.) Ð.
Cosmopolitics, eds P. Cheah and B. Robbins. Minneapolis, MN, 1998.
The Empire Writes Back. New York, 1989. Nation and Narration. New York, 1990.
The Location of Culture. New York, 1994.
Chatterjee, P. Chow, R.
Nationalist Thought and the Colonial World. Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
Woman and Chinese Modernity: The Politics of Reading Between East and West . Minneapolis,
MN, 1991. Ð.
Writing Diaspora: Tactics of Intervention in Contemporary Cultural Studies . Bloomington, IN, 1993.
Dirlik, A. `The Postcolonial Aura', in
Dangerous Liasons, eds A. McClintock et al. Minneapolis, MN,
1997. Fanon, F. Ð.
The Wretched of the Earth. New York, 1963.
Black Skin White Masks. New York, 1967. `Race', Writing and Difference. Chicago, 1985.
Gates Jr, H. L. hooks, b.
Yearning. Boston, 1990.
JanMohamed, A.
Manichean Aesthetics. Amherst, 1983.
Ð and Lloyd, D. (eds)
The Nature and Context of Minority Discourse. New York, 1990.
Kaplan, A. and Pease, D. (eds)
The Cultures of United States Imperialism . Durham, 1993.
Krupat, A. `Postcoloniality and Native American Literature', Lowe, L.
Yale Journal of Criticism. 7, i, 1994.
Immigrant Acts. Durham, NC, 1996.
McClintock, A. Ð et al. (eds)
Imperial Leather. New York, 1995.
Dangerous Liaisons. Minneapolis, MN, 1997.
Minh-ha, T. T.
Woman, Native, Other. Bloomington, IN, 1989.
Mohanty, C. `Under Western Eyes', in
Third World Women and the Politics of Feminism , eds Mohanty
et al. Bloomington, IN, 1991. Omi, M. and Winant, H.
Racial Formation in The United States. New York, 1986.
modern north american criticism and theory
126
Ong, A. `Flexible Citizenship among Chinese Cosmopolitans', in
Cosmopolitics,
eds P. Cheah and B.
Robbins. Minneapolis, MN, 1998.
Imperial Eyes.
Pratt, M. L.
Orientalism.
Said, E. W. Ð.
New York, 1992.
Diasporic Mediations.
Radhakrishnan, R.
Culture and Imperialism.
Saldivar, J. D.
New York, 1993.
Border Matters.
Berkeley, CA, 1997.
Beyond Postcolonial Theory.
San Jr, J. E.
Shohat, E. `Notes on the Postcolonial', Spivak, G. Chakravorty. Ð.
Minneapolis, MN, 1996.
New York, 1978.
New York, 1998.
Social Text,
31/32, 1992.
In Other Worlds: Essays in Cultural Politics.
Outside in the Teaching Machine.
Ð. `Can the Subaltern Speak', in
New York, 1988.
New York, 1993.
Colonial Discourse and Postcolonial Theory,
eds P. Williams and L.
Chrisman. New York, 1994. Ð.
A Critique of Postcolonial Reason.
Viswanathan, G.
Masks of Conquest.
Williams, P. and Chrisman, L. (eds) Young, R.
Colonial Desire.
Cambridge, MA, 1999. New York, 1989.
Colonial Discourse and Postcolonial Theory.
New York, 1994.
New York, 1995.
18. Cultural Studies and Multiculturalism
Cultural studies are concerned with the exploration of culture in its multiple forms and of the
socio-political
transdisciplinary
contexts
and
within
sometimes
which
it
manifests
counter-disciplinary
itself.
field'
As
an
`interdisciplinary,
(Grossberg
et
al.
1992,
4),
cultural studies are a relatively new phenomenon in British and American universities. In its
current
sense,
the
term
was
first
used
by
Birmingham's
Centre
for
Contemporary
Cultural Studies (CCCS) launched in 1963. As envisioned by Richard Hoggart in his inaugural lecture, cultural studies consist of three domains: `one is roughly historical and philosophical; another is, again roughly, sociological; the third ± which will be the most important ± is the literary critical' (1970, 255). The study of English was broadened to include
a
sociology
of
literature
and
the
study
of
non-literary
forms
(film,
television,
popular music) previously regarded as `substandard'. The approach of the CCCS resonated with the incipient American interest in cultural studies that had been prepared by a similar debate about the role of popular culture in the mid-1950s. This debate opposed those who argued the dehumanizing effects of mass culture (a point of view which dominated the anthology
Mass Culture: The Popular Arts in America,
1957), to emerging postmodern
critics like Leslie Fiedler (author of `The Middle Against both Ends', included in the same anthology, and `The New Mutants', 1965) and Susan Sontag ( Against
Interpretation,
1960).
The origins of American cultural studies are various and not limited to developments inside academia. The questions of high and mass culture were first articulated and fought outside
the
academy,
media
studies
emerged
from
commercial
needs
as
well
as
from
academic concerns, and `cultural critique was as much the province of the Beat poets and liberal journalists as university intellectuals' (Munns and Rajan 1995, 209). In terms of its academic roots, cultural studies emerged out of structuralist and poststructuralist critical
modern north american criticism and theory
126
Ong, A. `Flexible Citizenship among Chinese Cosmopolitans', in
Cosmopolitics,
eds P. Cheah and B.
Robbins. Minneapolis, MN, 1998.
Imperial Eyes.
Pratt, M. L.
Orientalism.
Said, E. W. Ð.
New York, 1992.
Diasporic Mediations.
Radhakrishnan, R.
Culture and Imperialism.
Saldivar, J. D.
New York, 1993.
Border Matters.
Berkeley, CA, 1997.
Beyond Postcolonial Theory.
San Jr, J. E.
Shohat, E. `Notes on the Postcolonial', Spivak, G. Chakravorty. Ð.
Minneapolis, MN, 1996.
New York, 1978.
New York, 1998.
Social Text,
31/32, 1992.
In Other Worlds: Essays in Cultural Politics.
Outside in the Teaching Machine.
Ð. `Can the Subaltern Speak', in
New York, 1988.
New York, 1993.
Colonial Discourse and Postcolonial Theory,
eds P. Williams and L.
Chrisman. New York, 1994. Ð.
A Critique of Postcolonial Reason.
Viswanathan, G.
Masks of Conquest.
Williams, P. and Chrisman, L. (eds) Young, R.
Colonial Desire.
Cambridge, MA, 1999. New York, 1989.
Colonial Discourse and Postcolonial Theory.
New York, 1994.
New York, 1995.
18. Cultural Studies and Multiculturalism
Cultural studies are concerned with the exploration of culture in its multiple forms and of the
socio-political
transdisciplinary
contexts
and
within
sometimes
which
it
manifests
counter-disciplinary
itself.
field'
As
an
`interdisciplinary,
(Grossberg
et
al.
1992,
4),
cultural studies are a relatively new phenomenon in British and American universities. In its
current
sense,
the
term
was
first
used
by
Birmingham's
Centre
for
Contemporary
Cultural Studies (CCCS) launched in 1963. As envisioned by Richard Hoggart in his inaugural lecture, cultural studies consist of three domains: `one is roughly historical and philosophical; another is, again roughly, sociological; the third ± which will be the most important ± is the literary critical' (1970, 255). The study of English was broadened to include
a
sociology
of
literature
and
the
study
of
non-literary
forms
(film,
television,
popular music) previously regarded as `substandard'. The approach of the CCCS resonated with the incipient American interest in cultural studies that had been prepared by a similar debate about the role of popular culture in the mid-1950s. This debate opposed those who argued the dehumanizing effects of mass culture (a point of view which dominated the anthology
Mass Culture: The Popular Arts in America,
1957), to emerging postmodern
critics like Leslie Fiedler (author of `The Middle Against both Ends', included in the same anthology, and `The New Mutants', 1965) and Susan Sontag ( Against
Interpretation,
1960).
The origins of American cultural studies are various and not limited to developments inside academia. The questions of high and mass culture were first articulated and fought outside
the
academy,
media
studies
emerged
from
commercial
needs
as
well
as
from
academic concerns, and `cultural critique was as much the province of the Beat poets and liberal journalists as university intellectuals' (Munns and Rajan 1995, 209). In terms of its academic roots, cultural studies emerged out of structuralist and poststructuralist critical
cultural studies and multiculturalism theory,
the
intellectual Clifford).
`cultural history
materialism' of (Foucault,
According
to
the
Birmingham Centre,
Bourdieu)
Antony
127
and
Easthope
cultural
(1991,
(1957).
Williams's
book
140),
the
two
introduced
a
social-
and
race
studies,
(Geertz,
books
Culture and Society
modern cultural studies were Raymond Williams's
Mythologies
gender
anthropology
Turner,
that
initiated
(1958) and Barthes's
anthropological
approach
to
culture, understood not only as a conveyor of meanings and values but also as a `particular way
of
life'
(Storey
1993,
53);
Barthes's
proposed
an
approach
that
unravelled
the
`secondary signification' (ideological connotations) of cultural discourses. An important early boost to American cultural studies came from Hannah Arendt and the members of the Frankfurt School (Max Horkheimer, Theodor W. Adorno and Herbert Marcuse) who moved to New York after Hitler's rise to power to set up a new Institute for Social
Research
at
Columbia
University.
In
1955
Adorno
published
Prisms,
subtitled
`Cultural Criticism and Society', and in 1959 a three-day colloquium organized by the Tamiment Institute in New York brought together philosopher Hannah Arendt, sociologist Edward Shils, historian Arthur Schlessinger and representatives of mass media to debate
the
effects
of
the
new
electronic
technologies
on
culture.
Both
events
helped
promote the American interest in cultural studies, articulating some of its later concerns. Retrieving
the
best
traditions
of
cultural
analysis
as
articulated
by
Adorno
in
the
programmatic essay of his 1955 book, American cultural studies have participated in what Henry Giroux, David Shumway, Paul Smith and James Sosnoski have called `counterdisciplinary' practices: `fostering forms of resistance' to cultural institutions and modes of production (including those of the academe) and articulating a `critical pedagogy . . . which promote[s] the identification and analysis of the underlying ideological interests at stake in the text and its readings' (1985, 654±5). The inter-/counter-disciplinarity of the field has forced a massive revision of traditional methods of textual and cultural analysis. During the heyday of New Criticism alternative post-formalist approaches to the national literary culture
were
established
pioneered
at
increasingly
George
by
the
nascent
Washington
interdisciplinary
in
the
American
University 1960s,
in
studies 1936).
exploring
programmes These
(the
first
programmes
movements,
patterns
one
became
of
thought
or the effects of mass communication on culture. Gender became an issue in American studies through the work of feminists like Annette Kolodny who in
The Lay of the Land
(1975) interrogated the recurrent representation of the American land as a female passively awaiting
male
impregnation.
The
Vietnam
War
and
the
Civil
Rights
movement
also
challenged the `melting pot' paradigm, bringing to the fore issues of race and cultural diversity, as in Angela Davis's
Women, Sex, Race and Class
(1982), which reread American
cultural history from a feminist, marxist and ethnic perspective. The growing interest in film
and
mass
communication
±
or
more
recently
in
gay
and
lesbian
studies
±
upset
disciplinary boundaries even further, breaking through some of the last defences of the traditional literary establishment. As
the
body
of
knowledge
assembled
through
empirical,
`ethnographic'
methods
increased considerably, cultural scholars engaged in a major rethinking of their fields, drawing rhetoric,
on
a
variety
semiotics,
of
analytic
sociology
and
models
from
anthropology.
linguistics, It
is
also
philosophy, true
that
literary
the
theory,
availability
of
powerful interpretive tools did not lead to theoretical sophistication across the board. Some scholars continued to resist the methodologies of linguistics, semiotics or literary theory, preferring more empirical approaches. Sociologists, for example, found the `pan-textualist' approach of cultural studies debilitating, reducing sociality to a matter of discourse. Early
modern north american criticism and theory
128
mass communication research was similarly divided between a culturalist approach, which applied methods derived from the humanities to the analysis of cultural messages, and an empirical approach that combined quantitative research with a `behaviouristic' understanding
of
the
process
of
communication.
The
integration
of
the
empirical
and
the
theoretical approaches to culture was delayed for at least two decades. The 1980s brought a more profound theoretical restructuring, reflected in the new centres and programmes opened between traditional departments (Duke University's Center for Interdisciplinary Studies
in
Science
and
Cultural
Studies,
Harvard's
Center
for
Literary
and
Cultural
Studies, Georgia Tech's School of Literature, Communication and Culture, the University of Rochester's programme in Visual and Cultural Studies, etc.). The 1990s were witness to the beginning of a new cross-disciplinary collaboration between social and cultural studies. In 1997, for example, Elizabeth Long published under the aegis of the Sociology of Culture Section of the American Sociological Association a collection entitled
Cultural Studies this
collection
From Sociology to
. Bringing together cultural scholars with sociologists and anthropologists, stressed
not
only
the
opportunities
for
new
cross-fertilizations
but
also
cultural studies' need for a firmer sociological grounding. These ongoing rapprochements make cultural studies difficult to define. Every time a seemingly incompatible theory or practice is brought to bear upon the `postdiscipline' of cultural studies, a new `crisis' of adjustment is triggered. The defining collections published since
the
Culture
,
end
1989;
of
the
1980s
Grossberg,
(Nelson
Nelson
and
and
A Cultural Studies Reader in Cultural Studies Cultural Studies Rajan's
Marxism and the Interpretation of Cultural Studies Disciplinarity and Dissent
Grossberg's
Treichler's
,
1992;
Munns
and
, 1995; Nelson and Goankar's
, 1996) reflect the ambitious polydimensionality but also the dispersal of
the field. As the editors of
put it, `[I]t is probably impossible to agree on any
essential definition or unique narrative of cultural studies . . . . Its methodology, ambiguous from the beginning, could best be seen as bricolage' (Grossberg et al. 1992, 2, 3). For Angela McRobbie, who wrote the `Postscript', cultural studies' `greater degree of openness' represents a welcome departure from the `rigidity' imposed by the field's original theoretical models (1992, 724). For Jameson and others, this fragmentation is a matter of serious concern. Responding to the
Cultural Studies
collection, Fredric Jameson chastised the field
for failing to clarify its definition and replacing the search for methodology with a fetishistic invocation of precursors such as Raymond Williams whose name `is taken in vain by virtually everyone and appealed to for moral support in any number of sins (and virtues)' (1993, 615, 618). Cultural studies can best be defined as a series of interrelated explorations rather than as a
single
body
of
theory
or
methods.
Therefore,
efforts
to
synthesize
them
under
one
description remain problematic, foregrounding the areas of tension inside cultural studies. Cultural studies have profited from models developed in literary theory, often taking a `text-based' approach to the exploration of culture. But cultural studies are not reduced to a study
of
literary
texts.
Beginning
with
Barthes's
Mythologies
that
effectively
applied
methods of literary analysis to a potentially limitless range of non-literary products, films, videos, comics, music disks, fashion, computer art and even oral culture have become legitimate objects of study. The work of cultural scholars like Judith Williamson, Richard Ohman,
Mas'ud
Zavarzadeh,
Teresa
de
Lauretis,
John
Fiske
and
Janice
Radway
has
managed to dispel the notion that media texts are transparent bearers of meaning, treating advertisements, film, TV series, or romance novels as `complex transactions involving not only
messages
and
meanings,
but
multivalenced
media
formats
and
a
wide
range
of
cultural studies and multiculturalism audience
variables
which
inflect
the
ways
in
129
which
the
media
text
is
received
and
interpreted' (Munns and Rajan 1995, 300). On the other hand these products are difficult to subsume under the traditional category of `text' because they are not always amenable to an analysis that can identify an author, a stable text or a distinctive genre. Even when a text-oriented approach is taken, the goal in cultural studies is to
decentre `the text' as an object of study. `The text' is no longer studied for its own sake, not even for the social effects it may be thought to produce, but rather for the subjective or cultural forms which it realizes and makes available. The text is only a
means
in cultural studies; [. . .] it is the
raw material from which certain forms (e.g. of narrative, ideological problematic, mode of address, subject position, etc.) may be abstracted. (Johnson 1983, 597)
In spite of this broadening/rethinking of the category of cultural studies, media studies and
English
continue
to
have
an
uncomfortable
relationship.
Only
film
has
been
satisfactorily integrated into English studies, the cinematic work producing a density of interpretation compatible with the kind of critical exegesis expected in literary studies. Other forms of popular culture are still perceived by many literary scholars as unworthy of their attention. Noting this continued crisis of adjustment, John Guillory has contended in
Cultural Capital
that the emergence of cultural studies in American literature departments
gives `more than sufficient evidence of the urgent need to reconceptualize the object of literary
study'
(1993,
265).
According
to
Guillory,
not
only
literary
studies
but
also
literature itself as a `cultural capital' has entered a terminal phase (x). And yet, while it is true
that
recent
developments
in
cultural
studies
have
thrown
the
object
of
literary
scholarship in crisis, English can contribute to cultural studies its sophisticated techniques of
analysis
and
its
insights
into
the
processes
of
cultural
creativity.
The
case
for
the
continued significance of the literary must be made, however, not by returning to some `neo-New-Critical, antitheoretical, apolitical, exclusive regime of literary study', but rather by valorizing the political and theoretical agendas of cultural studies (DeKoven 1996, 127). As
Marianne
discourse
DeKoven
because
it
has
can
argued,
act
literary
simultaneously
writing as
a
remains
medium
an
`of
important
self-assertion
model and
of
self-
construction; an acknowledgment of the division, alienation, and reification of the subject and at the same time an assertion of subjective agency' (128). For cultural critics like Guillory the category of `literature' simply `names the cultural capital of the old bourgeoisie' (1993,
x).
Ironically,
this
definition
ignores
the
significant
contribution
made
to
the
literary by the constituencies that cultural studies have been trying to enfranchise. Writers like
Toni
Marmon
Morrison,
Silko,
Shirley
Audre
Lorde,
Anne
Williams,
Maxine
Hong
Alice
Walker,
Kingston,
Gloria
Clarence
Major,
 a, Anzaldu
Leslie
Bharati
Mu-
kherjee, Sandra Cisneros, Jonathan Strong and Jamaica Kincaid have retrieved previously marginalized experiences and genres (autobiography, oral storytelling), `disaggregat[ing] the
literary
from
its
conservative
uses
as
a
high-cultural
gatekeeper
and
preserve
of
hegemonic cultural capital' (DeKoven 1996, 137). Following their example, Marianne DeKoven and others have proposed a version of cultural studies that will mix the literary with the non-literary and the canonical with the anti-canonical. This version can be said to already exist in new historicism, regarded by Jameson as the `basic competition' to cultural studies. While cultural studies often concern themselves with the contemporary represented
by
mass
and
popular
culture,
new
historicism
(Stephen
Greenblatt,
Louis
Montrose, Jonathan Goldberg, Jean Howard and others) is solidly anchored in history and in literature, pursuing the `the world's new textuality' (Jameson 1993, 616) from a broad
modern north american criticism and theory
130
interdisciplinary perpective. Greenblatt originally called his work a `poetics of culture' (1980, 5), conceiving the work of the critic as an archaeological search for the contextual traces of institutions, values and practices embedded in a text. Cultural poetics relocates literary texts within a web of competing forces, discourses and practices that range from literary to non-literary, aesthetic to political, microstructural to macrostructural. If the literary component has had a contradictory career in American cultural studies, the
political
component
seems
to
have
fared
better.
Cultural
studies
in
the
US
have
provided useful frameworks for addressing issues of historical change, cultural diversity and difference. And yet, by comparison to the Birmingham Centre, American cultural studies have tended to be `less overtly engaged in political critique'.
While the Marxist heritage has made British cultural studies alert to issues of class, popular culture and sub-cultures, at the expense of issues of race and gender, American forms of cultural studies focused upon the ethnographic approaches, making them more open to questions of gender and race but obscuring issues of class. (Munns and Rajan 1995, 4)
More recently, as cultural studies have begun to be integrated into traditional literature or communication departments, they have raised new questions about their political efficacy. For Jameson, the politics that informs cultural studies is a predictable ` ``academic'' politics' that operates like `a kind of United Nations plenary session', giving a `respectful (and ``politically
correct'')
hearing'
to
each
microgroup
or
social
movement
but
failing
to
articulate a politics beyond the `isolationist conception of group identity' (1993, 623). Such criticisms are overly harsh, ignoring the analytic sophistication and significance of much cultural studies work in the area of `otherness'. This work is concentrated in several new branches of cultural studies: ethnocriticism, multiculturalism and postcolonial studies. For Arnold Krupat, `ethnocriticism' or `multiculturalism' is `that particular organization of cultural studies which engages and in such a way as to provoke an interrogation of and a challenge to what we ordinarily take as familiar and our own' (1992, 3). This interrogation extends over one's own disenfranchised group ideology, allowing for tensions between group identities, and also to the more general question of why the `other' has been such a persistent
figure
in
North
American
society,
submitted
periodically
to
discriminatory
discourses and policies. The multicultural movement has developed in response to the charge that traditional American education was focused too narrowly on the dominant Euro-american literary culture and history, ignoring other alternatives. The emphasis on cultural diversity can be traced back to anthropology's interest in non-European cultures, to the civil rights and women's movements, and to postmodernism's attempts to reconceptualize culture from the margins, valorizing the experience of subaltern groups and excluded others. The type of polysystemic and multicultural fiction that has gradually emerged since the mid-1970s (Thomas Pynchon, Toni Morrison, Maxine Hong Kingston, Jamaica Kinkaid, Ishmail Reed, Bharati Mukherjee, Sandra Cisneros, etc.) has provided multiculturalists with a model of reclamation, retelling and refashioning of an experience of previously distorted or marginalized by the dominant culture. Acknowledging the impact of postmodern theory and practice on multicultural studies, some consider multiculturalism a branch of the postmodern project (Lundquist 1996, 259). But
postmodernism's
approach
to
otherness
is
inevitably
limited.
Postmodernism
has
taught us that difference and heterogeneity matter, but did not always tell us how to create that space wherein differences can be negotiated in non-conflictive ways. Stronger models
cultural studies and multiculturalism
131
of otherness can be found in new historicism, whose explorations of the richly layered culture of a period are conceived as encounters with the radical `otherness' of history, its places of dissention and change. Feminism has also explored issues of gendered otherness not only in literary texts, but also in the products of popular culture such as TV and film (Laura Mulvey's influential work on woman as image and man as bearer of the look), formulaic fiction (Tania Modleski, Janice Radway), pop music and fashion (Ros Coward). The very definition of gendered otherness has undergone a radical rethinking: the versions  a's `mestiza consciousness' or Donna Haraway's of female identity offered by Gloria Anzaldu cyborg emphasize strange multiplicities and the `intimate experience of boundaries, their construction and deconstruction' (Haraway 1991, 181). Race studies and, since the 1980s, postcolonial exposing the
criticism violence
have
also
played
done to the
an
important
body, mind
and
role
in
redefining
language
otherness
of the other
and
by western
colonial and postcolonial thought. The works that set the stage for this type of exploration were Frantz Fanon's
Black Skin, White Masks
(1963) and Albert Memmi's insights, Edward Said's
(1952; trans. 1968),
The Colonizer and the Colonized
Orientalism
The Wretched of the Earth
(1965). Building on their
(1978) described the process through which the West
constructed the East as a `colonizable' image. According to Gayatri Chakravorty Spivak, Said's
monumental
reading
of
`orientalism'
as
an
instrument
of
imperial
power
made
possible the `study of colonial discourse' and the new discipline of marginality `where the marginal can speak and be spoken, even spoken for' (1993, 56). Spivak's own work has focused on the double process of `othering' that produces both the dominant imperial Other that gives the ideological framework for understanding the world, and the small `others', the colonial subjects (1987, 249). It has also exposed the process of othering that the postcolonial critic inadvertently engages in.
Outside in the Teaching Machine
(1993)
describes the institutionalization of marginality studies within the First World metropolitan academy as a `new Orientalism', a neocolonialist gesture that consolidates the non-West in a position of `authentic marginality' (1993, 57). Much of the work in postcolonial studies has been anticipated/supplemented by the analysis of black American culture. African American studies have provided one of the earliest models of cross-cultural analysis for peoples affected by colonization and slavery. As the authors of a recent glossary of postcolonial concepts state, the `history of the struggle for self-determination by African Americans is historically intertwined with wider movements of diasporic struggles for independence', such as the `Back to Africa' movement initiated by the Jamaica-born Marcus Garvey (Ashcroft, Griffiths and Triffin, 1998, 7). More recently, efforts have been made to define an interdisciplinary field of `black cultural studies' that would integrate black literary criticism, black popular culture, critical race theory and film theory. Among its possible contributors are Elizabeth Alexander, Derrick Bell, Barbara Christian,
Ann
DuCille,
Henry
Louis
Gates,
Jr,
Paul
Gilroy,
Stuart
Hall,
bell
hooks,
Lawrence W. Hogue, Mae G. Henderson, Valerie Smith, Claudia Tate and Cornell West, whose work has been instrumental in dismantling the `white supremacist, homophobic, capitalist patriarchy' and offering alternative ways of conceiving race, gender and class that emphasize `the extraordinary diversity of subject positions, social experiences and cultural identities which compose [such categories]' (Sarup 1996, 61). The critique of the lingering of
assumptions
these
categories
is
strongest
in
bell
hooks'
books
that
challenge
the
universal category of `woman' and redirect the goal of feminism from achieving equal opportunity with men to eliminating sexism and sexist oppression. bell hooks, Henry Louis Gates,
Jr,
and
Barbara
Smith
have
also
urged
anti-discrimination
activists
to
ally
modern north american criticism and theory
132
themselves
against
all
forms
of
`othering'
and
oppression.
Challenging
the
persistent
homophobia not only in the dominant culture but also in the post-civil rights ethnocentrisms these writers have made clear that all forms of oppression are interconnected and that as long as one discrimination is allowed to stand through ignorance or prejudice, oppression in general is justified. This new awareness has been helped also by the work of queer theorists like Leo Bersani, Teresa de Lauretis, Eve Kosofsky Sedgwick, Gayle Rubin and Jeffrey
Weeks,
who
have
argued
that
sexuality
is
just
as
important
a
category
in
the
configuration of social identities as class and race. Drawing on these diverse theoretical perspectives, ethnocriticism has focused on the contradictory meanings and political uses of ethnicity, rejecting `natural' definitions of it. Ethnocriticism offers not only an ethnography but also a critique of `identities', being concerned with the actual processes of identity formation. Identity, as Charles Taylor reminds us, is `dialogic', built upon how others see or recognize `us' (1994, 33). Cultural identity has been experienced very differently on the American continent by the dominant white, heterosexual,
Western
European
immigrants,
and by the various non-European
minorities or by the Native Americans whose being has been periodically threatened with oversimplification and cancellation. Therefore the work of multiculturalists is needed to redress
the
positive
balance,
reclaiming/reconstructing
representations
of
minority
cultures.
marginalized But
telling
experiences positive
and
stories
promoting
about
one's
cultural difference or sensitizing the dominant group to the value of the Other is not enough: multicultural writers and theorists are also interested in channelling this differential potential between the dominant and alternative cultures, centres and peripheries, towards `the mutual revisions of our expressions of reality' (Lundquist 1996, 272±3). Both ethnocritics and multicultural writers believe that listening to the marginalized voice of the Other is essential, but they also seek to activate those forms of cross-cultural communication that submit cultural systems to a process of mutual revision. Multiculturalism has been defined as `the reality of the post-melting pot, post-assimilationist era' (Lundquist 1996, 263), but it is by no means an unproblematic perspective. Believers in a unitary conception of society lament the fact that multiculturalism conduces to hermetically sealed ethnic enclaves, anarchy and the lack of an integrating national narrative. Supporters of multiculturalism argue that monocultures need to be converted into polysystemic `mosaics' in which no group can claim the status of ruling majority and each group enjoys equal rights and respect for its ethnic or gender identity. But they remain aware of the danger of co-option that confronts multiculturalism in the current hyperconsumerist culture, interested in promoting the ethnic flavours of the month, and also of the more subtle reappropriation
of
otherness
by
the
`benevolent'
discourse
of
western
multiculturalism
`masquerad[ing] as the absent nonrepresenter who lets the oppressed speak for themselves' (Spivak 1988, 292). Marjorie Perloff finds peculiar the fact that, `despite the lip service currently paid to multiculturalism, one has the sense that the only thing that matters in U.S. culture.
. . is U.S. culture. True, that culture is divided up into a dozen of marginalized,
disempowered, and minority subsets . . . . But the requisite for all these groups turns out to be U.S. citizenship: the Other, it seems, does not include the literature of other nations or in other languages' (Perloff 1998, 21). Jameson likewise identifies cultural studies with `an American NATO view of the world' from which whole political geographies (the Pacific rim, China, Japan and sometimes Latin America) are absent (1993, 640). The fall of the Berlin Wall and the new globalizing impetus of consumer capitalism have posed difficult new questions to multiculturalism. Judging from Stuart Hall's essay `Culture,
cultural studies and multiculturalism
133
Community, Nation' (1993), multiculturalism and cultural studies in general have not done
well
on
this
test.
As
Saba
Mahmood
comments,
this
essay
written
by
a
major
representative of the Birmingham Centre has difficulty dealing with the social movements (politico-religious and ethnic) that have emerged in Eastern Europe, the Middle East or Central Asia (Mahmood 1996, 2). While noting the parallel development of nationalist movements in post-Cold War Western Europe and the non-western world, Hall carefully divides nationalisms into big and small (or `good' and `bad'). He regards the emerging nationalisms of small countries (as a result of the National Liberation Movements of the 1960s and 1970s, or more recently of the collapse of the Soviet Empire) as failed imitations of the big nation-building strategies. Replicating older stereotypical divisions between a Protestant or Catholic Western Europe and an Orthodox or Muslim Central Asia and Eastern Europe, Hall considers the latter cultures by definition ethnically and religiously absolutist, ignoring the fact that the `othering' violence perpetrated by the secular western states in the last two centuries remains as yet unmatched by the violence committed in the name of non-western religious and ethnic communities. Cultural studies need to examine the analytical assumptions and stereotypes they have inherited from traditional cultural history, otherwise it is condemned to `reify boundaries of cultural otherness, political persuasions and objectives' (Mahmood 1996, 10). The concept of multiculturalism itself must be revisited in the postcolonial, post-Cold War world, in order to interrogate its blind spots. One of these blind spots is the unequal treatment of various others (western vs. non-western, diasporic vs. native, etc.). Refusing such polarizations, Ella Shohat and Robert Stam advocate in their recent study of multiculturalism and
the
media
a
`radical
polycentric multiculturalism
'
that
`reconceptualizes
the
power
relations between cultural communities', challenging the hierarchical division of communities into `major' and `minor' (1994, 47). Polycentric multiculturalism is not about sensitivity
towards
other
groups
but
about
`dispersing
power,
about
empowering
the
disempowered, about transforming subordinating institutions and discourses', about deconstructing the `dominant or narrowly national discourses' and negotiating `many margins and many centers' (48±9). Taking issue with mainstream multiculturalism that does not offer
`a
participatory
Eurocentrism
knowledge
of
non-European
cultures',
the
authors
Unthinking
of
address the global reach of the contemporary media, offering critiques of
imperialist discourses, theorizings of `Third World' and `Third Cinema', as well as analyses of African, Asian, Latin American and First World `minority' and `diasporic' media. A similar effort to create a more responsive space for intercultural negotiation can be found in the revamped version of `culturology' proposed by Ellen E. Berry and Mikhail N. Epstein.
Against
both
deconstruction's
cavalier
dismissal
of
firm
contours
of
cultural
identity and essentialist multiculturalism's assumption that `each cultural formation can and should be explained in relation to its racial, sexual or ethnic origin that gives rise to the particular system of social signification' (1999, 80), Berry and Epstein propose a `transculturalist' approach that acknowledges the `enduring ``physicality'' and ``essentiality'' of existing
cultures'
but
also
`the
possibility
of
their
further
transcendence,
in
particular
though with other cultures' (84).
[To be transcultural] means to rise above one's inborn identity, such as `white, adult male', through
a
variety
of
self-deconstructions,
self-transformations,
and
interference
with
other
identities, such as woman, black, child, disabled. For this purpose books, films, and sign systems are created to dissolve the solidity of one's nature, one's identity and to share the experience of `the other'. (84)
modern north american criticism and theory
134
Transculturalism moves us from a `passive' multicultural perspective that recognizes the `unqualified
multiplicity
of
cultures
without
positing
any
ways
for
them
to
interact
meaningfully', to a perspective that encourages the interplay of cultures on the surmise that `each culture has some basic incompleteness that opens it for encounters with other cultures' (97). While a final assessment of this and other recent projects is not yet possible, it is evident by
now
that
cultural
studies
have
found
new
resources
to
respond
to
the
`disjunctive
intersections of global, national, and local cultures' (Berry and Epstein 1999, 129) in the post-Cold War world. Together with women's studies, gay/lesbian studies and postcolonial criticism, cultural studies have contributed substantially to the constitution of the `new humanities', challenging the accepted practices of knowledge-gathering within the academy, foregrounding the exclusions `which confirm the privileges and authority of canonic knowledge systems' and recovering those `marginalized' or `subjugated knowledges' which have been `occluded and silenced by the entrenched humanist curriculum' (Gandhi 1998, 42).
While
position
many
not
only
problems in
remain
many
(cultural
English
studies
departments,
but
continue also
in
to
the
occupy
a
culture
at
peripheral large;
the
refiguration of what is studied as `culture' is far from finished; the battle for the `soul' of postCold War America has not been won by the new culturalist left), the voracious appetite of cultural studies for new intellectual experiences guarantees its future open-endedness and `need to go on theorizing'.
Marcel Cornis-Pope
Further reading and works cited Ashcroft, B. et al.
Key Concepts in Post-Colonial Studies.
Berry, E. E. and Epstein, M. N.
DeKoven, M. `Cultural Dreaming and Cultural Studies',
Literary into Cultural Studies.
Easthope, A.
Franklin, S. et al. (eds) Gandhi, L.
Off Center.
Postcolonial Theory.
New York, 1998.
Transcultural Experiments.
New York, 1999.
New Literary History,
27, 1, 1996.
London, 1991.
New York, 1991.
New York, 1998.
Giroux, H. et al. `The Need for Cultural Studies: Resisting Intellectuals and Oppositional Public Spheres',
Dalhousie Review,
Greenblatt, S.
Grossberg, L. et al. (eds) Guillory, J.
64 (1985).
Renaissance Self-Fashioning. Cultural Studies.
Cultural Capital.
Chicago, 1980. New York, 1992.
Chicago, 1993.
Hall, S. `Culture, Community, Nation'. Haraway, D. `A Cyborg Manifesto',
Cultural Studies,
7, 3, October 1993.
Simians, Cyborgs, and Women.
Hoggart, R. `Schools of English and Contemporary Society', in
London, 1991.
Speaking to Each Other.
Harmonds-
worth, 1970. Jameson, F. `On Cultural Studies', Johnson,
R.
`What
Is
Cultural
Social Text,
Studies
34, 1993.
Anyway?'
Stenciled
Occasional
Paper
No.
74
(1983)
circulated by the Birmingham Centre for Contemporary Cultural Studies. Krupat, A.
Ethnocriticism.
Lundquist,
S.
Berkeley, CA, 1992.
`Ethnocriticism
and
Multiculturalism',
in
The Critical Experience,
ed.
D.
Cowles.
Dubuque, IA, 1996. McRobbie, A. `Post-Marxism and Cultural Studies', in
Cultural Studies,
eds L. Grossberg et al New
York, 1992. Mahmood, S. `Cultural Studies and Ethnic Absolutism',
Cultural Studies,
10, 1, 1996.
african-american studies
135
A Cultural Studies Reader Disciplinarity and Dissent in Cultural Studies Poetry On & Off the Page Orientalism Introducing Cultural Studies Identity, Culture, and the Postmodern World Unthinking Eurocentrism History and Theory Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture Outside in the Teaching Machine An Introductory Guide to Cultural Theory and Popular Culture Multiculturalism The Terms of Cultural Criticism
Munns, J. and Rajan, G. (eds)
. London, 1995.
Nelson, C. and Goankar, D. (eds) Perloff, M.
. New York, 1996.
. Evanston, IL, 1998.
Said, E. W.
. New York, 1978.
Sardar, Z. and Van Woon, B.
. New York, 1998.
Sarup, M.
. Athens, OH, 1996.
Shohat, E. and Stam, R.
. London, 1994.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty. `The Rani of Simur'.
, 24, 3, 1987.
Ð. `Can the Subaltern Speak?', in
, eds C. Nelson and L.
Grossberg. Urbana, IL, 1988. Ð.
. London, 1993.
Storey, J.
. Athens, GA, 1993.
Taylor, C. `The Politics of Recognition', in Wolin, R.
, ed. A. Gutmann. Princeton, NJ, 1994.
. New York, 1992.
19. African-American Studies
In a 1985 issue of legitimacy
was
Cultural Critique
`existentially
and
, Cornel West asserted that the pursuit of academic
intellectually
stultifying
for
black
intellectuals'.
In
typically provocative fashion, he claimed further that such a quest
not only generates anxieties of defensiveness on the part of intellectuals; it also thrives on them. The
need
humanistic
for
hierarchical
scholarship
ranking
cannot
and
provide
the
black
deep-seated intellectuals
racism with
shot
either
through
the
bourgeois
proper
ethos
or
conceptual framework to overcome a defensive posture. And charges of intellectual inferiority can never be met upon the opponent's terrain ± to try to do so only intensifies one's anxieties. Rather the terrain itself must be viewed as part and parcel of an antiquated form of life unworthy of setting the terms of contemporary discourse. (1985, 116)
Echoing the sentiments of many Black Arts proponents whose criticism of the academy in the 1960s and 1970s had singled out the `aristocratic' nature of the academy as cause for the black critic's outsider status, West's words describe the bind that the academy creates for black intellectuals. On the one hand, as West implies, the academy beckons as a site of promise: black intellectuals thus turn to the university, seeking in it a place to forge a sense of identity and even community. On the other hand, this existential pursuit for a sense of being in the world ± because it is also fraught with a narrative of legitimacy ± can for West ultimately
have
no
satisfying
end,
since
the
very
terms
of
the
intellectual
quest
are
underwritten by the racist assumption that blackness and intellect are incompatible, if not inimical. His critique turns then to counsel: because the academy `cannot provide either the proper ethos or conceptual framework' that would secure or welcome what it means to be a black intellectual, it can be no institutional home, and therefore must be refused altogether. The
opposition
that
West
sets
out
between
the
place
and
possibility
of
the
black
intellectual and the academy marks one way to characterize the problematic history of African-American studies as a discipline. Indeed, if West's account of the difficulties faced
african-american studies
135
A Cultural Studies Reader Disciplinarity and Dissent in Cultural Studies Poetry On & Off the Page Orientalism Introducing Cultural Studies Identity, Culture, and the Postmodern World Unthinking Eurocentrism History and Theory Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture Outside in the Teaching Machine An Introductory Guide to Cultural Theory and Popular Culture Multiculturalism The Terms of Cultural Criticism
Munns, J. and Rajan, G. (eds)
. London, 1995.
Nelson, C. and Goankar, D. (eds) Perloff, M.
. New York, 1996.
. Evanston, IL, 1998.
Said, E. W.
. New York, 1978.
Sardar, Z. and Van Woon, B.
. New York, 1998.
Sarup, M.
. Athens, OH, 1996.
Shohat, E. and Stam, R.
. London, 1994.
Spivak, G. Chakravorty. `The Rani of Simur'.
, 24, 3, 1987.
Ð. `Can the Subaltern Speak?', in
, eds C. Nelson and L.
Grossberg. Urbana, IL, 1988. Ð.
. London, 1993.
Storey, J.
. Athens, GA, 1993.
Taylor, C. `The Politics of Recognition', in Wolin, R.
, ed. A. Gutmann. Princeton, NJ, 1994.
. New York, 1992.
19. African-American Studies
In a 1985 issue of legitimacy
was
Cultural Critique
`existentially
and
, Cornel West asserted that the pursuit of academic
intellectually
stultifying
for
black
intellectuals'.
In
typically provocative fashion, he claimed further that such a quest
not only generates anxieties of defensiveness on the part of intellectuals; it also thrives on them. The
need
humanistic
for
hierarchical
scholarship
ranking
cannot
and
provide
the
black
deep-seated intellectuals
racism with
shot
either
through
the
bourgeois
proper
ethos
or
conceptual framework to overcome a defensive posture. And charges of intellectual inferiority can never be met upon the opponent's terrain ± to try to do so only intensifies one's anxieties. Rather the terrain itself must be viewed as part and parcel of an antiquated form of life unworthy of setting the terms of contemporary discourse. (1985, 116)
Echoing the sentiments of many Black Arts proponents whose criticism of the academy in the 1960s and 1970s had singled out the `aristocratic' nature of the academy as cause for the black critic's outsider status, West's words describe the bind that the academy creates for black intellectuals. On the one hand, as West implies, the academy beckons as a site of promise: black intellectuals thus turn to the university, seeking in it a place to forge a sense of identity and even community. On the other hand, this existential pursuit for a sense of being in the world ± because it is also fraught with a narrative of legitimacy ± can for West ultimately
have
no
satisfying
end,
since
the
very
terms
of
the
intellectual
quest
are
underwritten by the racist assumption that blackness and intellect are incompatible, if not inimical. His critique turns then to counsel: because the academy `cannot provide either the proper ethos or conceptual framework' that would secure or welcome what it means to be a black intellectual, it can be no institutional home, and therefore must be refused altogether. The
opposition
that
West
sets
out
between
the
place
and
possibility
of
the
black
intellectual and the academy marks one way to characterize the problematic history of African-American studies as a discipline. Indeed, if West's account of the difficulties faced
modern north american criticism and theory
136
by black intellectuals in entering the academy is a useful analogy for the difficulty that African-American studies has encountered in its development as a legitimate discipline, this essay looks to suggest that the inverse holds true as well. That is, just as the presence of black intellectuals in the academy enables for West a critique of the hierarchy and racism that lie at the heart of the institution, so does the emergence of African-American studies pose for the academy the necessity of understanding the mechanisms that drive disciplinarity in the contemporary university. In its own contentious history and debates over theory, practice and teaching, African-American studies, to put it another way, enables a sustained inquiry into the divided nature of disciplinarity. The significance of such division to African-American studies does not simply begin, however, with the full-blown appearance of the discipline on the academic stage. That is, the complications of making African-American culture an object of study has earlier ± or deeper ± roots than the disciplinary questions it raises in the late 1960s. Even the quickest of historical glances reveals that investment in such study and the contradictions that accompany century.
it
For
occupied
these
African-American
thinkers,
the
question
thinkers of
in
the
first
half
of
`African-American-ness'
the
was
twentietha
necessary
inquiry, one driven by the imperative to define and articulate the double-edge of the African-American experience: what W. E. B. Du Bois (1868±1963) famously named the `veil' of `double-consciousness'. Thus at the turn of the twentieth century author, magazine editor and journalist Pauline Hopkins (1859±1930) sought to forefront, and thereby create, the beginnings of a written history of African-American individual heroism in `Famous Men of the Negro Race' (1901) and `Famous Women of the Negro Race' (1902). W. E. B Du Bois, Arthur Schomburg (1874±1938) and Zora Neale Hurston (1891±1960) complicated this historical perspective by claiming that African-American folklore, religion and material culture, alongside economic and sociological analyses, warranted as much attention as the narratives of history. Du Bois in particular ± perhaps the most insistent voice addressing the ways in which the doubleness of the African-American experience constituted its uniqueness ± went so far as to argue throughout
The Souls of Black Folk
(1903) that at stake in such close inquiry was nothing less than future progress in race relations. In the meantime writers working during and shortly after the Harlem Renaissance
extended
this
line
anthologies, including 1922),
The New Negro
of
thinking
through
the
publication
The Book of American Negro Poetry (ed. Alain Locke, 1925),
(ed. V. F. Calverton, 1929),
a
number
of
literary
An Anthology of American Negro Literature
The Negro Caravan
Poetry of the Negro, 1746±1949
of
(ed. James Weldon Johnson,
(ed. Sterling A. Brown, 1941) and
The
(eds Langston Hughes and Arna Bontemps, 1949). The
discussions in the introductory pages of these anthologies anticipated the long-standing debate
over
the
canon
of
African-American
literature,
whether,
for
instance,
`Negro
literature' should represent literature by and/or about African-Americans, or even whether the use of the term, in its impulse to compartmentalize, might only further marginalize the work. For all that, however, these efforts sought in common to capture, all the while keeping in play, both the distinctiveness
and
American character of the African-American
experience. To do so was, as James Weldon Johnson put it, to `change that mental attitude and raise [the African-American's] status' by demonstrating the `intellectual parity by the Negro through the production of literature and art' (Johnson 1922, vii). When the young discipline of black studies (as it was then named) surfaced in the late 1960s, it faced this doubleness in the form of questions concerning its viability, definition and purpose. Student protests and radical activism of the time had produced an atmosphere
african-american studies
of
academic
reform,
137
contributing
not
simply
to
the
establishment
of
black
studies
programmes, but also to the sense that such programmes had a stake in the larger reform of the university (Frye 1976, 1). For many, this meant on the one hand revealing and doing away
with
assumptions
about the
homogeneity of
culture,
the
objectivity
of
scholarly
inquiry, including especially the notion that history and historiography embodied realms of pure fact, and the sanctity of any number of traditional liberal arts disciplinary canons (Thelwell 1979, 706±10). Black studies sought, in the words of one activist, `to correct falsehoods perpetrated by western academia about black people' (Frye 1976, 5). As a result, many black studies proponents insisted that the strength of the discipline would lie in its ability
to
enact
an
unprecedented
convergence
of
traditional
disciplines
±
including
history, political science, sociology, economics and literature. On the other hand, the development of black studies for scholars also meant the opportunity to make a social and Á -vis the articulation and expression of, as several put it at the institutional difference vis-a time, a black `sensibility' that, in embodying an Afrocentric vision, would challenge and revise the assumptions of western intellectual inquiry (one of the missions of the
American Literature Forum
Negro
, founded in 1967). This two-handed approach informed the
rush of success that black studies experienced in the early 1970s: in 1970, approximately 350 colleges and/or
universities had established such programmes, while by 1973, the
number had increased to 600 nationwide (Frye 1976, 4). In the meantime, these early years constituted conferences
a
period
and
of
disciplinary
`self-studies'
self-reflection,
involving
a
time
administrators,
when
faculty
workshops,
members
institutes,
and
students
addressed directly the development of black studies (Ford 1973, 88). Yet in the midst of success, discussions regarding the status, place and future of black studies
suggested
constituted
a
that,
dilemma
taken for
the
together,
even
discipline.
these
While
early
scholars
stages
of
institutionalization
continued
to
agree
that
the
discipline needed a vision of purpose, methodology, pedagogy and canon, the uniformity of such a vision had no consistent assurance. Around the debate over what `black studies' entailed, for instance, several questions split scholars into opposing camps. By the late 1970s, when the number of established programmes had declined to 200, proponents found themselves turning to diagnose institutional arrival
itself
as a cause of disciplinary ill health.
Responding to increasingly vocal complaints that black studies programmes, paralleling perhaps the radical ideology and aesthetics of the Black Arts movement, sought a separatist ± rather than pluralist ± agenda, some within the discipline voiced the concern that black studies' political origins, while initially the catalyst for administrative and curricular action, now haunted the discipline precisely by diminishing its institutional legitimacy (Ford 1973, 42). These accusations, however, exposed for other black studies scholars an anxiety on the part of more traditional disciplines that had seen students, courses and funding channelled towards the new and immensely popular field of study. To claim that the discipline was merely the result of political faddishness ± and therefore not intellectually serious ± was to serve
a
larger
agenda
to
reclaim
territory
presumably
`lost'
in
the
fray
of
institutional
competition. That many of these traditional disciplines had begun to add `black content' to their courses suggested that the old guard was seeking to `parallel and duplicate Black Studies' (Frye 1976, 37). To say that more recent developments in African-American studies also indicate this institutional tension is not, however, to argue that the discipline has somehow lost its way. If the discipline has experienced a bumpy ride in its history, this is not because AfricanAmerican studies possesses at base some inherent flaw. Rather, the impact that African-
modern north american criticism and theory
138
American studies has had (and continues to have) on the academy occurs as much through the challenges it has produced and negotiated as through the material it has brought into the academic fold. On the contemporary front, this is perhaps most evident in several areas: in the emergence of the exemplary African-American genre, the slave narrative; in the debates
over
the
place
and
role
of feminism
in
the
discipline;
and
in
the
continuing
discussion of what constitutes theory in the context of African-American studies.
In his introduction to
The Classic Slave Narratives
, Henry Louis Gates, Jr. writes that . . . one of
the most curious aspects of the African person's enslavement in the New World is that he and she
wrote
about
the
severe
conditions
of their
bondage . . .
In the
long
history
bondage, it was only the black slaves in the United States who . . . created a
genre
of human
of literature
that at once testified against their captors and bore witness to the urge of every black slave to be free and literate. (1987, ix, original emphasis)
Writing in 1987, Gates on the one hand extends his earlier claim that slave narratives function as a `countergenre' (1978, 47) ± a genre that, because it does not reside in any one generic
category
literature,
but
including
plantation
novel
deploys
and
conversion
tradition
and
mediates
between
narratives, sermons,
the
strategies
autobiography,
demands
a
of
other
sentimental
rethinking
of
kinds
romances,
literary
of
the
genres.
At
the same time, he identifies with assurance the fact that slave narratives now constitute a literary genre ± that is, a genre so marked and recognizable through certain conventions, thematics and structures that a canon exists by which one can judge and identify specific texts as `classic'. In so doing, Gates echoes a statement that Houston A. Baker, Jr had made five years earlier in his introduction to Penguin's edition of the
Douglass
:
`the
appearance
of
[the
Narrative
]
in
the
Narrative of the Life of Frederick
Penguin
American
Library
series
indicates that a new scholarly paradigm has emerged in our day' (1982, 15). Baker remarks that this recent popularity of slave narratives marks a resurgence of interest, since `prior to the 1960s, an accepted position in American literary and historical studies was that no distinct,
authentic,
surrounding
written
American
Afro-American
abolitionism'
(1982,
voice
existed
7±8).
While
in he
the does
canons not
of
say
discourse
so
directly,
implicit in Baker's statement is the sense that the arrival of the slave narrative as the `distinct,
authentic written
African-American paradigm':
with
studies.
Afro-American The
voice'
certification
such recommendation both
of
entails
the
generic
Gates
reinvigoration
status
and
and Baker herald
`a
as
new
well
of
scholarly
the debut
of the
slave narrative ± and therefore the discipline ± onto the institutional stage. The terms of this debut, as Gates' and Baker's comments reveal, mark an interest in the difference
of
African-American
literary
expression
±
and
therefore
the
difference
in
scholarship that it requires. As a number of commentators have observed, because slave narratives
provided
commentary,
they
source
material
mandated
and
on
the
institution
compelled
within
of
the
slavery
through
discipline
a
individual
major
shift
in
methodology. Such methodology sought to account for the enormous popularity of slave narratives ± within the first four months of its publication in 1845 Douglass'
Narrative
sold
five thousand copies; by 1860 the number had topped 30,000 (Gates 1987, xi). To do so meant, for one, to concede and consider the narratives' affective power alongside their rhetorical
suasiveness: to
read
them not simply
as
political
tracts
or
jeremiads,
but
as
expressions that captured the imagination of the public because, as Margaret Fuller put it in her review of Douglass's
Narrative
, they presented the immediacy of a `living voice' whose
african-american studies
139
speech could not be ignored (Andrews 1991, 24). At the same time, accounting for the genre's
popularity
also
meant
an
analysis
of
the
resistance
these
narratives
enacted
±
whether through their retrospective accounts of escape, their address to abolitionists or even their discussions and advocacy of literacy. Indeed, for many African-American critics the impact of the slave narrative resided most forcefully in their literariness; here, in the wielding
of
written,
published
and
disseminated
language,
lay
the
resistance
Gates
describes in naming the narratives a `countergenre'. Not surprisingly, this sense of the narratives' literary resistance involved reworking the view of literature and literary history that had in the past precisely dismissed slaves' voices as
unremarkable
or
irrelevant.
The
reintroduction
of
slave
narratives,
in
other
words,
enabled African-American critics to take on the notion of canonicity itself. From slave narratives, as Arna Bontemps argued, derived the African-American literary tradition, since they embodied `the spirit and vitality and the angle of vision responsible for the most effective prose writing by black American writers from William Wells Brown . . . [to] James Baldwin' (Gates 1987, x). The generic legitimacy of the slave narrative confirmed, because it produced, the legitimacy of the African-American literary tradition. What's more, with the
emergence
of
the
slave
narrative
African-American
critics
turned
the
American
literary canon on its head. Citing nineteenth-century commentary that slave narratives constituted
the
Americans',
`one
critics
series
of
claimed
literary
in
effect
productions that,
far
that
from
could
being
a
be
written
marginal
by
none
subset,
but
African-
American literature formed the very basis of American literature (Parker 1976, 245). Slave narratives, then, turned out to be a weapon on the disciplinary front, a weapon enabling African-American studies both to secure further its academic legitimacy and to trouble long-held assumptions about the history and character of American literary studies. At the same time, slave narratives also proved to be an ongoing occasion for AfricanAmerican studies to take stock of its own assumptions regarding the work done in its name. When, as part of her ground-breaking
Invented Lives
(an anthology and work of literary
criticism), Mary Helen Washington turns to an analysis of the slave woman's narrative, she does so with a larger view of countering a variety of notions about African-American women and their place in the discipline (Washington 1987, 3±12). The difficulties Harriet Jacobs faced in writing sexuality
that
Incidents in the Life of a Slave Girl
nineteenth-century
conventions
of
± her personal struggle to express a
`true
womanhood'
would
not
allow
except to demonize it, the struggle to convince readers that her account possessed validity ± have, according to Washington, continued well into the late twentieth century in the form of a literary tradition that refuses to admit, much less acknowledge, the presence of AfricanAmerican women. Tradition, writes Washington, is `a word that nags the feminist critic'; for the black feminist critic, it provokes all sorts of angry questions, including those that wonder about the presumption that blackness is male (Washington 1987, xvii). If in 1987
Invented Lives
in fact marked an interruption of an African-American literary
tradition dominated by male authors and critics, it also was taking part in an ongoing project to found and maintain a literary tradition of writing by African-American women. Washington's earlier books ±
Midnight Birds
(1980) and
Black-Eyed Susans
(1975) ± both
sought to present literature `by and about black women', and in so doing, had set the stage for
critical
inquiry
addressed
to
questions
of
the
embodied in and by African-American women institution
that
had
been
unable
to
imagine
and
how
specific
concatenation
of
difference
the critique of the tradition and the women
might
have
any
role
but
a
marginal one in the development of both. The 1970s and 1980s saw, then, the increased
modern north american criticism and theory
140
institutionalization including
of
such
Washington's,
work
Toni
through
Cade
the
publication
Bambara's
of
important
anthologies
±
The Black Woman (1970) and All the
Women are White, All the Blacks are Men, But Some of Us are Brave (1982), edited by Gloria T. Hull, Patricia Bell Scott and Barbara Smith ± as well as the launching of several reprint series ± the Beacon Black Women Writers Series, Rutgers' American Women Writers series, and the Oxford-Schomburg Library of nineteenth-century Black Women's Writings. Moreover, this entry into the academy mattered, since, as the editors of
But Some of Us are
Brave put it:
Merely to use the term `Black Women's Studies' is an act charged with political significance. At the very least, the combining of these words to name a discipline means taking the stance that Black women exist ± and exist positively ± a stance that is in direct opposition to most of what passes for culture and thought on the North American continent. To use the term and to act on it in a white-male world is an act of political courage. (1982, 5)
At stake in this statement is the notion that visibility ± here in the form of the name `Black Women's Studies' ± means everything: far from simply referring to a group or movement, it wins attention and solidifies support. In that sense, it poses in a nutshell the challenge to and revision of the discipline that black feminist critics were seeking to articulate. Black feminist scholarship in the meantime experienced a parallel explosion of interest and productivity such that by 1990 the essays in the anthology of criticism
Reading Black,
Reading Feminist could reflect the evenness of pace at which works of criticism and black women's writing were being produced. This, several of the contributors observed, one could say from the perspective of a mere ten years: in the wake of Barbara Smith's `Toward a
Black
Feminist
Criticism'
(1977)
followed
Christian's
Black Women Novelists: The
Development of a Tradition (1980) and the edited collection Black Feminist Criticism (1985), Alice Walker's Hortense Spiller's Carby's
In Search of Our Mothers' Gardens (1983), Marjorie Pryse and
Conjuring: Black Women Writers and Literary Tradition (1985) and Hazel
Reconstructing Womanhood (1987). Much as the literary anthologies had aspired to
demonstrate that the preoccupations of black women writers converge on their double experience of oppression, this decade of black feminist criticism turned to theorize the formations that contributed to the literary complex of `black womanhood', `black female identity' or `black feminine sexuality'. Indeed, in so far as Barbara Smith urged fellow critics not to `try to graft the ideas or methodology of white/male literary thought upon the precious materials of black women's art', black feminist critics privileged experience as the site and source from which the literature emerged (Hull, Scott and Smith 1982, 164). Still, as the title of Hazel Carby's
Reconstructing Womanhood implies, the notion that
womanhood ± black or white, racially `marked' or `unmarked' ± stood as some uniform, constant and unchanging essence did not go uncontested. By the late 1980s, responding in part to the influx of poststructuralist theory in American literary studies, black feminist criticism sought to reinvigorate the terms of its work, eschewing any naturalness associated either with race or femininity, and positing that the constructed nature of both meant that their
entanglements
demanded
scrutiny
of the
ways
in which literature
produced
and
subverted such ideologies. Not to rely on the `indigenous' criticism, as Deborah McDowell observes, and to take on `foreign' theories and methodologies is not so much to capitulate or submit to some interpretative outside (McDowell 1989, 54), nor is it to betray the community of black feminism, the African-American literary tradition or the disciplinary home in which both at times take up residence; rather, to assume the authority of wielding
african-american studies
a
variety
of
discourses
141
means
±
as
McDowell,
Hortense
Spillers,
Hazel
Carby,
Mae
Henderson and a number of other black feminists have argued ± the possibility of changing `the contours of Afro-American literary history and of Afro-American critical discourse' (McDowell 1989, 54). Perhaps the greatest impact that this encounter between black feminist criticism and the thing known as theory has had, however, is on theory itself. Isolating African-American literature or criticism from other discourses is impossible, not only because the encounter already has taken place, but because those encounters have proved meaningful. This fact is nowhere more evident in recent work on the relationships that obtain between feminism, African-American
Studies
and
psychoanalysis.
In
this
context,
the
work
by
African-
Americanists on the filial configurations imposed by slavery makes the strong argument that the psychoanalytic model of development, underwritten as it is by the figure of the nuclear family, can have no purchase; it is the theory that proves inadequate here, not the families
themselves.
Such
work
enables
further
interrogations
of psychoanalysis
for
its
normative presumptions. The knowledge that Freud, for instance, on one occasion figures femininity in terms of Africa ± the mysterious `Dark Continent' that western imperialism would conquer ± immediately raises questions about the gendered and radicalized presumptions of Freudian psychoanalysis. In the meantime, as recent work has demonstrated, because these assumptions are not solely the realm of a Victorian past, but continue to occupy contemporary `white' feminist psychoanalysis, the need for ongoing conversation between African-American studies, feminism and psychoanalysis remains urgent indeed. The affiliation of change with theory, the contention that theory alone wreaks change, describes
only
a
one-way
street
of
influence.
What
the
`second
generation'
of
black
feminists experienced in their efforts to negotiate the political and ethical implications of taking
on
`western'
theory
±
rather
than
hold
strictly
onto
an
Afrocentric
vision
±
amounted to a mediation of the theoretical impulse, a revision, or edition, of what it means to theorize. While this stance is a long way from the statements of Black Arts advocates that the academy bars its doors to African-American critics, it does extend the claims of such writers as Addison Gayle that African-American literature offers a view of the theories that seek to explain it. In this sense, both black feminism and the Black Arts movement
converge
on
a
notion
that
continues
to
fascinate
and
vex
contemporary
African-Americanists: the idea that the relationship between African-American literature and theory, far from being a simple matter of rejection, application or appropriation, is instead a matter of intimate tensions. That this intimacy takes several forms should be no surprise. One of the earliest occurs in the justification that the criticism of African-American literature needs theory. In
Literature and Literary Theory
Black
, one of the first texts to address directly the stakes of theory in
African-American literary criticism, Gates offers perhaps the most cited of defences when he asserts that the study of African-American literature
demands
the turn to formalism,
structuralism or poststructuralism. `Who would seek to deny us our complexity?' he asks, implying that one discourse of complexity ± literature ± requires another (Gates 1984, 4). This
justification
gains
added
force
when
his
rhetoric
shifts
to
one
of
duty:
African-
American critics, Gates contends, `owe it to those traditions to bring to bear upon their readings any ``tool'' which helps us to elucidate [them]' (1984, 10). To perform this duty is to begin to bring these traditions, at this point still on the periphery of the academy, to the centre of the profession. What critics owe to literature underlies as well the claim that whatever theoretical
modern north american criticism and theory
142
work
African-American
literature
needs,
it
(1984)
and
American `extrinsic'
The Signifying Monkey
culture theory,
that, is
while
(1988),
sensitive
fundamentally
expressive
tradition,
voice
Baker
of
and
reminds
a
that
on
in
its
effect
responsive from
the
own.
its
model
own
for
argument
call
to
When
Houston
A.
a
a
view
Madelyn its
of
African-
Jablon
vernacular
calls
(Jablon
which casts the blues as both
the
is
for
what
terms:
A Vernacular Theory,
theoretical
readers
they
and
derived
1997, 3). Indeed, through his subtitle, an
generates
Blues, Ideology, and Afro-American Literature
Baker and Gates advance this argument in
African-American
`reorientation',
a
literary
return.
For
him, this return to the native sign is motivated by a sense of ethics; it marks `a minute beginning in the labor of writing/ righting American history and literary history' (Baker 1984, 200, emphasis mine). For his part, Gates announces in the preface to
Monkey
that
Baker
`accomplishes
with
the
blues
what
I
try
to
The Signifying
accomplish
here
with
Signifyin(g)' (1988, x). Gates, like Baker, enacts a return to the vernacular ± here to the African
and
African-American
trickster
monkey
traditions
for
which
language,
inter-
pretation and meta-discourse are fundamental currency ± in order to account for the ways in which the African-American literary tradition is based on a dynamic of revising and revisiting. The claim Gates makes in naming this theory `signifyin(g)' marks a desire to have the tradition `speak for itself' rather than, as he admits of his earlier work, to have it only spoken by `the white hermeneutical circle' (1988, 17, 232). These returns mark an effort to strike a balance between tradition and theory ± or better, as the essays from
Afro-American Literary Study in the 1990s
suggest, to strike a balance such
that the usual opposition between `tradition' and `theory', whatever weight it carries, does not do so invisibly or without scrutiny. In the interstices, African-American literature could be said to do nothing less than read theory, even as theory reads for its nature. Baker in
his
essay
claims
for
a
poetics
of
African-American
women's
writing
a
`conjure'
of
phenomenology, feminism and African-American spirituality (Baker and Redmond 1989, 144±50); McDowell urges dialogism not simply as a method of reading texts, but as a figure for
the
encounters
between
black
feminist
criticism
and
other
discourses
(Baker
and
Redmond 1989, 70); Gates, while insisting that the turn inward will mean `the black critical theory as great as [the] greatest black art', also looks forward to the impact that such a development will have on theory and `the literary enterprise in general' (Baker and Redmond
1989,
25±9).
This,
then,
is
at
the
heart
of
what
contemporary
African-
Americanists Michael Awkward, Jr, Henry Louis Gates, Jr, Mae Henderson, Wahneema Lubiano, Deborah McDowell, Hortense Spillers and Cheryl Wall have made evident in their respective works: a commitment to read back and forth between literature, culture and theory, never presuming that one should wholly explain the other, nor expecting from what direction any explanation should derive.
Yun Hsing Wu
Further reading and works cited Andrews, W. Ð (ed.)
To Tell a Free Story.
Urbana, IL, 1986.
Critical Essays on Frederick Douglass.
Baker, Jr, H. A.
Boston, 1991.
Blues, Ideology, and Afro-American Literature.
Ð.
Modernism and the Harlem Renaissance.
Ð.
Black Studies, Rap, and the Academy.
Chicago, 1991.
Chicago, 1993.
Chicago, 1984.
chicano/a literature
Afro-American Literary Study in the 1990s.
Ð and Redmond, P. (eds) Blassingame, J. (ed.) Carby, H.
Slave Testimony.
Black Women Novelists.
Black Feminist Criticism.
Douglass, F.
Chicago, 1989.
Baton Rouge, LA, 1977.
Reconstructing Womanhood.
Christian, B. Ð.
143
New York, 1987. Westport, CT, 1980.
New York, 1985.
Narrative of the Life of Frederick Douglass, An American Slave, Written by Himself ,
ed. H. A.
Baker. New York. 1982.
Souls of Black Folk.
Du Bois, W. E. B. Ford, N. A.
Black Studies.
New York, 1961.
Port Washington, NY, 1973.
Impact of Black Studies on the Curricula of Three Universities .
Frye, C. A.
Washington, DC, 1976.
Gates, Jr, H. L. `Binary Opposition in Chapter One of Narrative of the Life of Frederick Douglass, an American Slave, Written by Himself', in
Afro-American Literature,
eds R. Stepto and D. Fisher.
New York, 1978. Ð (ed.)
Black Literature and Literary Theory.
Ð (ed.)
The Classic Slave Narratives.
Ð.
The Signifying Monkey.
Ð (ed.)
New York, 1988.
Reading Black, Reading Feminist.
Gayle, A. (ed.)
The Black Aesthetic.
Holloway, K. F. C.
New York, 1984.
New York, 1987.
New York, 1990.
New York, 1971.
Moorings and Metaphors.
New Brunswick, NJ, 1992.
Hull, G. T., Scott, P. Bell and Smith, B. (eds)
Some of Us are Brave.
Black Metafiction.
Jablon, M.
Johnson, J. Weldon (ed.) McDowell, D. F. (ed.)
All the Women are White, All the Blacks are Men, But
Old Westbury, NY, 1982. Iowa City, IA, 1997.
The Book of American Negro Poetry.
Slavery and the Literary Imagination.
New York, 1922.
Baltimore, MD, 1989.
Parker (1976) add at proofs. Stepto, R.
From Behind the Veil.
New York, 1979.
Thelwell, M. `Black Studies: A Political Perspective', Washington, M. H. (ed.) Ð.
Invented Lives.
Black-Eyed Susans.
Massachusetts Review,
Autumn 1979.
New York, 1975.
New York, 1987.
West, C. `The Dilemma of the Black Intellectual',
Cultural Critique,
1, Fall 1985.
20. Chicano/a Literature
Chicano/a
literature
historiography
is
dating
a
complex
much
term
earlier
encompassing
than
the
1940s.
political,
cultural
`Chicano/a'
and
originates
gendered from
the
sixteenth-century name, `Mexicano/a'. `Mexicano/a' derives from the Nahuatl `Mexica', meaning
a
people
who
live
in
the
centre
of
the
maguey
(cactus
plant).
Lingually,
`Mexicano/a' in sixteenth-century speech, was articulated as `Meshicano/a' or `Mechicano/a' and later altered in the twentieth-century to Chicano/a. Yet the literature belonging under this cultural marker can be traced back to 2 February 1848: the year the Treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo was signed. The Mexicans who remained on Mexican-turned-North American lands (as outlined in the Treaty) and those who immigrated `post-1848' from Mexico and other Latin American countries also chose various names for themselves: Mexican-American, Latino/a and/or
chicano/a literature
Afro-American Literary Study in the 1990s.
Ð and Redmond, P. (eds) Blassingame, J. (ed.) Carby, H.
Slave Testimony.
Black Women Novelists.
Black Feminist Criticism.
Douglass, F.
Chicago, 1989.
Baton Rouge, LA, 1977.
Reconstructing Womanhood.
Christian, B. Ð.
143
New York, 1987. Westport, CT, 1980.
New York, 1985.
Narrative of the Life of Frederick Douglass, An American Slave, Written by Himself ,
ed. H. A.
Baker. New York. 1982.
Souls of Black Folk.
Du Bois, W. E. B. Ford, N. A.
Black Studies.
New York, 1961.
Port Washington, NY, 1973.
Impact of Black Studies on the Curricula of Three Universities .
Frye, C. A.
Washington, DC, 1976.
Gates, Jr, H. L. `Binary Opposition in Chapter One of Narrative of the Life of Frederick Douglass, an American Slave, Written by Himself', in
Afro-American Literature,
eds R. Stepto and D. Fisher.
New York, 1978. Ð (ed.)
Black Literature and Literary Theory.
Ð (ed.)
The Classic Slave Narratives.
Ð.
The Signifying Monkey.
Ð (ed.)
New York, 1988.
Reading Black, Reading Feminist.
Gayle, A. (ed.)
The Black Aesthetic.
Holloway, K. F. C.
New York, 1984.
New York, 1987.
New York, 1990.
New York, 1971.
Moorings and Metaphors.
New Brunswick, NJ, 1992.
Hull, G. T., Scott, P. Bell and Smith, B. (eds)
Some of Us are Brave.
Black Metafiction.
Jablon, M.
Johnson, J. Weldon (ed.) McDowell, D. F. (ed.)
All the Women are White, All the Blacks are Men, But
Old Westbury, NY, 1982. Iowa City, IA, 1997.
The Book of American Negro Poetry.
Slavery and the Literary Imagination.
New York, 1922.
Baltimore, MD, 1989.
Parker (1976) add at proofs. Stepto, R.
From Behind the Veil.
New York, 1979.
Thelwell, M. `Black Studies: A Political Perspective', Washington, M. H. (ed.) Ð.
Invented Lives.
Black-Eyed Susans.
Massachusetts Review,
Autumn 1979.
New York, 1975.
New York, 1987.
West, C. `The Dilemma of the Black Intellectual',
Cultural Critique,
1, Fall 1985.
20. Chicano/a Literature
Chicano/a
literature
historiography
is
dating
a
complex
much
term
earlier
encompassing
than
the
1940s.
political,
cultural
`Chicano/a'
and
originates
gendered from
the
sixteenth-century name, `Mexicano/a'. `Mexicano/a' derives from the Nahuatl `Mexica', meaning
a
people
who
live
in
the
centre
of
the
maguey
(cactus
plant).
Lingually,
`Mexicano/a' in sixteenth-century speech, was articulated as `Meshicano/a' or `Mechicano/a' and later altered in the twentieth-century to Chicano/a. Yet the literature belonging under this cultural marker can be traced back to 2 February 1848: the year the Treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo was signed. The Mexicans who remained on Mexican-turned-North American lands (as outlined in the Treaty) and those who immigrated `post-1848' from Mexico and other Latin American countries also chose various names for themselves: Mexican-American, Latino/a and/or
modern north american criticism and theory
144
Chicano/a.
The
controversial
term
name
Hispanic
among
(also
Latino/a
linked
groups
to
in
these
the
identity
United
groupings)
States
±
has
specifically
been
a
Chica-
nos/as. In the 1980s, the US Federal Administration (under Ronald Reagan) instituted a `Hispanic month' which automatically placed all Latinos (Mexican-Americans, PuertoRican
Americans,
Cuban-Americans,
etc.)
within
a
`Spanish'
(denoting
Hispania
or
Spain) historical context. The government also designed census forms and other legal documentation to denote all Latinos as `Hispanic'. Some groups do claim true lineage from Spain or `Hispania'. For example, various groups in New Mexico such as communities in Taos or Santa Fe claim Hispanic identity. However, it is important to note that Latino groups should not be considered Hispanic collectively. Chicanos/as especially do not wish to be linked with the term `Hispanic' because they consider their indigenous roots from Mexico primary, not secondary. `Hispanic' or `Hispania' represents a historical marker for indigenous conquest and colonization in Mexico (such as the Spanish conquest of the Aztecs). Chicanos/as then, see their heritage as one of the conquered and the conqueror ± the Indian and the Spanish colonizer. The dichotomous intersection of opposing ancestries emphasizes another term linked to the Chicana/o identity: the Mestizo (mixed blood) or Mestizaje
(a
people
of
mixed
blood).
Chicano
scholar
Rafael
Perez-Torres
describes
Mestizaje:
Mestizaje cannot be separated from the histories of rape and violation from which it emerges. Simultaneously, it cannot be dismissed in search of an original indigenous identity that is not the condition of Chicano praxis. The cultural products that emerge from Chicano configurations
of
identity
carry
with
them
the
conditions
of
mestizaje:
conjunction,
enrichment,
violation, conquest, fusion, violence. Textualized, mestizaje enables a scrutiny of power and knowledge as these have been enacted or erased through history. (1995, 212)
Mestizaje, then, is an important Chicano/a cultural marker for its signification of Mexican history and most importantly, for its cultural concerns on North American soil. Chicanos/ as may see their heritage linked to Mexico, but a Chicano/a is, first and foremost, an immigrant to the United States or born in the United States. Throughout their writings, therefore, the Chicano/a people explore what it means to be an American from a MexicanAmerican perspective. And the perspectives are multifarious: the Chicano/a farmworker struggling
in
the
fields
of
such
states
as
California,
Nevada,
Colorado
and
Texas,
interpersonal relationships which emphasize cultural differences and struggles, religious convictions, cultural traditions and language. Today, the farmworker is also the meatpacker, the factory worker, the sweatshop (maquilladora) worker living either on or near the borders of Mexico or as far as Nebraska, New Jersey, New York. Chicanos/as in Kansas trace their migratory history from those who arrived in Topeka as early as the first decade of the 1900s to work on the railroads. Family units, whose members vary in generation, must contend with symbolic intersections of migration and cultural memory. Religion, as well, is transformed and translated outside and within the family. And of course, cultural traditions  is a good example of a symbolic language migration and language undergo change. Calo Ânez and which appears in Chicano/a literature. According to Chicano scholars Julio Martõ Â, Calo  is `an argot common in barrio slang and speech . . . filled with Francisco Lomelõ metaphoric inventions and creative hybrids of Spanish, English, Spanglish (Spanish mixed with English), and some Nahuatl terms' (474). Chicano scholar Alfred Arteaga writes that  is an `intercultural dynamic', an important ingredient in the construction of `Chicano Calo identity' (1997, 68). He says:
chicano/a literature
145
[B]eing for Chicanos occurs in the interface between Anglo and Latin America, on the border that is not so much a river from the Gulf of Mexico to El Paso and a wire fence from there to the Pacific but, rather, a much broader area where human interchange goes beyond the simple `American or no' of the border check. It is the space to contest cultural identities more complex than the more facile questions of legal status or images in popular culture . . . Mexicans negotiate the border like no others, north and south, south and north, realizing simultaneous cultural fission and fusion. It is this border context that differentiates the styles of linguistic interplay of Chicano
poetry
from
other
styles
of
polyglot
poetics.
The
poetry
of
Eliot
and
Pound,
for
example, incorporates other languages, from the Italian of Dante, to German conversation, to Chinese characters. The poetics of Montoya and Burciaga is similar to Eliot and Pound's in the fact of its linguistic hybridization, but the fact of the border contributes to a different emphasis in the styles of that multilingualism. In Eliot and Pound there is much greater emphasis on quotation and literary allusion; while in Montoya and Burciaga, poetic hybridization tends to replicate the polyglot style of quotidian Chicano discourse. The former often focuses on the content of that form (for example, Dante's Inferno) and interlards `significant' texts; the latter focuses
on
the
form
of
that
form
(for
Â, calo
example,
hybridization
itself)
and
implements
discursive interaction. (Arkeaga 1997, 68±9)
Language is then the vehicle by which hybridization or Mestizaje is created, recreated and laid
open.
Chicano/a
literature
explores
all
of
these
complexities
(history,
culture,
language) inherent in the formation of identities. As previously noted, Chicano/a literature began evolving from the moment the Treaty of Guadalupe Hidalgo was signed. In its nascent stage, the literature, by and large, was a literature of
testimonio
(transcribed oral testimonies), history, memoir and protest. By the
1940s, Chicanos/as, colonized and marginalized, were responding to years of oppression in various discursive and performative ways. The Pachuco of the 1930s, 1940s, and 1950s represented a defiance of assimilation. These were young urban Chicanos from El Paso, Los  ), wore Angeles and surrounding communities who spoke the language of resistance (Calo the
zoot suit
(baggy pant suits, pancake hats, long belt chains) and were involved in petty
criminal activities. While urban Chicanos were creating and proclaiming a resistant identity, a number of Chicanas were focusing upon preserving an identity they did not want to lose. In the southwest,
a
number
of
Chicanas
were
preoccupied
with
gathering
testimonios
or
oral
histories of their communities. Chicana scholars Tey Diana Rebolledo and Eliana S. Rivero write:
In New Mexico, influenced by the New Deal and the Federal Writers' Project, three New Mexican women began to write about their lives and their cultural heritage: they were Cleofas Jaramillo,
Fabiola
Cabeza
de
Baca
Gilbert
and
Nina
Otero-Warren
...
Along
with
Jovita
Gonzales, who was collecting Texas folklore in the 1920s and 1930s, these women felt the need to document what they saw as a vanishing cultural heritage: their sense that their identity was being assimilated through history and cultural domination . . . Although their writing presents the perspective of a landed society, they nevertheless cultivate the seeds of cultural resistance to Anglo hegemony . . . Close readings of the texts written by these women show that landscape is one symbolic icon for describing the loss of land. In both and
Romance of a Little Village Girl
We Fed Them Cactus
(Cabeza de Baca)
(Jaramillo) the landscape at the beginning of the narration is
a verdant paradise and at the end a windswept purgatory. (1993, 17)
From `verdant paradise' to `windswept purgatory', the theme of abundance and belonging transformed
into
disenfranchisement
is
a
constant
trope
throughout
the
history
of
modern north american criticism and theory
146
Chicano/a literature. By collecting these Jaramillo
and
Otero-Warren,
were
testimonios
primarily
, Chicana writers in the southwest, like
seeking
to
preserve
a
heritage
for
future
generations. Chicanos/as (and this included Pachucos) were also preoccupied with the Second World War as was the rest of the nation. Part of the war effort included inviting new immigrants to join the armed forces. The government offered to speed up the citizenship process in order to allow minorities to join. As a result, many new immigrants from Mexico who sought citizenship in the US enlisted. The war also attracted Chicanos/as who wanted to prove they
were
patriotic
Americans.
Their
hope
was
to
contribute
to
the
nation
and
end
discrimination. However, their enthusiasm and hopefulness was often met with disappointment upon their return. Felipe de Ortego y Gasca writes:
The tragedy for Chicanos was that even though they responded patriotically to the colors during the war, they were still considered `foreigners' by Anglo Americans most of whom had themselves `recently' arrived from elsewhere, particularly Europe. Ironically, the first draftee of World War II was Pete Aguilar Despart, a Mexican American from Los Angeles. Chicanos were to emerge as the American ethnic group having won more medals of honor than any other group of Americans except Anglos. (1931, 12)
Chicana/o writings during this time of the national war effort also included theatre. Artists Ân (from Los Angeles and San Antonio such as Daniel Ferreiro Rea and Carlos Villalongõ respectively) produced shows for free and created
revistas
and
zarzuelas
. A
combination of song and recitation within the confines of a dramatic play. published
writings
(of
plays,
poetry
or
prose
writings)
in
pamphlet
or
zarzuela Revistas
magazine
is a are
form.
Although their efforts were short-lived, Spanish-language theatre remained active due to artists
such
performers
as in
Ân Villalongõ New
York
and
(La
Ferreiro
Chata
Rea.
There
Loloesca)
and
were
Spanish-language
others
working
in
vaudeville
television
and
Âa Astol) during and after the war. Chicanos/as Spanish-language radio (Leonardo Garcõ were not only present in big city theatre venues but also in the agrarian areas of the southwest.
These
were
called
`tent
theatres:'
makeshift
theatres
easily
constructed
for
Ânez and Francisco Lomelõ Â note that `[t]ent theatres also travel. Chicano scholars Julio Martõ continued their perennial odysseys into the 1950s, often setting up right in the camps of migrant farm laborers to perform their young
people
who
would
create
a
revistas
. Through these traveling theatres some of the
Chicano
theater
in
the
1960s
[received]
their
first
exposure to Hispanic theatrical tradition' (1985, 179). These artists and performers were at the forefront of what was to be an important theatrical and literary revival.
In 1965 the modern Chicano theater movement was born when Luis Miguel Valdez founded El Teatro Campesino in an effort to assist in organizing farmworkers for the grape boycott and the strike in Delano, California. From the humble beginning of dramatizing the plight of farmworkers, the movement grew to include small, agit-prop theater groups in communities and on campuses around the country, and eventually developed into a total theatrical expression that would find resonance on the commercial stage and the screen. By 1968 Valdez and El Teatro Campesino had left the vineyards and lettuce patches in a conscious effort to create a theater for a people which Valdez and other grass roots organizers of the 1960s envisioned as working-class, Spanish-speaking or bilingual, rurally oriented, and with very strong Pre-Columbian cultural ties. By 1970 El Teatro Campesino had pioneered and developed what would come to be known as teatro chicano, a style of agit-prop that incorporated the spirit and presentational style of the commedia dell'arte with the humor, character types, folklore, and popular culture of the
chicano/a literature
147
Mexican, especially as articulated earlier in the century by Mexican vaudeville companies that Ânez and Lomele  1985, 179) toured the Southwest in tent theaters. (Martõ
Equally important are the women who were involved with Teatro Campesino from its inception as well as contemporary Chicana artists in theatre today. Â lez writes that `[w]omen have constituted a distinct force within Yolanda Broyles-Gonza the Teatro Campesino and, by extension, within the history of Chicana/o theater' (1996, 134). El Teatro Campesino's writing and production work was never solely created by one person but was a collective effort involving bright, vibrant and hard-working women who had to struggle to defend their presence in the theatre due to cultural patriarchal notions. Historically, Latin American and Mexican women have been relegated to the domestic sphere and women in theatre work, especially, are often not considered respectable. In addition
to
Campesino toward
the
working had
to
against
resist
inclusion
of
these
societal
stereotyped complex
roles
female
attitudes,
written
by
characters.
the the
women men
Olivia
in
within the
El
group
Chumacero,
a
Teatro or
work
member,
describes the way Teatro Campesino produced plays:
We used to develop our scripts as we went along, from the improvisations . . . Sometimes, like when we were doing
La carpa
, which was in
corrido
form [corrido is a popular ballad], we had
nights in which people met who wanted to work on writing the
versos
[verses] for the
corrido
.
Smiley and I would go, along with different other people who were interested in writing. We'd sit down with Luis and work at it that way too. First we would talk ideas, about where we wanted to go in the piece. And then we would write different verses or whatever, and then select from that . . . It was a collective way of working. We made our own costumes, we built our own props  lez 1996, 131) and sets . . . we did all the work collectively. (Broyles-Gonza
Yet in many historical accounts of El Teatro Campesino, the fact that women and men worked together to write and produce these plays is largely ignored. It is important to highlight the collective nature of this organization to understand Chicano/a theatre at this time because then we can see a logical development of the history of Chicano and Chicana  lez emtheatre production as well as literary development of all genres. Broyles-Gonza phasizes the importance of this understanding:
The activities of several of the women from El Teatro Campesino ± Olivia Chamacero, Socorro Valdez, Diane Rodriguez, Yolanda Parra ± and the work of Silvia Wood in Tucson, Arizona; Nita Luna from El Teatro Aguacero in New Mexico; the women and men of El Teatro de la Âa Elena Gaita  rez's or Marõ  n's one-woman shows; the plays by Estela Esperanza; Ruby Nelda Pe Âe Moraga, and more recently by Josefina Lo  vez, Cherrõ  pez, Edit Portillo Trambley, Denise Cha  ndez, all mark the entry into a new cycle of theatrical activity for Villareal, and Evelina Ferna Chicanas
...
The
history
of
women's
participation
in
theater
history,
is
of
far-reaching
significance in and of itself. (1996, 163)
Similarly, the contributions Chicanas have made in fiction and poetry have redefined and repositioned definitions of the Chicano/a within and outside of their respective community. The popularity of Chicano/a theatre which focused upon the human condition and also gave voice to oppressed and impoverished Chicano/a workers prefaced
El Movimiento
which is also known as the Chicano Movement occurring between the 1960s and 1970s. The
Chicano
Movement
flourished
due
to
a
change
in
national
and
international
 mez-Quin Ä ones, `The civil rights political and economic climates. According to Juan Go movement of the 1960s focused attention primarily on the problems of Blacks, while devoting
some
attention
to
the
problems
of
other
minorities.
The
Kennedy
adminis-
modern north american criticism and theory
148
tration's ``New Frontier'' and Johnson's ``Great Society'' environment seemed to be willing to consider the increased demands by Mexicans for equal citizenship rights' (1992, 103). As a result, support and available monetary resources increased within community groups who were organizing for equal rights and justice.
[I]nitiating forces were the Farm Workers Union, the Alianza, the Crusade for Justice, student organizations, and eventually, La Rasa Unida. Workers or persons of working-class origin were key to these forces, and women often provided the organizational backbone. Whatever the particular goals and methods of the political activism, the underlying current was disenchantment
over
the
Mexican's
political,
economic,
and
social
status
in
an
Anglo-dominated
capitalist society. Political activists became increasingly concerned with understanding how economic and class exploitation and racism had shaped the Mexican experience in the United States. The struggle to understand the Mexican American experience increasingly focused on questions of alienation, ethnicity, identity, class, gender and chauvinism. An articulation of a historical understanding of the Mexican experience became a paramount motif, a necessity in  mez-Quin Ä ones 1992, 103) the struggle to shape a future for La Raza in the United States. (Go
Within this context, the era of the Chicano Literary Renaissance emerged. Although most  rico Paredes' important work scholars date the beginning of the Renaissance in 1965, Ame
With A Pistol in His Hand
 Antonio Villarreal's novel (1958) and Jose
Pocho
(1959) point to
a slightly earlier beginning. Chicanas also figured prominently even in this early stage of the Renaissance. Tey Diana Rebolledo writes that `Quinto Sol [a Chicano publishing company]
published
El Espejo/the Mirror: Selected Chicano Literature
(1969),
the
first
anthology of Chicano literature published by Chicanos. Included among the writers were Estela Portillo, Raquel Moreno, and Georgia Cobos' (21). The Poetry, fiction and nonfiction focused on the perspective of the Mexican-American in the United States just as it had done in the earlier plays of El Teatro Campesino. The Teatro was also still quite active during this marked literary period. Â s Rivera, Novelists emerging at this time were Toma (1971); Alurista, Oscar Acosta,
Nationchild Plumaroja
 La Tierra ... Y No Se Lo Trago
(1972); Rudolfo Anaya,
The Revolt of the Cockroach People
Bless Me, Ultima
(1973); and Rolando Hinojosa,
(1972);
Estampas
Del Valle
(1973). In 1975, Chicana novelist Estela Portillo Trambley published
Rain of
Scorpions.
It was one of the first Chicana novels during this era. Ten years after
Rain of
Scorpions,
the nation would see an explosion of Chicana writing. Between that time (1975±
85) Rebolledo notes that publishing was easier for Chicanos than Chicanas:
[A]lthough some women were included among the first writers to be published, it was the male authors who made the initial inroads, were most easily and frequently published, and were the most recognized
. . . These authors became a canonical liturgy for Chicano writing . . . Chicanas
were
writing
during this early period. They were writing, but, having been silenced for long periods of time, the authors found breaking that silence into a public act difficult. (1995, 22)
Instead, the Chicano perspective was privileged with works such as Alejandro Morales,
Verdad Sin Voz
(1979); John Rechy,
Rushes
 squez, (1979); Richard Va
After the publication of the first Chicana anthology,
Grito,
Another Land
La
(1982).
Chicanas en La Literatura y El Arte: El
which was edited by Estela Portillo Trambley in September of 1973, Chicanas began
Âe Moraga and Gloria Anzaldu Âa to publish but activity was slow. Eight years later, Cherrõ published the anthology,
This Bridge Called My Back: Writings by Radical Women of Color
(1981). This anthology not only highlighted Chicana writings, but included women of
chicano/a literature
149
colour from a variety of backgrounds and prompted an explosion of writings quite different from the earlier writings of the 1970s. This anthology directly addressed what Chicanas felt had
always
colour):
been
problematic
women's
in
the
Chicano
disenfranchisement,
community
erasure
and
(and
gendered
other
communities
violence
within
a
of
male-
identified community. The development of the personal essay present in this anthology became
a
vehicle
to
express
these
frustrations.
The
anthology
was
a
success
and
also
controversial because, as scholar Tey Diana Rebolledo points out, it placed Chicanas in a dilemma:
`This dilemma often placed Chicanas in a tenuous position between Anglo-feminists and their male Chicano colleagues. It put an additional strain on the Chicana lesbian feminists who felt, moreover, that their heterosexually oriented sisters did not fully support them. These issues raised in Chicana literature are still in a state of dialogue between the various perspectives as writers struggle with issues of unity versus separation. (Rebelledo and Rivero 1993, 24)
However,
it
also
encouraged
communities
to
begin
speaking
about
these
complex
privileged and oppressed positions. These writings paved the way for further introspection  a's work, with Gloria Anzaldu Ana Castillo's work,
Borderlands/La Frontera: The New Mestiza (1987) and later
Massacre of the Dreamers: Essays on Xicanisma (1995). New Chicana
 vez, novelists emerged in full force during the 1980s and 1990s: Denise Cha
Last of the Menu
Âa Viramontes, Girls (1991); Sandra Cisneros, Woman Hollering Creek (1992); Helena Marõ
Under the Feet of Jesus (1996); the aforementioned Ana Castillo, The Mixquiahuala Letters (1992) and others. All of these works were ground-breaking for their investigation and perspectives of the Chicana in contemporary society ± both within the dominant society and in Chicano communities. Chicano male writers responded by re-investigating their own
male
identity.
Writer
understand his upbringing in  lez's anthology, Ray Gonza Chicanos
and
Latinos
Luis
J.
Rodriguez
returns
to
his
childhood
in
an
effort
to
Always Running: La Vida Loca, Gang Days in L.A. (1993). In
Muy Macho: Latino Men Confront Their Manhood (1996) sixteen
re-evaluate
their
patriarchal
social
conditioning.
As
well,
Luis
Alberto Urrea writes a scathing memoir tracing and critiquing his patriarchal upbringing in
Nobody's Son (1998). Indeed, Chicano/a literature has certainly experienced much growth in
the
past
forty
economically
and
years:
investigating
personally.
In
all
its
of
identity,
these
its
works,
place it
is
within
apparent
society that
politically,
Chicanos
are
moving towards a more inclusive and radical Mestizaje: a consciousness of inclusion and awareness of gendered as well as racial and class-based oppression and privilege. This, above all, is where the Chicano/a acquires her/his power to write.
Amelia MarõÂa de la Luz Montes
Further reading and works cited Arteaga, A.
Chicano Poetics. New York, 1997.
 lez, Y. Broyles-Gonza Âa, A. M. Garcõ
El Teatro Campesino. Austin, TX, 1996.
Chicana Feminist Thought. New York, 1997.
Gaspar de Alba, A. Â mez-Quin Ä ones, J. Go
Chicano Art. Austin, TX, 1998. Chicano Politics. Albuquerque, NM, 1992.
Gonzales-Berry, E. and Tatum, C. (eds)
Recovering the U.S. Hispanic Literary Heritage. Houston, TX,
1996. Â rrez, R. and Padilla, G. (eds) Gutie
Recovering the U.S. Hispanic Literary Heritage. Houston, TX, 1993.
modern north american criticism and theory
150
 ndez-Gutie  rrez, M. de Jesu  s and Foster, D. W. (eds) Herna
Literatura Chicana, 1965±1995.
New York,
1997. Herrera-Sobek, M. and Viramontes, H. M.  nchez Рand Korrol, V. Sa  pez, T. A. Lo
Growing Up Chicana/o.
Mariscal, G. (ed.)
Chicana Creativity and Criticism.
Recovering the U.S. Hispanic Literary Heritage .
 n and Viet Nam. Aztla
Berkeley, CA, 1999.
Chicano Literature.
This Bridge Called My Back.
The Decolonial Imaginary.
 rez-Torres, R. Pe
Women Singing in the Snow.
Ð and Rivero, E. S. (eds) Â nchez, G. J. Sa Trujillo, C.
Infinite Divisions.
Becoming Mexican American.
Living Chicana Theory.
16, Fall 1981.
Indianapolis, IN, 1999.
Movements in Chicano Poetry.
Rebolledo, T. D.
Westport, CT, 1985. New York, 1983.
Denver Quarterly,
Ortego y Gasca, F. de. `The Quetzal and the Phoenix', Â rez, E. Pe
Houston, TX, 2000.
New York, 1993.
Ânez, J. A. and Lomelõ Â, F. A. (eds) Martõ Â a, G. Moraga, C. and Anzaldu
Albuquerque, NM, 1996.
New York, 1995. Tucson, AZ, 1995.
Tucson, AZ, 1993. New York, 1993.
Berkeley, CA, 1998.
21. Film Studies
We are sometimes told today that film studies has progressed through `a general movement in approaches to film from a preoccupation with authorship (broadly defined), through a concentration upon the text and textuality, to an investigation of audiences' (Hollows and Jancovich 1995, 8) ± a consecutive pursuit of knowledge about film form, then realism, followed by language, and, finally, cultural politics (Braudy and Cohen 1999, xv±xvi). Such accounts forget the hardy perennials of cinema criticism, social and cultural theory and cultural policy: textual analysis of films, identification of directors with movies, and studies of the audience through psychology and psychoanalysis (Worth 1981, 39). These perennials involve: (a) the identification and promotion of a canon of work that can secure cinema a role as an art form and social text; and (b) anxieties about the impact of the screen on spectators. Under category (a), some film academics separate their work from politics, regarding it as a means of registering and developing aesthetic discrimination `in a relationship of tutelage, to the more established disciplines' (Bennett et al. 1981, ix). They seek to isolate the `basic features of film which can constitute it as an art' (Bordwell and Thompson 1997, ix). Textual ranking identifies authors and focuses on form and style. Such
old-fashioned
disciplinary
self-formation,
whereby
rent-seeking
professors
define
what is art and then instruct others, is a powerful force, as we know from the history of literary studies. But
film
always
exceeds
attempts
to
institute
such
New
Critical
readings,
precisely
because of its history and currency. As a governmental and business technology that spread with
urbanization
and
colonialism
alongside
multifarious
attempts
to
comprehend
the
modernity that it brought into vision (Shohat and Stam 1994, 100±36), film is impossible to delimit in a fetishized manner for long, in all but the most devastatingly intramural cloisters. More political work done under category (a) stresses that the avowed project of elevating cinema to the status of apolitical art is doomed to failure in its attempt to cordon
modern north american criticism and theory
150
 ndez-Gutie  rrez, M. de Jesu  s and Foster, D. W. (eds) Herna
Literatura Chicana, 1965±1995.
New York,
1997. Herrera-Sobek, M. and Viramontes, H. M.  nchez Рand Korrol, V. Sa  pez, T. A. Lo
Growing Up Chicana/o.
Mariscal, G. (ed.)
Chicana Creativity and Criticism.
Recovering the U.S. Hispanic Literary Heritage .
 n and Viet Nam. Aztla
Berkeley, CA, 1999.
Chicano Literature.
This Bridge Called My Back.
The Decolonial Imaginary.
 rez-Torres, R. Pe
Women Singing in the Snow.
Ð and Rivero, E. S. (eds) Â nchez, G. J. Sa Trujillo, C.
Infinite Divisions.
Becoming Mexican American.
Living Chicana Theory.
16, Fall 1981.
Indianapolis, IN, 1999.
Movements in Chicano Poetry.
Rebolledo, T. D.
Westport, CT, 1985. New York, 1983.
Denver Quarterly,
Ortego y Gasca, F. de. `The Quetzal and the Phoenix', Â rez, E. Pe
Houston, TX, 2000.
New York, 1993.
Ânez, J. A. and Lomelõ Â, F. A. (eds) Martõ Â a, G. Moraga, C. and Anzaldu
Albuquerque, NM, 1996.
New York, 1995. Tucson, AZ, 1995.
Tucson, AZ, 1993. New York, 1993.
Berkeley, CA, 1998.
21. Film Studies
We are sometimes told today that film studies has progressed through `a general movement in approaches to film from a preoccupation with authorship (broadly defined), through a concentration upon the text and textuality, to an investigation of audiences' (Hollows and Jancovich 1995, 8) ± a consecutive pursuit of knowledge about film form, then realism, followed by language, and, finally, cultural politics (Braudy and Cohen 1999, xv±xvi). Such accounts forget the hardy perennials of cinema criticism, social and cultural theory and cultural policy: textual analysis of films, identification of directors with movies, and studies of the audience through psychology and psychoanalysis (Worth 1981, 39). These perennials involve: (a) the identification and promotion of a canon of work that can secure cinema a role as an art form and social text; and (b) anxieties about the impact of the screen on spectators. Under category (a), some film academics separate their work from politics, regarding it as a means of registering and developing aesthetic discrimination `in a relationship of tutelage, to the more established disciplines' (Bennett et al. 1981, ix). They seek to isolate the `basic features of film which can constitute it as an art' (Bordwell and Thompson 1997, ix). Textual ranking identifies authors and focuses on form and style. Such
old-fashioned
disciplinary
self-formation,
whereby
rent-seeking
professors
define
what is art and then instruct others, is a powerful force, as we know from the history of literary studies. But
film
always
exceeds
attempts
to
institute
such
New
Critical
readings,
precisely
because of its history and currency. As a governmental and business technology that spread with
urbanization
and
colonialism
alongside
multifarious
attempts
to
comprehend
the
modernity that it brought into vision (Shohat and Stam 1994, 100±36), film is impossible to delimit in a fetishized manner for long, in all but the most devastatingly intramural cloisters. More political work done under category (a) stresses that the avowed project of elevating cinema to the status of apolitical art is doomed to failure in its attempt to cordon
film studies
151
off the social. This is a challenge to the Eurocentrism and universalism of formalist theory, in accord with social movements and Third and Fourth World counter-discourses (Carson and Friedman 1995). Category
(b)
±
concerns
about
the
audience
±
includes
psychological,
sociological,
educational, consumer, criminological and political promises and anxieties. These have been prevalent since silent cinema's faith in `the moving picture man as a local social force . . . the mere formula of [whose] activities' keeps the public well-tempered (Lindsay 1970, 243); through 1930s research into the impact of cinema on American youth via the Payne Studies (Blumer 1933); to post-Second World War concerns about Hollywood's intrication of education
and
entertainment
and
the
need
for counter-knowledge
among
the
public (Powdermaker 1950, 12±15). For the contemporary left, questions of pleasure have been central, as analysts have sought
to
account
for
and
resist
narrative
stereotypes
and
explain
`why
socialists
and
feminists liked things they thought they ought not to' (Dyer 1992, 4). This difficulty over pleasure accounts for film theory being highly critical of prevailing cultural politics, but never
reifying
itself
into
the
Puritanism
or
orthodoxy
alleged
by
critics
of
political
correctness. The extraordinary diversity of latter-day film anthologies makes this point clear. A feminist film anthology focuses on issues of representation and production that are shared by many women, but it also attends to differences of race, history, class, sexuality and nation, alongside and as part of theoretical difference (Carson et al. 1994), while a black
film
anthology
divides
between
spectatorial
and
aesthetic
dimensions
(Diawara
1993), and a queer anthology identifies links between social oppression and film and video practice (Holmlund and Fuchs 1997). I shall deal with the discourses of categories (a) and (b) serially, picking up from the latter to suggest a way forward for film studies
Film as an art form The first move made under category (a) is to uncover directorial authorship (auteurism). There have been three main currents in debates about film authorship. First, authorship has been a category of legal ownership and textual criticism. US law theorizes the producer of a film as its author. But not so US film studies, which seeks directors with an latter
case,
the
knot
that
allegedly
holds
films
together
across
time
oeuvre
and
. In the
space
is
a
recognizable set of concerns and stylistic norms that can be correlated with an individual director's biography and show a capacity to move from denotative storytelling to connotative thematic tropes. Second, a radical alternative argues for the material conditionality
of
the
category,
suggesting
that
authors
are
constituted
through
discourses
and
institutions rather than through personal vision. Third, an argument exists for the social nature of cultural production, the inevitable cross-pollination of signs, genres and codes that sweep across a landscape rather than originating in specific people. There is something laughably counter-indicative about auteurism. Making films is so obviously collective in its division of labour. Auteurism only makes sense if we consider the medium's claim to art. Authorship is identified and its eminence distributed in synchronization with artistic valorization ± once novels, movies, television drama or web pages are held to be of creative significance, a discourse of individual signatures emerges. The effect is a double one ± certain authors are named and elevated, and the medium or genre itself receives cross-validation from the process. (This person is an author, he/she is gifted. This medium has authors, it is artistic.) The nice irony, of course, is the use of categories from
modern north american criticism and theory
152
high-art appreciation to endorse popular culture in a way that acknowledges the audience imagined by film-makers as integral to their creative practice ± quite unlike the windswept romantic author pondering the infinite. Auteur writings covered a broad sweep of politics, and not always from a humanist perspective ± structuralists believed that auteurs touched on deeply secreted structures of mythic meaning in a culture, unconsciously opening up lines of fissure. Today arguments are
made
for
masculinist
auteurism
concerns
links
between
and directorial surrogates as sites of enunciation within
from
radical
political
projects
±
identifying
texts, or
seeking to promote the work of those marginalized from cinema by virtue of their sex or race. The second move of category (a) is about film form and style, via narratology. Narratives tell stories through an aetiological chain of cause and effect over time via a linear trajectory from the establishment of questions or problems to their resolution. A film moves from a presumed
state
of
normalcy,
or
equilibrium,
for
the
characters
prior
to
the
text,
to
a
disequilibrium set up in the opening of that text, and then through a series of manoeuvres that results in the achievement of a goal and a new equilibrium. Classical narrative cinema focuses on central characters, whose attitudes to the events going on around them and participation in conflicts and their resolution are critical. The success or otherwise of these moves frequently depends on their ability to engage dual forms of verisimilitude ± looking like a film story of a familiar kind, and also resembling the mental processes of ordinary human experience. Much academic narratology is linked to formalism, which divides narratives in two. The
fabula
or story concerns the chronological unfolding of relations between characters, or
actants. This is the immanent structure of the story, the spirit-within that impels a text
syuzhet, or plot (the syuzhet animates the fabula via an array
forward. When that basis becomes orchestrated, it is transformed into a movement from what is told to how to tell it). The
of artistic devices, such as parallelism, retardation, defamiliarization and so on: in short, sources of aesthetic pleasure that do not simply move the narrative forward. Understanding a narrative is more than following the trajectory of a story. It depends on reading the story horizontally as well as vertically ± the narrative thread only makes partial sense of a film, along with an attempt to remember, for example, the
conduct
of a specific
character
through the text. The classical Hollywood narrative is about action ± a search for an object by a person, and the event that closes the search off. This linear model does not deal particularly well with the atmospheric, processual type of film. A series of emotional engagements and disengagements is entered into, often without obvious motivation in terms of the overall narrative drive of the story. Signs float around in a way that is quite incidental to allowing the hero to find his pot of whatever. Instead, information that is supplementary to the excuse for the film becomes its effective/affective centre, the real template for the action. Methods of narration are influenced by the use of camera, and here questions of style arise. Subjective narration, which clearly locates the vantage point or enunciation within a character in the diegesis, often involves point-of-view shooting, whereas hidden enunciation is mimetic and favours objective camera. In subjective narration, the camera takes on the function of that character's vision in the text. Conversely, omniscient and objective narration
are
frequently
achieved
through
a
point
of
view
that
comes
from
nowhere,
outside the action and seemingly without a particular perspective or form of knowledge. But this narration can be interpreted to bring out the site of enunciation if we examine
film studies
153
factors such as the height of the camera. The eye-level shot is taken with the camera horizontal to the ground as if it were in the room in human form but without being seen or reacting to what occurs in front of it. The high-angle shot is taken from above the action. It can emphasize the insignificance of the human actants as opposed to the commercial, natural or architectural features in the frame. Conversely, low-angle shots are tilted up to cover the action, which can inflect it with a certain glow from below as well as highlighting size
and
speed.
This
attention
to
textual
detail
has
been
very
productive
for
the
aestheticization impulses of category (a). What of the social and political aspects to category (a)? I shall examine these with particular reference to class. Attempts to do class analysis in film involve a number of moves: literally observing how a class acts on screen ± its clothing, gesture, movement, work, leisure, home-life; seeing who controls the means of communication behind a film ± technicians, producers, directors, censors, shareholders; analysing the ideological message of stories ± personal transcendence versus collective solidarity, the legitimacy of capitalist freedoms, or the compensations in family and community for social inequality; and noting which
interests
bourgeoisies,
are
men,
served whites,
by
government-sponsored
distributors,
the
people.
In
national textual
film
industries
terms,
those
±
films
local that
foreground class through theme or identification do not exhaust the list of films ready for class readings. Patterns of speech or costume may not only signify the immediate referent of social position, but go beyond that to the trappings, logic and operation of capitalism: how the clothes were made, or the housing conditions that go along with the accent; we might think here of the James Bond series' obsession with small differentiations of social position through food, alcohol and cars, and the way that hotel staff and other employees are easily ordered about. Some of us deem it important that Sean Connery orders the Dom Perignon '52 and George Lazenby the '57. The
price
paid
for
attending
a
film
(exchange-value)
takes
over
from
the
desires
exhibited in the actual practical utility of what is being purchased (use-value). This price expresses the momentary monetary value of that need rather than its lasting utility. That notion of built-in obsolescence and value bestowed via a market is in fact a key to all commodities, popular or otherwise. They elicit desire by wooing consumers, glancing at them sexually, and smelling and looking nice in ways that are borrowed from romantic love but then reverse that relationship: people learn about correct forms of romantic love from commodities, such as love scenes in movies. This culture industries paradigm has alerted film theory to the fact that organizations train, finance, describe, circulate and reject actors and activities that go under the signs film-maker and film. Governments, trade unions, colleges, social movements, community groups and businesses aid, fund, control, promote, teach and evaluate creative persons. They define and implement criteria that make possible
the use of the word `creative'
through law courts that permit erotica on the grounds that they are works of art, schools that require pupils to study film on the grounds that it is improving, film commissions that sponsor scripts on the grounds that they reflect society back to itself, or studios that invite Academy Award voters to parties as promotions for their movies. In turn, these criteria may themselves derive, respectively, from legal doctrine, citizenship or tourism aims, and profit plans. This industrial infrastructure has implications for what it actually means to produce culture: `[T]he popular notion of a struggling artist working isolated in a lonely garret is extremely misleading as a representation of the norm. Creators often struggle economically, but in modern
modern north american criticism and theory
154
societies most of them work in organizational settings ± either directly in an organization or indirectly dependent upon one or more organizations to distribute or exhibit their work .
..
even culture production by individuals occurs in collective contexts . . . networks of functionally interdependent individuals, groups, and organizations. (Zollars and Cantor 1993, 3)
Film and its audience Testing the relationship between films and their viewers has produced two main forms of analysis: spectatorship theory and audience research. Spectatorship theory speculates about the effects on people of films, but instead of questioning, testing and measuring them, it uses
psychoanalysis
formation spectator
of
to
explore
subjectivity
is
understood
are
as
how
enacted
a
supposedly on-screen
universal and
narratively-inscribed
in
internal
the
concept
struggles
psyches that
can
of
over
watchers.
be
known
the The
via
a
combination of textual analysis and Freudianism. Audience research is primarily concerned with the number and conduct of people seated before screen texts: where they came from, how many there were and what they did as a consequence of being present. The audience is understood as an empirical concept that can be known via research instruments derived from sociology, demography, social psychology and marketing. The film spectator is generally understood as the product of two forces: first, psychic struggles for personality that psychoanalytic theory claims are characteristic of maturation and the getting of sexuality; and second how both the texts and the physical apparatus of cinema draw out these conflicts. Psychological battles are in the unconscious, which means that they cannot be known through the thoughts or neurones of people. Instead, they gain expression indirectly, via the repetition of various dramas about power and the self, with sexual identity at their core. Not surprisingly, these narratives find some expression in dreams, and may be sources for fiction as well; hence the similarity between film-going and dreams (the darkness and the abandon in story) is matched by a likeness in the texture of film narrative and the unconscious. As Dudley Andrew points out, psychoanalysis has been deployed to account for the unconscious of film-makers and spectators, the nature of film as fantasy, the inevitability of identification for fantasy to come into play, and how the unconscious in film may intersect with wider questions of psychoanalysis and culture (1984, 135). Graeme Turner argues
that
film
is
friendly
towards
psychoanalysis
because
of
`its
collapsing
of
the
boundaries of the real'. The cinema occupies the gap between what we see and what we imagine (1988, 113). Most
1970s
psychoanalytic
film
theory
argues
that
the
gaze
in
film
belongs
to
the
heterosexual male and his screen brothers. Feminist theorists and film-makers responded by supporting and making some determinedly unpleasurable films that confronted spectators with their complicity in patriarchy. The cinema is seen as a sexual technology, a site where practices
are
instantiated
that
construct
sex
and
desire
through
such
techniques
as
confession, concealment and the drive for truthful knowledge about motivation, character and occasion. The reproducibility of virtuosic performance provided by electronic technology has produced an era of performativity. Both simultaneity of instant reception and longevity of recorded life come with electronic media. The technology of visual reproduction
enables
a
multiplicity
of
personalized
perspectives
inside
a
world
of
commodity
reproduction. In some cases, this avant-gardisme denied both women's active address and engagement with classical narrative, and crucial social differences within genders that are
film studies
155
not about the acquisition of linguistic or familial norms or the getting of sexuality, but are to do with race and class (Pribram 1988, 1±3). The notion of overturning dominant forms of stitching spectators into the text relates to criticisms of realism. For example, the conventional documentary sets the spectator's gaze up as competent, once it is guided by the knowing hand±eye±technology coordination of the director and editor. Raymond Williams sees the avant-garde as acknowledging the existence of a `fragmented ego in a fragmented world', defying capitalist neatness and a unilogical realism (1989, 93). There is, of course, intense argument about how different forms of texts can be read. The notion of textually inscribed rules of reading ± interpellations of viewers ± as a function of naturalism/realism problematized the value of, for example, social realism. It has been an orthodoxy that linear, resolved narratives which compel closure are reactionary in their construction of the possibility of perfect knowledge. Instead, audiences should be confronted with the constructedness of their positioning and the seams of weaving of each text made explicit via self-referentiality. Like psychoanalytic theory, this critique makes symptomatic readings of texts, assuming that spectatorship was less a practice than a by-product of being positioned and attracted by narrative and image that implied perfect knowledge and political orthodoxy in their very essence. Psychoanalytic protocols have proved to be remarkably providential for interrogating questions of masculinity, femininity and postcoloniality. While Freud may be considered outmoded in the social sciences, his doctrine of counter-indicative reading and the centrality of sex remain magnetic to film theory, especially when linked to the apparatus of cinema. The apparatus in film theory refers to the interaction between spectators, texts and technology. Apparatus theory is concerned with the material circumstances of viewing: the nature of filmic projection (from behind the audience) or video playing (from behind or in front), the darkness of the theatre or the lightness of daytime TV, the textual componentry of what is screened and the psychic mechanisms engaged. In other words, apparatus theory inquires into the impact of the technical and physical specificity of watching films on the processing methods used by their watchers. This goes beyond issues raised in debates over technological innovation (discussed elsewhere) to focus on cinema as a `social machine'. This machine is more than the obvious machines of the cinema: film, lighting, sound recording systems, camera, make-up, costume, editing devices and projector. A blending of `narrativity, continuity, point of view, and identification' sees spectators become part of the very apparatus designed for them (Flitterman-Lewis 1990, 3, 12). The apparatus takes the spectatorial illusion of seeming to experience film as real life and makes it a combination of power and yet relaxation, of engagement coupled with leisure. Apparatus theory has basically operated at the level of speculation, apart from a brief flurry of writing on technological history and meaning that looked at those moments when the very technology of cinema was highlighted to audiences, or that retrieved cinema's prehistory via studies of panoramas, magic lanterns, dioramas and cineramas (de Lauretis and Heath 1985). This is because the principal interest of apparatus theorists never diverged from how subjectivity is constituted via the imaginary and the symbolic and their dance around the real. The interest in the specific technical apparatus of cinema is inextricably intertwined with an interest in marxist theorization of prevailing ideological norms plus psychoanalytic theorization of fantasies and complexes. The subject is presented with what looks like unveiled, transparent truth, whereby the camera substitutes for the eyes. Spectatorship is like being there, but with intriguingly radical transformations of time and perspective: the distant grows near, the past becomes
modern north american criticism and theory
156
present and points of view shift. The spectator's loss of mobility is compensated by this promiscuous look, which travels to the most dangerous or painful as well as exhilarating places,
and
with
equilibrium
impunity,
through
as
perfect
classical
knowledge.
narrative The
eye
ensures
the
transcends
ultimate
the
body
restoration to
roam
of
across
multiple viewpoints and scenes. Just as ideology is the means whereby social subjects have their conditions of existence represented back to them in everyday life, masquerading as an unvarnished, transcendent truth, so film is a key mechanism for encapsulating such cultural messages (Allen 1997, 19). Initial contributions and ripostes to apparatus theory came from feminist scholars for its failure to distinguish the different experiences and psychic mechanisms of men and women ±
that
male
viewers
were
principally
involved
in
fetishizing
women
on
screen
and
identifying with men on screen, which apparatus theorists had ignored. That engagement, by such writers as Constance Penley (1989), Sandy Flitterman-Lewis (1990) and Teresa de Lauretis
(de
Lauretis
and
Heath
1985),
enlivened
apparatus
theory
by
showing
the
centrality of difference to spectacle and the need for feminist film-making and feminist critical practice to account for and disrupt the association of the apparatus with the male gaze. A further critique of apparatus theory is that it has no mechanism for predicting or investigating
how
spectators
in
fact
process
information.
It
cannot
establish
whether
disavowal occurs or does not. In short, symptomatic theories have no means of being falsified,
because
they
know
the
answers
from
the
theoretical
baggage
that
poses
the
questions. Any interest in the concrete meaning-making of audiences, their ability to engage actively with texts and the apparatus via personal and collective cultural history and
systems
of
interpretation,
would
displace
the
assumption
that
the
unconscious
is
automatically and universally engaged by technologies of viewing. Such conflictual and manifold processes may see a proliferation of cross-identifications that go far beyond not just the limits of the body, but beyond the norms of psychic training and bodily awareness into entirely new territory (men identifying with women in melodramas, women identifying with male action heroes, Native Americans identifying with western pioneers ± in short, the theatre as a site of carnival as much as machine, where viewers transcend the dross of their ordinary social and psychological lives [Stam 1989, 224]). At the same time, this interest in the ability of audiences to make meaning has seen another, seemingly conflictual
paradigm
emerging
under
the
sign
of
Michel
Foucault
that
considers
the
contemporary moment as an electronic transformation of a long history of surveillance under modernity, from the panoptic prison designs of Jeremy Bentham to the all-seeing gaze and internalization of today's mall security and virtual home cinema (Denzin 1995). Between them, these two moves pull apart, replicate and make empirical many of the concerns that apparatus theory sought to synthesize. In short, symptomatic theory valuably problematized the exclusive concentration on representation, demonstrating that materiality and perception, too, had their place. This emphasis on ideology and the interplay of machine, text, culture and person guaranteed that film theory would not be caught in the formalism of much literary criticism. At the same time, its very mechanistic mode of inquiry, strangely redolent of the very metaphors it so disparaged, limited its utility as a paradigm for research. The second discourse of category (b) shifts to the empirical audience. There are three primary sites for defining this audience: the film industry, the state and criticism. In this sense, the audience is artificial, the creature of various agencies that then act upon their
film studies
157
creation. Many discussions of the audience are signs of anxiety: laments for civic culture in the US correlate an increase in violence and a decline in membership of parent-teacher associations with heavy film viewing ± as true today as it was when the Payne Fund Studies of
the
1930s
inaugurated
mass
social-science
panic
about
young
people,
driven
by
academic, religious and familial iconophobia and the sense that large groups of people were engaged with popular culture beyond the control of the state and ruling classes. Before even that, films were connected to gambling and horse racing in various forms of social criticism ± the arts of popular commerce forever threatening an orderly conduct of urban life ± or were lunged for as raw material by the emergent discipline of psychology, where obsessions with eyesight and the cinema gave professors something to do. At the same time, social reformers looked at the cinema as a potential forum for moral uplift; if film could drive the young to madness it might also provoke a sense of social responsibility (Austin 1989, 33±5). But unlike such institutions, the cultural audience is not so much a specifiable group
within
the social order as the principal site
of
that order. Audiences participate in the most
global (but local), communal (yet individual) and time-consuming practice of making meaning in the history of the world. The concept and the occasion of being an audience are textual links between society and person, at the same time as viewing involves solitary interpretation as well as collective behaviour. Production executives invoke the audience to
measure
success
and
claim
knowledge
of
what
people
want.
But
this
focus
on
the
audience is not theirs alone. Regulators do it to organize administration, psychologists to produce
proofs
education,
and
lobby-groups
violence
investigated
by
the
and state,
apathy
to
change
supposedly
psychology,
content,
hence
engendered
marxism,
by
the
link
the
screen
neoconservatism,
the
to
panics and
about
routinely
church,
liberal
feminism and others. The audience as consumer, student, felon, voter and idiot engages such groups. This is Harold Garfinkel's notion of the `cultural dope', a mythic figure `who produces the stable features of the society by acting in compliance with preestablished and legitimate alternatives of action that the common culture provides.' The `common sense rationalities
. . . of here and now
situations' used by people
are obscured by this
con-
descending categorization (1992, 68). When the audience is invoked as a category by the industry or its critics and regulators, it immediately becomes such a `dope'. Much nonHollywood film wants to turn such supposed dopes into a public of thinkers beyond the home ± civic-minded participants in a political and social system as well as an economy of purchasing. National cinemas in Europe, Asia, the Pacific, Latin America and Africa are expected to win viewers and train them in a way that complements the profit-driven sector. The entertainment function is secondary to providing programmes the commercial market would not deliver. Audiences are encouraged not just to watch and consume, but to act, to be better people.
Future developments Perhaps
the
most
historicization processes
must
significant
of context, now
be
innovation
in
recent
such that the analysis
supplemented
by
an
film
theory
has
of textual properties
account
of
occasionality
been
a
radical
and spectatorial that
details
the
conditions under which a text is made, circulated, received, interpreted and criticized. The life of any popular or praised film is a passage across space and time, a life remade again and again by institutions, discourses and practices of distribution and reception ± in short, all
modern north american criticism and theory
158
the shifts and shocks that characterize the existence of cultural commodities, their ongoing renewal as the temporary property of varied, productive workers and publics and their stasis as the abiding property of businesspeople. The crucial link between theories of the text and spectatorship ± one that abjures the idea of the dope ± may come from a specification of occasionality, that moment when a spectator
moves
from
being
`the
hypothetical
point
of
address
of
filmic
discourse'
to
membership in `a plural, social audience'; for that moment can produce surprises (Hansen 1994, 2). Jacqueline Bobo's analysis of black women viewers of
The Color Purple shows how
their process of watching the film, discussing it and reading the novel drew them back to Alice Walker's writing, with all three processes invoking their historical experience in ways quite unparalleled in dominant culture ± a far cry from the dismissal of the film by critics. These women `sifted through the incongruent parts of the film and reacted favorably to elements
with
which
they
could
identify'
(1995,
3).
Similarly,
gay
Asian-Caribbean-
Canadian video-maker Richard Fung (1991) talks about searching for Asian genitals in the much-demonized genre of pornography, an account not available in conventional denunciations of porn and its impact on minorities. Again, this type of historicized specificity is a valuable antidote to any purely textual or symptomatic reading. This is the abiding lesson of film theory: the medium's promiscuity points every day and in every way towards the social. It is three things, all at once: a unstaged pro-filmic event); a
of
recorder
of reality (the
manufacturer of reality (the staged and edited event); and part
reality (watching film as a social event on a Saturday night, or a protest event over
sexual, racial or religious stereotyping).
Toby Miller
Further reading and works cited Allen, R.
Projecting Illusion.
Andrew, J. D. Austin, B. A.
Cambridge, 1997.
Concepts in Film Theory. Immediate Seating.
Bennett, T. et al. `Preface', in Blumer, H. Bobo, J.
Oxford, 1984.
Belmont, CA, 1989.
Popular Television and Film,
Movies and Conduct.
eds T. Bennett et al. London, 1981.
New York, 1933.
Black Women as Cultural Readers.
New York, 1995.
Film Art.
New York, 1997.
Bordwell, D. and Thompson, K.
Braudy, L. and Cohen, M. `Preface', in
Film Theory and Criticism,
eds L. Braudy and M. Cohen. New
York, 1999. Carson, D. and Friedman, L. D. (eds) Ð et al. (eds)
Shared differences.
Multiple voices in Feminist Film Criticism.
Cook, P. and Bernink, M. (eds)
The Cinema Book.
de Lauretis, T. and Heath, S. (eds)
Urbana, IL, 1995.
Minneapolis, MN, 1994.
London, 1999.
The Cinematic Apparatus.
Denzin, N. `The Birth of the Cinematic, Surveillance Society',
London, 1985.
Current Perspectives in Social Theory,
15, 1995. Diawara, M. (ed.) Dyer, R.
Black American Cinema.
Only Entertainment.
Flitterman-Lewis, S.
New York, 1993.
London, 1992.
To Desire Differently.
Urbana, IL, 1990.
Fung, R. `Looking for my Penis: The Eroticized Asian in Gay Video Porn', in Object-Choices. Seattle, WA, 1991. Garfinkel, H. Hansen, M.
Studies in Ethnomethodology.
Babel and Babylon.
Cambridge, 1992.
Cambridge, MA, 1994.
How Do I look?, ed. Bad
feminist film studies and film theory Hill, J. and Church Gibson, P. (eds)
159
The Oxford Guide to Film Studies.
Hollows, J. and Jancovich, M. `Popular Film and Cultural Distinctions', in
Oxford, 1998.
Approaches to Popular Film,
eds J. Hollows and M. Jancovich. Manchester, 1995. Holmlund, C. and Fuchs, C. (eds) Lindsay, V.
The Future of an Illusion.
Powdermaker, H.
Shohat, E. and Stam, R.
Turner, G.
Worth, S.
ed. E. D. Pribram. London, 1988. New York, 1994.
Baltimore, MD, 1989.
Film and Theory.
Film as Social Practice.
Williams, R.
Boston, 1950.
Female Spectators,
Unthinking Eurocentrism.
Subversive Pleasures.
Ð and Miller, T. (eds)
Oxford, 1999.
Minneapolis, MN, 1989.
Hollywood: The Dream Factory.
Pribram, E. D. `Introduction', in
Minneapolis, MN, 1997.
New York, 1970.
A Companion to Film Theory.
Miller, T. and Stam, R. (eds) Penley, C.
Stam, R.
Between the Sheets, in the Streets.
The Art of the Moving Picture.
Oxford, 2000.
London, 1988.
The Politics of Modernism.
London, 1989.
Studying Visual Communication,
ed. L. Gross. Philadelphia, 1981.
Zollars, C. L. and Cantor, M. G. `The Sociology of Culture Producing Occupations',
on Occupations and Professions,
Current Research
8, 1993.
22. Feminist Film Studies and Film Theory
Strictly speaking, it is impossible to talk of a single feminist film theory, if by this title we assume
a
coherent,
unified,
intellectual,
academic
and
political
project.
Indeed,
that
feminist film theory, in whatever guise, is, and has always been, avowedly political in its agendas and interests, implies fracture and contest, heterogeneity, difference and diversity in the various interests and perspectives which may be considered to belong to the identity of
`feminist
film
theory'.
Thus,
this
essay,
in
recognizing
the
question
of
political
engagement as necessary to any feminist project concerned with the analysis of filmic modes of gendered identity construction and representation within various historical and cultural contexts, will
seek to
address various aspects
of feminist film
theory,
without
assuming any simple coherence or consonance in the guise of a unified area of study. Furthermore, while this essay addresses a range of feminist interventions in the area of film studies in the broader context of the North American university, this is not to say that feminist interventions in film study or theory are not restricted, on the one hand, to the university exclusively, or, on the other hand, to North America during the last three decades,
roughly
speaking.
Of
course,
no
discourse
evolves
in
isolation
from
other
discourses, and the history of feminist film theory in all its guises is marked by debate, appropriation, intervention and dissent from other theoretical, philosophically inflected, and political languages and processes. However reformulated, and however self-reformulating, so-called feminist film theory is, in part, an epistemo-political project engaging not only with feminist politics obviously, but also with semiotics, psychoanalysis, the discourses of race and gender, questions of culturally determined aesthetics, matters of mimesis and historically informed and mediated processes of identity construction, among a number of intellectual and social frameworks.
feminist film studies and film theory Hill, J. and Church Gibson, P. (eds)
159
The Oxford Guide to Film Studies.
Hollows, J. and Jancovich, M. `Popular Film and Cultural Distinctions', in
Oxford, 1998.
Approaches to Popular Film,
eds J. Hollows and M. Jancovich. Manchester, 1995. Holmlund, C. and Fuchs, C. (eds) Lindsay, V.
The Future of an Illusion.
Powdermaker, H.
Shohat, E. and Stam, R.
Turner, G.
Worth, S.
ed. E. D. Pribram. London, 1988. New York, 1994.
Baltimore, MD, 1989.
Film and Theory.
Film as Social Practice.
Williams, R.
Boston, 1950.
Female Spectators,
Unthinking Eurocentrism.
Subversive Pleasures.
Ð and Miller, T. (eds)
Oxford, 1999.
Minneapolis, MN, 1989.
Hollywood: The Dream Factory.
Pribram, E. D. `Introduction', in
Minneapolis, MN, 1997.
New York, 1970.
A Companion to Film Theory.
Miller, T. and Stam, R. (eds) Penley, C.
Stam, R.
Between the Sheets, in the Streets.
The Art of the Moving Picture.
Oxford, 2000.
London, 1988.
The Politics of Modernism.
London, 1989.
Studying Visual Communication,
ed. L. Gross. Philadelphia, 1981.
Zollars, C. L. and Cantor, M. G. `The Sociology of Culture Producing Occupations',
on Occupations and Professions,
Current Research
8, 1993.
22. Feminist Film Studies and Film Theory
Strictly speaking, it is impossible to talk of a single feminist film theory, if by this title we assume
a
coherent,
unified,
intellectual,
academic
and
political
project.
Indeed,
that
feminist film theory, in whatever guise, is, and has always been, avowedly political in its agendas and interests, implies fracture and contest, heterogeneity, difference and diversity in the various interests and perspectives which may be considered to belong to the identity of
`feminist
film
theory'.
Thus,
this
essay,
in
recognizing
the
question
of
political
engagement as necessary to any feminist project concerned with the analysis of filmic modes of gendered identity construction and representation within various historical and cultural contexts, will
seek to
address various aspects
of feminist film
theory,
without
assuming any simple coherence or consonance in the guise of a unified area of study. Furthermore, while this essay addresses a range of feminist interventions in the area of film studies in the broader context of the North American university, this is not to say that feminist interventions in film study or theory are not restricted, on the one hand, to the university exclusively, or, on the other hand, to North America during the last three decades,
roughly
speaking.
Of
course,
no
discourse
evolves
in
isolation
from
other
discourses, and the history of feminist film theory in all its guises is marked by debate, appropriation, intervention and dissent from other theoretical, philosophically inflected, and political languages and processes. However reformulated, and however self-reformulating, so-called feminist film theory is, in part, an epistemo-political project engaging not only with feminist politics obviously, but also with semiotics, psychoanalysis, the discourses of race and gender, questions of culturally determined aesthetics, matters of mimesis and historically informed and mediated processes of identity construction, among a number of intellectual and social frameworks.
modern north american criticism and theory
160
Moreover, this essay does not assume that, in addressing feminist film theory in the US, the subject of this essay has evolved without the influence of work pursued in film studies and related areas from outside the US. The work of French theorist Christian Metz and British critics Laura Mulvey and Jacqueline Rose on matters of the gaze and sexuality has been of crucial importance in the field. However, as far as is possible, while acknowledging the impossibility and undesirability of containing any discourse artificially according to national or continental boundaries, this article will speak to particular strategic moments in the study of film as though there were a specifically North American history.
Polemical beginnings While there is no absolutely justifiable beginning to which we can turn, it is provisionally possible to identify as one initiating moment in the history of feminist film theory the
Women and Film
establishment of the relatively short-lived journal
, the first issue of which
appeared in 1972, at the same time as the emergence of women's film festivals, notably those in New York and Edinburgh. The goal of images
of
women
as
these
represented
and
Women and Film
reflected
the
was to address filmic
oppressed,
stereotyped
and
marginalized position of women in society as brought into focus by the women's movement of
the
1960s.
intervention
Part
the,
in
of
the
polemic
retrospect,
of
perhaps
the
journal
somewhat
was
to
utopian
envision ideal
of
through
critical
transforming
the
representation of women in film so as to reflect more accurately the reality of female experience. Drawing in part on and responding to the work of, among others, Kate Millett and Germaine Greer, as well as Simone de Beauvoir,
Women and Film
thus may be seen in
retrospect as speaking to and exemplifying a sociological approach (as distinct from the perception of feminist film theory in Great Britain, specifically through articles published in
Screen
, as primarily theoretical). Such an approach (however reductive this identification
may be) sought, in the words of the editors, to take `up the struggle with women's image in film and women's roles in the film industry' (1972, 5) as part of a necessary corrective to the `political, psychological, social and economic oppression of women' (1972, 5). As Sue Thornham points out, the journal had a threefold goal: to transform film-making practice, to end ideological oppression, and to establish a `feminist critical aesthetics' (1999, 9±10). Sharon Smith's article, `The Image of Women in Film: Some Suggestions for Future Research', which was published in the first issue in 1972, typifies the political stance and goals of the journal. Smith aims to establish how the range of representations of women in film is limited and stereotyped in both limiting and negative ways which reproduce the experience of lived oppression, thereby perpetuating social marginalization. Film, Smith argues, needs to be transformed so as to represent a greater variety of women's roles and experiences. As Smith suggests, `[t]he role of a woman in film almost always revolves around her physical attraction and the mating games she plays with the male characters', while representations of men extend beyond the physical and biological, to the social and historical worlds (1999,
14±15).
Films thereby
`express the fantasies
and subconscious
needs of their (mostly male) creators' (15). For Smith there is a direct correlation between the representation of women and the access to positions of power in the film industry, including writing, editing and production (19). But, as Smith argues in conclusion, things can only change when cultural perceptions of women outside filmic representation have changed.
feminist film studies and film theory
161
A significant moment in the early years of feminist film study which built on the work of
Women and Film
and the kinds of arguments presented by Smith was the publication in
1974 of Molly Haskell's
From Reverence to Rape
. (Haskell's is, of course, not the only text of
significance, but due to lack of space we can only gesture towards other titles such as Marjorie Rosen's
Popcorn Venus
and Joan Mellon's
Women and Sexuality in the New Film
).
Part of Haskell's significance is in her recognition of film as not merely a mimetic mode of representation but as a complex textual process of encoding and registration around matters of gender and social roles. Haskell's position is similar to Smith's but is significantly more complex in its comprehension of representations of women. Identifying a range of positions and images for women in film across the history of film, Haskell locates what might be termed a typology of restrictive representation. However, where Haskell diverges from Smith
is
in
her
reading
of
film
for
the
heterogeneous and possibly subversive
possibilities
it
contains
for
the
encoding
modes of address. In support of this
of
thesis, she
turns to the `woman's film' of the 1930s and 1940s. While women may well be punished frequently in such films (
Dark Victory
with Bette Davis is a significant example) as a means
of reaching closure whereby women are, finally, recuperated within a male-centred vision, yet, for a while, Haskell argues, the woman dominates and controls the narrative, and it is this
temporary
control
which
may
be
read
as
implicitly,
if
not
explicitly,
because it presents an equally temporary strong, positive image of woman. ( one
such
cautionary
tale;
ambivalent
and
complex,
it
traces
Joan
subversive,
Mildred Pierce
Crawford's
rise
is
to
economic and social importance; she, however, ultimately is chastened and `punished' because her resistance to being subservient to men, it is implied, leads to her youngest daughter's death and her eldest daughter's arrest for murder.)
Theoretical interventions Feminist film theory, while developing in North America in the 1970s, did not remain unaffected by the theoretical explorations of critics in Britain such as Claire Johnston and Laura Mulvey. Indeed, by the late 1970s, the signs of a sea change in favour of a turn to theory are marked by the establishment, in 1976, of the journal
Camera Obscura
, and an
article by B. Ruby Rich, `The Crisis of Naming in Feminist Film Criticism', first published in the journal
Jump Cut
(1978), which took a retrospective glance at the history of feminist
film studies up to that point. Rich addresses the need to theorize as a way of providing a language of analysis where previously silence existed. Drawing on the silencing of the female voice in western culture, Rich argues for an understanding of the female spectator as an active creator of meaning, rather than being merely a passive consumer of stereotyped images. Claire Johnston (1973) argued, as Sue Thornham puts it, that `the figure of ``woman'' functions within film as a sign within patriarchal discourse' (Thornham 1999, 53), rather than being simply a reflection of some unmediated reality. Laura Mulvey, drawing on psychoanalysis, the film work of Christian Metz and Jean-Louis Baudry, and addressing adjunct concerns to those of Johnston, formulated the idea of cinema as an apparatus which situates the spectator (Thornham 1999, 53), aligning the spectator with the gaze of the camera. As Robert Stam summarizes Mulvey's position, `[v]isual pleasure on the cinema thus reproduced a structure of male
looking and female-to-be-looked-at-ness, a binary
structure which mirrored the asymmetrical power relations operative in the real social world' (2000, 174). More specifically, the spectator's pleasure is intrinsically interwoven
modern north american criticism and theory
162
with the gaze, in fetishized processes of voyeurism and scopophilia. At the same time, as Mulvey makes plain and echoing Metz, the spectator, whether male or female, is situated in a gendered position: the spectator is assumed to be male, the gaze that of a male spectator and the code `woman', constituted within the filmic text, an eroticized and fragmented, and therefore fetishized, figure. Such psychoanalytically inflected analysis is exemplified in North American feminist film studies by the work of Mary Ann Doane, Teresa de Lauretis and Kaja Silverman, whose publications punctuate film theory's interrogations in the 1980s. Doane's essay,
Caught
`
Rebecca
and
: The Inscription of Femininity as Absence' (1981) and a number of
other essays subsequently collected in
Femmes Fatales
(1991) move beyond Mulvey in their
analysis of the role and construction of the female spectator. Through examination of the `woman's film', `weepies' and the figure of the `femme fatale', Doane questions psychic processes of identification and alignment between the female spectator and the images of women, whereby the female spectator comes to terms with herself as object of desire. At the same time, however, `the ``woman's film'' centres both our narrative identification and its structures of looking on a female protagonist, so that its narratives claim, at least, to place female
subjectivity,
desire
and
agency
at
their
centre'
(Thornham
1999,
55).
Such
processes come at a cost for the female spectator, however, the cost being that, for being momentarily privileged, situated as the agent rather than the object of desire, such female characters are finally silenced, constituted through narrative as ultimately silent or absent. The
essays
signifier.
Femmes Fatales
of
technologies In
of
cinema
the
figure
dissimulation,
are of
masquerade
extend
employed
`femme and
such so
as
fatale',
duplicity.
analysis to
to
reinforce
woman Female
is
examine the
shown
sexuality
how
the
instability
to is
be
forms
of
constituted
perceived
as
and
`woman'
as
through
threatening
because both emphasized and fetishized (through close-up, lighting, focus and so on), and maintained as a site which troubles epistemological assumptions concerning what can and cannot be known (Doane 1991, 1). Doane thus presents a reading of a variety of films where the woman is unveiled, psychically, the threat explored through the mechanics of the gaze. Silverman and de Lauretis both explore the process of cinematic and psychic identification, while complicating Mulvey's comprehension of the gaze as being always aligned with masculinity.
In
different
ways,
both
examine
how
the
structures
of
identification
can
involve a double, and sometimes paradoxical, engagement on the part of female spectators, whereby they identify with both the `positions of both desired object and desiring subject' (Thornham 1999, 56). Identification for de Lauretis, the engagement of female subjectivity in narrative movement, is inextricably involved with the pleasures of narrative. However, this
is
never
neutral,
for
as
de
Lauretis
argues,
narratives
are
always
in
some
manner
Oedipal. Thus, `[t]he cinematic apparatus, in the totality of its operations and effects, produces
not
merely
images
but
imaging.
It
binds
affect
and
meaning
to
images
by
establishing terms of identification, orienting the movement of desire, and positioning the spectator in relation to them' (de Lauretis 1999, 85). As de Lauretis comments, `[i]f governed by an Oedipal logic, it is because it is situated within the system of exchange . . . where
woman functions
as both
a sign (representation) and
a
value
(object) for that
exchange' (1999, 88). Silverman comprehends cinema as figuring a psychic plenitude, its range of signifiers seducing the viewer with the paradoxically impossible possibility of psychic completion, from which the subject has been separated since infancy. For Silverman, cinema therefore
feminist film studies and film theory
163
re-enacts the primary displacement identified by Freud, by which the human subject comes to be constituted through separation and lack. Woman in film, in Silverman's reading, stands in as both mirror and screen of male lack (Thornham 1999, 56), in a complex reconfiguration of the signs of absence belonging to a Freudian lexical triangulation of castration, disavowal and fetishism (Silverman 1988, 6ff.). `Always on display', woman, Silverman concludes, has so little resistance to the male gaze, `that she often seems no more than an extension of it' (Silverman 1988, 32).
Spectatorship Clearly, the discussion opened between feminism and psychoanalysis in the field of film theory opens up the problematic of the gaze as both assumed locus in the constitution of subjectivity and in its practical-ideological positioning of the female spectator. As psychoanalytic work reveals, the spectator is not simply the person sitting in the cinema but is also the imagined subject constituted by a range of textual effects, not confined to diegesis but extending to framing, editing, lighting, sound and so on. The technology of cinematic representation and projection, in extending its powers of imaginary and phantasmatic constitution beyond the immediate matters of narrative and representation, has arguably greater control over subjectification for its `invisibility' (most members of film audiences do not, arguably, distance themselves from the narrative so as to observe the processes by which those narratives create their effects ± at least, not during a screening). However, it can be argued that the psychoanalytic focus on psychic positioning of the subject and the objectification of woman leaves the female spectator with only a passive role, wherein, constituted always as object of desire and as lack or absence, there is little or no position which runs counter to the structures that psychoanalytically inflected analysis imposes as much as it interprets. Moreover, as B. Ruby Rich appositely summarizes, the political problematic inherent in the psychoanalytic project, inasmuch as `sexuality and psychoanalysis are considered ahistorical, eternal, outside ideology', so analytical procedures addressing sexuality and situated by psychoanalytic reading reproduce in theory the traditional positioning of women (Citron et al. 1999, 117). The feminist focus on the female spectator seeks to redress the balance, by analysing female figures which trouble, albeit
momentarily,
the
effects
of
containment
and
closure
effected
by
mainstream
Hollywood or narrative cinema. Reading those subversive or excessive representations and their effects against the ideological grain extends the possibility of power and resistance for the female spectator. It has thus been a necessary project of feminist film analysis to articulate difference, dissonance and resistance within the mainstream, rather than simply reading displacement and the maintenance of passivity or in seeking to create a purely oppositional filmic discourse. A striking example of analysis which situates the dissident within mainstream cinema with regard to the female spectator is that of Mary Ann Doane, already mentioned, in
Femmes Fatales
. In the first chapter, `Film and the Masquerade: Theorizing the Female
Spectator' (Doane 1991, 17±32; first published in
Screen
in 1982), Doane develops her
Á re's essay arguments concerning a different spectatorship through a reading of Joan Rivie `Womanliness as a Masquerade', first published in
The International Journal of Psychoanalysis
(1929). Doane therefore draws on psychoanalytic theory, and yet provides a more active, participatory role for the female spectator. Drawing on Riviere's argument that `womanliness'
is
not
essential
but
a
mask
or
role
to
be
performed,
Doane
suggests
that
the
modern north american criticism and theory
164
masquerade, `in flaunting femininity, holds it at a distance. Womanliness is a mask which can be worn or removed. The masquerade's resistance to patriarchal positioning would therefore lie in its denial of the production of femininity . . . Masquerade . . . involves a realignment of femininity' (1991, 25±6). There is thus a destabilization in the truth of the image,
which
is
resistant
to
patriarchal
assumptions
concerning
woman's
`truth',
and
which, therefore, has an affirmative potential for dissident identification on the part of the female spectator. Such identification on the part of the female spectator with the fact that femininity is performed (and can thus be changed, denied, abandoned, in favour of other performative masks or affects), leads Doane to the conclusion that `[f]emininity is produced very precisely as a position within a network of power relations . . . the elaboration of a theory of female spectatorship is indicative of the crucial necessity of understanding that position in order to dislocate it' (1991, 32).
Matters of difference We have seen above that psychoanalytic feminist film critique is available to criticism in that
its
concerns
reproduce
the
implicitly
patriarchal
ideologies
of
universalism
and
ahistoricism. In addition, there is a sense in which the woman, whether as spectator or film image, has been analysed or otherwise addressed without due attention to matters of class. While feminist film studies `began' in the United States with specifically sociological and ideological critiques of patriarchal and capitalist structures of aesthetic representation in mind, the transformation of film analysis by the intervention of theory (specifically psychoanalysis) can be read, in retrospect, as a retreat from the political, for all its apparent radicality. While the work of the critics already cited is undeniably of great significance and marks, moreover, a series of urgent interventions, what the various debates between film theorists have revealed are a number of limits to aspects of the theoretically driven project. The binarisms `male-active/female-passive' on which certain theoretical assumptions in feminist film studies rest (Mulvey's essay has been extensively criticized for this static model) do not account for matters of class, race and sexual orientation. In recent years, critics such as Jane Gaines have drawn attention to the blindness in film theory to the possible theorization of a lesbian gaze or to the `elision of the specificity of black women's positioning', to which Lola Young has drawn our attention. Young
has
continent',
as
remarked, follows:
in
the
`There
context
has
been
of
Freud's
white
metaphor
feminist
of
woman
overinvestment
as
in
`the
the
dark
gender
component of the ``dark continent'', which has resulted in the virtual elimination of the racial and colonial implications. Thus this most racialized of sexual metaphors has become synonymous with the concerns of white women' (1996, 177). Jane Gaines has also spoken to the inability of a `high-theoretical' discourse to speak to the historical and cultural specificities
of
race
experience,
while
also
considering
the
relative
silence
on
lesbian
spectatorship. In an essay from 1988, `White Privilege and Looking Relations: Race and Gender in Feminist Film Theory', first published in
Screen
, Gaines begins by suggesting that
`[p]ositing a lesbian spectator would significantly change the trajectory of the gaze' (in Thornham 1999, 293). She continues, `[i]t might even lead us to see how the eroticised star body might be not just the object, but what I would term the visual objective of another female gaze within the film's diegesis ± a gaze with which the viewer might identify' (293). As an example of such a situation for the gaze, Gaines locates the reciprocal, subversive gaze between Marilyn Monroe and Jane Russell in
Gentlemen Prefer Blondes
, which, as
feminist film studies and film theory Gaines
goes
on
to
suggest,
can
be
read
as
165
excluding
both
the
straight
and
the
male
perspective and location, and effectively erasing the `male/female opposition' (294). On
the
question
of
race,
Gaines
points
out
that
the
`dominant
feminist
paradigm
actually encourages us not to think in terms of any oppression other than male dominance and female subordination'; however, `it is clear that Afro-American women have historically formulated identity and political allegiance in terms of race rather than gender or class . . . Even more difficult for feminist theory to digest is black female identification with the black male. On this point, black feminists diverge from white feminists, in repeatedly reminding us that they do not necessarily see the black male as patriarchal antagonist, but feel instead that their racial oppression is ``shared'' with men' (294±5). Thus, what Gaines brings
into
category,
focus
is
however
the
urgent
much
that
necessity
of
not
categorization
sealing
may
off
appear
the to
subject be
as
based
an
on
idealized questions
concerning gender, from the subject's historicity and her real historical experience. A theorization of position which forgets to account for cultural and historical specificity ultimately undoes its political potential in being structured from its initiating moments around unread assumptions which amount to a retreat from political engagement. bell hooks addresses the question of black female spectators in her
Representation
Black Looks: Race and
(1992). Importantly, in analysing the power of the look, she argues, from a
reading of Frantz Fanon, that `[s]paces of agency exist for black people, wherein we can both interrogate the gaze of the Other but also look back, and at one another, naming what we see'. She continues, `[t]he ``gaze'' has been and is the site of resistance for colonized black people globally. Subordinates in relations of power learn experientially that there is a critical gaze, one that ``looks'' to document, one that is oppositional . . . one learns to look a certain way in order to resist' (1992, 116). Criticizing the psychoanalytic paradigm as hegemonic within film studies, hooks resituates the question of resistance in specifically political ways, drawing on models of analysis taken from cultural studies in presenting an argument that the gaze is materially constructed. The work of bell hooks, Jane Gaines and Lola Young has been of vital significance in opening the field of feminist film theory to itself, in order to articulate the various blind spots which have historically developed as a result of, on the one hand, ahistorical and formalist theorization, and, on the other, the institutionalization of radical theorization and the often all too inevitable concomitant effect of depoliticization. Other critics, such as Tania Modleski and Judith Butler, have also sought to redress the balance in addressing matters of race and gender in filmic representation. Modleski (1991) has turned to the psychoanalytic/deconstructive work of Homi Bhabha in the field of postcolonial studies, particularly resistances
his
powerful
to racial and
deconstruction, has also
articulation
of
the
functions
cultural stereotyping. sought to
Butler's
of
mimicry
own
destabilize heterosexist
work
and
ambivalence
as
(1991), informed by
assumptions
concerning
the
authenticity and essentialist truth of gender, addressing gender and sexual identity in terms of impersonation and performativity, as a series of supplements without origin. This is not, of course, to suggest that feminist film theory has arrived at a point where the political problematic has been effectively and comprehensively countered, or that feminist film
theories
methodology,
have
reached
analysis
or
some
concern.
cosy
or
(Nor,
facile
indeed,
consensus should
with
they
regard
to
necessarily,
matters
for
to
do
of so
would be, finally, to announce that film theory's time had come and that there were no more political questions to be asked, thereby negating the very premise on which the very idea of feminist film analysis arose.) As Barbara Christian has remarked, with regard to the
modern north american criticism and theory
166
question of addressing race in relation to gender: `if defined as black, her woman nature was often denied; if defined as woman, her blackness was often ignored; if defined as working class, her gender and race were muted' (cit. in Young-Bruehl 1996, 514). Yet we should not rush, as some have done, to say that so-called feminist film theories, have lost impetus or direction because of what might appear to be `internal' debates. What remains vital is the political
condition
theoretical
or
of
feminist
academic
film
concerns.
analysis,
As
Sue
as
a
politics
Thornham
has
irreducible so
cogently
to
institutional
summarized
the
position, `[i]f that politics has had more recently to recognise divisions and fragmentations in subjectivity . . . and histories and experiences other than those of the white woman under western patriarchy, such recognitions of the differences between women may be seen to signal the further development of and not, as some have suggested, a loss of direction in feminist film theory'.
Julian Wolfreys
Further reading and works cited Butler, J.
Bodies that Matter: On the Discursive Limits of `Sex' . London, 1993.
Citron, M. et al. `Women and Film', in de Lauretis, T.
Ð. `Oedipus Interruptus', in Doane, M. A. Ð.
Feminist Film Theory, ed. S. Thornham. Edinburgh 1999.
Alice Doesn't. Basingstoke, 1984. Feminist Film Theory, ed. S. Thornham. Edinburgh 1996.
The Desire to Desire. Basingstoke, 1987.
Femmes Fatales New York, 1991.
Erens, P. (ed.)
Issues in Feminist Film Criticism. Bloomington, IN, 1990.
Gaines, J. `White Privilege and Looking Relations: Race and Gender in Feminist Film Theory', in
Feminist Film Theory, ed. S. Thornham. Edinburgh, 1999. Haskell, M.
From Reverence to Rape. Chicago, 1974.
Black Looks. London, 1992.
hooks, b.
Johnston, C. `Women's Cinema as Counter-Cinema', in
Notes on Women's Cinema, ed. C. Johnston.
London, 1973. Kaplan, E. A.
Modleski, T. Ð.
Women and Film. New York, 1983.
Woman at the Keyhole. Bloomington, IN, 1990.
Mayne, J.
The Woman who Knew Too Much. New York, 1988.
Feminism without Women: Culture and Criticism in a `Postfeminist' Age . London, 1991.
Mulvey, L. `Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema', Pietropaolo, L. and Testafarri, A. (eds)
Screen, 16, 3, 1975.
Feminisms in the Cinema. Bloomington, IN, 1995.
Rich, B. R. `The Crisis of Naming in Feminist Film Criticism', Silverman, K. Ð.
Jump Cut, 19, 1978.
The Acoustic Mirror. Bloomington, IN, 1988.
The Threshold of the Visible World. New York, 1996.
Smith, B. `Toward a Black Feminist Criticism', in
The New Feminist Criticism, ed. E. Showalter.
London, 1986. Smith, S. `The Image of Women in Film', in
Feminist Film Theory, ed. S. Thornham. Edinburgh,
1999. Stam, R.
Film Theory. Oxford, 2000.
Thornham, S. (ed.)
Feminist Film Theory. Edinburgh, 1999.
Women and Film, Editorial, 1, 1972. Young, L.
Fear of the Dark. London, 1996.
Young-Bruehl, E.
The Anatomy of Prejudices. Cambridge, MA, 1996.
23. Ethical Criticism
The recent incarnation of ethical criticism in literary studies functions both as a response to the alleged nihilism of poststructuralist theoretical concerns such as deconstruction and postmodernism, as well as to the return to humanistic interpretation. By the mid-1980s, deconstructionist,
marxist
and
postmodernist
methodologies
appeared
to
reach
their
influential apex, prompting a critical backlash from a variety of quarters. As David Parker remarks: `The irresistible expansive moment of post-structuralism in the 1970s and early 1980s has suppressed some discursive possibilities which, constituted as we partly are by various religious and humanistic traditions, we stand in abiding need of, and are poorer without. The possibilities I mean are evaluative, and especially ethical ones' (1994, 3±4). With the evolution of a number of new, socially challenging and culturally relevant modes of critical thought ± including, for example, gender studies, historical criticism and other forms of cultural criticism ± poststructuralist schools of interpretation, deconstruction in particular, increasingly endured charges of `anti-humanism' and the development of `antitheory'
movements
that
persist
in
the
present.
The
emergence
of
these
movements
accounts for the revival of ethical criticism, an interpretive paradigm that explores the nature of ethical issues and their considerable roles in the creation and interpretation of literary works. The
recent
apotheosis
of
ethical
criticism
finds
its
origins
in
the
North
American
academy ± and particularly as a result of the institutionalization of English studies and literary theory in the United States. In European circles, ethical criticism has taken on entirely different theoretical dimensions. While some British critics ± Christopher Ricks, for example ± have sporadically challenged the place of theory in literary studies, many European
scholars opt to examine ethical
issues
in terms of their
philosophical possi-
bilities rather than through the interpretive lens of cultural studies. The current North American re-evaluation of poststructuralism's theoretical hegemony finds its roots in the initial critical responses that often accompanied the promulgation of the trend's various sub-movements. This is, of course, not at all unusual, for new critical paradigms inevitably blossom amid a fury of debate. Jean-Franc Ë ois Lyotard's widely acknowledged postmodernist manifesto almost
The Postmodern Condition
concomitantly
(1979), a
volume
with
the
(1979), for example, enjoyed its publication
appearance
that problematizes
`the
of
myth
Gerald
Literature against Itself
Graff's
of the postmodern
breakthrough'
as a
literary and critical movement destined to implode because of postmodernism's dependence
upon
its
own
extreme
elements
of
scepticism,
alienation
and
self-parody.
As
a
historical response to modernist conceptions of art as a panacea for the chaos of the early twentieth century, postmodernism posits that art lacks the required faculties of consolation
to
assuage
the
human
condition
in
the
post-industrial
world.
`Postmodernism
modern north american criticism and theory
168
signifies that the nightmare of history, as modernist aesthetic and philosophical traditions have defined history, has overtaken modernism itself', Graff writes. `If history lacks value, pattern,
and
rationally
intelligible
meaning',
he
continues,
`then
no
exertions
of
the
shaping, ordering imagination can be anything but a refuge from truth' (1979, 32, 55). Rather than asserting its utter impossibility in the postmodern world, Graff's search for truth in literature and criticism underscores one of the principal arguments emanating from the practitioners of ethical criticism: that literature and its interpretation
do
offer
readers the possibilities for locating truth and defining value despite the persistence of a contemporary landscape that seems to rest upon a sceptical and chaotic social foundation. `Postmodern literature', Graff remarks, `poses in an especially acute fashion the critical problem raised by all experimental art: does this art represent a criticism of the distorted aspects
of
modern
postmodernist
life
literature
or
a
mere
evokes
addition
likewise
to
it?'
(1979,
subverts
the
normative
55).
The
roles
criticism
of
meaning
that and
value in literary interpretation. In
Truth and the Ethics of Criticism
, Christopher Norris examines the ways in which
literary theory has redefined itself in a contemporary hermeneutic circle concerned with epistemological
rigour
and
cultural
critique.
Norris
argues
that
literary
theorists
can
implement a series of correctives that may yet infuse the theoretical project with much needed doses of pragmatism and social relevance. Norris characterizes this paradigmatic shift as `the retreat from high theory', as an era in which `a great deal depends on where one happens to be in terms of the wider socio-political culture and the local opportunities for linking theory and practice in a meaningful way' (1994, 1, 5). By providing readers with the means to establish vital interconnections between texts and the divergent, heterogeneous community in which we live, ethical criticism attempts to empower the theoretical project with the capacity to produce socially and culturally relevant critiques. This way of reading, Norris
writes,
allows
critics
to
alternative where the difference the
common
differences ethics
of
ground,
between
criticism
the
look
within
measure
to
`the
prospect
of
a
better,
more
enlightened
each and every subject is envisaged as providing
of
shared
humanity,
whereby
to
transcend
such
ethnic and national ties' (1994, 94). In this way, Norris posits an that
self-consciously
assesses
the
theoretical
presuppositions
under-
girding the moral character of contemporary hermeneutics. In one of the more forceful ethical critiques of literary theory, Tobin Siebers identifies the crisis that confronts modern criticism ± an interpretive dilemma that `derives in part from an ethical reaction to the perceived violence of the critical act' (1988, 15). He further argues that an ethical approach to literary study requires critics to engage their subjects selfconsciously with sustained attention to the potential consequences of their interpretive choices: `The ethics of criticism involves critics in the process of making decisions and of studying how these choices affect the lives of fellow critics, writers, students, and readers as well as our ways of defining literature and human nature.' Siebers ascribes the aforementioned
crisis
practice.
in
criticism
`Modern
to
literature
a
linguistic
has
its
own
paradox cast
of
that
inevitably
characters',
he
problematizes writes.
`It
critical
speaks
in
a
discourse largely concerned with issues of language, but behind its definitions of language lie ideals of human character' (1988, 10). Siebers argues that acknowledging the place of ethics in critical theory affords practitioners of the discipline the autonomy to offer relevant conclusions
about
literary
texts
and
their
considerable
social
and
ideological
import.
`Literary criticism cannot endure without the freedom to make judgements', Siebers notes, `and modern theory urgently needs to regain the capacity to decide' (1988, 41). The ability
ethical criticism to
render
sound,
169
moral
interpretations,
then,
provides
the
foundation
for
an
ethical
criticism that fully engages the remarkably human nature of literary study. Such a reading methodology allows for the self-conscious reassessment of our evaluative procedures and their
potential
for
the
production
of
meaningful
critiques.
As
Siebers
concludes:
`To
criticize ethically brings the critic into a special field of action: the field of human conduct and belief concerning the human' (1988, 1).
The Company We Keep (1988) and Martha C.
Volumes such as Wayne C. Booth's Nussbaum's
Love's
Knowledge
(1990)
demonstrate
the
interpretive
power
of
ethical
criticism, as well as the value of its critical machinery to scholarly investigations regarding the
nature
of
motivations of
literary satire ±
character, the
the
narrative
cultural
landscapes
manoeuvres that
of
Booth
fiction,
and
ascribes to
the
ethical
our desire to
`make and remake ourselves' (1988, 14). Critics such as Booth and Nussbaum avoid the textual violence of censorship to advocate instead a form of criticism that explores the moral sensibilities that inform works of art. In
Love's Knowledge, Nussbaum illustrates the
nature of ethical criticism's recent emergence as a viable interpretive paradigm: `Questions about justice, about well-being and social distribution, about moral realism and relativism, about the nature of rationality, about the concept of the person, about the emotions and desires, about the role of luck in human life ± all these and others are debated from many sides with considerable excitement and even urgency', she writes (1990, 169±70). In its desire to examine the ethical nature of these artistic works, ethical criticism seeks to create a meaningful bond between the life of the narrative and the life of the reader. Although ethical criticism hardly functions as a conventional interpretive paradigm in the tradition of marxist, Lacanian or gender textual readings, it serves effectively nevertheless as a selfreflexive means for critics to explain the contradictory emotions and problematic moral stances that often mask complex and fully realized literary characters. Ethical criticism provides its
practitioners, moreover, with the capacity to posit socially relevant inter-
pretations by celebrating the Aristotelian qualities of living well and flourishing. In this way, ethical criticism evokes the particularly `human character' of literature that Siebers extols the merits of in In
The Ethics of Criticism.
The Reader, the Text, the Poem (1978), Louise M. Rosenblatt supplies ethical critics
with an interpretational matrix for explaining the motives of readers and their `transactions' with literary texts. Rosenblatt identifies two different types of reading strategies ± aesthetic reading, in which the reader devotes particular attention to what occurs
during
the actual reading event, and non-aesthetic reading, a reading strategy in which the reader focuses attention upon the traces of knowledge and data that will remain
after the event.
Rosenblatt designates the latter strategy as a kind of `efferent' reading in which readers primarily interest themselves in what will be derived materially from the experience (1978, 23±5). Efferent readers reflect upon the verbal symbols in literature, `what the symbols designate, what they may be contributing to the end result that [the reader] seeks ± the information, the concepts, the guides to action, that will be left with [the reader] when the reading is over' (1978, 27). Booth argues that ethical criticism functions as a methodology for distinguishing the `efferent freight' that results from this reading strategy (1983, 14). Rosenblatt describes the act of reading itself ± whether aesthetic or non-aesthetic ± as a transaction that derives from the peculiar array of experiences that define the reader's persona: `Each reader brings to the transaction not only a specific past life and literary history, not only a repertory of internalised ``codes'', but also a very active present, with all its
preoccupations,
anxieties,
questions,
and
aspirations',
she
writes
(1978,
144).
This
modern north american criticism and theory
170
recognition of the complexity of the reading transaction underscores the deep interconnections
between
readers
and
the
human
communities
in
which
they
live
and
seek
personal fulfilment. Rosenblatt argues that the transaction of reading involves `laying bare the assumptions about human beings and society and the hierarchy of values that govern the world derived from the text' (1978, 149±50), a conclusion regarding the ethical value of art in the human community that John Gardner illuminates in his influential volume, (1978).
He
knowledge
argues from
its
that
literary
pages,
the
art
should
possibility
offer
±
readers
rather
than
the the
On Moral Fiction
opportunity didactic
for
receiving
requirement
±
of
emerging from a reading experience with a heightened sense of communal awareness. Gardner writes:
We recognize art by its careful, thoroughly honest search for and analysis of values. It is not didactic because, instead of teaching by authority and force, it explores, open-mindedly, to learn what it should teach. It clarifies, like an experiment in a chemistry lab, and confirms. As a chemist's experiment tests the laws of nature and dramatically reveals the truth or falsity of scientific hypotheses, moral art tests values and rouses trustworthy feelings about the better and the worse in human action. (1978, 19)
The role of the ethical critic, then, involves the articulation of a given text's ability to convey
notions
of
knowledge
and
universal
good
to
its
readers,
whether
through
the
auspices of allegory, satire, morality plays, haiku or any other fictive means of representation. In Gardner's estimation, ethical critics can only accomplish this end through the fomentation of understanding in their readership. `Knowledge may or may not lead to belief',
he
writes.
But
`understanding
always
does,
since
to
believe
one
understands
a
complex situation is to form at least a tentative theory of how one ought to behave in it' (1978, 139). Thus, ethical criticism examines the ways in which literary characters respond to the divergent forces they encounter in the fictional landscapes that they occupy. Their human
behaviours
and
conclusion. As Gardner notes in
actions
provide
On Moral Fiction
the
interpretive
basis
for
moral
reflection
and
, however, practitioners of ethical criticism must
invariably confront the spectre of censorship, a dangerous commodity rooted in the human tendency to instruct without regard for the plurality of competing value systems at work in both
the
theoretical
`Didacticism',
he
realm
cautions,
of
literary
`inevitably
criticism
and
simplifies
the
morality
larger and
world thus
of
humankind.
misses
it'
(1978,
137). Similarly, critics must avoid the perils of attempting to establish models of behaviour and codified moral standards of acceptability, for such practices inevitably lead to the textual injustice of censorship. Gardner writes: `I would not claim that even the worst bad art should be outlawed, since morality by compulsion is a fool's morality' (1978, 106). Despite his own admonitions to the contrary in
On Moral Fiction
± and because of the
dearth of genuine scholarly wisdom inherent in his study of moral criticism ± Gardner himself nevertheless trolls dangerously close to the shores of censorship when he speaks of carrying out `art's proper work': art `destroys only evil', he argues. `If art destroys good, mistaking it for evil, then that art is false, an error; it requires denunciation' (1978, 15). Such a proposition inevitably leads to the establishment of singular standards of good and evil in the heterogeneous, pluralistic spheres of criticism and human reality. Can
ethical
critics, in good conscience, operate from superior positions of moral privilege and arrogant didacticism?
ethical criticism
171
Understanding the place of moral philosophy in the latest incarnation of ethical criticism offers
a
means
Philosophy
for
exploring
this
dilemma.
Bernard
Williams's
Ethics and the Limits of
(1985), for instance, discusses the ways in which the tenets of moral philosophy
provide a context for us `to recreate ethical life' in the sceptical world of contemporary western culture (1985, vii). In addition to examining the Johnsonian question of how to live, Williams devotes particular attention to assessing the role of the ethical critic. `Given people who are in some general sense committed to thinking in ethical terms, how should they think?' he asks. `Are their ethical thoughts sound?' (1985, 71). The issue of a valid ethical criticism itself poses a spurious philosophical quandary, for it requires the critic to define standards of moral correctness, or, as Williams concludes, to dispense with establishing them altogether. `An ethical theory is a theoretical account of what ethical thought and practice are', he writes, which `either implies a general test for the correctness of basic ethical beliefs and principles or else implies that there cannot be such a test' (1985, 72). Williams suggests that critics can only surmount this dilemma by interpreting a given set of events from an empathetic
position,
and,
moreover,
through
their
`ability
to
arrive
at
shared
ethical
judgements' (1985, 97). In this way, ethical critics and moral philosophers alike engage in a form of ethical practice that allows for the reflexive process of critical contemplation, a self-conscious methodology for critically articulating the pluralistic nuances of that which constitutes a shared sense of moral correctness. In addition to questioning the nature of our communal sense of ethical propriety, moral philosophers such as Williams attempt to account for the motives of those critics who dare to engage in the interpretation of human values. Such critics must assume the risks ± whether or not they employ an equitable and pluralistic system of evaluation ± of impinging upon the current
direction
of
the
philosophical
conversation
regarding
human
ethics.
`Critical
reflection should seek for as much shared understanding as it can find on any issue, and use any ethical material that, in the context of the reflective discussion, makes some sense and commands some loyalty', Williams notes, although `the only serious enterprise is living, and we have to live after the reflection' (1985, 117). For this reason, the principles of moral philosophy
charge
ethical
critics
with
the
maintenance
of
a
sense
of
free
intellectual
discourse, in addition to obliging them to render sound moral conclusions. `We should not try to seal determinate values into future society', he warns, for `to try to transmit free inquiry and the reflective consciousness is to transmit something more than nothing, and something that demands some forms of life more rather than others' (1985, 173). Ethical criticism endeavours, as a matter of course, to communicate the meaning of this `something' and its greater social relevance through the interpretation of literary works. In
The Company We Keep
, Booth offers an expansive account of ethical criticism and its
potential for literary study, while also attempting to allay any fears that his heuristic rests upon dogmatic foundations. Booth affords particular attention to the range of hermeneutic functions that ethical criticism performs, as well as to its unfortunate lack of clarity as an interpretive paradigm:
 . It is practised everywhere, often We can no longer pretend that ethical criticism is passe surreptitiously, often guiltily, and often badly, partly because it is the most difficult of all critical modes, but partly because we have so little serious talk about why it is important, what purposes it serves, and how it might be done well. (1988, 19)
Booth
notes
didactic
in
that
ethical
nature.
criticism's
Instead,
Booth
opponents argues,
often
`ethical
misread
criticism
the
paradigm's
attempts
to
intent
describe
as
the
modern north american criticism and theory
172
encounters of a storyteller's ethos with that of the reader or listener. Ethical critics need not begin with the intent to evaluate, but their descriptions will always entail appraisals of the value of what is being described.' In this way, Booth supports a reflexive interpretational methodology, an ethical criticism that allows for the recognition of the interconnections between the reading experience and the life of the reader. Ethical criticism acknowledges, moreover, the powerful factors of language and ideology in its textual assessments. `There are no neutral ethical terms', Booth writes, `and a fully responsible ethical criticism will make explicit those appraisals that are implicit whenever a reader or listener reports on stories about human beings in action' (1988, 8±9). Booth criticism
defines ±
as
these
acts
of
instances
of
`coduction',
appraisal
referential
±
these
moments
practical in
applications
which
critics
of
ethical
compare
their
reading experiences with the conclusions of others. Like Siebers, who argues that `the heart of ethics is the desire for community' (1988, 202), Booth notes that the act of `judgement requires a community' of trustworthy friends and colleagues (1988, 72). Coduction, in Booth's schema, valorizes the reflexive relationship that develops between texts and their readers, as well as the equally reflexive manner in which texts postulate meaning. `The question of whether value is in the poem or in the reader is radically and permanently ambiguous, requiring two answers', Booth writes. `Of course the value is not in there,
actually, until it is actualized, by the reader. But of course it could not be actualized if it were not
in potential
there,
,
in
the
poem'
(1988,
89).
Booth
also
notes
ethical
criticism's
pluralistic imperatives and their value to the understanding and operation of ideological paradigms. In his analysis of feminist criticism, for example, Booth discusses the ways in which `the feminist challenge' derives from fundamental ethical dilemmas inherent in the construction of literary texts: `Every literary work implies either that women can enter its imaginative world as equals or that they cannot ± that instead they must, in reading, decide whether or not to enter a world in which men are a privileged center' (1988, 387). As Booth reveals, feminist criticism itself functions as a type of ethical criticism, a means of literary
interpretation that seeks
to repair an abiding social injustice
that, through
its
misogyny, problematizes the lives of the larger community of readers. In
The Ethics of Reading
, J. Hillis Miller posits an `ethics of reading' that seeks to explain
the reflexive process that occurs between the text and the reader, in addition to offering testimony Miller
to
the
argues
ethical
that
the
possibilities
act
of
reading
of
poststructuralism,
ethically
transpires
particularly
when
`an
deconstruction.
author
turns
back
on himself, so to speak, turns back on a text he or she has written, re-reads it' (1987, 15). For Miller, such a process allows readers ± the
de facto
authors of the texts that they appraise
± to offer relevant conclusions about the moral properties of literary works and the ethical sensibilities
of
otherwise. In
the
readers'
theoretical
Versions of Pygmalion
the `ethics of narration'
and
the
premises,
whether
they
be
deconstructive
or
(1990), Miller proffers a similar argument regarding
shifting,
performative aspects
of reading
experiences.
Miller derives the title of his volume from the story of Pygmalion in Book 10 of the
Metamorphoses
± a narrative in which something inanimate comes alive, just as reading
ethically creates a vital, living relationship between the text and the reader. Miller devotes special attention to the ways in which reading defies stasis, as well as to the manner in which reading ethically, moreover, evolves during successive readings of a given text: `Reading occurs in a certain spot to a certain person in a certain historical, personal, institutional, and political situation, but it always exceeds what was predictable from those circumstances',
he
observes.
`It
makes
something
happen
that
is
a
deviation
from
its
ethical criticism context,
and
what
173
happens
demands
a
new
definition
each
time'
(1990,
22).
In
his
paradigm for the ethics of reading, Miller allows for the negative possibilities of reading, aspects that Booth, in his effort to celebrate ethical criticism and its myriad of affirmative outcomes, prefers to ignore: `A theory of the ethics of reading that takes seriously the possibility that reading might lead to other morally good or valuable actions would also have to allow for the possibility that the reading even of a morally exemplary book might cause something morally deplorable to occur', Miller writes (21). In this manner, Miller postulates a valuable corollary to the reflexive properties of ethical criticism and the ways in which context and temporality possess the propensity to alter the quality of reading experiences. Like Williams, Nussbaum advocates an ethical criticism with tenable foundations in moral philosophy, as well as an interpretive mechanism that functions as an impetus for sustaining
moral
discourse
and
social
interconnection.
In
addition
to
her
enthusiastic
subscription to many of the arguments inherent in Booth's ontology for an ethical criticism, Nussbaum proffers a series of essays in
Love's Knowledge that sharpen the ethical paradigm's
focus through her discussion about the interrelations between philosophy and literature, as well as through her close, ethical readings of a diversity of writers, including Henry James, Proust, Ann Beattie and Samuel Beckett, among others. Drawing upon selected works by these figures, Nussbaum examines the ways in which style and content impinge upon ethical issues, while also deliberating about the manner in which the ethical interpretation of literary works offers readers a means for exploring the moral import of emotions and locating paths to self-knowledge. Nussbaum affords particular attention to the roles that stylistics,
linguistics
and
structure
play
in
articulating
the
moral
essence
of
a
given
narrative:
Form and style are not incidental features. A view of life is of
genre,
formal
structures,
sentences,
vocabulary,
of
told. The telling itself ± the selection
the
whole
manner
of
addressing
the
reader's sense of life ± all of this expresses a sense of life and of value, a sense of what matters and what does not, of what learning and communicating are, of life's relations and connections. Life is never simply
presented by a text; it is always represented as something. (1990, 5)
In Nussbaum's schema, then, the literary artist bears the responsibility for honourably positing narratives that allow readers the opportunity to discover their own paths to selfunderstanding and meaning, to formulate their own strategies for living well. Like Booth, Nussbaum equates the quality of life with the ethical dimensions of literature. `The novel is itself a moral achievement', she writes, `and the well-lived life is a work of literary art' (1990, 148). In addition to advancing the ethical notion of community in her work, Nussbaum argues for the place of love as a subject in the evolving discourse of ethical criticism. `The subject of romantic and erotic love is not often treated in works on moral philosophy', she admits (1990, 336). For this reason, Nussbaum differentiates between the Kantian notions of `pathological' and `practical' love in her analysis. Pathological love, she notes, signifies the often irrational emotions of romantic love in sharp contrast to the more enduring qualities of practical love, an emotion that Nussbaum defines as `an attitude of concern that one can will oneself to have toward another human being, and which is, for that reason, a part of morality'. The moral dimensions of practical love, therefore, merit considerable attention as a methodology for understanding the many ways in which readers respond ethically to literary texts. Moreover, `if one believes, in addition, that the realm of morality is of special
modern north american criticism and theory
174
and perhaps of supreme importance in human life . . . one will be likely, having once made that distinction, to ascribe high
human
worth to practical love' (1990, 336±7). In this way,
the acknowledgement of practical love provides additional insight into human conceptions of living well and the manner in which literary texts depict love's capacity to produce personal fulfilment. Nussbaum also refines the communal aspects that mark the ethical paradigm. She extends the metaphor that ethical criticism forges a type of community between text and reader to allow for not only the possibility of living well as an individual, but living together well in a much larger sense of the word. `A community is formed by author and readers', she writes. `In this community separateness and qualitative difference are not neglected; the privacy and the imagining of each is nourished and encouraged. But at the same time it is stressed that living together is the object of our ethical interest' (1990, 48). In
Poetic Justice
(1995), Nussbaum advances this concept through her exploration of
the value of ethical reading as a means for influencing political theory and public discourse: `If we think of reading in this way, as combining one's own absorbed imagining with periods of more detached (and interactive) critical scrutiny, we can already begin to see why we might find in it an activity well suited to public reasoning in a democratic society' (1995, 9). By widening the scope of the ethical paradigm to account for a range of emotional states, as well as a variety of public and private modes of discourse, Nussbaum shares in the creation of an ethical criticism that provides for the relevant interpretation of the social, political and cultural nuances of the human community.
Getting It Right
In
, Geoffrey Galt Harpham continues Booth's and Nussbaum's efforts to
elaborate the ethical paradigm as an interdisciplinary means of interpretation. Ethical criticism should `be considered a matrix, a hub from which the various discourses and disciplines fan out and at which they meet, crossing out of themselves to encounter each other', he writes. `Ethics is perhaps best conceived as a `conceptual base' ± neither as organic drive nor as properly conceptual superstructure, but rather as a necessary, and necessarily impure and unsystematic, mediation between unconscious and instinctual life and its cognitive and cultural transformation' (1992, 17±18). Harpham supports this endeavour through his examinations of such `ethical terms' as `obligation', `
ought
', `ethical duty' and `ethicity'. Through their delineation, he
seeks to establish meaningful interconnections between ethical criticism and other means of textual inquiry. Harpham argues that the issue of choice lies at the heart of obligation. `One can ± one must ± choose which principle to be governed by', he observes. `Ethics in general is a species of risk that affords no rigorous way to tell ethical reasons from other reasons, choices from obligations' (1992, 37). Harpham further asserts that `at the dead center of ethics lies the
ought
', or the ethical obligation. This notion of an
ought
± the moral obligations of an ethical
person ± reveals that person's `commitments, values, character. To be ethical, an
ought
must
not refer itself to threats or desires, coercion or self-ends' (1992, 18). Harpham defines `ethical duty' as a form of critical reflection: `One must always reflect', Harpham writes. `This is the law that ethical discourse virtually presumes as well as teaches' (1992, 42). Finally, in Harpham's conception of an ethical terminology, `ethicity' refers to the interpretive moment in ethical criticism: `the most dramatic of narrative turnings, the climactic point just between the knitting and unravelling of the action, the
fort
and the
da
, the moment when the rising line of
Ânouement'. Addressing the complication peaks, pauses, and begins its descent into the de narratological and characterological essences of this evaluative instance ± what Harpham calls the `macro-turn' ± enables ethical critics, through their obligations to their own sets of values and commitments, to reflect upon and interpret the moral choices depicted in narratives (1992, 171).
ethical criticism Despite
the
175
publication
in
recent
years
of
a
number
of
volumes
devoted
to
the
humanistic study of literary works, ethical criticism must still successfully contend with several issues of historical and contemporary import in order to authenticate itself as a viable interpretive paradigm. Apart from continuing to underscore its usefulness to literary study, ethical criticism must effectively differentiate itself from the contemporary critical prejudice associated with the `traditional humanism' previously associated with such figures as F. R. Leavis and Northrop Frye. Practitioners of ethical criticism are succeeding in this regard in a variety of ways, including their critical alliance with the ethical philosophies of Emmanuel Levinas and via the recent emergence of the law and literature movement. By also
demonstrating
its
significant
pedagogical
value,
as
well
as
establishing
itself
as
a
meaningful component in the future of the theoretical project, the ethical paradigm may yet realize Booth's vision in
The Company We Keep of a reading methodology that shuns
theoretical dogma in favour of `critical pluralism' and highlights the ethical interconnections between the lives of readers and their textual experiences (1988, 489).
Kenneth Womack
Further reading and works cited The Company We Keep. Berkeley, CA, 1988.
Booth, W. C.
The Moral Imagination. Iowa City, IA, 1986.
Clausen, C.
Davis, T. F. and Womack, K. (eds) Eaglestone, R. Gardner, J.
On Moral Fiction. New York, 1978. Agents and Lives. Cambridge, 1993.
Goldberg. S. L. Graff, G.
Mapping the Ethical Turn. Charlottesville, VA, 2001.
Ethical Criticism. Edinburgh, 1997.
Literature against Itself. Chicago, 1979.
Harpham, G. Galt. Lyotard, J.-F.
Getting It Right. Chicago, 1992.
The Postmodern Condition. Minneapolis, MN, 1984.
Miller, J. Hillis.
The Ethics of Reading. New York, 1987.
Ð. `Is There an Ethics of Reading?', in Ð.
Reading Narrative, ed. J. Phelan. Columbus, OH, 1988.
Versions of Pygmalion. Cambridge, 1990.
Newton, A. Z. Norris, C.
Narrative Ethics. Cambridge, MA, 1995.
Truth and the Ethics of Criticism. New York, 1994.
Nussbaum, M. C.
The Fragility of Goodness. Cambridge, 1986.
Ð.
Love's Knowledge. New York, 1990.
Ð.
Poetic Justice. Boston, 1995.
Parker, D.
Ethics, Theory, and the Novel. Cambridge, 1994.
Parr, S. Resneck.
The Moral of the Story. New York, 1982.
PMLA, Special Issue, `Ethics and Literary Criticism', 114, 1, January 1999. Posner, R. A. `Against Ethical Criticism', Rosenblatt, L. M.
Philosophy and Literature, 21, 1997.
The Reader, the Text, the Poem. Carbondale, 1978.
Salmagundi, Special Issue, `Art and Ethics: A Symposium', 111, Summer 1996. Siebers, T.
The Ethics of Criticism. Ithaca, NY, 1988.
Spacks, P. Meyer. `The Novel as Ethical Paradigm', in
Why the Novel Matters, eds M. Spilka and C.
McCracken-Flesher. Bloomington, IN, 1990. Tirrell, L. `Storytelling and Moral Agency', Williams, B.
Journal of Aesthetics and Art Criticism, 48, Spring 1990.
Ethics and the Limits of Philosophy. Cambridge, 1985.
Worthington, K. L.
Self as Narrative. Oxford, 1996.
24. Postmodernism
Any
discussion
of
postmodernism
in
the
USA
must
adopt
an
interdisciplinary
and
comparative perspective. The intellectual history of postmodernism can only be understood
in
literary
its
intricate
criticism
we
interconnections associate
with
that
straddle cultures,
postmodernism
is
for
fields
the
and
most
practices.
part
The
theoretical,
concerned not only with `literature as a question' (Lucy 1997, 141) but also with questions of
language,
representation,
identity,
origin
and
truth.
At
the
same
time,
the
`global'
features of postmodernism can be studied more efficiently in their specific `local' manifestations. Despite its increasing globalization, postmodernism has continued to encourage cultural differentiation and local solutions. The evolution of American postmodernism is a case in point. Many innovative practices in poetry, fiction, architecture, the visual and the performing arts
were
developed beginning in the
mid-1950s
in direct response to
the
economic and political environment of post-Fordist, Cold War America. These practices have benefited from an interaction with the emerging poststructuralist theories of France (deconstruction, oriented
Lacanian
theory),
or
with
psychoanalysis, the
literature
French
of
the
feminism)
European
and
Germany
avant-gardes
and
(reader-
the
Latin
American boom, but they cannot be seen as derivative. Theo D'haen and Hans Bertens's recent
book
(1997)
on
the
reception
of
postmodern
American
fiction
in
four
West
European countries demonstrates not only the impact of American postmodernism abroad but also the extent to which the dialogue with other literary experiences has helped expand the definition of American postmodernism to include alternative experiences and issues of gender, ethnicity or subjectivity. The earliest American uses of the term `post-Modern' to describe tendencies in postwar literature can be found in Charles Olson's essays beginning with `Projected Verse' (1950). Olson reserved the term for the anti-modernist and anti-rationalist aesthetics pursued by the poets and artists associated with the Black Mountain College. Limited originally to discussions of poetry and architecture, the term was gradually expanded to other artistic and cultural endeavours that reacted against modernism's emphasis on transcendent reason and its separation of art from history and mass culture. The early postmodern theorizings (William
Van
O'Connor,
Leslie
Fiedler,
Susan
Sontag)
encouraged
an
anti-elitist,
experiential approach to art. This approach was subsequently developed along two lines: one
existential-phenomenological,
ontological Altieri,
pluralization
Richard
emphasizing
(Richard
Pearce);
the
Wasson,
performative William
immediacy,
Spanos,
structural-epistemological,
other
Richard
process
art
Palmer,
Charles
highlighting
a
and
range
of
`doubly-coded', dislocating and reconfiguring procedures in literature (Jerome Klinkowitz, Larry
McCaffery,
Charles
Jencks,
Marjorie
Kenneth
Perloff,
Linda
Frampton),
the
Hutcheon), visual
arts
architecture
(Leonard
B.
(Robert
Meyer,
Venturi,
Hal
Foster,
postmodernism Rosalind
Krauss,
177
Craig
Owens),
photography
(Douglas
Crimp,
Linda
Andre),
theatre
È l Carroll) and dance (Sally Banes). Ihab Hassan was the first to (Herbert Blau), film (Noe pull these directions together into a comprehensive definition of postmodernism as an epistemic mutation in the `Western mind', a vast `unmaking' of the `tyranny of wholes' and their replacement with `fragments or fractures, and a corresponding ideological commitment to minorities in politics, sex, and language' (1977, 55). Hassan mapped this mutation in binary oppositions: abstraction, metaphor, depth, transcendence, technologism, elitism, the genital and the phallic are modern; new concreteness, metonymy, surface, immanence, runaway technology, anti-authoritarianism, the polymorphous and the androgynous are postmodern. First introduced in
The Dismemberment of Orpheus
contrastive features were amplified and revised in
methean Fire according
a
(1979)
and
non-linear,
the
retrospective
`paracritical'
style
collection that
(1971), Hassan's lists of
Paracriticisms
(1975),
The Right Pro-
The Postmodern Turn
imitated
the
experimental
(1987),
nature
of
postmodernism itself. The break with modernism was viewed from the outset in contradictory ways. For critics formed at
the school
of modernist and
New Critical principles,
postmodernism was a
retrograde assault on the values of Enlightenment rationalism and an `anti-intellectual' abandonment of aesthetic and cultural standards (Irving Howe, `Mass Society and PostFiction', 1959; Harry Levin, `What Was Modernism', 1960). For supporters, postmodernism was `everything that is radical, innovative, forward-looking' (Perloff 1998, 6); it was a `new sensibility' that attempted to `close the gap' between highbrow literature and mass culture, art and life (Susan Sontag, `One Culture and the New Sensibility', 1965; Leslie Fiedler, `The New Mutants', 1965, `Cross the Border ± Close that Gap: Postmodernism', 1969; Ihab Hassan, `POSTmodernISM: A Paracritical Bibliography', 1971). This divided way of thinking about postmodernism has continued unchanged until today. Many critics still
oppose
a
reproductive,
`neoconservative'
postmodernism
to
an
emancipatory
or
`resistant' one. For example, Charles Russell has typically distinguished an academic form of postmodernism, that has led to the `embourgeoisement' of the old avant-garde (1982, 54), from a socially-conscious form `which attempts to combat the reigning discourse and substitute alternate codes' (57). More recently, Paul Maltby has contrasted the `introverted' self-reflection of Nabokov, Barth and Gass, which exposes `the operation of its narrative codes or rhetorical strategies' (1991, 1, 5, 15), with the `dissident' self-reflection of Acker, Barthelme, Burroughs, Coover, DeLillo, Pynchon or Reed, that engages more directly the `surrounding or contemporaneous discourses (including literary narrative forms and the meaning-systems they embody') (17). This division has been replicated in the social sciences where one can identify an `affirmative social discourse (Drucker, Etzione, Ferre and theorists of the post-industrial society) [which] reproduced the 1950s optimism . . . that technology and modernization were making possible the break with an obsolete past' (Best and Kellner 1991, 14), and a negative discourse `that reflected a pessimistic take on the trajectories of [post]modern societies' (Toynbee, Mills, Bell, Steiner, Baudrillard). Despite persistent disagreements regarding its definition and applications, postmodernism became an established term in literary and art criticism by the mid±1970s. About the same time it began to be acclimatized in the discourses of social and physical sciences as a catch-all
designation
for
a
new
cultural-scientific
episteme
 (Ferre
1976;
Spanos
1982;
Rorty 1983; Prigogine and Stengers 1984). Postmodernism was drawn in this phase into a `poststructuralist
orbit'
(Bertens
1995,
5),
being
associated
at
first
with
the
textualist-
deconstructive practices inspired by Roland Barthes and Jacques Derrida, then with the
modern north american criticism and theory
178
ideas of Michel Foucault, Jacques Lacan and Gilles Deleuze who anchored textuality in
La condition
relations of power, knowledge and subjectivity. The translation of Lyotard's
postmoderne
(1984), in which a prominent poststructuralist adopted the term `postmodern',
acknowledging his indebtedness to Hassan, `seemed to many to signal a full-fledged merger between an originally American postmodernism and French poststructuralism' (Bertens 1995, 6). In the comprehensive definition supplied by Lyotard and other cultural critics of a poststructuralist or neo-marxist ilk (Jameson, Foster, Harvey, Lash) postmodernism was the `cultural logic' of a new phase in the development of western societies: the phase of post-industrial consumerism, informational glut, and multinational capitalism. In a few years, postmodernism `became an indispensable concept in theories of the contemporary' (Bertens 1995, 111), especially through Jameson's contributions beginning with `Postmodernism paradigm
and
and
Consumer
brought
Society'
home
the
(1983)
that
theoretical
turned
debate
postmodernism
between
Lyotard
into and
a
global
Habermas
concerning the limits of this episteme. Another contributor to the rethinking of postmodernism along systematic sociocultural lines was William V. Spanos, founder of the first American journal of postmodern theory, 1970s
and
early
1980s
reoriented
the
boundary 2
discussion
(1972). Spanos's essays through the
of
postmodernism
from
a
Heidegger-
inspired phenomenology (Spanos's 1972 essay, `The Detective and the Boundary', praised postmodernism's Charles
Olson
`existential
a
imagination'
neo-Heideggerian
and
reading)
gave
to
an
the
poetry
emphasis
of
on
Robert
Creeley
cultural
revision
and that
reconciled Heidegger's critique of the onto-theo-logical tradition with Foucault's prosecution
of modernity's
reassessment, contributed
the
to
the
Enlightenment'
totalizing
emergence break
and
the
up
modes
of thought.
of
oppositional
of
the
As
Spanos
`anthropological
`(neo-)imperial
put
postmodernism
structure
of
in
structure
it
in
the
his
most
1960s
privileged
by
American/European
recent
and the
1970s post-
modernity',
foregrounding possibilities `utterly precluded . . . by the instrumental logic of the dominant discourse' (Spanos 1996, 67, 68). The turn of postmodern discourse to (poststructuralist) theory and cultural analysis has been
questioned
endedness
of
by
the
practical
movement.
critics
interested
Marjorie
in
Perloff
preserving
has
thus
the
idiosyncratic
deplored
the
shift
open-
from
a
literary-utopian postmodernism prevalent in the early 1970s, that `involved a romantic faith in the . . . ability of [the literary and artistic discourses] to transform themselves', to a theoretical-prescriptive postmodernism in the 1980s which hardened art `into a set of norms'
(1998,
9).
As
she
notes,
in
spite
of
`all
the
talk
of
rupture,
transgression,
antiformalism, the breaking of vessels ± in Lyotardian terms, the deligitimation of the great metanarratives ± there seem to be more rules and prescriptions around than ever' (10). The conflation of postmodernism with poststructuralism is problematic from another point of view. French poststructuralism has focused primarily on modern and premodern literary phenomena, with rare sallies into postmodern popular culture. Its chief contribution, according to Andreas Huyssen, is `an
archeology of modernity,
a theory of modernism at
the stage of exhaustion' (1984, 39). The application of poststructuralist theories to the analysis of postmodern discourses has often resulted in an overrating of their deconstructive features
at
the
expense
of
the
transformative
ones.
The
emphasis
on
disruptive,
anti-
representational aspects of postmodernism predominated in the criticism of the late 1970s and 1980s (Federman's Thiher's
Surfiction
Words in Reflection
(1975), Klinkowitz's
(1984), Cristopher Nash's
Literary Disruptions
World-Games
(1980), Allen
(1987)), even though
one can identify also the beginning of a counter-trend which argued for a socially-conscious
postmodernism
179
definition of postmodernism (Jonathan Arac's collection Brian
McHale's
Hutcheon's
ings
Postmodern Fiction
(1987),
The Politics of Postmodernism
Tom
Postmodernism and Politics
LeClair's
The Art of Excess
(1989) and Jerry A. Varsava's
(1986), (1989),
Contingent Mean-
(1990)).
But criticism was not alone in emphasizing the disruptive, self-referential side of the project. Innovative writers and artists share with their critics the responsibility for their misrepresentation, overstating initially the playful, self-cancelling aspects of their work. Ronald Sukenick's 1970s `digressions on the act of fiction' called for a radical version of `nonrepresentational'
fiction
whose
`main
qualities
are
abstraction,
improvisation,
and
opacity' (Sukenick 1985, 211). By making its language opaque, innovative fiction resists the game of make-believe, calling attention to the structure and `truth of the page' (212). This reorientation toward the materiality of the novel was regarded by unsympathetic critics as an act of ideological `recoiling', creating `a new kind of flatness or depthlessness, a new kind of superficiality in the most literal sense' (Jameson 1991, 9). Yet it is clear from other more considered statements made by Sukenick and his colleagues that the point innovative writers were trying to put across was not that the world exists solely within the word, but that our versions of reality depend on perceptual and discursive systems that offer biased representations under the guise of a `natural' order. Therefore, it is the writer's duty to challenge naturalized conventions of representation, imagining better aesthetic and sociocultural
syntheses.
On
an
experiential
level,
postmodern
literature
disrupts
the
consensual boundaries of `reality' through improvisation and `invention' in order to allow more experience to slip through. On a cultural level postmodern literature interrogates the `great system of constraints by which the West compelled the everyday to bring itself into discourse' (Foucault 1979, 91), rearticulating our narrative and cultural options. Criticism has often dissociated the disruptive and rearticulative sides of innovation, describing the postmodern project alternatively as overly critical and socially destabilizing, or
as
non-implicated
concept
of
literary
and
self-fetishizing.
discourse
as
an
Underlying
effective
both
integrating
descriptions
machine.
is
Within
a
nostalgic
this
model,
epistemological and compositional concerns are ignored or subordinated to the representational function of literature. What the contemporary novel needs, according to Charles Newman, is not poetic self-interrogation but comprehensive acts of order-making that reinforce `the positive socializing function of literature' (1985, 5±6). Critiques of postmodernism on the left have not been more helpful. The prevailing view among theorists like Jean Baudrillard, Alex Callinicos, Terry Eagleton, Hal Foster, Fredric Jameson and Christopher Norris is that postmodernism is an art of pastiche and simulation that renders history `reified, fragmented, fabricated ± both imploded and depleted' (Foster 1985, 123). In Jameson's critique, postmodernism confines itself to a narrow textual and ideological circuit that reinforces `the logic of consumer capitalism'. But Jameson's own argument suffers from circularity, focusing on forms of art that give support to his deterministic view that postmodernism is complicit with late multinational capitalism: the fiction of E. L. Doctorow, that `epic poet of the disappearance of the American radical past' (1991, 24), nostalgic-parodic architecture and film, or the science fiction of Philip K. Dick. On the other hand, he ignores the political polysystemic novel of Coover and Pynchon, surfiction, L=A=N=G=U=A=G=E poetry, feminist literature and film, and oppositional uses of video that have successfully tested
some
of the
methods envisioned by him,
such
as `global
cognitive mapping' and `transcoding' (1991, 54). Critical terminology has also prevented a more balanced understanding of postmodern
modern north american criticism and theory
180
innovation. Used all too often to describe experimental forms of narrative, concepts such as `metafiction', `anti-narrative', `pure fiction', `parody', `pastiche' have reduced postmodernism to an `either-or' logic that opposes invention to imitation. A prevailing trend in the criticism of the 1970s and 1980s has been to regard innovative literature as a heterogeneous collection of anti-referential procedures (self-reflection, digression, distortion, decomposition, displacement, cancellation, pla[y]giarism, arbitrary formal patterning, collage, cutups),
estranging
narration
from
reality.
More
recent
criticism
has
re-evaluated
the
postmodern agenda through finer theoretical tools (feminist, new historicist, postcolonial), amending
its
earlier
view
of
experimentation
Politics of Postmodernism
Hutcheon's
(1989)
as
politically
found
uninvolved.
self-reflection
For
example,
compatible
with
a
politically significant stance interested in revising the culture's power systems. Likewise, Brian
Constructing Postmodernism
McHale's
acknowledged
the
`double-coded',
culture-
conscious nature of postmodern fiction (1992, 2). In lieu of the inventory of structuralthematic features which undergirded the `descriptive poetics' of
Postmodern Fiction
(1987),
McHale's new book proposes `a plurality of constructions' that valorize postmodernism's bifurcating options: ontological construction vs. political destabilizing, centring microworlds vs. living in the `zone', paranoid reading vs. reading `otherwise' (2±3). While appropriately rehistoricizing innovative literature, inscribing literary aesthetics within the framework of a cultural politics, such re-evaluations continue to waver between two theoretical descriptions of postmodern innovation: one explains the writer's task as a `purification' of language by `rendering [it] seemingly incoherent, irrational, illogical, and even meaningless' (Federman 1993, 33); the other emphasizes the socially relevant task of reformulation, arguing that `the techniques of parody, irony, introspection, self-reflexiveness directly challenge the oppressive forces of social and literary authorities' (32). At the root of this conceptual hesitation is a simplified application of Jacques Derrida's deconstruction and of Michel Foucault's and Jean-Franc Ë ois Lyotard's critiques of the universalizing
discourses
of
modernity.
The
role
of
postmodern
writing,
as
Lyotard
saw
it,
is
to
undercut the powerful metanarratives that societies resort to in order to minimize risk and unpredictability.
When
it
does
not
simply
suggest
an
economy
of
the
`unpresentable'
(1984, 82), Lyotard's theory of resisting writing translates into `discontinuous, catastrophic, nonrectifiable,
and
paradoxical
petits reÂcits
'
(66).
These
local
stories
recognize
`the
heteromorphous nature of the language games' (66), but also prevent a comprehensive view of the cultural system as a whole. Against
Lyotard's
agonistic
theory
of
postmodern
signification,
other
writers
and
theorists have sought a transactive model that would valorize the mediating-transformative role
of
literary
imagination.
One
such
model
has
been
found
in
(poly)system
theory,
applied to postmodern literature by Tom LeClair, Joseph Natoli, William Paulson, Molly Hite, David Porush and Marcel Cornis-Pope. As a radical development of the `dynamic functionalism' proposed by the Russian formalists, polysystem theory describes `system[s] of various systems, which intersect with each other and partly overlap, using concurrently different
options,
yet
functioning
as
one
structured
whole,
whose
members
are
inter-
dependent' (Even-Zohar 1990, 11). Itamar Even-Zohar urges us to think of polysystems not `in terms of
one
center and
one
periphery, since several such positions are hypothesized'
(14), but as dynamic stratifications that incessantly redefine centre and periphery. This theoretical perspective is particularly useful in rethinking the functions of postmodern innovation. We can argue that postmodernism employs strategies of decentring and framebreaking as part of a transformative agenda that converts closed hierarchical systems into
postmodernism
181
dynamic polysystems that acknowledge `multiple forms of otherness as they emerge from differences in subjectivity, gender, sexuality, class, and ``race'' ' (Sarup 1996, 101). While traditional literature tried for the most part to mask the `difference of disorder' within a system
(Natoli
1992,
203),
postmodern
literature
exploits
the
subversive
potential
of
boundary-crossing and intersystemic interference. The ` ``motley'' society macroimage' that Joseph Natoli recognizes in Acker, Barth, Pynchon or Sorrentino allows us to see `what a social order cannot see but has already been made ``see-able'' by the ``dissident'' acts of narration' (124). The task of delineating a cooperative rather competitive model of signification that would reconcile the disruptive with the rearticulative side of postmodernism has been pursued more vigorously by postcolonial and postmodern feminist theorists. Feminism's challenge, according to Sandra Harding, has been to articulate a gender-specific epistemology as a defence against male claims of `objectivism/universalism', on the one hand, and self-denying relativism on the other (1990, 87). For this particular task Lyotard's `agonistic theory of language and paralogistic theory of legitimation cannot serve as basis' (Benhabib
1990,
122).
The
tendency
of
Lyotard's
version
of
postmodernism
to
put
everything `under erasure' pre-empts important cultural concepts such as those of knowing subject, gendered agent and female experience. As Nancy Fraser and Linda J. Nicholson insist, feminism still requires these concepts or `at minimum large narratives about changes in social organization and ideology' (1990, 26). And yet, in spite of their mutual mistrust and different discursive paths, the two `most important political-cultural currents of the last decade' (19) have had reasons to cooperate, correcting/enhancing each other's critiques of the
master
narratives
of
modernity.
Feminism
has
called
into
question
the
excessive
fragmentation of the postmodern sociocultural vision and the marginalization of female issues in the male avant-gardes. In turn, the postmodern perspective has been useful in challenging the separatism characteristic of some versions of cultural feminism, and the feminist recourse to conventional narrative forms or to essentialist categories like `sexuality, mothering, reproduction, and sex-affective production [that] group together phenomena which are not necessarily conjoined in all societies' (Fraser and Nicholson 1990, 31). From the blend of a feminist standpoint epistemology (Harding) and a revisionistic literary poetics has resulted a stronger, politically oriented version of postmodernism. The concept of difference itself has been re-evaluated in recent postmodern feminism and certain postcolonial projects, being removed from the earlier emphasis on a `single concept of ``otherness'' [that] has associations of binarity, hierarchy, and supplementarity . . . in favor of a more plural and disprivileging concept of difference and the ex-centric' (Hutcheon 1989, 65). Navigating between a `politics of difference' focused on `building new political groupings with categories neglected in previous modern politics such as race, gender,
sexual
preference,
and
ethnicity'
and
a
`politics
of
identity'
that
attempts
to
construct `identities through political struggle and commitment' (Best and Kellner 1991, 205),
postmodernism
reification
of
has
difference.
managed
The
play
to
of
develop
cultural
diversified
differences
strategies
has
been
that
evoked
avoid in
the
recent
postmodern/postcolonial literature (Charles Johnson, Toni Morrison, Bharati Mukherjee, Â a, Zygmund Bauman, Homi Bhabha, Rey Thomas Pynchon) and theory (Gloria Anzaldu Chow, Susan Stanford Friedman) not in order to enhance divisions based on race, class, gender
or
sexual
preference,
but
rather
to
create
a
more
responsive
framework
for
intercultural translation. Much of this work of rethinking and mediation has been carried out by the writers
modern north american criticism and theory
182
themselves in the oblique, self-questioning forms of postmodern theorizing that shares Richard Rorty's aversion for context-transcendent claims to truth. Theoretical reflections can be found in the most unlikely places, such as in the story of the cyborg Abhor in Kathy Acker's
Empire of the Senseless (1988), in the debate between two philosophic dogs in
Robert Coover's
Pinocchio in Venice (1991), or in the adventures of an electric bulb called
Byron in Pynchon's criticism,
analysis
Federman's
Gravity's Rainbow (1973). The very distinction between fiction and
and
performance,
breaks
down
in
Hassan's
Paracriticisms (1975) or
Critifiction (1993), two leading compendiums of postmodern poetics that
emphasize the `extemporaneous', open-ended nature of narrative and theoretical articulation. Sukenick's own critical `digressions on the act of fiction' follow a `questioning' rather than `answering' mode, being carefully dissociated from the `hierophantic complications' of `formal thinking' (1985, 4). Like Sukenick's `surfiction', his `working theory' depends on a revisionistic type of `experiential thinking' that seeks to `undercut official versions of reality in favour of our individual sense experience' (67). Sukenick thus shares with other recent reformulative projects (postcolonial literature, L=A=N=G=U=A=G=E poetry, innovative feminist fiction and film) a basic principle of narrative and cultural rewriting. Rewriting devises `new sets of rules by which the familiar pieces could be rearranged' (Federman 1993, 125); it also `re-invents what [has] been banished, hidden, or expelled from individual or collective memory' (128). As defined further by postmodern feminism, rewriting is both an `act of looking back, of seeing with fresh eyes' ± hence an `act of survival' for those who have been misrepresented ± and an act of looking forward, `seeing difference differently' (Rich 1979, 35). In this sense, `rewriting' covers a broad range of possibilities from mere parody to cultural intertextuality wherein a text engages and transforms not only previous texts but also an old discursive system. An important object of rewriting in postmodern literature and theory has been history. Taking its cue from the philosophies of history developed during and after the Second World War (the `negative dialectic' of the Frankfurt School, Heidegger's emphasis on the gap between `historicity' and `real history', Sartre's questioning of history's intelligibility in terms of the individual's aspiration to freedom, or Foucault's critique of unified notions of historical
agency
and
memory),
postmodern
fiction
has
foregrounded
the
problematic
nature of all historical representation. Coming of age in the `decade after Hiroshima', John Barth, Donald Barthelme, Richard Brautigan, Robert Coover, Thomas Pynchon, Ishmael Reed and Kurt Vonnegut denounced the ideological myths on which official representations relied, retelling history in a satirical key. Other writers emerging after 1968 and associated with the trend of surfiction (Walter Abish, Russell Banks, George Chambers, Raymond
Federman,
Madeline
Gins,
Steve
Katz,
Clarence
Major,
Ursule
Molinaro,
Gilbert Sorrentino, Ronald Sukenick) rejected mimetic realism altogether, denouncing its `silent agreement with the official discourse of the State' (Federman 1993, 28±9). Their `critifictional discourse' attacked `the vehicle that expressed and represented that reality: discursive language and the traditional form of the novel' (32). Innovative
literature
and
criticism
share
with
postmodern
historiography
(Fernand
Braudel, the Annales School, Michel Foucault, Jean-Franc Ë ois Lyotard, Hayden White, Gianni Vattimo, Michael Rogin) a suspicion of linear evolutionary models, regarding them as verbal fictions. But while subverting history's metanarratives, postmodernism has also tried to retrieve those details of everyday life that do not fit into easy patterns. The fiction of Coover, DeLillo, McElroy and Pynchon illustrates a dialogic vision of narrative that accommodates alternative histories and voices. Resorting to what Morrison has called acts
postmodernism
183
Beloved chronicle
of `re-memory' in rather
than
, postmodern feminist fiction has also tried to `
it'
(Marshall
1992,
150),
retrieving
ignored
intervene
events
in history
and
shifting
attention from `winners' to `ordinary people' or the `historically displaced'. Significant work of rewriting/revision has been carried out also in the area of cultural identities. To the extent the current geopolitical scene is more hospitable to intercultural understanding, some credit is due to the revisionistic imagination of postmodernism that has deconstructed the polarized ideology of the Cold War era, replacing it with polysystemic
mappings.
descriptions
of
marginalized
Us
As
Rorty
and
minority
the
and
put
it,
Other
human
are
women
beings
available
writers
has
come
(1989, been
together
xvi).
The
particularly
when work
useful
imaginative
of in
previously rethinking
questions of identity. Charles Johnson, Clarence Major, Maxine Hong Kingston, Toni Morrison,
Leslie
poetically, moorings.
Silko,
taking Their
it
or
out
Alice
of
re-creative
its
Walker
have
traditional
impulse
radicalized
patriarchal,
bears
out
the
novel
rationalistic
Barbara
thematically and
Christian's
and
monocultural
observation
that
`[P]eople of color have always theorized ± but in forms quite different from the Western form of abstract logic. . . . [O]ur theorizing . . . is often in narrative forms, in the stories we create, in riddles and proverbs, in the play with language' (1987, 52). Drawing on their work, Henry Louis Gates Jr, Hortense Spillers, Robert B. Stepto, Mae G. Henderson, David Cowart and W. Lawrence Hogue have articulated a new poetics for African-American and multicultural literature, one that problematizes received ideas about identity, gender, race and history. It is also true that postmodernism has raised at times unrealistic expectations about the emancipatory potential of its rewritings. The events of 1989 have brought some of these limitations into focus. While the collapse of the Cold War system may be regarded as a success story of the type of experimental thinking that postmodernism itself has been deploying
for
two
decades,
it
has
also
raised
questions
about
the
role
that
literary
experimentation can play in the `new world order'. Are the idioms of cultural `resistance' and
artistic
innovation
viable
strategies
in
the
age
of
globalized
capitalism
and
the
dominance of market culture that renders the work of intellectuals all but superfluous? Can literary discourse mediate between the ethnocentric concepts of culture that have reemerged in many places? As Susan Suleiman put it, in the post-1989 world `Things are [no longer] so simple; the idea of a postmodern paradise in which one can try on identities like costumes in a shopping mall . . . appears . . . not only naive, but intolerably thoughtless in a world where ± once again ± whole populations are murdered in the name of (ethnic) identity'
(1996,
54).
But
Suleiman
is
first
to
admit
that
a
revamped
form
of
`ethical
postmodernism', without `universal values, but also without the innocent thoughtlessness of
the
``happy
essentialist Lyotard's
cosmopolitan'' '
conception
of
post-totalitarian
self' ethic
(55), (56) of
is
needed
that
today
informs
discourse
but
to
interrogate
ethnocentric
strengthening
`the
conflicts. its
unitary Building
mediating
and on
function,
this ethical postmodernism would emphasize multicultural translation, making the world `safe for dialogue' again (63). In order to better respond to these new solicitations, postmodernism has undergone a slow process of reconstruction in the 1990s, both in literary studies (McHale, Hutcheon, Maltby, Suleiman, Gates Jr) and in social theory and philosophic/religious thought (Laclau and
Mouffe,
Best
and
Kellner,
Michael
Walzer,
Vincent
Leitch,
Charles
Taylor).
As
William Spanos has argued recently, this revamped postmodernism can participate in the `urgent project of interrogating the post-Cold War discourse of the New World Order'
modern north american criticism and theory
184
(Spanos 1996, 69), breaking the dualities of self and other, First World and Third World, global and local, that still haunt this emergent order. Susan Stanford Friedman has likewise highlighted in
Mappings: Feminism and the Cultural Geographies of Encounter
(1998) the
contribution postmodernism can make to the articulation of a post-Cold War epistemology, `specify[ing] a liminal space in between [self and other, western and non-western], the interstitial sight of interaction, interconnection, and exchange' (3). The theorists' guarded optimism about literature's potential for renewal in the post-Cold War age is shared by experimental poets and writers. A 1990 collection of essays on
Politics of Poetic Form
The
made bold claims for literature as a form of cultural `resistance',
`provocation', `remaking', active historical `recovery' and subversive `public plasma'. In response to the contemporary `crisis of expression', this collection rallied innovative writers around an oppositional poetics meant to re-empower art. Innovative writing was credited with the capacity to reconfigure the larger sociocultural situation, offering its innovations `not only as alternative aesthetic conventions but also as alternative social formations' (Bernstein 1990, 243). This liberationist project may appear utopian in the rapidly shrinking space that literary discourse
occupies
in
the
current
high-tech
mediascape.
But
postmodern
writers
have
discovered new possibilities at the intersection of literature and the electronic media. The `postlinear'
poetry
of
Clark
Coolidge,
Steve
McCaffery,
Karen
MacCormack,
Charles
Bernstein, Susan Howe and Bruce Andrews has explored the possibilities of intertextual and mediatic crossovers. The new cyberpunk and avant-pop fiction of Mark Leyner, Mark Amerika,
William
Vollman,
Eurudice
or
Criss
Mazza
has
tried
to
reconcile
narrative
innovation with techno-pop, using a range of recycling/rewriting strategies to expose the `hyperreality' of consumer culture. The literary and theoretical work produced since 1989 demonstrates postmodernism's capacity to refashion itself in response to the challenges of the post-Cold war transition. The
series
of
Federman's (1998),
Bag
novels
published
in
the
1990s
±
Coover's
To Whom It May Concern Vineland Mason & Dixon Mosaic Man (1990),
Pynchon's
(1990)
(1994) and
Pinocchio in Venice Jazz Paradise Doggy (1991),
Morrison's
and
(1992)
(1997),
or
and
Sukenick's
(1999) ± give ample proof that contemporary innovative
writing has not surrendered its commitment to transformative thinking. The input of their narrative imagination that emphasizes counter-hegemonic mappings ± fluid, multiplex, interactive ± can play a significant corrective role in the current ideological restructuring. The kaleidoscopic range of definitions and agendas that we continue to associate with postmodernism also testifies to its `discursive centrality'. For `only those signifiers around which
important
social
practices
take
place
are
subject
to
this
systematic
effect
of
ambiguity' (Laclau 1988, 80).
Marcel Cornis-Pope
Further reading and works cited Benhabib, S. `Epistemologies of Postmodernism', in New York, 1990.
Feminism/Postmodernism The Politics of Poetic Form
Bernstein, C. `Comedy and the Poetics of Political Form', in Bernstein. New York, 1990. Bertens, H.
The Idea of the Postmodern
. London, 1995.
, ed. L. J. Nicholson.
, ed. C.
postmodernism
185
Postmodern Theory Five Faces of Modernity Against Postmodernism Cultural Critique American Postmodern Fiction in Germany, Italy, Spain, and the Netherlands Poetics Today Critifiction Shaping the Future Recodings Power, Truth, Strategy Feminism/Postmodernism Feminism/Postmodernism Mappings Feminism/Postmodernism Amerikastudien Race, Modernity, Postmodernity The Politics of Postmodernism New German Critique The Anti-Aesthetic Postmodernism, or, the Cultural Logic of Late Capitalism Literary Disruptions Universal Abandon Postmodernism Postmodern Literary Theory. The Postmodern Condition Postmodern Fiction Constructing Postmodernism Dissident Postmodernists Teaching the Postmodern Mots d'Ordre The Post-Modern Aura Poetry On & Off the Page. On Lies, Secrets, and Silence The Consequences of Pragmatism Contingency, Irony, and Solidarity Chicago Review Identity, Culture, and the Postmodern World The Question of Textuality International Postmodernism In Form International Postmodernism
Best, S. and Kellner, D.
. New York, 1991.
Calinescu, M.
. Durham, NC, 1987.
Callinicos, A.
. New York, 1989.
Christian, B. `The Race for Theory',
, 6, 1987.
D'haen, T. and Bertens, H. (eds) `Closing the Gap': . Amsterdam, 1997.
Even-Zohar, I. `Polysystem Theory', Federman, R.
, 11, 1, Spring, 1990.
. Albany, NY, 1993.
 , F. Feroe
. New York, 19
Foster, H,
. Port Townsend, NY, 1985.
Foucault, M.
, eds M. Morris and P. Patton. Sydney, 1979.
Fraser, N. and Nicholson, L. J. `Social Criticism without Philosophy',
, in
, ed. L. J. Nicholson, New York, 1990.
Friedman, S. Stanford.
. Princeton, NJ, 1998.
Harding, S. `Feminism, Science, and the Anti-Enlightenment Critiques', in
,
ed. L. J. Nicholson. New York, 1990.
Hassan, I. `The Critic as Innovator',
, 22, 1977.
Hogue, L. W.
. Albany, NY, 1996.
Hutcheon, L.
. New York, 1989.
Huyssen, A. `Mapping the Postmodern', Jameson,
F.
`Postmodernism
and
, 33, 1984.
Consumer
Society',
in
,
ed.
H
Foster.
Port
Townsend, NY, 1983.
Ð.
. Durham, NC, 1991.
Klinkowitz, J.
. Urbana, IL, 1980.
Laclau, E. `Politics and the Limits of Modernity', in
, ed. A. Ross. Minneapolis,
MN, 1988.
Leitch, V. B.
. Albany, NY, 1996.
Lucy, N.
Oxford, 1997.
Lyotard, J.-F.
. Minneapolis, MN, 1984.
McHale, B.
. New York, 1987.
Ð.
. New York, 1992.
Maltby, P.
. Philadelphia, 1991.
Marshall, B. K. Natoli, J.
. New York, 1992.
. Albany, NY, 1992.
Newman, C.
. Evanston, IL, 1985.
Perloff, M.
Evanston, IL, 1998.
Rich, A.
. New York, 1979.
Rorty, R.
. Minneapolis, MN, 1983.
Ð.
. New York, 1989.
Russell, C. `Subversion and Legitimation', Sarup, M.
, 33, 2, 1982.
. Athens, OH, 1996.
Spanos, W. et al. (eds)
. Bloomington, IN, 1982.
Ð. `Rethinking the Postmodernity of the Discourse of Postmodernism', in , eds H. Bertens and D. Fokkema. Amsterdam, 1996.
Sukenick, R.
. Carbondale, 1985.
Suleiman, S. Rubin. `The Politics of Postmodernism after the Wall', in eds H. Bertens and D. Fokkema. Amsterdam, 1996.
,
25. The Role of Journals in Theoretical Debate
The place of literary theory within journals is necessarily tied in with the development of the literary journal, and the literary essay, as a whole. All literary criticism is at some level a contribution to the field of theory in that it contains a range of aesthetic, ideological and philosophical assumptions. Sometimes these assumptions are heavily veiled, but nonetheless the reviews and more general literary articles contained within nineteenth-century forerunners ± notably the
Atlantic Monthly
, which was founded in 1857 by a group of
literary-minded Republicans at the time that their party was developing its pro-abolition stance ± may be regarded as contributions to the theoretical debates of their day. Some of the issues raised ± about literary value and what we would now term canonicity, about the relationship between texts and morality/ethics, about the effects of reading, and about literatures and national identity ± are still very much with us. Although literary theory may be defined as that which focuses on the conceptual and abstract, on form and structure, effect and ideology ± rather than, say, on content or the biographical aspects of an individual author ± the dividing line between literary theory and literary criticism remains a necessarily blurred one. This has been true from the inception of the subject-dedicated journal,
which
may be
dated
to
the foundation of
Publications of the Modern Language Association of America
±
in
1884.
PMLA
As
an
±
the
organ
of
association, it has, in addition to its role as a generalist journal publishing scholarly articles relating to modern languages (in an Anglo-and-euro-centric understanding of the term), had an important role in diffusing information about the profession, especially in North America. Thus its advertisements valuably highlight coming publications, and both the requests for conference papers and for articles for edited volumes, and the programme of papers to be delivered at the annual MLA conference, when taken together with its annual bibliography, function as a symptomatic index of the state of literary studies, including trends in theoretical work. In recent times, special issues have highlighted areas of particular relevance to literary theory, such as reader-response criticism (1991), colonialism and the post-colonial
condition
Atlantic Quarterly
(1995),
queer
theory
(1995)
and
ethnicity
(1998).
The
South
, founded in 1901, has changed even more conspicuously with the times,
having no obligation to fulfil the utilitarian requirements of a profession's journal. Now published exclusively in special issues, it both debates the work of individual intellectuals and creative writers (Bakhtin 1998; Deleuze 1997; Walcott 1997) and analyses particular issues (domestic tragedy, 1998; psycho-marxism, 1998; nations, identities, cultures, 1995). Other long-established journals, such as
Modern Philology
(founded 1903), while rarely
containing articles of direct interest to literary theorists, nevertheless bring their readers
the role of journals in theoretical debate
187
into dialogue with theoretical issues through the generous number and length of their book reviews. But the most notable decade in the first half of the twentieth century for literary theory's development within the periodical was the 1930s. The (founded
1935)
and
Kenyon Review Sewanee Review
the
Ransom), as well as the close
reading
which
(1939,
under
the
editorship
Southern Review of
John
Crowe
(1892), were all instrumental in disseminating the
was
beginning
to
take
hold
as
a
dominant
critical
method
in
universities. This stressed formal and aesthetic values, de-emphasized both textual scholarship
and
regionalism,
and
Partisan Review History
the
was
quite
distinct
New Republic
criticism published by the
from
the
(founded 1914),
far
more
cultural
The New Masses
(founded 1936). It was sharply differentiated, too, from
and
political
(1926±48) and
English Literary
(founded 1934), which, with its continuing commitment to publish studies that
interpret
the
American
conditions
literary
affecting
texts,
has
the
been
production
flexibly
and
receptive
dissemination
to
the
of
English
historiographic
and
shifts
and
ideological self-interrogation in recent literary-historical scholarship, as well as to issues of gender
and
race.
Modern Language Quarterly
changes
within
the
opening
article,
by
field. J.
D.
Founded M.
Ford,
in
has
1940,
was
on
its
even
more
original
`Some
conspicuously
stance
Principles
of
was
adapted
philological
Linguistic
to
(the
Change
in
Romance'). But from March 1993, an issue devoted to `The State of Literary History', it added `A Journal of Literary History' to its masthead. As the editorial matter explains, when it was launched, `literary study often meant a quest for origins ± in sources and influences,
in
Subsequent
authorial
critical
intention,
movements
in
have
the
history
sought
of
to
ideas,
disrupt
and
such
in
the
efforts,
fixing but
of
a
texts'.
constant
undercurrent has been provided by calls for a new literary history ± prompted in particular by, but not limited to, `new historicism'. The journal now seeks out contributions on all aspects of literary change, whether these encompass influence, reception, or dissemination of texts themselves, or the historical dimensions of semiotics, hermeneutics and deconstruction, or the poetics of history, the history of the profession or the history of literary history. Claiming `we particularly welcome theoretical reflections on these topics, and on historicism in relation to feminism, ethnic studies, cultural materialism, discourse analysis, and
all
other
forms
of
cultural
representation
and
cultural
critique',
one
can
see
very
clearly how the turn towards historicism, and cultural history above all, in the 1990s has enabled new life, informed by critical theory, to be breathed into old journals without them rupturing entirely with their former identities. John Fisher, in an article surveying a century of
PMLA
, notes how the decade of social
and academic ferment between 1960 and 1970 witnessed a leap in the MLA's membership from
12,000
to
30,000,
and
simultaneously
periodicals in fields once largely served by
saw
the
PMLA
inception
of
over
two
thousand
. Specialization, and to some extent
fragmentation, of the discipline had arrived. As will be seen, the specialization on the page was often symbiotically linked to the development of a particular critical emphasis within a university department.
Victorian Studies dialogue become
between a
Many of the period-specific journals founded
(1957) and
notable
Modern Fiction Studies
literature feature
of
and
theory,
pioneered
contemporary
literary
at this
time, like
(1955), which actively encourages a the
inter-disciplinarity
studies.
The
publication
which
has
history
of
others provides an indicative pointer to broader developments within social and ideological conceptualizing. Shifts in racial nomenclature and self-perception, for example, lie behind the retitling of the
American Literature Forum
Negro American Literature Forum African American Review
(founded 1967) to the
in 1976, to
Black
in 1992. What remains
modern north american criticism and theory
188
constant,
however,
is
this
publication's
commitment
to
diversity
within
its
particular
ambit: thus in 1992 alone it produced special issues on the black church and black theatre, film, the literature of jazz and fiction. Many of the journals which have made the biggest impact in terms of literary theory were founded at the very end of the 1960s, or during the 1970s. When Ralph Cohen,
New
Literary History's long-standing editor, established this highly influential quarterly in 1969, he wrote that he envisaged it becoming `a challenge to the profession of letters', and it has sought to maintain this role ever since, through interrogating the relationship between works from the past and current critical and theoretical needs. Focusing on the reasons for literary change, the definitions of periods and the evolution of styles, conventions and ideologies, it has been notable for introducing writing from some of the most significant European theorists of the last quarter-century, starting, in the very first issue, with Georges Poulet, on `Phenomenology of Reading', and Robert Weimann, on `Past Significance and Present Meaning in Literary History'. On occasion ± as with the translation of Roland Barthes' `An Introduction to the Structural Analysis of Narrative' which appeared in 1975 ± the journal has been responsible for disseminating through translation work which had been available for some time in its original tongue (Barthes' piece first appeared in the French periodical found
a
whole
Communications in 1966) but which subsequently, and dramatically,
new
Anglophone
audience.
It
has
always
been
open
to
experimental
 le Á ne presentation, whether in the form of Ihab Hassan's `POSTmodernISM' (1971) or He Cixous's introspective `Without End/no/State of Drawingness/no, rather:/The Executioner's Taking off' (1993). More recently, the journal has manifested a self-awareness of its own Euro-and-American centricity: the 1998 issue entitled `Theoretical Explorations', for example, contains an interview with Fredric Jameson, a stalwart contributor to the journal, conducted by Xudong Zhang, which from a Chinese perspective interrogates the relationship between western scholarship and critical theory during the past fifty years.
New Literary History's emphasis has, more than that of most other journals, been on `pure' theory ± on hermeneutics, phenomenology, formalism and concepts of history and ideology.
SubStance (founded 1971) which explicitly devotes itself to issues concerning the
perception of contemporary culture, be these humanistic or scientific in their emphasis, ranges through literary theory, philosophy, psychoanalysis, art criticism and film studies.
diacritics, launched the same year from the Department of Romance Studies at Cornell (again indicative of the impact of European continental thought on the discipline) has similarly always stressed interdisciplinarity in that it is interested in films and drama as well as the written word. From the start it has been deliberately polemical. From 1978, it has quite
explicitly
stated
in
its
editorial
policy
that
it
is
`concerned
primarily
with
the
problems of criticism', its diacritical discussion ± typically taking the form of a review, and a response to the issues raised in the review ± setting out to distinguish `the methodological and
ideological
issues
relation to them'.
which
critics
encounter
and
setting
forth
a
critical
position
in
boundary 2, originating in 1972 from the English Department of the State
University of New York at Binghampton under the editorship of William V. Spanos (and in 1990, when its publication was taken over by Duke University Press, coming under the  ), began as `an guidance of an editorial collective under the overall leadership of Paul Bove international journal of postmodern literature' and now announces itself as `extending beyond the postmodern'. Throughout its history, it has been especially valuable for the political, historical and theoretically informed analysis its contributors have brought to bear on a range of topics and problems within literature and culture, such as Poetry and
the role of journals in theoretical debate Politics
(spring
1999),
Aesthetics
(summer
1998),
189
Edward
Said
(spring
1998)
and
Feminism and Postmodernism (summer 1992). The two issues edited by Donald Pease, in spring 1990 and spring 1992, importantly focused on the redefinition of what may be said to constitute `American' culture in contemporary critical approaches.
Critical Inquiry
, probably as influential as
New Literary History
, albeit, again, in a more
interdisciplinary way, was inaugurated in 1974. On its original title page ± a proclamation almost instantly dropped ± it glossed itself as `A voice for reasoned inquiry into significant creations of the human spirit', and in its first editorial statement, Sheldon Sacks wrote that its instigators were `interested in criticism that aspires to be a special kind of ``learning'' ± not in any sense dispassionate or impersonal but something akin to that fusion of human commitment'. This emphasis was reflected in its first pair of articles, Wayne C. Booth on `Kenneth Burke's Way of Knowing' and a somewhat pained response by Burke himself, and has
been
continued
in
Critical Inquiry
's
willingness
to
publish
articles
which,
while
maintaining scholarly and philosophical rigour, nonetheless find space for the personal voice, the speculative, and the stylistically daring, whether these include Marjorie Garber's speculations concerning ` `` '' ' (1999), or Michael Taussig's meditations on `the beach' (2000), or some of the contributions of the `Intimacy' issue of 1997, with its investigations of the interplay of privacy and public in the intimate sphere.
Critical Inquiry
has a particular
knack for spotting current trends and then interrogating the particular assumptions that are in danger of becoming ossified by them. Thus Homi Bhabha, in his introduction to the `FRONT LINES/BORDER POSTS' number of 1997, writes of how the crossing of cultures, and the hybridity of knowledges and identifications thus produced, have become `the
activity
of a theoretical enterprise that negotiates a range of critical conditions with the
post
mark ± poststructuralist, postfeminist, postcolonial, postmodern'. But why, he asks, `never post-
the other
?'
Certain articles, even if subsequently published in volume form, may be isolated not just for their intrinsic importance, but for their role as setting down pointers for the direction in which subsequent critical trends were to develop. French feminism's introduction into the United States, for example, owes a good deal to the publication in translation of Luce Irigaray's `Et l'une ne bouge pas sans l'autre' in a 1981 issue of
Signs
. Or one might cite
Stephen Greenblatt's formulation of `new historicism' in his introduction to `The Forms of Power and the Forms of Power in the Renaissance', which appeared in a special issue of
Genre
in 1982; or Donna Haraway's launching of the post-gender concept of the cyborg ±
that utopian notion of what humans might just possibly become ± in `A Manifesto for Cyborgs: science, technology, and socialist feminism in the 1980s', in 1985;
or
Homi
Bhabha's
`Signs
Taken
for
Wonders:
authority under a tree outside Delhi, May 1817', in these
cases,
the
authors
subsequently
published
questions
of
Critical Inquiry
these
pieces
as
Socialist Review
ambivalence
,
and
, 1985. In each of
part
of
fuller,
single-
authored volumes, but the ideas they contain received their earliest airings, and established their influence, through journal publication. The journal, too, provides a site for graduate students and others early in their career paths to make an impact before they bring out a whole
book.
In
certain
areas,
and
postcolonial
study
is
perhaps
notable
here,
the
publication of a well-received article can carry at least as much weight as a longer volume. On
occasion,
particular
issues
of
periodicals
have
taken
on
a
seminal
importance,
something reinforced by their subsequent publication in separate volume form. In 1992, Kwame Anthony Appiah and Henry Louis Gates edited the `identity issue' of
Theory
Critical
, which shifted the issue of identity from the terrain of personhood (whether this be
modern north american criticism and theory
190
understood in terms of the individual or community) and resituated it as a question of historical and geographical positioning. Or, to take an earlier example, in 1981
Yale French
Studies published a rare ± for this journal ± feminist issue, edited by a collective of seven Dartmouth faculty women, and combining feminist analysis with psychoanalytic theory: a timely conjunction with the appearance of Irigaray in
Signs. Signs was not, however, the
earliest major journal fostering an analytical response to feminist issues.
Feminist Issues was
started in 1969, early in the contemporary women's movement, by Ann Calderwood, who, as a note from the editors in February 1978 informs us, for years ran it `as an out-of-pocket, out-of-apartment operation. She not only helped to solicit manuscripts and scrupulously edited them, she also set the type, handled the subscriptions, and addressed the envelopes' ±
a
significantly
different
enterprise
from
the
scholarly
journal
with
its
departmental
backing. The journal went mainstream in 1973: while a barometer of changing trends in feminist theory and criticism, it has maintained its explicitly politicized, and optimistic aims of not just interpreting women's experiences, but of changing women's condition, through looking to alter consciousness, social forms and modes of action.
Signs, which
began in 1975 under the editorship of Catherine Stimpson, has consistently published articles which have employed philosophical and conceptual formulations to interrogate the material conditions of women's' lives, and which have, likewise, used concrete practices and examples to challenge theoretical assumptions. Its very first issue, on the theme of power, included Julia Kristeva's `On the Women of China': the first English translation of Kristeva, `among the most provocative and respected contemporary French intellectuals', and its focus has been global ever since, contributing to discussions, within its own pages and elsewhere, of the consistent factors and the necessary variables that must be taken into account in assessing the methodology of feminist theories. A number of other journals devoted to feminist studies have ranged somewhat less widely in their foci.
Tulsa Studies in
Women's Literature (founded in 1982) has a strong tradition of publishing feminist literary analyses and articles on women's literary history.
Hypatia, which first appeared in 1986, has
its roots in the Society for Women in Philosophy: intended to encourage and communicate many different kinds of feminist philosophy, it debates issues of knowledge and identity, particularly at the intersection of gender, race and nation, and discusses the nature of love, desire and the emotions, as well as manifesting an increasing interest in ecofeminism.
camera obscura (1976) has offered innovative (in presentation as well as in critical methodology) feminist perspectives on film, television and visual media. The boundaries of feminist criticism became very fluid from the late 1980s onwards, transforming not just in dialogue with other critical categories, especially those of race (and earlier, class), but under the influence of gender studies. The direction taken by
differences,
founded in 1989 as `a journal of feminist cultural studies' and affiliated with the Pembroke Centre for Teaching and Research on Women at Brown University, is symptomatic of these
developments,
both
in
its
desire
to
interrogate
how
concepts
and
categories
of
difference ± notably but not exclusively gender ± operate within culture. The Fall 1997 number, guest edited by Joan Wallach Scott, epitomizes the anxious self-questioning of the entire field: her own introduction is called `Women's Studies on the Edge', and others are entitled `The ``Women'' in Women's Studies', `The Impossibility of Women's Studies' and `Do Women's + Feminist + Men's + Lesbian and Gay + Queer Studies = Gender Studies?' Having helped to create a field and to disseminate debate within it, the proliferation of subfields bring into question the very identity of the originating field itself.
GLQ (founded
1993) has explicitly taken on board the task of offering queer perspectives on all issues
the role of journals in theoretical debate
191
touching on sex and sexuality, whether these are within law, science, religion, political science
or
literary
periodicals, to
which
and,
cultural
structuralist founded
studies.
in
studies
theory
in
1983
From
particular,
as
a
with
±
the
the
originally,
dominant
an
early
1980s,
character
editorial
an
force
of
import
within
board
the
new
direction
journals,
from
the
co-chaired
Britain
US by
taken
has ±
has
academy. Svetlana
by
reflected
established the
degree
supplanted
post-
Representations was
Alpers
and
Stephen
Greenblatt: the first issue, featuring articles by each of them, also published pieces by D. A. Miller
(English
literature).
literature),
While
its
Thomas
opening
Laqueur
number
(history)
contains
no
and
Jean-Joseph
explicit
editorial
Goux
(French
statement
±
the
approach which was to become labelled `new historicist' is left to speak for itself ± the order form which it contains carried the endorsement of the historian Natalie Zemon Davis, explaining that the periodical will provide `intellectual discovery and delight to the many readers who want to understand how cultural forms are made', and it has continued to provide leadership in the practice of materialist cultural history.
American Literary History
(founded 1989) has notably concerned itself with how one thinks
about America, and has
played a very influential role in shaping the agenda for what constitutes American cultural studies. It has given especial weight not just to the social, economic and political aims of American literature, and to such issues as the reading process, reception and the institution of American criticism, but it has foregrounded the problematics of canon formation, and has emphasized ethnic and native American issues. Likewise,
American Quarterly (1949),
especially under the editorship of Lucy Maddox, has broadened the standard understanding of
what
constitutes
`American
studies',
and
has
hypertext scholarship in the field. In broader terms,
also
started
to
investigate
the
role
of
Social Text (founded 1979) was an early
leader in the area of cultural studies and cultural theory, consistently focusing on gender, sexuality, race, the environment and labour relations: it has been especially notable for the range of provocative interviews it carries. Launched in 1987, the
Yale Journal of Criticism
has published a range of polemical work in the humanities, including not just scholarly articles
and
review
essays,
but
original
artwork,
and
experimental
and
performative
material, developing the possibilities of such critical genres as memoir, confession and fable. More recently still, a number of journals dedicated to analysing cultural practice among specific ethnic groups from theoretically inflected viewpoints have been established, such as the
Journal of Asian American Studies (1998), and Hopscotch (1999), which
looks at a whole range of material from past and present Hispanic cultures, from African slaves to later waves of immigration, covering art, literature, cinema and politics. The 1990s, too, has seen a growth of journals dedicated to specific areas of cross-disciplinarity, bringing critical theory to bear on the intersections between disciplines.
Configurations, for
example, was launched in 1993, and is dedicated to the study of discourse pertaining to the theories and practices of science, technology and medicine, exploring the relationship of literature and the arts to these areas. The next year,
modernism/modernity was founded,
focusing systematically on the methodological, archival and theoretical exigencies particular to modernist ± i.e. post-1860 ± studies, whether in music or architecture, the visual arts or intellectual and literary history. The interest in globalization which one finds within journals, particularly in connection with postcolonial theory, is also reflected in the mobile publishing contexts and histories of some publications. For example, the twice-yearly
History and Memory (founded 1989) is
based in both Tel Aviv and Los Angeles. Unsurprisingly, its emphasis is on historical consciousness, the area in which collective memory, the writing of history and other modes
modern north american criticism and theory
192
of shaping images of the past continually returns to the example of the Holocaust, thus both drawing from and helping to establish the centrality of this atrocity within memory studies, a prominent area of 1990s theoretical investigation.
Transition
was founded in
Uganda by Rajat Neogy in 1961 (suspended 1968±71 and 1977±90): now published in the US as an official publication of the W. E. B. Du Bois Institute under the editorship of Appiah and Gates, it retains a strong African link, not least by having Wole Soyinka as chair
of
its
editorial
board.
It
is
particularly
striking
both
for
its
imaginative
use
of
photography and its incorporation of creative writing, and for its broad-based investigation of ethnic diversities, whether concerning itself with Romanian street children or the legacy of James Baldwin, contemporary Indian fiction or French identity politics.
Callaloo
, started
in 1976 as an offshoot of the creative writing workshops conducted by its editor Charles H. Rowell at Southern University, Baton Rouge, initially fostered the writings of the AfricanAmerican Southern writing community that had emerged in the 1960s and 1970s, but soon became more internationalist in scope, featuring a combination of scholarly and creative writing and visual art from throughout Africa and the African diaspora: as it approached its twenty-fifth anniversary in 2001, the redirection of its mission to `discovering, nurturing, and publishing new and young writers from marginalized communities' was announced. The trend towards globalization ± and the speed of dissemination of ideas which is a key factor
in
periodicals'
power
of
influence
±
has
been
yet
further
accentuated
by
the
development of the on-line journal, whether this puts material from the printed publication onto the web, or whether it exists solely as an e-journal. The latter tend to have irregular postings, and, at least in the realm of literary theory, are less remarkable than individuals' postings on their own websites or one-off projects (the theory sections of the on-line resource, Alan Liu's provide
quick
links
to
Voice of the Shuttle CTHEORY
, at http://vos.ucsb.edu/shuttle/english.html,
such
resources).
,
however
(at
http://ctheory.com)
provides an exception: in existence since 1993, this on-line journal of theory, technology and culture contains a combination of analytical thinking (a series of articles by Jean Baudrillard from 1994 is notable here) and more meditative and creative pieces concerning contemporary culture. Journals invite their own mode of reading, which differs from single-authored volumes. The juxtaposition of articles both engages the conceptual imagination of the browsing reader, who may, among the heterogenous offerings, serendipitously encounter new ideas that
they
would
not
otherwise
have
been
let
to
read.
Undoubtedly,
the
energetic
enthusiasm shown by American university presses (who derive a considerable percentage of their profits from journal publication) to launch and devote journals dedicated wholly or largely to theoretical matters has had an enormous effect on the spread and popularization of theory throughout the American academy and, indeed, further afield. The economic advantages to college libraries of an annual journal subscription, as opposed to buying a handful of books, are obvious: both a range of viewpoints, and information and opinion about volume publications, are placed into rapid circulation, and an atmosphere of debate, even
urgency,
created.
In
turn,
this
generates
discussion
about
the
degree
to
which
American concerns translate, or fail to be readily adaptable, to other localized sites.
Kate Flint
whiteness studies
193
Further reading and works cited Association of American University Presses. http://aaup.princeton.edu/journals/subjects/ Chielens, E. E. (ed.)
CTHEORY,
American Literary Magazines.
Westport, CT, 1986.
however. http://ctheory.com
PMLA 1884±1982', PMLA, 99, Around 1981: Academic Feminist Literary Theory. London, 1992. Voice of the Shuttle. http://vos.ucsb.edu/shuttle/english.html
Fisher, J. H. `Remembrance and Reflection:
1984.
Gallop, J. Liu, A.
Project Muse. http://muse.jhu/journals/index.html
26. Whiteness Studies
Whiteness studies investigates the parameters of white racial identity, locating its scope and function in systems of representation. This field of study takes as its founding premise the constructed nature of identity, a poststructuralist concept heralded by race theorists who
argue
that
race
itself
is
not
a
natural
or
biological
category
but
rather
a
social
construction given meaning through historical contexts. Whiteness studies gained academic prominence in the 1990s after minority theorists such as Toni Morrison and bell hooks challenged white critics to examine their own `racial' speaking position instead of solely focusing on the `Other'. The rise of multiculturalism and the pluralization of `the canon' did much to further whiteness studies; as ethnic traditions gained visibility and strength, many critics questioned why texts written predominantly by white male authors had never been treated as `white' texts but rather as `universal' texts representing all people. This tendency of whiteness to occlude or erase markers of particularity is now recognized as one of its characteristics. Investigations in the field have spread from feminism, labour history and literary studies to cultural studies, psychoanalysis and beyond. Whiteness studies owes it origins in part to all of those who have agitated against the privileges
of
`white
skin',
who
have
sought
to
unsettle
social,
political
and
economic
hierarchies based upon categories of race. While movements against social injustice have occurred across disciplines and beyond the academy, whiteness studies in its current sense finds
articulation
privilege'
and
primarily
power
through
through
the
academic
analysis
of
theorists
who
whiteness.
focus
This
on
critical
upsetting project
`white
finds
its
antecedents in the works of writers of colour who have examined the characteristics of white identity. Most germane for contemporary studies is the work of Langston Hughes and W. E. B. Du Bois. In 1926, Hughes published `The Negro Artist and the Racial Mountain' that outlined the attributes of ` ``white'' culture', a culture distinguished by rigid `manners, morals and Puritan standards' (694). For him, whiteness operates as a set of oppressive beliefs and values which could be adopted at will; he describes `this urge within the [black] race towards whiteness, the desire to pour racial individuality into the mold of American standardization, and to be as little Negro and as much American as possible' (692). Hughes' assimilation theory finds voice in later sociological renderings of Americanization and contemporary theories on whiteness. As a historian and race theorist, W. E. B. Du Bois
whiteness studies
193
Further reading and works cited Association of American University Presses. http://aaup.princeton.edu/journals/subjects/ Chielens, E. E. (ed.)
CTHEORY,
American Literary Magazines.
Westport, CT, 1986.
however. http://ctheory.com
PMLA 1884±1982', PMLA, 99, Around 1981: Academic Feminist Literary Theory. London, 1992. Voice of the Shuttle. http://vos.ucsb.edu/shuttle/english.html
Fisher, J. H. `Remembrance and Reflection:
1984.
Gallop, J. Liu, A.
Project Muse. http://muse.jhu/journals/index.html
26. Whiteness Studies
Whiteness studies investigates the parameters of white racial identity, locating its scope and function in systems of representation. This field of study takes as its founding premise the constructed nature of identity, a poststructuralist concept heralded by race theorists who
argue
that
race
itself
is
not
a
natural
or
biological
category
but
rather
a
social
construction given meaning through historical contexts. Whiteness studies gained academic prominence in the 1990s after minority theorists such as Toni Morrison and bell hooks challenged white critics to examine their own `racial' speaking position instead of solely focusing on the `Other'. The rise of multiculturalism and the pluralization of `the canon' did much to further whiteness studies; as ethnic traditions gained visibility and strength, many critics questioned why texts written predominantly by white male authors had never been treated as `white' texts but rather as `universal' texts representing all people. This tendency of whiteness to occlude or erase markers of particularity is now recognized as one of its characteristics. Investigations in the field have spread from feminism, labour history and literary studies to cultural studies, psychoanalysis and beyond. Whiteness studies owes it origins in part to all of those who have agitated against the privileges
of
`white
skin',
who
have
sought
to
unsettle
social,
political
and
economic
hierarchies based upon categories of race. While movements against social injustice have occurred across disciplines and beyond the academy, whiteness studies in its current sense finds
articulation
privilege'
and
primarily
power
through
through
the
academic
analysis
of
theorists
who
whiteness.
focus
This
on
critical
upsetting project
`white
finds
its
antecedents in the works of writers of colour who have examined the characteristics of white identity. Most germane for contemporary studies is the work of Langston Hughes and W. E. B. Du Bois. In 1926, Hughes published `The Negro Artist and the Racial Mountain' that outlined the attributes of ` ``white'' culture', a culture distinguished by rigid `manners, morals and Puritan standards' (694). For him, whiteness operates as a set of oppressive beliefs and values which could be adopted at will; he describes `this urge within the [black] race towards whiteness, the desire to pour racial individuality into the mold of American standardization, and to be as little Negro and as much American as possible' (692). Hughes' assimilation theory finds voice in later sociological renderings of Americanization and contemporary theories on whiteness. As a historian and race theorist, W. E. B. Du Bois
modern north american criticism and theory
194
explores the labour arena, defining whiteness as a set of benefits white workers accrue which offset any economic disadvantages they may experience in a classed society. In his
Black Reconstruction in America , he argued that white workers received a `public and
study
psychological wage' which included `public deference', access to public facilities, judgement in a court of law by peers of one's racial group, better schools, etc. to compensate for economic inequities (1975, 700±1). Instead of fighting for all workers to forward the cause of democracy, white workers turned to racism for social and political gain (30). Labour historians rely on Du Bois's constructs to understand white working-class identity today. Research in the history of white racism also serves as a backdrop for contemporary whiteness studies whose critics rely on a range of analytic tools borrowed from a number of disciplines ± psychoanalysis, cultural studies, marxism among others ± to understand the persistence of `white skin privilege'. Early psycho-cultural studies locate a combination of cultural and psychological forces as the source of white identity. Winthrop Jordan's
White
Over Black serves as a case in point. Jordan outlines the ways Elizabethan concepts of blackness and darkness, whiteness informed
the
imaginary
and light
constructs
of
(to symbolize evil and
colonizing
Europeans
who
good respectively) perceived
African-
Americans as sexualized primitives and Native Americans as errant savages. Like others who
followed,
Jordan
relies
on
psychoanalytic
theory
to
show
how
a
certain
psychic
splitting and projection occurs, an interpretative process which remains in vogue even if the
psychological
explanations
for
such
projections
vary.
Jordan's
approach
garners
criticism for being ahistorical and dependent on the concept of a collective psyche whose existence cannot be supported (Saxton 1990, 11±12). Many historians turn instead to a socio-economic example
in
approach,
Edmund
S.
one
which
Morgan's
finds
its
most
well
regarded
and
comprehensive
American Slavery/American Freedom: The Ordeal of
Colonial Virginia. According to Morgan, racism did not originate overseas but rather found root on American soil among legislators who sought to control the labour force through racial division. Fearing the combined uprising of African-American slaves and European-American
bond-labourers
following
Bacon's Rebellion of
1676, the
Virginia
Assembly passed a series of acts meant to `foster the contempt of whites for blacks and Indians' (1975, 331). Sounding much like Du Bois, Morgan argues that such laws provided `social, psychological, and political advantages' to white labourers to encourage them to align their loyalties with Anglo slave holders (1975, 344). While Morgan's work retains wide currency, he fails to consider the persistence of racism and white identifications under other economic and social circumstances. Contemporary theorists such as David Roedigger and Alexander Saxton instead rely on ideological arguments to more completely explain the existence of racism, strategies now widely adopted by whiteness critics. Saxton, for example, argues that racism is not simply economically driven but rather constitutes a system of beliefs and values which shape `reality'. Like Morgan, Saxton gives weight to economic benefits but, turning to the theories of Italian Communist Antonio Gramsci, stresses more completely the manner in which social identities are constructed through scientific, historical, religious and economic discourses intended to sustain class hegemony (1990, 13±15). In
The Rise and Fall of the White Republic, he points to the origins of racism
in the mid-fourteen hundreds when Western Europeans sought to expand and conquer in their
desire
skinned,
to
while
accumulate the
peoples
capital. they
He
writes,
encountered
`Since are
Europeans
generally
were
dark,
for
generally three
and
whitea
half
centuries basic human relationships centered on the domination of whites over people of color'
(14).
Racism
became
a
series
of
discourses
which
supported
such
hierarchies,
whiteness studies
195
expressed through the religious and scientific theories of the nineteenth and twentieth centuries (15). Whiteness studies also locates its historical origins in the first and second wave of AngloAmerican feminism which, with its failure to attend to racial identity, enacted its own racial ideology. Instead of locating themselves as middle-class white women, activists and academics tended to focus on gender as the only significant axis of identity. In the early  n among 1980s, women of colour such as bell hooks, Barbara Christian and Norma Alarco others protested widely, showing how racism pervaded the (white) women's movement that took as its primary subject, in its early years, the oppression and plight of (white) domestic housewives. Adrienne Rich suggests that early white feminists suffered from a type of `white solipsism ± not the consciously held
belief that one race is inherently superior
to all others, but a tunnel-vision which simply does not see non-white experience or existence as precious or significant' (1979, 306). French feminists, of course, were guilty of the same oversight. The privileging of gender as the initial site of oppression found its way into
feminist
psychoanalysis
in
which
white
feminist
theorists
argued
that
all
other
oppressions, such as race and class, find their origins in the recognition of sexual difference. In the mid to late 1980s, white academic feminists responded in part by trying to build coalitions with women of colour or by shifting their attention from texts written by white women to those authored by minority writers. Such moves unfortunately left unexamined whiteness as a speaking position and inadvertently reactivated traditional hierarchies in which the `Other' either became responsible for educating whites about the nature of her oppression or once again became the object of investigation. The real work on whiteness did not take place until writers such as Marilyn Frye and Peggy McIntosh sought to give voice to the nature of whiteness and white privilege. Frye offered what is now considered common
sense to whiteness theorists. She writes, referring
to herself and other white
feminists, `[I]t never occurred to us to modify our nouns . . .; to our minds the people we were writing about were
people.
We don't think of ourselves as
white.
It is an important
breakthrough for a member of a dominant group to come to know s/he is a member of a
group,
. . . only
`invisible
a part
knapsack'
of humanity' (1983, 117). McIntosh outlined the contents of an
of
`skin-colour
privileges'
benefiting
those
phenotypically
white
±
again reminiscent of Du Bois's wage ± including varied images in greeting cards, dolls, toys, etc. to curriculum materials, welcoming attitudes in middle- to upper-class neighbourhoods, wide representation in courts of law and police forces, and easy access to simple items appropriate for one's group such as hair care products and `flesh' colour bandages (1990, 33±4). Such observations corresponded with the work of Richard Dyer, a film critic, whose ideas now form the bedrock of the field. In his study of US and British popular films, he compares the way whiteness functions representationally in US and British culture to colour theory:
Black is always marked as a colour (as the term `coloured' egregiously acknowledges), and is always particularizing; whereas white is not anything really, not an identity, not a particularising quality, because it is everything ± white is no colour because it is all colours. This property of whiteness, to be everything and nothing, is the source of its representational power. (1988, 45)
Whiteness tends to be `subsumed into other identities' (45), much like Hughes' equation of whiteness with `American standardization'; whites tend to identify themselves according to nation, region, gender or class, etc. rather then race so that the explicit characteristics of
modern north american criticism and theory
196
whiteness disappear behind the definitions of the `norm' (46). As Dyer notes, `Power in contemporary society habitually passes itself off as embodied in the normal as opposed to the superior' (45). Such a sense of invisibility makes it difficult to name the ways white domination operates; whites tend to experience their identities more as a case of `historical accident, rather than a characteristic cultural/historical construction, achieved through white domination' (46). Dyer's advances in film study found reflection in the scholarship of Toni Morrison who
Michigan Quarterly Review
in a 1989 article in the widely known study
articulated the premises of her more
Playing in the Dark: Whiteness and the Literary Imagination .
She brings
whiteness to the forefront of the literary arena, asking readers to consider ways American literature is shaped by white imaginations responding to an African-American presence and
more
inclusively
to
`Africanism',
`the
denotative
and
connotative
blackness
that
African peoples have come to signify' (1992, 6). Her work fundamentally shifted the focus for many literary critics from the conceptualization of American literature as representing `universal' themes to a literature in which race functions as a founding marker of identity. Morrison writes, `Africanism is inextricable from the definition of Americanness' (65): `[I]ndividualism is foregrounded (and believed in) when its background is stereotypified, enforced dependency. Freedom (to move, to earn, to learn, to be allied with a powerful centre, to narrate the world) can be relished more deeply in a cheek-by-jowl existence with the bound and unfree, the economically oppressed, the marginalized, the silenced' (64). Huck's freedom and individuality becomes visible in light of Jim's enslavement. Morrison's critique centres not only on the books themselves but also on critics who historically have ignored figurations of race. Her work has revolutionized American literary studies and has spawned countless investigations, from rereadings of American `classics' such as Melville's
Moby Dick Pym,
(racing the white whale) and Edgar Allan Poe's
The Voyage of Arthur Gordon
to surveys of whiteness in early American literature, regional literature, modernist
drama and poetry, and contemporary fiction by writers of all ethnic backgrounds. Coincident with Morrison's breakthrough in literary analysis was David Roedigger's innovations
in
labour
Alexander Saxton's
history.
While
The Wages of Whiteness
Roedigger's
The Rise and Fall of the White Republic,
followed
it made a more lasting impact
on the field. Roedigger refuses traditional marxist tendencies to privilege class over race, an act which erases the relational and integrated nature of the terms. He rejects the simplicity of earlier split-market labour theories which located fault with the ruling class for the promotion of racism. Such theories position workers, Roedigger argues, as innocent `dupes' instead of participants in their own ideological becoming, constructing their identities in response to a range of economic and social pressures (1999, 9). He turns to Du Bois's concept
of
the
`public
and
psychological
wage'
and
the
linguistic
theories
of
Mikhail
Bakhtin who, in Roedigger's words, reveals the ways meaning is `socially contested . . . neither absent nor unconnected with social relations' (15). Roedigger traces the way white workers linguistically registered racial identity in the urban North in the early nineteenth century.
For
example,
white
labourers
adopted
the
signifier
`help'
and
`hired
man'
to
replace the word `servant' (synonymous with `slave' at the time) (47±8) and `boss' to replace `master' (54). Such assertions signalled their membership in a free republic and difference from the bound, servile black population of the South (49). Roedigger also makes a considerable contribution to interpretations of black minstrelsy. He argues that the popularity
of
`preindustrial
minstrelsy past'
in
which
Northern
blacks
cities
in
represented
the
(97).
early
1800s
Driven
by
signalled a
a
capitalist
desire regime
for
a
that
whiteness studies
197
required more and more regimentation in daily living, white labourers turned to blacks to express their own desire for spontaneity. Roedigger's work finds later comment in texts which more completely address the changing face of minstrelsy and the anxieties which surround white working-class masculinity. Such early work on whiteness has resulted in a burgeoning of whiteness studies such that critics no longer separate race from gender or class. Advances have been made across the spectrum, most notably in gender and cultural studies. The meanings of white femininity have found critical comment, from histories on the construction of white womanhood during the suffrage, abolitionist and women's movements to contemporary investigations into the meaning of whiteness for white women in today's world. To a far greater extent, however,
white
straight
masculinity
has
attracted
critical
attention,
with
particular
emphasis placed on a culture of white male victimhood which has emerged in response to advances in feminism, civil rights and economic changes that have disempowered the working-class white male since the 1950s. Reactions against affirmative action and gay rights legislation have helped fuel an image of white heterosexual manhood as under siege. Critics have tracked this image through the popular press, film and the predominately white men's movement of the 1980s, unpacking the ways in which white masculinity is constructed as multivalent and contested. For example, in his inaugural study
Studies in Postmodern Domination and Difference , straight
masculinity
megalomania,
is
a
`single,
instrumental
monolithic
rationality,
and
White Guys:
Fred Pfeil challenges the belief that white
category the
...
shot
obsessive
through
desire
for
with
violence,
recognition
and
definition through conquest' (1995, viii). He suggests it functions as a `dialectical coconstruction whose on-going identity is at least partially dependent on the very forms and modalities of femininity it seeks to dominate and control' (ix). He argues that like other identities,
`the
modalities
of
white
straight
masculinity
are
multiple,
and/or
riven
by
contradictions and fissures, and and/or subject to flux and change' (x). Such advances in gender and race theory throw in question any easy opposition between races or genders and highlight
the
limits
of
multiculturalism.
If
all
identities
result
from
historical
change,
varying according to social context, it becomes difficult to maintain the oppositions that gave birth to whiteness studies as an area of academic study. As the field reaches the end of its first decade of study, it wobbles on its ontological moorings. Some regard it as a form of `vulgar multiculturalism' in which whiteness becomes essentialized as evil (Wray and Newitz 1997, 12, note 7). Repeated characteristics attached to the category create a form of cultural racism, replacing earlier biological forms. Matt Wray and Annalee Newitz argue that not all forms of whiteness function oppressively. In their anthology
White Trash: Race and Class in America,
the authors, paraphrasing the words
of John Waters, write, ` ``white'' trash' is not just a classic slur ± it's also a racial epithet that marks out certain whites as a breed apart, a dysgenic race unto themselves' (1997, 2). Pointing to the eugenic studies of the early twentieth century which labelled poor whites as inferior, Wray and Newitz suggest that the category of white trash resists what one might call the `invisibility' argument of Dyer in favour of a certain visibility ± in scientific studies and more recently in the media and popular culture. Elvis becomes the white trash king and pornographic movies are analysed as a form of `social and moral protest' (10). The anthology usefully draws attention to the ways `white trash' as a signifier alleviates middleand upper-class anxiety about class inequities in a democratic yet capitalist culture. Yet simultaneously it seeks to claim a place for `white trash' alongside other ethnic groups. The authors write: `[W]hite trash is one place multiculturalism might look for a white identity
modern north american criticism and theory
198
which does not view itself as the norm from which all other races and ethnicities deviate' (5). While Wray and Newitz argue that `[p]erhaps white trash can also provide a corrective to what has been called a ``vulgar multiculturalist'' assumption that whiteness must always equal terror and racism' (5), they veer towards creating the very dynamics they seek to avoid. Lower-class whites become stripped of racial privileges to be located as `victims', a position
that
bespeak
a
belies
certain
work
desire
to to
date
on
locate
working-class
whiteness
whiteness.
outside
of
its
The
authors' comments
historical
constructions
as
dominating in ways that throw the goals of the larger critical project into disarray. Similarly,
while
anthologies,
panels,
special
issues
and
articles
reveal
an
ardent
en-
thusiasm to eradicate `white skin privilege', their very existence may have the opposite effect in the academy. In 1997, Howard Winant charged that studies that aim to `abolish whiteness' may actually preserve the category in order to transcend it. Most representative of such studies was Noel Ignatiev and John Garvey's activist/academic journal
Race Traitor,
an early 1990s series republished as an anthology in 1996. The authors sought to move beyond academic meditations on whiteness to actions individuals could take to `abolish' the `white club', `which grants privileges to certain people in return for obedience to its rules' (1996, 35). Winant's charge find its echo in criticism of the rise of whiteness studies which suffers, many argue, from a certain narcissism, or willingness to dwell on racial subjectivity by those who are `white', redirecting academic attention once again from margin to centre. Such an appropriation of margins offers white critics a new opportunity to enter the multicultural fray, having found a sanctioned enterprise for hawking academic wares on the marketable topic of race. Despite
such
criticism
and
epistemological
dangers,
the
future
of
whiteness
studies
remains hopeful. While many critics have investigated the ways whiteness depends on blackness for definition (either through contrast or appropriation of cultural forms), several now acknowledge the ways whiteness functions antithetically or multiply in relation to a range
of
other
ethnic
interrogations of
identities.
whiteness
in
The
the
cultural
studies
popular media,
arena
from
has
Rush
exploded
Limbaugh
with
talk
varied
shows
to
country music. In addition, critics working within gay and lesbian studies are helping shed the light on the long association of white maleness with heterosexuality. Finally, interesting work has emerged which looks at whiteness as a series of performative acts, whether that be in ethnographies, in which women of colour assume a white masculinist gaze in order to critique it, to the performance of whiteness on stage as a deconstructive act. The inventiveness of such strategies for `seeing' whiteness bodes well for a future that may be textured and rich, one which moves beyond analyses of United States culture as vested completely within black and white dualities.
Betsy Nies
Further reading and works cited Allen, T. Babb, V.
The Invention of the White Race. Whiteness Visible.
Delgado, R. and Stefanic, J. (eds) Du Bois, W. E. B. Dyer, R. `White', Frankenberg, R.
London, 1994.
New York, 1998.
Critical Whiteness Studies.
Black Reconstruction in America.
Screen,
Philadelphia, 1997.
New York, 1975.
29, 4, Autumn 1988.
White Women, Race Matters.
Minneapolis, MN, 1993.
masculinity and cultural studies Ð (ed.)
Displacing Whiteness.
Frye, M.
The Politics of Reality.
Hill, M. (ed.)
Whiteness.
199
Durham, NC, 1997. New York, 1983.
New York, 1997.
Hughes, L. `The Negro Artist and the Racial Mountain', Ignatiev, N.
How the Irish Became White.
Ð and Garvey, J. Jordan, W. D.
Race Traitor.
Lott, E.
Morrison, T.
Pfeil, F.
31±6, Winter, 1990. New York, 1975.
New York, 1992. Durham, NC, 1998.
London, 1995.
On Lies, Secrets, and Silence.
Roedigger, D. Ð.
National Manhood.
White Guys.
Rich, A.
Independent School,
American Slavery/American Freedom.
Playing in the Dark.
Nelson, D. D.
New York, 1996.
New York, 1993.
McIntosh, P. `White Privilege', Morgan, E. S.
Chapel Hill, NC, 1968.
White by Law.
Love and Theft.
122, 3181, 23 June 1926.
New York, 1996.
White Over Black.
Lopez, I. F. Haney.
The Nation,
New York, 1995.
New York, 1979.
Towards the Abolition of Whiteness.
Wages of Whiteness,
London, 1994.
afterword D. Roedigger. London, 1999.
differences: A Journal of Feminist Cultural Studies,
Savran, D. `The Sadomasochist in the Closet',
8, 2,
1996. Saxton, A. Ware V.
The Rise and Fall of the White Republic.
Beyond the Pale.
London, 1990.
London, 1992.
Winant, H. `Behind Blue Eyes', in Wray, M. and Newitz, A. (eds)
Off White,
White Trash.
eds Michele Fine et al. New York, 1997.
New York, 1997.
27. Masculinity and Cultural Studies
What does it mean to be a man? One response to this question is fairly straightforward: one might define being a man in terms of biology, the possession of a male anatomy, and in particular, of course, the possession of the principal sign of sexual difference, the penis. But being is, of course, not merely a biological fact, since we exist and become conscious of ourselves and others within culture, within, that is, a system or systems of values. It is through culture, then, that we begin to attribute and internalize a certain significance to being one sex or another, so that being a man is as much about the consequences attendant on the possession of a particular anatomy as it is about the mere possession of it. Hence, the familiar distinction made in gender studies between sex and gender, where sex denotes biology,
and
gender
those
cultural
norms
conventionally
attributed
to
biological
sex.
Masculinity, then, is the gender associated with maleness, and in essentialist thinking is considered the natural expression of this biological condition, whereas in cultural studies, which broadly challenges the conservatism of such forms of essentialism, masculinity is regarded as a construction grounded in nothing more than social discourses and practices. Consequently,
this
cultural
studies
perspective
promotes
the
view
that
the
qualities
associated with masculinity are open to challenge and change. In more recent work, as we will see, the `necessity' of viewing masculinity as an expression of maleness ± whether culturally conditioned or otherwise ± has even been called into question.
masculinity and cultural studies Ð (ed.)
Displacing Whiteness.
Frye, M.
The Politics of Reality.
Hill, M. (ed.)
Whiteness.
199
Durham, NC, 1997. New York, 1983.
New York, 1997.
Hughes, L. `The Negro Artist and the Racial Mountain', Ignatiev, N.
How the Irish Became White.
Ð and Garvey, J. Jordan, W. D.
Race Traitor.
Lott, E.
Morrison, T.
Pfeil, F.
31±6, Winter, 1990. New York, 1975.
New York, 1992. Durham, NC, 1998.
London, 1995.
On Lies, Secrets, and Silence.
Roedigger, D. Ð.
National Manhood.
White Guys.
Rich, A.
Independent School,
American Slavery/American Freedom.
Playing in the Dark.
Nelson, D. D.
New York, 1996.
New York, 1993.
McIntosh, P. `White Privilege', Morgan, E. S.
Chapel Hill, NC, 1968.
White by Law.
Love and Theft.
122, 3181, 23 June 1926.
New York, 1996.
White Over Black.
Lopez, I. F. Haney.
The Nation,
New York, 1995.
New York, 1979.
Towards the Abolition of Whiteness.
Wages of Whiteness,
London, 1994.
afterword D. Roedigger. London, 1999.
differences: A Journal of Feminist Cultural Studies,
Savran, D. `The Sadomasochist in the Closet',
8, 2,
1996. Saxton, A. Ware V.
The Rise and Fall of the White Republic.
Beyond the Pale.
London, 1990.
London, 1992.
Winant, H. `Behind Blue Eyes', in Wray, M. and Newitz, A. (eds)
Off White,
White Trash.
eds Michele Fine et al. New York, 1997.
New York, 1997.
27. Masculinity and Cultural Studies
What does it mean to be a man? One response to this question is fairly straightforward: one might define being a man in terms of biology, the possession of a male anatomy, and in particular, of course, the possession of the principal sign of sexual difference, the penis. But being is, of course, not merely a biological fact, since we exist and become conscious of ourselves and others within culture, within, that is, a system or systems of values. It is through culture, then, that we begin to attribute and internalize a certain significance to being one sex or another, so that being a man is as much about the consequences attendant on the possession of a particular anatomy as it is about the mere possession of it. Hence, the familiar distinction made in gender studies between sex and gender, where sex denotes biology,
and
gender
those
cultural
norms
conventionally
attributed
to
biological
sex.
Masculinity, then, is the gender associated with maleness, and in essentialist thinking is considered the natural expression of this biological condition, whereas in cultural studies, which broadly challenges the conservatism of such forms of essentialism, masculinity is regarded as a construction grounded in nothing more than social discourses and practices. Consequently,
this
cultural
studies
perspective
promotes
the
view
that
the
qualities
associated with masculinity are open to challenge and change. In more recent work, as we will see, the `necessity' of viewing masculinity as an expression of maleness ± whether culturally conditioned or otherwise ± has even been called into question.
modern north american criticism and theory
200
This approach to masculinity within cultural studies is largely a product of feminist thinking
from
the
late
1960s
and
1970s
which
interrogated
the
relationship
between
female and feminine, arguing that the assumed `naturalness' of the relationship between these was one of the crucial means by which women were oppressed. Indeed, it is possible to see the contemporary interest in masculinity as arising from this period, specifically as a response to feminist concerns and the issues that these raised for men, since
men, in
patriarchal society, were the problem, the ones who exercised, or were at least invested with, power. Andrew Tolson's book,
The Limits of Masculinity
, for instance, emerged from
his involvement with a men's group formed in response to feminist challenges to the privileges and powers accorded to men, though that experience was the reverse of the kind of empowerment which women's groups emphasized at that time:
In all our practical activities, we faced an immediate contradiction. As men, as the agents of a patriarchal culture, we remained the dominant gender. In a certain sense, we were imperialists in a rebellion of slaves ± concerned, defensively, about the threat to our privilege. The very notion of `men's politics' was paradoxical. We had no experience of sexual oppression, violence, jokes at our expense. There were no issues to unite us ± no basis for action against a system that already operates in our favour. (Tolson 1977, 143)
Tolson therefore highlights one of the problems with studies of masculinity and what has become known in some quarters as `men's studies', and some feminists have remained suspicious of this increasingly common focus. In her critique of Kaja Silverman's book
Subjectivity at the Margins well
and
good
for
Male
, for instance, Abigail Solomon-Godeau writes that `It is all very
male
scholars
and
theorists
to
problematize
their
penises,
or
their
Á cle . . . in which, relations to them, but is this so very different from a postmodern mal de sie once again, it is male subjectivity that becomes the privileged term' (1995, 76). Whether or not the growth in studies of masculinity is itself a manifestation of the male ego's typical absorption in self-pity at a time of emotional change, it does appear to be the case that the contemporary interest in masculinity ± and not just in the academy ± is related to
social
changes
in
men's
roles.
Lynne
Segal,
writing
in
1997,
points
out
that
the
`ineluctable rise in men's studies and the accompanying glut of books on masculinity (over 400 new texts in the last 10 years alone), register a topic newly fraught with personal doubts, social anxieties and conceptual fragmentation' (1997, xii), and this surge in interest in masculinity is characteristic of literary and cultural studies on both sides of the Atlantic (I will be discussing both British and US work here). It has even become conventional to talk about a `crisis in masculinity'. But if there is such a crisis it is not only bound up with the
impact
of
feminism
±
though
we
shouldn't
minimize
feminism's
social
gains
in
challenging, for instance, men's leadership in the workplace, or the automatic assumption that
the
women's
heterosexual sexual
role
male
is
should
primarily
be
to
a
family's
service
the
breadwinner, requirements
or of
the men.
conviction Men's
that
sense
of
diminishing power is also related to other, economic changes; principally, the erosion of job security as a consequence of the economic policies which have dominated government policies in Britain and the US since the 1980s (on this see, for instance, Rutherford 1996, 4±5).
Of
course,
no
one
±
other
than,
possibly,
the
CBI
and
other
such
employers'
representatives ± would want to celebrate the economic disempowerment of male workers, but one problem with the resistance to, or dissatisfaction with, such transformations is that it is often expressed in gendered terms and in ways which result in women bearing the brunt of the anger that is generated.
masculinity and cultural studies
201
Consequently, while the academic world has seen the rise of studies of masculinity in response to the changes outlined above, outside it we have witnessed the emergence of anti-feminist movements and spokespersons, as well as other less explicitly reactionary, but nonetheless problematic, social phenomena which betoken a resistance to change. We have seen in the US in the early 1990s, for instance, the emergence of the men's movement inspired
by
the
mythopoetic
writings
of
Robert
Bly,
encouraging
men
to
separate
themselves from women in order to commune with their inner masculinity (see Schwalbe 1996). In Britain, we have witnessed the New Laddism associated with various men's magazines, representing a transmutation, rather than a transformation, of masculinity in its combination of a self-consciousness ± possibly even an ironic consciousness ± of aspects of masculinity with a reluctance to abandon its privileges, reflecting in this way a disjuncture between traditionally defined roles and changing realities. But
even
though
I've
begun
to
touch
here
on
the
historically
variable
nature
of
masculinity, there has still been a tendency in my account so far to write about it as if it were a coherent and easily recognizable phenomenon. When we start to consider the qualities associated with the term, however, what should strike us is the diversity, even contradictoriness, connotes
of
rationality
masculinity
is
the
its
connotations.
and
self-control.
struggle
to
tame
In
certain
Jonathan
and
subdue
contexts,
Rutherford the
for
instance,
argues
emotional
and
that
masculinity
`A
sexual
history self
and
of to
recognise the ascendant and superior nature of reason and thought' (Rutherford 1996, 26). Yet
often
sexual
masculinity
virility.
is
Indeed,
associated
such
is
the
with
an
uncontainable
diversity
of
ways
in
aggression
which
or
(threatening)
masculinity
has
been
constructed, enacted or even embodied, that it has become usual to talk in the plural of masculinities, rather than of a singular masculinity (though we might also want to consider the limits to such fashionable pluralizing since masculinity cannot be endlessly variable without ceasing to be recognizable as a phenomenon, and it is surely at least as important to develop some sense of those overarching features which render different forms of masculinity still discernibly masculine). Herbert Sussman has pointed out that `the emphasis on the constructed rather than the innate, and on the multiple rather than the unitary view of the masculine calls attention to the historical contingency of such formations of manliness and of male power itself, thus questioning male dominance and supporting the possibility of altering the configuration of what is marked as masculine' (Sussman 1995, 9), and, indeed, one of the features of studies of masculinity has been to emphasize its historically variant features. In the twentieth century, for instance, masculinity has tended to be defined against homosexuality since homosexuality has tended to connote effeminacy (even though there are masculine, even macho,
styles
of
homosexuality,
it
is
a
common
feature
of
gay
personal
ads
that
an
individual will describe himself as `straight acting', thus confirming the elision between homosexuality and effeminacy). Eve Sedgwick has famously noted that in the spectrum of different forms of male homosociality, or male bonding, ranging from business contacts to sports
camaraderie
to
sexual
relations
between
men,
there
is
a
`prohibitive
structural
obstacle' (Sedgwick 1985, 3) in the form of homophobia which renders that spectrum discontinuous. Yet, as Alan Sinfield has recently argued, prior to the Oscar Wilde trials in 1895 the effeminacy of the dandy tended to be associated with a generalized libertinism, and only after this watershed was the specific cultural link established between homosexuality and effeminacy (Sinfield 1994). The change signalled by the Wilde trial is a particularly dramatic one, whereas typically changes in gender formations tend to take
modern north american criticism and theory
202
rather longer and may be uneven, but nonetheless it is indicative of the extent to which constructions of gender are subject to historical forces.
Masculinity and history In the short space available here, it would be impossibly reductive to attempt a survey of the extensive historicist work on masculinity. What I intend to do, therefore, is to provide some sense of the work that has been carried out in one particular historical period which has seen a significant increase in the number of texts on this subject ± the Victorian period ± while at the same time using this work to signal certain broader themes in the treatment of masculinity. One of the classic texts in the discussion of masculinity in the Victorian period is that of Leonore Davidoff and Catherine Hall,
Family Fortunes
. This charts the ways in which both
masculinity and femininity were constructed by the economically, and therefore culturally, increasingly important middle class. Davidoff and Hall's approach to the study of gender, in itself, alerts us to the ways in which particular expressions of gender have been bound up with other forms of difference (in this case, class, but other studies have focused on the determining forces of `race' and nation). They argue that a religious, and especially Pauline, discourse of male dominance was reinforced by an increasing physical segregation of work and domestic space in the spatial organization of nineteenth-century industrial cities, as businesses and factories were located away from suburban living areas, thus consolidating and intensifying the distinctions between public and private, masculine and feminine, and helping to constitute the Victorian `separate spheres' ideology (Davidoff and Hall 1987). But Davidoff and Hall's account does not represent an exhaustive discussion of the multiple determinants of gendered identity in the Victorian period. Medical discourse is also crucial to Victorian perceptions of masculinity and femininity, though in ways which connect Victorian perceptions with more persistent attitudes. Simone de Beauvoir has pointed out that man `thinks of his body as a direct and normal connection with the world, which he believes he apprehends objectively, whereas he regards the body of woman as a hindrance' (Beauvoir 1972, 15). The status of women's perceptions as bound up with an overwhelming
subjectivity
in the Victorian period was a consequence of their supposed
greater susceptibility to nervous instability, ultimately to hysteria, something confirmed by the medical discourses about the nervous system which developed in the late eighteenth century (see Logan 1997). The consequences of this discourse were particularly important, not
merely
in
terms
of
specific
relations
between
men
and
women,
but
in
terms
of
consolidating the conservatism of Victorian attitudes, since, as I have argued elsewhere, revolutionary politics in the period following the French Revolution were perceived as hysterical in contrast to the `rational', gradualist and therefore manly character of British politics (Alderson 1998, esp. 34±9). In this sense, manliness was at the heart of an English ± and, by extension, British ± national character. That same stable, manly sensibility which was considered definitive of British constitutional politics, though, was also considered to be a specifically Anglo-Saxon trait (Alderson 1998, 32±4), and this further reflects the way in which gender has been bound up with race and colonialism. Other races ± notably, among European races, the Celts (Cairns and Richards 1988, 42±57; Alderson 1998, 98±119), and beyond Europe, Asians (see, for instance, Sinha 1995) ± were feminized, at least in part because imperial ideology attributed to these groups an incapacity for autonomous government. Indeed, the relation-
masculinity and cultural studies
203
ship between gender and imperialism has been the focus of numerous studies (see, for instance, Bristow 1991; Dawson 1994; McClintock 1995; Midgley 1998; Phillips 1997), not least since one of the characteristic tropes for colonial or imperial conquest, from late sixteenth-century
Ireland
to
late
nineteenth-century
Africa,
has
been
one
of
sexual
conquest, often of a virgin territory awaiting, even inviting, masculine penetration. Elaine Showalter has further discussed the late nineteenth-century context and the perceived remasculinization of the novel in relation to the Scramble for Africa of the late nineteenth century. She discerns a shift in fictional themes and genres away from the domestic novel towards
the
`male
quest
romance',
typically
centred
on
Africa
and
`represent[ing]
a
yearning for escape from a confining society, rigidly structured in terms of gender, class, and race, to a mythologized place elsewhere where men can be freed from the constraints of Victorian morality' (Showalter 1991, 81; on the male quest romance more generally, see Fraser 1999). Showalter's argument is problematic in that she goes on to suggest that this flight from feminine domesticity is bound up with homosexual desire, thus eliding the homosocial and the homosexual in ways which Sedgwick's distinction between the two hoped to avert, but it nonetheless indicates the ways in which the imperial context was structured by gender. There
has
perhaps
been
a
tendency
to
dwell
too
heavily
on
the
consequences
of
imperialism for those white men who dominated empires, though, whereas an awareness of empire ± and of the slave trade and racism which were integral to it ± behoves us to consider its damaging effects and legacies on those who were subject to it.
Masculinity and race Black men's relationships to masculinity, in particular, have been deeply influenced by racist social structures and by those anxieties of white men which have their roots in the most powerful structuring oppositions of western culture. As Daniel P. Black points out, `black men have wrestled with the concept and the attainment of manhood since the days of their enslavement by Europeans' (Black 1997, 4). Frantz Fanon has famously written that `For the majority of white men the Negro represents the sexual instinct (in its raw state).
The
Negro
is
the
incarnation
of
a
genital
potency
beyond
all
moralities
and
prohibitions' (Fanon 1986, 177). Further, this essentially biological condition attributed to
Thinker
black men is in opposition to the cerebral, since there are `Two realms: the intellectual and the sexual. An erection on Rodin's
is a shocking thought' (Fanon 1986, 165). This
opposition has been both tenacious ± infecting even black self-images ± and pernicious. Historically ± and let us not forget that history is far from finished ± it has determined the most brutal manifestations of racism: in the American South the widely practised lynchings of the nineteenth and twentieth centuries, for instance, commonly culminated in the castration of the black man. Indeed, one of the common justifications of such acts was the `need' to protect white women, and the association between black men and rape has been a persistent
one.
Lynne
Segal
records
that
`To
this
day,
although
50
per
cent
of
men
convicted of rape in the Southern states are white, over 90 per cent of men executed for rape are black (mostly accused of raping white women). No white man has ever been executed for raping a black woman' (Segal 1997, 179). Moreover, the significance of recent high-profile
cases,
involving
figures
such
as
Clarence
Thomas,
Mike
Tyson
and
O.
J.
Simpson, has been overdetermined by issues raised by this history ± which is not to say that issues of guilt or innocence are insignificant ± and often black activists have been set
modern north american criticism and theory
204
against feminists. In this sense, in so far as masculinity connotes sexual potency, black men have been defined as excessively so, but in so far as masculinity connotes greater rationality and self-control, the black man has been viewed as insufficiently so. Moreover, racism has affected the material construction of black masculinity. Crucially, there is `a close connection between the disproportionate representation of black male youth in unemployment data and their over-representation in crime statistics' (Mercer and Julien 1996, 113±14). Hence black males have been denied the role of wage earner which, in western societies, has been a principal source of male dignity, and at the same time and partly in consequence of this, they have been associated with a malevolent hostility to those societies they inhabit, reinforcing the well established link between white±black oppositions
and
metaphysical
concepts
of
good
and
evil.
The
legacies
of
all
this
are
profound and consequently raise profoundly sensitive matters. Crucially, the black struggle not merely for political rights, but for a recognition of human dignity has frequently been gendered, taking on the form of a struggle for black
male
dignity which has involved a
corresponding high investment in forms of black masculinity, and causing problems for those ± for instance, women and black gay men ± who may be stigmatized or disempowered by it. The most obvious recent expression of this tendency took the form of the Million Man March of 1995 which explicitly excluded women's participation ± prompting protests from black feminists ± and which encouraged black men to embrace their patriarchal responsibilities for themselves, their families and their communities. As Segal points out, this message was `fully in line with conservative attacks upon affirmative action, welfare and public resources generally' (1997, xvii). These
are
some
of
the
principal
questions
which
have
been
interrogated
by
the
substantial rise in studies of black masculinity. Respect for the complexity ± not least the
political
complexity ± of the subject matter, especially given the limitations of space
here, lead me to foreclose discussion at this point and to point readers in the direction of some of this material (Blount and Cunningham 1996; Gilroy 2000; Majors and Billson 1992; Marriott 2000).
Masculinity and sexual difference I
began
this
piece
by
stating
the
conventional
wisdom
that
masculinity
is
the
set
of
culturally defined norms attributed to maleness. That is a definition whose adequacy has been increasingly challenged, though, since if masculinity is a cultural norm rather than a biological given we should not expect the relationship between masculinity and maleness to be automatic: men may demonstrate feminine traits and might even, in the face of stigmatization, adopt
consciously
masculine
adopt
identifications.
feminine Indeed,
identifications,
this
and
women
(in)appropriation
of
may
gender
become celebrated as a mode of subversiveness following Judith Butler's
assume norms
or
has
Gender Trouble
.
Butler's argument revisits the sex/gender division so influential on feminist thinking in order to argue that the body too is constructed in and through discourse, and is therefore itself
a
cultural,
rather
than
straightforwardly
biological
phenomenon.
Instead,
the
relationship between gender and sex is a performative one, that is, dependent on certain modes of (imitated or learnt) behaviour:
That the gendered body is performative suggests that it has no ontological status apart from the various acts which constitute its reality . . . acts and gestures, articulated and enacted desires
masculinity and cultural studies
205
create the illusion of an interior and organizing gender core, an illusion discursively maintained for the purposes of the regulation of sexuality within the obligatory frame of reproductive heterosexuality. (Butler 1990, 136)
Hence,
Butler argues for the importance of those forms of gender performance which
suggest a radical dislocation of gender and sex, seeing in drag in particular an erosion of the assumed connection between the two by highlighting precisely the performative element involved in that relationship. More recently, Eve Sedgwick has argued that `it is important to drive a wedge in, early and often and if possible conclusively, between the two topics, masculinity and men, whose relation to one another it is so difficult not to presume' (Sedgwick 1985, 12). Judith Halberstam's recent book-length study,
Female Masculinity,
attempts to assert alternative forms of masculinity to those hegemonic forms embodied in, or performed by, white men, since `transsexuality and transgenderism . . . afford opportunities to track explicit performances of nondominant masculinity' (1998, 40). Such
emphases
Winterson's narrator
is
are
also
characteristic
of
recent
cultural
production.
In
Jeanette
Written on the Body, for instance, the gender of the sexually `promiscuous'
never
specified,
leaving
us
to
speculate
on
whether
s/he
is
a
`womanizing'
heterosexual or a lesbian who challenges the `proper', sexually restrained behaviour of women. Jackie Kay's
Trumpet deals with the aftermath of the death of an apparently male
jazz trumpeter, Joss Moody, who is discovered by the coroner ± representative, perhaps, of the normalizing institutional forces in our society ± to have been (biologically) a woman. Just to complicate matters, Joss was married ± his `widow' lives on ± and has an adopted son. Significantly, at one point in the novel, he denies that he is a lesbian ± as does Brandon Teena, the central character in the film
Boys Don't Cry (Peirce 1999) which presents the
true story of a woman, Teena, who dressed as a man in order to have relationships with women, and who was raped and ultimately murdered by two men as a punishment for her `perversion'. It is not at all clear in either
Trumpet or Boys Don't Cry that these characters'
rejection of lesbianism is a form of self-denial or false consciousness ± as it might have been treated in lesbian cultural productions of, say, the 1970s or 1980s ± so that in both cases we are forced to confront the question of whether gender identity, rather than sexuality, is the primary
organizing
category
for
such
characters
and
in
such
relationships
(for
further
commentary on this issue, see Sinfield 2000). But these narratives also raise questions about the tenacity of what Sinfield calls the `cross-sex grid' (1994, 161±75) and the effectiveness of attempts to transgress them. One of the significant features of Kay's novel, for instance, is the pursuit of Joss Moody's story by an opportunistic journalist who clearly wants to frame the narrative in a populist way, treating it as a form of perversion and a betrayal of the son's relationship with his father, and, while ultimately the journalist is thwarted by the son's refusal to co-operate, the novel makes us aware
that
dominant
discourses
have
their
own
ways
of
constructing
transgendered
identities. This reminds us therefore that, as Butler herself recognizes (1990, 137), the efficacy of `parody' as a form of subversion is dependent substantially on how its message is received (though it should be noted too that, according to the narrative, Moody succeeded in passing as a man, and in this respect his masculinity did
not point up the performative
aspects of gender; it simply fooled people). This
emphasis
on
gender
as
performance,
pose
or
style
has
probably
become
the
dominant one in contemporary studies of masculinity (and femininity, for that matter), and, in this respect, there is a discernible if subtle shift in the direction of such studies: from
modern north american criticism and theory
206
an emphasis on the denaturalization of masculinity as a privileged term in male±female and other relations to an emphasis on masculinity as a depthless style or performance on the part of persons of either sex. This latter emphasis need not necessarily exclude a sense of the former, of course, but it does seem to me that there is at least the risk that the emphasis on masculinity as a `performance' might obscure our sense of it as bound up with the possession of power and the desire to retain that power. Clearly, overtly performative versions of masculinity, such as those by drag kings, may dislocate the relationship between masculinity as a set of signifiers and the male body, but the further relationship between that masculinity and the power that is attendant on its `authentic' relation to the body is surely another thing.
That
relationship is beyond individual stylistic choices or identifications,
and one of the problems with the emphasis on `performance' ± at least in some invocations of it ± is that it tends towards an emphasis on voluntarism and choice, on gender as a commodity. I
will
end
this
survey
of
recent
work
with
a
few
observations
which
may
not
be
particularly original but which seem to me to bear repetition. First, it may be that there are problems attendant on regarding masculinity as an identity ± whether ironized or not ± in the first place, on talking about it as a kind of possession ± that is, as `my' or `his' or `her' masculinity. Speaking for myself ± and self-reflexiveness is a significant feature of many studies of masculinity ± my sense of my own gender is a variable one, bound up with specific contexts and with roles which are expected of me which I might adopt or ± possibly in the face of strong pressure and involving the refusal of certain rewards for `good' conduct ± decline. This leads me to an attendant observation, that in talking about gender we are dealing with the body, its socialization and its social meaning and value, and indeed our relations to our bodies will always be culturally mediated in one way or another. But to say this is not to say that the body is simply a product of discourse: bodies have needs and are characterized by differences which may themselves have social significance. For instance, the capacity to bear children, whether exercised or not, has consequences in terms of people's relationship to their work and the rights which they might want to claim, though whether or not our current distinctions between male and female are helpful or adequate may well be a matter for debate. The ultimate political challenge implicit in these debates about
gender
is
to
create
social
values
and
relations
which
do
not
assign
power
and
privileges on the basis of particular configurations of the body.
David Alderson
Alderson, D.
Mansex Fine
Further reading and works cited . Manchester, 1998.
Territories of Desire in Queer Culture The Second Sex Constructing Masculinity Dismantling Black Manhood Representing Black Men Empire Boys Gender Trouble Writing Ireland Male Order Family Fortunes
Ð and Anderson, L. (eds) Beauvoir, S. de.
Berger, M. et al. (eds)
. London, 1995.
Black, D. P.
. New York, 1997.
Blount, M. and Cunningham, G. P. Bristow, J. Butler, J.
. Manchester, 2000.
. Harmondsworth, 1972.
. London, 1996.
. London, 1991.
. New York, 1990.
Cairns, D. and Richards, S.
Chapman, R. and Rutherford, J. Davidoff, L. and Hall, C.
. Manchester, 1988. . London, 1996.
. London, 1987.
comics studies
207
Dawson, G. Soldier Heroes. London, 1994. Fanon, F. Black Skin, White Masks. London, 1996. Fraser, R. Victorian Quest Romance. Plymouth, 1999. Gilroy, P. Between Camps. Harmondsworth, 2000. Halberstam, J. Female Masculinity. Durham, NC, 1998. Kay, J. Trumpet. London, 1998. Logan, P. Nerves and Narratives. Berkeley, CA, 1997. McClintock, A. Imperial Leather. New York, 1995. Majors, R. and Billson, J. Mancini Cool Pose. New York, 1992. Marriott, D. On Black Men. Edinburgh, 2000. Mercer, K. and Julien, I. `Race, Sexual Politics and Black Masculinity: A Dossier', Male Order, eds R. Chapman and J. Rutherford. London, 1996. Midgley, C. (ed.) Gender and Imperialism. Manchester, 1998. Phillips, R. Mapping Men and Empire. London, 1997. Schwalbe, M. Unlocking the Iron Cage. Oxford, 1996. Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Between Men. New York, 1985. Ð. ` ``Gosh, Boy George, You must be Awfully Secure in Your Masculinity!'' ', in Constructing Masculinity, eds Berger M. et al. London, 1995.
Segal, L. Slow Motion. London, 1997. Sinfield, A. The Wilde Century. London, 1994. Showalter, E. Sexual Anarchy. London, 1991. Silverman, K. Male Subjectivity at the Margins. New York, 1992. Ð. `Transgendered identities', in Territories of Desire in Queer Culture, eds D. Alderson and L. Anderson. Manchester, 2000. Sinha, M. Colonial Masculinity. Manchester, 1995. Solomon-Godeau, A. `Male Trouble', in Constructing Masculinity, eds M. Berger et al. London, 1995. Sussman, H. Victorian Masculinities. Cambridge, 1995. Tolson, A. The Limits of Masculinity. London, 1977. Winterson, J. Written on the Body. London, 1992.
28. Comics Studies
Although both film and comics in their currently recognized forms emerged in the nineteenth century, film acquired much earlier critical academic recognition, even though as early as the 1830s the comic strip began to distinguish itself from already established fields of printmaking and caricature. Despite its being the older medium, the comic strip and its cultural significance have only recently begun to be appreciated in academic studies. As a result, the relatively recent rise in comics studies and comics scholarship has led to a number of different debates concerning origins and seminal influences and sources. È pffer (1799±1846), others cite the origins of the While some scholars credit Rodolphe To comic strip with either George Cruikshank (1792±1878) or William Hogarth (1679± 1764), the latter's narrative cycle The Rake's Progress being offered as a prototype of the comic strip. Other comics scholars have, more radically, assigned the origin of the comic strip to the Bayeux tapestries (1077), produced after the Norman conquest of Anglo-Saxon
comics studies
207
Dawson, G. Soldier Heroes. London, 1994. Fanon, F. Black Skin, White Masks. London, 1996. Fraser, R. Victorian Quest Romance. Plymouth, 1999. Gilroy, P. Between Camps. Harmondsworth, 2000. Halberstam, J. Female Masculinity. Durham, NC, 1998. Kay, J. Trumpet. London, 1998. Logan, P. Nerves and Narratives. Berkeley, CA, 1997. McClintock, A. Imperial Leather. New York, 1995. Majors, R. and Billson, J. Mancini Cool Pose. New York, 1992. Marriott, D. On Black Men. Edinburgh, 2000. Mercer, K. and Julien, I. `Race, Sexual Politics and Black Masculinity: A Dossier', Male Order, eds R. Chapman and J. Rutherford. London, 1996. Midgley, C. (ed.) Gender and Imperialism. Manchester, 1998. Phillips, R. Mapping Men and Empire. London, 1997. Schwalbe, M. Unlocking the Iron Cage. Oxford, 1996. Sedgwick, E. Kosofsky. Between Men. New York, 1985. Ð. ` ``Gosh, Boy George, You must be Awfully Secure in Your Masculinity!'' ', in Constructing Masculinity, eds Berger M. et al. London, 1995.
Segal, L. Slow Motion. London, 1997. Sinfield, A. The Wilde Century. London, 1994. Showalter, E. Sexual Anarchy. London, 1991. Silverman, K. Male Subjectivity at the Margins. New York, 1992. Ð. `Transgendered identities', in Territories of Desire in Queer Culture, eds D. Alderson and L. Anderson. Manchester, 2000. Sinha, M. Colonial Masculinity. Manchester, 1995. Solomon-Godeau, A. `Male Trouble', in Constructing Masculinity, eds M. Berger et al. London, 1995. Sussman, H. Victorian Masculinities. Cambridge, 1995. Tolson, A. The Limits of Masculinity. London, 1977. Winterson, J. Written on the Body. London, 1992.
28. Comics Studies
Although both film and comics in their currently recognized forms emerged in the nineteenth century, film acquired much earlier critical academic recognition, even though as early as the 1830s the comic strip began to distinguish itself from already established fields of printmaking and caricature. Despite its being the older medium, the comic strip and its cultural significance have only recently begun to be appreciated in academic studies. As a result, the relatively recent rise in comics studies and comics scholarship has led to a number of different debates concerning origins and seminal influences and sources. È pffer (1799±1846), others cite the origins of the While some scholars credit Rodolphe To comic strip with either George Cruikshank (1792±1878) or William Hogarth (1679± 1764), the latter's narrative cycle The Rake's Progress being offered as a prototype of the comic strip. Other comics scholars have, more radically, assigned the origin of the comic strip to the Bayeux tapestries (1077), produced after the Norman conquest of Anglo-Saxon
208
modern north american criticism and theory
England eleven years earlier. There is, though, no absolutely agreed starting point. In this article, therefore, I will focus on the development and reception of, briefly, the comic strip, and subsequently the comic book, in the United States through the twentieth century. Comic strips preceded the comic book in North America, but publishers soon realized the potential of reprinting strips in comic book form. The once widely held view that R. F. Outcault (1863±1928) created what was recognized as the first modern American comic strip with The Yellow Kid (1895) is now discredited, even though Outcault's creation, the Yellow Kid, was a hugely popular phenomenon of its time, boosting newspaper sales in which the comic appeared. Amongst scholars of the comic strip, the first American comic book proper is now generally considered to be Funnies on Parade (1933), which was not produced specifically as a comic book, but was reprinted from already published newspaper strips. The early twentieth century was a particularly fruitful period for comic strips: Windsor McKay's Little Nemo (1904±13, revived briefly in 1924) and George Herriman's Krazy Kat (1916±44) are discussed in almost every scholarly work on comic strips. By 1935, in the midst of the Depression, the comic book established itself as a medium of mass entertainment and communication. As a result, comic-book reproduction of previously printed material in newspapers and magazines was superseded by the regular publication of original material. Soon afterwards, Jerry Siegel and Joe Schuster's Superman opened the floodgates of superhero comics in Action Comics #1 (1938). The `Golden Age' of comic books, a term developed by the collectors' market, continues from around this time until the early 1950s and has been the subject of much amateur, trade and academic writing over the years. The number of popular books published about Superman, Batman and other superhero icons born in the Golden Age is, at an initial glance, overwhelming, but as yet, no definitive academic monograph on this period or any of its cartoonists has emerged. The first critical commentaries contemporaneous with the first half of the twentieth century and its comics output were generally less than favourable, tending to dismiss the field as harmful at worst or vapid at best. Favourable criticism was limited to arguments that a specific strip or book was an exception to the rule. Jeet Heer and Kent Worcester's Arguing Comics (2004) recovers such `lost' criticism, sampling articles from 1895 through to the early 1960s. The most negative and damaging critical attack on comics was Frederic Wertham's Seduction of the Innocent (1954). Presently out of print, it was of great significance both at the time of its publication and subsequently, in that it brought about comics' self-censorship via the institution of the Comics Code Authority (CCA). As a result comic books established in the genres of horror and crime narrative were occasionally forced out of business. EC Comics, the best-regarded of the Horror and Crime comics publishers, all but went under, surviving only in the form of Harvey Kurtzman's Mad Magazine. Around the same time at the end of the 1950s, fanzines began to appear, discussing and defending comics, as well as serving to establish art and writing credits (most comic books being, up to this time, uncredited). The turmoil caused by the Comics Code did not have any substantial impact on what are known as `funny animal' comics, one of the medium's most enduring and best selling genres. Little critical attention has been paid to these comics, or their greatest talent, Carl Barks. After the institution of the Comics Code, the Silver Age of Comics begins, characterized by Spiderman and the X-Men, and given their most significant and inventive interpreters in artist Jack Kirby and editor/writer Stan Lee. By the end of the 1950s, scholarship on comic strips and comic books had begun to develop in North American universities, even though publication of articles was not
comics studies
209
forthcoming. Sol Davidson earned his Ph.D. with a thousand-page dissertation on comics (the first on the subject in the US) in 1959, but no academic books on comics would appear until the 1970s. The underground comics of the 1960s and 1970s varied as widely in quality as they did in distribution, but they contained elements that opened doors for future work
and
scholarship:
the
countercultural
impulse
to
break
taboos,
the
artist-writer
(already a staple of comic strips), and autobiographical elements. Robert Crumb is the most famous of the underground artists, and his mixture of self-loathing and extreme sexual candor has had a lasting influence. Visual art and design journal
Graphis
put out two issues,
one on comic strips and one on comic books, in 1972. Out of print now, this is an early and key example of how to bring serious writing and lavish art reproductions together and is, in addition, one of the very few transatlantic works on comics. Amongst the first monographs on comics are David Kunzle's
The Early Comic Strip:
Picture Stories and Narrative Strips in the European Broadsheet from c.1450 to 1825 second volume,
The History of the Comic Strip: The Nineteenth Century.
and the
Kunzle's books offer
histories and necessary cultural contextualization, while focusing exclusively on comic strips. The nineteenth-century volume is of particular interest, establishing the centrality È pffer, Hogarth and Cruikshank, and later to comic strip study of early innovators such as To popular caricaturists such as Cham, Busch and Petit ± all of whose work appeared in popular magazines of the day, particularly
Charivari, Punch
and
Fliegende Blatter.
Out of
necessity, Kunzle formulates a working definition of the comic strip as dominated by images rather than text and consisting of a sequence of images. However, while such a focus may be
now
Kunzle's
considered key
as
insights
misplaced, was
to
Kunzle's
describe
work
comics
did
as
effect
important
mass-produced
changes.
and
topical,
One
of
thereby
anticipating the `cultural history' genre of comics scholarship. Additionally, he established the necessity of taking the comic strip seriously as a field of academic inquiry, while also drawing
attention
to
the
lack
of
such
interest.
Furthermore,
Kunzle's
groundbreaking
publications more or less irreversibly exploded the fallacy that comic strips began in North America and are a uniquely North American art form. Since the publication of Kunzle's work, there has been a great deal of debate as to whether it is primarily sequential images or the combination of text and image that defines comics, but his significance is not to be diminished. At the same time as Kunzle's work appeared in print, comics study made its first forays into the university classroom. In 1974, Donald Ault created a `Literature and Popular Culture' course at the University of California, Berkeley, and was the first to include comic books as course readings, placing them alongside animated films, conventional literature and literary theory in the classroom. As a result chiefly of the initiatives of Kunzle and Ault, comics studies has emerged subsequently as a field over a period ironically in which comic book sales have continued to decline and comic strips are increasingly cramped for space. In such difficult times, post-underground comics have taken off in an increasing variety of directions, from Art Spiegelman's avant-garde comic
Raw
to self-published `ground level'
comics and, in addition, to deliberately unpolished mini-comics. Will Eisner's groundbreaking
A Contract With God
(1979), is often incorrectly identified
as `the first graphic novel'. It was neither the first graphic novel, nor was it properly a `novel', being instead a collection of short stories. In retrospect such determinations merely reveal on the one hand the lack of academic awareness of the widespread extent of avantgarde and underground work already under way, and on the other, something which comic book readers had known for some time: that the comic book had already established itself,
modern north american criticism and theory
210
via counter-cultural means, as a serious aesthetic medium. This is not to diminish Eisner's significance, however. Eisner did popularize the term `graphic novel', his book proving a crucial turning-point in its being among the first works to reach a wider audience than hitherto. It drew attention to itself in being the work of a single author-artist (it is also, interestingly,
semi-autobiographical),
like
much
other
underground
material,
and
was
intended from the start as a book, not just a comic, for distribution and sale primarily in bookstores, aimed at a general ± though generally adult ± audience.
Comics and Sequential Art
Eisner followed this up with the seminal text were
already
guides
to
cartooning
technique,
but
Eisner's
book
was
(1985). There
broader
in
scope,
conveying a lifetime's experience about how to use the elements of the medium to achieve dramatic
effect.
Watchmen
The
Batman
revisionist
following
tales,
year,
collected
editions
The Dark Knight Returns,
and Spiegelman's
Maus,
were
Alan
released
Moore
of Frank
and
Dave
Miller's
Gibbons's
thereby consolidating previous work and establishing
irrevocably the graphic novel as its own genre. This `holy trinity' of comic books would result in the first of many furores over the `new' comics, and all have subsequently become
Maus
staples of academic teaching and research. classes,
while
both
it
and
Watchmen
have
is taught in many Holocaust literature
de rigeur
become
for
classes
on
comics
as
literature. All three have been the subject of many journal articles book chapters, but as yet none have received dedicated monographs. A major entry into the field occurred in 1990 with the publication of M. Thomas Inge's
Comics as Culture
and Joseph Witek's
Comic Books as History: The Narrative Art of Jack
Jackson, Art Spiegelman, and Harvey Pekar . Comics as Culture
anthologizes Inge's essays,
published
under
between
1983
and
1990.
Inge,
who
had
studied
Eisner,
persistently
contextualized American comics, showing how specific writers and artists were influenced by
works
and
cultural
influences
outside
the
field
of
comics
and
how
they,
in
turn,
influenced others, in counterpoint to often-insular fan and popular work. Witek, who had been one of Ault's students, took an opposite tack, considering how Jackson, Spiegelman and Pekar depicted history in and through their work. Witek's tightly focused monograph may be the first to consider a small number of comics in great detail, to offer close readings of
the
genre
narratives.
and,
moreover,
Comics as Culture
to
and
give
careful
cultural
Comic Books as History
and
historical
grounding
to
the
were the first Comics Studies titles
published by the University Press of Mississippi, which has since become a major publisher of monographs, essay collections and interview books in the field. The 1990s witnessed something of a tumult in the comic book industry, the meteoric rise and fall of Image Comics and the collapse of an over-inflated collector's market being amongst the most notable phenomena. At the same time, there was a marked shift in critical interest, as a result, largely, of the influence of Scott McCloud's
Comics: The Invisible Art
Understanding
(1990) as readers started to be more interested in scholarship and
the general public became more aware of comics. No book has done more to shape Comics Studies
as a
readers
became
field,
or readers' perceptions of
more
interested
in
the
field
comics. as
a
From
McCloud's
scholarly
concern,
work, academic while
a
greater
awareness of the comic book and graphic novel developed among the general reading public. Written entirely as a comic book, McCloud's
Understanding Comics
is something of
a sea-change. It takes Eisner's definition of comics as `sequential art' and founds a theory on that definition, making the `gutter' or space between panels the single most important element
in
any
comic.
He
follows
from
Kunzle
and
others
in
excluding
single-panel
cartoons and caricatures as `not comics', providing a widely used typology of the transitions
comics studies
211
between panels. McCloud, not an academic himself, has drawn some fire from those who feel
Understanding Comics
is too proscriptive or lacks scholarly rigor. Nonetheless, virtually
all books and papers on comics since have cited McCloud, even if only to refute him. Robert C. Harvey's book
The Art of the Funnies: An Aesthetic History
The Art of the Comic Book
(1994) and follow-up
(1996) are both published by a university press, though
Harvey, like McCloud and Eisner, is not an academic but a professional comics creator. Harvey
unapologetically
focuses
on
the
works
he
considers
to
be
the
best
and
most
innovative, making his books more formal critiques than survey histories. Like McCloud, he takes a proscriptive stance, but his criterion for aesthetic and formal evaluation is governed by elements of verbal-visual blending. He favours comics where image and text are as complementary as possible and only allows for wordless or `pantomine' comics as the exceptions that prove the rule. One
particular
university:
that
of
critical
voice
British
of
note
academic
emerged
Roger
during
Sabin.
His
the
1990s
from
within
the
Adult Comics: An Introduction
(1993) examines the origins of comics written for adults, both in and before the underground commix. It was written largely as a corrective to the idea that comics `grew up' in the 1980s. Sabin draws examples from
 es manga, bandes dessine
(French comics) and
fumetti
(Italian comics), but is mostly interested in Anglo-American comics. His follow-up book,
Comics, Comix and Graphic Novels
(1996), is a coffee-table book in a similar vein, though
broader in scope. Here, Sabin made the case that British work generally leads rather than follows the American comics scene. Sabin
was
not
alone,
however.
By
the
mid-1990s,
two
major
threads
of
Comics
Scholarship had been established: cultural histories placing and contextualizing comics on the one hand and, on the other, explanatory theories of what the medium is and can do. Notably, writing in the field up to this point tends largely to be defensive, with many publications establishing
offering the
not
only
bona fides
of
critical
the
field
analysis and
its
but
also
subject,
acting
as
showing
apologia:
why
comic
intent
on
books
are
relevant and worth studying, and establishing that they are different from and not inferior to movies, novels and picture-books. As the decade proceeded, the number of academic works
on
decreased.
comics By
increased
1998,
Amy
the decade, could produce
dramatically
Kyste
Nyeberg,
and
the
typical
amount of
of
comics
defensive
scholarship
Seal of Approval: The History of the Comics Code ,
manoeuvring at
the
end
of
speaking of the
much-reviled CCA as a forerunner to other industry self-regulation, such as the MPAA movie ratings. Similarly, Ian Gordon, in
Comic Strips and Consumer Culture, 1890±1945
(1998), was free to focus on consumer culture and merchandising as a driving force behind comic strips, ignoring many of the most renowned strips. The turn of the century witnessed a redoubling of the volume and scope of Comics Studies. It also attracted scholars from other fields with an interest in the subject. David Carrier,
for
historian to
example,
brought
his
background
The Aesthetics of Comics
as
an
analytic
philosopher
and
an
art
(2000). Bradford D. Wright compared Golden and
Silver Age comics to American culture more broadly perceived in
Transformation of Youth Culture in America
(2001).
The
Comic Book Nation: The
work
of
these
two
men
is
noteworthy for particular reasons. Carrier's text offers an explanatory theory most notable  Daumier's caricatures and other for giving credibility to the comparison between Honore work by `fine' artists and that of comics; Wright, on the other hand, offers a cultural history that combines extensive cultural analysis grounded in a sense of the historical specificity of popular national identity in the US as this is mediated in the singular form of the comic.
modern north american criticism and theory
212
In the first years of the twenty-first century, the breadth and diversity of disciplinary approaches to comics studies has increased markedly, with works applying techniques from the areas of Cultural Studies, Film Studies and Postcolonial Studies. Geoff Klock's
Read Superhero Comics and Why
How to
(2002) applies Harold Bloom's theory of the anxiety of
influence to comics, and Neil Cohn's self-published work (2002±present), departing from McCloud's work, argues that there is a sentence-like grammar to the comic strip or page and that visual elements can be `read'. At present, there are no clear divisions among comics scholars, though the emergence of one or more dominant `schools' of comics studies seems likely. There is, though, increasing availability of, and ease of access to, source material and institutional support for those working in the field. The first academic journal devoted to comics studies,
Inks: Cartoon and Comic Art Studies
(1994±7), was of great significance to the
field, only to disappear after three years, leaving a void not filled until 1999 by John Lent's
The International Journal of Comic Art (IJOCA), notable for its 2004, Donald Ault inaugurated
ImageTexT,
proactive internationalism. In
an e-journal for comics and animation studies
that places an emphasis on theoretical reflection on and intervention into the field, as the necessary means of producing rigorous analysis from a multidisciplinary base. In 2002 M. Todd Hignite's
Comic Art
emerged as a serious trade publication that welcomed academic
input. The other serious trade magazine, Gary Groth's
The Comics Journal
(1977±present)
has, unfortunately, traditionally been skeptical of academics and academic writing. University libraries are expanding their holdings in comics, particularly Michigan State University,
whose
collection
of
comics
may
exceed
that
of
the
Library
of
Congress.
Bowling Green State University and the University of California, Riverside also have large collections. Masters and doctoral tracks in Comics Studies have been introduced at the University of Florida (UF), and the library there is expanding its holdings in comics. The University of Mississippi Press is putting out a series of interview books with notable comics creators and animators, including Robert Crumb, Carl Barks, Charles M. Schultz and Milton
Caniff.
Forums
for
comics
scholarship
are
well
established:
the
Comics
Arts
Conference at the San Diego Comic-Con has been going since 1992 and the International Comics Art Fest since 1996. The UF Conference on Comics is four years old and the Pop Culture Association/American Culture Association has an Area Chair for Comics. Increasingly specialized works are being put out by popular presses, including Patrick Rosencranz' definitive work on the Underground Comics,
Comix Revolution 1963±1975
Rebel Visions: The Underground
(2002) and Trina Robbins's books on many aspects of women
and comics, including most recently,
The Great Women Cartoonists
(2001). Academic
publications are likewise becoming more focused, as with Jeffery A. Brown's press-specific look at race in comics:
Black Superheroes, Milestone Comics and their Fans
(2001). In recent
years there has also been a steady growth in the market for `alternative' comics, `zines', mini-comics comics.
and
Charles
graphic
novels,
Hatfield's
against
a
continued
decline
in
sales
Alternative Comics: An Emerging Literature
of
`mainstream'
(2005)
describes
these phenomena and links alternative comics to the underground comix, while Daniel Raeburn's
Chris Ware
(2004) takes a fine-art approach to Ware's comics, design and objects
d'art. As a field, Comics Studies has grown to embrace galley exhibitions and counterculture(s), art history, cultural studies and the gap between old and new media. Thus, both in the university and beyond, comics studies has developed, often despite prejudice and in unexpected ways, and shows every sign of continuing to do so.
Christopher Eklund
comics studies
213
Further reading and works cited
Barker, M.
A Haunt of Fears: The Strange History of the British Horror Comics Campaign.
Jackson, MS,
1984. Brown, J. A. Carrier, D. Cohn, N.
Black Superheroes, Milestone Comics and their Fans.
Jackson, MS, 2001.
University Park, PA, 2000.
The Aesthetics of Comics.
Early Writings on Visual Language.
Dowd, D. B. and Hignite, M. T. (eds)
Carlsbad, CA, 2003.
The Rubber Frame: Essays in Culture and Comics.
St Louis, MI,
2004. Eisner, W. Ð.
Tamarack, FL, 1985.
Comics and Sequential Art.
Graphic Storytelling and Visual Narrative.
ÐÐ.
A Contract with God.
Fingeroth, D.
Tamarack, FL, 1996.
Tamarack, FL, 1979.
Superman on the Couch: What Superheroes Really Tell Us about Ourselves and our Society.
New York, 2004. Gordon, I.
Comic Strips and Consumer Culture, 1890±1945.
Groth, G. and Fiore, R. (eds) Hatfield, C.
Jackson, 2005.
The Art of the Funnies: An Aesthetic History.
The Art of the Comic Book: An Aesthetic History.
Heer, J. and Worcester, K. (eds)
Washington, DC, 1998.
New York, 1988.
Alternative Comics: An Emerging Literature .
Harvey, R. C. Ð.
The New Comics.
Jackson, MS, 1994.
Jackson, MS, 1996.
Arguing Comics: Literary Masters on a Popular Medium.
Jackson, MS,
2004. Herdeg, W. and Pascal, D. (eds) Jones, G. Klock, G.
How to Read Superhero Comics and Why.
Kunzle, D.
New York, 2004.
New York, 2002.
Berkeley, CA, 1973.
The History of the Comic Strip: The Nineteenth Century.
Juno, A. (ed.) McCloud, S.
Berkeley, CA, 1990. New York, 1997.
Dangerous Drawings: Interviews with Comix and Graphix Artists.
McAllister, M. P. et al. (eds) Ð.
Zurich, 1972.
The Early Comic Strip: Picture Stories and Narrative Strips in the European Broadsheet from
c.1450 to 1825.
Ð.
Comics: The Art of The Comic Strip.
Men of Tomorrow: Geeks, Gangsters and the Birth of the Comic Book.
Comics and Ideology.
New York, 2001.
Understanding Comics: The Invisible Art.
Northampton, MA, 1993.
Reinventing Comics: How Imagination and Technology Are Revolutionizing an Art Form.
New York,
2000. Nyeberg, A. K. Phelps, D.
Seal of Approval: The History of the Comics Code.
Reading the Funnies.
Raeburn, D.
Chris Ware.
Robbins, T.
The Great Women Superheroes.
Ð.
Jackson, MS, 1998.
Seattle, WA, 2001.
New Haven, CT, 2004. Northampton, MA, 1996.
From Girls to Grrlz: A History of Women's Comics from Teens to Zines.
San Francisco, 1999. Ð.
The Great Women Cartoonists.
Rosenkranz, P. Sabin, R. Ð.
New York, 2001.
Rebel Visions: The Underground Comix Revolution 1963±1975.
Adult Comics: An Introduction.
Comics, Comix and Graphic Novels.
New York, 1996.
Schutz, D. and Kitchen, D. (eds)
Will Eisner's Shop Talk.
Thomas, I. M.
Jackson, MS, 2000.
Comics as Culture.
Varnum, R. and Gibbons, C. T. (eds) Wertham, F. Comics.
Jackson, MS, 2001.
New York, 1954.
Comic Book Rebels: Conversations with the Creators of the New
New York, 1993.
Wright, B. D. 2001.
Milwaukie, OR, 2001.
The Language of Comics: Word and Image.
Seduction of the Innocent.
Wiater, S. and Bissette, S. R. (eds)
Seattle, 2002.
New York, 1993.
Comic Book Nation: The Transformation of Youth Culture in America.
Baltimore, MD,
29. Anglophone Canadian Literary Studies
As the product of a relatively young country ± young in terms of its written history and young in terms of its political construction as a nation ± the tradition of Anglophone Canadian literary studies is inevitably a recent one. The moment of origin of a distinctively
Canadian
literature has always been in dispute, but the beginnings of Canadian literary
criticism can be traced back to around the mid-nineteenth century. At this time, just before the
Confederation
of
1867,
when
unity
and
rebellion
were
key
political
concerns
throughout what was then British North America, a number of critical essays and articles appeared in which the state and function of literature in Canada was being discussed. (Many early critical pieces are collected in Ballstadt 1975.) In particular, there emerged a common argument for the need of a distinctive national literature to reflect and encourage a national unity. Typifying this nationalist sentiment, Edward Hartley Dewart introduced his
1864
Selections from Canadian Poets
anthology,
literature
±
with
the
statement:
`A
national
±
the
literature
first
is
an
anthology
essential
of
Canadian
element
in
the
formation of national character.' Literature, he argued, is `the bond of national unity, and the
guide
of
national
energy'
(1864,
ix).
Dewart
pointed
to
the
common
belief
that
Canadians were too practical-minded, too lacking in wealth and leisure, and simply too busy forging a living from the wilderness that surrounded them to engage with poetry. But above all such considerations, he blamed Canada's lack of an internationally renowned literature on its colonial position, which he argued undermined `interest and faith in all indigenous literary productions' (1864, x). Dewart's early analysis pointed to a number of themes that have continued to recur throughout Anglophone Canadian literary studies. The nationalist sentiment of
from Canadian Poets
Selections
explicitly politicized the role of literature as a national unifier, and
when this view was countered by a growing demand for regionalism ± for recognition of difference and diversity of style and experience ± the literary beginnings of an ongoing Canadian
tension
were
forged.
Other
important
points
are
touched
on
in
Dewart's
introduction: the presence of practical barriers to a flourishing literary production, the weight
of
a
colonial
tradition
and,
in
the
conclusion
to
his
introductory
essay,
a
significantly meek and self-effacing reference to Canada's youth when he states: `Though poor in historic interest, our past is not altogether devoid of events capable of poetic treatment' (1864, xix). Canadian literature, it has variously been said, is psychologically bound
by
its
artistically Northrop
colonial
past,
overwhelmed Frye
wrote
of
by
is its
emotionally British
his native
and
land:
`It
crippled
by
American is
its
former
literary
practically
the
Puritanism,
counterparts.
only
country
and
In
left
is
1971, in
the
world which is a pure colony, colonial in psychology as well as in mercantile economics' (1971,
iii).
Such
views
of
course
have
always
been
challenged,
but
they
have
held
anglophone canadian literary studies
215
surprisingly firm in the popular imagination. Indeed, it was not until the mid-twentiethcentury
`renaissance'
critically
examined
of
Canadian
and
literature
dismantled,
and
that
it
is
these from
stereotypes this
later
really
period
started
to
onwards
be
that
Anglophone Canadian literary studies began to engage with Canadian and world literature from a much broader and more diverse point of inquiry.
Frontier Writing ± First Writers, First Readers Earle Birney's 1962 poem `Can. Lit.' famously concludes with the line, `It's only by our lack of ghosts/we're haunted' (Atwood 1982, 116), and the lack of indigenous literary tradition has been a defining factor in the study of Canadian literature. Whilst European writers of the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries were anchored within
a multifaceted literary
heritage, the location and existence of a Canadian literature remained uncertain. From John Cabot's first entry into the Gulf of St Lawrence in 1497 to the division of Upper and Lower Canada by the Canada Act of 1791, from the 1867 Confederation of the Dominion of Canada to well into the post-war twentieth century, the notion of `Canada' has been a contested site, both culturally and geographically. Accordingly, Frye posed the conundrum `where is here?' as the crux of Canadian identity, more potent a query than `who am I?'. Place, argued Frye, is central to Canadian sensibility, and the shaping of Canadian history and geography is reflected in the development of its literature (1971, 220). The
first
texts
that
came
out
of
Canada
were
largely
descriptive
and
instructive
documents of varying literary quality written by explorers, travellers and early settlers. Various permutations on the `Travels in North America' theme were published from the late sixteenth century onwards, with texts such as Alexander Mackenzie's
Voyages from
Montreal on the River St. Laurence, through the Continent of North America to the Frozen and Pacific Oceans in the Years 1789 and 1793 Elder's
1776
(published 1801) and Alexander Henry the
Travels and Adventures in Canada and the Indian Territories between the Years 1760 and
(published 1809) charting a specifically Canadian experience. These writings tended
to combine adventure story and natural history with journal writings and social observations. Placing such texts as the origin of Canadian literature is contentious for a number of reasons. Firstly, the men who wrote them ± and it was primarily men, although women travel writers later made their mark in the field, most notably Anna Jameson with
Studies and Summer Rambles in Canada works.
Secondly,
the
authors
were
Winter
(1838) ± had little intention of creating `literary'
not
natives
of
Canada
and
their
work
was
largely
published in Europe and intended for a European readership. And finally, these texts were for
a
long
time
regarded
as
historical
documents
rather
than
literary
works.
Canada's
heritage of exploration and travel literature, however, contains many thematic connections to its contemporary literature. Novelist and poet Margaret Atwood, for example, addresses Frye's question, `where is here?' and suggests that this is what `a man asks when he finds himself in unknown territory, and it implies several other questions. Where is this place in relation to other places? How do I find my way around in it?' (Atwood 1972, 17). Atwood connects the earliest explorations of Canada with an ongoing literary inquiry into the construction of a Canadian sensibility and an uneasy interaction with the country's wilderness and wildlife which can be traced through a significant amount of Canadian literature. This retrospective lineage, plotted from Canada's earliest texts to its contemporary writers, was important to the thematic critics of the 1960s and 1970s, but it is also
modern north american criticism and theory
216
significant in providing evidence of a Canadian literary heritage that extends beyond the nineteenth and twentieth centuries. Other, more obviously literary, works were also written in this early period, for example Frances
Brooke's
epistolary
The History of Emily Montague
novel,
(1769),
which
is
considered to have been the first Canadian novel. Brooke, however, was born in and lived in England, and although she resided with her husband in Quebec for part of the 1760s ± providing the setting for her best-known work ± she published the novel on her return to England where it found an enthusiastic European audience, making it, in W. J. Keith's words, `an English novel that happens to exploit Canadian subject matter' (1985, 42). Much later, the works of two of Canada's most famous pioneer writers were, like those of
Brooke,
still
characterised
by
their
focus
on
an
intended
European
±
and
indeed
American ± readership. Sisters Susanna Moodie and Catherine Parr Traill were British born, moving
to Canada
with their
husbands
in the
1830s.
However, unlike Brooke,
Moodie and Traill emigrated with the intention of settling and consequently, while they chronicled the curiosities of an alien land for the edification of `outsiders', as settlers rather than visitors, they wrote as `insiders' to the newly forming Canadian nation. Although their subject matter was superficially similar, the writing styles and sensibilities of the two sisters were very different. Moodie, best known for
Roughing It in the Bush
(1852), is
renowned for her occasionally romantic and often melodramatic sketches, based on real life but consciously fictional in their use of character, parody and roughly sequential plot. Where Moodie was self-consciously literary in style, Traill, author of
The Backwoods of Canada
(1836),
is generally regarded as being the more pragmatic and optimistic of the two. Speaking of a poet's lament that Canada was too young to inspire art, Traill merely notes that the immigrant labourers `feel no regret that the land they labour on has not yet been celebrated by the pen of the historian or the lay of the poet' (1836, 154). Even in two writers of such strikingly similar background and experience, no singular `Canadian voice' can be located, and their contrasting similarities and differences have contributed to evolving interpretations of their work. While Moodie was most often recalled for clinging to `the refinements and luxuries of European society' (1852, vii), Traill was seen to have embraced the democracy of a new, less rigidly hierarchical society. With time, however, later critics have applied a psychological reading to Moodie's work. Keith, for example, suggests that `while reading Moodie we frequently receive painful glimpses of a mind at the end of its tether' (1985, 21), and in
Journals of Susanna Moodie
The
, a poetic interpretation of Moodie's experiences, Atwood depicts a
woman haunted by ghosts and `divided down the middle' (1970, 62). With such poetic and critical analyses as these, Canada's early texts move much beyond documents of pioneer life and become crucial aspects of a constantly revisited and redefined literary heritage. The multiple aspects of these early texts, which frequently vacillate between documentary, anecdote, commentary, romance and narrative, and were often not intended for a Canadian readership, point to the ill-defined boundaries of early Canadian literature. From such
beginnings,
therefore,
nurturance and definition
of
the a
main
task
national
of
Canadian
literature
that
literary
could
studies
withstand
became
both
the
the geo-
graphical and political pressures of Canadian pioneer living and the psychological pressures of European cultural domination. The Confederation of 1867 went some way to attaining this goal by at least asserting the existence of a Canadian nation, but colonial barriers to a national literature persisted, as Canada continued to be perceived as parochial, uncultured, unromantic Lighthall's
and
`poor
in
historic
interest',
Songs from the Great Dominion
as
Dewart
(1889),
had
conceded.
published
William
twenty-five
Douw
years
after
anglophone canadian literary studies Selections from Canadian Poets,
217
moved to address this view. Like Dewart, Lighthall was a
nationalist, but where Dewart sought to elevate Canadian poetry to the benchmark of European literature, Lighthall organised his anthology under confident headings such as `The New Nationality' and `The Spirit of Canadian History' (1889, vii; xiii). His anthology aimed to choose `only what illustrates the country and its life
in a distinctive way'
(1889,
xxxiv) and he called on Canadian poets to celebrate their nation's youth and great natural beauty. Whilst certainly not challenging Canada's position as the `Eldest Daughter of the Empire' (1889, xxi),
Songs from the Great Dominion
pointed to a newer, post-Confederation
confidence in Canada's unique qualities and in the capacity of its literature to embody those qualities in a wholly individual and proficient manner. As Canada moved towards the twentieth century, the practical difficulties of writing in a country with a limited publishing infrastructure continued. The `lack of ghosts' of course persisted, and, despite Lighthall's call for optimism, observations of the famous Canadian inferiority complex continued to colour literary analysis. Increasingly, it became clear that this malaise ± always related to Canada's lack of a strong national identity in the face of British
and
French
cultural
and
political
history,
and
increasingly
in
contrast
to
the
burgeoning confidence of the United States ± needed to be addressed, and in the twentieth century, the Canadian government moved towards a policy of state sponsorship of the arts. This led to increased national literary production, but it also stimulated the production of Anglophone Canadian literary studies as Canadian literary heritage came under renewed scrutiny from an increasingly diverse range of perspectives.
The Twentieth Century From
its
opening
to
its
close,
the
twentieth
century
saw
a
remarkable
evolution
and
diversification of Canadian literature, and a correspondingly productive and diverse period of
literary
Paraphrase,
criticism.
In
his
preface
to
Frank
Davey's
1983
critical
text,
Surviving the
Eli Mandel stated: `From its earliest beginnings, Canadian criticism has been a
surprisingly aggressive art' (Davey 1983, i). Whilst early critical studies worked defensively to establish and define Canadian literature, criticism in the mid- to late twentieth century became increasingly combative as crucially ideologically opposed critics entered into public debate on the direction in which Anglophone Canadian literary studies should be heading. At the start of the period, however, many features and difficulties of the nineteenth century
remained.
American
and
British
imports
continued
to
be
more
economically
viable than locally published books, few Canadian publishing houses existed and there was a small indigenous readership. The nature of Canada's literary contribution remained in dispute and the period between Confederation and the First World War saw the continued production
of
critical
surveys
and
anthologies
attempting,
above
all,
to
confirm
the
existence of an established body of Canadian literature: for example, Archibald MacMurchy's
Handbook of Canadian Literature
Literature
(1914). European modernism reached Canada with some difficulty and many
critics,
(1906) and T. G. Marquis's
who still largely continued to equate
English-Canadian
realism with nationalism, viewed it with
suspicion. Poet Arthur Stringer prefaced his 1914 collection,
Open Water,
with a call for
recognition of free verse and literary experimentalism, and the progressive critical magazine
Canadian Forum,
founded in 1920, moved to disseminate modernist principles. But on the
whole, Canadian literature moved into the twentieth century slowly, retaining many of its nineteenth-century influences.
modern north american criticism and theory
218
The
continuing
popularity
of
the
Confederation
Poets
±
a
loose
association
based
predominantly on its affiliates being born around the 1860s ± provides, with their nature poetry heavily influenced by the European Romantics, an example of the perpetuation of Victorian
sensibilities.
Perhaps
more
significantly
however,
the
Confederation
Poets
represented the first Canadian `school' of writers, creating a poetic voice which distinctively belonged to Canada. Animal stories provided another, more idiosyncratic Canadian school of writing. The most famous examples of these are Ernest Thompson Seton's
Wild
Animals I have Known (1898) and Charles G. D. Roberts's Earth's Enigmas (1896). A little later in this period, sentimental stories of provincial life also became very popular, typified by L. M. Montgomery's
Anne of Green Gables (1907), based on Prince Edward Island, and
the gentle humour of Stephen Leacock's Ontario-based
Sunshine Sketches of a Little Town
(1912). These developments ± particularly the realistic animal stories of Seton and Roberts ± helped
to support the idea that there were literary conventions that could truly be
described as indigenous to Canada. In 1922, Lorne Pierce and Albert Watson published another anthology,
Our Canadian Literature, which, as the first post-war anthology, and the
first to include prose alongside poetry, moved to further entrench the notion of a unique Canadian cultural identity, while still clearly struggling to disentangle Canadian literature from its European roots. This key theme of identity in Canadian literary studies persisted well into the twentieth century. By the 1920s, Canada had experienced a number of distinctive literary movements, various anthologies of national literature had been collected and critics had begun to identify the recurring patterns and themes of a maturing corpus. However, in a 1928 essay published in
Canadian Forum, entitled `Wanted ± Canadian Criticism', A. J. M. Smith
argued
with
that,
its
coming
of
age,
Canadian
literature
must
be
judged
openly
and
critically for its literary merit. Smith argued for a rejection of uncritical nationalist literary  s of Canadian life and nature over studies which valued sentimental and romantic cliche aesthetic worth, and called for a period of maturity in Canadian literature and criticism: `Sensibility is no longer enough,' he stated, `intelligence is also required. Even in Canada' (1928). The split between nationalist or native, and what was sometimes termed internationalist, and sometimes cosmopolitan or modernist, criticism widened throughout the twentieth century and became increasingly important in Anglophone Canadian literary studies.
Unity and Individuality The move to develop a strong and uniquely Canadian literary canon evidently pre-dates the twentieth century, but the 1960s finally saw it come to fruition, partly as a result of the new
publishing
infrastructure
that
had
steadily
been
put into place over the previous
decade, and partly as a consequence of a growing cultural nationalism which also fuelled government funding of the arts through the Canada Council. At this time in particular, Canadian writing was politicized by nationalist sentiment and Canadian criticism flourished alongside Canadian publishing. There were a number of reasons, both optimistic and defensive, for the increase in Canadian nationalism during the late twentieth century. Keith, for example, writing in 1985, suggested that it `is partly the result of greater cultural confidence, but it also reflects the anxiety of a sparsely populated country in an overcrowded world of superpowers' (1985, 5). The proliferation of Canada's literary successes came at a time when the United States was rapidly gaining international power, and the
anglophone canadian literary studies
219
declining influence of Britain and France in Canada's affairs was balanced by the rising shadow
of
America's
cultural
domination
of
its
northern
neighbour.
Yet
despite
this
growing cultural imperialism, Canadian literature succeeded in undergoing a period of significant productivity in the 1960s and 1970s, with Canadian authors such as Michael Ondaatje, Alice Munro, Margaret Laurence, Margaret Atwood, Robert Kroetsch, Leonard Cohen and numerous others achieving international success. The earliest symptoms of this renaissance are clear: the New Canadian Library was established by publishers McClelland and Stewart in 1957, and in 1959 George Woodcock founded existed
the
and
journal was
Canadian Literature,
appropriate
for
sending
academic
a
clear
attention.
In
signal
1965
that
the
Coach
phenomenon
House
Press
was
founded, followed in 1966 by Oberon and in 1967 by Vancouver-based Talonbooks and Toronto-based publisher House of Anansi Press. Also in 1967, Norah Story edited the
Oxford Companion to Canadian History and Literature .
At this time, Canadian publishers
really began to publish Canadian authors in significant numbers. Literary newsletters and
Tish,
magazines sprang up, such as
a Vancouver-based poetry magazine edited by a number
of poets, including Frank Davey. From its nineteenth-century beginnings as the published commentaries of various professionals ± clergy, lawyers, politicians ± during the 1960s, Canadian literary
studies became
noticeably academic.
The
first
university
courses
on
`Can. Lit.' appeared on university syllabi, and frequently both writers and critics were themselves university-affiliated academics. The best-known academic-critic is Northrop Frye, whose
Anatomy of Criticism
(1957)
was hugely influential. However, in his later work, Frye chose not to apply his universal mythopoeic structure to Canadian literature and instead, in his 1971 collection of essays,
The Bush Garden,
produced
a
critical
reading
based
on
images
and
themes
unique
to
Canadian writers. Frye propounds a form of environmental determinism, demonstrating unique
characteristics
geography
and
of
history,
the
and
Canadian evident
literature. In his 1965 conclusion to
Garden,
in
sensibility recurring
prompted patterns
largely
and
A Literary History of Canada,
by
themes
the in
country's Canadian
included in
The Bush
Frye outlined his best-known idea of the Canadian sensibility ± what he called the
`garrison mentality':
Small and isolated communities surrounded with a physical or psychological `frontier,' . . . communities that provide all that their members have in the way of distinctively human values, and that are compelled to feel a great respect for the law and order that holds them together, yet confronted
with
communities
are
a
huge,
bound
unthinking,
to
develop
menacing,
what
we
and
may
formidable
provisionally
physical call
a
setting
garrison
±
such
mentality
(1971, 225).
This
mentality,
according
to
Frye,
was
characteristic
of
Canadians
and
consequently
characteristic of their literature. Frye's thematic criticism was incredibly influential, and the best-known proponents of his argument were Douglas Jones's (1972) and John Moss's
Butterfly on Rock
(1970), Margaret Atwood's
Patterns of Isolation in English-Canadian Fiction
Survival
(1974). In each of
these largely essentialist texts, a unifying mythology and pattern of themes is identified in Canadian literature and
the Canadian experience
is largely perceived in terms of the
defining struggle with nature ± evident in images of `isolation' according to Moss, `survival' according to Atwood. By each of these analyses, Canadian literature is more realistic, more pragmatic, and less visionary or optimistic than American literature.
modern north american criticism and theory
220
Thematic criticism dominated Anglophone Canadian literary studies in the late 1960s and early 1970s, and eventually there was a strong backlash against the determinism of the doctrine. This was largely led by Davey, who delivered his essay `Surviving the Paraphrase' as a lecture in 1974 and published it in
Canadian Literature
in 1976 (1983, 1±12). In this
essay, much influenced by the New Critical promotion of text and technique, he accused the thematic critics of lacking confidence in Canadian literature, of being `anti-evaluative', looking towards `alleged cultural influences and determiners' instead of working to `explain and illuminate the work on its own terms' (1983, 1). Other critics such as Michael Dixon, Eli Mandel and Barry Cameron joined Davey in his disavowal of what Cameron has termed `the
vulgar
sociology
of
Frye,
Jones,
Atwood,
and
Moss,
which
stereotypes
Canadian
consciousness' (1990, 129). In a 1978 interview, Atwood responded to such criticisms by arguing: `One can only afford ``a thoughtful consideration of technique'' when the question of
mere
existence
is
no
longer
a
question'
(1978,
85).
With
this
retort,
Atwood
was
identifying pre-1970 Canadian literature with the unstable `adolescence' that Smith had argued in 1928 it had already outgrown. Davey's main concern was that thematic criticism subsumed the individual identity into a humanistic cultural whole. The cultural-nationalist compulsion to define an artistic unity was working to silence the individual voice; the independent artist and the unique text were being compelled to speak for the whole, and authors and texts that failed to coincide with the ideological mainstream were being disregarded by the critical authorities. Davey complained that `books which begin ostensibly as attempts to illuminate separate instances of Canadian writing become messianic attempts to define a national identity or psychosis' (1983, 3). His essay was a call for regionalism and individualism, for a New Critical concentration on technique rather than a historicist focus on cultural and environmental determinism. The regional diversity which had always been an obstacle to overcome in the great task of unifying the second largest country in the world was increasingly being hailed as a strength to be celebrated. National literary unity was instead denounced as stultifying ± diminishing Canada's multifaceted strengths and diversities to a homogeneous whole of quaint animal images and isolation themes. In contrast, Patricia Marchak argued that only through regional difference can Canada create `a culture strong enough to resist American dominance and to establish a culture of national unity' (qtd in Cameron, 1990, 134). By this view, regionalism is actually an aid to nationalism. In her 1982 introduction to
New Oxford Book of Canadian Verse in English
The
, Atwood observed that ` ``regional'' has
changed in recent years from a bad word to a good word' (1982, xxviii). Regionalism became connected in the theorising of Davey and others with an increasingly postmodern project and with a valuing of fragmentation and difference over centrism and unity. Clearly, Canada has never been the unified state that many have wished it to be. Even in
The Bush Garden
, Frye acknowledged that `identity is local and regional, rooted in the
imagination and in works of culture', but he believed that `unity is national in reference, international in perspective' (1971, 2). This differentiation between identity and unity subsumes the regional identity to the project of national unity, but it still acknowledges the pull of regionalism in a writer's imagination. Frye in fact stated that the famous problem of Canadian identity is a regional rather than a national problem, and suggested that `an environment turned outward to the sea, like so much of Newfoundland, and one turned towards inland seas, like so much of the Maritimes, are an imaginative contrast' (1971, ii). The rising interest in regionalism in the late twentieth century led to a renewed emphasis on
the
heterogeneous
nature
of
the
literatures
of
Canada's
provinces,
which
posed
a
anglophone canadian literary studies
221
significant challenge to the nationalist project to identify a unified Canadian literature. In a 1987 essay on thematic criticism, T. D. MacLulish suggested: `whether Canada has one ``national'' literature or two, or whether it possesses only a mosaic of regional literatures, is still
a
matter
of
debate'
(1987,
18).
In
contrast
to
the
unifying
notion
of
a
uniquely
Canadian identity, regionalism celebrates the differences of Canada's geographically vast experience.
Ex-centricities: Postmodernism, Multiculturalism, Post-colonialism The backlash against thematic criticism resulted finally in the increased critical concentration on close textual analysis and appreciation of experimentalism and fragmentation that Smith had called for in `Wanted ± Canadian Criticism', well before thematic criticism had
reached
however,
the
was
height
more
of
its
significant
influence. for
This
paralleling
late
and
twentieth-century
informing
the
development,
rising
influence
of
post-structuralism and postmodernism in Canadian criticism. A number of critics (Barbara Godard, Cameron, Davey) have argued that structuralism and post-structuralism occurred simultaneously in Canada, with the consequence that the Canadian postmodern was a peculiar phenomenon, unique to the literary and critical culture of the nation. One of the most notable proponents of the idea that there exists a uniquely Canadian form of postmodernism is Linda Hutcheon. A key element of her thesis is the idea that `since the periphery or the margin might also describe Canada's perceived position in international terms, perhaps the postmodern ex-centric is very much a part of the identity of the nation' (1988, 3). Canada, which has always been `ex-centric' to the centralised powers of Britain, France and America, has always defined itself in terms of oppositions and differences. Consequently, many of the principles of postmodernism are natural to Canadian aesthetics and Hutcheon suggests that `the post-modern irony that refuses resolution of contraries' is an appropriate framework from which to read many Canadian writers such as Kroetsch, Atwood, Ondaatje and Munro (1988, 4). The rise of postmodernist criticism had a number of consequences for Anglophone Canadian literary studies. For a nation so long preoccupied with identifying a literary tradition, the postmodernist rejection of the humanist practice of canon-formation was inevitably a central concern. The long-standing and self-conscious move to identify a national literature resulted in, for example, the founding of the New Canadian Library. In many ways, this attempt to entrench Canadian literature within a qualitative structure was a
natural
instinct.
Whereas
`time
itself,
in
the
older
countries,
has
been
the
great
anthologizer' (Atwood 1982, xxix±xxx), Canadian history afforded no such assurances of
quality
and
longevity,
so
the
construction
of
a
canon
became
a
deliberate
act
of
collective consensus. However, as Canadian postmodernists attempted to push Canadian literary criticism towards a repudiation of such universalizing processes, others refused the idea that Canada was so quickly ready to reject the canon that it had barely begun to form. The most notable defender of the canon has been Robert Lecker, who, in
The Canonization of English-Canadian Literature ,
Making it Real:
accused the poststructuralists of `repudiat-
ing or ignoring the connection . . . between the country and its literature' (1995, 15). Lecker argued that the rejection of the developing canon worked to undermine Canada's still relatively unstable sense of self and, on this point, entered into public dialogue with Davey
during
the
1990s,
as
argument
published between the two writers.
and
counterargument
for
canonization
were
modern north american criticism and theory
222
The politics of canonization had further consequences for a growing body of multicultural writers and critics. Multiculturalism became an official policy in Canada in 1971, was made part of the Charter of Rights in 1982 and was entrenched in domestic policy by the Canadian Multiculturalism Act of 1988. Around this period, a wealth of ethnic literary anthologies
appeared,
but
with
little
impact
(a
representative
list
is
given
in
Smaro
Kamboureli 2000, 132±3), and the first anthology to receive significant critical attention was the 1990 text,
Other Solitudes: Canadian Multicultural Fictions,
edited by Hutcheon and
Marion Richmond. Hutcheon and Richmond undertook to interrogate the parameters of `ethnic literature', and their decision to place established Canadian writers such as Michael Ondaatje and Mordecai Richler within the context of multiculturalism caused so much debate that Hutcheon was later moved to respond with the observation that all Canadian literature is marginal and other, and that `there is an argument to be made that the canon in Canada has been, from the first, a creation of women and ``minorities'' ' (1996, 13). However,
the
debate
continued,
and
in
her
2000
text,
Scandalous Bodies,
Kamboureli
suggests that this inclusive view of multiculturalism merely works to sidestep the problems of marginalism and ethnicity within Canadian literature. In the late twentieth century, both postmodernism and multiculturalism have been increasingly
prominent
in
Anglophone
Canadian
literary
studies.
Both
turn
on
the
multiplicities and marginal identities that are in many ways integral to Canada's identity and both, as can be seen by the protests over
Other Solitudes,
point to the tensions between
canonical and diasporic literatures in English Canada. Furthermore, post-colonial criticism has also risen in influence in recent years. Canada's position as a post-colonial nation is, for many critics, an unstable one. Some have denied that Canada, as a white-settler colony, can accurately be understood as a post-colonial nation when placed within the context of emerging African nations, for example (Williams 1993, 4), whilst others point to the heritage of white Canada as a coloniser of its own indigenous peoples (Bennett 2004; Bannerji 2004). As a unique aspect of imperial history, Canadian post-colonial studies increasingly contributes to the complexity of a wider post-colonial discourse. Canada remains a country with limited unity in terms of language, culture, myth, religion, ethnicity and region. Ultimately, and despite a history of attempting to define and unite the nation through its literary culture, it is this diversity that has best come to characterize Canada and its writing. With the rising influence of post-colonial criticism and multicultural studies, the multiplicities, contradictions and shifting identities that have always been present in the developing body of Canadian literature can be seen to continue to inform Anglophone Canadian literary studies as it develops into the twenty-first century.
Fiona Tolan
Further reading and works cited Atwood, M. Ð (ed.) Ð.
The Journals of Susanna Moodie.
Survival.
Ballstadt, C.
D.
Toronto, 1982.
1972. Toronto, 1996.
The Search for English-Canadian Literature.
Bannerji, H. `Geography Lessons', in Bennett,
Toronto, 1970.
The New Oxford Book of Canadian Verse in English.
`English
Canada's
Peterborough, ON, 2004.
Unhomely States,
Postcolonial
Toronto, 1975. ed. C. Sugars. Peterborough, ON, 2004.
Complexities',
in
Unhomely States,
ed.
C.
Sugars.
anglophone canadian literary studies
223
The History of Emily Montague. London, 1769.
Brooke, F.
Cameron, B. `English Critical Discourse in/on Canada,' in
Studies on Canadian Literature, ed. A. E.
Davidson. New York, 1990. Davey, F. `Surviving the Paraphrase.'
Canadian Literature 70 (1976): 5±13. Repr. in Surviving the
Paraphrase, Winnipeg, 1983, 1±12. Dewart, E. H. Frye, N. ÐÐ.
Selections from Canadian Poets. Montreal, 1864.
The Bush Garden. Toronto, 1971.
Anatomy of Criticism. (1957). Princeton, 2000.
Godard, B. `Structuralism/Post-Structuralism', in
Future Indicative, ed. J. Moss. Ottawa, 1987.
Travels and Adventures in Canada and the Indian Territories between the Years 1760 and 1776.
Henry, A.
(1809). Toronto, 1901. Hutcheon, L.
The Canadian Postmodern. Toronto, 1988.
Ð and Richmond, M. (eds)
Other Solitudes: Canadian Multicultural Fictions . Toronto, 1990.
Ð.
Cultural Difference and the Literary Text, ed. W. Siemerling and K.
`Multicultural
Furor',
in
Schwenk. Iowa City, 1996.
Winter Studies and Summer Rambles in Canada. London, 1838.
Jameson, A. B. Jones, D.
Butterfly on Rock. Toronto, 1970.
Kamboureli, S. Keith, W. J. Lecker, R.
Scandalous Bodies. Don Mills, 2000.
Canadian Literature in English. London, 1985.
Making it Real: The Canonization of English-Canadian Literature. Concord, ON, 1995.
Lighthall, W. D. Mackenzie, A.
Songs from the Great Dominion. London, 1889.
Voyages from Montreal on the River St. Laurence, through the Continent of North America
to the Frozen and Pacific Oceans in the Years 1789 and 1793 . London, 1801. MacLulish, T. D. `Thematic Criticism, Literary Nationalism, and the Critics New Clothes',
Essays on
Canadian Writing, 35, Winter 1987. Qtd in Leandoer, K. From Colonial Expression to Export Commodity. Uppsala, 2002. Handbook of Canadian Literature. Toronto, 1906.
MacMurchy, A. Marquis, T. G. Moodie, S. Moss, J.
English-Canadian Literature. Toronto, 1914.
Roughing It in the Bush. London, 1852.
Patterns of Isolation in English-Canadian Fiction . Toronto, 1974.
Oates, J. C. `Dancing on the Edge of the Precipice', in
Margaret Atwood, ed. E. G. Ingersoll. Princeton,
1990. Pierce, L. A. and Watson, A. D. Roberts, C. G. D. Seton, E. T.
Our Canadian Literature. Ryerson, 1922.
Earth's Enigmas. Boston, 1896.
Wild Animals I have Known. New York, 1898.
Smith, A. J. M. `Wanted ± Canadian Criticism',
Canadian Forum, April, 1928.
Stevenson, L.
Appraisals of Canadian Literature. Toronto, 1926.
Story, Norah.
Oxford Companion to Canadian History and Literature . Oxford, 1967.
Stringer, Arthur. Toye, W. (ed.) Traill, C. P.
Open Water. New York, 1914.
The Oxford Companion to Canadian Literature. Toronto, 1983.
The Backwoods of Canada. London, 1836.
Williams, P. and Chrisman, L.
Colonial Discourse and Post-Colonial Theory. New York, 1993.
30. Francophone Canadian Literature
The development of Francophone Canadian literature has been shaped and influenced by the history of French Canada itself, starting with the travel accounts of the first explorers who recorded the discovery of the `New World', as well as the conflicted relations with the Native population. These constitute the earliest writings in French in Canada and include
Des sauvages, ou voyage de Samuel Champlain, de Brouage (1603), the description of Samuel de Champlain's travels and settlement in baron de Lahontan in
Nouvelle France, the exploration accounts of the
 rique septentrionale (1703), and PierreNouveaux voyages dans l'Ame
Franc Ë ois Xavier de Charlevoix's
 ne  rale de Nouvelle France (1744). Histoire et description ge
Another important aspect of this period of settlement is illustrated by the exchange of letters between French missionaries come to convert the Native population through the colonial
effort
and
their
superiors
in
France;
these
are
known
as
 suites Les relations je
(published between 1632 and 1673) and offer a valuable testimony of life in Canada in the seventeenth century. Similarly, Marie de l'Incarnation's letters to her son, as well as her dictionaries of Algonquian and Iroquois, describe the process of setting up the Ursulines Convent in Quebec City in 1639 and the education and conversion of the local Native population. The publication of the first French Canadian work of fiction would have to wait until 1837, with
 sors ou l'influence d'un livre by Philippe Aubert de Gaspe  fils, a Le chercheur de tre
novel which draws on what would become the French Canadian tradition of the diabolical folktale.
 pe Á re (1863), follows a similar trend and Les anciens Canadiens, by Aubert de Gaspe
also takes inspiration from local folk legends and traditions. However, the publication in 1839 of the `Durham Report', by Lord Durham, the governor-general of British North America at the time, has critical consequences on the development of French Canadian literature: in the wake of the violent insurrections of 1837±38, Lord Durham recommends the assimilation of the French Canadian population into the English-speaking majority as the best way to control their aspirations to independence, famously declaring that French Canada is `a people with no history and no literature'. Proving this assertion wrong has been a central preoccupation for French Canadian authors and intellectuals ever since, starting with Franc Ë ois-Xavier Garneau's
Á nos  couverte jusqu'a Histoire du Canada depuis sa de
jours (1845±8), which is considered still today a seminal work of historical study. Another significant work of the period is Laure Conan's romance
set
in
nineteenth-century
French
Angeline de Montbrun (1884), a historical
Canada
and
revolving
around
the
female
protagonist of the title; this is also the first French Canadian novel authored by a woman. The
genre
of
historical
fiction,
popular
in
the
nineteenth
century,
would
become
prominent again in the latter part of the twentieth century. The
nineteenth
century
also
sees
the
emergence
of
an
important
trend
in
French
francophone canadian literature Canadian letters: the
roman du terroir
225
(novel of the land). The trend celebrates some of the
key beliefs on which French Canada strove during the period of the first
half
of
the
twentieth
patriarchal lifestyle
berceaux
where
century. the
These
Catholic
beliefs
church
were
based
held sway
on
and
survivance, an
where
idyllic the
until the
rural
and
revanche des
(revenge of the cradles) played an important role: women were encouraged to
have large families as a way to ensure the future of the French Canadian nation and save it from the threat of assimilation. Some important Lajoie's
Jean Rivard
Chez nos gens arpents,
romans du terroir
Marie Chapdelaine
 mon's (1862), Louis He
 rininclude Antoine Ge
(1914), and Adjutor Rivard's
Trente
(1918). The genre was brought to an end in 1938 with Ringuet's
which
received
the
Prix
de
 mie l'Acade
Franc Ë aise
(1939)
and
the
Prix
de
la
 bec (1940). The novel offers a more cynical vision of rural life in French Province de Que Canada, and its success is indicative of the increasingly secular and urban aspirations of the nation. The first half of the twentieth century thus marks the arrival of modernity in French Canadian literature, with the work of poets Emile Nelligan ( Emile
Nelligan et son oeuvre,
published in 1904), and Hector de Saint-Denys Garneau ( Regards
et jeux dans l'espace,
published in 1937). They were influenced by the European Modernist movement which also inspired the creation of the
 cole litte  raire de Montre  al E
in 1895, an important school of
thought which lasted over thirty years. The realistic urban novel is another aspect of this modernity, as with
Les Plouffe
(1948) by Roger Lemelin, and
Bonheur d'Occasion
(1945) by
Gabrielle Roy, a novel which has achieved canonical status through its depiction of the difficult life of a working-class neighbourhood in Montreal in the early years of World War II. The realistic urban novel is also a reflection of French Canada's changing lifestyle in the twentieth century, and its increasing disillusion with the restrictive ethos imposed by the Catholic church. The arrival of modernity also brings about the period of the `Quiet Revolution' in the 1960s, an important moment of self-definition and search for a cultural identity in French Canada. One of the outcomes of this fascinating period of literary innovation and cultural self-assertion
 be  cois, Que
is
the
fact
that
the
term
Canadien franc Ë ais
is
progressively
replaced
by
as a means of both emphasising a difference from the rest of the Confederation
and asserting the belonging to a specific territory (Quebec). The use of the
joual,
a local
form of French with Quebecois colloquial expressions, becomes another way to assert the importance and the worth of the `local' against the backdrop of a hegemonic Parisian French; this is the case for instance in Michel Tremblay's play where
language
is
the
means
of
defining
place
and
identity.
Les belles-soeurs
Local
sources
of
(1968), cultural
reference, together with language, are celebrated as the sign of a difference which is no longer synonymous with `minor' or `peripheral', as it was previously in the context of a literature fashioned after France's and England's artistic canon. Quebec's national and artistic claims during the Quiet Revolution are also a reaction against the period known as
la grande noirceur,
which refers to Maurice Duplessis's years as
the Prime Minister of Quebec (1936±9 and 1944±59) and the conservative values his government imposed, with the support of the Catholic church. Underlying these various preoccupations is the central concern with obtaining Quebec's cultural but also political independence from the Confederation; this would eventually lead to the first referendum  rard Bessette (Le on separation in 1980 and finds expression in the novels of Ge 1960),
Hubert
1966)
and
Aquin
Jacques
(Prochain
Godbout
 pisode, e
(Salut
1965),
 jean Re
Galarneau!,
Ducharme
1967),
and
in
Âe (L'avale the
Libraire,
 s, des avale
poetry
of
Yves
modern north american criticism and theory
226
 fontaine (Pays Pre
 , 1970), Fernand sans parole, 1967), Gaston Miron (L'homme rapaille
 sie: Ouellette (Poe
Á mes 1953±1971, 1972) and Miche Á le Lalonde (Speak White, 1974). poe
The
circulation
of
these
works
was
greatly
aided
by
the
establishment
of
small,
local
publishing houses, such as Hexagone which was founded in 1953, and the publication of new intellectual and political journals, such as
Parti pris.
An offspring of this central concern with independence is also the emergence of the genre of the
fantastique in Quebecois literature ± a genre influenced both by the English
Gothic
by
and
French
nineteenth century with  Gaspe
Canada's
tradition
of
the
diabolical
folktale,
emerging
in
the
 sors ou l'influence d'un livre by Philippe Aubert de Le chercheur de tre
 pe Á re. The fantastique becomes a fils and Les anciens Canadiens by Aubert de Gaspe
way for Quebecois authors to express their artistic and political claims during and after the period of the Quiet Revolution, while developing a literary form very much their own. The not strictly realistic quality of the genre provides a means through which a frustrating reality can be altered and a new world, filled with endless possibilities, can be imagined.
fantastique draws on themes of alienation, madness, hidden monstrosity and the evil
The
double to express deep anxieties linked to the uncertain future of Quebec; this is the case in the short stories of Jacques Ferron ( Contes
du pays incertain, 1962) and Roch Carrier (Jolis
 dans l'oeuf (1969). The genre can also deuils, 1964), and in Michel Tremblay's novel La cite enable
the
critique
and
satire
of
the
limitations
 bert's patriarchal society, as in Anne He
imposed
by
an
oppressively
religious
Les enfants du sabbat (1975).
With the advent of the Women's Liberation Movement in the 1970s, female writers in Quebec begin to express radical subversion through literary experimentation and to address their symbolic absence from the essentially male
 be  cois aesthetics developed during the que
period of the Quiet Revolution. The ideal of the
revanche des berceaux (revenge of the
cradles) in particular is criticised by authors such as Marie-Claire Blais in
Une saison dans la
 bert in Kamouraska (1970). That period sees the rise vie d'Emmanuel (1965) and Anne He of a particular type of women's writing seeking to renew the way women are perceived and proposing new strategies in terms of form; as a result, experimentalism becomes a norm in the
work
of
Quebecois
female
authors,
as
seen
in
the
writings
of
Louky
Bersianik
 lionne, 1976), Nicole Brossard (Amantes, 1980) and in Denise Boucher's play (L'Eugue  es ont soif (1978). In the 1980s, after the feminist movement has reached its peak, Les fe Quebec women's writing enters a new phase described as
 tafe  minisme (Saint-Martin me
1992, 81). Rejecting the intense experimentalism of the 1970s, the new trend expresses objectives which differ from those of feminist writing and its overt political agenda, such as abolishing patriarchy and developing a feminine culture.
 tafe  minisme takes distance Me
from the feminist movement and although its authors do agree with its political views, many feel this should not restrict their creativity to the defence of a particular cause (SaintMartin 1992, 81). Examples of
 tafe  ministe fiction include Yolande Villemaire's La vie en me
prose (1980), Nicole Houde's La maison du remous (1986) and Monique Proulx's Le sexe des  toiles (1987). e The concept of `Quebecois literature', originally envisaged as a unified body, a project based on a collective memory and a totalizing vision, has come under scrutiny in recent years
through
the
emergence
of
Francophone
writing
outside
the
borders
of
Quebec's
province: Acadian author Antonine Maillet, for instance, achieved fame and won the prix Goncourt
in
1979
for
her
novel
 lagie-la-Charette, Pe
a
description
of
the
trials
and
tribulations encountered by the Acadian nation in the eighteenth century; while more recently the Franco-Ontarian novelist Daniel Poliquin distinguished himself with
Visions
francophone canadian literature
227
de Jude (1990), a novel which opens up the cultural and linguistic borders of Francophone Canada.
Moreover,
the
presence
of
Aboriginal
writing
in
French,
as
with
Jovette
Le crachat solaire (1975) and An Antane Kapesh's Qu'as-tu fait de mon
Marchessault's
pays? (1979), testify to some of the many First Nation responses to the 1969 government `White
Paper'
written
in
proposing
French,
the removal of
complicate
the
special
notion
of
status
for Native
Quebecois
people. These
literature
as
authored
texts,
by
the
descendants of the original French settlers, and challenge traditional visions of national and cultural borders. Additionally, immigration on a large scale since the 1970s has meant that a growing number of nationalities and ethnic groups are now represented in Canada. A great part of these have found a voice and a role to play on the Quebecois cultural scene, Â gine Robin expressing such themes as diaspora, exile and displacement, as in the work of Re (La
 be  coite, 1983), Mona Latif Ghattas (Le double conte de l'exil, 1990) and Ge  rard Que
Etienne (La
pacotille, 1991). This has also further complicated the claims of the Quiet
Revolution to a national unity based on the use of the French language, and has questioned the link between language, culture and identity. Consequently,
the
idea
of
`Quebecois
literature'
has
been
denounced
as
being
an
increasingly totalizing concept and becoming simply a formula, an empty shell (Nepveu 1988,
13);
it
has
fragmentation
been
and
the
progressively idea
of
replaced
movement
by
within
an
emphasis
texts
which
on are
plurality,
diversity,
constantly
evolving
(Nepveu 1988, 14). The project of developing a national culture and literature, which was one of the key objectives of the 1960s, has thus simultaneously been realised and dissipated; this
marks
the
`end'
of
Quebecois
literature
beginning of a new phase described as
as
it
was
originally
conceived,
and
the
 rature post-que  be  coise (Nepveu 1988, 14). litte
An important aspect of this new phase is the concern with re-reading and re-evaluating Quebec's past and its role in the formation of the nation; this is visible in Quebecois authors and intellectuals' recurrent need to go back to the period of the Quiet Revolution in order to examine how the national discourse was initially formed and question the linguistic, political and cultural beliefs set in place at the time. As a consequence, the historical novel has seen a resurgence since the 1980s, a historical fiction which explores the fundamental aspects of both Canadian history, specifically, and the writing of history, more generally (Wyile et al. 2002, 4). The Francophone Canadian historical fiction is indeed not only concerned with the politics of historical representation, addressing `some of
the
darker
corners
of
Canadian
history',
but
also
with
drawing
`attention
to
the
mechanics of historical representation ± the conventions and textual devices that both permit and complicate the representation of pastness' (Wyile et al. 2002, 4). This form of writing is described as `post-modern historical novel' (Paterson 1993, 54) and it has allowed renewal of the genre of historical fiction, while giving rise to some fresh thinking on both history and historiography (Desjardins 1999, 47). The
trend
is
particularly
prominent
in
the
work
of
women
historical novel, offer new readings of narratives of the Quebec
history
oppressed
in
female
 oret (Nous The
creating
figures
are
specifically given
an
female
historical
opportunity
to
writers
past and spaces
make
who,
attempt to
in
which
themselves
with
the
`re-write'
traditionally
heard.
France
 crit, 1982), Madeleine Ouellette-Michalska ( La maison parlerons comme on e
 bert (Le premier jardin, Tresler, 1984), Arlette Cousture (Les filles de Caleb, 1985), Anne He 1988), Nancy Huston (Cantique
des plaines, 1993) and Rachel Leclerc (Noces de sable,
1995) all locate their fiction in the past and use actual historical figures in order to question hegemonic and national historical discourses.
modern north american criticism and theory
228
The writing of historical fiction thus holds a political purpose: it is linked to overcoming the weight of colonial cultural hegemony which dictated that, previously, Quebec was `a people with no history and no literature'. Through the re-assertion of their local values Quebecois writers are pushing against the notion of what has been traditionally accepted as aesthetically worthy. Such traditions have been established in the past and it could be argued that these writers' attempts at re-visiting the past, and at re-interpreting it, have much to do with their will to assert a renewed sense of self in the present and influence the way in which their nation's future is defined.
Elodie Rousselot
Further reading and works cited  recompose  : la pre  sence de l'Histoire dans le roman que  be  cois contemporain Desjardins, N. `Le passe (1980±1995)', in Nepveu, P.
Á se, antithe Á se, synthe Á se II, ed. M. Coulombe and Y. Duchesne. Montreal, 1999. The
 cologie du re  el. Montreal, 1988. L'e
Paterson, J. M.
 be  cois. Ottawa, 1993. Moments postmodernes dans le roman que
 tafe  minisme et la nouvelle prose fe  minine au Que  bec', Saint-Martin, L. `Le me
Voix et Images, 18,
1992. Â ', Wyile, H. et al. `Past Matters/Choses du passe
canadienne, 27:1, 2002.
  rature Studies in Canadian Literature/ Etudes en litte
Contributors Kenneth Womack, Pennsylvania State University, Altoona Charles Altieri, University of California, Berkeley William Baker, Northern Illinois University Imre Salusinszky, University of Newcastle, Australia Mark Currie, Anglia Polytechnic University Jeremy Lane, University of Sussex Ortwin de Graef, Katholieke universiteit, Leuven William Flesch, Brandeis University Carolyn Lesjak, Swarthmore College John Kucich, University of Michigan Ruth Robbins, University College, Northampton Megan Becker-Leckrone, University of Nevada, Las Vegas Anne Donadey, San Diego State University Virginia Mason Vaughan, Clark University David Van Leer, University of California, Davis Malini Johar Schueller, University of Florida Marcel Cornis-Pope, Virginia Commonwealth University Yun Hsing Wu, Indiana University  de la Luz Montes, University of Nebraska, Lincoln Amelia Maria Toby Miller, New York University Julian Wolfreys, University of Florida Kate Flint, Linacre College, Oxford University Betsy Nies, University of North Florida David Alderson, Manchester University Christopher Eklund, Deparment of English, University of Florida Fiona Tolan, Lecturer, Department of English Studies, University of Durham Elodie Rousselot, School of English, University of Kent at Canterbury
Index
Abrahams, Julie, 114
Barnes, Harry Elmer, 27
Abrams, M. H., 30, 31
Barthes, Roland, 27, 128, 177
Achebe, Chinua, 119
Bataille, Georges, 52
Acker, Kathy, 182
Baudrillard, Jean, 57
Acosta, Oscar, 148
Baudry, Jean-Louis, 161
Addington Symons, John, 111
Beal, Frances, 97, 99
Adler, Mortimer, 13
Beardsley, Monroe, 49
Adorno, Theodor, 55, 58, 127
Beauvoir, Simone de, 79, 160, 202
Ahmad, Aijaz, 119
Bellow, Saul, 17
 n, Norma, 100, 101, 117, 195 Alarco
Belsey, Catherine, 108
Alavi, Hamza, 120
Benjamin, Walter, 51, 58
Alighieri, Dante, 82
Bentham, Jeremy, 156
Alkon, Paul, 15
Benveniste, Emile, 50
Allen, Paula Gunn, 99, 100, 102
Berlant, Laurent, 116, 117
Althusser, Louis, 57
Berry, Ellen E., 133
Anaya, Rudolfo, 148
Bersani, Leo, 116
Anderson, Benedict, 124
Bersianik, Louky, 226
Anderson, Perry, 61, 62
Bertens, Hans, 176
Andrew, Dudley, 154
 rube  , Allan, 111 Be
Anger, Kenneth, 111
 rard, 225 Bessette, Ge
 a, Gloria, 99, 101, 102, 117, 124, 131, Anzaldu
Bhabha, Homi K., 47, 68, 118, 119, 120, 121,
148, 149
122, 165, 189
Appadurai, Arjun, 124
Birney, Earle, 215
Appiah, Kwame Anthony, 189
Black, Daniel P., 203
Aquin, Hubert, 225
Blackmur, R. P., 4
Aristotle, 12, 15, 16
Blais, Marie-Claire, 226
Armstrong, Nancy, 76
Blake, William, 18, 19, 21, 24, 25
Arteaga, Alfred, 144
Blanchot, Maurice, 46, 49, 50, 51
Asensi, Manuel, 48
Bleich, David, 33±9
Ashberry, John, 46
Bloch, Ernst, 56, 58
Atwood, Margaret, 215, 219
Bloom, Harold, 18, 22, 23, 31, 40±8, 50, 51,
Ault, Donald, 209, 210
53, 54, 76, 212
Austen, Jane, 121
Bly, Robert, 201
Austen, Jane, 76
Bobo, Jacqueline, 158
Austin, J. L., 38
Bond, Donald F., 15 Bontemps, Arna, 139
Baker, Houston, 119, 138
Boone, Joseph Allen, 112
Bakhtin, Mikhail, 16, 196
Boose, Lynda E., 108
 de, 57 Balzac, Honore
Booth, Wayne C., 13, 15, 16, 30, 169, 171,
Bambara, Toni Cade, 100, 140 Barks, Carl, 208
172, 175 Boswell, John, 111
index Boucher, Denise, 226 Bourdieu, Pierre, 52
231
Crane, Ronald Salmon, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 19, 26
 , Paul Bove
Crawford, Joan, 161
Brant, Beth, 99, 102
 , 98, 117 Crenshaw, Kimberle
Brecht, Bertolt, 55, 59
Crews, Frederick, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 94
È , Charlotte, 75 Bronte
Crumb, Robert, 209
È , Emily, 76 Bronte
Culler, Jonathan, 26, 28, 29, 31, 34, 39
Brooke, Frances, 216 Brooks, Cleanth, 4, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 27
D'Emilio, John, 111, 112
Brooks, Gwendolyn, 77
D'haen, Theo, 176
Brooks, Peter, 83, 87, 88, 89, 90, 92
 , 211 Daumier, Honore
Brossard, Nicole, 226
Davey, Frank, 217, 220, 221
Brown, Jeffrey A., 212
Davidoff, Leonore, 202
Brown, Judith C., 111
Davidson, Sol, 209
 lez, Yolanda, 147 Broyles-Gonza
Davis, Angela, 99, 127
Burke, Edmund, 94
Davis, Bette, 161
Burke, Kenneth, 4, 10, 92, 189
Davis, Natalie Zemon, 191
Butler, Judith, 47, 52, 80, 84, 85, 115, 116,
De Charlevoix, Pierre-Franc Ë ois Xavier, 224
165, 204, 205
De Graef, Ortwin, 49 De L'Incarnation, Marie, 224
Cabot, John, 215 Calderwood, Ann, 190
De Man, Paul, 10, 14, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 40±8, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 92, 93, 94
Callaghan, Dympna, 108
De Ortego y Gasca, Felipe, 146
Camus, Albert, 121
Deely, John, 1
Cantor, Paul, 109
DeKoven, Marianne, 129
Carby, Hazel, 100, 123, 140
Deleuze, Gilles, 50, 52, 57, 122, 178
Carrier, David, 211
Derrida, Jacques, 17, 26, 27, 28, 29, 31, 32,
Carrier, Roch, 226 Caruth, Cathy, 51
40±8, 49, 50, 53, 57, 64, 94, 95, 113, 123, 177, 180
Case, Sue-Ellen, 115
Devi, Mahasweta, 122
Castillo, Ana, 98, 149
Dewart, Edward Hartley, 214, 216, 217
 , 120 Cesaire, Aime
Dick, Philip K., 179
Chase, Cynthia, 51
Dickens, Charles, 23
Chase, Cynthia, 87, 92, 93, 94
Dickinson, Emily, 76
Chatman, Seymour, 39
Dillon, G., 39
Chatterjee, Partha, 119, 124
Dirlik, Arif, 119
Chauncey, George, 111
Doane, Mary Ann, 162, 163, 164
Chavez, Denise, 149
Doctorow, E. L., 179
Chow, Rey, 123
Donaldson, Laura, 99
Christian, Barbara, 100, 102, 165, 183, 195
Douglass, Frederick, 138
Chumacero, Olivia, 147
Du Bois, W. E. B., 136, 193, 194, 195, 196
Cisneros, Sandra, 149
Duberman, Martin Bauml, 112
 le Á ne, 188 Cixous, He
 jean, 225 Ducharme, Re
Cliff, Michele, 102
Duplessis, Maurice, 225
Clifford, James, 65
Dyer, Richard, 117, 195, 196
Cohen, Ralph, 188 Cohen, Walter, 109
Eagleton, Terry, 4, 11, 24, 26, 32, 66, 71, 123
Coleridge, Samuel Taylor, 23
Easthope, Antony, 127
Collins, Patricia Hill, 100, 101
Edelman, Lee, 53, 112
Comfort, Alex, 111
Eisner, Will, 209, 210
Conan, Laure, 224
Elam, Diane, 80, 83
Connery, Sean, 153
Eliot, George, 75, 76, 94
Conrad, Joseph, 57, 64, 67, 88, 89, 90, 121
Ellis, Havelock, 111
Coover, Robert, 179, 182
Ellmann, Mary, 72, 73, 79
Corrington, Robert S., 3
Ellmann, Maud, 88, 92
Cousure, Arlette, 227
Epstein, Mikhail N., 133
index
232 Erickson, Peter, 108 Etienne, GeÂrard, 227 Even-Zohar, Itamar, 180 Faderman, Lillian, 112 Fanon, Frantz, 120, 121, 131, 203 Fekete, John, 4 Felman, Shoshana, 46, 51, 87, 90, 91, 92 Ferron, Jacques, 226 Fetterley, Judith, 79 Fiedler, Leslie, 126 Fielding, Henry, 12, 16 Fish, Stanley, 33±9 Flaubert, Gustave, 94 Fletcher, Angus, 23 Flitterman-Lewis, Susan, 156 Foerster, Norman, 5 Ford, J. D. M., 187 Foster, Jeannette H., 111 Foucault, Michel, 84, 104, 105, 112, 112, 121, 122, 156, 178, 180, 182 Frankenberg, 117 Fraser, Nancy, 181 Freedman, Estelle, 111, 112 Freud, Sigmund, 49, 51, 52, 53, 83, 87, 88, 90, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 111, 155, 163 Friedan, Betty, 70, 71, 76, 114 Friedman, Arthur, 15 Friedman, Susan Stanford, 83, 84, 184 Frye, Marilyn, 195 Frye, Northrop, 18±25, 43, 214, 215, 219, 220 Fuller, Margaret, 138 Fung, Richard, 158 Funt, D., 29 Gaines, Jane, 164, 165 Gallop, Jane, 81, 82, 83 Garber, Marjorie, 189 Gardner, John, 170 Garfinkel, Harold, 157 Garneau, FrancËois-Xavier, 224 Garneau, Hector de Saint-Denys, 225 Garvey, John, 198 Garvey, Marcus, 131 GascheÂ, Rodolphe, 31 Gaskell, Elizabeth, 75 Gaspe (peÁre), Aubert de, 224, 226 Gaspe (fils), Philippe Aubert de, 224, 266 Gates Jr., Henry Louis, 119, 131, 138, 141, 189 Gayle, Addison, 141 Geertz, Clifford, 105 Genet, Jean, 72 Genette, GeÂrard, 16 GeÂrin-Lajoie, Antoine, 225 Ghattas, Mona Latif, 227
Gibbons, Dave, 210 Gilbert, Sandra M., 76, 79 Giovanni, Nikki, 77 Giroux, Henry, 127 Gissing, George, 57 Godard, Jean-Luc, 50 Godbout, Jacques, 225 Goldberg, Jonathan, 52, 106, 108 GonzaÂlez, Ray, 149 Gould, Janice, 99, 102 Graff, Gerald, 4, 13, 14, 17, 26, 27, 167, 168 Gramsci, Antonio, 194 Greenblatt, Stephen, 47, 52, 103±9, 130, 189 Greer, Germaine, 160 Greif, Martin, 111 Groth, Gary, 212 Guattari, FeÂlix, 57 Gubar, Susan, 76, 79, 81, 82, 84, 85 Guillory, John, 52, 53, 129 Guinier, Lani, 98 Halberstam, Judith, 117, 205 Hall, Catherine, 202 Hall, Stuart, 117, 132, 133 Hamacher, Werner, 53 Hamilton, A. C., 25 Haraway, Donna, 131, 189 Harding, Sandra, 181 Harpham, Geoffrey Galt, 174 Harriot, Thomas, 105 Harris, Bertha, 111 Harsnett, Samuel, 105 Harth, Philip, 15 Hartman, Geoffrey, 18, 40±8 Harvey, Robert C., 211 Haskell, Molly, 161 Hassan, Ihab, 178, 188 Hatfield, Charles, 212 HeÂbert, Anne, 226, 227 Heer, Jeet, 208 Hegel, G. W. F., 49, 60, 123 Heidegger, Martin, 40, 49, 53, 182 HeÂmon, Louis, 225 Henry, Alexander (the Elder), 215 Herrera-Sobek, MarõÂa, 100 Herriman, George, 208 Hertz, Neil, 52, 53, 87, 92, 93, 94 Hignite, M. Todd, 212 Hill, Christopher, 53 Hinojosa, Rolando, 148 Hirschfeld, Magnus, 111 Hitler, Adolf, 127 Hogarth, William, 206 Hoggart, Richard, 126 Holland, Norman, 16, 33±9 Hong Kingston, Maxine, 102
index
233
Hooker, Richard, 104
Krupat, Arnold, 130
hooks, bell, 82, 119, 123, 124, 131, 165
Kunzle, David, 209, 210
Hopkins, Mary Frances, 15
Kurtzman, Harvey, 208
Hopkins, Pauline, 136 Houde, Nicole, 226 Howard, Jean E., 107, 108, 109
Lacan, Jacques, 50, 52, 87, 88, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 178
Hughes, Langston, 193
LaDuke, Winona, 99
Hurston, Zora Neale, 77, 136
Á le, 226 Lalonde, Miche
Huston, Nancy, 227
Lamming, George, 120, 123
Hutcheon, Linda, 180
Landa, Louis A., 15
Hutchins, Robert Maynard, 13
Larsen, Nella, 77
Huyssen, Andreas, 178
Lauretis, Teresa de, 116, 128, 156, 162 Lazenby, George, 153
Ignatiev, Noel, 198
Leacock, Stephen, 218
Inge, M. Thomas, 210
Lecker, Robert, 221
Irigaray, Luce, 114, 189
Leclerc, Rachel, 227
Âaz, Ada Marõ Âa, 98 Isai-Dõ
Lee, Stan, 208 Lemelin, Roger, 225
Jablon, Madelyn, 142
Lent, John, 212
Jaimes, M. Annette, 99
Lentricchia, Frank, 109
Jakobson, Roman, 28, 50
Levinas, Emmanuel, 49, 51, 52
James, C. L. R., 120
 vi-Strauss, Claude, 53 Le
James, Henry, 91, 116, 173
Lewis, Wyndham, 55
Jameson, Fredric, 46, 55±62, 105, 128, 129,
Lidov, David, 2
130, 132, 178
Lighthall, William Douw, 216, 217
Jarrell, Randall, 10
Ling, Amy, 100
Johnson, Barbara, 46, 51, 140
Liu, Alan, 52, 192
Johnson, Barbara, 80, 84, 85, 87, 89, 92, 94,
Â, Francisco, 144, 145 Lomelõ
95
Long, Elizabeth, 128
Johnson, James Weldon, 136
Longinus, 16, 94
Johnston, Claire, 161
Lorde, Audre, 99, 101, 102, 116, 123
Jones, Douglas, 219
Lowe, Lisa, 120, 124
Jonson, Ben, 108
 cs, Georg, 58, 59, 60, 61 Luka
Jordan, Winthrop, 194
Lyotard, Jean-Franc Ë ois, 59, 105, 167, 181
Kamuf, Peggy, 80
McCloud, Scott, 210, 211, 212
Kanafani, Ghassan, 67
McDowell, Deborah, 140, 142
Kant, Immanuel, 50, 53, 94, 123
McHale, Brian, 180
Kapesh, An Antane, 227
McIntosh, Peggy, 195
Katz, Jonathan Ned, 111
McKay, Windsor, 208
Kauffman, Linda, 80
Mackenzie, Alexander, 215
Kay, Jackie, 205
McKeon, Richard P., 13, 14, 15
Keast, W. R., 13, 15
MacLean, Norman, 13, 15
Keats, John, 50, 53
MacLulish, T. D., 221
Keenan, Thomas, 51, 53
McRobbie, Angela, 128
Keith, W. J., 216, 218
Maddox, Lucy, 191
Kenny, Shirley Strum, 15
Mahmood, Saba, 133
Kermode, Frank, 28, 90
Mailer, Norman, 72
Kirby, Jack, 208
Maillet, Antonine, 226
Kleist, Heinrich von, 50
Malek, James, 15
Klock, Geoff, 212
 , Ste  phane, 50 Mallarme
Kolb, Gwin J., 15
Mandel, Eli, 217
Kolodny, Annette, 127
Mandel, Ernest, 60
Kornillon, Susan Coppelman, 73
Mankiller, Wilma, 99
Krafft-Ebbing, Richard von, 111
Marchak, Patricia, 220
Kristeva, Julia, 57, 93, 122, 190
Marchessault, Jovette, 227
index
234
Marcuse, Herbert, 56
Norris, Christopher, 26, 167, 168
Âa, 53 Â rquez, Gabriel Garcõ Ma
Nussbaum, Martha C., 169, 173, 174
Marquis, T. G., 217
Nyeberg, Amy Kyste, 211
Marshall, Paula, 77 Martin, Biddy, 84
Olson, Charles, 176
Martin, Robert K., 112
Olson, Elder, 13, 14, 15, 19
Ânez, Julio, 144, 145 Martõ
Ondaatje, Michael, 222
Marx, Karl, 56, 58
Ong, Aihwa, 124
Matsuda, Mari, 98
Ong, Walter J., 39
Maus, Katherine Eisaman, 109
Orgel, Stephen, 106, 108
Mellon, Joan, 161
Ouellette, Fernand, 226
Memmi, Albert, 120, 131
Ouellette-Michalska, Madeleine, 227
Mercer, Kobena, 114, 117
Outcault, R. F., 208
Merleau-Ponty, Maurice, 50
Owens, Craig, 112
Merrell, Floyd, 2 Metz, Christian, 160, 161
Parain, Brice, 50
Michaels, Walter Benn, 52
 rico, 148 Paredes, Ame
Miller, D. A., 52, 112
Paris, Bernard J., 16
Miller, Frank, 210
Parker, David, 168
Miller, J. Hillis, 30, 31, 40±8, 52, 172, 173
Parry, Benita, 65
Millett, Kate, 114, 160
Pascal, Blaise, 50
Milton, John, 8, 18, 19, 21, 37
Patai, Daphne, 85
Minh-ha, Trinh T., 123
Pearce, Roy Harvey, 27
Mirikitani, Janice, 101
Pease, Donald, 189
Miron, Gaston, 226
Pechter, Edward, 108, 109
Modleski, Tania, 165
Penley, Constance, 156
Moers, Ellen, 74, 76, 114
Perez-Torres, Rafael, 144
Mohanty, Chandra, 99, 123
Perloff, Marjorie, 132, 178
Moi, Toril, 73
Pfeil, Fred, 197
Monroe, Marilyn, 164
Phelan, James, 13, 16
Montgomery, L. M., 218
Pierce, Charles Sanders, 1±3
Montrose, Louis Adrian, 106, 107, 109
Pierce, Lorne, 218
Moodie, Susanna, 216
Plath, Sylvia, 76
Moore, Alan, 210
Poe, Edgar Allan, 94, 95, 196
Âe, 99, 101, 102, 117, 148 Moraga, Cherrõ
Pope, Alexander, 51
Morales, Alejandro, 148
Porter, Catherine, 109
More, Paul Elmer, 5
Poulet, Georges, 43, 44, 188
More, Sir Thomas, 104
 fontaine, Yves, 226 Pre
Morgan, Edmund S., 194
Preminger, Alexander, 13
Morgan, Robin, 114
Presley, Elvis, 197
Morrison, Toni, 77, 102, 182, 183, 196
Proulx, Monique, 226
Moss, John, 219
Pynchon, Thomas, 179, 182
Mullaney, Steven, 108 Mulvey, Laura, 115, 160, 161, 164
Rackin, Phyllis, 108 Raeburn, Daniel, 212
Natoli, Joseph, 181
Raleigh, Sir Walter, 104
Neely, Carol Thomas, 108
Ransom, John Crowe, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 17, 26,
Nehru, Jawaharlal, 120
27, 187
Nelligan, Emile, 225
Rea, Daniel Ferreiro, 146
Neogy, Rajat, 192
Reagan, Ronald, 144
Newitz, Annalee, 197, 198
Rebolledo, Tey Diana, 145, 148, 149
Newman, Charles, 179
Rechy, John, 148
Newman, Karen, 108
Retamar, Roberto Fernandez, 120
Newton, Esther, 115
Rich, Adrienne, 97, 115, 195
Nicholson, Linda J., 181
Rich, B. Ruby, 161
Nietzsche, Friedrich, 30, 49, 53
Richards, I. A., 6, 7, 8, 10, 28, 39
index
235
Richardson, Dorothy, 75
Shelley, Mary, 76
Richler, Mordecai, 222
Shelley, Percy Bysshe, 22, 46, 50, 53
Rivard, Adjutor, 225
Shohat, Ella, 133
 s, 148 Rivera, Toma
Showalter, Elaine, 70, 73, 74, 75, 76, 79, 112,
Rivero, Eliana, S., 145
203
Á re, Joan, 115 Rivie
Shumway, David, 127
Robbins, Trina, 212
Siebers, Tobin, 168, 169, 172
Roberts, Charles G. D., 218
Siegal, Jerry, 208
 gine, 227 Robin, Re
Silverman, Kaja, 162, 163, 200
Robinson, James Harvey, 27
Silverstein, Charles, 111
Rodriguez, Luis J., 149
Sinfield, Alan, 205
Roedigger, David, 194, 196, 197
Sisley, Emily, 111
Rorty, Richard, 183
Smith, A. J. M., 218, 220
Rose, Jacqueline, 160
Smith, Barbara, 77, 98, 99, 100, 102, 117, 131
Rose, Wendy, 99, 102
Smith, Paul, 127
Rosen, Marjorie, 161
Smith, Sharon, 160
Rosenblatt, Louise, 39, 169, 170
Smith-Rosenberg, Carol, 112, 114
Rosencranz, Patrick, 212
Sokal, Alan, 53
Rosenfeld, Isaac, 17
Solomon-Godeau, Abigail, 200
Rosenheim, Edward W., 15
Soyinka, Wole, 192
Rosenthal, Sandra B., 3
Spacks, Patricia Meyer, 73, 74, 76, 77
Rossetti, Christina, 76
Spanos, Willliam V., 188
Rousseau, George, 112
Spengler, Oswald, 24
Rousseau, Jean-Jacques, 50
Spenser, Edmund, 104
Roy, Gabrielle, 225
Spiegelman, Art, 209, 210
Ruegg, Maria, 32
Spillers, Hortense J., 101, 119, 140
Ruggiero, Guido, 111
Spivak, Gayatri Chakravorty, 46, 52, 82, 83,
Rukeyser, Muriel, 77
98, 101, 119, 121, 122, 123, 131
Russell, Charles, 177
Stam, Robert, 133, 161
Russell, Jane, 164
Starobinski, Jean, 43
Russo, Vito, 111
Steiner, George, 17
Rutherford, Jonathan, 201
Stimpson, Catherine, 190 Story, Norah, 219
Sabin, Roger, 211
Strauss, Leo, 50, 52
Sacks, Sheldon, 13, 16, 189
Stringer, Arthur, 217
Said, Edward, 31, 32, 63±9, 118, 119, 120,
Strout, Cushing, 27
121, 131
Sukenick, Ronald, 179, 182
 , 124 Saldivar, Jose
Suleiman, Susan Rubin, 183
Sandoval, Chela, 98
Sussman, Herbert, 201
Sartre, Jean-Paul, 49, 50, 55, 58 Saussure, Ferdinand de, 50
Takaki, Ronald, 119
Saxton, Alexander, 196
Tate, Allen, 4, 7, 8, 9,
Schomberg, Arthur, 136
Taussig, Michael, 189
Schor, Naomi, 80, 81, 82, 84
Taylor, Charles, 132
Schueller, Malini, 125
 oret, France, 227 The
Schuster, Joe, 208
Thody, Philip, 28
Scott, Joan Wallach, 85, 86, 190
Thornham, Sue, 160, 161, 166
Searle, John, 31, 38
Tillyard, E. M. W., 104
Sedgwick, Eve Kosofsky, 52, 53, 80, 81, 115,
Todorov, Tzvetan, 28
201, 203
Tolson, Andew, 200
Segal, Lynne, 200, 203
Traill, Catherine Parr, 216
Sembene, Ousmene, 60
Trambley, Ester Portillo, 148
Senghor, Leopold, 120
Tremblay, Michel, 225, 226
Seton, Ernest Thompson, 218
Trilling, Lionel, 92
Shakespeare, William, 104, 105, 108, 109
Truth, Sojourner, 98
Shanley, Kate, 99
Turner, Graeme, 154
index
236
Ulrichs, Karl Heinrich, 111
White, Edmund, 111
Urrea, Alberto, 149
Wiegman, Robyn, 81, 82, 84, 85, 117 Wilde, Oscar, 116, 201
Van Leer, David, 117
Williams, Bernard, 171, 173
 squez, Richard, 148 Va
Williams, Raymond, 17, 104, 127, 128, 155
Vico, Giambattista, 24, 65, 67
Wilson, John Dover, 104
Ân, Carlos, 146 Villalongõ
Wimsatt, W. K., 7, 27, 49
 Antonio, 148 Villarreal, Jose
Wing, Adrien, 98
Villemaire, Yolande, 226
Winters, Yvor, 4
Âa, 149 Viramontes, Helena Marõ
Winterson, Jeanette, 205 Witek, Joseph, 210
Walker, Alice, 77, 97, 100, 102, 140, 158
Woo, Deborah, 100
Walker, Margaret, 77
Woodcock, George, 219
Warminski, Andrzej, 47
Woolf, Virginia, 75, 82
Warner, Michael, 116
Worcester, Kent, 208
Warren, Robert Penn, 4
Wordsworth, William, 46, 47, 50, 52, 82, 92,
Washington, Mary Helen, 100
93, 94
Washington, Mary Helen, 139
Wray, Matt, 197, 198
Watson, Albert, 218
Wright, Bradford D., 211
Watts, Edward, 125 Wayne, Valerie, 108
Xun, Lu, 60
Weber, Max, 52, 58 Weiksel, Thomas, 94
Yamada, Mitsuye, 100, 102
Weimann, Robert, 188
Yarbro-Bejaranu, Yvonne, 100
Weinberg, Bernard, 15
Young, Lola, 165
Weinbrot, Howard, 15 Â , 5, 27, 28 Wellek, Rene
Zhang, Xudong
West, Cornel, 135
Zimmerman, Bonnie, 114